UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549
FORM 20-F
¨ |
REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) OR 12(g) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 |
OR
x |
ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 |
For the fiscal year ended March 31, 2015
OR
¨ |
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 |
For the transition period from to
OR
¨ |
SHELL COMPANY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 |
Date of event requiring this shell company report
Commission file number 001-32945
WNS
(Holdings) Limited
(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)
Not Applicable
(Translation of Registrants name into English)
Jersey, Channel Islands
(Jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)
Gate 4, Godrej & Boyce Complex
Pirojshanagar, Vikhroli(W)
Mumbai 400 079, India
(Address of principal executive offices)
Sanjay Puria
Group
Chief Financial Officer
Gate 4, Godrej & Boyce Complex
Pirojshanagar, Vikhroli(W)
Mumbai 400 079, India
(91-22) 4095-2100
sanjay.puria@wns.com
(Name, Telephone, E-mail and/or Facsimile number and Address of Company Contact Person)
Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act.
|
|
|
Title of each class |
|
Name of each exchange on which registered |
American Depositary Shares, each represented by |
|
The New York Stock Exchange |
one Ordinary Share, par value 10 pence per share |
|
|
Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act.
None
(Title of Class)
Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act
None
(Title of Class)
Indicate the number of outstanding shares of each of the issuers classes of capital or common stock as of the close of the period covered by
the annual report.
As at March 31, 2015, 51,950,662 ordinary shares, par value 10 pence per share, were issued and outstanding, of which 51,770,634
ordinary shares were held in the form of American Depositary Shares, or ADSs. Each ADS represents one ordinary share.
Indicate by check mark if the
registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities
Act. x Yes ¨ No
If this report is an annual or transition report, indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or
15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. ¨ Yes x No
Note Checking the box above will not relieve any registrant required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities
Exchange Act of 1934 from their obligations under those Sections.
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant: (1) has filed all reports required
to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing
requirements for the past 90 days. x Yes ¨ No
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required
to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files). ¨ Yes ¨ No
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, or a non-accelerated filer. See definition of
accelerated filer and large accelerated filer in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):
|
|
|
|
|
Large accelerated filer x |
|
Accelerated filer ¨ |
|
Non-accelerated filer ¨ |
Indicate by check mark which basis of accounting the registrant has used to prepare the financial statements included in this
filing:
|
|
|
|
|
U.S. GAAP ¨ |
|
International Financial Reporting Standards as issued
by the International Accounting Standards Board x |
|
Other ¨ |
If Other has been checked in response to the previous question, indicate by check mark which financial statement
item the registrant has elected to follow: ¨ Item 17 ¨ Item 18
If this report is an annual report, indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange
Act). ¨ Yes x No
TABLE OF CONTENTS
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
Ex-4.12 Lease Deed commencing April 28, 2014 between WNS Global Services Private Limited and DLF Assets Private Limited
with respect to the lease of office premises on the 10th floor of Blocks A2 and A3 at World Tech Park.
Ex-4.13 Lease Deed commencing April 28, 2014 between WNS Global Services Private Limited and DLF Assets Private Limited with respect to the lease of office
premises on the 8th, 9th and 11th floors of Blocks A2 and A3 at World Tech Park.
Ex-8.1 List of subsidiaries of WNS (Holdings) Limited
Ex-12.1
Certification by the Chief Executive Officer to 17 CFR 240, 15d-14(a), as adopted pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
Ex-12.2
Certification by the Chief Financial Officer to 17 CFR 240, 15d-14(a), as adopted pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
Ex-13.1
Certification by the Chief Executive Officer to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
Ex-13.2 Certification by the Chief Financial Officer to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
Ex-15.1 Consent of Grant Thornton, independent registered public accounting firm
1
CONVENTIONS USED IN THIS ANNUAL REPORT
In this annual report, references to US are to the United States of America, its territories and its possessions. References to UK are
to the United Kingdom. References to India are to the Republic of India. References to China are to the Peoples Republic of China. References to South Africa are to the Republic of South Africa. References
to $ or dollars or US dollars are to the legal currency of the US, references to
or rupees or Indian rupees are to the legal currency of India, references to pound sterling or £ are to the legal currency of the UK, references to
pence are to the legal currency of Jersey, Channel Islands, references to Euro are to the legal currency of the European Monetary Union, references to South African rand or R or ZAR are to
the legal currency of South Africa, references to A$ or AUD or Australian dollars are to the legal currency of Australia and references to RMB are to the legal currency of China. Our financial
statements are presented in US dollars. Prior to April 1, 2011, we prepared our financial statements in accordance with US generally accepted accounting principles, or US GAAP. With effect from April 1, 2011, we adopted the International
Financial Reporting Standards and its interpretations, or IFRS, as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board, or the IASB. Our financial statements included in this annual report are prepared in accordance with
IFRS, as issued by the IASB. Unless otherwise indicated, references to GAAP in this annual report are to IFRS, as issued by the IASB.
References to a particular fiscal year are to our fiscal year ended March 31 of that calendar year. Any discrepancies in any table between
totals and sums of the amount listed are due to rounding.
In this annual report, unless otherwise specified or the context requires, the term
WNS refers to WNS (Holdings) Limited, a public company incorporated under the laws of Jersey, Channel Islands, and the terms our company, we, our and us refer to WNS (Holdings) Limited and
its subsidiaries.
In this annual report, references to Commission are to the United States Securities and Exchange Commission.
We also refer in various places within this annual report to revenue less repair payments, which is a non-GAAP financial measure that is
calculated as (a) revenue less (b) in our auto claims business, payments to repair centers (1) for fault repair cases where we act as the principal in our dealings with the third party repair centers and our clients and
(2) for non-fault repair cases with respect to one former client (whose contract with us was terminated with effect from April 18, 2012). This non-GAAP financial information is not meant to be considered in isolation or as a
substitute for our financial results prepared in accordance with GAAP.
We also refer to information regarding the business process management, or BPM,
industry, our company and our competitors from market research reports, analyst reports and other publicly available sources. Although we believe that this information is reliable, we have not independently verified the accuracy and completeness of
the information. We caution you not to place undue reliance on this data. We previously described BPM as business process outsourcing, or BPO.
This annual report also includes information regarding the BPO market from the Gartner Inc.,Forecast: IT Services, Worldwide, 2013-2019 1Q15
Update report dated March 16, 2015 by Gartner Inc. (which we refer to herein as the Gartner Report). The Gartner Report described herein contains data, research opinions or viewpoints published, as part of a syndicated
subscription service, by Gartner, Inc. (Gartner), and are not representations of fact. The Gartner Report speaks as of its original publication date (and not as of the date of this annual report) and the opinions expressed in the Gartner
Report are subject to change without notice.
SPECIAL NOTE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS
This annual report contains forward-looking statements that are based on our current expectations, assumptions, estimates and projections about our
company and our industry. The forward-looking statements are subject to various risks and uncertainties. Generally, these forward-looking statements can be identified by the use of forward-looking terminology such as anticipate,
believe, estimate, expect, intend, will, project, seek, should and similar expressions. Those statements include, among other things, the discussions of
our business strategy and expectations concerning our market position, future operations, margins, profitability, liquidity and capital resources, tax assessment orders and future capital expenditures. We caution you that reliance on any
forward-looking statement inherently involves risks and uncertainties, and that although we believe that the assumptions on which our forward-looking statements are based are reasonable, any of those assumptions could prove to be inaccurate, and, as
a result, the forward-looking statements based on those assumptions could be materially incorrect. These risks and uncertainties include but are not limited to:
|
|
|
worldwide economic and business conditions; |
2
|
|
|
political or economic instability in the jurisdictions where we have operations; |
|
|
|
regulatory, legislative and judicial developments; |
|
|
|
our ability to attract and retain clients; |
|
|
|
technological innovation; |
|
|
|
telecommunications or technology disruptions; |
|
|
|
future regulatory actions and conditions in our operating areas; |
|
|
|
our dependence on a limited number of clients in a limited number of industries; |
|
|
|
our ability to expand our business or effectively manage growth; |
|
|
|
our ability to hire and retain enough sufficiently trained employees to support our operations; |
|
|
|
negative public reaction in the US or the UK to offshore outsourcing; |
|
|
|
the effects of our different pricing strategies or those of our competitors; |
|
|
|
increasing competition in the business process management industry; |
|
|
|
our ability to successfully grow our revenue, expand our service offerings and market share and achieve accretive benefits from our acquisition of (1) Fusion Outsourcing Services (Proprietary) Limited, or Fusion
(which we have renamed as WNS Global Services SA (Pty) Ltd following our acquisition) or (2) Aviva Global Services Singapore Pte. Ltd., or Aviva Global (which we have renamed as WNS Customer Solutions (Singapore) Private Limited, or WNS Global
Singapore, following our acquisition) and our master services agreement with Aviva Global Services (Management Services) Private Limited, or Aviva MS, as described below; |
|
|
|
our liability arising from fraud or unauthorized disclosure of sensitive or confidential client and customer data; |
|
|
|
our ability to successfully consummate and integrate strategic acquisitions; and |
|
|
|
volatility of our ADS price. |
These and other factors are more fully discussed in Part I
Item 3. Key Information D. Risk Factors, Part I Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects and elsewhere in this annual report. In light of these and other uncertainties, you should not
conclude that we will necessarily achieve any plans, objectives or projected financial results referred to in any of the forward-looking statements. Except as required by law, we do not undertake to release revisions of any of these forward-looking
statements to reflect future events or circumstances.
3
PART I
ITEM 1. IDENTITY OF DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND ADVISERS
Not applicable.
ITEM 2. |
OFFER STATISTICS AND EXPECTED TIMETABLE |
Not applicable.
ITEM 3. KEY INFORMATION
A. Selected Financial Data
Our consolidated financial
statements as at and for the years ended March 31, 2015, March 31, 2014, March 31, 2013 and March 31, 2012 have been prepared in conformity with IFRS, as issued by the IASB. Our consolidated financial statements as at and for the
year ended March 31, 2011 were originally prepared in accordance with US GAAP and were restated in accordance with IFRS for comparative purposes only.
The following selected financial data should be read in conjunction with Part I Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and
Prospects and our consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this annual report.
The following selected consolidated statement of
income data for fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013 and selected consolidated statement of financial position data as at March 31, 2015 and March 31, 2014 have been derived from our audited consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in
this annual report. The selected consolidated statement of income data for fiscal 2012 and 2011 and selected consolidated statement of financial position data as at March 31, 2013, March 31, 2012 and March 31, 2011 have been derived
from our audited consolidated financial statements which are not included in this annual report.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For the year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
2012 |
|
|
2011 |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions, except share and per share data) |
|
Consolidated Statement of Income Data: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenue(1) |
|
$ |
533.9 |
|
|
$ |
502.6 |
|
|
$ |
460.3 |
|
|
$ |
474.1 |
|
|
$ |
616.3 |
|
Cost of revenue(1)(2) |
|
|
342.7 |
|
|
|
327.7 |
|
|
|
311.0 |
|
|
|
340.9 |
|
|
|
490.0 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Gross profit |
|
|
191.2 |
|
|
|
174.9 |
|
|
|
149.3 |
|
|
|
133.2 |
|
|
|
126.2 |
|
Operating expenses: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Selling and marketing expenses(2) |
|
|
31.1 |
|
|
|
35.2 |
|
|
|
30.2 |
|
|
|
26.3 |
|
|
|
23.5 |
|
General and administrative expenses(2) |
|
|
70.0 |
|
|
|
55.4 |
|
|
|
57.1 |
|
|
|
51.3 |
|
|
|
56.4 |
|
Foreign exchange loss (gains), net |
|
|
(4.6 |
) |
|
|
11.2 |
|
|
|
5.5 |
|
|
|
(1.9 |
) |
|
|
(15.1 |
) |
Amortization of intangible assets |
|
|
24.2 |
|
|
|
23.8 |
|
|
|
26.4 |
|
|
|
29.5 |
|
|
|
31.8 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Operating profit |
|
|
70.5 |
|
|
|
49.4 |
|
|
|
30.1 |
|
|
|
28.0 |
|
|
|
29.7 |
|
Other income, net |
|
|
(11.9 |
) |
|
|
(9.5 |
) |
|
|
(4.8 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1.1 |
) |
Finance expense |
|
|
1.3 |
|
|
|
2.9 |
|
|
|
3.6 |
|
|
|
4.0 |
|
|
|
11.4 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Profit before income taxes |
|
|
81.0 |
|
|
|
55.9 |
|
|
|
31.3 |
|
|
|
24.0 |
|
|
|
19.4 |
|
Provision for income taxes |
|
|
22.4 |
|
|
|
14.3 |
|
|
|
9.9 |
|
|
|
11.5 |
|
|
|
1.5 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Profit |
|
$ |
58.6 |
|
|
$ |
41.6 |
|
|
$ |
21.4 |
|
|
$ |
12.5 |
|
|
$ |
17.9 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Earnings per share of ordinary share: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Basic |
|
$ |
1.14 |
|
|
$ |
0.82 |
|
|
$ |
0.43 |
|
|
$ |
0.28 |
|
|
$ |
0.40 |
|
Diluted |
|
$ |
1.10 |
|
|
$ |
0.79 |
|
|
$ |
0.41 |
|
|
$ |
0.27 |
|
|
$ |
0.40 |
|
Basic weighted average ordinary shares outstanding |
|
|
51,633,516 |
|
|
|
50,958,864 |
|
|
|
50,309,140 |
|
|
|
45,261,411 |
|
|
|
44,260,713 |
|
Diluted weighted average ordinary shares outstanding |
|
|
53,428,981 |
|
|
|
52,689,157 |
|
|
|
51,711,532 |
|
|
|
46,504,282 |
|
|
|
45,232,413 |
|
4
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
2012 |
|
|
2011 |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Consolidated Statement of Financial Position Data: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Assets |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and cash equivalents |
|
$ |
32.4 |
|
|
$ |
33.7 |
|
|
$ |
27.9 |
|
|
$ |
46.7 |
|
|
$ |
27.1 |
|
Investments |
|
|
133.5 |
|
|
|
83.8 |
|
|
|
46.5 |
|
|
|
26.4 |
|
|
|
|
|
Trade receivables including unbilled revenue, net |
|
|
95.5 |
|
|
|
96.7 |
|
|
|
90.0 |
|
|
|
102.3 |
|
|
|
109.4 |
|
Other current assets(3) |
|
|
53.7 |
|
|
|
39.6 |
|
|
|
39.5 |
|
|
|
50.2 |
|
|
|
44.9 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total current assets |
|
|
315.1 |
|
|
|
253.9 |
|
|
|
203.8 |
|
|
|
225.6 |
|
|
|
181.5 |
|
Goodwill and intangible assets, net |
|
|
122.4 |
|
|
|
152.9 |
|
|
|
179.2 |
|
|
|
201.8 |
|
|
|
250.1 |
|
Property and equipment, net |
|
|
48.2 |
|
|
|
45.2 |
|
|
|
48.4 |
|
|
|
45.4 |
|
|
|
47.2 |
|
Deferred tax assets |
|
|
21.3 |
|
|
|
37.1 |
|
|
|
41.6 |
|
|
|
43.8 |
|
|
|
33.7 |
|
Investments |
|
|
|
|
|
|
28.7 |
|
|
|
43.2 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other non-current assets(4) |
|
|
23.3 |
|
|
|
20.8 |
|
|
|
18.6 |
|
|
|
8.4 |
|
|
|
10.3 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total non-current assets |
|
|
215.2 |
|
|
|
284.6 |
|
|
|
331.1 |
|
|
|
299.5 |
|
|
|
341.3 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total assets |
|
|
530.3 |
|
|
|
538.4 |
|
|
|
534.9 |
|
|
|
525.2 |
|
|
|
522.7 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Liabilities and equity |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Current portion of long term debt |
|
|
12.8 |
|
|
|
12.6 |
|
|
|
7.7 |
|
|
|
26.0 |
|
|
|
49.4 |
|
Trade payables |
|
|
22.7 |
|
|
|
29.1 |
|
|
|
29.3 |
|
|
|
47.9 |
|
|
|
44.3 |
|
Other current liabilities(5) |
|
|
92.5 |
|
|
|
143.2 |
|
|
|
145.4 |
|
|
|
114.3 |
|
|
|
102.7 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total current liabilities |
|
|
128.0 |
|
|
|
184.8 |
|
|
|
182.4 |
|
|
|
188.2 |
|
|
|
196.4 |
|
Long term debt |
|
|
|
|
|
|
13.5 |
|
|
|
33.7 |
|
|
|
36.7 |
|
|
|
42.9 |
|
Other non-current liabilities(6) |
|
|
13.2 |
|
|
|
15.1 |
|
|
|
18.2 |
|
|
|
16.6 |
|
|
|
19.0 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total non-current liabilities |
|
|
13.2 |
|
|
|
28.6 |
|
|
|
51.9 |
|
|
|
53.3 |
|
|
|
61.9 |
|
Share capital (ordinary shares $0.16 (10 pence) par value, authorized 60,000,000 shares, issued: 51,950,662; 51,347,538; 50,588,044;
50,078,881; and 44,443,726 shares each as at March 31, 2015; March 31, 2014; March 31, 2013; March 31, 2012; and March 31, 2011, respectively) |
|
|
8.1 |
|
|
|
8.0 |
|
|
|
7.9 |
|
|
|
7.8 |
|
|
|
7.0 |
|
Share premium |
|
|
286.8 |
|
|
|
276.6 |
|
|
|
269.3 |
|
|
|
263.5 |
|
|
|
211.4 |
|
Other shareholders equity (7) |
|
|
94.2 |
|
|
|
40.3 |
|
|
|
23.4 |
|
|
|
12.3 |
|
|
|
46.1 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total shareholders equity |
|
|
389.1 |
|
|
|
325.0 |
|
|
|
300.6 |
|
|
|
283.7 |
|
|
|
264.4 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total liabilities and equity |
|
$ |
530.3 |
|
|
$ |
538.4 |
|
|
$ |
534.9 |
|
|
$ |
525.2 |
|
|
$ |
522.7 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5
The following table sets forth for the periods indicated selected consolidated financial data, non-GAAP financial
data and operating data:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For the year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
2012 |
|
|
2011 |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions, except percentages
and employee data) |
|
Other Consolidated Financial Data: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenue |
|
$ |
533.9 |
|
|
$ |
502.6 |
|
|
$ |
460.3 |
|
|
$ |
474.1 |
|
|
$ |
616.3 |
|
Gross profit as a percentage of revenue |
|
|
35.8 |
% |
|
|
34.8 |
% |
|
|
32.4 |
% |
|
|
28.1 |
% |
|
|
20.5 |
% |
Operating income as a percentage of revenue |
|
|
13.2 |
% |
|
|
9.8 |
% |
|
|
6.5 |
% |
|
|
5.9 |
% |
|
|
4.8 |
% |
Non-GAAP Financial Data: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenue less repair payments(8) |
|
$ |
503.0 |
|
|
$ |
471.5 |
|
|
$ |
436.1 |
|
|
$ |
395.1 |
|
|
$ |
369.4 |
|
Gross profit as a percentage of revenue less repair payments |
|
|
38.0 |
% |
|
|
37.1 |
% |
|
|
34.2 |
% |
|
|
33.7 |
% |
|
|
34.2 |
% |
Operating income as a percentage of revenue less repair payments |
|
|
14.0 |
% |
|
|
10.5 |
% |
|
|
6.9 |
% |
|
|
7.1 |
% |
|
|
8.0 |
% |
Operating Data: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Number of employees (at year end) |
|
|
28,890 |
|
|
|
27,020 |
|
|
|
25,520 |
|
|
|
23,874 |
|
|
|
21,523 |
|
Notes:
(1) |
During fiscal 2012, we re-negotiated contracts with certain of our clients and repair centers in the auto claims business, whereby the primary responsibility for providing the services is borne by the repair centers
instead of us and the credit risk that the client may not pay for the services is no longer borne by us. As a result of these changes, we are no longer considered to be the principal in providing the services. Accordingly, we no longer account for
the amount received from these clients for payments to repair centers and the payments made to repair centers for cases referred by these clients as revenue and cost of revenue, respectively, resulting in lower revenue and cost of revenue. The
contract re-negotiation process is ongoing and aimed at simplifying our accounting requirements. |
(2) |
Includes the following share-based compensation amounts: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For the year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
2012 |
|
|
2011 |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Cost of revenue |
|
$ |
0.8 |
|
|
$ |
1.3 |
|
|
$ |
1.0 |
|
|
$ |
1.0 |
|
|
$ |
0.7 |
|
Selling and marketing expenses |
|
$ |
0.8 |
|
|
$ |
0.6 |
|
|
$ |
0.4 |
|
|
$ |
0.4 |
|
|
$ |
0.2 |
|
General and administrative expenses |
|
$ |
7.9 |
|
|
$ |
5.0 |
|
|
$ |
3.9 |
|
|
$ |
3.9 |
|
|
$ |
2.3 |
|
(3) |
Consists of funds held for clients, derivative assets and prepayments and other current assets. |
(4) |
Consists of non-current portion of derivative assets and other non-current assets. |
(5) |
Consists of provisions and accrued expenses, derivative liabilities, pension and other employee obligations, short term line of credit, deferred revenue, current taxes payable and other liabilities. |
(6) |
Consists of non-current portion of derivatives liabilities, pension and other employee obligations, deferred revenue, deferred tax liabilities and other non-current liabilities. |
(7) |
Consists of retained earnings and other components of equity. |
6
(8) |
Revenue less repair payments is a non-GAAP financial measure which is calculated as (a) revenue less (b) in our auto claims business, payments to repair centers (1) for fault repair cases
where we act as the principal in our dealings with the third party repair centers and our clients and (2) for non-fault repair cases with respect to one former client (whose contract with us was terminated with effect from
April 18, 2012). The following table reconciles our revenue (a GAAP financial measure) to revenue less repair payments (a non-GAAP financial measure) for the indicated periods: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For the year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
2012 |
|
|
2011 |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Revenue (GAAP) |
|
$ |
533.9 |
|
|
$ |
502.6 |
|
|
$ |
460.3 |
|
|
$ |
474.1 |
|
|
$ |
616.3 |
|
Less: Payments to repair centers(a) |
|
|
30.9 |
|
|
|
31.1 |
|
|
|
24.1 |
|
|
|
79.1 |
|
|
|
246.9 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenue less repair payments (non-GAAP) |
|
$ |
503.0 |
|
|
$ |
471.5 |
|
|
$ |
436.1 |
|
|
$ |
395.1 |
|
|
$ |
369.4 |
|
Note:
(a) |
Consists of payments to repair centers in our auto claims business (1) for fault repair cases where we act as the principal in our dealings with the third party repair centers and our clients and
(2) for non-fault repair cases with respect to one former client as discussed below. |
We have two reportable segments for
financial statement reporting purposes WNS Global BPM and WNS Auto Claims BPM. In our WNS Auto Claims BPM segment, we provide both fault and non-fault repairs. For fault repairs, we provide claims handling
and repair management services, where we arrange for automobile repairs through a network of third party repair centers. In our repair management services, where we act as the principal in our dealings with the third party repair centers and our
clients, the amounts which we invoice to our clients for payments made by us to third party repair centers are reported as revenue. Where we are not the principal in providing the services, we record revenue from repair services net of repair cost.
Since we wholly subcontract the repairs to the repair centers, we evaluate the financial performance of our fault repair business based on revenue less repair payments to third party repair centers, which is a non-GAAP financial measure.
We believe that revenue less repair payments for fault repairs reflects more accurately the value addition of the business process management services that we directly provide to our clients.
For our non-fault repairs business, we generally provide a consolidated suite of accident management services including credit hire and credit
repair, and we believe that measurement of such business on a basis that includes repair payments in revenue is appropriate. Revenue including repair payments is therefore used as a primary measure to allocate resources and measure operating
performance for accident management services provided in our non-fault repairs business. For one former client in our non-fault repairs business (whose contract with us was terminated with effect from April 18, 2012), we
provided only repair management services where we wholly subcontracted the repairs to the repair centers (similar to our fault repairs). Accordingly, we evaluated the financial performance of our business with this former client in a
manner similar to how we evaluate our financial performance for our fault repairs business, that is, based on revenue less repair payments. Our non-fault repairs business where we provide accident management services,
accounts for a relatively small portion of our revenue for our WNS Auto Claims BPM segment.
This non-GAAP financial information is not meant to be
considered in isolation or as a substitute for our financial results prepared in accordance with GAAP. We believe that the presentation of this non-GAAP financial measure in this annual report provides useful information for investors regarding the
financial performance of our business and our two reportable segments. Our revenue less repair payments may not be comparable to similarly titled measures reported by other companies due to potential differences in the method of calculation.
B. Capitalization and Indebtedness
Not applicable.
7
C. Reason for the Offer and the Use of Proceeds
Not applicable.
D. Risk Factors
This annual report contains forward-looking statements that involve risks and uncertainties. Our actual results could differ materially from those
anticipated in these forward-looking statements as a result of a number of factors, including those described in the following risk factors and elsewhere in this annual report. If any of the following risks actually occur, our business, financial
condition and results of operations could suffer and the trading price of our ADSs could decline.
Risks Related to Our Business
The global economic conditions have been challenging and have had, and may continue to have, an adverse effect on the financial markets and the economy
in general, which has had, and may continue to have, a material adverse effect on our business, our financial performance and the prices of our equity shares and ADSs.
Global economic conditions have shown some signs of recovery, particularly in the US, but remain challenging as concerns remain on the sustainability of the
recovery. Some key indicators of sustainable economic growth remain under pressure. Ongoing concerns over the sustainability of economic recovery in the US, its substantial debt burden and expected shift in monetary policy to increase short term
interest rates, the low price of crude oil across the globe and the related implications for potential global deflation, as well as concerns of slower economic growth in the European Union, or EU, Russia, China and Japan, have contributed to market
volatility and diminished expectations for the US, European and global economies. If countries in the Eurozone or other countries require additional financial support, if sovereign credit ratings continue to decline, or in the event of a default on
sovereign debt obligations in certain countries including Greece, Argentina and Russia, yields on the sovereign debt of certain countries may continue to increase, the cost of borrowing may increase and credit may become more limited. In the US,
there continue to be concerns over the failure to achieve a long term solution to the issues of government spending, the increasing US national debt and rising debt ceiling, and their negative impact on the US economy as well as concerns over
potential increases in cost of borrowing and reduction in availability of credit as the US Federal Reserve ends its quantitative easing program. Further, there continue to be signs of economic weakness such as weaker economic growth and low
inflation in the EU, Japan and China. Continuing conflicts and instability in various regions around the world may lead to additional acts of terrorism and armed conflict around the world, as well as the growing concerns over the sustained and
drastic fall in the price of crude oil and the associated risk of global deflation, which may contribute to further economic instability in the global financial markets.
These economic conditions may affect our business in a number of ways. The general level of economic activity, such as decreases in business and consumer
spending, could result in a decrease in demand for our services, thus reducing our revenue. The cost and availability of credit has been and may continue to be adversely affected by illiquid credit markets and wider credit spreads. Continued
turbulence or uncertainty in the European, US, Asian and international financial markets and economies may adversely affect our liquidity and financial condition, and the liquidity and financial condition of our customers. If these market conditions
continue or worsen, they may limit our ability to access financing or increase our cost of financing to meet liquidity needs, and affect the ability of our customers to use credit to purchase our services or to make timely payments to us, resulting
in adverse effects on our financial condition and results of operations.
Furthermore, a weakening of the rate of exchange for the US dollar or the pound
sterling (in which our revenue is principally denominated) against the Indian rupee (in which a significant portion of our costs are denominated) also adversely affects our results. Although the expected shift in US monetary policy to increase short
term interest rates is likely to strengthen the US dollar against a number of currencies, particularly against emerging market currencies, fluctuations between the pound sterling or the Indian rupee and the US dollar also expose us to translation
risk when transactions denominated in pound sterling or Indian rupees are translated to US dollars, our reporting currency. For example, the pound sterling appreciated against the US dollar by an average of 1.5% and 0.6% in fiscal 2015 and 2014,
respectively. On the other hand, in fiscal 2015 and 2014, the Indian rupee depreciated against the US dollar by an average of 1.2% and 11.0%, respectively, the Australian dollar depreciated against the US dollar by an average of 6.1% and 9.6%,
respectively, and the South African rand depreciated against the US dollar by an average 9.4% and 17.9%, respectively. The appreciation of the pound sterling and the depreciation of the Indian rupee and the South African rand against the US dollar
positively impacted our results of operations in fiscal 2015 and 2014 whereas the depreciation of the Australian dollar negatively impacted our results of operations in fiscal 2015 and 2014.
8
Uncertainty about current global economic conditions could also continue to increase the volatility of our share
price. We cannot predict the timing or duration of an economic slowdown or the timing or strength of a subsequent economic recovery generally or in our targeted industries, including the travel and leisure and insurance industries. If macroeconomic
conditions worsen or current global economic conditions continue for a prolonged period of time, we are not able to predict the impact that such worsening conditions will have on our targeted industries in general, and our results of operations
specifically.
A few major clients account for a significant portion of our revenue and any loss of business from these clients could reduce our
revenue and significantly harm our business.
We have derived and believe that we will continue to derive in the near term a significant portion of
our revenue from a limited number of large clients. In fiscal 2015 and 2014, our five largest clients accounted for 33.0% and 36.9% of our revenue and 35.0% and 39.4% of our revenue less repair payments, respectively. In fiscal 2015 and 2014, our
three largest clients accounted for 27.4% and 28.9% of our revenue and 29.0% and 30.8% of our revenue less repair payments, respectively. In fiscal 2015, our largest client, Aviva MS, individually accounted for 13.4% and 15.2% of our revenue and
revenue less repair payments, respectively, as compared to 14.2% and 16.9% in fiscal 2014, respectively. Any loss of business from any major client could reduce our revenue and significantly harm our business.
For example, in line with our expectations, one of our top five clients by revenue contribution in fiscal 2014 and 2013, an online travel agency, or OTA,
provided us with a lower volume of business in fiscal 2015. The client entered into a strategic marketing agreement with another OTA in August 2013 pursuant to which it over a period of time, from the fourth quarter of fiscal 2014 to the fourth
quarter of fiscal 2015, moved its customer care and sales processes that were previously managed by us to a technology platform managed by the other OTA. As a result, we lost most of our business from our OTA client. Our OTA client accounted for
2.5%, 6.1% and 7.3% of our revenue and 2.6%, 6.5% and 7.7% of our revenue less repair payments in fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The other OTA uses several BPM vendors to manage such processes on their technology platform. We are approved
as one of the other OTAs providers of BPM services. We have managed to compete with incumbent BPM vendors for the other OTAs business and the other OTA has become one of our large clients. There can be no assurance that we will be able
to offset the loss of business from our OTA client to a significant extent or at all.
Further, in early 2012, as a result of concerns that the UK
Competition Commission, or UKCC, would ban the payment of referral fees by accident management companies to claims management companies and insurance companies in the provision of credit hire replacement vehicles and third party vehicle repairs, one
of our largest auto claims clients by revenue contribution in fiscal 2012 terminated its contract with us with effect from April 18, 2012. This client accounted for 10.4% and 7.5% of our revenue and 1.3% and 1.9% of our revenue less repair
payments in fiscal 2012 and 2011, respectively.
Our prior contracts with one of our major clients, Aviva International Holdings Limited, or Aviva,
provided Aviva Global, which was Avivas business process offshoring subsidiary, options to require us to transfer the relevant projects and operations of our facilities at Sri Lanka and Pune, India to Aviva Global. On January 1,
2007, Aviva Global exercised its call option requiring us to transfer the Sri Lanka facility to Aviva Global effective July 2, 2007. Effective July 2, 2007, we transferred the Sri Lanka facility to Aviva Global and we lost the revenue
generated by the Sri Lanka facility. For the period from April 1, 2007 through July 2, 2007, the Sri Lanka facility contributed $2.0 million of revenue and in fiscal 2007 it accounted for 1.9% of our revenue and 3.0% of our revenue less
repair payments. We may, in the future, enter into contracts with other clients with similar call options that may result in the loss of revenue that may have a material impact on our business, results of operations, financial condition and cash
flows, particularly during the quarter in which the option takes effect.
We have, through our acquisition of Aviva Global in July 2008, resumed
ownership of the Sri Lanka facility and we have continued to retain ownership of the Pune facility. Revenue from Aviva MS under our current master services agreement with Aviva MS, or the Aviva master services agreement, accounts for a significant
portion of our revenue and we expect our dependence on Aviva MS to continue for the foreseeable future. The terms of the Aviva master services agreement include termination at will provisions which permit Aviva MS to terminate the agreement without
cause with 180 days notice upon payment of a termination fee.
9
In addition, the volume of work performed for specific clients is likely to vary from year to year, particularly
since we may not be the exclusive outside service provider for our clients. Thus, a major client in one year may not provide the same level of revenue in any subsequent year. The loss of some or all of the business of any large client could have a
material adverse effect on our business, results of operations, financial condition and cash flows. A number of factors other than our performance could cause the loss of or reduction in business or revenue from a client, and these factors are not
predictable. For example, a client may demand price reductions, change its outsourcing strategy or move work in-house. A client may also be acquired by a company with a different outsourcing strategy that intends to switch to another business
process management service provider or return work in-house.
Our revenue is highly dependent on clients concentrated in a few industries, as well
as clients located primarily in Europe and the US. Economic slowdowns or factors that affect these industries or the economic environment in Europe or the US could reduce our revenue and seriously harm our business.
A substantial portion of our clients are concentrated in the insurance industry and the travel and leisure industry. In fiscal 2015 and 2014, 35.8% and 36.7%
of our revenue, respectively, and 31.7% and 32.6% of our revenue less repair payments, respectively, were derived from clients in the insurance industry. During the same periods, clients in the travel and leisure industry contributed 18.7% and 19.5%
of our revenue, respectively, and 19.8% and 20.8% of our revenue less repair payments, respectively. Our business and growth largely depend on continued demand for our services from clients in these industries and other industries that we may target
in the future, as well as on trends in these industries to outsource business processes. Global economic conditions have shown some signs of recovery, particularly in the US, but remain challenging as concerns remain on sustainability of the
recovery. Some key indicators of sustainable economic growth remain under pressure. Ongoing concerns over the sustainability of economic recovery in the US, its substantial debt burden and expected shift in monetary policy to increase short term
interest rates, the low price of crude oil across the globe and the related implications for potential global deflation, as well as concerns of slower economic growth in the EU, and Russia, have contributed to market volatility and diminished
expectations for the US, European and global economies. If countries in the Eurozone or other countries require additional financial support, if sovereign credit ratings continue to decline, or in the event of a default on sovereign debt obligations
in certain countries including Greece, Argentina and Russia, yields on the sovereign debt of certain countries may continue to increase, the cost of borrowing may increase and credit may become more limited. In the US, there continue to be concerns
over the failure to achieve a long-term solution to the issues of government spending, the increasing US national debt and rising debt ceiling, and their negative impact on the US economy as well as concerns over potential increases in cost of
borrowing and reduction in availability of credit when the US Federal Reserve ends its quantitative easing program. Further, there continue to be signs of economic weakness such as weaker economic growth and low inflation in the EU. Continuing
conflicts and instability in various regions around the world may lead to additional acts of terrorism and armed conflict around the world, as well as the growing concerns over the sustained and drastic fall in the price of crude oil and the
associated risk of global deflation, which may contribute to further economic instability in the global financial markets.
These economic conditions may
affect our business in a number of ways. The general level of economic activity, such as decreases in business and consumer spending, could result in a decrease in demand for our services, thus reducing our revenue. The cost and availability of
credit has been and may continue to be adversely affected by illiquid credit markets and wider credit spreads. Continued turbulence or uncertainty in the European, the US and international financial markets and economies may adversely affect our
liquidity and financial condition, and the liquidity and financial condition of our customers. If these market conditions continue or worsen, they may limit our ability to access financing or increase our cost of financing to meet liquidity needs,
and affect the ability of our customers to use credit to purchase our services or to make timely payments to us, resulting in adverse effects on our financial condition and results of operations.
Certain of our targeted industries are especially vulnerable to crises in the financial and credit markets and potential economic downturns. A downturn in any
of our targeted industries, particularly the insurance or travel and leisure industries, a slowdown or reversal of the trend to outsource business processes in any of these industries or the introduction of regulation which restricts or discourages
companies from outsourcing could result in a decrease in the demand for our services and adversely affect our results of operations. For example, as a result of the mortgage market crisis, in August 2007, First Magnus Financial Corporation, or
FMFC, a US mortgage services client, filed a voluntary petition for relief under Chapter 11 of the US Bankruptcy Code. FMFC was a major client of Trinity Partners Inc. which we acquired in November 2005 from the First Magnus Group and became
one of our major clients. In fiscal 2008 and 2007, FMFC accounted for 1.0% and 4.3% of our revenue, respectively, and 1.4% and 6.8% of our revenue less repair payments, respectively.
10
Further, the uncertainty in worldwide economic and business conditions has resulted in a few of our clients
reducing or postponing their outsourced business requirements, which in turn has decreased the demand for our services and adversely affected our results of operations. In particular, our revenue is highly dependent on the economic environments in
Europe and the US, which continue to show signs of economic weakness, particularly weaker economic growth and low inflation in the EU and continued uncertainty in the US. In fiscal 2015 and 2014, 52.8% and 52.8% of our revenue, respectively, and
49.9% and 49.6% of our revenue less repair payments, respectively, were derived from clients located in the UK. During the same periods, 25.9% and 27.3% of our revenue, respectively, and 27.5% and 29.1% of our revenue less repair payments,
respectively, were derived from clients located in North America (primarily the US). Further, during the same periods, 5.4% and 5.3% of our revenue, respectively, and 5.7% and 5.7% of our revenue less repair payments, respectively, were derived from
clients in the rest of Europe. Any further weakening of or uncertainty in the European or US economy will likely have a further adverse impact on our revenue.
Other developments may also lead to a decline in the demand for our services in these industries. Significant changes in the financial services industry or
any of the other industries on which we focus, or a consolidation in any of these industries or acquisitions, particularly involving our clients, may decrease the potential number of buyers of our services and have an adverse impact on our
profitability. Any significant reduction in or the elimination of the use of the services we provide within any of these industries would result in reduced revenue and harm our business. Our clients may experience rapid changes in their prospects,
substantial price competition and pressure on their profitability. Although such pressures can encourage outsourcing as a cost reduction measure, they may also result in increasing pressure on us from clients in these key industries to lower our
prices which could negatively affect our business, results of operations, financial condition and cash flows.
We may fail to attract and retain
enough sufficiently trained employees to support our operations, as competition for highly skilled personnel is significant and we experience significant employee attrition. These factors could have a material adverse effect on our business, results
of operations, financial condition and cash flows.
The business process management industry relies on large numbers of skilled employees, and our
success depends to a significant extent on our ability to attract, hire, train and retain qualified employees. The business process management industry, including our company, experiences high employee attrition. During fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013,
the attrition rate for our employees who have completed six months of employment with us was 34%, 33% and 35%, respectively. We cannot assure you that our attrition rate will not continue to increase in the future. There is significant competition
in the jurisdictions where our operation centers are located, including India, the Philippines, Romania and Sri Lanka, for professionals with the skills necessary to perform the services we offer to our clients. Increased competition for these
professionals, in the business process management industry or otherwise, could have an adverse effect on us. A significant increase in the attrition rate among employees with specialized skills could decrease our operating efficiency and
productivity and could lead to a decline in demand for our services.
In addition, our ability to maintain and renew existing engagements and obtain new
business will depend largely on our ability to attract, train and retain personnel with skills that enable us to keep pace with growing demands for outsourcing, evolving industry standards and changing client preferences. Our failure either to
attract, train and retain personnel with the qualifications necessary to fulfill the needs of our existing and future clients or to assimilate new employees successfully could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations,
financial condition and cash flows.
Currency fluctuations among the Indian rupee, the pound sterling, the US dollar, the Australian dollar and the
South African rand could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations.
Although substantially all of our revenue is denominated in
pound sterling, the US dollars or Australian dollars, a significant portion of our expenses (other than payments to repair centers, which are primarily denominated in pound sterling) are incurred and paid in Indian rupees and to a lesser extent, in
South African rand. We report our financial results in US dollars and our results of operations would be adversely affected if the Indian rupee or the South African rand appreciates against the US dollar or the pound sterling or Australian dollar
depreciates against the US dollar. The exchange rates between each of the Indian rupee, pound sterling, Australian dollar and South African rand and the US dollar have changed substantially in recent years and may fluctuate substantially in the
future.
11
The average Indian rupee to US dollar exchange rate was approximately
61.12 per $1.00 in fiscal 2015, which represented a depreciation of the Indian rupee by an average of 1.2% as compared with the average exchange rate of approximately
60.38 per $1.00 in fiscal 2014, which in turn represented a depreciation of the Indian rupee by an average of 11.0% as compared with the average exchange rate of approximately
54.38 per $1.00 in fiscal 2013.
The average pound sterling to US dollar exchange rate was approximately
£0.62 per $1.00 in fiscal 2015, which represented an appreciation of the pound sterling by an average of 1.5% as compared with the average exchange rate of approximately £0.63 per $1.00 in fiscal 2014, which in turn represented
an appreciation of the pound sterling by an average of 0.6% as compared with the average exchange rate of approximately £0.63 per $1.00 in fiscal 2013.
Our results of operations may be adversely affected if the Indian rupee appreciates significantly against the pound sterling or the US dollar or if the pound
sterling depreciates against the US dollar. We hedge a portion of our foreign currency exposures using options and forward contracts. We cannot assure you that our hedging strategy will be successful or will mitigate our exposure to currency risk.
We may be unable to effectively manage our growth and maintain effective internal controls, which could have a material adverse effect on our
operations, results of operations and financial condition.
Since we were founded in April 1996, and especially since Warburg Pincus acquired
a controlling stake in our company in May 2002, we have experienced growth and significantly expanded our operations. For example, over the last five fiscal years, our employees have increased to 28,890 as at March 31, 2015 from 21,958 as
at March 31, 2010. In fiscal 2011, we expanded our delivery center in Romania. In fiscal 2013, we opened new facilities in Poland and Vishakhapatnam, or Vizag. In fiscal 2014, our facilities in China and Sri Lanka became operational. In fiscal
2015, our delivery centers in South Carolina and Pennsylvania, in the US, as well as in South Africa, became fully operational, as did our newest facility in China. We now have delivery centers across 10 countries in China, Costa Rica, India,
the Philippines, Poland, Romania, South Africa, Sri Lanka, the UK and the US. Further, in February 2011, we received in-principle approval for the allotment of a piece of land on lease for a term of 99 years, measuring 5 acres in
Tiruchirappalli Navalpattu, special economic zone, or SEZ, in the state of Tamil Nadu, India from Electronics Corporation of Tamil Nadu Limited, or ELCOT for setting up delivery centers in the future. We intend to further expand our global
delivery capability, and we are exploring plans to do so in Asia Pacific and Latin America.
We have also completed numerous acquisitions. For example, in
June 2012, we acquired Fusion, a leading BPM provider based in South Africa. Fusion provides a range of outsourcing services, including contact center, customer care and business continuity services, to both South African and international
clients. With operations in Cape Town and Johannesburg, Fusion employed approximately 1,500 people as at June 30, 2012, which increased to 2,330 people as at March 31, 2015.
This growth places significant demands on our management and operational resources. In order to manage growth effectively, we must implement and improve
operational systems, procedures and internal controls on a timely basis. If we fail to implement these systems, procedures and controls on a timely basis, we may not be able to service our clients needs, hire and retain new employees, pursue
new business, complete future acquisitions or operate our business effectively. Failure to effectively transfer new client business to our delivery centers, properly budget transfer costs or accurately estimate operational costs associated with new
contracts could result in delays in executing client contracts, trigger service level penalties or cause our profit margins not to meet our expectations or our historical profit margins. As a result of any of these problems associated with
expansion, our business, results of operations, financial condition and cash flows could be materially and adversely affected.
12
We may face difficulties as we expand our operations to establish delivery centers in onshore locations and
offshore in countries in which we have limited or no prior operating experience.
In June 2012, we acquired Fusion, a leading BPM provider
with two delivery centers in South Africa. In April 2014 our delivery center in South Carolina in the US became fully operational. We also opened an additional delivery center in Pennsylvania in the US in September 2014. In October 2014, we moved
our operations from one site in Gurgaon to another and opened another delivery center in South Africa. We intend to continue to expand our global footprint in order to maintain an appropriate cost structure and meet our clients delivery needs.
We plan to establish additional offshore delivery centers in Africa, the Asia Pacific and Latin America, which may involve expanding into countries other than those in which we currently operate. Our expansion plans may also involve expanding into
less developed countries, which may have less political, social or economic stability and less developed infrastructure and legal systems. As we expand our business into new countries we may encounter regulatory, personnel, technological and other
difficulties that increase our expenses or delay our ability to start up our operations or become profitable in such countries. This may affect our relationships with our clients and could have an adverse effect on our business, results of
operations, financial condition and cash flows.
Our loan agreements impose operating and financial restrictions on us and our subsidiaries.
Our loan agreements contain a number of covenants and other provisions that, among other things, impose operating and financial restrictions on us
and our subsidiaries. These restrictions could put a strain on our financial position. For example:
|
|
|
they may increase our vulnerability to general adverse economic and industry conditions; |
|
|
|
they may require us to dedicate a substantial portion of our cash flow from operations to payments on our loans, thereby reducing the availability of our cash flow to fund capital expenditure, working capital and other
general corporate purposes; |
|
|
|
they may require us to seek lenders consent prior to paying dividends on our ordinary shares; |
|
|
|
they may limit our ability to incur additional borrowings or raise additional financing through equity or debt instruments; |
|
|
|
they impose certain financial covenants on us that we may not be able to meet, which may cause the lenders to accelerate the repayment of the balance loan outstanding; and |
|
|
|
a reduction in revenue by more than 10% in two succeeding quarters due to a change in the largest shareholder of the company may also constitute an event of default under certain of our loan agreements.
|
Further, the restrictions contained in our loan agreements could limit our ability to plan for or react to market conditions, meet capital
needs or make acquisitions or otherwise restrict our activities or business plans. Our ability to comply with the covenants of our loan agreements may be affected by events beyond our control, and any material deviations from our forecasts could
require us to seek waivers or amendments of covenants or alternative sources of financing or to reduce expenditures. We cannot assure you that such waivers, amendments or alternative financing could be obtained, or if obtained, would be on terms
acceptable to us.
To service our indebtedness and other potential liquidity requirements, we will require a significant amount of cash. Our ability
to generate cash depends on many factors beyond our control and we may need to access the credit market to meet our liquidity requirements.
Our
ability to make payments on our loans and to fund planned capital expenditures will depend on our ability to generate cash in the future. This, to a large extent, is subject to general economic, financial, competitive, legislative, regulatory and
other factors that are beyond our control. Furthermore, given that the uncertainty over global economic conditions remains, there can be no assurance that our business activity will be maintained at our expected level to generate the anticipated
cash flows from operations or that our credit facilities would be available or sufficient. If global economic uncertainties continue, we may experience a decrease in demand for our services, resulting in our cash flows from operations being lower
than anticipated. This may in turn result in our need to obtain additional financing.
13
If we cannot service our loan agreements, we may have to take actions such as seeking additional equity or
reducing or delaying capital expenditures, strategic acquisitions and investments. We cannot assure you that any such actions, if necessary, could be effected on commercially reasonable terms or at all.
The international nature of our business exposes us to several risks, such as significant currency fluctuations and unexpected changes in the regulatory
requirements of multiple jurisdictions.
We have operations in China, Costa Rica, India, the Philippines, Poland, Romania, South Africa, Sri
Lanka, the UK and the US, and we service clients across Asia, Europe, South Africa, Australia and North America. Our corporate structure also spans multiple jurisdictions, with our parent holding company incorporated in Jersey, Channel Islands, and
intermediate and operating subsidiaries (including branch offices) incorporated in Australia, China, Costa Rica, India, Mauritius, the Netherlands, the Philippines, Romania, South Africa, Singapore, Sri Lanka, the United Arab Emirates, the UK
and the US. As a result, we are exposed to risks typically associated with conducting business internationally, many of which are beyond our control. These risks include:
|
|
|
significant currency fluctuations between the US dollar and the pound sterling (in which our revenue is principally denominated) and the Indian rupee (in which a significant portion of our costs are denominated), for
more information, see Currency fluctuations among the Indian rupee, the pound sterling and the US dollar could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations; |
|
|
|
legal uncertainty owing to the overlap of different legal regimes, and problems in asserting contractual or other rights across international borders; |
|
|
|
potentially adverse tax consequences, such as scrutiny of transfer pricing arrangements by authorities in the countries in which we operate; |
|
|
|
potential tariffs and other trade barriers; |
|
|
|
unexpected changes in regulatory requirements; |
|
|
|
the burden and expense of complying with the laws and regulations of various jurisdictions; and |
|
|
|
terrorist attacks and other acts of violence or war. |
The occurrence of any of these events could have a
material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition.
If we fail to maintain an effective system of internal control over
financial reporting, we may not be able to accurately report our financial results or prevent or detect fraud. As a result, current and potential investors could lose confidence in our financial reporting, which could harm our business and have an
adverse effect on our ADS price.
Effective internal control over financial reporting is necessary for us to provide reliable financial reports.
The effective internal controls together with adequate disclosure controls and procedures are designed to prevent or detect fraud. Deficiencies in our internal controls may adversely affect our managements ability to record, process,
summarize, and report financial data on a timely basis. As a public company, we are required by Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 to include a report of managements assessment on our internal control over financial reporting
and an auditors attestation report on our internal control over financial reporting in our annual report on Form 20-F.
Although management
concluded that our companys disclosure controls and procedures and internal control over financial reporting were effective as at March 31, 2015 and 2014, it is possible that, in the future, material weaknesses could be identified in our
internal controls over financial reporting and we could be required to further implement remedial measures. If we fail to maintain effective disclosure controls and procedures or internal control over financial reporting, we could lose investor
confidence in the accuracy and completeness of our financial reports, which could have a material adverse effect on our ADS price.
14
We have applied for a license in the UK to provide legal services to clients as part of our auto claims
service offerings and any failure to obtain this license in a timely manner, or at all, may have a material and adverse effect on our auto claims business.
There is an established and continuing trend for our clients in the UK to bundle some of the services ordinarily provided by our auto claims business with
legal services. We have made an application to the UK Solicitors Regulatory Authority for a license to provide such legal services to our clients. We expect a decision on this application during fiscal 2016. If we are unable to obtain this license
in a timely manner, or at all, our ability to win future business from clients who seek to bundle these services together may be materially and adversely affected, which would in turn have a material and adverse effect on our auto claims business.
Our business may not develop in ways that we currently anticipate due to negative public reaction to offshore outsourcing, proposed legislation or
otherwise.
We have based our strategy of future growth on certain assumptions regarding our industry, services and future demand in the market for
such services. However, the trend to outsource business processes may not continue and could reverse. Offshore outsourcing is a politically sensitive topic in the UK, the US and elsewhere. For example, many organizations and public figures in the UK
and the US have publicly expressed concern about a perceived association between offshore outsourcing providers and the loss of jobs in their home countries.
Such concerns have led to proposed measures in the US that are aimed at limiting or restricting outsourcing. There is also legislation that has been enacted
or is pending at the state level in the US, with regard to limiting outsourcing. The measures that have been enacted to date are generally directed at restricting the ability of government agencies to outsource work to offshore business service
providers. These measures have not had a significant effect on our business because governmental agencies are not a focus of our operations. However, some legislative proposals would, for example, require contact centers to disclose their geographic
locations, require notice to individuals whose personal information is disclosed to non-US affiliates or subcontractors, require disclosures of companies foreign outsourcing practices, or restrict US private sector companies that have federal
government contracts, federal grants or guaranteed loan programs from outsourcing their services to offshore service providers. Such legislation could have an adverse impact on the economics of outsourcing for private companies in the US, which
could in turn have an adverse impact on our business with US clients.
Such concerns have also led the UK and other EU jurisdictions to enact regulations
which allow employees who are dismissed as a result of transfer of services, which may include outsourcing to non-UK or EU companies, to seek compensation either from the company from which they were dismissed or from the company to which the work
was transferred. This could discourage EU companies from outsourcing work offshore and/or could result in increased operating costs for us.
In addition,
there has been publicity about the negative experiences, such as theft and misappropriation of sensitive client data, of various companies that use offshore outsourcing, particularly in India.
Current or prospective clients may elect to perform such services themselves or may be discouraged from transferring these services from onshore to offshore
providers to avoid negative perceptions that may be associated with using an offshore provider. Any slowdown or reversal of existing industry trends towards offshore outsourcing would seriously harm our ability to compete effectively with
competitors that operate out of facilities located in the UK or the US.
15
Our executive and senior management team and other key team members in our business units are critical to
our continued success and the loss of such personnel could harm our business.
Our future success substantially depends on the performance of the
members of our executive and senior management team and other key team members in each of our business units. These personnel possess technical and business capabilities including domain expertise that are difficult to replace. There is intense
competition for experienced senior management and personnel with technical and industry expertise in the business process management industry, and we may not be able to retain our key personnel due to various reasons, including the compensation
philosophy followed by our company as described in Part I Item 6. Directors, Senior Management and Employees Compensation. Although we have entered into employment contracts with our executive officers, certain
terms of those agreements may not be enforceable and in any event these agreements do not ensure the continued service of these executive officers. In the event of a loss of any key personnel, there is no assurance that we will be able to find
suitable replacements for our key personnel within a reasonable time. The loss of key members of our senior management or other key team members, particularly to competitors, could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of
operations, financial condition and cash flows. A loss of several members of our senior management at the same time or within a short period may lead to a disruption in the business of our company, which could materially adversely affect our
performance.
Wage increases may prevent us from sustaining our competitive advantage and may reduce our profit margin.
Salaries and related benefits of our operations staff and other employees in countries where we have delivery centers, in particular India, are among our most
significant costs. Wage costs in India have historically been significantly lower than wage costs in the US and Europe for comparably skilled professionals, which has been one of our competitive advantages. However, rapid economic growth in India,
increased demand for business process management outsourcing to India, and increased competition for skilled employees in India may reduce this competitive advantage. In addition, if the US dollar or the pound sterling declines in value against the
Indian rupee, wages in the US or the UK will further decrease relative to wages in India, which may further reduce our competitive advantage. We may need to increase our levels of employee compensation more rapidly than in the past to remain
competitive in attracting the quantity and quality of employees that our business requires. Wage increases may reduce our profit margins and have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and cash flows.
Further, following our acquisitions of Aviva Global, Business Applications Associates Limited, or BizAps, and Chang Limited, our operations in the UK have
expanded and our wage costs for employees located in the UK and the US now represent a larger proportion of our total wage costs. Wage increases in the UK and the US may therefore also reduce our profit margins and have a material adverse effect on
our financial condition and cash flows.
Our operating results may differ from period to period, which may make it difficult for us to prepare
accurate internal financial forecasts and respond in a timely manner to offset such period to period fluctuations.
Our operating results may
differ significantly from period to period due to factors such as client losses, variations in the volume of business from clients resulting from changes in our clients operations, the business decisions of our clients regarding the use of our
services, delays or difficulties in expanding our operational facilities and infrastructure, changes to our pricing structure or that of our competitors, inaccurate estimates of resources and time required to complete ongoing projects, currency
fluctuations and seasonal changes in the operations of our clients. For example, our clients in the travel and leisure industry experience seasonal changes in their operations in connection with the US summer holiday season, as well as episodic
factors such as adverse weather conditions. Transaction volumes can be impacted by market conditions affecting the travel and insurance industries, including natural disasters, outbreak of infectious diseases or other serious public health concerns
in Asia or elsewhere (such as the outbreak of the Influenza A (H7N9) virus in various parts of the world) and terrorist attacks. In addition, our contracts do not generally commit our clients to providing us with a specific volume of business.
In addition, the long sales cycle for our services, which typically ranges from three to 12 months, and the internal budget and approval processes of our
prospective clients make it difficult to predict the timing of new client engagements. Commencement of work and ramping up of volume of work with certain new and existing clients have been slower than we had expected. Revenue is recognized upon
actual provision of services and when the criteria for recognition are achieved. Accordingly, the financial benefit of gaining a new client may be delayed due to delays in the implementation of our services. These factors may make it difficult for
us to prepare accurate internal financial forecasts or replace anticipated revenue that we do not receive as a result of those delays. Due to the above factors, it is possible that in some future quarters our operating results may be significantly
below the expectations of the public market, analysts and investors.
16
Employee strikes and other labor-related disruptions may adversely affect our operations.
Our business depends on a large number of employees executing client operations. Strikes or labor disputes with our employees at our delivery centers may
adversely affect our ability to conduct business. Our employees are not unionized, although they may in the future form unions. We cannot assure you that there will not be any strike, lock out or material labor dispute in the future. Work
interruptions or stoppages could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations, financial condition and cash flows.
Failure to adhere to the regulations that govern our business could result in us being unable to effectively perform our services. Failure to adhere to
regulations that govern our clients businesses could result in breaches of contract with our clients.
Our clients business operations
are subject to certain rules and regulations such as the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act, the Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act and Health Information Technology for Economic and Clinical Health Act in the US and the Financial Services
Act in the UK. Our clients may contractually require that we perform our services in a manner that would enable them to comply with such rules and regulations. Failure to perform our services in such a manner could result in breaches of
contract with our clients and, in some limited circumstances, civil fines and criminal penalties for us. In addition, we are required under various Indian laws to obtain and maintain permits and licenses for the conduct of our business. If we fail
to comply with any applicable rules or regulations, or if we do not maintain our licenses or other qualifications to provide our services, we may not be able to provide services to existing clients or be able to attract new clients and could
lose revenue, which could have a material adverse effect on our business.
Our clients may terminate contracts before completion or choose not to
renew contracts which could adversely affect our business and reduce our revenue.
The terms of our client contracts typically range from three to
five years. Many of our client contracts can be terminated by our clients with or without cause, with three to six months notice and, in most cases, without penalty. The termination of a substantial percentage of these contracts could
adversely affect our business and reduce our revenue. Contracts that will expire on or before March 31, 2016 (including work orders/statement of works that will expire on or before March 31, 2016) represented approximately 22% of our
revenue and 20% of our revenue less repair payments from our clients in fiscal 2015. Failure to meet contractual requirements could result in cancellation or non-renewal of a contract. Some of our contracts may be terminated by the client if certain
of our key personnel working on the client project leave our employment and we are unable to find suitable replacements. In addition, a contract termination or significant reduction in work assigned to us by a major client could cause us to
experience a higher than expected number of unassigned employees, which would increase our cost of revenue as a percentage of revenue until we are able to reduce or reallocate our headcount. We may not be able to replace any client that elects to
terminate or not renew its contract with us, which would adversely affect our business and revenue.
For example, one of our largest auto claims clients
by revenue contribution in fiscal 2012 terminated its contract with us with effect from April 18, 2012. This client accounted for 10.4% and 7.5% of our revenue and 1.3% and 1.9% of our revenue less repair payments in fiscal 2012 and 2011,
respectively.
In addition, one of our top five clients by revenue contribution in fiscal 2014 and 2013, an OTA client provided us with a lower volume of
business in fiscal 2015. The client entered into a strategic marketing agreement with another OTA in August 2013 pursuant to which it over a period of time, from the fourth quarter of fiscal 2014 to the fourth quarter of fiscal 2015, moved its
customer care and sales processes that were previously managed by us to a technology platform managed by the other OTA. As a result, we lost most of our business from our OTA client. Our OTA client accounted for 2.5%, 6.1% and 7.3% of our revenue
and 2.6%, 6.5% and 7.7% of our revenue less repair payments in fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The other OTA uses several BPM vendors to manage such processes on their technology platform. We are approved as one of the other OTAs
providers of BPM services. We have managed to compete with incumbent BPM vendors for the other OTAs business and the other OTA has become one of our large clients. There can be no assurance that we will be able to offset the loss of business
from our OTA client to a significant extent or at all. For more information, see A few major clients account for a significant portion of our revenue and any loss of business from these clients could reduce our revenue and significantly
harm our business.
17
Some of our client contracts contain provisions which, if triggered, could result in lower future revenue
and have an adverse effect on our business.
In many of our client contracts, we agree to include certain provisions which provide for downward
revision of our prices under certain circumstances. For example, certain contracts allow a client in certain limited circumstances to request a benchmark study comparing our pricing and performance with that of an agreed list of other service
providers for comparable services. Based on the results of the study and depending on the reasons for any unfavorable variance, we may be required to make improvements in the service we provide or to reduce the pricing for services to be performed
under the remaining term of the contract. Some of our contracts also provide that, during the term of the contract and for a certain period thereafter ranging from six to 12 months, we may not provide similar services to certain or any of their
competitors using the same personnel. These restrictions may hamper our ability to compete for and provide services to other clients in the same industry, which may result in lower future revenue and profitability.
Some of our contracts specify that if a change in control of our company occurs during the term of the contract, the client has the right to terminate the
contract. These provisions may result in our contracts being terminated if there is such a change in control, resulting in a potential loss of revenue. Some of our client contracts also contain provisions that would require us to pay penalties to
our clients if we do not meet pre-agreed service level requirements. Failure to meet these requirements could result in the payment of significant penalties by us to our clients which in turn could have an adverse effect on our business, results of
operations, financial condition and cash flows.
If our pricing structures do not accurately anticipate the cost and complexity of performing our
work, our profitability may be negatively affected.
The terms of our client contracts typically range from three to five years. In many of our
contracts, we commit to long-term pricing with our clients, and we negotiate pricing terms with our clients utilizing a range of pricing structures and conditions. Depending on the particular contract, these include input-based pricing (such as
full-time equivalent-based pricing arrangements), fixed-price arrangements, output-based pricing (such as transaction-based pricing), outcome-based pricing, and contracts with features of all these pricing models. Our pricing is highly dependent on
our internal forecasts and predictions about our projects and the marketplace, which are largely based on limited data and could turn out to be inaccurate. If we do not accurately estimate the costs and timing for completing projects, our contracts
could prove unprofitable for us or yield lower profit margins than anticipated. Some of our client contracts do not allow us to terminate the contracts except in the case of non-payment by our client. If any contract turns out to be economically
non-viable for us, we may still be liable to continue to provide services under the contract.
We intend to focus on increasing our service offerings that
are based on non-linear pricing models (such as fixed-price and outcome-based pricing models) that allow us to price our services based on the value we deliver to our clients rather than the headcount deployed to deliver the services to them.
Non-linear revenues may be subject to short term pressure on margins as initiatives in developing the products and services take time to deliver. The risk of entering into non-linear pricing arrangements is that if we fail to properly estimate the
appropriate pricing for a project, we may incur lower profits or losses as a result of being unable to execute projects with the amount of labor we expected or at a margin sufficient to recover our initial investments in our solutions. While
non-linear pricing models are expected to result in higher revenue productivity per employee and improved margins, they also mean that we continue to bear the risk of cost overruns, wage inflation, fluctuations in currency exchange rates and failure
to achieve clients business objectives in connection with these projects. Although we use our internally developed methodologies and processes and past project experience to reduce the risks associated with estimating, planning and performing
transaction-based pricing, fixed-price and outcome-based pricing projects, if we fail to estimate accurately the resources required for a project, future wage inflation rates or currency exchange rates, or if we fail to meet defined performance
goals or objectives, our profitability may suffer.
We have in the past and may in the future enter into subcontracting arrangements for the delivery of
services. For example, in China, in addition to delivering services from our own delivery center, we used to deliver services through a subcontractors delivery center. We could face greater risk when pricing our outsourcing contracts, as
our outsourcing projects typically entail the coordination of operations and workforces with our subcontractor, and utilizing workforces with different skill sets and competencies. Furthermore, when outsourcing work we assume responsibility for our
subcontractors performance. Our pricing, cost and profit margin estimates on outsourced work may include anticipated long-term cost savings from transformational and other initiatives that we expect to achieve and sustain over the life of the
outsourcing contract. There is a risk that we will underprice our contracts, fail to accurately estimate the costs of performing the work or fail to accurately assess the risks associated with potential contracts. In particular, any increased or
unexpected costs, delays or failures to achieve anticipated cost savings, or unexpected risks we encounter in connection with the performance of this work, including those caused by factors outside our control, could make these contracts less
profitable or unprofitable, which could have an adverse effect on our profit margin.
18
Our profitability will suffer if we are not able to maintain our pricing and asset utilization levels and
control our costs.
Our profit margin, and therefore our profitability, is largely a function of our asset utilization and the rates we are able to
recover for our services. An important component of our asset utilization is our seat utilization rate, which is the average number of work shifts per day, out of a maximum of three, for which we are able to utilize our work stations, or seats.
During fiscal 2015 and 2014, we incurred significant expenditures to increase our number of seats by establishing additional delivery centers or expanding production capacities in our existing delivery centers. During fiscal 2015, we incurred costs
to move our operations from one site in Gurgaon to another. If we are not able to maintain the pricing for our services or an appropriate seat utilization rate, without corresponding cost reductions, our profitability will suffer. The rates we are
able to recover for our services are affected by a number of factors, including our clients perceptions of our ability to add value through our services, competition, introduction of new services or products by us or our competitors, our
ability to accurately estimate, attain and sustain revenue from client contracts, margins and cash flows over increasingly longer contract periods and general economic and political conditions.
Our profitability is also a function of our ability to control our costs and improve our efficiency. As we increase the number of our employees and execute
our strategies for growth, we may not be able to manage the significantly larger and more geographically diverse workforce that may result, which could adversely affect our ability to control our costs or improve our efficiency. Further, because
there is no certainty that our business will ramp up at the rate that we anticipate, we may incur expenses for the increased capacity for a significant period of time without a corresponding growth in our revenues. Commencement of work and ramping
up of volume of work with certain new and existing clients have been slower than we had expected. If our revenue does not grow at our expected rate, we may not be able to maintain or improve our profitability.
We face competition from onshore and offshore business process management companies and from information technology companies that also offer business
process management services. Our clients may also choose to run their business processes themselves, either in their home countries or through captive units located offshore.
The market for outsourcing services is very competitive and we expect competition to intensify and increase from a number of sources. We believe that the
principal competitive factors in our markets are price, service quality, sales and marketing skills, and industry expertise. We face significant competition from our clients own in-house groups including, in some cases, in-house departments
operating offshore or captive units. Clients who currently outsource a significant proportion of their business processes or information technology services to vendors in India may, for various reasons, including diversifying geographic risk, seek
to reduce their dependence on any one country. We also face competition from onshore and offshore business process management and information technology services companies. In addition, the trend toward offshore outsourcing, international expansion
by foreign and domestic competitors and continuing technological changes will result in new and different competitors entering our markets. These competitors may include entrants from the communications, software and data networking industries or
entrants in geographic locations with lower costs than those in which we operate. Technological changes include the development of complex automated systems for the processing of transactions that are formerly labor intensive, which may reduce or
replace the need for outsourcing such transaction processing.
Some of these existing and future competitors have greater financial, human and other
resources, longer operating histories, greater technological expertise, more recognizable brand names and more established relationships in the industries that we currently serve or may serve in the future. In addition, some of our competitors may
enter into strategic or commercial relationships among themselves or with larger, more established companies in order to increase their ability to address client needs, or enter into similar arrangements with potential clients. Increased
competition, our inability to compete successfully against competitors, pricing pressures or loss of market share could result in reduced operating margins which could harm our business, results of operations, financial condition and cash flows.
We have incurred losses in the past. We may not be profitable in the future.
We incurred losses in each of the three fiscal years from fiscal 2003 through fiscal 2005. We expect our selling and marketing expenses and general and
administrative expenses to increase in future periods. If our revenue does not grow at a faster rate than these expected increases in our expenses, or if our operating expenses are higher than we anticipate, we may not be profitable and we may incur
losses.
19
If we cause disruptions to our clients businesses, provide inadequate service or are in breach of our
representations or obligations, our clients may have claims for substantial damages against us. Our insurance coverage may be inadequate to cover these claims and, as a result, our profits may be substantially reduced.
Most of our contracts with clients contain service level and performance requirements, including requirements relating to the quality of our services and the
timing and quality of responses to the clients customer inquiries. In some cases, the quality of services that we provide is measured by quality assurance ratings and surveys which are based in part on the results of direct monitoring by our
clients of interactions between our employees and our clients customers. Failure to consistently meet service requirements of a client or errors made by our associates in the course of delivering services to our clients could disrupt the
clients business and result in a reduction in revenue or a claim for substantial damages against us. For example, some of our agreements stipulate standards of service that, if not met by us, will result in lower payment to us. In addition, in
connection with acquiring new business from a client or entering into client contracts, our employees may make various representations, including representations relating to the quality of our services, abilities of our associates and our project
management techniques. A failure or inability to meet a contractual requirement or our representations could seriously damage our reputation and affect our ability to attract new business or result in a claim for substantial damages against us.
Our dependence on our offshore delivery centers requires us to maintain active data and voice communications between our main delivery centers in China, Costa
Rica, India, the Philippines, Poland, Romania, South Africa, Sri Lanka, the UK and the US, our international technology hubs in the UK and the US and our clients offices. Although we maintain redundant facilities and communications links,
disruptions could result from, among other things, technical and electricity breakdowns, computer glitches and viruses and adverse weather conditions. Any significant failure of our equipment or systems, or any major disruption to basic
infrastructure like power and telecommunications in the locations in which we operate, could impede our ability to provide services to our clients, have a negative impact on our reputation, cause us to lose clients, reduce our revenue and harm our
business.
Under our contracts with our clients, our liability for breach of our obligations is generally limited to actual damages suffered by the client
and capped at a portion of the fees paid or payable to us under the relevant contract. Although our contracts contain limitations on liability, such limitations may be unenforceable or otherwise may not protect us from liability for damages. In
addition, certain liabilities, such as claims of third parties for which we may be required to indemnify our clients, are generally not limited under those agreements. Further, although we have professional indemnity insurance coverage, the coverage
may not continue to be available on reasonable terms or in sufficient amounts to cover one or more large claims and our insurers may disclaim coverage as to any future claims. The successful assertion of one or more large claims against us that
exceed available insurance coverage, or changes in our insurance policies (including premium increases or the imposition of large deductible or co-insurance requirements), could have a material adverse effect on our business, reputation, results of
operations, financial condition and cash flows.
We are liable to our clients for damages caused by unauthorized disclosure of sensitive or
confidential information, whether through a breach or circumvention of our or our clients computer systems and processes, through our employees or otherwise.
We are typically required to manage, utilize and store sensitive or confidential client data in connection with the services we provide. Under the terms of our
client contracts, we are required to keep such information strictly confidential. Our client contracts do not include any limitation on our liability to them with respect to breaches of our obligation to maintain confidentiality on the information
we receive from them. Although we seek to implement measures to protect sensitive and confidential client data, there can be no assurance that we would be able to prevent breaches of security. Further, some of our projects require us to conduct
business functions and computer operations using our clients systems over which we do not have control and which may not be compliant with industry security standards. In addition, some of the client designed processes that we are
contractually required to follow for delivering services to them and which we are unable to unilaterally change, could be designed in a manner that allows for control weaknesses to exist and be exploited. Any vulnerability in a clients system
or client designed process, if exploited, could result in breaches of security or unauthorized transactions and result in a claim for substantial damages against us. If any person, including any of our employees, penetrates our or our clients
network security or otherwise mismanages or misappropriates sensitive or confidential client data, we could be subject to significant liability and lawsuits from our clients or their customers for breaching contractual confidentiality provisions or
privacy laws. Although we have insurance coverage for mismanagement or misappropriation of such information by our employees, that coverage may not continue to be available on reasonable terms or in sufficient amounts to cover one or more large
claims against us, and our insurers may disclaim coverage as to any future claims. Penetration of the network security of our or our clients data centers or computer systems or unauthorized use or disclosure of sensitive or confidential client
data, whether through breach of our or our clients computer systems, systems failure, loss or theft of assets containing confidential information or otherwise, could also have a negative impact on our reputation which would harm our business.
20
Fraud and significant security breaches in our or our clients computer systems and network
infrastructure could adversely impact our business
Our business is dependent on the secure and reliable operation of our information systems,
including those used to operate and manage our business and our clients information systems, whether operated by our clients themselves or by us in connection with our provision of services to them. Although we take adequate measures to
safeguard against system-related and other fraud, there can be no assurance that we would be able to prevent fraud or even detect them on a timely basis, particularly where it relates to our clients information systems which are not managed by
us. For example, we have identified incidences where our employees have allegedly exploited weaknesses in information systems as well as processes in order to misappropriate confidential client data and used such confidential data to record
fraudulent transactions. We are generally required to indemnify our clients from third party claims arising out of such fraudulent transactions and our client contracts generally do not include any limitation on our liability to our clients
losses arising from fraudulent activities by our employees. Accordingly, we may have significant liability arising from such fraudulent transactions which may materially affect our business and financial results. Although we have professional
indemnity insurance coverage for losses arising from fraudulent activities by our employees, that coverage may not continue to be available on reasonable terms or in sufficient amounts to cover one or more large claims against us, and our insurers
may also disclaim coverage as to any future claims. We may also suffer reputational harm as a result of fraud committed by our employees, or by our perceived inability to properly manage fraud related risks, which could in turn lead to enhanced
regulatory oversight and scrutiny.
Our expansion into new markets may create additional challenges with respect to managing the risk of fraud due to the
increased geographical dispersion and use of intermediaries. Our business also requires the appropriate and secure utilization of client and other sensitive information. We cannot be certain that advances in criminal capabilities (including
cyber-attacks or cyber intrusions over the internet, malware, computer viruses and the like), discovery of new vulnerabilities or attempts to exploit existing vulnerabilities in our or our clients systems, other data thefts, physical system or
network break-ins or inappropriate access, or other developments will not compromise or breach the technology protecting our or our clients computer systems and networks that access and store sensitive information. Cyber threats, such as
phishing and trojans, could intrude into our or our clients network to steal data or to seek sensitive information. Any intrusion into our network or our clients network (to the extent attributed to us or perceived to be attributed to
us) that results in any breach of security could cause damage to our reputation and adversely impact our business and financial results. Although we have implemented security technology and operational procedures to prevent such occurrences, there
can be no assurance that these security measures will be successful. A significant failure in security measures could have a material adverse effect on our business, reputation, results of operations and financial condition.
Changes in technology could lead to changes in our clients businesses as well as their requirements for business process services, which may
adversely impact our business and results of operations.
Proliferation of accessible technology, such as smartphones and internet, has had an
impact on the manner in which customers and businesses interact with each other. Companies are increasingly adopting social media platforms, online self-help portals and mobile applications for communicating with and servicing their customers rather
than utilizing business process management companies such as ourselves to manage these interactions. Our clients also continue to invest in technology by upgrading their platforms and application capabilities towards increased automation of
transactions. Advances in software, such as robotic process automation and voice recognition, have the potential to reduce dependency on human processing transactions. Such developments and other innovations, such as autonomous vehicles, have the
potential to significantly change the way our clients businesses operate and may reduce their dependency on business process management companies, including our company, for managing their business processes. We are therefore subject to a risk
of disintermediation on account of such changes in technology, which could impact our future growth prospects and may require continued investments in our business.
21
Our business could be materially and adversely affected if we do not protect our intellectual property or
if our services are found to infringe on the intellectual property of others.
Our success depends in part on certain methodologies, practices,
tools and technical expertise we utilize in designing, developing, implementing and maintaining applications and other proprietary intellectual property rights. In order to protect our rights in such intellectual properties, we rely upon a
combination of nondisclosure and other contractual arrangements as well as trade secret, copyright and trademark laws. We also generally enter into confidentiality agreements with our employees, consultants, clients and potential clients, and limit
access to and distribution of our proprietary information to the extent required for our business purpose.
India is a member of the Berne Convention, an
international intellectual property treaty, and has agreed to recognize protections on intellectual property rights conferred under the laws of other foreign countries, including the laws of the United States. There can be no assurance that the
laws, rules, regulations and treaties in effect in the United States, India and the other jurisdictions in which we operate and the contractual and other protective measures we take, are adequate to protect us from misappropriation or
unauthorized use of our intellectual property, or that such laws will not change. We may not be able to detect unauthorized use and take appropriate steps to enforce our rights, and any such steps may not be successful. Infringement by others of our
intellectual property, including the costs of enforcing our intellectual property rights, may have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.
Our clients may provide us with access to, and require us to use, third party software in connection with our delivery of services to them. Our client
contracts generally require our clients to indemnify us for any infringement of intellectual property rights or licenses to third party software when our clients provide such access to us. If the indemnities under our client contracts are inadequate
to cover the damages and losses we suffer due to infringement of third party intellectual property rights or licenses to third party software to which we were given access, our business and results of operations could be adversely affected. We are
also generally required, by our client contracts, to indemnify our clients for any breaches of intellectual property rights by our services. Although we believe that we are not infringing on the intellectual property rights of others, claims may
nonetheless be successfully asserted against us in the future. The costs of defending any such claims could be significant, and any successful claim may require us to modify, discontinue or rename any of our services. Any such changes may have a
material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.
We may not succeed in identifying suitable acquisition
targets or integrating any acquired business into our operations, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations, financial condition and cash flows.
Our growth strategy involves gaining new clients and expanding our service offerings, both organically and through strategic acquisitions. It is possible that
in the future we may not succeed in identifying suitable acquisition targets available for sale or investments on reasonable terms, have access to the capital required to finance potential acquisitions or investments, or be able to consummate any
acquisition or investments. Future acquisitions or joint ventures may also result in the incurrence of indebtedness or the issuance of additional equity securities, which may present difficulties in financing the acquisition or joint venture on
attractive terms. The inability to identify suitable acquisition targets or investments or the inability to complete such transactions may affect our competitiveness and our growth prospects.
Historically, we have expanded some of our service offerings and gained new clients through strategic acquisitions. For example, in November 2011, we
acquired the shareholding of Advanced Contact Solutions, Inc., or ACS, our former joint venture partner in WNS Philippines Inc. and increased our share ownership from 65% to 100%. The lack of profitability of any of our acquisitions or joint
ventures could have a material adverse effect on our operating results.
In addition, our management may not be able to successfully integrate any
acquired business into our operations or benefit from any joint ventures that we enter into, and any acquisition we do complete or any joint venture we do enter into may not result in long-term benefits to us. For instance, if we acquire a company,
we could experience difficulties in assimilating that companys personnel, operations, technology and software, or the key personnel of the acquired company may decide not to work for us. In June 2012, we acquired Fusion, a leading BPM
provider based in South Africa. Fusion provides a range of outsourcing services, including contact center, customer care and business continuity services, to both South African and international clients. With operations in Cape Town and
Johannesburg, Fusion employed approximately 1,500 people as at June 30, 2012 which increased to 2,330 people as at March 31, 2015. We cannot assure you that we will be able to successfully integrate Fusions business operations with
ours, or that we will be able to successfully leverage Fusions assets to grow our revenue, expand our service offerings and market share or achieve accretive benefits from our acquisition of Fusion.
22
Further, we may receive claims or demands by the sellers of the entities acquired by us on the indemnities that
we have provided to them for losses or damages arising from any breach of contract by us. Conversely, while we may be able to claim against the sellers on their indemnities to us for breach of contract or breach of the representations and warranties
given by the sellers in respect of the entities acquired by us, there can be no assurance that our claims will succeed, or if they do, that we will be able to successfully enforce our claims against the sellers at a reasonable cost. Acquisitions and
joint ventures also typically involve a number of other risks, including diversion of managements attention, legal liabilities and the need to amortize acquired intangible assets, any of which could have a material adverse effect on our
business, results of operations, financial condition and cash flows.
We recorded a significant impairment charge to our earnings in fiscal 2008 and
may be required to record another significant charge to earnings in the future when we review our goodwill, intangible or other assets for potential impairment.
As at March 31, 2015, we had goodwill and intangible assets of approximately $79.1 million and $43.3 million, respectively, which primarily resulted from
the purchases of Aviva Global, BizAps, Chang Limited, Flovate Technologies Limited, or Flovate, Fusion, Marketics Technologies (India) Private Limited, or Marketics, Town & Country Assistance Limited (which we subsequently rebranded as WNS
Assistance), and WNS Global Services Private Limited, or WNS Global. Of the $43.3 million of intangible assets as at March 31, 2015, $34.0 million pertain to our purchase of Aviva Global. Under IFRS, we are required to review our goodwill,
intangibles or other assets for impairment when events or changes in circumstances indicate the carrying value may not be recoverable. In addition, goodwill, intangible or other assets with indefinite lives are required to be tested for impairment
at least annually. We performed an impairment review and recorded a significant impairment charge to our earnings in fiscal 2008 relating to Trinity Partners Inc. If, for example, the insurance industry experiences a significant decline in business
and we determine that we will not be able to achieve the cash flows that we had expected from our acquisition of Aviva Global, we may have to record an impairment of all or a portion of the $34.0 million of intangible assets relating to our purchase
of Aviva Global. Although our impairment review of goodwill and intangible assets in fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013 did not indicate any impairment, we may be required in the future to record a significant charge to earnings in our financial statements
during the period in which any impairment of our goodwill or other intangible assets is determined. Such charges may have a significant adverse impact on our results of operations.
Any changes in accounting standards can be difficult to predict and can materially impact how we report our financial results.
We have adopted IFRS, as issued by the IASB, with effect from April 1, 2011. From time to time, the IASB changes its standards that govern the preparation
of our financial statements. Changes in accounting standards are difficult to anticipate and can significantly impact our reported financial condition and the results of our operations.
Our facilities are at risk of damage by natural disasters.
Our operational facilities and communication hubs may be damaged in natural disasters such as earthquakes, floods, heavy rains, tsunamis and cyclones. For
example, during floods caused by typhoons in Manila, Philippines in September 2009, our delivery center was rendered inaccessible and our associates were not able to commute to the delivery center for a few days, thereby adversely impacting our
provision of services to our clients. During the floods in Mumbai in July 2005, our operations were adversely affected as a result of the disruption of the citys public utility and transport services making it difficult for our associates
to commute to our office. Such natural disasters may also lead to disruption to information systems and telephone service for sustained periods. Damage or destruction that interrupts our provision of BPM services could damage our relationships with
our clients and may cause us to incur substantial additional expenses to repair or replace damaged equipment or facilities. We may also be liable to our clients for disruption in service resulting from such damage or destruction. Although we have
implemented business continuity planning and infrastructure resiliency measures which are designed to minimize the impact of natural disasters on our business, such measures may be rendered less effective in certain circumstances. While we currently
have property damage insurance and business interruption insurance, our insurance coverage may not be sufficient. Furthermore, we may be unable to secure such insurance coverage at premiums acceptable to us in the future or secure such insurance
coverage at all. Prolonged disruption of our services as a result of natural disasters would also entitle our clients to terminate their contracts with us.
23
We are incorporated in Jersey, Channel Islands and are subject to Jersey rules and regulations. If the
tax benefits enjoyed by our company are withdrawn or changed, we may be liable for higher tax, thereby reducing our profitability.
As a company
incorporated in Jersey, Channel Islands, we are currently subject to a Jersey income tax rate of 0%. Although we continue to enjoy the benefits of the Jersey business tax regime, if Jersey tax laws change or the tax benefits we enjoy are otherwise
withdrawn or changed, we may become liable for higher tax, thereby reducing our profitability.
Risks Related to Key Delivery Locations
A substantial portion of our assets and operations are located in India and we are subject to regulatory, economic, social and political uncertainties in
India.
Our primary operating subsidiary, WNS Global, is incorporated in India, and a substantial portion of our assets and employees are located
in India. We intend to continue to develop and expand our facilities in India. The Government of India, however, has exercised and continues to exercise significant influence over many aspects of the Indian economy. The Government of India has
provided significant tax incentives and relaxed certain regulatory restrictions in order to encourage foreign investment in specified sectors of the economy, including the business process management industry. Those programs that have benefited us
include tax holidays, liberalized import and export duties and preferential rules on foreign investment and repatriation. We cannot assure you that such liberalization policies will continue. The Government of India may also enact new tax
legislation or amend the existing legislation that could impact the way we are taxed in the future. For more information, see New tax legislation and the results of actions by taxing authorities may have an adverse effect on our
operations and our overall tax rate. Our financial performance and the market price of our ADSs may be adversely affected by changes in inflation, exchange rates and controls, interest rates, Government of India policies (including taxation
regulations and policies), social stability or other political, economic or diplomatic developments affecting India in the future.
India has witnessed
communal clashes in the past. Although such clashes in India have, in the recent past, been sporadic and have been contained within reasonably short periods of time, any such civil disturbance in the future could result in disruptions in
transportation or communication networks, as well as have adverse implications for general economic conditions in India. Such events could have a material adverse effect on our business, the value of our ADSs and your investment in our ADSs.
If the tax benefits and other incentives that we currently enjoy are reduced or withdrawn or not available for any other reason, our financial condition
would be negatively affected.
We have benefitted from, and continue to benefit from, certain tax holidays and exemptions in various jurisdictions
in which we have operations.
In fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013, our tax rate in India and Sri Lanka impacted our effective tax rate. We would have incurred
approximately $3.0 million, $1.7 million and $0.8 million in additional income tax expense on our operations in Sri Lanka and on our SEZ operations in India for fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively, if the tax holidays and exemptions as
described below had not been available for the respective periods.
We expect our tax rate in India and Sri Lanka and, to a lesser extent, the Philippines
to continue to impact our effective tax rate. Our tax rate in India have been impacted by the reduction in the tax exemption enjoyed by our delivery center located in Gurgaon under the SEZ scheme from 100.0% to 50.0% which started in fiscal 2013.
However, we expect to expand the operations in our delivery centers located in other SEZs that are still in their initial five years of operations and therefore eligible for 100.0% income tax exemption.
For example, in the past, the majority of our Indian operations were eligible to claim income tax exemption with respect to profits earned from export revenue
from operating units registered under the Software Technology Parks of India, or STPI. The benefit was available for a period of 10 years from the date of commencement of operations, but not beyond March 31, 2011. Effective April 1, 2011,
upon the expiration of this tax exemption, income derived from our operations in India became subject to the prevailing annual tax rate, which is currently 33.99%. For further details on our tax benefits, see Item 4B.Business
OverviewRegulations.
24
When any of our tax holidays or exemptions expire or terminate, or if the applicable government withdraws or
reduces the benefits of a tax holiday or exemption that we enjoy, our tax expense may materially increase and this increase may have a material impact on our results of operations. The applicable tax authorities may also disallow deductions claimed
by us and assess additional taxable income on us in connection with their review of our tax returns.
New tax legislation and the results of actions
by taxing authorities may have an adverse effect on our operations and our overall tax rate.
The Government of India may enact new tax legislation
that could impact the way we are taxed in the future. For example, the Government of India has clarified that, with retrospective effect from April 1, 1962, any income accruing or arising directly or indirectly through the transfer of capital
assets situated in India will be taxable in India. If any of our transactions are deemed to involve the direct or indirect transfer of a capital asset located in India, such transactions could be investigated by the Indian tax authorities, which
could lead to the issuance of tax assessment orders and a material increase in our tax liability. For example, we received a request from the relevant income tax authority in India for information relating to our acquisition in July 2008 from
Aviva of all the shares of Aviva Global, which owned subsidiaries with assets in India and Sri Lanka. No allegation or demand for payment of additional tax relating to that transaction has been made yet. The Government of India has issued guidelines
on General Anti Avoidance Rule, or the GAAR, which is currently expected to be effective April 1, 2017, and which is intended to curb sophisticated tax avoidance. Under the GAAR, a business arrangement will be deemed an impermissible
avoidance arrangement if the main purpose of the arrangement is to obtain tax benefits. Although the full implications of the GAAR are presently still unclear, if we are deemed to have violated any of its provisions, we may face an increase to
our tax liability.
Further, the Government of India, pursuant to the Indian Finance Act 2014, stipulated that any income arising from unlisted securities
and units (other than equity oriented funds) after July 10, 2014 would only be considered as a long term capital gain if held for more than 36 months as compared to the current period of 12 months. Income from a long term capital asset is
currently taxed at 10% as compared to 33.99% for income from short term capital assets. We have invested in a number of debt oriented fixed maturity plans, or FMPs, that were categorized as long term capital assets under the previous rules but are
now categorized as short term capital assets under the current rules. As a result, our investment in such FMPs resulted in an increase in income tax payable by $1.7 million in fiscal 2015, which reduced our net profit by the same amount for that
fiscal year.
The Government of India, the US or other jurisdictions where we have a presence could enact new tax legislation which would have a material
adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition. In addition, our ability to repatriate surplus earnings from our delivery centers in a tax-efficient manner is dependent upon interpretations of local laws, possible
changes in such laws and the renegotiation of existing double tax avoidance treaties. Changes to any of these may adversely affect our overall tax rate, or the cost of our services to our clients, which would have a material adverse effect on our
business, results of operations and financial condition.
We are subject to transfer pricing and other tax related regulations and any determination
that we have failed to comply with them could materially adversely affect our profitability.
Transfer pricing regulations to which we are subject
require that any international transaction among our company and its subsidiaries, or the WNS group enterprises, be on arms-length terms. Transfer pricing regulations in India have been extended to cover specified Indian domestic transactions
as well. We believe that the international and India domestic transactions among the WNS group enterprises are on arms-length terms. If, however, the applicable tax authorities determine that the transactions among the WNS group enterprises do
not meet arms length criteria, we may incur increased tax liability, including accrued interest and penalties. This would cause our tax expense to increase, possibly materially, thereby reducing our profitability and cash flows.
We may be required to pay additional taxes in connection with audits by the Indian tax authorities.
From time to time, we receive orders of assessment from Indian tax authorities assessing additional taxable income on us and/or our subsidiaries in connection
with their review of our tax returns. We currently have orders of assessment for fiscal 2003 through fiscal 2012 pending before various appellate authorities. These orders assess additional taxable income that could in the aggregate give rise to an
estimated
3,046.6 million ($48.6 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) in additional taxes, including interest of
1,078.9 million ($17.2 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015).
25
These orders of assessment allege that the transfer prices we applied to certain of the international
transactions between WNS Global or WNS Business Consulting Services Private Limited, or WNS BCS, each of which is our Indian subsidiary, as the case may be, and our other wholly-owned subsidiaries were not on arms length terms, disallow a tax
holiday benefit claimed by us, deny the set off of brought forward business losses and unabsorbed depreciation and disallow certain expenses claimed as tax deductible by WNS Global or WNS BCS, as the case may be. As at March 31, 2015 we have
provided a tax reserve of
906.8 million ($14.5 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) primarily on account of the Indian tax authorities denying the set off of brought forward business losses and unabsorbed
depreciation. We have appealed against these orders of assessment before higher appellate authorities. For more details on these assessments, see Part I Item 5 Operating and Financial Review and Prospects Tax
Assessment Orders.
In addition, we currently have orders of assessment pertaining to similar issues that have been decided in our favor by first
level appellate authorities, vacating tax demands of
2,482.2 million ($39.6 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) in additional taxes, including interest of
770.5 million ($12.3 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015). The income tax authorities have filed appeals against these orders at higher appellate authorities.
In case of disputes, the Indian tax authorities may require us to deposit with them all or a portion of the disputed amounts pending resolution of the matters
on appeal. Any amount paid by us as deposits will be refunded to us with interest if we succeed in our appeals. We have deposited a portion of the disputed amount with the tax authorities and may be required to deposit the remaining portion of the
disputed amount with the tax authorities pending final resolution of the respective matters.
As at March 31, 2015, corporate tax returns for fiscal
years 2012 (for certain legal entities) and thereafter remain subject to examination by tax authorities in India.
After consultation with our Indian tax
advisors and based on the facts of these cases, certain legal opinions from counsel, the nature of the tax authorities disallowances and the orders from first level appellate authorities deciding similar issues in our favor in respect of
assessment orders for earlier fiscal years, we believe these orders are unlikely to be sustained at the higher appellate authorities and we intend to vigorously dispute the orders of assessment.
In March 2009, we also received an assessment order from the Indian Service Tax Authority demanding payment of
348.1 million ($5.6 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) of service tax and related penalty for the period from March 1, 2003 to January 31, 2005. The assessment order alleges that
service tax is payable in India on BPM services provided by WNS Global to clients based abroad as the export proceeds are repatriated outside India by WNS Global. In response to an appeal filed by us with the appellate tribunal against the
assessment order in April 2009, the appellate tribunal has remanded the matter back to the lower tax authorities to be adjudicated afresh. Based on consultations with our Indian tax advisors, we believe this order of assessment is more likely
than not to be upheld in our favor. We intend to continue to vigorously dispute the assessment.
No assurance can be given, however, that we will prevail
in our tax disputes. If we do not prevail, payment of additional taxes, interest and penalties may adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition and cash flows. There can also be no assurance that we will not receive similar or
additional orders of assessment in the future.
Terrorist attacks and other acts of violence involving India or its neighboring countries could
adversely affect our operations, resulting in a loss of client confidence and materially adversely affecting our business, results of operations, financial condition and cash flows.
Terrorist attacks and other acts of violence or war involving India or its neighboring countries may adversely affect worldwide financial markets and could
potentially lead to economic recession, which could adversely affect our business, results of operations, financial condition and cash flows. South Asia has, from time to time, experienced instances of civil unrest and hostilities among neighboring
countries, including India and Pakistan. In previous years, military confrontations between India and Pakistan have occurred in the region of Kashmir and along the India/Pakistan border. There have also been incidents in and near India such as the
bombings of the Taj Mahal Hotel and Oberoi Hotel in Mumbai in 2008, a terrorist attack on the Indian Parliament, troop mobilizations along the India/Pakistan border and an aggravated geopolitical situation in the region. Such military activity or
terrorist attacks in the future could influence the Indian economy by disrupting communications and making travel more difficult. Resulting political tensions could create a greater perception that investments in Indian companies involve a high
degree of risk. Such political tensions could similarly create a perception that there is a risk of disruption of services provided by India-based companies, which could have a material adverse effect on the market for our services. Furthermore, if
India were to become engaged in armed hostilities, particularly hostilities that were protracted or involved the threat or use of nuclear weapons, we might not be able to continue our operations.
26
Restrictions on entry visas may affect our ability to compete for and provide services to clients in the US
and the UK, which could have a material adverse effect on future revenue.
The vast majority of our employees are Indian nationals. The ability of
some of our executives to work with and meet our European and North American clients and our clients from other countries depends on the ability of our senior managers and employees to obtain the necessary visas and entry permits. In response to
previous terrorist attacks and global unrest, US and European immigration authorities have increased the level of scrutiny in granting visas. Immigration laws in those countries may also require us to meet certain other legal requirements as a
condition to obtaining or maintaining entry visas. These restrictions have significantly lengthened the time requirements to obtain visas for our personnel, which has in the past resulted, and may continue to result, in delays in the ability of our
personnel to meet with our clients. In addition, immigration laws are subject to legislative change and varying standards of application and enforcement due to political forces, economic conditions or other events, including terrorist attacks. We
cannot predict the political or economic events that could affect immigration laws or any restrictive impact those events could have on obtaining or monitoring entry visas for our personnel. If we are unable to obtain the necessary visas for
personnel who need to visit our clients sites or, if such visas are delayed, we may not be able to provide services to our clients or to continue to provide services on a timely basis, which could have a material adverse effect on our
business, results of operations, financial condition and cash flows.
If more stringent labor laws become applicable to us, our profitability may be
adversely affected.
India has stringent labor legislation that protects the interests of workers, including legislation that sets forth detailed
procedures for dispute resolution and employee removal and legislation that imposes financial obligations on employers upon retrenchment. Though we are exempt from a number of these labor laws at present, there can be no assurance that such laws
will not become applicable to the business process management industry in India in the future. In addition, our employees may in the future form unions. If these labor laws become applicable to our workers or if our employees unionize, it may become
difficult for us to maintain flexible human resource policies, discharge employees or downsize, and our profitability may be adversely affected.
Most of our delivery centers operate on leasehold property and our inability to renew our leases on commercially acceptable terms or at all may
adversely affect our results of operations.
Most of our delivery centers operate on leasehold property. Our leases are subject to renewal and we
may be unable to renew such leases on commercially acceptable terms or at all. Our inability to renew our leases, or a renewal of our leases with a rental rate higher than the prevailing rate under the applicable lease prior to expiration, may have
an adverse impact on our operations, including disrupting our operations or increasing our cost of operations. In addition, in the event of non-renewal of our leases, we may be unable to locate suitable replacement properties for our delivery
centers or we may experience delays in relocation that could lead to a disruption in our operations. Any disruption in our operations could have an adverse effect on our results of operation.
Risks Related to our ADSs
Substantial future sales
of our shares or ADSs in the public market could cause our ADS price to fall.
Sales by us or our shareholders of a substantial number of our ADSs
in the public market, or the perception that these sales could occur, could cause the market price of our ADSs to decline. These sales, or the perception that these sales could occur, also might make it more difficult for us to sell securities in
the future at a time or at a price that we deem appropriate or to pay for acquisitions using our equity securities. As at March 31, 2015, we had 51,950,662 ordinary shares outstanding, including 51,770,634 shares represented by 51,770,634 ADSs.
In addition, as at March 31, 2015, a total of 3,160,306 ordinary shares or ADSs are issuable upon the exercise or vesting of options and restricted share units, or RSUs, outstanding under our 2002 Stock Incentive Plan and our Third Amended and
Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan. All ADSs are freely transferable, except that ADSs owned by our affiliates may only be sold in the US if they are registered or qualify for an exemption from registration, including pursuant to Rule 144 under
the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or the Securities Act. The remaining ordinary shares outstanding may also only be sold in the US if they are registered or qualify for an exemption from registration, including pursuant to Rule 144 under
the Securities Act.
27
The market price for our ADSs may be volatile.
The market price for our ADSs is likely to be highly volatile and subject to wide fluctuations in response to factors including the following:
|
|
|
announcements of technological developments; |
|
|
|
regulatory developments in our target markets affecting us, our clients or our competitors; |
|
|
|
actual or anticipated fluctuations in our operating results; |
|
|
|
changes in financial estimates by securities research analysts; |
|
|
|
changes in the economic performance or market valuations of other companies engaged in business process management; |
|
|
|
addition or loss of executive officers or key employees; |
|
|
|
sales or expected sales of additional shares or ADSs; |
|
|
|
loss of one or more significant clients; and |
|
|
|
a change in control, or possible change of control, of our company. |
In addition, securities markets generally
and from time to time experience significant price and volume fluctuations that are not related to the operating performance of particular companies. These market fluctuations may also have a material adverse effect on the market price of our ADSs.
We may not be able to pay any dividends on our shares and ADSs.
We have never declared or paid any dividends on our ordinary shares. We cannot give any assurance that we will declare dividends of any amount, at any rate or
at all. Because we are a holding company, we rely principally on dividends, if any, paid by our subsidiaries to us to fund our dividend payments, if any, to our shareholders. Any limitation on the ability of our subsidiaries to pay dividends to us
could have a material adverse effect on our ability to pay dividends to you.
Any future determination to pay cash dividends will be at the discretion of
our Board of Directors and will be dependent upon our results of operations and cash flows, our financial position and capital requirements, general business conditions, legal, tax, regulatory and any contractual restrictions on the payment of
dividends and any other factors our Board of Directors deems relevant at the time.
Subject to the provisions of the Companies (Jersey) Law 1991, or the
1991 Law, and our Articles of Association, we may by ordinary resolution declare annual dividends to be paid to our shareholders according to their respective rights and interests in our distributable reserves. Any dividends we may declare must not
exceed the amount recommended by our Board of Directors. Our board may also declare and pay an interim dividend or dividends, including a dividend payable at a fixed rate, if paying an interim dividend or dividends appears to the Board to be
justified by our distributable reserves. We can only declare dividends if our directors who are to authorize the distribution make a prior statement that, having made full enquiry into our affairs and prospects, they have formed the opinion that:
|
|
|
immediately following the date on which the distribution is proposed to be made, we will be able to discharge our liabilities as they fall due; and |
|
|
|
having regard to our prospects and to the intentions of our directors with respect to the management of our business and to the amount and character of the financial resources that will in their view be available to us,
we will be able to continue to carry on business and we will be able to discharge our liabilities as they fall due until the expiry of the period of 12 months immediately following the date on which the distribution is proposed to be made or until
we are dissolved under Article 150 of the 1991 Law, whichever first occurs. |
Subject to the deposit agreement governing the issuance of
our ADSs, holders of ADSs will be entitled to receive dividends paid on the ordinary shares represented by such ADSs. See Risks Related to Our Business Our loan agreements impose operating and financial restrictions on us and
our subsidiaries.
28
Holders of ADSs may be restricted in their ability to exercise voting rights.
At our request, the depositary of the ADSs will mail to you any notice of shareholders meeting received from us together with information explaining how
to instruct the depositary to exercise the voting rights of the ordinary shares represented by ADSs. If the depositary timely receives voting instructions from you, it will endeavor to vote the ordinary shares represented by your ADSs in accordance
with such voting instructions. However, the ability of the depositary to carry out voting instructions may be limited by practical and legal limitations and the terms of the ordinary shares on deposit. We cannot assure you that you will receive
voting materials in time to enable you to return voting instructions to the depositary in a timely manner. Ordinary shares for which no voting instructions have been received will not be voted.
As a foreign private issuer, we are not subject to the proxy rules of the Commission, which regulate the form and content of solicitations by US-based
issuers of proxies from their shareholders. The form of notice and proxy statement that we have been using does not include all of the information that would be provided under the Commissions proxy rules.
Holders of ADSs may be subject to limitations on transfers of their ADSs.
The ADSs are transferable on the books of the depositary. However, the depositary may close its transfer books at any time or from time to time when it deems
necessary or advisable in connection with the performance of its duties. In addition, the depositary may refuse to deliver, transfer or register transfers of ADSs generally when the transfer books of the depositary are closed, or at any time or from
time to time if we or the depositary deem it necessary or advisable to do so because of any requirement of law or of any government or governmental body or commission or any securities exchange on which the American Depositary Receipts or our
ordinary shares are listed, or under any provision of the deposit agreement or provisions of or governing the deposited shares, or any meeting of our shareholders, or for any other reason.
Holders of ADSs may not be able to participate in rights offerings or elect to receive share dividends and may experience dilution of their holdings,
and the sale, deposit, cancellation and transfer of our ADSs issued after exercise of rights may be restricted.
If we offer our shareholders any
rights to subscribe for additional shares or any other rights, the depositary may make these rights available to them after consultation with us. We cannot make rights available to holders of our ADSs in the US unless we register the rights and the
securities to which the rights relate under the Securities Act, or an exemption from the registration requirements is available. In addition, under the deposit agreement, the depositary will not distribute rights to holders of our ADSs unless we
have requested that such rights be made available to them and the depositary has determined that such distribution of rights is lawful and reasonably practicable. We can give no assurance that we can establish an exemption from the registration
requirements under the Securities Act, and we are under no obligation to file a registration statement with respect to these rights or underlying securities or to endeavor to have a registration statement declared effective. Accordingly, holders of
our ADSs may be unable to participate in our rights offerings and may experience dilution of your holdings as a result. The depositary may allow rights that are not distributed or sold to lapse. In that case, holders of our ADSs will receive no
value for them. In addition, US securities laws may restrict the sale, deposit, cancellation and transfer of ADSs issued after exercise of rights.
We may be classified as a passive foreign investment company, which could result in adverse US federal income tax consequences to US Holders of our ADSs
or ordinary shares.
Based on our financial statements and relevant market and shareholder data, we believe that we should not be treated as a
passive foreign investment company for US federal income tax purposes, or PFIC, with respect to our most recently closed taxable year. However, the application of the PFIC rules is subject to uncertainty in several respects, and we cannot
assure you that we will not be a PFIC for any taxable year. A non-US corporation will be a PFIC for any taxable year if either (i) at least 75% of its gross income for such year is passive income or (ii) at least 50% of the value of its
assets (based on an average of the quarterly values of the assets) during such year is attributable to assets that produce passive income or are held for the production of passive income. A separate determination must be made after the close of each
taxable year as to whether we were a PFIC for that year. Because the value of our assets for purposes of the PFIC test will generally be determined by reference to the market price of our ADSs and ordinary shares, fluctuations in the market price of
the ADSs and ordinary shares may cause us to become a PFIC. In addition, changes in the composition of our income or assets may cause us to become a PFIC. If we are a PFIC for any taxable year during which a US Holder (as defined in
Part I Item 10. Additional Information E. Taxation US Federal Income Taxation) holds an ADS or ordinary share, certain adverse US federal income tax consequences could apply to such US Holder.
29
Our share repurchase program could affect the price of our ADSs.
Our Board of Directors and shareholders have authorized the repurchase of up to 1.1 million of our ADSs, each representing one ordinary share, at a price
range of $10 to $30 per ADS from time to time for 12 months from April 1, 2015. Any repurchases pursuant to our repurchase program could affect the price of our ADSs and increase their volatility. The existence of a repurchase program could
also cause the price of our ADSs to be higher than it would be in the absence of such a program and could potentially reduce the market liquidity of our ADSs. There can be no assurance that any repurchases will enhance shareholder value because the
market price of our ADSs may decline below the levels at which we repurchase any ADSs. In addition, although our repurchase program is intended to enhance long-term shareholder value, short-term price fluctuations in our ADSs could reduce the
programs effectiveness. Significant changes in the price of our ADSs and our ability to fund our proposed repurchase program with cash on hand could impact our ability to repurchase ADSs. The timing and amount of future repurchases is
dependent on our cash flows from operations, available cash on hand and the market price of our ADSs. Furthermore, the program does not obligate our Company to repurchase any dollar amount or number of ADSs and may be suspended or discontinued at
any time, and any suspension or discontinuation could cause the market price of our ADSs to decline.
We have certain anti-takeover provisions in our
Articles of Association that may discourage a change in control.
Our Articles of Association contain anti-takeover provisions that could make it
more difficult for a third party to acquire us without the consent of our Board of Directors. These provisions include:
|
|
|
a classified Board of Directors with staggered three-year terms; and |
|
|
|
the ability of our Board of Directors to determine the rights, preferences and privileges of our preferred shares and to issue the preferred shares without shareholder approval, which could be exercised by our Board of
Directors to increase the number of outstanding shares and prevent or delay a takeover attempt. |
These provisions could make it more
difficult for a third party to acquire us, even if the third partys offer may be considered beneficial by many shareholders. As a result, shareholders may be limited in their ability to obtain a premium for their shares.
It may be difficult for you to effect service of process and enforce legal judgments against us or our affiliates.
We are incorporated in Jersey, Channel Islands, and our primary operating subsidiary, WNS Global, is incorporated in India. A majority of our directors and
senior executives are not residents of the US and virtually all of our assets and the assets of those persons are located outside the US. As a result, it may not be possible for you to effect service of process within the US upon those persons or
us. In addition, you may be unable to enforce judgments obtained in courts of the US against those persons outside the jurisdiction of their residence, including judgments predicated solely upon the securities laws of the US.
30
ITEM 4. INFORMATION ON THE COMPANY
A. History and Development of our Company
WNS (Holdings)
Limited was incorporated as a private liability company on February 18, 2002 under the laws of Jersey, Channel Islands, and maintains a registered office in Jersey at Queensway House, Hilgrove Street, St Helier, Jersey JE1 1ES. We converted
from a private limited company to a public limited company on January 4, 2006 when we acquired more than 30 shareholders as calculated in accordance with Article 17A of the 1991 Law. We gave notice of this to the Jersey Financial Services
Commission, or JFSC, in accordance with Article 17(3) of the 1991 Law on January 12, 2006. Our principal executive office is located at Gate 4, Godrej & Boyce Complex, Pirojshanagar, Vikhroli (W), Mumbai 400 079, India,
and the telephone number for this office is (91-22) 4095-2100. Our website address is www.wns.com. Information contained on our website does not constitute part of this annual report. Our agent for service in the US is our subsidiary,
WNS North America Inc., 15 Exchange Place, 3 rd Floor, Suite 310, Jersey City, New Jersey 07302, US.
We began operations as an in-house unit of British Airways in 1996 and became a business process outsourcing service provider for third parties in fiscal
2003. Warburg Pincus acquired a controlling stake in our company from British Airways in May 2002 and inducted a new senior management team.
In July
2006, we completed our initial public offering, whereupon our ADSs became listed on the New York Stock Exchange, or the NYSE, under the symbol WNS. In February 2012, in connection with our follow-on offering, we issued new ordinary
shares in the form of ADSs, at a price of $9.25 per ADS, aggregating approximately $50.0 million and at the same time, Warburg Pincus divested 6,847,500 ordinary shares in the form of ADSs. In February 2013, Warburg Pincus sold its remaining
14,519,144 ordinary shares in the form of ADSs, thereby divesting its entire stake in our company.
From 2004 to July 2007, we provided business process
outsourcing services to Aviva, a major client, pursuant to build-operate-transfer contracts from facilities in Colombo, Sri Lanka and Pune, India. The contracts at that time granted Aviva Global the option to require us to transfer our facilities in
Sri Lanka and Pune to Aviva Global, which was the business process offshoring subsidiary of Aviva at that time. In 2007, Aviva Global exercised its call option requiring us to transfer the Sri Lanka facility to Aviva Global and the transfer was
effective in July 2007. In July 2008, we acquired Aviva Global from Aviva and resumed ownership of the Sri Lanka facility. In connection with our acquisition of Aviva Global, we also entered into a master services agreement with Aviva MS in
2008, or the 2008 Aviva master services agreement, which we recently replaced with the Aviva master services agreement, pursuant to which we provide BPM services to Avivas UK business and Avivas Irish subsidiary, Hibernian Aviva Direct
Limited, and certain of its affiliates. See Part I Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects Revenue Our Contracts for more details on this transaction.
We have made a number of acquisitions since fiscal 2003, including our acquisition of Town & Country Assistance Limited, a UK-based automobile claims
handling company, thereby extending our service portfolio beyond the travel and leisure industry to include insurance-based automobile claims processing. We subsequently rebranded the company as WNS Assistance, which is part of WNS Auto Claims BPM,
our reportable segment for financial statement purposes. In fiscal 2004, we acquired the health claims management business of Greensnow Inc. In fiscal 2006, we acquired Trinity Partners Inc. (which we merged into our subsidiary, WNS North America
Inc.), a provider of BPM services to financial institutions, focusing on mortgage banking. In August 2006, we acquired from PRG Airlines Services Limited, or PRG Airlines, its fare audit services business. In September 2006, we acquired
from GHS Holdings LLC, or GHS, its financial accounting business. In May 2007, we acquired Marketics, a provider of offshore analytics services. In June 2007, we acquired Flovate, a company engaged in the development and maintenance of
software products and solutions, which we subsequently renamed as WNS Workflow Technologies Limited. In March 2008, we entered into a joint venture with ACS, a provider in BPO services and customer care in the Philippines, to form WNS
Philippines Inc. and in November 2011, we acquired ACSs shareholding in WNS Philippines Inc., which became our wholly-owned subsidiary. In April 2008, we acquired Chang Limited, an auto insurance claims processing services provider
in the UK, through its wholly-owned subsidiary, Accidents Happen Assistance Limited, or AHA (formerly known as Call 24-7 Limited, or Call 24-7). In June 2008, we acquired BizAps, a provider of Systems Applications and Products, or SAP®, solutions to optimize the enterprise resource planning functionality for our finance and accounting processes. In June 2012, we acquired Fusion, a provider of a range of outsourcing
services, including contact center, customer care and business continuity services, to both South African and international clients. Following our acquisition of Fusion, we have renamed it as WNS Global Services SA (Pty) Ltd.
31
In fiscal 2010, we restructured our organizational structure in order to streamline our administrative
operations, achieve operational and financial synergies, and reduce the costs and expenses relating to regulatory compliance. This restructuring involved the merger of the following seven Indian subsidiaries of WNS Global into WNS Global through a
Scheme of Amalgamation approved by an order of the Bombay High Court passed in August 2009 pursuant to the Indian Companies Act, 1956: Customer Operational Services (Chennai) Private Limited, Marketics, Noida Customer Operations Private
Limited, or Noida, NTrance Customer Services Private Limited, WNS Customer Solutions (Private) Limited, or WNS Customer Solutions, WNS Customer Solutions Shared Services Private Limited and WNS Workflow Technologies (India) Private Limited. In
another restructuring exercise, three of our subsidiaries, First Offshoring Technologies Private Limited, Hi-Tech Offshoring Services Private Limited and Servicesource Offshore Technologies Private Limited, were merged into WNS Global through a
Scheme of Amalgamation approved by an order of the Bombay High Court passed in March 2010 pursuant to the Indian Companies Act, 1956. In fiscal 2011 and 2012, we restructured and rationalized our UK and US group companies, wherein three of our
UK-based non-operating subsidiaries, Chang Limited, Town & Country Assistance Limited and BizAps, were voluntarily dissolved. In the US, two of our subsidiaries, WNS Customer Solutions North America Inc. and Business Application Associates
Inc. were merged with and into WNS North America Inc. In fiscal 2012, we also incorporated a new subsidiary in the US, WNS Global Services Inc., established a new branch of WNS (Mauritius) Limited in the Dubai Airport Free Zone, United Arab
Emirates, WNS Mauritius Limited ME (Branch), and de-registered our existing subsidiary WNS Global FZE in the Ras-Al-Khaimah Free Trade Zone, United Arab Emirates or UAE. In fiscal 2013, as part of our restructuring activities, WNS Philippines Inc.
was merged into WNS Global Services Philippines, Inc. and ownership of our Costa Rican subsidiary, WNS BPO Services Costa Rica, S.R.L. (formerly known as WNS BPO Services Costa Rica, S.A.), was transferred and is now a subsidiary of WNS North
America Inc. In May 2012, WNS Global Services (UK) Limited, or WNS UK, established a branch in Poland, WNS Global Services (UK) Limited (Spółka Z Ograniczoną Odpowiedzialnością) Oddział W Polsce, Gdańsk. In March
2013, we also established a new branch of Business Applications Associates Beijing Ltd. in Guangzhou, China named Business Applications Associates Beijing Limited Guangzhou Branch. In January 2014, we incorporated a new subsidiary of WNS (Mauritius)
Limited in China, WNS Global Services (Dalian) Co. Ltd. In March 2014, we incorporated WNS Legal Assistance LLP in the UK under the Limited Liability Partnership Act, 2000. In November 2014, we established a new branch of WNS Global Services Private
Limited in Singapore, WNS Global Services Private Limited (Singapore Branch). Our organizational structure now comprises 23 entities in 16 countries, and four branches in Poland, UAE, China and Singapore. Of these 23 entities, WNS Cares Foundation,
which is a wholly-owned subsidiary of WNS Global, is a not-for-profit organization registered under formerly Section 25 of the Indian Companies Act, 1956 (which has become Section 8 of the Indian Companies Act, 2013), India formed for
the purpose of promoting corporate social responsibilities and not considered for the purpose of preparing our consolidated financial statements.
We are
headquartered in Mumbai, India, and we have client service offices in Dubai (United Arab Emirates), Jersey City, (the US), Sydney, (Australia), London (the UK), and Singapore and delivery centers in San Jose (Costa Rica), Bangalore, Chennai,
Gurgaon, Mumbai, Nashik, Pune and Vizag (India), Manila (the Philippines), Gydnia (Poland), Bucharest (Romania), Cape Town and Johannesburg (South Africa), Colombo (Sri Lanka), Ipswich, Manchester and Mansfield (the UK), and Columbia, South
Carolina (the US) and Guangzhou (China).
Our capital expenditures in fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013 amounted to $22.9 million, $19.6 million and $21.2
million, respectively. Our principal capital expenditure were incurred for the purposes of setting up new delivery centers, expanding existing delivery centers and developing new technology-enabled solutions to enable execution and management of
clients business processes. We expect our capital expenditure needs in fiscal 2016 to be between $21.0 million to $25.0 million, a significant amount of which we expect to spend on infrastructure build-out, technology-enablement and the
streamlining of our operations. The geographical distribution, timing and volume of our capital expenditures in the future will depend on new client contracts we may enter into or the expansion of our business under our existing client contracts. As
at March 31, 2015, we had commitments for capital expenditures of $3.1 million relating to the purchase of property and equipment for our delivery centers. Of this committed amount, we plan to spend approximately $2.3 million in India,
approximately $0.2 million in the UK, approximately $0.2 million in Europe (excluding the UK), approximately $0.1 million in South Africa and approximately $0.3 million in the rest of the world. We expect to fund these estimated capital expenditures
from cash generated from operating activities, existing cash and cash equivalents and the use of existing credit facilities. See Part I Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects Liquidity and Capital
Resources for more information.
32
B. Business Overview
We are a leading global provider of BPM services, offering comprehensive data, voice, analytical and business transformation services. We reengineer, transform
and manage business processes to help make our clients more efficient and competitive through a blended onshore, nearshore and offshore delivery model. We transfer the business processes of our clients to our delivery centers and manage the
business processes of our clients from these delivery centers, located in China, Costa Rica, India, the Philippines, Poland, Romania, South Africa, Sri Lanka, the UK and the US with a view to offer cost savings, operational flexibility,
improved quality and actionable insights to our clients. We seek to help our clients transform their businesses by identifying business and process optimization opportunities through technology-enabled solutions, process design
improvements, analytics and improved business understanding.
We win outsourcing engagements from our clients based on our domain knowledge of their
business, our experience in managing the specific processes they seek to outsource and our customer-centric approach. Our company is organized into vertical business units in order to provide more specialized focus on each of the industries that we
target, to more effectively manage our clients business processes and to offer customized solutions and business insights designed to improve their competitive positioning. The major industry verticals we currently focus on are insurance;
travel and leisure; diversified businesses including manufacturing, retail, consumer packaged goods, or CPG, media and entertainment and telecommunication or telecom; utilities; consulting and professional services; banking and financial services;
healthcare; and shipping and logistics; as well as the public sector.
Our portfolio of services includes industry-specific processes that are tailored to
address our clients specific business and industry practices. In addition, we offer a set of shared services that are common across multiple industries, including contact center, finance and accounting, research and analytics, technology
services, legal services, and human resources outsourcing.
We monitor our execution of our clients business processes against multiple performance
parameters, and we aim to consistently meet and exceed these parameters in order to maintain and expand our client relationships. We aim to build long-term client relationships, and we typically sign multi-year contracts with our clients that
provide us with recurring revenue. In fiscal 2015, 83 and 75 clients contributed more than $1 million to our revenue and revenue less repair payments, respectively. In fiscal 2014, 76 and 70 clients contributed more than $1 million to our revenue
and revenue less repair payments, respectively.
As of March 31, 2015, we had 28,890 employees executing approximately 700 business processes for our
292 clients.
In fiscal 2015, our revenue was $533.9 million, our revenue less repair payments was $503.0 million and our profit was $58.6 million. Our
revenue less repair payments is a non-GAAP financial measure. For a discussion of our revenue less repair payments and a reconciliation of our revenue less repair payments to revenue, see Part I Item 5. Operating and Financial
Review and Prospects Overview.
Industry Overview
Companies are outsourcing a growing proportion of their business processes in order to reduce costs, increase process quality, increase flexibility, and
improve business outcomes. Companies have shifted their BPM requirements from simpler processes such as contact center related activities to a wider range of more complex business processes, including finance and accounting, research and analytics
and industry-specific solutions. Companies are also asking their BPM providers to deliver higher-value services, such as process re-engineering and transformation services, which increase competitive advantage and have an impact on revenues as well
as profits. In order to provide complex services and transformational capabilities, providers must increasingly leverage technology platform solutions, analytics and industry-specific knowledge to deliver improved business processes and business
outcomes. These companies are also asking for more flexible business models that align the interests of the provider with those of the company. Transaction and outcome-based engagements are two examples of such models. Many companies are outsourcing
to offshore locations such as China, India and the Philippines to access a large, high quality and cost-effective workforce. They are also outsourcing to nearshore and onshore locations across the globe to mitigate risks and to take advantage of
language capabilities and cultural alignment. We are a leading global provider in the BPM industry and believe that we are well-positioned to benefit from these outsourcing trends with our blend of onshore, nearshore and offshore delivery
capabilities.
The global business process management industry is a large and growing industry. According to the Gartner Report, the worldwide BPO market
is estimated to have grown to $150.393 billion in 2014. Gartner has estimated that the revenue for the worldwide BPO market will grow from $150.393 billion in 2014 to $194.193 billion in 2019 at a compounded annual growth rate of 5.25% (compounded
annual growth rate calculated by WNS Global).
33
The following chart sets forth the estimated growth in revenue generated from worldwide BPO services:
Chart created by WNS Global based on Gartner research.
Source: Gartner, Inc., Forecast: IT Services, Worldwide, 2013-2019, 1Q15 Update. Dated: 16 March 2015.
Business process management typically requires a long-term strategic commitment for companies. The processes that companies outsource frequently are complex
in nature, and tightly integrated with their core operations. These processes require a high degree of customization and, often, a multi-stage outsource transfer program. Companies therefore would incur high switching and other costs to transfer
these processes back to their internal operations or to other business process outsourcing providers, whether onshore or offshore. As a result, once a business process outsourcing provider gains the confidence of a client, the resulting business
relationship usually is characterized by multi-year contracts with predictable annual revenue.
Given the long-term, strategic nature of these
engagements, companies undertake a rigorous process in evaluating their business process management provider. Based on our experience, a client typically seeks several key attributes in a business process management provider, including:
|
|
|
Domain knowledge and industry-specific expertise; |
|
|
|
Process expertise across horizontal service offerings; |
|
|
|
Ability to innovate, add new operational expertise and drive down costs; |
|
|
|
Demonstrated ability to execute a diverse range of mission-critical and often complex business processes; |
|
|
|
Analytical capabilities to deliver actionable business insights; |
|
|
|
Technology-enabled services and solutions; |
|
|
|
Global presence via onshore, nearshore and offshore delivery centers; |
|
|
|
Capability to scale employees and infrastructure without a diminution in quality of service; and |
|
|
|
Established reputation and industry leadership. |
As the business process management industry evolves further,
we believe that industry-specific knowledge, higher-value process expertise, analytical capabilities, technology-enabled solutions, a global delivery platform, scale, reputation and leadership will become increasingly important factors in this
selection process.
34
We believe that non-linear pricing models which allow BPM providers to price their services based on volume of
transactions processed or the value delivered to companies will replace, in certain engagements, pricing models that are primarily based on headcount (often referred to as full-time equivalents, or FTEs), as companies look to align revenues and
costs by paying for the value delivered to them rather than the efforts deployed to provide the services to them. Non-linear pricing models therefore create the incentive for BPM providers to improve the productivity of their employees, increase the
use of technology and improve the overall efficiency of their operations.
Competitive Strengths
We believe that we have the competitive strengths necessary to maintain and enhance our position as a leading global provider of BPM services:
Well positioned for the evolving BPM market
The
BPM industry, which started with the first wave of outsourced processes, such as contact center customer service activities, has now expanded to include higher-value services that involve process re-engineering, management of mission-critical
operations and business transformation. We believe that as companies have become more experienced with outsourcing, they generally look to outsource an increasing number of processes and to outsource increasingly complex and more industry-specific
processes. We believe that our industry-specific expertise, comprehensive portfolio of complex services, transformation capabilities, technology-enabled solutions and customer-centric approach position us at the forefront of the evolving BPM market.
In addition, as companies increasingly look to diverse global delivery locations for their BPM services to mitigate risk and leverage language capabilities and cultural alignment, we believe we are well positioned to benefit from this trend with our
blend of onshore, nearshore and offshore delivery capabilities.
Deep industry expertise
We have established deep expertise in the industries we target as a result of our legacy client relationships, acquisitions and the hiring of management with
specific industry knowledge. We have developed methodologies, proprietary knowledge and industry-specific technology platforms applicable to our target industries that allow us to provide industry-focused solutions and be more responsive to customer
needs within these industries.
In addition, we have organized our company into business units aligned along each of the industries on which we focus. By
doing so, we are able to approach clients in each of our target industries with a combined sales, marketing and delivery effort that leverages our in-depth industry knowledge and industry-specific technology platforms.
For example, in our insurance vertical, we have specialized expertise in multiple insurance sub-sectors including property and casualty, auto and life. We
offer various insurance-specific processes such as premium and policy administration, claims management, actuarial services and underwriting.
We have
received numerous recognitions for our industry leadership. Our 2015 and 2014 awards and recognitions are set forth below:
General:
|
|
|
Skoch Order-of-Merit at the 38th Skoch Summit recognizing WNS best practices in the fields of governance, finance, banking, technology, corporate citizenship, economics and inclusive growth |
|
|
|
Asia Pacific Entrepreneurship Award under the Outstanding Category for sustainable leadership and continuous innovation presented to our Group CEO, Keshav R. Murugesh |
35
Insurance:
|
|
|
Everest Groups 2014 Insurance BPO PEAK Matrix Positioned as a Leader |
|
|
|
NelsonHall NEAT Assessment for Property and Casualty BPO in overall category in the Automotive Sector Ranked as a Leader |
|
|
|
NelsonHall NEAT Rankings for Property and Casualty Insurance BPO in the Automotive Sector Ranked as a Leader in Claims Focus, E2E Auto BPO, Reducing Customer Churn and Upping the Underwriter
|
Finance and Accounting:
|
|
|
Gartner 2014 Magic Quadrant for Finance and Accounting BPO Positioned in the Leaders Quadrant |
|
|
|
HfS Research Recognized as a High Performer in Progressive Finance and Accounting BPO Services in 2015 |
|
|
|
Everest Groups 2014 Finance and Accounting Outsourcing Service Provider Landscape with PEAK MatrixTM Assessment Positioned as a Major
Contender |
|
|
|
Everest Groups 2014 Record-to-Report BPO Service Provider Landscape with PEAK MatrixTM Assessment Positioned as a Major Contender
|
|
|
|
Everest Groups 2014 Order-to-Cash BPO Service Provider Landscape with PEAK MatrixTM Assessment Positioned as a Major Contender
|
Banking and Financial Services:
|
|
|
NelsonHall NEAT Rankings 2015 for overall Mortgage and Loan Ranked as a Leader |
|
|
|
NelsonHall NEAT Rankings 2015 for Mortgage and Loan Servicing BPO Ranked as a Leader in Mortgage Loan Secondary Market Services, Mortgage Loan Origination, Mortgage Loan Default Management and
Mortgage Loan Servicing BPO |
|
|
|
Everest Groups PEAK MatrixTM Assessment 2014 for Banking Service Provider Landscape Positioned as a Major Contender |
|
|
|
Everest Groups PEAK MatrixTM Assessment 2015 for Capital Markets Service Provider Landscape Positioned as a Major Contender
|
Customer Care:
|
|
|
Everest Groups Contact Center Outsourcing for the Banking, Financial Services and Insurances Industry Service Provider Landscape with PEAK MatrixTM
Assessment 2014 Positioned as a Major Contender |
|
|
|
Everest Groups Contact Center Outsourcing Market for the Healthcare Industry Service Provider Landscape with PEAK MatrixTM Assessment 2014
Positioned as a Major Contender |
Procurement and Supply Chain:
|
|
|
Everest Groups Procurement Outsourcing Service Provider Landscape for Europe with PEAK MatrixTM Assessment 2015 Positioned as a Major
Contender |
Analytics:
|
|
|
Everest Groups Analytics Business Process Services Service Provider Landscape with PEAK MatrixTM Assessment 2015 Positioned as a Major
Contender |
36
HRO:
|
|
|
People Matters Talent Acquisition Leadership League Award 2014 Best in Recruitment Re-engineering in recognition of WNS talent acquisition best practices |
Technology:
|
|
|
International Business Awards 2014 (8th Annual Stevie Awards) Gold for Best New Product or Service of the Year- Software Web Services Solution for
ProGenieSM |
|
|
|
International Business Awards 2014 (8th Annual Stevie Awards) Bronze for Best New Product or Service of the Year- Software Big Data Solution for WNS
Analytics Decision Engine (WADE)SM |
|
|
|
Data Security Council of India Excellence Award for Security in BPM Large |
|
|
|
Winner at the National Case Study Competition Service Track in Operational Excellence in Insurance in IndiZEN 2015, organized by Kaizen Institute India |
Quality:
|
|
|
National Institute for Quality and Reliability Lean Six-Sigma Case Study Presentation Platinum Award - Insurance sector for Improved Fraud Conversion rate and Silver Award Travel sector for Improved
Transactional Quality |
Learning and Development:
|
|
|
The American Society for Training & Developments BEST Learning and Development Award Domain University |
|
|
|
Shared Services & Outsourcing Networks Excellence Award 2014 Winner in Talent Management & Leadership Development Category |
|
|
|
Shared Services & Outsourcing Networks Excellence Award 2014 Runner-up Award in Culture Creation Category |
Corporate Social Responsibility:
|
|
|
The Golden Peacock Global Award for Corporate Social Responsibility, 2015 |
|
|
|
The Chief Marketing Officer Asia Outsourcing Excellence Award for Corporate Social Responsibility and Excellence in Culture Creation |
|
|
|
International Business Awards 2014 (8th Annual Stevie Awards) Bronze Corporate Social Responsibility Program of the Year (Asia, Australia and New
Zealand) for the WNS Cares Foundation |
37
Comprehensive portfolio of complex services, higher-value transformational services and technology-enabled
solutions
We seek to focus our service portfolio on more complex processes and solutions, and to evolve away from reliance on services that are
less integral to our clients operations, such as commoditized voice services (telemarketing and technical helpdesks), which characterized the business process outsourcing industry in its early days. We offer higher-value services such as
finance and accounting services, research and analytics services, transformation services and technology-enabled solutions, which are designed to help our clients to improve operating efficiency and leverage large amounts of information to help make
their businesses more competitive. We also provide industry-specific solutions which cut across these traditional horizontal services. These solutions are designed to help clients address process efficiency requirements and provide
business insights specific to their industry.
We have also developed and continue to develop technology-enabled, or automated, solutions that
utilize our proprietary software and licensed software in conjunction with our core business process management services. These integrated, technology-enabled solutions allow us to offer higher value, differentiated services which are more scalable
and repeatable and create value for our clients through increased process efficiency and quality. We also collaborate with technology companies, combining their software platforms and expertise with our service capabilities to deliver business
solutions to the marketplace. We believe these technology-enabled automated solutions will enable us to grow our revenue in a non-linear way by decoupling revenue growth from headcount growth.
For example, we offer various technology-enabled platforms as part of our broad suite of transformation services that also includes Consulting and Program
Management Services, Process and Quality Services and Technology Services. For a large North American airline, we utilized our VerifareSM platform to streamline the airlines revenue recovery
process and ensure compliance with industry rules and regulations as well as the airlines own internal policies and procedures, which enabled the airline to increase the amount of revenue recovered by auditing fares, taxes and commission
reported or claimed by travel agents.
Proven global delivery platform
We deliver our services from 37 delivery centers around the world, located in China, Costa Rica, India, the Philippines, Poland, Romania, South Africa,
Sri Lanka, the UK and the US. Our ability to offer services delivered from onshore, nearshore and offshore locations, benefits our clients by providing them with high-quality services from scalable, efficient and cost-effective locations based on
their requirements and process needs. It also provides our clients with the benefits of language capabilities, cultural alignment and risk mitigation in their outsourcing programs.
We believe the breadth of our delivery capability allows us to meet our clients needs, diversifies our workforce and allows us to access local talent
pools around the world.
Our client-centric focus
We have a client-centric engagement model that leverages our industry-specific and shared-services expertise, flexible pricing models,
client-partner relationship approach, as well as our global delivery platform to offer business solutions designed to meet our clients specific needs.
We have sought to enhance our value proposition to our clients by providing them with more flexible pricing models that align our objectives with those of our
clients. In addition to traditional headcount-based pricing, we provide alternative pricing models such as transaction-based pricing and outcome-based pricing. These models enable our clients to pay only for actual work performed or tangible benefit
received.
We have also adopted a client-centric sales model, which is tightly integrated with our vertical organizational structure. Strategic client
accounts are assigned a dedicated client partner from our team who is responsible for managing the day-to-day relationship. The client partner is typically a seasoned resource with deep domain experience, who works directly from the clients
local offices. Within our company, the client partner is aligned with a specific vertical, and directly manages sales resources responsible for expanding client relationships (farmers). The client partner is responsible for driving business value to
our clients, ensuring quality of delivery and customer satisfaction, and managing account growth and profitability.
We believe our ability to provide
highly relevant solutions, alternative pricing models, a client-centric approach and a global delivery platform gives our clients the capabilities they seek from their outsourcing partner. As a result, we have built long-standing relationships with
large multinational companies.
38
Experience in transferring processes offshore and running them efficiently
Many of the business processes that our clients outsource to us are critical and core to their operations, requiring substantial program management expertise.
Our methodical program management methodology is designed to ensure smooth transfer of business processes from our clients facilities to our delivery centers. Our experienced program management team has transferred approximately 700 business
processes for our clients globally. The toolkit used to effect such transfer of business processes is continuously upgraded with our learnings and experiences from various transitions.
We focus on delivering our client processes effectively on an ongoing basis. We have a robust quality management system and we have maintained continual
compliance with International Standard Organization, or ISO, 9001:2008 and ISO 27001 standards. We apply Lean Six Sigma methodologies, which are methodologies that combine Six Sigma, a methodology designed to improve consistency across processes,
and Lean, which is an engineering methodology to further improve our process delivery. We invest in training and development to equip our employees with Lean Six Sigma knowledge and skills, and encourage them to identify key opportunity areas within
different processes and drive operational excellence.
We also continually seek feedback from our customers at regular intervals. We carry out annual
surveys of our customers through which suggestions are invited for improvements along with ratings on specific parameters. Such ratings provide unfiltered customer feedback that helps us assess our performance and maintain focus on our clients
key expectations.
Extensive investment in human capital development
We have established the WNS Learning Academy, which provides ongoing training to our employees for the purpose of continuously improving their leadership and
professional skills. This includes the provision of extensive training infrastructure, such as training rooms, mobile application-based learning systems and in-house learning programs, which help impart key professional skills and industry-specific
knowledge to our employees. We seek to promote our team leaders and operations managers from within, thereby offering internal advancement opportunities and clear long-term career paths.
As part of their development, we have launched programs for our front line managers and top employees to help them improve their performance in their current
roles and to develop new skill sets to enable them to take on new roles. These programs include our business intervention programs Beyond Horizon, Inspire, TransforME, Empower and Evolve
which are all programs that are designed to identify promising employees at various levels of the organization and to provide them with the skills to grow and eventually step into senior leadership roles.
We have put in place our New Leadership Competency framework, which serves as a tool to help leaders measure the skill sets and behavioral patterns required
by them and their teams to excel in the current and future roles.
In addition, we create individual development plans for our top talent based on inputs
from our line managers and business units heads to help further their career development.
Our aim is to develop a truly global team, invest in
high-growth opportunities and increase our employees sales effectiveness in farming and hunting while leveraging on technology to create a learning organization.
Experienced management team
We benefit from the
effective leadership of a global management team with diverse backgrounds including extensive experience in outsourcing. Members of our executive and senior management team have, on average, over 20 years of experience in diverse industries,
including in the business process and information technology outsourcing sector, and in the course of their respective careers have gathered experience in developing long-standing client relationships, launching practices in new geographies,
developing new service offerings and successfully integrating acquisitions.
39
Business Strategy
Our objective is to strengthen our position as a leading global business process management provider. To achieve this, we will seek to increase our client
base, expand our existing relationships, further develop our industry expertise, enhance our value proposition to our clients, develop new business services, leverage analytics to create actionable insights, enhance our brand, develop
technology-enabled services and solutions, expand our global delivery platform and make selective acquisitions.
We have made significant investments to
accelerate our growth. These investments include:
|
|
|
The expansion and reorganization of our sales force; |
|
|
|
An increase in the expertise and management capability within our sales force; |
|
|
|
The expansion of other sales channels including the development of new partnerships and alliances and broadening our engagement with outsourcing industry advisors and analysts; |
|
|
|
An increase in the range of services and solutions offered to our clients across different industries and business functions; |
|
|
|
The establishment of our Capability Creation Group to facilitate the creation of new client offerings and automation of solutions; |
|
|
|
An increase in the amount of technology in our service offerings including the development of new technology-enabled solutions; and |
|
|
|
The expansion of our global delivery platform. |
The key elements of our growth strategy are described below.
Increase business from existing clients and add business from new clients
We have organized our company into vertical business units to focus on each of the industries that we target and to more effectively manage our clients
business processes and to offer customized solutions designed to solve their business challenges. Our sales force of 69 members as at March 31, 2015, provides broad sales coverage and management experience. Our sales force is organized
into two groups, one focused primarily on expanding existing client relationships (farmers) and another focused on seeking new clients (hunters).
We seek
to expand our relationships with existing clients by identifying additional processes that can be transferred to our global delivery centers, cross-selling new services, adding technology-based offerings, utilizing analytics to create actionable
insights, and expanding into other lines of business and geographies within each client. Our account managers and client partners have industry-specific knowledge and expertise and are responsible for maintaining a thorough understanding of our
clients outsourcing roadmaps as well as identifying and advocating new outsourcing opportunities. As a result of this strategy, we have built a strong track record of extending the scope of our client relationships over time.
For new clients, we seek to provide value-added solutions by leveraging our deep industry knowledge, process expertise, technology-enablement, analytics
capabilities and transformation solutions. As a result of our capabilities and industry vertical go-to-market approach, we have been able to compete effectively for new opportunities as they arise.
Reinforce leadership in existing industries
Through our industry-focused operating model, we have established leading business process management practices in various industries and business sectors. We
intend to leverage our knowledge of the insurance; travel and leisure; diversified businesses including manufacturing, retail, CPG, media and entertainment, and telecom; and banking and financial services industries, with additional focus on the
consulting and professional services; utilities; healthcare; shipping and logistics industries, as well as the public sector, to penetrate additional client opportunities within these industries. To complement our industry-focused approach, we
continue to invest in talent, analytics and technology platforms with the goal of expanding our business and acquiring industry specific expertise to improve our service offerings across industries.
40
Provide higher value added services
We enhance our value proposition to our clients by leveraging our industry-specific expertise; our portfolio of higher-value services such as our finance and
accounting services, research and analytics services, transformation services and technology-enabled solutions; and our flexible pricing models. We expect that as the BPM market matures, the demand for industry-specific services that enable deeper
penetration and for outcome based pricing models that are aligned to clients higher expectations of providers to increase. Accordingly, we have made significant investments in both of these areas which we expect to continue to give us a
competitive advantage. We intend to broaden the scope of our higher-value service offerings to capture new market opportunities. By delivering a wider portfolio of higher-value services to our clients and migrating them towards transaction or
outcome-based pricing models, we aim to increase the value of our solutions to our clients and enhance the strength, size and profitability of these relationships.
In January 2012, we established our Capability Creation Group, which is responsible for facilitating the creation of new industry leading solution
offerings, transformation methodologies and frameworks, and process reengineering offerings. These solution offerings include automation of manual processes, solving operational challenges and enhancing productivity and efficiencies for client
organizations. We intend to continue to expand on capability creation to drive process excellence, technology development, and new solutions and capabilities to address client needs.
Enhance awareness of the WNS brand name
Our
reputation for operational excellence and domain expertise among our clients has been instrumental in attracting and retaining new clients as well as talented and qualified employees. We believe we have benefited from strong word-of-mouth references
in the past to scale our business. However, as the size and complexity of the business process management market continue to grow, we are actively increasing our efforts to enhance awareness of the WNS brand in our target markets and among potential
employees. To accomplish this, we have established a dedicated global marketing team comprised of experienced industry talent. We are also focusing on developing channels to increase market awareness of the WNS brand, including participation in
industry events and conferences, exposure in industry publications, publication of articles and white papers, webinars and podcasts, internet and digital marketing techniques, and other initiatives that create enhanced visibility of the WNS brand
and establish WNS thought leadership in the BPM industry. In addition, we are aggressively targeting BPM industry analysts, sourcing advisors, general management consulting firms, and boutique outsourcing firms, who are often retained by
prospective clients to provide strategic advice, act as intermediaries in the sourcing processes, develop scope specifications, and aid in the partner selection process.
Expand our delivery capabilities
We currently
have 37 delivery centers located in ten countries around the world. In fiscal 2015, we expanded our delivery capacity by 813 seats or approximately 3.5% of our capacity at the end of fiscal 2014. We intend to expand our global delivery capability
through additional delivery centers in onshore, nearshore and offshore locations as well through collaborations with other providers. This approach will allow us to offer our clients maximum value and flexibility, as well as gain access to
potential clients and markets that may have specific delivery requirements or constraints.
Broaden industry expertise and enhance growth through
selective acquisitions and partnerships
Our acquisition strategy is focused on adding new service offerings, technology-enabled automation tools
and capabilities, and deeper industry expertise, as well as expanding our geographic delivery platform. Our acquisition track record demonstrates our ability to integrate, manage and develop the specific capabilities we acquire. Our intention is to
continue to pursue targeted acquisitions in the future and to rely on our integration capabilities to expand the growth of our business.
41
Business Process Management Service Offerings
We offer our services to clients through industry-focused business units. We are organized into the following vertical business units to provide more
specialized focus on each of these industries and more effectively manage our sales, marketing and delivery processes:
|
|
|
Diversified businesses including manufacturing, retail, CPG, media and entertainment, and telecom; |
|
|
|
Consulting and professional services; |
|
|
|
Banking and financial services; |
|
|
|
Shipping and logistics; and |
In addition to industry-specific services, we offer a range of services that are common across
multiple industries (which we refer to as our horizontal services), in the areas of customer care (or contact center), finance and accounting, human resource outsourcing, research and analytics, technology and legal services. In addition, our global
transformation practice offers higher-value services such as transformation services, which are designed to help our clients modify their business processes to enhance productivity, and manage changes in the business environment and leverage
business knowledge to increase market competitiveness. We help clients drive these initiatives with technology-enabled solutions, process re-design including quality initiatives such as Six Sigma or Lean, and business analytics.
To achieve in-depth understanding of our clients industries and the geographies in which they operate, we manage and conduct our sales processes in our
three key markets Europe, North America and Asia-Pacific. Our sales teams are led by senior professionals who focus on target industries, processes and clients. Each business unit is staffed by a dedicated team of managers and employees
engaged in providing business process management client solutions. In addition, each business unit draws upon common support services from our information technology, human resources, training, corporate communications, corporate finance, risk
management and legal departments, which we refer to as our corporate-enabling units.
Vertical Business Units:
Insurance
Our insurance services (actuarial and
non-actuarial) are structured into three lines of business offerings customized for property and casualty insurance, life and annuities and healthcare. We cater to a diverse and sizeable number of clients globally and have significant experience
across a broad range of insurance product lines.
The key insurance industry sectors we serve include:
|
|
|
Life, annuity and property and casualty insurers; |
|
|
|
Insurance brokers and loss assessors, property and casualty insurance providers, re-insurance brokers and motor insurance companies; |
|
|
|
Self-insured auto fleet owners; |
|
|
|
Commercial and retail banks; |
|
|
|
Mortgage banks and loan servicers; |
|
|
|
Asset managers and financial advisory service providers; and |
|
|
|
Healthcare payers, providers and device manufacturers. |
42
Our insurance business vertical includes our auto claims business, consisting of WNS Assistance and AHA, which
comprises our WNS Auto Claims BPM segment. We offer a technology-driven model that enables us to handle the entire automobile insurance claims cycle. We offer comprehensive repair management services to our clients where we arrange for the repair of
automobiles through a network of repair centers. We also offer claims management services where we process accident insurance claims for our clients. In addition, we provide third party claims handling services including the administration and
settlement of property and bodily injury claims while providing repair management and rehabilitation services to our insured and self-insured fleet clients and the end-customers of our insurance company clients. Our service for uninsured losses
focuses on recovering repair costs and legal expenses directly from negligent third parties. See Part I Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects Overview.
As at March 31, 2015, we had 6,401 employees working in this business unit. In fiscal 2015 and 2014, this business unit accounted for 35.7% and 36.7% of
our revenue and 31.8% and 32.5% of our revenue less repair payments, respectively.
The following graphic illustrates the key areas of services provided
to clients in this business unit:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Insurance Service Offerings |
Agency Services |
|
Policy Administration |
|
Investment Management |
|
New Business Support |
Licensing and contracting, correspondence, renewals, terminations, commissions, special compensation, abandoned properties, accounting |
|
Underwriting and underwriting support, policy issue, policy benefits, policy reinstatement and quotes, policy changes, inbound customer service, endorsements, renewals, pre-renewals/ expiry
premium, lapses, indexing and logging, specialist line, mid-term changes, motor insurance database updates |
|
Trade compliance, performance measurement, credit research, data management, real estate |
|
Sales, conversion, quote acceptance, cross-selling and up-selling, customer enquiries, exposure assessment, new business data entry, rules-based underwriting, policy issuance |
|
|
|
|
Premium Administration |
|
UK Motor Accident
Management Provision |
|
Claims |
|
Actuarial Services |
Fund applications, refunds, billing, premium mode changes, bank information changes, account reconciliation |
|
First notification of loss, repair management and engineering, liability handling, third-party capture, subrogation, non-fault claims management, claims handling process technology |
|
Claim set-up, examination, review, settlement, correspondence, tax compliance, first notification of loss, policyholders and broker claim inquiries, claim notification processing adjustment, endorsements and renewals, claim
assessment, negotiation and litigation, recovery check processing, third-party claims, subrogation, supplier payments, claims progression, bodily injury claims, delegated authority payments, claims bill payment, claims adjudication, manual claims
intervention, transfers and withdrawals, loss adjusting transcription |
|
Life actuarial services: financial reporting and measurement, actuarial systems support and actuarial technical support
Property and casualty services: product development, underwriting and pricing; claims
reserving; and marketing and claims analytics Solvency II services |
43
Proprietary Platform:
Proprietary platform designed to transform business processes ClaimProTM End-to-End Claims
Management software.
Case Study
Our client, a
leading insurance provider across life and pension, general and health insurance verticals, wanted a solution to the inefficiencies in its existing operations on account of fragmented processes spread across multiple locations, lack of standardized
documentation, the use of manual and paper-based processes, and multiple legacy systems.
Since the commencement of our engagement with the client, our
team has provided the following services to the client:
|
|
|
Transition of operations to a center of excellence, or CoE: Our team consolidated processes and transferred, in a phased manner, parts of the clients general insurance, life and pensions, and healthcare
operations, and half of the functions of the finance office from the clients UK and Ireland operations to CoE centers that we had established in India and Sri Lanka. |
|
|
|
Streamlining of management structure: Our team standardized and optimized the clients processes, cross-utilized staff and shared best practices across different lines of business, and implemented uniform
benchmarking techniques for use across the organization. |
|
|
|
Re-engineering of processes: Our team leveraged technology-enabled solutions to re-engineer processes. |
We have helped our client strengthen and improve its operational efficiencies and data management and reporting function. Specific benefits delivered to the
client included:
|
|
|
Providing actionable intelligence to internal business units based on insights from the CoE, which may be translated into profitable growth; |
|
|
|
Improved end-to-end accountability for business results and target transformation by jointly leveraging on our and clients own internal resources; and |
|
|
|
Improved process efficiencies through consolidation and standardization of processes and rationalization of platforms across the clients business. |
Travel and Leisure Services
We deliver end-to-end
services to clients across the travel and leisure industry value chain. We provide a wide range of scalable solutions that support air, car, hotel, marine and packaged travel and leisure services offered by our clients.
The key travel and leisure industry sectors we serve include:
|
|
|
Travel agencies, online travel agencies, tour operators and hospitality companies; |
|
|
|
Rental car companies and motor clubs; |
|
|
|
Hotels and cruise lines; and |
|
|
|
Global distribution systems providers. |
44
As at March 31, 2015, we had 6,453 employees in this business unit, several hundred of whom have
International Air Transport Association, Universal Federation of Travel Agents or other travel industry related certifications. In fiscal 2015 and 2014, this business unit accounted for 18.7% and 19.5% of our revenue and 19.8% and 20.8% of our
revenue less repair payments, respectively.
The following graphic illustrates the key areas of services provided to clients in this business unit:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Travel and LeisureService Offerings |
Sales and Customer Care |
|
Operations |
|
Platform-Based |
|
Shared Services |
Customer service, sales and reservations, loyalty program management, customer relations, lost baggage tracing and customer support, website navigation, specialty help desk |
|
Fare filing and loading, revenue management, fares and ticketing, queue processing, passenger name record servicing, cargo operations support |
|
VerifareSM Automated web-based fare audit solution
JADESM Passenger revenue accounting platform for airlines
SmartProSM Proration engine
driven by advanced analytics designed to help airlines make better revenue management decisions Booking information data tapes, or BIDT, audit and
analytics: Designed to help airlines understand their indirect distribution pattern and identify opportunities to reduce the cost of sale. Our BIDT audit service uses an in-house proprietary tool Q-Bay: Automated passenger name record queue solution
is a single platform that manages queues from multiple global distribution systems
RePAX: Flight disruption management tool, which is designed to minimize direct and indirect losses and improve passenger experience |
|
Passenger / cargo revenue accounting and auditing services, corporate finance and accounting, transactional accounting, human resource management, fraud prevention and control, analytics and management information systems, or
MIS |
45
Case Study
Our client, a leading European airline, decided to deliver passenger revenue accounting, or PRA, processes for both the airline itself and the carriers for
whom it was providing hosted revenue accounting services.
Our engagement with the airline began with a transfer of the PRA processes into one of our CoEs
for revenue accounting in India. Several of the initiatives we undertook to improve efficiency and reduce costs of the revenue accounting process included:
|
|
|
Ensuring a robust and seamless transition: By leveraging our proprietary, transition methodology, EnABLE, we effected the seamless transition of PRA processes. It was a complex transition given that the
airlines PRA operations encompassed approximately 90 legacy applications which were operated on two different revenue accounting systems, one used for the airlines PRA operations and the other used for the carriers for whom the airline
provided hosted PRA services. |
|
|
|
Enriching the knowledge repository tool: We enriched the knowledge repository tool by developing exhaustive documentation on the systems processes, best practices and tools, and made them easily accessible
to the team. |
|
|
|
Consolidating and re-engineering processes: We re-engineered and restructured the fare audit process to deliver enhanced revenue recovery and revenue protection to the airline. The processes were consolidated
across geographies including Europe, the Middle East and the US into our CoE. |
We have helped our client improve its efficiencies, by
reducing costs and improving the productivity of its PRA operations. Specific benefits delivered to the client included:
|
|
|
Identifying recoveries of revenue; |
|
|
|
Improving accuracy in interline sampling, resulting in significant revenue protection; |
|
|
|
Delivering improvement in turnaround time and managing a significant number of exception transactions, which refers to transactions that cannot be processed electronically due to non-automated ticketing by
certain airlines, for which the clients PRA process is insufficient; and |
|
|
|
Reducing the cost of revenue accounting operations. |
Diversified Businesses including Manufacturing,
Retail, Consumer Products, Media and Entertainment, and Telecom
We deliver comprehensive BPM services for diversified businesses including
manufacturing, retail, consumer products, media and entertainment, and telecom.
As at March 31, 2015, we had 4,150 employees in this business
unit. In fiscal 2015 and 2014, this business unit accounted for 14.0% and 14.4% of our revenue and 14.9% and 15.3% of our revenue less repair payments, respectively.
Manufacturing: Our manufacturing team has experience in delivering metrics-driven solutions and transformation programs for our manufacturing clients.
The key manufacturing sectors we serve include:
|
|
|
Electronics manufacturers; |
|
|
|
Metal and mining companies; |
|
|
|
Medical equipment manufacturers; |
|
|
|
Surgical equipment and vision care product manufacturers; |
|
|
|
Building and construction product manufacturers; and |
|
|
|
Automobile manufacturers. |
46
The following graphic illustrates the key areas of services provided to clients in this business unit:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
ManufacturingService Offerings |
Supply Chain Planning and Forecasting |
|
Fulfillment and Logistics |
|
Sales, Marketing and
Customer Services |
|
Sourcing and Procurement |
|
Shared Services |
|
Warranty and Returns
Management |
Sales and operations planning, demand forecasting, supply planning, inventory management, inventory analytics |
|
Order entry and processing, order tracking, billing / invoicing, transport management, logistics
optimization |
|
Global market opportunities, brand building, go to market strategy, customer services, telemarketing, order management, acquisition analysis, retention analysis |
|
Strategic sourcing, category management, contract management, spending analytics, transactional procurement |
|
Finance and accounting services, billing queries, marketing analytics support, billing support, debt collection, human resource services, customer care services |
|
Warranty customer operations, warranty claims management, parts / repair management, warranty financial management, returns management, customer helpdesk |
Retail and Consumer Products: Our retail and CPG team offers services that leverage on our proprietary tools and
methodologies that are designed to help our clients improve customer service, optimize marketing expenditures, reduce operational costs and streamline processes through efficiency, quality and productivity improvements.
The key retail and CPG companies we serve include:
|
|
|
Fast food chains and restaurants; |
|
|
|
Office products retailers; |
|
|
|
Cosmetics and healthcare companies; |
|
|
|
Specialty retailers; and |
To support our services, we use our proprietary research and analytics platform, WADESM, which was designed and developed to enable retail and CPG companies to access, organize and analyze data from various outside sources and use the information to take informed decisions.
47
The following graphic illustrates the key areas of services provided to clients in this business unit:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Retail and Consumer Packaged GoodsService
Offerings |
Strategy Solutions |
|
Customer Service Solutions |
|
Supply Chain Solutions |
|
Revenue Management
Solutions |
|
Global Back-office
Solution |
Market entry strategy, balancing portfolio investments, consumer and market insights, innovation strategies, power brand strategy, marketing spending optimization |
|
Omni-channel (phone, e-mail, fax, website, live chat, social media) customer relationship management |
|
Retailer-supplier collaboration for demand-driven supply chain and retail execution management, supply intelligence, supplier performance and risk monitoring, contract management. supply chain orchestration global trade
shared services, trading partner helpdesks, logistics |
|
Planning and execution of transaction and interaction-based campaign strategies, loyalty management, credit control and collections |
|
Simplified, shared global self-service organization model with local business partners for finance and accounting, human resources, or HR, IT, indirect procurement; end-to-end low cost shared services for transaction processes and
virtual centers of excellence, or CoEs. for specialized services (tax, internal audit, IT architecture) |
Media and Entertainment: Our media and entertainment team offers services that leverage our proprietary tools and
methodologies that are designed to help our clients create new revenue streams, capitalize on emerging digital opportunities, harness new-age consumers to their advantage and boost margins.
The key media and entertainment sectors we serve include:
|
|
|
Sports entertainment; and |
|
|
|
Internet and outdoor advertising firms. |
Our vertical approach to delivering outcomes, large team of domain
experts and award-winning proprietary research and analytics solution platform, WADESM, are at the core of the solutions we design for our clients in the media and entertainment space.
48
The following graphic illustrates the key areas of services provided to clients in this business unit:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Media and EntertainmentService Offerings |
Strategy Solutions |
|
Digital Operations and
Royalty Management
Solutions |
|
Sales, Marketing and
Distribution Solutions |
|
Customer Service Solutions |
|
Global Back-office Solutions |
Market entry strategy, balancing portfolio investments, consumer and market insights, innovation strategies, brand power strategy, marketing expense optimization |
|
Digital operations solutions to help companies successfully expand into the digital business.
Royalty management solutions to help clients manage rights and royalties in the new media
as well as the traditional media |
|
Seamless integration of traditional and digital product sales, marketing and distribution to enable client to roll out timely innovative pricing / packaging strategies |
|
Omni-channel (phone, e-mail, fax, website, live chat, social media) customer relationship management |
|
Simplified, shared global self-sufficient organization model with local business partners for finance and accounting, human resources, information technology and indirect procurement; end-to-end low cost shared services for
transaction processes and virtual Center of Excellence (CoE) for specialized services (tax, internal audit, IT architecture) |
Telecom: Our experience in consolidating and centralizing the functions of our telecommunications clients with built-in
variable capacity to meet business requirements helps us deliver business value. We offer analytics, optimization, domain and process expertise.
The
following graphic illustrates the key areas of services provided to clients in this business unit:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
TelecommunicationsService Offerings |
Customer Acquisition |
|
Order Provisioning and Order
Management |
|
Operations and Customer
Relationship Management
(CRM) |
|
Sales and Contracts Administration |
Order entry, order fulfillment, contract management, lead generation, outbound sales, sales analytics, cross-selling and up-selling analytics |
|
New products and services, service delivery process creation, order provisioning, technical validation and support, rejected order tracking, multi-vendor tracking, order tracking, proactive order management, test delivery
conformance, billing, data management (forms, administration) |
|
Inbound contact center, logging and monitoring service requests, directory publishing, churn analysis and support, usage analytics, CRM analytics, collection analytics, traffic routing planning, web correspondence, network
utilization reporting and analytics |
|
Inside sales, pricing and contract preparation, sales order taking, ordering support, inbound contact center |
49
Proprietary Platform:
Proprietary platform-based service offering: research and analytics solution platform WADESM.
Case Study
Our client, a leading electronics, media and
entertainment conglomerate with global operations in a number of geographies, engaged us to find solutions to its challenges such as fragmented processes spread across multiple locations and non-standardized and manual processes with extremely high
operational costs.
Since the commencement of our engagement with the client, our team has provided the following services to the client:
|
|
|
Establishment of CoE: Our team established a CoE with centralized project delivery from our India and Romania delivery centers. This reduced the clients organizational complexity, enabled economies of
scale, provided access to finance and accounting expertise, and embedded compliance and control processes. |
|
|
|
Process standardization: Our team unified the clients processes through a transition from country-specific processes to a process-specific structure. Our team also ensured process optimization through Lean
and Six Sigma methodologies. |
|
|
|
Technology enablement: Our team implemented technologies such as Systems, Applications, Products in data processing (SAP), supplier relationship management and Concur (a travel management technology that provides
travel and expense management services to businesses), leading to reduced query resolution and payment time, and automation of disputes and overall process. |
|
|
|
Establishment of a multi-lingual helpdesk: Our team helped the client with language translation services across 15 languages for cost optimization. |
|
|
|
Establishment of a lean legal structure: Our team established a lean and simplified legal structure designed to ensure standardization and compliance across territories. |
|
|
|
Adherence to a strong purchase order policy: Our team implemented a strong procurement policy whereby payments were not disbursed until the receipt of a purchase order. |
We helped our client to simplify its business operations and reduce operational costs. Specific benefits delivered to the client included:
|
|
|
Embedded compliance and control processes; |
|
|
|
Accounts prioritization for key customer countries and rigor on collections resulted in reduction in collectable accounts receivable amounts; and |
|
|
|
Achieved substantially all of the clients documented goals in terms of certain services we provided, including services related to procure-to-pay, order-to-cash, record-to-report, procurement
and Sarbanes-Oxley compliance. |
50
Consulting and Professional Services
Our consulting and professional services, or CPS, business unit has a strong India presence coupled with global delivery capabilities, which allows us to serve
a diverse and large global client base.
Our CPS business unit offers a range of services to a range of client sectors in consulting and professional
services. These sectors include:
|
|
|
Information service providers; |
|
|
|
Marketing service providers; |
|
|
|
Real estate service firms; |
|
|
|
Executive search firms; |
|
|
|
Research and consulting firms; and |
As at March 31, 2015, we had 1,585 employees in the business unit. In fiscal 2015
and 2014, this business unit accounted for 7.4% and 6.8% of our revenue and 7.9% and 7.2% revenue less repair payments, respectively.
We provide a wide
range of services from complex business and financial research and analytics, to very simple data management operations. Besides providing shared services support to our clients such as finance and accounting, human resource management, customer
support and IT helpdesk, We provide the following domain specific services:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Consulting and Professional ServicesService
Offerings |
Information Service Providers |
|
Research and Consulting Firms |
|
Real Estate Services Firms |
|
Executive Search Firms |
Content sourcing, management and analysis; production management digital and print; new product creation |
|
Sales and marketing-pitch book support, research and analytics support for consulting, and research support, including report writing |
|
Strategy support, sales and marketing support, survey management support, end-to-end conveyancing process, and contract management |
|
Pitch book support, industry and company research, database clean-up, update and management, name identification, business executive support |
|
|
|
|
|
Market Research Firms |
|
Market Service Providers |
|
Legal Services Firms |
End-to-end research operations support research design, project management, survey programming, data collection, coding, data processing, data analytics, and presentation |
|
Industry, company and product research support, market research operations, market research analytics, shopper and CRM analytics, advertising / digital analytics, data management and insights, content management (website and
creative support) |
|
Legal support, business research, pitch support, directory / award submission |
51
Case Study
Our client, a leading retail consulting firm engaged in providing customer data analysis, wanted to establish an offshore hub to assist its onshore team in
campaign management, data management and reporting jobs using analytics platforms and applications such as Statistical Analysis System, or SAS, Visual Basic for Applications, or VBA, and Structured Query Language, or SQL. Our client also wanted to
encourage global efficiencies and best practices by the offshore hub, which challenged the clients existing business culture.
Since the
commencement of our engagement with the client, our team has provided the following services to the client:
|
|
|
Data and campaign management: Our team targets, segments, executes and evaluates promotional campaigns using SAS and SQL. We also manage campaign statistics and report and analyze the return on investment of
the campaign. |
|
|
|
Data solutions management: Our team manages weekly data loads on our clients scheduler tools, running customized IT applications and SAS to enhance efficiency. |
|
|
|
Insights reporting: Our team uses third party tools to analyze and understand segment response and consumer behavior, and identify opportunities to improve campaign effectiveness. |
|
|
|
Digital media: Our digital media team provides support on content generation through photo imaging and graphics software. |
|
|
|
Market research: Our team conducts market research projects from our Mumbai office. |
Through our
processes we have delivered the following benefits to our client:
|
|
|
An increase in the number of error-free deliveries; and |
|
|
|
Improvements in efficiency and productivity, creating increased headroom in its onshore team. |
Healthcare
We deliver end-to-end BPM services
across the healthcare industry value chain. We offer health information management, or HIM, coding (including current procedural technology, or CPT, and ICD-9 codes for international statistical classification of diseases and related health
problems), Medicare and medical claim processing, revenue management related processes and Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act, or HIPAA, compliance.
The healthcare industry segments we serve include:
|
|
|
Durable medical equipment manufacturers; |
|
|
|
Third party billing service providers; |
|
|
|
Third party administrators; |
|
|
|
Payers and providers of pharmaceutical products; |
|
|
|
Providers for utilization management and case management services; and |
|
|
|
Providers of workers compensation, medical management and disability solutions. |
As at March 31, 2015, we
had 1,635 employees in this business unit. In fiscal 2015 and 2014, this business unit accounted for 5.2% and 5.1% of our revenue and 5.6% and 5.4% of our revenue less repair payments, respectively.
52
The following graphic illustrates the key areas of services provided to client segments in this business unit:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
HealthcareService Offerings |
Providers |
|
Payer |
|
Durable Medical Equipment Manufacturers |
|
Enterprise Shared Services |
|
Pharmaceutical and
Consumer Health |
Revenue cycle management, medical coding, bill preparation, receivables management, payment posting, debt analysis |
|
Claims administration, member and provider services, clinical support, overpayment recovery, fraud detection and investigation |
|
Billing and submissions, fulfillment support, collections, patient services, collection analytics |
|
Finance and accounting, workflow / platforms, research and analytics (knowledge process outsourcing), technology solutions, front-end / mailroom, contact center |
|
Competitive intelligence, pipeline analysis, product profiling, key performance indicators or KPI reporting, epidemiology analysis, market opportunity assessment, social media analysis |
Case Study
Our client,
one of the global leaders in specialty home medical equipment, designs and manufactures high-end and specialty medical devices that require verification of insurance benefits and pre-authorization of complex medical claims. The client wanted to
improve cash flows by optimizing its revenue cycle and selected us to provide sales order processing and support and healthcare billing and collection from insurance carriers and patients.
Since the commencement of our engagement with the client, our team has provided the following services to the client:
|
|
|
Alignment of outcome: Our team implemented a system of risk-based rewards and penalties to align our team with our clients outcomes. |
|
|
|
Capacity augmentation: Our team implemented processes which have helped to improve productivity and increase the clients capacity. |
|
|
|
Claims management: Our team used specific analytics to help the client identify and prioritize claims with a greater likelihood of being paid. |
|
|
|
Quality monitoring systems: Our team created systems to help the client monitor and improve its process quality and capabilities. |
Through our efforts, we improved our clients revenue cycle operations, which in turn led to an increase in collections, an acceleration of cash flow and
an improvement in customer service. Specific benefits delivered to the client included:
|
|
|
Improvement in the order-to-bill process and development of modifications with enhanced collection speed using Six Sigma tools and IT enhancements; |
|
|
|
Establishment of an analytics-driven collections strategy that has led to an increase in collections; |
|
|
|
Dashboards that created significant visibility into detailed lead indicators and drivers; and |
|
|
|
Reduction in costs associated with billing. |
Banking and Financial Services
We provide a broad range of business operation services for the banking and financial services industry.
We aim to add value to our clients businesses by improving their customer satisfaction, unlocking cost efficiencies and streamlining processes through
technology optimization.
The key banking and financial sectors we serve include:
|
|
|
Consumer, retail and commercial banking and mortgage; |
53
|
|
|
Wealth, investment management and investment banking; |
|
|
|
Research and analytics services; |
|
|
|
Credit cards, capital markets and asset management; |
|
|
|
Financial advisory firms; and |
|
|
|
Financial research and financial market intelligence companies. |
As at March 31, 2015, we had 2,142
employees working in this business unit. In fiscal 2015 and 2014, this business unit accounted for 5.8% and 6.5% of our revenue and 6.1% and 7.0% of our revenue less repair payments, respectively.
The following graphic illustrates the key areas of services provided to clients in this business unit:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Banking and Financial ServicesService
Offerings |
Retail Banking |
|
Commercial Banking |
|
Capital Markets |
|
Mortgage Banking |
Acquisition: lead generation and deployment, customer behavioral analysis, campaign management, product development/management and
support On-boarding: application scanning and indexing, account opening, product application processing, detailed documentation review and verification,
underwriting/spend limit assignment, welcome calls Maintenance and servicing : account maintenance, account and general enquiries, customer data
maintenance, statement generation, payment processing, funds allocation and return payment processing, complaint handling, funds transfers, remittance, refunds and settlements, billing queries and statement processing
Collections: collections and recovery, ship tracking, pre-delinquency management, payment plans |
|
Trade finance: account opening, bills for collection, export bills negotiation, import bills, letter of credit processing, bank guarantees
credit limits Credit risk management: financial spreading, proposal development, reconciliation, credit analysis, collateral management, renewal support,
billing and contribution management, audit support Cash management: funds transfer, trade processing, reconciliations, accrual calculations,
investigations, payment processing, settlement, reference data management, reporting Commercial Lending: account opening, know your customer,
loan onboarding, documentation, covenant monitoring, billing, statutory accounting Treasury services: cash management, foreign exchange settlements, bill
discounting, rates updates, mark to market, margin allocation |
|
Front office: financial and business research, investment strategy and modeling, order entry, allocation/rebalancing
Middle office: reference data management, cash flow forecasting, risk management, amendments/maintenance of existing data, manual trade allocations, manual
trade booking, trade exception/rejection management, trade amendment, trade confirmation, queries handling Back office Accounting: expense and
income processing, securities lending, corporate actions processing, fund accounting/net asset value calculations, financial reporting, settlement follow-up with clients
Back office Asset servicing: clearing and settlement, custody/record keeping, stock transfer, collateral management, transfer agency, claims
management Back office Treasury: cash management, cash forecasting, payment processing, invoicing/billing processing |
|
Originations: indexing, pre-underwriting checklist, pre-funding audit, correspondent indexing, title commitment, credit evaluation, contact
point verification, disbursals Servicing: customer service, loan boarding and set-up, adjustable rate mortgage audit, payments processing, assignments and
endorsements, lien release, escrow management/periodic analysis, final documents follow up and audit Default servicing: pre-loss mitigation, foreclosure
support, borrower research, operations intake, claims processing, investor reporting, closing and monitoring functions, trial period monitoring (forbearance support), loan modification document preparation
Secondary markets services: post close audit, due diligence of acquired packets, documentary fulfillment |
54
The following graphic illustrates our research and analytics practice focused on banking and financial services.
Case Study
Our client
is a regional US bank dealing in loans and credits, mortgages, investments and insurance. The client engaged us to provide solutions for challenges such as fragmented processes spread across multiple locations, lack of standardization, paper and
imaging dependency for record keeping and other processes, lack of access to reliable and thorough analytics due to resource constraints, regulatory and compliance challenges, and a lack of monitoring of third party provider performance under
service level agreements.
Since the commencement of our engagement with the client, our team has provided the following services to the client:
|
|
|
Underwriting support CoE: Our team established a CoE to consolidate fragmented processes and set up operations spread across 24 hours a day and three shifts |
|
|
|
Transition methodology: Our team implemented our proprietary transition methodology, EnABLE, for robust documentation and parallel transition of multiple processes to the CoE. |
|
|
|
Consolidation and automation: Our team consolidated disparate processes and implemented automation across certain processes. |
|
|
|
Standardization of processes: Our team implemented standardization across numerous operations including mortgage, lending, default servicing, retail banking, and research and analytics operations.
|
|
|
|
Diagnostics roadmap: Our team implemented an organization-wide diagnostics roadmap comprising more than 2,000 employees to create a detailed 18-month agenda for transitioning certain services offshore.
|
55
Through our processes we have delivered the following benefits to our client:
|
|
|
Consolidation and automation of processes which led to cost savings and productivity gains; |
|
|
|
A more effective cost model through conversion from fixed to variable pricing for certain managed processes, flexible staffing and reduced transition costs; |
|
|
|
Created a sustainable offshore business model; and |
|
|
|
Improved efficiencies and consistency of results through standardization of processes. |
Utilities
Our utilities team offers end-to-end solutions, which utilize our technology platforms and sophisticated analytical tools that allow utilities
companies to transform their operations and thereby gain a competitive edge in the market place.
The key energy and utilities industry sectors we serve
include:
As at March 31, 2015, we had 2,834 employees working in this business unit. In fiscal
2015 and 2014, this business unit accounted for 9.5% and 7.8% of our revenue, and 10.1% and 8.3% of our revenue less repair payments, respectively.
The
following graphic illustrates the key areas of services provided to clients in this business unit:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
UtilitiesService Offerings |
Sales Management |
|
Customer Financial
Management |
|
Meter Operations and
Billing |
|
Supply Chain and
Distribution Management |
|
Customer Service
Management |
Campaign management, sales management, account and contact management, integrated sales planning and analysis |
|
Receivables and collections management, reconciliation, bill disputes and clients queries |
|
Customer billing, management of prepaid accounts, billing of unmetered services |
|
Order provisioning and order management, sales and contract administration, technical support help desk, import and export documentation management, freight bill auditing services, procurement support services |
|
Service order management, service contract, complaints and requests management, electronic customer services, account management, contract management |
56
Case Study
Our client, a leading gas and electricity provider in the UK and the US, wanted to fuel its growth by improving its customer service levels and increase
customer satisfaction while reducing its operational costs.
Since the commencement of our engagement with the client, our team has provided the following
services to the client:
|
|
|
Customer care process management: Our team handled customer care processes including interacting with the clients customers through e-mail, physical mail and telephone calls and helped the customer cope
with increased customer interactions. |
|
|
|
Customer management system: Our team also managed billing exceptions to ensure correct bills were generated for the client. |
|
|
|
Process management: Our team helped the client implement its first SAP® platform and developed guidelines to enhance process management. |
Through our processes we have delivered the following benefits to our client:
|
|
|
Reduction in customer complaints; |
|
|
|
Increased customer satisfaction; and |
|
|
|
Improved debt recovery rates through transformation of the tariff and measurement system. |
Shipping and
Logistics
We deliver a range of industry-specific business processes across the shipping and logistics industry, as well as provide services in
the areas of finance and accounting, customer care, business technology, procurement and human resources administration. We also offer decision support services in the form of research and analytics. To support our shipping and logistics team, we
use our proprietary consumer information system platform, which aids various customer services such as account management, billing support and analytics.
The key shipping and logistics industry sectors we serve include:
|
|
|
Global courier companies; |
|
|
|
Non-vessel operating common carriers and forwarders; |
|
|
|
Ocean carriers; including container ships, bulk carriers and tankers; |
|
|
|
Trucking rental, including less than truck load and full truck load rental and trucking records management companies; and |
57
As at March 31, 2015, we had 1,583 employees working in this business unit. In fiscal 2015 and 2014, this
business unit accounted for 3.4% and 2.9% of our revenue, and 3.6% and 3.1% of our revenue less repair payments, respectively.
The following graphic
illustrates the key areas of services provided to clients in this business unit:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Shipping and Logistics Service Offerings |
Sales and Trade
Management |
|
Customer Service |
|
Documentation |
|
Operations |
|
Finance |
Tariff update, rate quotes, global tender management, sales reports and analytics, freight bookings, yield analysis, service contract and rate agreement maintenance, CRM analytics |
|
Customer help desk, e-commerce registration, service or rate enquiries, pre-advice and arrival notifications, cargo claims, booking desk, contact center, customer and data file administrator |
|
Bill of lading and airway bill management, freight corrections and reporting, billing and invoicing, freight audit, data transmission, advance manifest information, customs and port compliance |
|
Purchase order creation, driver logs and fuel tickets, global tracking, equipment control, terminal operations, trans-shipment and cross docking, schedule maintenance, routing creation and maintenance, stowage planning,
hazardous cargo approvals |
|
Accounts payable, accounts receivable, credit and collections, vendor help desk, detention and demurrage reporting, cost reporting, audit and vendor reconciliation, general ledger or bank reconciliation, management
reporting |
Case Study
Our client, a
leading global air express and courier company, wanted to standardize its finance and accounting function, specifically those relating to its Ship-to-Collect process across the Europe, Middle East and Africa region.
Since the commencement of our engagement with the client, our team has provided the following services to the client:
|
|
|
Bill manifesting: Our team handled manifesting of airway bills, indexing and classification of supporting documents. |
|
|
|
Billing: Our team manually rectified errors and released airway bills to generate freight, duties and taxes for invoices that fail the auto-billing process. |
|
|
|
Invoice adjustment: Our team handled the resolution of billing disputes as well as making necessary adjustments to billing entries. |
|
|
|
Cash application: Our team matched payments received to open invoices and investigated sources for unapplied cash. |
|
|
|
Accounts Payable: Our team also scrutinized and processed invoices for payment. |
Through our processes
we have delivered the following benefits to our client:
|
|
|
Increased invoicing accuracy levels; |
|
|
|
Improved turnaround time for billing of consignments; |
|
|
|
Reduced unapplied cash; and |
|
|
|
Reduced cost of operations. |
58
Horizontal Units
Contact Center
We have a strong track record of
supporting customer care functions while focusing on business outcomes. To increase customer loyalty and satisfaction, we offer tailor-made customer care solutions by leveraging our industry-specific expertise, sophisticated technology and analytics
supported by a strong talent pool. Contact center services are offered across our vertical business units.
As at March 31, 2015, we had 8,883
employees in this horizontal unit. In fiscal 2015 and 2014, this horizontal unit accounted for 22.5% and 23.6% of our revenue, and 23.9% and 25.2% of our revenue less repair payments, respectively.
The following graphic illustrates the key contact center services we provide:
|
|
|
|
|
Contact CenterService Offerings |
Services |
|
Channels |
|
Languages |
Customer acquisition, customer retention, customer service, sales and support (cross-sell or up-sell), loyalty program management, collections, technical help desk, specialty help desk, contact center analytics |
|
Voice (inbound / outbound), e-mail, physical mail, chat, social media, SMS, fax |
|
English, French, Italian, Russian, Spanish, Portuguese, German, Hungarian, Greek, Turkish, Finnish, Dutch, Polish, Swedish, Mandarin, Cantonese, Japanese, Korean, Arabic, and more than 20 regional languages |
Case Study
Our client, a
leading global travel company, was undergoing significant growth and engaged us to help manage its increasing volume of customer inquiries that was critical to its growth.
Since the commencement of our engagement with the client, our team has provided the following services to the client:
|
|
|
Delivered actionable insights using third party tools to collect and analyze customer data. |
|
|
|
Build customer segmentation and identified variables across the different behavior dimensions. |
|
|
|
Built revenue and cost estimation models to better predict propensity of success in campaigns. |
|
|
|
Delivered process efficiencies to better manage larger volumes of customer inquiries. |
|
|
|
Managed seasonality through our technology-led workforce optimization. |
|
|
|
Multichannel customer support through voice, e-mail, social media. |
|
|
|
Improved measurement and reporting of key cost metrics. |
Through our processes we have delivered the following
benefits to our client:
|
|
|
Reduced operational costs through increased cost efficiencies as a result of reduced average handling time and increased call volumes being handled per agent; |
|
|
|
Increased sales conversion rate; |
|
|
|
Increased workforce optimization; and |
|
|
|
Improved sales campaign effectiveness. |
59
Finance and Accounting
Our finance and accounting service offerings include standardization of finance and accounting processes and transformation of finance operations. Finance
and accounting services are offered across our vertical business units.
We have experience in delivering large scale and complex finance and accounting
transformation programs, which include:
|
|
|
Rapid, large scale transitions; |
|
|
|
Implementation of shared service centers and rationalization of financial systems to optimize and consolidate our clients information technology platforms; |
|
|
|
Multi-location, multi-system global finance and accounting consolidation; |
|
|
|
End-to-end processes ranging from simple, transaction-based processes to high-end, judgment-based processes, such as analytics and treasury; |
|
|
|
Enhanced procure to pay services including spend analytics, contract management, catalog (demand management) and global procurement; |
|
|
|
Global risk and compliance services such as forensics, background screening and digital credit screening; and |
|
|
|
Process maturity model which allows for objective assessment of processes, technology and people using performance benchmarks which are customized for the industry and size of the company. |
As at March 31, 2015, we had 4,025 employees in this horizontal unit. In fiscal 2015 and 2014, this horizontal unit accounted for 20.0% and 18.6% of our
revenue, and 21.2% and 19.8% of our revenue less repair payments, respectively.
The following graphic illustrates the key finance and accounting services
we provide:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Finance and AccountingService Offerings |
Procure-to-Pay |
|
Order-to-Cash |
|
Record-to-Report |
|
Decision Support |
|
Corporate Functions |
Sourcing services, procurement and administration, invoice / expense processing and payment, accounts payables |
|
Accounts receivables, billing and cash application, order management, credit control, collections |
|
General accounting, fixed assets, reconciliations, month-end reporting and consolidation, tax filing and reporting, cost accounting, inter-company accounting, statutory reporting |
|
Budgeting, forecasting, variance analysis, management reporting |
|
Treasury, cash management, financial planning and analysis, tax and compliance, decision support, management accounting |
60
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Supply Chain
Finance |
|
Industry-specific
Accounting |
|
Technology Solutions |
|
Governance, Risk, Compliance and
Audit Services |
Product costing, inventory accounting, manufacturing accounting |
|
Passenger revenue accounting, revenue audit and recovery, claims management, loan account maintenance, royalty accounting, fiduciary accounting, trip records, freight and fuel charges accounting, cost accounting, franchise
accounting, meter reading, pre-payment billing |
|
Enterprise resource planning (ERP) implementation, hosting, optimization
Bolt-on tools reconciliations, reporting, workbench, query management, web
portal Enablers mailroom solution, workflow |
|
Governance consulting, risk analytics services, compliance services and audit services |
Proprietary Platform:
|
|
|
Proprietary platform-based service offering: Xponential The ERP Card SolutionTM, a part of our BizAps Procure to Pay (P2P) Solutions brand umbrella.
|
Case Study
Our client, one of the
leading global travel leisure groups, was facing concerns while transitioning its processes to another outsourcing provider. The client also wanted to reduce operating costs, increase customer satisfaction, automate processes and implement
comprehensive documentation.
Since the commencement of our engagement with the client, our team has provided the following services to the client:
|
|
|
Leveraged transition best practices and created a tripartite governance model for real-time monitoring. |
|
|
|
Implemented more stringent payment policies across all geographies and business units and deployed the tools for work flow and case management. |
|
|
|
Implemented processes benchmarking to identify opportunities for incremental benefits. |
|
|
|
Shared opportunities for automation such as robotic process automation, dashboards and close management tools. |
Through our processes we have delivered the following benefits to our client:
|
|
|
Delivered and identified incremental savings; and |
|
|
|
Increased customer satisfaction. |
61
Research and Analytics
We leverage our research and analytics expertise in tandem with our rich industry domain knowledge to help companies better understand their data and enable
them to make insight-based business decisions. Data driven analytics can allow our clients to reduce risk, understand consumers better, increase operational effectiveness and keep abreast with the changing market landscape, which can help to reduce
costs and enhance their customers experience.
We offer a range of services including data enrichment (harmonization, consolidation and
visualization), domain based advanced analytics, market research, business and financial research across different industry verticals.
As at
March 31, 2015, we had 2,183 employees in this horizontal unit. In fiscal 2015 and 2014, this horizontal unit accounted for 12.5% and 11.4% of our revenue, and 13.2% and 12.1% of our revenue less repair payments, respectively.
The following graphic illustrates the key research and analytics services we provide:
|
|
|
|
|
Research and AnalyticsService Offerings |
Customer Analytics |
|
Marketing Analytics |
|
Supply Chain and Procurement |
Acquisition / retention analytics, loyalty analytics, customer segmentation, campaign analytics, fraud analytics, customer life time value, cross-sell/up-sell analytics |
|
Product launch support and analysis, country clustering, category analysis, brand equity tracking, brand and consumer insights, pricing analytics and revenue management |
|
Spend analytics, demand forecasting, inventory optimization, supplier capability profiling, profitability modeling |
|
|
|
Digital Analytics |
|
Data Services |
|
Research |
Social media analytics, web analytics, text mining |
|
Data acquisition, data cleansing and aggregation, data stitching and analysis, data visualization, reports and dashboards |
|
Market research: survey programming, computer-assisted telephone interviews and web surveys, data processing Business research: company / industry / country research, market sizing and entry strategies, documentation services,
library services Financial research: credit research, equity research, mergers and acquisitions research, fixed income research |
|
|
|
Big Data Analytics |
|
HR Analytics |
|
Operations Analytics |
Big Data consulting, Big Data implementation, Big Data support and maintenance |
|
Workforce analytics, employee attrition analytics, compensation analytics, learning analytics |
|
Contact center performance tracking, KPI analysis and reporting /dashboard, optimal capacity utilization and scheduling, forecasting and capacity planning, cross-sell/up-sell campaign strategies, interactive voice response (IVR)
optimization, speech and text analytics, customer satisfaction (CSAT) analysis, enterprise wide scheduling (EWS) |
Proprietary Platform:
|
|
|
Proprietary platform-based service offering: research and analytics solution platform WADESM. |
|
|
|
Proprietary platform for customer interaction on websites: ProGenieSM. |
62
Case Study
Our client, one of the largest online travel agencies in the world, providing travel products and services to customers through websites and contact centers,
was experiencing a decline in revenues and market share due to a mismatch in its focus on the online channel and its actual consumer distribution pattern which was more geared towards the offline channel. The client engaged with us to develop a
robust offline strategy and to devise a roadmap to bridge the gap.
Since the commencement of our engagement with the client, our team has provided the
following services to the client:
|
|
|
Identified the offline channel as an additional revenue stream. |
|
|
|
Conducted a thorough customer segmentation and analysis based on cross-sell and up-sell product and services data, customer profitability and customer life time value models. |
|
|
|
Performed an in-depth evaluation of the performance of offline sales agents to select the right agents to be deployed for the project. |
|
|
|
Optimize staffing of the best agents at peak intervals to maximize sales. |
|
|
|
Make changes to the clients interactive voice response (IVR) system to enhance productivity and direct convertible customers to the sales agents. |
|
|
|
Devised a separate strategy for managing the least profitable set of customers (bottom quartile management). |
Through our processes we have delivered the following benefits to our client:
|
|
|
Increase in offline revenues; and |
|
|
|
Enhanced sales conversion rate. |
Technology Services
Our technology services team offers a suite of end-to-end services designed to help our clients to identify business and process optimization opportunities and
leverage our industry and process expertise, technology solutions and analytics capabilities. Technology services are offered across our vertical business units.
As at March 31, 2015, we had 182 employees in this horizontal unit. In fiscal 2015 and 2014, this horizontal unit accounted for 1.2% and 1.4% of our
revenue, and 1.3% and 1.5% of our revenue less repair payments, respectively.
63
The following graphic illustrates the key technology services we provide:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Technology ServicesService Offerings |
Enterprise Solution / ERP
Optimization |
|
Application
Development,
Maintenance and Support |
|
Business Process
Management |
|
Business Intelligence
and Analytical
Solutions |
|
Infrastructure and Network
Services |
Consult, implement and optimize ERP solutions, solution selection, design and architecture, functional and technical consulting, process design and re-engineering, configuration, customization and implementation, interface design,
development and implementation, enterprise platform integration and optimization, ERP training, ERP upgrades |
|
J2EE, NET and legacy systems application development-maintenance support, custom software design, development, testing, package configuration, integration, customization and implementation, software upgrades, maintenance and
support, training and end-user support |
|
Mailroom management, scanning and imaging solutions, Optical Character Recognition (OCR) solutions, customized workflow solutions |
|
Analytical model definition and implementation, configuration, customization and implementation of Executive Information System solutions using online analytical processing, or OLAP, tools, Interface development, extraction
-transformation-loading and data cleansing, OLAP and report generation |
|
IT infrastructure and process design and re-engineering, network and remote infrastructure management, managed services and hosting, IT support and helpdesk |
Legal Services
Our legal process outsourcing solutions team provides organizations access to a high quality talent pool of legal professionals, a global delivery model and
deep domain expertise.
We aim to help our clients reduce the costs of their legal processes and, more importantly, allow their associates to focus on
spending more time with their clients, thereby creating greater value for their organization.
As at March 31, 2015, we had 155 employees in this
horizontal unit. In fiscal 2015 and 2014, this horizontal unit accounted for 0.7% and 0.7% of our revenue and 0.7% and 0.7% of our revenue less repair payments, respectively.
The following graphic illustrates the key legal services we provide:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Legal ServicesService Offerings |
Property Law |
|
Law Firm Back-office |
|
Corporate Legal Support |
|
Personal Injury Claims |
Freehold and leasehold conveyancing, mortgage re-financing legal processing, title checking services, home information pack, or HIP, back-office |
|
Digital dictation transcription, accounts payables and general ledger, employee data management and payroll |
|
Contract management, legal research, litigation support, legal secretarial support |
|
New claims processing, medical evidence evaluation, claims settlement and closing |
64
Human Resource Outsourcing
We support organizations in meeting their human resources objectives through comprehensive service offerings for human resources-related functions. Our
solutions enable clients to overcome challenges such as managing the high cost of human resources operations, improving compliance with quality parameters, handling routine human resources activities that require significant manual intervention and
managing disparate legacy human resources systems. Human resources outsourcing services are offered across our vertical business units. This horizontal unit was established in fiscal 2013.
As at March 31, 2015, we had 71 employees in this horizontal unit. In fiscal 2015 and 2014, this horizontal unit accounted for 0.2% and 0.2% of our
revenue, and 0.2% and 0.2% of our revenue less repair payments, respectively.
The following graphic illustrates the key human resources outsourcing
services we provide:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Human Resources OutsourcingService Offerings |
HR Analytics |
|
Recruitment Process |
|
Payroll |
|
Employee Data Management |
Hiring and retention, performance management, compensation and benefits, information management, workforce development, training and development, vendor management |
|
Manpower planning, external and job portal advertisements, internal job posting, campus recruitment program, CV management, application tracking management, end-to-end sourcing, offer management, vendor management, background and
reference checks, orientation management, pre-on-boarding support and management |
|
Pre-payroll processing (build to gross), payroll processing (gross to net), post payroll processing, vendor management |
|
Transactions processing, vendor management |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Travel Services |
|
Learning and Performance
Management |
|
Compensation and Benefits |
Travel helpdesk services, booking and reservations, mobility, visa services, invoicing, cancellations, transportation, accommodation |
|
Administration, development, delivery, vendor management |
|
Rewards and recognition, benefits enrollment, benefits calculation, compliance reporting, industry benchmarking, salary structure and administration, pensions administration, vendor management |
Case Study
Our client,
one of the leading manufacturers of semiconductor systems, wanted to automate and bring efficiencies into its manual and non-standardized HR processes.
Since the commencement of our engagement with the client, our team has provided the following services to the client:
|
|
|
Helped implement an ERP platform for end-to-end HR processes including hiring, payroll, claims, appraisal, training and vacation. |
|
|
|
Helped re-engineer and transform processes for improved ERP implementation. |
65
Through our processes we have delivered the following benefits to our client:
|
|
|
Improved productivity gains driven by an increase in volume of processes transacted on the ERP platform by our clients employees; and |
|
|
|
Reduced operational costs. |
Sales and Marketing
The sales cycle for business process management services can be time consuming and complex in nature. The extended sales cycle generally includes initiating
client contact, submitting requests for information and requests for proposals for client business, hosting client visits to our delivery centers, performing analysis including diagnostic studies and conducting pilot implementations to demonstrate
our delivery capabilities. Due to the complex nature of the sales cycle, we have aligned our sales teams to our vertical business units and staffed them with hunting, or new sales, professionals, as well as farming, or client relationship,
professionals. Our hunters and farmers have specialized industry knowledge and experience, which enable them to better understand prospective and existing clients business needs and to offer appropriate domain-specific solutions.
Our sales and sales support professionals are based in Australia, Dubai, Eastern Europe, India, Singapore, South Africa, the UK and the US. Our sales teams
work closely with our sales support team in India, which provides critical analytical support throughout the sales cycle. Other key functions provided by our India sales support team include generating leads for potential business opportunities and
telephone sales support. As of March 31, 2015, our front-line sales teams consisted of 69 members including hunters and farmers. Our front-line sales teams are responsible for identifying and initiating discussions with prospective clients, and
selling services in new areas to existing clients. We assign dedicated client partners and / or account managers to our key clients. These managers work with their clients daily at the client locations. They also are the conduit to our service
delivery teams addressing clients needs. More importantly, by leveraging their detailed understanding of the clients business and outsourcing objectives gained through this close interaction, our existing clients and account managers
actively identify and target additional processes that can be outsourced to us. Through this methodology, we have developed a strong track record of increasing our sales to existing clients over time.
Clients
As at March 31, 2015, we had a diverse
client base of 292 clients across a variety of industries and process types, including companies that we believe are among the leading players in their respective industries.
We believe the diversity in our client profile differentiates us from our competitors. See Part I Item 5. Operating and Financial
Review and Prospects Revenue for additional information on our client base.
The table below sets forth the number of our clients by revenue
less repair payments for the periods indicated. We believe that the large number of clients who generate more than $1 million of annual revenue less repair payments indicates our ability to extend the depth of our relationships with existing clients
over time.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
Below $1.0 million |
|
|
209 |
|
|
|
196 |
|
$1.0 million to $5.0 million |
|
|
57 |
|
|
|
48 |
|
$5.0 million to $10.0 million |
|
|
15 |
|
|
|
12 |
|
More than $10.0 million |
|
|
11 |
|
|
|
10 |
|
66
Competition
Competition in the business process management services industry is intense and growing steadily. See Part I Item 3. Key Information
D. Risk Factors Risks Related to Our Business We face competition from onshore and offshore business process management companies and from information technology companies that also offer business process management services. Our
clients may also choose to run their business processes themselves, either in their home countries or through captive units located offshore.
We
compete primarily with:
|
|
|
Focused business process management service companies based in offshore locations (primarily India), such as EXL Service Holdings, Inc., Firstsource Solutions Limited and Genpact Limited; |
|
|
|
Business process management divisions of numerous information technology service companies operating out of India such as Cognizant Technology Solutions, Infosys Technologies Limited, Tata Consultancy Services Limited
and Wipro Technologies Limited; and |
|
|
|
Global companies such as Accenture Limited., Affiliated Computer Services Inc., Electronic Data Systems Corporation, a division of Hewlett-Packard, and International Business Machines Corporation which provide an array
of products and services, including broad-based information technology, software, consulting and business process outsourcing services. |
In
addition, departments of certain companies may choose to perform their business processes in-house, in some cases via an owned and operated facility in an offshore location such as India. Their employees provide these services as part of their
regular business operations.
Intellectual Property
We use a combination of our clients software systems, third party software platforms and systems and our own proprietary software and platforms to
provide our services. Our proprietary and licensed software allows us to market our services with an integrated solution that combines a technology platform with our core business process management service offerings. Our principal proprietary
software includes our passenger revenue accounting platform and fare audit platform, which we use in our travel and leisure business unit, and auto claims software platform, which we use in WNS Assistance. In addition, we use our proprietary
software to optimize our clients finance and accounting processes. These include solutions for:
|
|
|
Approval of documents such as invoices and requisitions; |
|
|
|
Maintaining master data, such as vendor and customer data; |
|
|
|
Vendor and customer communication; |
|
|
|
Purchasing card expense management; and |
We customarily enter into licensing and non-disclosure agreements with our clients with
respect to the use of their software systems and platforms. Our client contracts usually provide that all customized intellectual property created specifically for the use of our clients will be assigned to them.
Our employees are also required to sign confidentiality agreements as a condition to their employment. These agreements include confidentiality undertakings
regarding our companys and the clients intellectual property that bind our employees even after they cease to work with us. These agreements also ensure that all intellectual property created or developed by our employees in the
course of their employment is assigned to us.
We have registered the trademark WNS and WNS-Extending Your Enterprise in most of
the countries where we have global presence.
67
Technology
We have a dedicated team of technology experts who support clients at every stage of their engagement with us. The team designs, executes and supports
technology solutions to enable delivery of business processes for our customers.
Wide-area-network We have designed and built a global
multi-protocol label switching, or MPLS, network, connecting all of our delivery centers to points of presence in the US and UK through diverse service providers and cable systems to ensure redundancy. We run both data and voice service on this
global MPLS network to serve customers.
Contact Center Technology Infrastructure We have deployed the Avaya Aura platform at all of our
contact centers for delivering voice processes. The platform is designed to provide secure access to define call flow, vectoring, and skill-based call routing as needed.
Data centers Our global datacenter is over 25,000 square feet in size, and hosts data for our clients and internal corporate applications.
Technology service management methodology We have designed and deployed diverse data and voice connectivity solutions for more than 200 clients
using our industry standard infrastructure, experienced solution design/project management/operations teams and robust delivery methodology.
Process
and Quality Assurance and Risk Management
Our process and quality assurance compliance programs are critical for the success of our operations. We
have an independent quality team to monitor, analyze, and provide feedback and report process performance and compliance. Our company-wide quality management system focuses on effectively managing our client processes on an ongoing basis. Our
process delivery is managed by independent empowered teams and is measured regularly against pre-defined operational metrics. We have over 800 employees in our quality assurance team which help us meet ISO 9001:2008 standards for quality management
systems and to ensure continued compliance. We apply Lean Six Sigma methodologies, which are statistical and process-focused methodologies to improve and deliver consistent quality across processes. We apply well-defined quality management
principles to improve and provide consistent levels of service quality to our clients. In fiscal 2015, more than 300 different projects were completed using Lean Six Sigma methodologies and over 400 projects are in progress.
We have been honored with the following awards for our achievements in the last three years:
|
|
|
Golden Peacock Global Business Excellence Award, 2013; |
|
|
|
Medici Hall of Fame for Innovation, 2013; |
|
|
|
Lean Six Sigma Award in ITES Category, NIQR- 2014; |
|
|
|
National Case Study- Service Track, IndiZEN 2015; and |
|
|
|
Golden Peacock Global Business Excellence Award, 2015. |
Our Board of Directors is primarily responsible for
overseeing our risk management processes. The Board of Directors receives and reviews reports from the Head of Risk Management and Audit as considered appropriate regarding our companys assessment of risks. The Board of Directors focuses on
the most significant risks facing our company and our companys general risk management strategy, and also ensures that risks undertaken by our company are consistent with the Boards appetite for risk.
Our risk management framework also focuses on three important elements: business continuity planning, information security and operations risk management.
Our approach to business continuity planning involves implementation of an organization-wide business continuity management framework which includes
continual self-assessment, strategy formulation, execution and review. Our business continuity strategy leverages our expanding network of delivery centers for operational and technological risk mitigation in the event of a disaster. To manage our
business continuity planning program, we employ a dedicated team of experienced professionals. A customized business continuity strategy is developed for key clients, depending on their specific requirements. For mission-critical processes,
operations are typically split across multiple delivery centers in accordance with client-approved customized business continuity plans.
68
Our approach to information security involves implementation of an organization-wide information security
management system, which complies with the ISO 27001:2013 to manage organizational information security risks. These measures seek to ensure that sensitive company information remains secure. Currently, information security systems at 31 delivery
centers are ISO 27001:2013 certified, and we expect to seek similar certifications in our newer delivery centers. We also comply with the Payment Card Industry Data Security Standard (PCI DSS) which is a security standard aimed at helping companies
proactively protect cardholder data and sensitive authentication data. In addition, we also undergo Statement on Standards for Attestation Engagements (SSAE) No. 16 / International Standard on Assurance Engagements (ISAE) No. 3402,
Reporting on Controls at a Service Organization (SOC) 1 Type 2 audits with respect to our general control environment supporting operational delivery in accordance with ISAE on an annual basis. We also undergo Reporting on Controls
at a Service Organization (SOC) 2 Type 2 audits with respect to security, availability and confidentiality.
Our approach to operations risk
management involves the implementation of a three lines of defense framework for our clients offshored business processes. Under this framework, the quality assurance teams embedded within the business units act as the first
line of defense, an independent and centralized risk management team acts as the second line of defense and client-end internal audit teams act as the third line of defense. Our lines of defense are designed to identify potential risks,
evaluate design efficiency and operating effectiveness of controls embedded within the offshored business processes and propose additional controls as appropriate for mitigation of the identified risks.
In addition, our clients may be governed by regulations specific to their industries or in the jurisdictions where they operate or where their customers are
domiciled which may require them to comply with certain process-specific requirements. As we serve a large number of clients globally and across various industries, we rely on our clients to identify the process-specific compliance requirements and
the measures that must be implemented in order to comply with their regulatory obligations. We assist our clients to maintain and enforce compliance in their business processes by implementing control and monitoring procedures and providing training
to our employees serving specific client programs. The control and monitoring procedures defined by this function are separate from and in addition to our periodic internal audits.
Human Capital
As at March 31, 2015, we had 28,890
employees, of which 9 are based in Australia, one is based in Brazil, 167 are based in China, 161 are based in Costa Rica, 21,736 are based in India, 2,699 are based in the Philippines, 109 are based in Poland, 408 are based in Romania, one is based
in Singapore, 2,330 are based in South Africa, 805 are based in Sri Lanka, two are based in United Arab Emirates, 261 are based in the UK and 201 are based in the US. Most of our associates hold university degrees. As at March 31, 2014 and
2013, we had 27,020 and 25,520 employees, respectively. Our employees are not unionized. We believe that our employee relations are good. We focus heavily on recruiting, training and retaining our employees.
Recruiting and Retention
We believe that talent
acquisition is an integral part our overall organizational strategy. We have developed effective human resource strategies and demonstrated a strong track record in recruitment specific to the needs of our business units to optimize the training and
development of our employees. As we continue to grow, we look to improve and enhance our candidate pool, which is sourced from recruitment agencies, job portals, advertisements, college campuses (where we focus on recruiting talented
individuals) and walk-in applications. In addition, a significant number of our applicants are referred to us by existing employees. We recruit an average of 1,333 employees per month.
During fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013, the attrition rate for our employees who had completed six months of employment with us was 34%, 33% and 35%, respectively.
Training and Development
We devote
significant resources to the training and development of our associates. Our training typically covers modules in leadership and client processes, including the functional aspects of client processes such as quality and transfer. Training for new
associates may also include behavioral and process training as well as cultural, voice and accent training, as required by our clients.
69
We have established the WNS Learning Academy, where we offer specialized skills development, such as leadership
and management development, and behavioral programs as well as pre-process training that includes voice and accent and customer service training, for new associates. The WNS Learning Academy is staffed with over 50 full-time trainers and content
designers. We customize our training programs according to the nature of the clients business, the country in which the client operates and the services the client requires. Further, the WNS Learning Academy has an in-house e-learning unit
which creates computer or web-based learning modules to support ongoing learning and development.
Since the launch of the WNS Learning Academy, we have
made significant efforts to improve the learning and development of our supervisory, management and leadership teams, which is visible through focused learning initiatives targeted at employees with specific job roles and based upon current and
future business competency requirements. Our learning initiatives include, among others, the following:
|
|
|
A five-day leadership program, implemented in 2008, with a 60-90 day action learning project focused on professional and leadership skills and process improvement for over 2,000 team leaders and managers;
|
|
|
|
Educational opportunities through tie-ups with leading institutions, such as the Indian Institute of Management and Symbiosis Institute of Business Management; |
|
|
|
Train the Trainer programs, in which master trainers visit our various locations to conduct training sessions; |
|
|
|
The ongoing expansion of our virtual domain university for each business unit, which we intend to serve as a one stop solution for domain knowledge; and |
|
|
|
Diversity and cross-cultural understanding training initiatives. |
Through these learning initiatives and
others, we are addressing developmental and functional needs at the junior management level, leadership and sales focus at the middle management level and business and strategic development at the senior leadership level. Our goal is to consolidate,
build and share intellectual property and business knowledge throughout our organization, which we believe will benefit us, as well as our clients, in the long run.
Further, in connection with our focus on institutionalizing talent identification, succession planning and talent development frameworks, the WNS Learning
Academy is involved with the design and implementation of talent development roadmaps that are designed to help us organically build leaders for the future and develop clear succession plans. We plan to achieve this through the design and roll-out
of customized individual development plans, as well as specialized training programs run for groups of employees at similar stages of career development or in similar roles, which we call clustered interventions.
In order to keep pace with the ever-changing global business environment, we recognize that there is a strong need to focus on consolidating, building and
sharing our domain knowledge. Hence, in fiscal 2015, we set up a virtual domain university for certain vertical business units such as finance and accounting, banking and financial services, travel, diversified businesses, and shipping and
logistics. The university serves as repository for domain knowledge that is accessible virtually by our employees. The university was established to assist us in retaining and building our domain knowledge for our business units, and we intend to
continue to expand its offerings to cover each of our business units. It is expected to benefit us as well as our clients in the long run. We have also launched 100 e-learning modules through a vendor partner, Skillsoft, providing our employees with
the opportunity of self-paced learning. These modules are accessible through our online learning management system.
Other Development Initiatives
Diversity and inclusion As we increase our global presence, we believe it is important to grow and foster an inclusive and diverse
business environment, and therefore we seek to equip our managers with the skills required to collaborate, manage and lead in a diverse global environment. Our learning and development team is proactively designing training materials related to
diversity and cross-cultural understanding in order to groom successful managers who have a global mindset and the necessary soft skills to function effectively in a diverse environment. We believe that skills such as good communication and cultural
adaptability and understanding are essential in the workplace. Therefore, we aim to instill in our global managers an awareness of, and an appreciation for, the differences among the cultures with which they do business and to provide them the
techniques and support they need to succeed.
70
Representatives of the learning and development team are also involved in feasibility studies for potential new
locations from a talent availability point of view. To improve our reach, we are increasingly deploying blended learning solutions via video-based and e-learning to reach our managers globally. We have also collaborated with an external e-learning
provider to assist in providing appropriate and relevant online training materials while keeping in mind our organizational goals. Our continued focus on e-learning has helped us in reducing costs associated with training as the costs associated
with online products on a per person, per hour basis, are significantly less than the costs associated with training in the physical classroom. We were recognized in 2013 as the Global L&D Team of the Year at the 5th TISS Leap Vault CLO Summit India and we received the Corporate University Best-in-Class (or CUBIC) Award.
Front line capability building As an individual advances within an organization, it is important that he or she adds the qualifications
and skills required to perform the role and responsibilities to which he or she is assigned. Our Learning Academy focuses on providing new managers the necessary tools to successfully make the transition from employee to business leader. In doing
so, our Learning Academy trains new managers on the technical and leadership skills necessary to manage people, understand key drivers of financial performance, provide good customer service and follow our business and shared best practices.
Regulations
Due to the industry and geographic diversity
of our operations and services, our operations are subject to a variety of rules and regulations, and several federal and state agencies in Australia, China, Costa Rica, India, Mauritius, the Netherlands, Romania, the Philippines, Poland,
Singapore, South Africa, Sri Lanka, United Arab Emirates, the UK and the US that regulate various aspects of our business. See Part I Item 3. Key Information D. Risk Factors Risks Related to our Business
Failure to adhere to the regulations that govern our business could result in us being unable to effectively perform our services. Failure to adhere to regulations that govern our clients businesses could result in breaches of contract with
our clients. We have benefitted from, and continue to benefit from, certain tax holidays and exemptions in various jurisdictions in which we have operations.
In fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013, our tax rate in India and Sri Lanka impacted our effective tax rate. We would have incurred approximately $3.0 million, $1.7
million and $0.8 million in additional income tax expense on our operations in Sri Lanka and on our SEZ operations in India for fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively, if the tax holidays or exemptions as described below had not been available for
the respective periods.
We expect our tax rate in India and Sri Lanka and, to a lesser extent, the Philippines to continue to impact our effective tax
rate. Our tax rate in India have been impacted by the reduction in the tax exemption enjoyed by our delivery center located in Gurgaon under the SEZ scheme from 100.0% to 50.0% which started in fiscal 2013. However, we expect to expand the
operations in our delivery centers located in other SEZs that are still in their initial five years of operations and therefore eligible for 100.0% income tax exemption.
India
In the past, the majority of our Indian
operations were eligible to claim income tax exemption with respect to profits earned from export revenue from operating units registered under the STPI. The benefit was available for a period of 10 years from the date of commencement of
operations, but not beyond March 31, 2011. Effective April 1, 2011, upon the expiration of this tax exemption, income derived from our operations in India became subject to the prevailing annual tax rate, which is currently 33.99%.
Further, in 2005, the Government of India implemented the SEZ legislation, with the effect that taxable income of new operations established in designated
SEZs may be eligible for a 15-year tax holiday scheme consisting of a complete tax holiday for the initial five years and a partial tax holiday for the subsequent ten years, subject to the satisfaction of certain capital investment conditions. Our
delivery center located in Gurgaon, India and registered under the SEZ scheme is eligible for a 50.0% income tax exemption from fiscal 2013 to fiscal 2022. During fiscal 2012, we also started operations in delivery centers in Pune, Mumbai and
Chennai, India registered under the SEZ scheme, through which we are eligible for a 100.0% income tax exemption until fiscal 2016 and a 50.0% income tax exemption from fiscal 2017 to fiscal 2026. During fiscal 2015, we commenced operations at
our new delivery centers in Gurgaon and Pune in India which were registered under the SEZ scheme and are eligible for a 100.0% income tax exemption until fiscal 2019, and a 50.0% income tax exemption from fiscal 2020 to fiscal 2029.
71
The SEZ legislation has been criticized on economic grounds by the International Monetary Fund and the SEZ
legislation may be challenged by certain non-governmental organizations. It is possible that, as a result of such political pressures, the procedure for obtaining benefits under the SEZ legislation may become more onerous, the types of land eligible
for SEZ status may be further restricted or the SEZ legislation may be amended or repealed. Moreover, there is continuing uncertainty as to the governmental and regulatory approvals required to establish operations in the SEZs or to qualify for the
tax benefit. This uncertainty may delay our establishment of additional operations in the SEZs.
In addition to these tax holidays, our Indian
subsidiaries are also entitled to certain benefits under relevant state legislation and regulations. These benefits include the preferential allotment of land in industrial areas developed by state agencies, incentives for captive power generation,
rebates and waivers in relation to payments for transfer of property and registration (including for purchase or lease of premises) and commercial usage of electricity.
Since fiscal 2008, we have become subject to minimum alternate tax, or MAT, and we have been required to pay additional taxes. The Government of India,
pursuant to the Indian Finance Act, 2011, has also levied MAT on the book profits earned by the SEZ units at the prevailing tax rate, which is currently 20.96%. To the extent MAT paid exceeds the actual tax payable on our taxable income we would be
able to offset such MAT credits from tax payable in the succeeding ten years, subject to the satisfaction of certain conditions. During fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013, we have offset $6.4 million, $5.7 million and $1.3 million, respectively, of our MAT
payments for earlier years from our increased tax liability based on our taxable income following the expiry of our tax holiday on STPI effective fiscal 2012.
The Government of India may enact new tax legislation that could impact the way we are taxed in the future. For example, the Government of India has clarified
that, with retrospective effect from April 1, 1962, any income accruing or arising directly or indirectly through the transfer of capital assets situated in India will be taxable in India. If any of our transactions are deemed to involve the
direct or indirect transfer of a capital asset located in India, such transactions could be investigated by the Indian tax authorities, which could lead to the issuance of tax assessment orders and a material increase in our tax liability. For
example, we received a request from the relevant income tax authority in India for information relating to our acquisition in July 2008 from Aviva of all the shares of Aviva Global, which owned subsidiaries with assets in India and Sri Lanka.
No allegation or demand for payment of additional tax relating to that transaction has been made yet. The Government of India has issued guidelines on General Anti Avoidance Rule, or the GAAR, which is currently expected to be effective
April 1, 2017, and which is intended to curb sophisticated tax avoidance. Under the GAAR, a business arrangement will be deemed an impermissible avoidance arrangement if the main purpose of the arrangement is to obtain tax benefits.
Although the full implications of the GAAR are presently still unclear, if we are deemed to have violated any of its provisions, we may face an increase to our tax liability. See Part I Item 3. Key Information D. Risk
Factors Risks Related to our Business New tax legislation and the results of actions by taxing authorities may have an adverse effect on our operations and our overall tax rate.
Sri Lanka
Our operations in Sri Lanka are also
eligible for tax exemptions. One of our Sri Lankan subsidiaries was eligible to claim income tax exemption with respect to profits earned from export revenue by our delivery center registered with the Board of Investments. This tax exemption expired
in fiscal 2011, however, effective fiscal 2012, the Government of Sri Lanka has exempted the profits earned from export revenue from tax. This has enabled our Sri Lankan subsidiary to continue to claim tax exemption under the Sri Lanka Inland
Revenue Act following the expiry of the tax exemption.
Philippines
Our subsidiary in the Philippines, WNS Global Services Philippines Inc., located in Eastwood Avenue, Manila was also eligible to claim income tax exemption
with respect to profits earned from export revenue by our delivery centers registered with the Philippines Economic Zone Authority, which expired in fiscal 2015 and we intend to apply for an extension until fiscal 2016, which is subject to
fulfillment of certain conditions. During fiscal 2013, we started operations in a delivery center in the Philippines located in Techno Plaza II, Manila which is also eligible for a tax exemption that will expire in fiscal 2017. Following the expiry
of the tax exemption, income generated by WNS Global Services Philippines, Inc. will be taxed at the prevailing special tax rate, which is currently 5.0% on gross income.
72
Costa Rica
Our subsidiary in Costa Rica is also eligible for a 100% income tax exemption from fiscal 2010 until fiscal 2017 and a 50.0% income tax exemption from fiscal
2018 to fiscal 2021.
See Part I Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects Critical Accounting Policies Income
Taxes.
Enforcement of Civil Liabilities
We
are incorporated in Jersey, Channel Islands. Most of our directors and executive officers reside outside of the US. Substantially all of the assets of these persons and substantially all of our assets are located outside the US. As a result, it may
not be possible for investors to effect service of process on these persons or us within the US, or to enforce against these persons or us, either inside or outside the US, a judgment obtained in a US court predicated upon the civil liability
provisions of the federal securities or other laws of the US or any state thereof. A judgment of a US court is not directly enforceable in Jersey, but constitutes a cause of action which will be enforced by Jersey courts provided that:
|
|
|
the court which pronounced the judgment has jurisdiction to entertain the case according to the principles recognized by Jersey law with reference to the jurisdiction of the US courts; |
|
|
|
the judgment is given on the merits and is final and conclusive it cannot be altered by the courts which pronounced it; |
|
|
|
there is payable pursuant to the judgment a sum of money, not being a sum payable in respect of tax or other charges of a like nature or in respect of a fine or other penalty; |
|
|
|
the courts of the US have jurisdiction in the circumstances of the case; |
|
|
|
the judgment can be enforced by execution in the jurisdiction in which the judgment is given; |
|
|
|
the person against whom the judgment is given does not benefit from immunity under the principles of public international law; |
|
|
|
there is no earlier judgment in another court between the same parties on the same issues as are dealt with in the judgment to be enforced; |
|
|
|
the judgment was not obtained by fraud, duress and was not based on a clear mistake of fact; and |
|
|
|
the recognition and enforcement of the judgment is not contrary to public policy in Jersey, including observance of the principles of natural justice which require that documents in the US proceeding were properly
served on the defendant and that the defendant was given the right to be heard and represented by counsel in a free and fair trial before an impartial tribunal. |
It is the policy of Jersey courts to award compensation for the loss or damage actually sustained by the person to whom the compensation is awarded. Although
the award of punitive damages is generally unknown to the Jersey legal system, there is no prohibition on them either by statute or by customary law. Whether a judgment is contrary to public policy depends on the facts of each case. Exorbitant,
unconscionable, or excessive awards will generally be contrary to public policy. Moreover, if a US court gives a judgment for multiple damages against a qualifying defendant, the Protection of Trading Interests Act 1980, an Act of the UK extended to
Jersey by the Protection of Trading Interests Act 1980 (Jersey) Order 1983, or the Order, provides that such judgment would not be enforceable in Jersey and the amount which may be payable by such defendant may be limited. The Order provides, among
others, that such qualifying defendant may be able to recover such amount paid by it as represents the excess of such multiple damages over the sum assessed as compensation by the court that gave the judgment. A qualifying defendant for
these purposes is a citizen of the UK and Colonies, a body corporate incorporated in the UK, Jersey or other territory for whose international relations the UK is responsible or a person carrying on business in Jersey.
73
Jersey courts cannot enter into the merits of the foreign judgment and cannot act as a court of appeal or review
over the foreign courts. It is doubtful whether an original action based on US federal securities laws can be brought before Jersey courts. A plaintiff who is not resident in Jersey may be required to provide security for costs in the event of
proceedings being initiated in Jersey. There is uncertainty as to whether the courts of Jersey would:
|
|
|
recognize or enforce judgments of US courts obtained against us or our directors or officers predicated upon the civil liability provisions of the securities laws of the US or any state in the US; or |
|
|
|
entertain original actions brought in each respective jurisdiction against us or our directors or officers predicated upon the federal securities laws of the US or any state in the US. |
In India, recognition and enforcement of foreign judgments is provided for under Section 13 and Section 44A of the Code of Civil Procedure, 1908
(India), or the Civil Code, as amended. Section 44A of the Civil Code provides that where a foreign judgment has been rendered by a superior court in any country or territory outside India which the Indian government has by notification
declared to be a reciprocating territory, such foreign judgment may be enforced in India by proceedings in execution as if the judgment had been rendered by a competent court in India. However, Section 44A of the Civil Code is applicable only
to monetary decrees not being in the nature of amounts payable in respect of taxes or other charges of a similar nature or in respect of fines or other penalties and does not include arbitration awards. The US has not been declared by the Indian
government to be a reciprocating territory for the purposes of Section 44A of the Civil Code. Accordingly, a judgment of a foreign court, which is not a court in a reciprocating territory, may be enforced in India only by a fresh suit
instituted in a court of India and not by proceedings in execution. Furthermore, the execution of the foreign decree under Section 44A of the Civil Code is also subject to the exception under Section 13 of the Civil Code, as discussed
below.
Section 13 of the Civil Code, states that a foreign judgment is conclusive as to any matter directly adjudicated upon except:
|
|
|
where the judgment has not been pronounced by a court of competent jurisdiction; |
|
|
|
where the judgment has not been given on the merits of the case; |
|
|
|
where it appears on the face of the proceedings that the judgment is founded on an incorrect view of international law or a refusal to recognize the law of India in cases where such law is applicable; |
|
|
|
where the proceedings in which the judgment was obtained were opposed to natural justice; |
|
|
|
where the judgment has been obtained by fraud; or |
|
|
|
where the judgment sustains a claim founded on a breach of any law in force in India. |
The suit must be
brought in India within three years from the date of the judgment in the same manner as any other suit filed to enforce a civil liability in India. It is unlikely that a court in India would award damages on the same basis as a foreign court if an
action is brought in India. Furthermore, it is unlikely that an Indian court would enforce foreign judgments if it viewed the amount of damages awarded as excessive or inconsistent with public policy in India. A party seeking to enforce a foreign
judgment in India is required to obtain prior approval from the Reserve Bank of India under the Indian Foreign Exchange Management Act, 1999, to repatriate any amount recovered pursuant to such execution and such amount may be subject to tax in
accordance with applicable laws. Any judgment in a foreign currency would be converted into Indian rupees on the date of judgment and not on the date of payment. We cannot predict whether a suit brought in a court in India will be disposed of in a
timely manner.
74
C. Organizational Structure
The following diagram illustrates our companys organizational structure and the place of organization of each of our subsidiaries as of the date hereof.
Unless otherwise indicated, each of our subsidiaries is wholly owned, directly or indirectly, by WNS (Holdings) Limited.
Notes:
(1) |
WNS (Holdings) Limited has made a 99.99% capital contribution in WNS Global Services Netherlands Cooperative U.A., or the Co-op. The remaining 0.01% capital contribution in the Co-op was made by WNS North America Inc.
to satisfy the regulatory requirement to have a minimum of two members. |
(2) |
All the shares except one share of WNS Business Consulting Services Private Limited are held by WNS North America Inc. The remaining one share is held by a nominee shareholder on behalf of WNS North America Inc. to
satisfy the regulatory requirement to have a minimum of two shareholders. |
(3) |
WNS Global Services Private Limited (Singapore Branch) was formed on November 28, 2014 and is a branch of WNS Global Services Private Limited. |
(4) |
WNS Cares Foundation is a not for profit organization registered under formerly Section 25 of the Indian Companies Act, 1956 (which has become Section 8 of the Indian Companies Act,
2013), formed for the purpose of promoting corporate social responsibilities and is not considered for the purpose of preparing our consolidated financial statements. |
(5) |
WNS Legal Assistance LLP was incorporated under the Limited Liability Partnerships Act, 2000 in the UK on November 4, 2014. |
75
D. Property, Plants and Equipment
As at March 31, 2015, we have an installed capacity of 24,316 production workstations, or seats, that can operate on an uninterrupted 24/7 basis and can
be staffed on a three-shift per day basis. The majority of our properties are leased by us, as described in the table below, and most of our leases are renewable at our option. The following table describes each of our delivery centers and sales
offices, including centers under construction, and sets forth our lease expiration dates:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Location |
|
Total Space (square feet) |
|
|
Total Number of Workstations/Seats |
|
|
Lease Expiration |
|
|
Extendable Until(1) |
|
India: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Mumbai |
|
|
406,513 |
(2) |
|
|
3,405 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Godrej Plant 10 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
February 15, 2016 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
Godrej Plant 11 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
February 15, 2016 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
Godrej Plant 5 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
February 15, 2016 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
Raheja (SEZ) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
May 31, 2019 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
Rupa Solitaire-Unit 319 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
December 10, 2018 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
Rupa Solitaire-Unit 318 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
February 9, 2020 |
|
|
|
February 9, 2025 |
|
Gurgaon |
|
|
215,895 |
|
|
|
2,491 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
DLF (SEZ) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
September 15, 2017 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
Udyog Vihar |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
July 14, 2017 |
|
|
|
July 14, 2020 |
|
World Tech Park-8th, 9th, 10th and a part of 11th floor(3) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
April 27, 2019 |
|
|
|
April 27, 2024 |
|
World Tech Park- the remaining part of 11th floor(3) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
November 2, 2019 |
|
|
|
April 2, 2024 |
|
Pune |
|
|
601,086 |
|
|
|
6,962 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Magarpatta(4) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
N/A |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
WeikfieldPhase I |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
February 14, 2018 |
|
|
|
February 14, 2022 |
|
WeikfieldPhase II |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
April 30, 2018 |
|
|
|
April 30, 2022 |
|
WeikfieldPhase III |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
June 14, 2018 |
|
|
|
June 14, 2022 |
|
Mantri Estate |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
May 26, 2016 |
|
|
|
May 26, 2020 |
|
Magarpatta (SEZ)Level 5 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
February 14, 2016 |
|
|
|
February 14, 2026 |
|
Magarpatta (SEZ)Level 6 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
October 26, 2016 |
|
|
|
October 26, 2026 |
|
Magarpatta (SEZ)Level 7 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
February 28, 2017 |
|
|
|
February 28, 2027 |
|
Nasik |
|
|
74,620 |
|
|
|
1,003 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Shreeniketan |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
June 30, 2018 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
Vascon |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
October 13, 2018 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
Bangalore |
|
|
156,432 |
|
|
|
1,605 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
RMZ Centennial |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
August 31, 2015 |
|
|
|
August 31, 2025 |
|
Chennai |
|
|
110,792 |
|
|
|
910 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
RMZ Millenia |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
March 31, 2018 |
|
|
|
March 31, 2045 |
|
DLF (SEZ)Phase 1 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
March 31, 2016 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
DLF (SEZ)Phase 2 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
March 31, 2017 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
Vishakhapatnam |
|
|
37,050 |
|
|
|
564 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
MPS Plaza |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
March 4, 2017 |
|
|
|
March 4, 2027 |
|
Tiruchirappalli |
|
|
217,800 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Plot of land(5) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
November 15, 2111 |
|
|
|
November 15, 2210 |
|
76
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Sri Lanka: |
|
|
59,249 |
|
|
|
823 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Colombo (HNB) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
July 31, 2015 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
Orion City |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
May 31, 2018 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
|
|
|
|
|
UK: |
|
|
29,530 |
|
|
|
519 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Museum Street |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
May 23, 2028 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
Cheadle |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
July 21, 2020 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
Piccadilly |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
February 1, 2017 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
Mansfield |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
February 14, 2016 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
Hayes |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
February 28, 2021 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
|
|
|
|
|
US: |
|
|
57,300 |
|
|
|
351 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Exchange Place, NJ |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
July 30, 2019 |
|
|
|
July 30, 2024 |
|
The State Building |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
April 19, 2017 |
|
|
|
April 19, 2023 |
|
Pennsylvania |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
June 23, 2015 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
|
|
|
|
|
Romania: |
|
|
38,750 |
|
|
|
478 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Bucharest |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
February 25, 2023 |
|
|
|
February 25, 2026 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
Philippines: |
|
|
143,331 |
|
|
|
1,883 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
EastwoodBasement 3 Parking |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
November 30, 2015 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
Eastwood10th floor |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
June 30, 2016 |
|
|
|
June 30, 2019 |
|
Eastwood9th floor |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
August 31, 2015 |
|
|
|
August 31, 2018 |
|
Techno Plaza II |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
April 30, 2019 |
|
|
|
April 30, 2024 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
Costa Rica: |
|
|
25,184 |
|
|
|
401 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Forum H San Jose |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
April 30, 2016 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
|
|
|
|
|
United Arab Emirates: |
|
|
510 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Dubai Airport Free Trade Zone |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
November 27, 2017 |
|
|
|
November 27, 2017 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
South Africa: |
|
|
198,028 |
|
|
|
2,532 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cape Town (Knowledge Park) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
March 31, 2019 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
Cape Town (Ambition House)4th floor |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
September 30, 2017 |
|
|
|
September 30, 2018 |
|
Cape Town (Ambition House)3rd floor |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
June 30, 2018 |
|
|
|
June 30, 2019 |
|
Johannesburg (Commissioners Street) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
May 31, 2016 |
|
|
|
May 31, 2021 |
|
Cape Town (Claremont) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
May 31, 2015 |
|
|
|
August 31, 2018 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
Poland: |
|
|
9,738 |
|
|
|
133 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Gdynia |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
April 1, 2018 |
|
|
|
April 1, 2023 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
China: |
|
|
31,708 |
|
|
|
257 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Guangzhou |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
April 30, 2017 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
Dalian |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
May 15, 2017 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
Beijing |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
December 31, 2015 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
|
|
|
|
|
Australia: |
|
|
646 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Sydney |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
November 30, 2015 |
|
|
|
N/A |
|
Notes:
N/A means not
applicable.
77
(1) |
Reflects the expiration date if the applicable extension options is exercised. |
(2) |
The total space for Mumbai includes 9,942 square feet available at the units in Rupa Solitaire which we leased in February 2015. We intend to build workstations at these units once our operations ramp up at that
location. We have entered in to a sublease agreement with a client, pursuant to which we have sublet the units at Rupa Solitaire to such client. |
(3) |
We entered into two leases commencing April 2014 for the premises at World Tech Park in Gurgaon for a period of five years for a total area of 147,260 square feet. In addition, we have, through a letter of intent,
exercised an option to lease additional space of 9,141 square feet at the same facility on the 11th floor in November 2014. We intend to execute a lease deed pursuant to the terms of the letter of
intent, prior to which the lease for the premises continues to be valid on the terms set out in the letter of intent. |
(4) |
We own these premises and a charge over these premises has been created in favor of HSBC Bank (Mauritius) Limited under a term loan agreement with HSBC Bank (Mauritius) Limited for a term loan of $7 million.
|
(5) |
This is a SEZ plot in the ELCOT Navalpattu IT/ITES SEZ Park. |
Our delivery centers are equipped with fiber
optic connectivity and have backups to their power supply designed to achieve uninterrupted operations. In fiscal 2016, we intend to establish additional delivery centers, as well as continue to streamline our operations by further consolidating
production capacities in our delivery centers.
78
ITEM 4A. |
UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS |
None.
79
ITEM 5. OPERATING AND FINANCIAL REVIEW AND PROSPECTS
The following discussion on the financial condition and results of operations of our company should be read in conjunction with our consolidated financial
statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this annual report. Some of the statements in the following discussion contain forward-looking statements that involve risks and uncertainties. See Special Note Regarding Forward-Looking
Statements. Our actual results could differ materially from those anticipated in these forward-looking statements as a result of a number of factors, including, but not limited to, those described below and elsewhere in this annual report,
particularly in the risk factors described in Part I Item 3 Key Information D. Risk Factors.
Overview
We are a leading global provider of BPM services, offering comprehensive data, voice, analytical and business transformation services with a blended onshore,
nearshore and offshore delivery model. We transfer the business processes of our clients to our delivery centers, located in China, Costa Rica, India, the Philippines, Poland, Romania, South Africa, Sri Lanka, the UK and the US, with a view to offer
cost savings, operational flexibility, improved quality and actionable insights to our clients. We seek to help our clients transform their businesses by identifying business and process optimization opportunities through
technology-enabled solutions, process design improvements, analytics and improved business understanding.
We win outsourcing engagements from our clients
based on our domain knowledge of their business, our experience in managing the specific processes they seek to outsource and our customer-centric approach. Our company is organized into vertical business units in order to provide more specialized
focus on each of the industries that we target, to more effectively manage our sales and marketing process and to develop in-depth domain knowledge. The major industry verticals we currently target are the insurance; travel and leisure; diversified
businesses including manufacturing, retail, consumer packaged goods, or CPG, media and entertainment, and telecom; utilities; consulting and professional services; banking and financial services; healthcare; and shipping and logistics industries; as
well as the public sector.
Our portfolio of services includes vertical-specific processes that are tailored to address our clients specific
business and industry practices. In addition, we offer a set of shared services that are common across multiple industries, including contact center, finance and accounting, research and analytics, technology services, legal services, and human
resources outsourcing.
Although we typically enter into long-term contractual arrangements with our clients, these contracts can usually be terminated
with or without cause by our clients and often with short notice periods. Nevertheless, our client relationships tend to be long-term in nature given the scale and complexity of the services we provide coupled with risks and costs associated with
switching processes in-house or to other service providers. We structure each contract to meet our clients specific business requirements and our target rate of return over the life of the contract. In addition, since the sales cycle for
offshore business process management is long and complex, it is often difficult to predict the timing of new client engagements. As a result, we may experience fluctuations in growth rates and profitability from quarter to quarter, depending on the
timing and nature of new contracts. Our operating results may also differ significantly from quarter to quarter due to seasonal changes in the operations of our clients. For example, our clients in the travel and leisure industry typically
experience seasonal changes in their operations in connection with the US summer holiday season, as well as episodic factors such as adverse weather conditions. Our focus, however, is on deepening our client relationships and maximizing shareholder
value over the life of a clients relationship with us.
Our revenue is generated primarily from providing business process management services. We
have two reportable segments for financial statement reporting purposes WNS Global BPM and WNS Auto Claims BPM. In our WNS Auto Claims BPM segment, we provide both fault and non-fault repairs. For fault
repairs, we provide claims handling and repair management services, where we arrange for automobile repairs through a network of third party repair centers. In our repair management services, where we act as the principal in our dealings with the
third party repair centers and our clients, the amounts which we invoice to our clients for payments made by us to third party repair centers are reported as revenue. Where we are not the principal in providing the services, we record revenue from
repair services net of repair cost. See Note 2.s of the consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this annual report. Since we wholly subcontract the repairs to the repair centers, we evaluate the financial performance of our
fault repair business based on revenue less repair payments to third party repair centers, which is a non-GAAP financial measure. We believe that revenue less repair payments for fault repairs reflects more accurately the
value addition of the business process management services that we directly provide to our clients.
80
For our non-fault repairs business, we generally provide a consolidated suite of accident management
services including credit hire and credit repair, and we believe that measurement of such business on a basis that includes repair payments in revenue is appropriate. Revenue including repair payments is therefore used as a primary measure to
allocate resources and measure operating performance for accident management services provided in our non-fault repairs business. Our non-fault repairs business where we provide accident management services accounts for a
relatively small portion of our revenue for our WNS Auto Claims BPM segment.
Revenue less repair payments is a non-GAAP financial measure which is
calculated as (a) revenue less (b) in our auto claims business, payments to repair centers for fault repair cases where we act as the principal in our dealings with the third party repair centers and our clients. This non-GAAP
financial information is not meant to be considered in isolation or as a substitute for our financial results prepared in accordance with GAAP. Our revenue less repair payments may not be comparable to similarly titled measures reported by other
companies due to potential differences in the method of calculation.
The following table reconciles our revenue (a GAAP financial measure) to revenue
less repair payments (a non-GAAP financial measure) for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Revenue |
|
$ |
533.9 |
|
|
$ |
502.6 |
|
|
$ |
460.3 |
|
Less: Payments to repair centers(1) |
|
|
30.9 |
|
|
|
31.1 |
|
|
|
24.1 |
|
Revenue less repair payments |
|
$ |
503.0 |
|
|
$ |
471.5 |
|
|
$ |
436.1 |
|
Note:
(1) |
Consists of payments to repair centers in our auto claims business (a) for fault repair cases where we act as the principal in our dealings with the third party repair centers and our clients and
(b) for non-fault repair cases with respect to one former client as discussed above. |
The following table sets forth our
constant currency revenue less repair payments for the periods indicated. Constant currency revenue less repair payments is a non-GAAP financial measure. We present constant currency revenue less repair payments so that revenue less repair payments
may be viewed without the impact of foreign currency exchange rate fluctuations, thereby facilitating period-to-period comparisons of business performance. Constant currency revenue less repair payments is presented by recalculating prior
periods revenue less repair payments denominated in currencies other than in US dollars using the foreign exchange rate used for the latest period, without taking into account the impact of hedging gains/losses. Our non-US dollar denominated
revenues include, but are not limited to, revenues denominated in pound sterling, Australian dollars, Euros and South African rand.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Constant currency revenue less repair payments |
|
$ |
500.1 |
|
|
$ |
476.2 |
|
|
$ |
440.3 |
|
81
Global Economic Conditions
Global economic conditions have shown some signs of recovery, particularly in the US, but remain challenging as concerns remain on the sustainability of the
recovery. Some key indicators of sustainable economic growth remain under pressure. Ongoing concerns over the sustainability of economic recovery in the US and its substantial debt burden, the low price of crude oil across the globe and the related
implications for potential global deflation, as well as concerns of slower economic growth in the EU, Russia, China and India, have contributed to market volatility and diminished expectations for the US, European and global economies. If countries
in the Eurozone or other countries require additional financial support, if sovereign credit ratings continue to decline, or in the event of a default on sovereign debt obligations in certain countries including Argentina, Greece and Russia, yields
on the sovereign debt of certain countries may continue to increase, the cost of borrowing may increase and credit may become more limited. In the US, there continue to be concerns over the failure to achieve a long term solution to the issues of
government spending, the increasing US national debt and rising debt ceiling, and their negative impact on the US economy as well as concerns over potential increases in cost of borrowing and reduction in availability of credit as the US Federal
Reserve ends its quantitative easing program. Further, there continue to be signs of economic weakness such as relatively high levels of unemployment in major markets including Europe and the US. Continuing conflicts and instability in various
regions around the world may lead to additional acts of terrorism and armed conflict around the world, as well as the growing concerns over the sustained and drastic fall in the price of crude oil and the associated risk of global deflation which
may contribute to further economic instability in the global financial markets. These economic conditions may affect our business in a number of ways. The general level of economic activity, such as decreases in business and consumer spending, could
result in a decrease in demand for our services, thus reducing our revenue. The cost and availability of credit has been and may continue to be adversely affected by illiquid credit markets and wider credit spreads. Continued turbulence or
uncertainty in the European, the US and the international financial markets and economies may adversely affect our liquidity and financial condition, and the liquidity and financial condition of our customers. If these market conditions continue or
worsen, they may limit our ability to access financing or increase our cost of financing to meet liquidity needs, and affect the ability of our customers to use credit to purchase our services or to make timely payments to us, resulting in adverse
effects on our financial condition and results of operations.
Furthermore, a weakening of the rate of exchange for the US dollar or the pound sterling or
the Australian dollar (in which our revenues are principally denominated) against the Indian rupee (in which a significant portion of our costs are denominated) also adversely affects our results. Fluctuations between the pound sterling, the
Australian dollar, the South African rand or the Indian rupee, on the one hand, and the US dollar, on the other hand, also expose us to translation risk when transactions denominated in these currencies are translated into US dollars, our reporting
currency For example, the pound sterling appreciated against the US dollar by an average of 1.5% and 0.6% in fiscal 2015 and 2014, respectively. On the other hand, in fiscal 2015 and 2014, the Indian rupee depreciated against the US dollar by an
average of 1.2% and 11.0%, respectively, the Australian dollar depreciated against the US dollar by an average of 6.1% and 9.6%, respectively, and the South African rand depreciated against the US dollar by an average 9.4% and 17.9%, respectively.
The appreciation of the pound sterling and the depreciation of the Indian rupee and the South African rand against the US dollar positively impacted our results of operations in fiscal 2015 and 2014 whereas the depreciation of the Australian dollar
negatively impacted our results of operations in fiscal 2015 and 2014.
Uncertainty about current global economic conditions could also continue to
increase the volatility of our share price. We cannot predict the timing or duration of an economic slowdown or the timing or strength of a subsequent economic recovery generally or in our targeted industries, including the travel and leisure and
insurance industries. If macroeconomic conditions worsen or current global economic conditions continue for a prolonged period of time, we are not able to predict the impact that such worsening conditions will have on our targeted industries in
general, and our results of operations specifically.
Our History and Milestones
We began operations as an in-house unit of British Airways in 1996 and started focusing on providing business process management services to third parties in
fiscal 2003. The following are the key milestones in our operating history since Warburg Pincus acquired a controlling stake in our company from British Airways in May 2002 and inducted a new senior management team:
|
|
|
In fiscal 2003, we acquired Town and Country Assistance Limited (which we subsequently rebranded as WNS Assistance and which is part of WNS Auto Claims BPM, our reportable segment for financial statement purposes), a
UK-based automobile claims handling company, thereby extending our service portfolio beyond the travel and leisure industry to include insurance-based automobile claims processing. |
82
|
|
|
In fiscal 2003 and 2004, we invested in our infrastructure to expand our service portfolio from data-oriented processing to include complex voice and blended data/voice service capabilities, and commenced offering
comprehensive processes in the travel and leisure, banking and financial services and insurance industries. |
|
|
|
In fiscal 2004, we acquired the health claims management business of Greensnow Inc. |
|
|
|
In fiscal 2005, we opened facilities in Gurgaon, India and Colombo, Sri Lanka, thereby expanding our operating footprints across India and Sri Lanka. |
|
|
|
In fiscal 2006, we acquired Trinity Partners Inc. (which we subsequently merged into our subsidiary, WNS North America Inc.), a provider of business process management services to financial institutions, focusing on
mortgage banking. |
|
|
|
In fiscal 2007, we expanded our facilities in Gurgaon, Mumbai and Pune, India. |
|
|
|
In fiscal 2007, we acquired the fare audit services business of PRG Airlines and the financial accounting business of GHS. |
|
|
|
In May 2007, we acquired Marketics, a provider of offshore analytics services. |
|
|
|
In June 2007, we acquired Flovate, a company engaged in the development and maintenance of software products and solutions, which we subsequently renamed as WNS Workflow Technologies Limited. |
|
|
|
In July 2007, we completed the transfer of our delivery center in Sri Lanka to Aviva Global. |
|
|
|
In January 2008, we launched a 133-seat facility in Bucharest, Romania. |
|
|
|
In March 2008, we entered into a joint venture with ACS, a provider in BPM services and customer care in the Philippines, to form WNS Philippines Inc. |
|
|
|
In April 2008, we opened a facility in Manila, the Philippines. |
|
|
|
In April 2008, we acquired Chang Limited, an auto insurance claims processing services provider in the UK, through its wholly-owned subsidiary, AHA (formerly known as Call 24-7). |
|
|
|
In June 2008, we acquired BizAps, a provider of SAP® solutions to optimize the enterprise resource planning functionality for our finance and accounting
processes. |
|
|
|
In July 2008, we acquired from Aviva all the shares of Aviva Global, which we renamed to WNS Global Singapore, and resumed ownership of the delivery center in Sri Lanka that was transferred to Aviva Global in July
2007, as mentioned above. In connection with our acquisition of Aviva Global, we also entered into the 2008 Aviva master services agreement (as varied by the variation agreement entered into in March 2009) with Aviva MS, pursuant to which we
provided BPM services to Avivas UK business and Avivas Irish subsidiary, Hibernian Aviva Direct Limited, and certain of its affiliates. We replaced this 2008 Aviva master services agreement with the Aviva master services agreement in
September 2014. |
83
|
|
|
In November 2009, we opened a facility in San Jose, Costa Rica. |
|
|
|
In January 2010, we moved from our existing facility to a new and expanded facility in Manila, the Philippines. |
|
|
|
In October 2010, we moved from our existing facility in Marple to Manchester, UK and expanded our facility in Manila, the Philippines. |
|
|
|
In November 2010, we expanded our sales office in London, UK. |
|
|
|
In March 2011, we expanded our facility in Bucharest, Romania. |
|
|
|
In November 2011, we acquired ACSs shareholding in WNS Philippines Inc., which became our wholly-owned subsidiary. |
|
|
|
In fiscal 2012, we expanded our facilities in Mumbai, Pune, Gurgaon, Chennai, India, the Philippines, Costa Rica and Romania. |
|
|
|
In February 2012, we completed a follow-on public offering of ADS and raised approximately $50.0 million to fund our growth initiatives and enhance delivery capability. |
|
|
|
In June 2012, we acquired Fusion, a provider of a range of management services, including contact center, customer care and business continuity services, to both South African and international clients, which we
subsequently renamed as WNS Global Services SA (Pty) Ltd. |
|
|
|
In June 2012, we opened a facility in Vizag, India. |
|
|
|
In December 2012, we opened a facility in Gydnia, Poland. |
|
|
|
In fiscal 2014, we added new facilities in Guangzhou, China; Colombo, Sri Lanka; and Mumbai, India. |
|
|
|
In fiscal 2015, we added new facilities in Dalian, China; Cape Town, South Africa; and Pennsylvania, United States. |
As a result of these acquisitions and other corporate developments, our financial results in corresponding periods may not be directly comparable.
Revenue
We generate revenue by providing business
process management services to our clients. The following table shows our revenue (a GAAP financial measure) and revenue less repair payments (a non-GAAP financial measure) for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
% |
|
Revenue |
|
$ |
533.9 |
|
|
$ |
502.6 |
|
|
|
31.3 |
|
|
|
6.2 |
% |
Revenue less repair payments |
|
$ |
503.0 |
|
|
$ |
471.5 |
|
|
|
31.5 |
|
|
|
6.7 |
% |
We have a large client base diversified across industries and geographies. Our client base grew from 254 clients as at
March 31, 2010 to 292 clients as at March 31, 2015.
Our revenue is characterized by client, industry, service type, geographic and contract
type diversity, as the analysis below indicates.
84
Revenue by Top Clients
For fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013, the percentage of revenue and revenue less repair payments that we derived from our largest clients were in the proportions set
forth in the following table:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenue |
|
|
Revenue less repair payments |
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Top client |
|
|
13.4 |
% |
|
|
15.2 |
% |
|
|
16.9 |
% |
|
|
14.2 |
% |
|
|
16.2 |
% |
|
|
17.8 |
% |
Top five clients |
|
|
33.0 |
% |
|
|
36.9 |
% |
|
|
37.1 |
% |
|
|
35.0 |
% |
|
|
39.4 |
% |
|
|
39.2 |
% |
Top ten clients |
|
|
44.5 |
% |
|
|
48.5 |
% |
|
|
49.5 |
% |
|
|
47.2 |
% |
|
|
51.7 |
% |
|
|
52.0 |
% |
Top twenty clients |
|
|
60.1 |
% |
|
|
63.3 |
% |
|
|
66.3 |
% |
|
|
63.5 |
% |
|
|
66.7 |
% |
|
|
68.5 |
% |
In fiscal 2015, our three largest clients individually accounted for 13.4%, 8.5% and 5.5%, respectively, of our revenue as
compared to 15.2%, 7.7% and 6.1%, respectively, in fiscal 2014 and 16.9%, 7.3% and 6.5%, respectively, in fiscal 2013.
In line with our expectations, one
of our top five clients by revenue contribution in fiscal 2014 and 2013, an OTA client provided us with a lower volume of business in fiscal 2015. The client entered into a strategic marketing agreement with another OTA in August 2013 pursuant to
which it over a period of time, from the fourth quarter of fiscal 2014 to the fourth quarter of fiscal 2015, moved their customer care and sales processes that were previously managed by us to a technology platform managed by the other OTA. As a
result, we lost most of our business from our OTA client. Our OTA client accounted for 2.5%, 6.1% and 7.3% of our revenue and 2.6%, 6.5% and 7.7% of our revenue less repair payments in fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The other OTA uses
several BPM vendors to manage such processes on their technology platform. We are approved as one of the other OTAs providers of BPM services. We have managed to compete with incumbent BPM vendors for the other OTAs business and the
other OTA has become one of our large clients. There can be no assurance that we will be able to offset the loss of business from our OTA client to a significant extent or at all.
Further, we have entered into the Aviva master services agreement with an existing major client, Aviva MS, effective April 1, 2014. The Aviva master
services agreement replaced our prior master services agreement, the 2008 Aviva master services agreement, with the client that was due to expire in November 2016. See Our Contracts Revenue by Contract Type. The new pricing
arrangements under the new agreement resulted in lower revenue from the client in fiscal 2015 as compared to fiscal 2014 and 2013. Aviva MS accounted for 13.4%, 15.2% and 16.9% of our revenue and 14.2%, 16.2% and 17.8% of our revenue less repair
payments in fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
Revenue by Industry
For financial statement reporting purposes, we aggregate several of our operating segments, except for the WNS Auto Claims BPM (which we market under the WNS
Assistance brand) as it does not meet the aggregation criteria under IFRS. See Results by Reportable Segment.
We organize our company
into the following industry-focused business units to provide more specialized focus on each of these industries: insurance; travel and leisure; diversified businesses including manufacturing, retail, CPG, media and entertainment, and telecom;
utilities; consulting and professional services; banking and financial services; healthcare; and shipping and logistics industries; as well as the public sector.
85
For fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013, our revenue and revenue less repair payments were diversified across our
industry-focused business units in the proportions set forth in the following table:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As a percentage of revenue |
|
|
As a percentage of revenue less repair payments |
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
Business Unit |
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Insurance |
|
|
35.8 |
% |
|
|
36.7 |
% |
|
|
35.5 |
% |
|
|
31.7 |
% |
|
|
32.6 |
% |
|
|
31.9 |
% |
Travel and leisure |
|
|
18.7 |
% |
|
|
19.5 |
% |
|
|
20.5 |
% |
|
|
19.8 |
% |
|
|
20.8 |
% |
|
|
21.5 |
% |
Diversified businesses including manufacturing, retail, CPG, media and entertainment, and telecom |
|
|
14.0 |
% |
|
|
14.4 |
% |
|
|
15.5 |
% |
|
|
14.9 |
% |
|
|
15.3 |
% |
|
|
16.3 |
% |
Utilities |
|
|
9.5 |
% |
|
|
7.8 |
% |
|
|
6.6 |
% |
|
|
10.1 |
% |
|
|
8.3 |
% |
|
|
7.0 |
% |
Consulting and professional services |
|
|
7.4 |
% |
|
|
6.8 |
% |
|
|
6.9 |
% |
|
|
7.9 |
% |
|
|
7.2 |
% |
|
|
7.3 |
% |
Banking and financial services |
|
|
5.8 |
% |
|
|
6.5 |
% |
|
|
5.5 |
% |
|
|
6.1 |
% |
|
|
7.0 |
% |
|
|
5.9 |
% |
Healthcare |
|
|
5.2 |
% |
|
|
5.1 |
% |
|
|
6.5 |
% |
|
|
5.6 |
% |
|
|
5.4 |
% |
|
|
6.9 |
% |
Shipping and logistics |
|
|
3.4 |
% |
|
|
2.9 |
% |
|
|
2.6 |
% |
|
|
3.6 |
% |
|
|
3.1 |
% |
|
|
2.8 |
% |
Public sector |
|
|
0.2 |
% |
|
|
0.3 |
% |
|
|
0.4 |
% |
|
|
0.3 |
% |
|
|
0.3 |
% |
|
|
0.4 |
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Certain services that we provide to our clients are subject to the seasonality of our clients business. Accordingly, we
see an increase in transaction related services within the travel and leisure industry during holiday seasons, such as during the US summer holidays (our fiscal second quarter); an increase in business in the insurance industry during the beginning
and end of the fiscal year (our fiscal first and last quarters) and during the US peak winter season (our fiscal third quarter); and an increase in business in the consumer product industry during the US festive season towards the end of the
calendar year when new product launches and campaigns typically happen (our fiscal third quarter).
Revenue by Service Type
For fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013, our revenue and revenue less repair payments were diversified across service types in the proportions set forth in the
following table:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As a percentage of revenue |
|
|
As a percentage of revenue less repair payments |
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
Service Type |
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Industry-specific |
|
|
31.0 |
% |
|
|
31.2 |
% |
|
|
32.1 |
% |
|
|
33.0 |
% |
|
|
33.3 |
% |
|
|
33.8 |
% |
Contact center |
|
|
22.5 |
% |
|
|
23.6 |
% |
|
|
23.9 |
% |
|
|
23.9 |
% |
|
|
25.2 |
% |
|
|
25.2 |
% |
Finance and accounting |
|
|
20.0 |
% |
|
|
18.6 |
% |
|
|
17.6 |
% |
|
|
21.2 |
% |
|
|
19.8 |
% |
|
|
18.6 |
% |
Autoclaim |
|
|
11.4 |
% |
|
|
12.5 |
% |
|
|
12.0 |
% |
|
|
6.0 |
% |
|
|
6.8 |
% |
|
|
7.1 |
% |
Research and analytics |
|
|
12.5 |
% |
|
|
11.4 |
% |
|
|
11.3 |
% |
|
|
13.2 |
% |
|
|
12.1 |
% |
|
|
11.9 |
% |
Technology services |
|
|
1.7 |
% |
|
|
1.8 |
% |
|
|
2.2 |
% |
|
|
1.8 |
% |
|
|
1.9 |
% |
|
|
2.3 |
% |
Legal services |
|
|
0.7 |
% |
|
|
0.7 |
% |
|
|
0.7 |
% |
|
|
0.7 |
% |
|
|
0.7 |
% |
|
|
0.8 |
% |
Human resources outsourcing(1) |
|
|
0.2 |
% |
|
|
0.2 |
% |
|
|
0.2 |
% |
|
|
0.2 |
% |
|
|
0.2 |
% |
|
|
0.3 |
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note:
(1) |
This horizontal unit was established in the first quarter of fiscal 2013. |
86
Revenue by Geography
For fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013, our revenue and revenue less repair payments were derived from the following geographies (based on the location of our clients)
in the proportions set forth below in the following table:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As a percentage of revenue |
|
|
As a percentage of revenue less repair payments |
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
Geography |
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
UK |
|
|
52.8 |
% |
|
|
52.7 |
% |
|
|
53.3 |
% |
|
|
49.9 |
% |
|
|
49.6 |
% |
|
|
50.7 |
% |
North America (primarily the US) |
|
|
25.9 |
% |
|
|
27.3 |
% |
|
|
30.5 |
% |
|
|
27.5 |
% |
|
|
29.1 |
% |
|
|
32.2 |
% |
Europe (excluding the UK) |
|
|
5.4 |
% |
|
|
5.4 |
% |
|
|
5.9 |
% |
|
|
5.7 |
% |
|
|
5.7 |
% |
|
|
6.3 |
% |
Australia |
|
|
6.4 |
% |
|
|
3.7 |
% |
|
|
2.4 |
% |
|
|
6.8 |
% |
|
|
3.9 |
% |
|
|
2.5 |
% |
South Africa |
|
|
3.3 |
% |
|
|
4.1 |
% |
|
|
3.1 |
% |
|
|
3.5 |
% |
|
|
4.3 |
% |
|
|
3.3 |
% |
Rest of world |
|
|
6.2 |
% |
|
|
6.8 |
% |
|
|
4.8 |
% |
|
|
6.6 |
% |
|
|
7.4 |
% |
|
|
5.0 |
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenue by Location of Delivery Centers
For fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013, our revenue and revenue less repair payments were derived from the following geographies (based on the location of our delivery
centers) in the proportions set forth in the following table:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As a percentage of revenue |
|
|
As a percentage of revenue less repair payments |
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
Location of Delivery Center |
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
India |
|
|
64.2 |
% |
|
|
65.1 |
% |
|
|
68.4 |
% |
|
|
68.4 |
% |
|
|
69.4 |
% |
|
|
72.3 |
% |
UK |
|
|
12.0 |
% |
|
|
12.8 |
% |
|
|
12.5 |
% |
|
|
6.6 |
% |
|
|
7.1 |
% |
|
|
7.7 |
% |
South Africa(1) |
|
|
7.8 |
% |
|
|
7.6 |
% |
|
|
5.2 |
% |
|
|
8.3 |
% |
|
|
8.1 |
% |
|
|
5.4 |
% |
Philippines |
|
|
6.6 |
% |
|
|
5.7 |
% |
|
|
5.7 |
% |
|
|
7.0 |
% |
|
|
6.1 |
% |
|
|
6.0 |
% |
Sri Lanka |
|
|
3.0 |
% |
|
|
2.5 |
% |
|
|
2.3 |
% |
|
|
3.1 |
% |
|
|
2.7 |
% |
|
|
2.4 |
% |
Romania |
|
|
2.5 |
% |
|
|
2.4 |
% |
|
|
2.4 |
% |
|
|
2.7 |
% |
|
|
2.6 |
% |
|
|
2.5 |
% |
United States |
|
|
1.3 |
% |
|
|
1.5 |
% |
|
|
1.5 |
% |
|
|
1.3 |
% |
|
|
1.6 |
% |
|
|
1.6 |
% |
Costa Rica |
|
|
0.7 |
% |
|
|
0.8 |
% |
|
|
1.3 |
% |
|
|
0.7 |
% |
|
|
0.8 |
% |
|
|
1.4 |
% |
China(2) |
|
|
1.1 |
% |
|
|
0.9 |
% |
|
|
0.3 |
% |
|
|
1.1 |
% |
|
|
0.9 |
% |
|
|
0.3 |
% |
Poland(3) |
|
|
0.8 |
% |
|
|
0.7 |
% |
|
|
0.4 |
% |
|
|
0.8 |
% |
|
|
0.7 |
% |
|
|
0.4 |
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Notes:
(1) |
This includes revenue from Fusion which we acquired on June 21, 2012. For the period prior to June 21, 2012, this includes revenue from services provided through Fusion under a subcontract arrangement.
|
(2) |
For fiscal 2015, this includes revenue from our new China facility which became operational in October 2014, as well as our first China facility and through our former subcontractors delivery center in China. For
fiscal 2014 and 2013, this includes revenue from services provided through our former subcontractors delivery center in China, and revenue from our first China facility which became operational in May 2013. |
(3) |
The facility became operational in October 2012. |
87
Our Contracts
We provide our services under contracts with our clients, which typically range from three to five years, with some being rolling contracts with no end dates.
Typically, these contracts can be terminated by our clients with or without cause and with short notice periods. However, we tend to have long-term relationships with our clients given the complex and comprehensive nature of the business processes
executed by us, coupled with the switching costs and risks associated with relocating these processes in-house or to other service providers.
Each client
contract has different terms and conditions based on the scope of services to be delivered and the requirements of that client. Occasionally, we may incur significant costs on certain contracts in the early stages of implementation, with the
expectation that these costs will be recouped over the life of the contract to achieve our targeted returns. Each client contract has corresponding service level agreements that define certain operational metrics based on which our performance is
measured. Some of our contracts specify penalties or damages payable by us in the event of failure to meet certain key service level standards within an agreed upon time frame.
When we are engaged by a client, we typically transfer that clients processes to our delivery centers over a two to six month period. This transfer
process is subject to a number of potential delays. Therefore, we may not recognize significant revenue until several months after commencing a client engagement.
In the WNS Global BPM segment, we charge for our services based on the following pricing models:
|
1) |
per full-time equivalent arrangements, which typically involve billings based on the number of full-time employees (or equivalent) deployed on the execution of the business process managed; |
|
2) |
per transaction arrangements, which typically involve billings based on the number of transactions processed (such as the number of e-mail responses, or airline coupons or insurance claims processed); |
|
3) |
fixed-price arrangements, which typically involve billings based on achievements of pre-defined deliverables or milestones; |
|
4) |
outcome-based arrangements, which typically involve billings based on the business result achieved by our clients through our service efforts (such as measured based on a reduction in days sales outstanding, an
improvement in working capital, an increase in collections or a reduction in operating expenses); or |
|
5) |
other pricing arrangements, including cost-plus arrangements, which typically involve billing the contractually agreed direct and indirect costs and a fee based on the number of employees deployed under the arrangement.
|
Apart from the above-mentioned pricing methods, a small portion of our revenue is comprised of reimbursements of out-of-pocket expenses
incurred by us in providing services to our clients.
Outcome-based arrangements are examples of non-linear pricing models where revenues from platforms
and solutions and the services we provide are linked to usage or savings by clients rather than the efforts deployed to provide these services. We intend to focus on increasing our service offerings that are based on non-linear pricing models that
allow us to price our services based on the value we deliver to our clients rather than the headcount deployed to deliver the services to them. We believe that non-linear pricing models help us to grow our revenue without increasing our headcount.
Accordingly, we expect increased use of non-linear pricing models to result in higher revenue per employee and improved margins. Non-linear revenues may be subject to short term pressure on margins, however, as initiatives in developing the products
and services take time to deliver. Moreover, in outcome-based arrangements, we bear the risk of failure to achieve clients business objectives in connection with these projects. For more information, see Part I Item 3.
Key Information D. Risk Factors If our pricing structures do not accurately anticipate the cost and complexity of performing our work, our profitability may be negatively affected.
In our WNS Auto Claims BPM segment, we earn revenue from claims handling and repair management services. For claims handling, we charge on a per claim basis
or a fixed fee per vehicle over a contract period. For automobile repair management services, where we arrange for the repairs through a network of repair centers that we have established, we invoice the client for the amount of the repair. When we
direct a vehicle to a specific repair center, we receive a referral fee from that repair center. We also provide a consolidated suite of services towards accident management including credit hire and credit repair for non-fault repairs
business.
88
Revenue by Contract Type
For fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013, our revenue and revenue less repair payments were diversified by contract type in the proportions set forth in the following
table:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As a percentage of revenue |
|
|
As a percentage of revenue less repair payments |
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Full-time-equivalent |
|
|
69.7 |
% |
|
|
63.5 |
% |
|
|
59.6 |
% |
|
|
74.0 |
% |
|
|
67.6 |
% |
|
|
62.8 |
% |
Transaction |
|
|
22.4 |
% |
|
|
27.6 |
% |
|
|
29.7 |
% |
|
|
17.6 |
% |
|
|
22.9 |
% |
|
|
25.8 |
% |
Fixed price |
|
|
3.4 |
% |
|
|
4.6 |
% |
|
|
6.0 |
% |
|
|
3.6 |
% |
|
|
4.9 |
% |
|
|
6.4 |
% |
Outcome-based |
|
|
1.1 |
% |
|
|
0.9 |
% |
|
|
1.1 |
% |
|
|
1.2 |
% |
|
|
1.0 |
% |
|
|
1.2 |
% |
Others |
|
|
3.4 |
% |
|
|
3.4 |
% |
|
|
3.6 |
% |
|
|
3.6 |
% |
|
|
3.6 |
% |
|
|
3.8 |
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
We have continued our ten-year relationship with Aviva MS by entering into the Aviva master services agreement with Aviva MS,
in September 2014, for a term of eight years, effective April 1, 2014 and expiring on March 31, 2022. The Aviva master services agreement replaced our 2008 Aviva master services agreement with the client that was due to expire in November
2016. The agreement continues to provide us with the exclusive right to provide the client with the services we currently provide, and in the same geographic regions, subject to the rights and obligations of the Aviva group under their existing
contracts with other providers of similar services. Aviva MS has agreed, and further agreed to procure other members of the Aviva group, not to renew or extend such existing contacts unless they are contractually bound to do so. We are also regarded
as a preferred supplier with respect to any new services or any new geographic regions in which the client seeks BPM services, subject to our meeting certain conditions of the clients supplier tender process.
Our clients customarily provide one to three month rolling forecasts of their service requirements. Our contracts with our clients do not generally provide
for a committed minimum volume of business or committed amounts of revenue, with the exception of the Aviva master services agreement. The Aviva master services agreement requires Aviva MS to provide us with a minimum volume of business until
October 31, 2016 (the last complete month prior to the expiration of the 2008 Aviva master services agreement). The minimum volume commitment is calculated as 3,000 billable full time employees, where one billable full time employee is the
equivalent of a production employee engaged by us to perform our obligations under the contract for one working day at least nine hours for 250 days a year. The revised contract is priced on a full-time equivalent, or FTE, pricing model for certain
types of outsourced processes and a non-FTE based pricing model for other types of outsourced processes. In the event the mean average monthly volume of business in any rolling three-month period does not reach the minimum volume commitment, Aviva
MS has agreed to pay us a minimum commitment fee as liquidated damages. Notwithstanding the minimum volume commitment, there are termination at will provisions which permit Aviva MS to terminate the Aviva master services agreement without cause,
with six months notice upon payment of a termination fee. The annual minimum volume commitment under this contract was not met in fiscal 2015 because of a small reduction in demand for our services provided under the contract in the fourth
quarter of fiscal 2015. Aviva MS paid us the minimum commitment fee for fiscal 2015.
The new pricing arrangements under the Aviva master services
agreement provide for productivity-related discounts associated with FTE and non-FTE models. Some of these discounts are mandatorily applied through the term of the contract. Pricing also varies based on degree of complexity of the outsourced
processes. The new pricing arrangements under the Aviva master services agreement resulted in lower revenue for fiscal 2015 as compared to fiscal 2014 and 2013. Aviva MS accounted for 13.4%, 15.2% and 16.9% of our revenue and 14.2%, 16.2% and 17.8%
of our revenue less repair payments in fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
Under the terms of an agreement with one of our top five clients
negotiated in December 2009, we are the exclusive provider of certain key services from delivery locations outside of the US, including customer service and ticketing support for the client. This agreement became effective on April 1, 2010 and
will expire in December 2015. Under our earlier agreement with this client, we were entitled to charge premium pricing because we had absorbed the initial transition cost in 2004. That premium pricing is no longer available in the new contract with
this client. The early termination of the old agreement entitled us to a payment by the client of a termination fee of $5.4 million which was received on April 1, 2010. As the termination fee was related to a renewal of our agreement with the
client, we have determined that the recognition of the termination fee as revenue will be deferred over the term of the new agreement (i.e., over the period from April 1, 2010 to December 31, 2015).
89
Expenses
The majority of our expenses consist of cost of revenue and operating expenses. The key components of our cost of revenue are employee costs, facilities costs,
payments to repair centers, depreciation, travel expenses, and legal and professional costs. Our operating expenses include selling and marketing expenses, general and administrative expenses, foreign exchange gains and losses and amortization of
intangible assets. Our non-operating expenses include finance expenses as well as other expenses recorded under other income, net.
Cost of
Revenue
Employee costs represent the largest component of cost of revenue. In addition to employee salaries, employee costs include costs related to
recruitment, training and retention, and share-based compensation expense. Historically, our employee costs have increased primarily due to increases in number of employees to support our growth and, to a lesser extent, to recruit, train and retain
employees. Salary levels in India and our ability to efficiently manage and retain our employees significantly influence our cost of revenue. See Part I Item 4. Information on the Company B. Business Overview
Human Capital. We expect our employee costs to increase as we expect to increase our headcount to service additional business and as wages continue to increase globally. See Part I Item. 3. Key Information. D. Risk
Factors Risks Related to Our Business Wage increases may prevent us from sustaining our competitive advantage and may reduce our profit margin. We seek to mitigate these cost increases through improvements in employee
productivity, employee retention and asset utilization.
Our WNS Auto Claims BPM segment includes repair management services, where we arrange for
automobile repairs through a network of third party repair centers. This cost is primarily driven by the volume of accidents and the amount of the repair costs related to such accidents.
Our facilities costs comprise lease rentals, utilities cost, facilities management and telecommunication network cost. Most of our leases for our facilities
are long-term agreements and have escalation clauses which provide for increases in rent at periodic intervals commencing between three and five years from the start of the lease. Most of these agreements have clauses that cap escalation of lease
rentals.
We create capacity in our operational infrastructure ahead of anticipated demand as it takes six to nine months to build up a new site. Hence,
our cost of revenue as a percentage of revenue may be higher during periods in which we carry such additional capacity.
Once we are engaged by a client
in a new contract, we normally have a transition period to transfer the clients processes to our delivery centers and accordingly incur costs related to such transfer. Therefore, our cost of revenue in relation to our revenue may be higher
until the transfer phase is completed, which may last for two to six months.
Selling and Marketing Expenses
Our selling and marketing expenses primarily comprise employee costs for sales and marketing personnel, travel expenses, legal and professional fees,
share-based compensation expense, brand building expenses and other general expenses relating to selling and marketing.
Selling and marketing expenses as
a proportion of revenue were 5.8% in fiscal 2015 as compared to 7.0% and 6.6% for fiscal 2014 and 2013, respectively. Selling and marketing expenses as a proportion of revenue less repair payments were 6.2% in fiscal 2015 as compared with 7.5% and
6.9% for fiscal 2014 and 2013, respectively. We expect our selling and marketing expenses to increase in fiscal 2016 but at a lower rate than the increase in our revenue less repair payments.
We expect the employee costs associated with sales and marketing and related travel costs to increase in fiscal 2016. See Part I
Item 4. Information on the Company B. Business Overview Business Strategy Enhance awareness of the WNS brand name. Our sales team is compensated based on achievement of business targets set at the beginning of each
fiscal year. Accordingly, we expect this variable component of the sales team costs to increase in line with overall business growth.
90
General and Administrative Expenses
Our general and administrative expenses primarily comprise employee costs for senior management and other support personnel, travel expenses, legal and
professional fees, share-based compensation expense and other general expenses not related to cost of revenue and selling and marketing.
General and
administrative expenses as a proportion of revenue were 13.1% in fiscal 2015 as compared with 11.0% and 12.4% for fiscal 2014 and 2013, respectively. General and administrative expenses as a proportion of revenue less repair payments were 13.9% in
fiscal 2015 as compared with 11.7% and 13.1% for fiscal 2014 and 2013, respectively. We expect general and administrative expenses to increase in fiscal 2016 but at a lower rate than the increase in our revenue less repair payments.
We also expect our corporate employee costs for general and administrative and other support personnel to increase in fiscal 2016 but at a lower rate than the
increase in our revenue less repair payments.
Foreign Exchange Loss / (Gain), Net
Foreign exchange gains or losses, net include:
|
|
|
marked to market gains or losses on derivative instruments that do not qualify for hedge accounting and are deemed ineffective; |
|
|
|
realized foreign currency exchange gains or losses on settlement of transactions in foreign currency and derivative instruments; and |
|
|
|
unrealized foreign currency exchange gains or losses on revaluation of other assets and liabilities. |
Amortization of Intangible Assets
Amortization of
intangible assets is primarily associated with our acquisitions of Marketics in May 2007, Flovate in June 2007, Accidents Happens Assistance Limited (formerly known as Call 24-7), or AHA, in April 2008, BizAps in June 2008, Aviva Global in July 2008
and Fusion in June 2012.
Other Income, Net
Other
income, net comprises interest income, income from investments and other miscellaneous expenses.
Finance Expense
Finance expense primarily relates to interest charges payable on our term loan and short-term borrowings. We expect our finance expense to decline in fiscal
2016 based on reducing debt levels.
Operating Data
Our profit margin is largely a function of our asset utilization and the rates we are able to recover for our services. One of the most significant components
of our asset utilization is our seat utilization rate which is the average number of work shifts per day, out of a maximum of three, for which we are able to utilize our seats. Generally, an improvement in seat utilization rate will improve our
profitability unless there are other factors which increase our costs such as an increase in lease rentals, large ramp-ups to build new seats, and increases in costs related to repairs and renovations to our existing or used seats. In addition, an
increase in seat utilization rate as a result of an increase in the volume of work will generally result in a lower cost per seat and a higher profit margin as the total fixed costs of our built up seats remain the same while each seat is generating
more revenue.
91
The following table presents certain operating data as at the dates indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Total headcount |
|
|
28,890 |
|
|
|
27,020 |
|
|
|
25,520 |
|
Built up seats(1) |
|
|
24,316 |
|
|
|
23,503 |
|
|
|
21,975 |
|
Used seats(1) |
|
|
17,636 |
|
|
|
16,425 |
|
|
|
15,443 |
|
Seat utilization rate(2) |
|
|
1.17 |
|
|
|
1.16 |
|
|
|
1.21 |
|
Notes:
(1) |
Built up seats refer to the total number of production seats (excluding support functions like Finance, Human Resource and Administration) that are set up in any premises. Used seats refer to the number of built up
seats that are being used by employees. The remainder would be termed vacant seats. The vacant seats would get converted into used seats when we increase headcount. |
(2) |
The seat utilization rate is calculated by dividing the average total headcount by the average number of built up seats to show the rate at which we are able to utilize our built up seats. Average total headcount and
average number of built up seats are calculated by dividing the aggregate of the total headcount or number of built up seats, as the case may be, as at the beginning and end of the fiscal year by two. |
We expect our total headcount in fiscal 2016 to increase as compared to fiscal 2015 as the impact of an increased flow of business from new and existing
clients is expected to increase our hiring requirements in fiscal 2016.
Foreign Exchange
Exchange Rates
We report our financial results in
US dollars and our results of operations may be adversely affected if the pound sterling or, to a lesser extent, the Australian dollar depreciates against the US dollar, or the Indian rupee or, to a lesser extent, the South African rand appreciates
against the US dollar. Although a substantial portion of our revenue and revenue less repair payments is denominated in pound sterling (51.5% and 48.5%, respectively, in fiscal 2015, 52.3% and 49.2%, respectively, in fiscal 2014, and 52.4% and
49.8%, respectively, in fiscal 2013), US dollars (32.7% and 34.7%, respectively, in fiscal 2015, 32.5% and 34.7%, respectively, in fiscal 2014, and 35.3% and 37.2%, respectively, in fiscal 2013), and Australian dollars (6.4% and 6.8%, respectively,
in fiscal 2015, 5.6% and 6.0%, respectively, in fiscal 2014, and 3.5% and 3.7%, respectively, in fiscal 2013), most of our expenses (net of payments to repair centers) are incurred and paid in Indian rupees (55.5% in fiscal 2015, 56.1% in fiscal
2014 and 59.0% in fiscal 2013) and, to a lesser extent, in South African rand (8.3% in fiscal 2015, 8.4% in fiscal 2014 and 6.0% in fiscal 2013). The exchange rates between these currencies and the US dollar have changed substantially in recent
years and may fluctuate substantially in the future.
The average Indian rupee to US dollar exchange rate was approximately
61.12 per $1.00 in fiscal 2015, which represented a depreciation of the Indian rupee of 1.2% as compared with the average exchange rate of approximately
60.38 per $1.00 in fiscal 2014, which in turn represented a depreciation of the Indian rupee of 11.0% as compared with the average exchange rate of approximately
54.38 per $1.00 in fiscal 2013.
The average pound sterling to US dollar exchange rate was approximately
£0.620 per $1.00 in fiscal 2015, which represented an appreciation of the pound sterling of 1.5% as compared with the average exchange rate of approximately £0.629 per $1.00 in fiscal 2014, which in turn represented an
appreciation of the pound sterling of 0.6% as compared with the average exchange rate of approximately £0.633 per $1.00 in fiscal 2013.
The
average Australian dollar to US dollar exchange rate was approximately A$0.88 per $1.00 in fiscal 2015, which represented a depreciation of the Australian dollar of 6.1% as compared with the average exchange rate of approximately
A$0.933 per $1.00 in fiscal 2014, which in turn represented a depreciation of the Australian dollar of 9.6% as compared with the average exchange rate of approximately A$1.03 per $1.00 in fiscal 2013.
92
The average South African rand to US dollar exchange rate was approximately R11.1 per $1.00 in fiscal 2015,
which represented a depreciation of the South African rand of 9.4% as compared with the average exchange rate of approximately R10.1 per $1.00 in fiscal 2014, which in turn represented a depreciation of the South African rand of 17.9% as
compared with the average exchange rate of approximately R8.6 per $1.00 in fiscal 2013.
The depreciation of the Indian rupee against the US dollar by
1.2% in fiscal 2015 as compared to the average exchange rate in fiscal 2014 and by 11.0% as compared to the average exchange rate in fiscal 2013 has had a positive impact on our expenses in fiscal 2015 and 2014, respectively. As a result, increases
in our cost of revenue, and to a lesser extent, our general and administrative expenses were partially offset by the impact of the depreciation of Indian rupee in fiscal 2015 and increases in our cost of revenue, and to a lesser extent, our general
and administrative expenses and selling and marketing expenses were partially offset by the impact of the depreciation of Indian rupee in fiscal 2014. The appreciation of the pound sterling and depreciation of the South African rand against the
US dollar in fiscal 2015 and 2014 has positively impacted our results of operations, whereas the depreciation of the Australian dollar has negatively impacted our results of operations. See Part I Item 11. Quantitative and
Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk B. Risk Management Procedures Components of Market Risk Exchange Rate Risk.
We have
subsidiaries in several countries and hence, the functional currencies of these entities differ from our reporting currency, the US dollar. The financial statements of these entities are translated to the reporting currency as at the balance sheet
date. Adjustments resulting from the translation of these financial statements from functional currency to reporting currency are accumulated and reported as other comprehensive income (loss), which is a separate component of equity. Foreign
currency transaction gains and losses are recorded as other income or expense.
Currency Regulation
Our Indian subsidiaries are registered as exporters of business process management services with STPI or SEZ. According to the prevailing foreign exchange
regulations in India, an exporter of business process management services registered with STPI or SEZ is required to receive its export proceeds in India within a period of 12 months from the date of such exports in order to avail itself of the
tax and other benefits. In the event that such a registered exporter has received any advance against exports in foreign exchange from its overseas customers, it is required to render the requisite services so that such advances are earned within a
period of 12 months from the date of such receipt. If such a registered exporter does not meet these conditions, it will be required to obtain permission from the Reserve Bank of India to receive and realize such foreign currency earnings.
A majority of the payments we receive from our clients are denominated in pound sterling, US dollars and Euros. For most of our clients, our subsidiaries in
Mauritius, the Netherlands, the UK and the US enter into contractual agreements directly with our clients for the provision of business process management services by our Indian subsidiaries, which hold the foreign currency receipts in an export
earners foreign currency account. All foreign exchange requirements, such as for the import of capital goods, expenses incurred during overseas travel by employees and discharge of foreign exchange expenses or liabilities, can be met using the
foreign currency in the export earners foreign currency account in India. As and when funds are required by us, the funds in the export earners foreign currency account may be transferred to an ordinary rupee-denominated account in
India.
There are currently no Jersey, UK or US foreign exchange control restrictions on the payment of dividends on our ordinary shares or on the conduct
of our operations.
Income Taxes
We operate in
multiple tax jurisdictions including Australia, China, Costa Rica, India, Mauritius, the Netherlands, Romania, the Philippines, Poland, Singapore, South Africa, Sri Lanka, United Arab Emirates, the UK and the US. As a result, our effective tax
rate will change from year to year based on recurring factors such as the geographical mix of income before taxes, state and local taxes, the ratio of permanent items to pre-tax book income and the implementation of various global tax strategies, as
well as non-recurring events.
In fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013, our tax rate in India and Sri Lanka impacted our effective tax rate. We would have incurred
approximately $3.0 million, $1.7 million and $0.8 million in additional income tax expense on our operations in Sri Lanka and on our SEZ operations in India for fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively, if the tax holidays and exemptions as
described below had not been available for the respective periods.
We expect our tax rate in India and Sri Lanka and, to a lesser extent, the Philippines
to continue to impact our effective tax rate. Our tax rate in India have been impacted by the reduction in the tax exemption enjoyed by our delivery center located in Gurgaon under the SEZ scheme from 100.0% to 50.0% starting from fiscal 2013.
However, we expect to expand the operations in our delivery centers located in other SEZs that are still in their initial five years of operations and therefore eligible for 100.0% income tax exemption.
93
India
In the past, the majority of our Indian operations were eligible to claim income tax exemption with respect to profits earned from export revenue from
operating units registered under the STPI. The benefit was available for a period of 10 years from the date of commencement of operations, but not beyond March 31, 2011. Effective April 1, 2011, upon the expiration of this tax exemption,
income derived from our operations in India became subject to the prevailing annual tax rate, which is currently 33.99%.
Further, in 2005, the Government
of India implemented the SEZ legislation, with the effect that taxable income of new operations established in designated SEZs may be eligible for a 15-year tax holiday scheme consisting of a complete tax holiday for the initial five years and a
partial tax holiday for the subsequent ten years, subject to the satisfaction of certain capital investment conditions. Our delivery center located in Gurgaon, India and registered under the SEZ scheme is eligible for a 50.0% income tax
exemption from fiscal 2013 to fiscal 2022. During fiscal 2012, we also started operations in delivery centers in Pune, Mumbai and Chennai, India registered under the SEZ scheme, through which we are eligible for a 100.0% income tax exemption
until fiscal 2016 and a 50.0% income tax exemption from fiscal 2017 to fiscal 2026. During fiscal 2015, we commenced operations at our new delivery centers in Gurgaon and Pune in India which were registered under the SEZ scheme and are eligible for
a 100.0% income tax exemption until fiscal 2019, and a 50.0% income tax exemption from fiscal 2020 to fiscal 2029.
The SEZ legislation has been
criticized on economic grounds by the International Monetary Fund and the SEZ legislation may be challenged by certain non-governmental organizations. It is possible that, as a result of such political pressures, the procedure for obtaining benefits
under the SEZ legislation may become more onerous, the types of land eligible for SEZ status may be further restricted or the SEZ legislation may be amended or repealed. Moreover, there is continuing uncertainty as to the governmental and regulatory
approvals required to establish operations in the SEZs or to qualify for the tax benefit. This uncertainty may delay our establishment of additional operations in the SEZs.
In addition to these tax holidays, our Indian subsidiaries are also entitled to certain benefits under relevant state legislation and regulations. These
benefits include the preferential allotment of land in industrial areas developed by state agencies, incentives for captive power generation, rebates and waivers in relation to payments for transfer of property and registration (including for
purchase or lease of premises) and commercial usage of electricity.
Since fiscal 2008, we have become subject to minimum alternate tax, or MAT and we
have been required to pay additional taxes. The Government of India, pursuant to the Indian Finance Act, 2011, has also levied MAT on the book profits earned by the SEZ units at the prevailing tax rate, which is currently 20.96%. To the extent MAT
paid exceeds the actual tax payable on our taxable income we would be able to offset such MAT credits from tax payable in the succeeding ten years, subject to the satisfaction of certain conditions. During fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013, we have offset
$6.4 million, $5.7 million and $1.3 million, respectively, of our MAT payments for earlier years from our increased tax liability based on our taxable income following the expiry of our tax holiday on STPI effective fiscal 2012.
The Government of India may enact new tax legislation that could impact the way we are taxed in the future. For example, the Government of India has clarified
that, with retrospective effect from April 1, 1962, any income accruing or arising directly or indirectly through the transfer of capital assets situated in India will be taxable in India. If any of our transactions are deemed to involve the
direct or indirect transfer of a capital asset located in India, such transactions could be investigated by the Indian tax authorities, which could lead to the issuance of tax assessment orders and a material increase in our tax liability. For
example, we received a request from the relevant income tax authority in India for information relating to our acquisition in July 2008 from Aviva of all the shares of Aviva Global, which owned subsidiaries with assets in India and Sri Lanka.
No allegation or demand for payment of additional tax relating to that transaction has been made yet. The Government of India has issued guidelines on General Anti Avoidance Rule, or the GAAR, which is currently expected to be effective
April 1, 2017, and which is intended to curb sophisticated tax avoidance. Under the GAAR, a business arrangement will be deemed an impermissible avoidance arrangement if the main purpose of the arrangement is to obtain tax benefits.
Although the full implications of the GAAR are presently still unclear, if we are deemed to have violated any of its provisions, we may face an increase to our tax liability. See Part I Item 3. Key Information D. Risk
Factors Risks Related to our Business New tax legislation and the results of actions by taxing authorities may have an adverse effect on our operations and our overall tax rate.
94
Sri Lanka
Our operations in Sri Lanka are also eligible for tax exemptions. One of our Sri Lankan subsidiaries was eligible to claim income tax exemption with respect to
profits earned from export revenue by our delivery center registered with the Board of Investments. This tax exemption expired in fiscal 2011, however, effective fiscal 2012, the Government of Sri Lanka has exempted the profits earned from export
revenue from tax. This has enabled our Sri Lankan subsidiary to continue to claim tax exemption under the Sri Lanka Inland Revenue Act following the expiry of the tax exemption.
Philippines
Our subsidiary in the Philippines,
WNS Global Services Philippines, Inc. located in Eastwood Avenue, Manila was also eligible to claim income tax exemption with respect to profits earned from export revenue by our delivery centers registered with the Philippines Economic Zone
Authority, which expired in fiscal 2015 and we intend to apply for an extension until fiscal 2016, which is subject to fulfillment of certain conditions. During fiscal 2013, we started operations in a delivery center in the Philippines located in
Techno Plaza II, Manila which is also eligible for a tax exemption that will expire in fiscal 2017. Following the expiry of the tax exemption, income generated by WNS Global Services Philippines, Inc. will be taxed at the prevailing special tax
rate, which is currently 5.0% on gross income.
Costa Rica
Our subsidiary in Costa Rica is also eligible for a 100.0% income tax exemption from fiscal 2010 until fiscal 2017 and a 50.0% income tax exemption from fiscal
2018 to fiscal 2021.
Critical Accounting Policies
The discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations are based on our consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this
annual report which have been prepared in accordance IFRS, as issued by the IASB. Note 2 to our consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this annual report describes our significant accounting policies and is an essential part of our
consolidated financial statements.
We believe the following to be critical accounting policies. By critical accounting policies, we mean
policies that are both important to the portrayal of our financial condition and financial results and require critical management judgments and estimates. Although we believe that our judgments and estimates are appropriate, actual future results
may differ from our estimates.
Revenue Recognition
We derive revenue from providing BPM services to our clients, which primarily include providing back office administration, data management, contact center
management and automobile claims handling services. We recognize revenue when the significant terms of the arrangement are enforceable, services are being delivered and the collectability is reasonably assured. We recognize revenue on an accrual
basis when services are performed.
When the terms of the agreement specify service level parameters that must be met, we monitor such service level
parameters and determine if there are any service credits or penalties that we need to account for. Revenue is recognized net of any service credits that are due to a client. Generally, our revenue is from large companies, where we do not believe we
have a significant credit risk.
We invoice our clients depending on the terms of the arrangement, which include billing based on a per employee basis, a
per transaction basis, a fixed price basis, an outcome based basis or other pricing arrangements including cost-plus arrangements. Amounts billed or payments received, where all the conditions for revenue recognition have not been met, are recorded
as deferred revenue and are recognized as revenue when all recognition criteria have been met. However, the costs related to the performance of BPM services unrelated to transition services (discussed below) are recognized in the period in which the
services are rendered. An upfront payment received towards future services is recognized ratably over the period when such services are provided.
For
certain of our clients, we perform transition activities at the outset of entering into a new contract for the provision of BPM services. We have determined these transition activities do not meet the revenue recognition criteria to be accounted for
as a separate unit of accounting with stand-alone value separate from the on-going BPM contract. Accordingly, transition revenue and costs are subsequently recognized ratably over the period in which the BPM services are performed. Further, the
deferral of costs is limited to the amount of the deferred revenue. Any costs in excess of the deferred transition revenue are recognized in the period it was incurred.
95
In limited instances, we have entered into minimum commitment arrangements that provide for a minimum revenue
commitment on an annual basis or a cumulative basis over multiple years, stated in terms of annual minimum amounts. Where a minimum commitment is specific to an annual period, any revenue shortfall is invoiced and recognized at the end of this
period.
Our revenue is net of value-added taxes and includes reimbursements of out-of-pocket expenses, with the corresponding out-of-pocket expenses
included in cost of revenue.
We provide automobile claims handling services, which include claims handling and administration (which we refer to as
claims handling), car hire and arranging for repairs with repair centers across the UK and the related payment processing for such repairs (which we refer to as repair management).
We also provide services where motorists involved in accidents were not at fault. Our service offerings include the provision of replacement hire vehicles
(which we refer to as credit hire), repair management services and claims handling (which we collectively refer to as accident management).
With respect to claims handling, we enter into contracts with our clients to process all their claims over the contract period, where the fees are determined
either on a per claim basis or a fixed payment for the contract period. Where our contracts are on a per claim basis, we invoice the client at the inception of the claim process. We estimate the processing period for the claims and recognize revenue
over the estimated processing period. This processing period generally ranges between one to two months. The processing time may be greater for new clients and the estimated service period is adjusted accordingly. The processing period is estimated
based on historical experience and other relevant factors, if any. Where the fee is a fixed payment for the contract period, revenue is recognized on a straight line basis over the period of the contract. In certain cases, where the fee is
contingent upon the successful recovery of a claim by the client, revenue is not recognized until the contingency is resolved. Revenue in respect of car hire is recognized over the car hire term.
In order to provide repair management services, we arrange for the repair of vehicles involved in an accident through a network of repair centers. The repair
costs are invoiced to customers. In determining whether the receipt from the customers related to payments to repair centers should be recognized as revenue, we consider the criteria established by IAS 18, Illustrative example (IE) 21
Determining whether an entity is acting as a principal or as an agent. When we determine that we are the principal in providing repair management services, amounts received from customers are recognized and presented as third
party revenue and the payments to repair centers are recognized as cost of revenue in the consolidated statement of income.
Factors considered in
determining whether we are the principal in the transaction include whether:
(a) |
we have the primary responsibility of providing the services, |
(b) |
we negotiate the labor rates with repair centers, |
(c) |
we are responsible for timely and satisfactory completion of repairs, and |
(d) |
we bear the risk that the customer may not pay for the services provided (credit risk). |
If there are
circumstances where the above criteria are not met and therefore we are not the principal in providing repair management services, amounts received from customers are recognized and presented net of payments to repair centers in the consolidated
statement of income. Revenue from repair management services is recorded net of the repairer referral fees passed on to customers.
96
Share-based Compensation
We provide share-based awards such as share options and RSUs to our employees, directors and executive officers through various equity compensation plans. We
account for share-based compensation expense relating to share-based payments using a fair-value method in accordance with IFRS 2, Share-based Payments. IFRS 2 addresses the accounting for share-based payment transactions in which
an enterprise receives employee services in exchange for equity instruments of the enterprise or liabilities that are based on the fair value of the enterprises equity instruments or that may be settled by the issuance of such equity
instruments.
Equity instruments granted is measured by reference to the fair value of the instrument at the date of grant. The grants vest in a graded
manner. Under the fair value method, the estimated fair value of awards is charged to income over the requisite service period, which is generally the vesting period of the award, for each separately vesting portion of the award as if the award was,
in substance, multiple awards. We include a forfeiture estimate in the amount of compensation expense being recognized based on our estimate of equity instrument that will eventually vest.
IFRS 2 requires the use of a valuation model to calculate the fair value of share-based awards. Based on our judgment, we have elected to use the
Black-Scholes-Merton pricing model to determine the fair value of share-based awards on the date of grant. RSUs are measured based on the fair market value of the underlying shares on the date of grant.
We believe the Black-Scholes-Merton model to be the most appropriate model for determination of fair value of the share-based awards. In determining the fair
value of share-based awards using the Black-Scholes-Merton option pricing model, we are required to make certain estimates of the key assumptions that include expected term, expected volatility of our shares, dividend yield and risk free interest
rate. Estimating these key assumptions involves judgment regarding subjective future expectations of market prices and trends. The assumptions for expected term and expected volatility have the most significant effect on calculating the fair value
of our share options. We use the historical volatility of our ADSs in order to estimate future share price trends. In order to determine the estimated period of time that we expect employees to hold their share-based options, we have used historical
exercise pattern of employees. The aforementioned inputs entered into the option valuation model that we use to determine the fair value of our share awards are subjective estimates and changes to these estimates will cause the fair value of our
share-based awards and related share-based compensation expense we record to vary.
We are required to estimate the share-based awards that we expect to
vest and to reduce share-based compensation expense for the effects of estimated forfeitures of awards over the expense recognition period. Although we estimate forfeitures based on historical experience and other factors, actual forfeitures in the
future may differ. To the extent our actual forfeitures are different than our estimates, we record a true-up for the difference in the period in which the awards vest, and such true-ups could materially affect our operating results.
We record deferred tax assets for share-based awards based on the future tax deduction which will be based on our ADS price at the reporting date. If the
amount of the future tax deduction exceeds the cumulative amount of share-based compensation expense, the excess deferred tax is directly recognized in equity.
Business Combinations, Goodwill and Intangible Assets
Business combinations are accounted for using the acquisition method. As a part of acquisition accounting, we allocate the purchase price of acquired companies
to the identified tangible and intangible assets based on the estimated fair values on the date of the acquisition. The purchase price allocation process requires management to make significant estimates and assumptions, especially at acquisition
date with respect to intangible assets, income taxes, contingent consideration and estimated restructuring liabilities. Although we believe the assumptions and estimates we have made in the past have been reasonable and appropriate, they are based
in part on historical experience and information obtained from the management of the acquired companies and are inherently uncertain. Examples of critical estimates in valuing certain of the intangible assets we have acquired or may acquire in the
future include but are not limited to appropriate method of valuation, future cash flow projections, weighted average cost of capital, discount rates, risk-free rates, market rate of return and risk premiums.
Unanticipated events and circumstances may occur which may affect the accuracy or validity of such assumptions, estimates or actual results.
97
Goodwill is initially measured at cost, being the excess of the cost of the acquisition of the acquiree over our
share of the net fair value of the acquirees identifiable assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities on the date of the acquisition. If the cost of acquisition is less than the fair value of the net assets of the business acquired, the
difference is recognized immediately in the income statement. Goodwill is tested for impairment at least annually and when events occur or changes in circumstances indicate that the recoverable amount of the cash generating unit is less than its
carrying value. The goodwill impairment test is performed at the level of cash-generating unit or groups of cash-generating units which represent the lowest level at which goodwill is monitored for internal management purposes.
We use market related information and estimates (generally risk adjusted discounted cash flows) to determine the fair values. Cash flow projections take into
account past experience and represents managements best estimate about future developments. Key assumptions on which management has based its determination of fair value less costs to sell and value in use include estimated growth rates,
weighted average cost of capital and tax rates. These estimates, including the methodology used, can have a material impact on the respective values and ultimately the amount of any goodwill impairment. See also the discussion on impairment testing
under Impairment of Goodwill and Intangible Assets below.
Intangible assets are recognized only when it is probable that the expected
future economic benefits attributable to the assets will accrue to us and the cost can be reliably measured. Intangible assets acquired separately are measured on initial recognition at cost. The cost of intangible assets acquired in a business
combination is its fair value as at the date of acquisition determined using generally accepted valuation methods appropriate for the type of intangible asset. Following initial recognition, intangible assets are carried at cost less any accumulated
amortization and any accumulated impairment losses. Intangible assets with finite lives are amortized over the estimated useful life and assessed for impairment whenever there is an indication that the intangible asset may be impaired. The
amortization of an intangible asset with a finite useful life reflects the manner in which the economic benefit is expected to be generated and consumed. These estimates are reviewed at least at each financial year end. Intangible assets with
indefinite lives are not amortized, but instead are tested for impairment at least annually and written down to the fair value as required. See also the discussion on impairment testing under Impairment of Goodwill and Intangible
Assets below.
Impairment of Goodwill and Intangible Assets
Goodwill is not subject to amortization and is instead tested annually for impairment and whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the
carrying amount may not be recoverable. Intangible assets that are subject to amortization are reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount may not be recoverable. An impairment loss is
recognized for the amount by which the assets carrying amount exceeds its recoverable amount. The recoverable amount is the higher of an assets fair value less costs to sell and value in use. For the purposes of assessing impairment,
assets are grouped at the cash generating unit level, which is the lowest level for which there are separately identifiable cash flows. Impairment losses recognized in respect of cash generating units are allocated first to reduce the carrying
amount of any goodwill allocated to the cash generating units (or group of cash generating units) and then, to reduce the carrying amount of the other assets in the cash generating unit (or group of cash generating units) on a pro rata basis.
Intangible assets that suffered impairment are reviewed for possible reversal of the impairment at each reporting date.
An impairment loss is recognized
for the amount by which an assets or cash-generating units carrying amount exceeds its recoverable amount. To determine the recoverable amount, management estimates expected future cash flows from each asset or cash-generating unit and
determines a suitable interest rate in order to calculate the present value of those cash flows. In the process of measuring expected future cash flows management makes assumptions about future operating results. These assumptions relate to future
events and circumstances. In arriving at our forecasts, we consider past experience, economic trends and inflation as well as industry and market trends. The projections also take into account factors such as the expected impact from new client
contracts and expansion of business from existing clients, efficiency initiatives, and the maturity of the markets in which each business operates. The actual results may vary, and may cause significant adjustments to our assets within the next
financial year.
In most cases, determining the applicable discount rate involves estimating the appropriate adjustment to market risk and the appropriate
adjustment to asset-specific risk factors.
We cannot predict the occurrence of future events that might adversely affect the reported value of goodwill,
intangible assets. Such events include, but are not limited to, strategic decisions made in response to economic and competitive conditions, the impact of the environment on our customer base, and material negative changes in relationships with
significant customers.
Income Taxes
Income
tax comprises current and deferred tax. Income tax expense is recognized in statements of income except to the extent it relates to items directly recognized in equity, in which case it is recognized in equity.
98
Current Income Tax
As part of the process of preparing our consolidated financial statements, we are required to estimate our income taxes in each of the jurisdictions in which
we operate. We are subject to tax assessments in each of these jurisdictions. Current income taxes for the current and prior periods are measured at the amount expected to be recovered from or paid to the taxation authorities based on the taxable
profit for the period. The tax rates and tax laws used to compute the amount are those that are enacted or substantively enacted by the reporting date and applicable for the period. We offset current tax assets and current tax liabilities, where we
have a legally enforceable right to set off the recognized amounts and where we intend either to settle on a net basis, or to realize the asset and liability simultaneously.
Significant judgments are involved in determining the provision for income taxes including judgment on whether tax positions are probable of being sustained
in tax assessments. A tax assessment can involve complex issues, which can only be resolved over extended time periods. The recognition of taxes that are subject to certain legal or economic limits or uncertainties is assessed individually by
management based on the specific facts and circumstances. Though we have considered all these issues in estimating our income taxes, there could be an unfavorable resolution of such issues that may affect results of our operations.
Deferred Income Tax
We recognize deferred income
tax using the balance sheet approach. Deferred income tax assets and liabilities are recognized for all deductible temporary differences arising between the tax bases of assets and liabilities and their carrying amount in financial statements,
except when the deferred income tax arises from the initial recognition of goodwill or an asset or liability in a transaction that is not a business combination and affects neither accounting nor taxable profits or loss at the time of transaction.
Deferred income tax assets and liabilities are measured at the tax rates that are expected to apply in the period when the asset is realized or the
liability is settled, based on tax rates (and tax laws) that have been enacted or substantively enacted at the reporting date.
Deferred income tax asset
in respect of carry forward of unused tax credits and unused tax losses are recognized to the extent that it is probable that taxable profit will be available against which the deductible temporary differences, and the carry forward of unused tax
credits and unused tax losses can be utilized.
The carrying amount of deferred income tax assets is reviewed at each reporting date and reduced to the
extent that it is no longer probable that sufficient taxable profit will be available to allow all or part of the deferred income tax asset to be utilized.
The measurement of deferred tax assets involves judgment regarding the deductibility of costs not yet subject to taxation and estimates regarding sufficient
future taxable income to enable utilization of unused tax losses in different tax jurisdictions. We consider the expected reversal of deferred tax assets and projected future taxable income in making this assessment. All deferred tax assets are
subject to review of probable utilization. The assessment of the probability of future taxable profit in various years in which deferred tax assets can be utilized is based on the latest approved budget forecast, which is adjusted for significant
non-taxable profit and expenses and specific limits to the use of any unused tax loss or credit. The tax rules in the various jurisdictions in which we operate are also carefully taken into consideration. If a positive forecast of taxable
profit indicates the probable use of a deferred tax asset, especially when it can be utilized without a time limit, that deferred tax asset is usually recognized in full. The recognition of deferred tax assets that are subject to certain legal or
economic limits or uncertainties is assessed individually by management based on the specific facts and circumstances.
We recognize deferred tax
liabilities for all taxable temporary differences, except those associated with investments in subsidiaries and associates where the timing of the reversal of the temporary difference can be controlled and it is probable that the temporary
difference will not reverse in the foreseeable future.
As part of our accounting for business combinations, some of the purchase price is allocated to
goodwill and intangible assets. Impairment charges associated with goodwill are generally not tax deductible and will result in an increased effective income tax rate in the quarter any impairment is recorded. Amortization expenses associated with
acquired intangible assets are generally not tax deductible pursuant to our existing tax structure; however, deferred taxes have been recorded for non-deductible amortization expenses as a part of the purchase price allocation process. We have taken
into account the allocation of these identified intangibles among different taxing jurisdictions, including those with nominal or zero percent tax rates, in establishing the related deferred tax liabilities. Income tax contingencies existing as of
the acquisition dates of the acquired companies are evaluated quarterly and any adjustments are recorded as adjustments to goodwill during the measurement period.
99
Uncertainties in income taxes are not addressed specifically in IAS12 Income Taxes and hence
the general measurement principles in IAS12 are applied in measuring the uncertain tax positions. Uncertain tax positions are reflected at the amount likely to be paid to the taxation authorities. A liability is recognized in connection with each
item that is not probable of being sustained on examination by taxing authority. The liability is measured using single best estimate of the most likely outcome for each position taken in the tax return. Thus the provision would be the aggregate
liability in connection with all uncertain tax positions. We also include interest related to such uncertain tax positions within our provision for income tax expense.
Evaluation of tax positions and recognition of provisions, as discussed above, involves interpretation of tax laws, estimates of probabilities of tax
positions being sustained and the amounts of payments to be made under various scenarios. Although we believe we are adequately reserved for our unresolved disputes with the taxation authorities, no assurance can be given with respect to the final
outcome on these matters. To the extent that the final outcome on these matters is different than the amounts recorded, such differences will impact our provision for income taxes in the period in which such a determination is made.
Derivative Financial Instruments and Hedge Accounting
We are exposed to foreign currency fluctuations on foreign currency assets, liabilities, net investment in foreign operations, forecasted cash flows
denominated in foreign currency and fluctuation in interest rates. We limit the effect of foreign exchange rate fluctuation by following established risk management policies including the use of derivatives. We enter into derivative financial
instruments where the counter party is a bank. We use derivative financial instruments such as foreign exchange forward, option contracts, currency swaps and interest rate swaps to hedge certain foreign currency and interest rate exposures. Forward
and option contracts on various foreign currencies are entered into to manage the foreign currency exchange rate risk on forecasted transactions denominated in foreign currencies and monetary assets and liabilities held in non-functional currencies.
Interest rate swaps are entered into to manage interest rate risk associated with floating rate borrowings. Our primary exchange rate exposure is with the US dollars, pound sterling and the Indian rupee.
Cash Flow Hedges
We recognize derivative
instruments as either assets or liabilities in the statement of financial position at fair value. Derivative instruments qualify for hedge accounting when the instrument is designated as a hedge; the hedged item is specifically identifiable and
exposes us to risk; and it is expected that a change in fair value of the derivative instrument and an opposite change in the fair value of the hedged item will have a high degree of correlation. Determining that there is a high degree of
correlation between the change in fair value of the hedged item and the derivative instruments involves significant judgment including the probability of the occurrence of the forecasted transaction. Although our estimates of the forecasted
transactions are based on historical experience and we believe that they are reasonable, the final occurrence of such transactions could be different as a result of external factors such as industry and economic trends, and internal factors such as
changes in our business strategy and our internal forecasts, which will have a material effect on our earnings.
For derivative instruments where hedge
accounting is applied, we record the effective portion of derivative instruments that are designated as cash flow hedges in other comprehensive income (loss) in the statement of comprehensive income, which is reclassified into earnings in the same
period during which the hedged item affects earnings and disclosed as a part of revenue, foreign exchange loss/(gains), net and finance expense, as applicable. The remaining gain or loss on the derivative instrument in excess of the cumulative
change in the present value of future cash flows of the hedged item, if any (i.e., the ineffective portion) or hedge components excluded from the assessment of effectiveness, and changes in fair value of other derivative instruments not designated
as qualifying hedges is recorded as gains/losses, net in the statement of income. Cash flows from the derivative instruments are classified within cash flows from operating activities in the statement of cash flows.
Fair Value Measurements
IFRS 13 Fair
Value Measurements (IFRS 13) defines fair value as the amount for which an asset could be exchanged, or a liability settled, between knowledgeable, willing parties in an arms length transaction. The fair value of
financial instruments that are traded in active markets at each reporting date is determined by reference to quoted market prices or dealer price quotations, without any deduction for transaction costs. For financial instruments not traded in an
active market, the fair value is determined using appropriate valuation models. Where applicable, these models project future cash flows and discount the future amounts to a present value using market-based observable inputs including interest rate
curves, credit risk, foreign exchange rates, and forward and spot prices for currencies.
100
IFRS 7 Financial Instruments: Disclosures also requires the classification of fair value
measurements using fair value hierarchy that reflects the significance of the inputs used in making the measurements as below:
Level 1 quoted
prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets or liabilities;
Level 2 other techniques for which all inputs which have a significant
effect on the recorded fair value are observable, either directly or indirectly; and
Level 3 techniques which use inputs which have a significant
effect on the recorded fair value that are not based on observable market data.
The fair value is estimated using the discounted cash flow approach and
market rates of interest. The valuation technique involves assumptions and judgments regarding risk characteristics of the instruments, discount rates and future cash flows.
Management uses valuation techniques in measuring the fair value of financial instruments, where active market quotes are not available. In applying the
valuation techniques, management makes maximum use of market inputs, and uses estimates and assumptions that are, as far as possible, consistent with observable data that market participants would use in pricing the instrument. Where applicable data
is not observable, management uses its best estimate about the assumptions that market participants would make. These estimates may vary from the actual prices that would be achieved in an arms length transaction at the reporting date.
Other Estimates
Allowance for Doubtful
Accounts
We make estimates of the uncollectability of our accounts receivable based on historical trends and other factors such as ageing and economic
trends. Adverse economic conditions or other factors that might cause deterioration of the financial health of customers could change the timing and levels of payments received and necessitate a change in estimated losses.
Accounting for Defined Benefit Plans
In accounting for
pension and post-retirement benefits, several statistical and other factors that attempt to anticipate future events are used to calculate plan expenses and liabilities. These factors include expected return on plan assets, discount rate assumptions
and rate of future compensation increases. To estimate these factors, actuarial consultants also use estimates such as withdrawal, turnover, and mortality rates which require significant judgment. The actuarial assumptions used by us may differ
materially from actual results in future periods due to changing market and economic conditions, regulatory events, judicial rulings, higher or lower withdrawal rates, or longer or shorter participant life spans.
Results of Operations
The following table sets forth
certain financial information as a percentage of revenue and revenue less repair payments:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As a percentage of |
|
|
|
Revenue |
|
|
Revenue less repair payments |
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Cost of revenue |
|
|
64.2 |
% |
|
|
65.2 |
% |
|
|
67.6 |
% |
|
|
62.0 |
% |
|
|
62.9 |
% |
|
|
65.8 |
% |
Gross profit |
|
|
35.8 |
% |
|
|
34.8 |
% |
|
|
32.4 |
% |
|
|
38.0 |
% |
|
|
37.1 |
% |
|
|
34.2 |
% |
Operating expenses: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Selling and marketing expenses |
|
|
5.8 |
% |
|
|
7.0 |
% |
|
|
6.6 |
% |
|
|
6.2 |
% |
|
|
7.5 |
% |
|
|
6.9 |
% |
General and administrative expenses |
|
|
13.1 |
% |
|
|
11.0 |
% |
|
|
12.4 |
% |
|
|
13.9 |
% |
|
|
11.7 |
% |
|
|
13.1 |
% |
Foreign exchange loss / (gains), net |
|
|
(0.9 |
)% |
|
|
2.2 |
% |
|
|
1.2 |
% |
|
|
(0.9 |
)% |
|
|
2.4 |
% |
|
|
1.3 |
% |
Amortization of intangible assets |
|
|
4.5 |
% |
|
|
4.7 |
% |
|
|
5.7 |
% |
|
|
4.8 |
% |
|
|
5.0 |
% |
|
|
6.0 |
% |
Operating profit |
|
|
13.2 |
% |
|
|
9.8 |
% |
|
|
6.5 |
% |
|
|
14.0 |
% |
|
|
10.5 |
% |
|
|
6.9 |
% |
Other (income) / expense, net |
|
|
(2.2 |
)% |
|
|
(1.9 |
)% |
|
|
(1.0 |
)% |
|
|
(2.4 |
)% |
|
|
(2.0 |
)% |
|
|
(1.1 |
)% |
Finance expense |
|
|
0.2 |
% |
|
|
0.6 |
% |
|
|
0.8 |
% |
|
|
0.3 |
% |
|
|
0.6 |
% |
|
|
0.8 |
% |
Provision for income taxes |
|
|
4.2 |
% |
|
|
2.8 |
% |
|
|
2.1 |
% |
|
|
4.5 |
% |
|
|
3.0 |
% |
|
|
2.3 |
% |
Profit |
|
|
11.0 |
% |
|
|
8.3 |
% |
|
|
4.6 |
% |
|
|
11.7 |
% |
|
|
8.8 |
% |
|
|
4.9 |
% |
101
The following table reconciles revenue (a GAAP financial measure) to revenue less repair payments (a non-GAAP
financial measure) and sets forth payments to repair centers and revenue less repair payments as a percentage of revenue:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenue |
|
$ |
533.9 |
|
|
$ |
502.6 |
|
|
$ |
460.3 |
|
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
Less: Payments to repair centers |
|
|
30.9 |
|
|
|
31.1 |
|
|
|
24.1 |
|
|
|
5.8 |
% |
|
|
6.2 |
% |
|
|
5.2 |
% |
Revenue less repair payments |
|
$ |
503.0 |
|
|
$ |
471.5 |
|
|
$ |
436.1 |
|
|
|
94.2 |
% |
|
|
93.8 |
% |
|
|
94.8 |
% |
The following table presents our results of operations for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Revenue |
|
$ |
533.9 |
|
|
$ |
502.6 |
|
|
$ |
460.3 |
|
Cost of revenue(1) |
|
|
342.7 |
|
|
|
327.7 |
|
|
|
311.0 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Gross profit |
|
|
191.2 |
|
|
|
174.9 |
|
|
|
149.3 |
|
Operating expenses: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Selling and marketing expenses(2) |
|
|
31.1 |
|
|
|
35.2 |
|
|
|
30.2 |
|
General and administrative expenses(3) |
|
|
70.0 |
|
|
|
55.4 |
|
|
|
57.1 |
|
Foreign exchange loss / (gains), net |
|
|
(4.6 |
) |
|
|
11.2 |
|
|
|
5.5 |
|
Amortization of intangible assets |
|
|
24.2 |
|
|
|
23.8 |
|
|
|
26.4 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Operating profit |
|
|
70.5 |
|
|
|
49.4 |
|
|
|
30.1 |
|
Other income, net |
|
|
(11.9 |
) |
|
|
(9.5 |
) |
|
|
(4.8 |
) |
Finance expense |
|
|
1.3 |
|
|
|
2.9 |
|
|
|
3.6 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Profit before income taxes |
|
|
81.0 |
|
|
|
55.9 |
|
|
|
31.3 |
|
Provision for income taxes |
|
|
22.4 |
|
|
|
14.3 |
|
|
|
9.9 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Profit |
|
$ |
58.6 |
|
|
$ |
41.6 |
|
|
$ |
21.4 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Notes:
(1) |
Includes share-based compensation expense of $0.9 million for fiscal 2015, $1.3 million for fiscal 2014 and $1.0 million for fiscal 2013. |
(2) |
Includes share-based compensation expense of $0.8 million for fiscal 2015, $0.6 million for fiscal 2014 and $0.4 million for fiscal 2013. |
(3) |
Includes share-based compensation expense of $7.9 million for fiscal 2015, $5.0 million for fiscal 2014 and $3.9 million for fiscal 2013. |
Fiscal 2015 Compared to Fiscal 2014
The following
table sets forth our revenue and percentage change in revenue for the periods indicated:
Revenue
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
% Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenue |
|
$ |
533.9 |
|
|
$ |
502.6 |
|
|
$ |
31.3 |
|
|
|
6.2 |
% |
102
The increase in revenue of $31.3 million was primarily attributable to revenue from new clients of $17.5 million
and an increase in revenue from existing clients of $4.7 million. In addition, we had an increase in hedging gain on our revenue by $9.1 million to $2.9 million in fiscal 2015 from a hedging loss of $6.2 million in fiscal 2014. The increase in
revenue was primarily due to higher volumes in our utilities, shipping and logistics, consulting and professional services and healthcare verticals, and included approximately $3.0 million of one-time benefits received in fiscal 2015 relating to
performance-based incentives, gain sharing and the removal of foreign exchange collars from certain client contracts. The increase in revenue was partially offset by the impact of a lower volume of business from one of our top five clients by
revenue contribution in fiscal 2014 and 2013, a reduction in pricing and productivity discounts under our new contract with Aviva MS and lower volumes in our banking and financial services vertical. Further our research and analytics and finance and
accounting units grew by 16.4% and 14.1%, respectively, in fiscal 2015 and now represent 12.5% and 20.0%, respectively, of our revenue in fiscal 2015.
Revenue by Geography
The following table sets forth the
composition of our revenue based on the location of our clients in our key geographies for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenue |
|
|
As a percentage of revenue |
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
UK |
|
$ |
281.9 |
|
|
$ |
265.0 |
|
|
|
52.8 |
% |
|
|
52.7 |
% |
North America (primarily the US) |
|
|
138.5 |
|
|
|
137.4 |
|
|
|
25.9 |
% |
|
|
27.3 |
% |
Europe (excluding the UK) |
|
|
28.8 |
|
|
|
27.0 |
|
|
|
5.4 |
% |
|
|
5.4 |
% |
South Africa |
|
|
17.4 |
|
|
|
20.5 |
|
|
|
3.3 |
% |
|
|
4.1 |
% |
Australia |
|
|
34.2 |
|
|
|
18.5 |
|
|
|
6.4 |
% |
|
|
3.7 |
% |
Rest of world |
|
|
33.1 |
|
|
|
34.2 |
|
|
|
6.2 |
% |
|
|
6.8 |
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
533.9 |
|
|
$ |
502.6 |
|
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The increase in revenue from the UK region was primarily attributable to higher volumes in our shipping and logistics, banking
and financial services, healthcare, travel and utilities verticals, partially offset by a reduction in pricing and productivity discounts under our new contract with Aviva MS. The increase in revenue from Australia region was primarily attributable
to higher volumes in our insurance and utilities verticals. The increase in revenue from Europe (excluding the UK) region was primarily due to higher volumes in our healthcare, retail and CPG, consulting and professional services, shipping and
logistics, and insurance verticals. The increase in revenue in North America (primarily the US) was primarily due to higher volumes in our healthcare vertical, partially offset by lower volumes in our insurance, consulting and professional services
and utilities verticals and the impact of a lower volume of business from one of our top five clients by revenue contribution in fiscal 2014 and 2013. The decrease in revenue from South Africa region was primarily attributable to lower volumes in
our banking and financial services vertical. The decrease in revenue from the Rest of world region was primarily attributable to lower volumes in our consulting and professional services and insurance verticals, partially offset by higher volumes in
our travel, healthcare, retail and CPG, and shipping and logistics verticals.
Revenue Less Repair Payments
The following table sets forth our revenue less repair payment and percentage change in revenue less repair payments for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
% Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in million) |
|
|
|
|
Revenue less repair payments |
|
$ |
503.0 |
|
|
$ |
471.5 |
|
|
$ |
31.5 |
|
|
|
6.7 |
% |
103
The increase in revenue less repair payments of $31.5 million was primarily attributable to revenue less repair
payments from new clients of $17.5 million and an increase in revenue less repair payments from existing clients of $4.7 million. In addition, we had an increase in hedging gain on our revenue less repair payments by $9.1 million to $2.9
million in fiscal 2015 from a hedging loss of $6.2 million in fiscal 2014. The increase in revenue less repair payments was primarily due to higher volumes in our utilities, shipping and logistics, consulting and professional services and healthcare
verticals, and included $3.0 million of one-time benefits received in fiscal 2015 relating to performance-based incentives, gain sharing and removal of foreign exchange collars from certain client contracts. The increase in revenue less repair
payments was partially offset by the impact of a lower volume of business from one of our top five clients by revenue less repair payments contribution in fiscal 2014 and 2013, a reduction in pricing and productivity discounts under our new contract
with Aviva MS and lower volumes in our banking and financial services vertical. Further our research and analytics and finance and accounting units grew by 16.4% and 14.1%, respectively, in fiscal 2015 and now represent 13.2% and 21.2%,
respectively, of our revenue less repair payments in fiscal 2015.
Revenue Less Repair Payments by Geography
The following table sets forth the composition of our revenue less repair payments based on the location of our clients in our key geographies for the periods
indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenue less repair payments |
|
|
As a percentage of revenue less repair payments |
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
UK |
|
$ |
251.1 |
|
|
$ |
233.8 |
|
|
|
49.9 |
% |
|
|
49.6 |
% |
North America (primarily the US) |
|
|
138.5 |
|
|
|
137.4 |
|
|
|
27.5 |
% |
|
|
29.1 |
% |
Europe (excluding the UK) |
|
|
28.8 |
|
|
|
27.1 |
|
|
|
5.7 |
% |
|
|
5.7 |
% |
South Africa |
|
|
17.4 |
|
|
|
20.5 |
|
|
|
3.5 |
% |
|
|
4.4 |
% |
Australia |
|
|
34.2 |
|
|
|
18.5 |
|
|
|
6.8 |
% |
|
|
3.9 |
% |
Rest of world |
|
|
33.1 |
|
|
|
34.2 |
|
|
|
6.6 |
% |
|
|
7.4 |
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
503.0 |
|
|
$ |
471.5 |
|
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The increase in revenue less repair payments from the UK region was primarily attributable to higher volumes in our shipping
and logistics, banking and financial services, healthcare, travel and utilities verticals, partially offset by a reduction in pricing and productivity discounts under our new contract with Aviva MS. The increase in revenue less repair payments from
Australia region was primarily attributable to higher volumes in our insurance and utilities verticals. The increase in revenue less repair payments from Europe (excluding the UK) region was primarily due to higher volumes in our healthcare, retail
and CPG, consulting and professional services, shipping and logistics, and insurance verticals. The increase in revenue less repair payments in North America (primarily the US) was primarily due to higher volumes in our healthcare vertical,
partially offset by lower volumes in our insurance, consulting and professional services and utilities verticals and the impact of a lower volume of business from one of our top five clients by revenue less repair payments contribution in fiscal
2014 and 2013. The decrease in revenue less repair payments from South Africa region was primarily attributable to lower volumes in our banking and financial services vertical. The decrease in revenue less repair payments from the Rest of world
region was primarily attributable to lower volumes in our consulting and professional services and insurance verticals, partially offset by higher volumes in our travel, healthcare, retail and CPG, and shipping and logistics verticals.
104
Cost of Revenue
The following table sets forth the composition of our cost of revenue for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Employee costs |
|
$ |
199.8 |
|
|
$ |
184.7 |
|
|
$ |
15.1 |
|
Facilities costs |
|
|
64.7 |
|
|
|
61.3 |
|
|
|
3.3 |
|
Repair payments |
|
|
30.9 |
|
|
|
31.1 |
|
|
|
(0.2 |
) |
Depreciation |
|
|
13.9 |
|
|
|
13.5 |
|
|
|
0.4 |
|
Travel costs |
|
|
9.5 |
|
|
|
10.9 |
|
|
|
(1.4 |
) |
Legal and professional costs |
|
|
7.3 |
|
|
|
10.9 |
|
|
|
(3.5 |
) |
Other costs |
|
|
16.8 |
|
|
|
15.3 |
|
|
|
1.4 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total cost of revenue |
|
$ |
342.7 |
|
|
$ |
327.7 |
|
|
$ |
15.0 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As a percentage of revenue |
|
|
64.2 |
% |
|
|
65.2 |
% |
|
|
|
|
The increase in cost of revenue was primarily due to an increase in employee costs due to higher headcount and wage
increments, an increase in facilities costs due to an expansion of facilities in Pune and Chennai, India and the addition of new facilities in US, South Africa and China and an increase in other costs due to an increase in costs associated with
providing onshore services and subcontract costs, partially offset by a decrease in legal and professional services due to a decrease in onshore subcontracting costs and a decrease in travel costs. Further, the depreciation of the Indian rupee
against the US dollar by an average of 1.2% in fiscal 2015 as compared to the average exchange rate in fiscal 2014 resulted in an overall decrease of approximately $2.0 million in the cost of revenue.
Gross Profit
The following table sets forth our gross
profit for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Gross profit |
|
$ |
191.2 |
|
|
$ |
174.9 |
|
|
$ |
16.2 |
|
As a percentage of revenue |
|
|
35.8 |
% |
|
|
34.8 |
% |
|
|
|
|
As a percentage of revenue less repair payments |
|
|
38.0 |
% |
|
|
37.1 |
% |
|
|
|
|
Gross profit was higher primarily due to higher revenue as discussed above. Gross profit as a percentage of revenue and
revenue less repair payments similarly increased primarily due to higher revenue as discussed above. We had an increase in hedging gain on our revenue less repair payments by $9.1 million to $2.9 million in fiscal 2015 from a hedging loss of $6.2
million in fiscal 2014. Further, the depreciation of the Indian rupee against the US dollar in fiscal 2015 by an average of 1.2% as compared to the average exchange rate in fiscal 2014 partially reduced our cost of revenue.
During fiscal 2015, our built up seats increased by 3.5% from 23,503 as at the end of fiscal 2014 to 24,316 as at the end of fiscal 2015 when we expanded
facilities in Pune and Chennai, India and the addition of new facilities in US, South Africa and China. This was part of our strategy to expand our delivery capabilities, including in the SEZ in India. Our total headcount increased by 6.9% from
27,020 to 28,890 during the same period, resulting in an increase in our seat utilization rate from 1.16 in fiscal 2014 to 1.17 in fiscal 2015. This 0.1 increase in our seat utilization rate increased our gross profit as a percentage of revenue by
approximately 0.01% and increased our gross profit as a percentage of revenue less repair payments by approximately 0.02%.
105
Selling and Marketing Expenses
The following table sets forth the composition of our selling and marketing expenses for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Employee costs |
|
$ |
23.1 |
|
|
$ |
26.4 |
|
|
$ |
(3.3 |
) |
Other costs |
|
|
8.0 |
|
|
|
8.8 |
|
|
|
(0.8 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total selling and marketing expenses |
|
$ |
31.1 |
|
|
$ |
35.2 |
|
|
$ |
(4.2 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As a percentage of revenue |
|
|
5.8 |
% |
|
|
7.0 |
% |
|
|
|
|
As a percentage of revenue less repair payments |
|
|
6.2 |
% |
|
|
7.5 |
% |
|
|
|
|
The decrease in selling and marketing expenses was primarily due to a decrease in employee costs as a result of a decrease in
sales headcount, and lower legal and professional expenses and marketing costs.
General and Administrative Expenses
The following table sets forth the composition of our general and administrative expenses for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Employee costs |
|
$ |
48.3 |
|
|
$ |
39.8 |
|
|
$ |
8.5 |
|
Other costs |
|
|
21.7 |
|
|
|
15.6 |
|
|
|
6.1 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total general and administrative expenses |
|
$ |
70.0 |
|
|
$ |
55.4 |
|
|
$ |
14.6 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As a percentage of revenue |
|
|
13.1 |
% |
|
|
11.0 |
% |
|
|
|
|
As a percentage of revenue less repair payments |
|
|
13.9 |
% |
|
|
11.7 |
% |
|
|
|
|
The increase in general and administrative expenses was primarily due to an increase in employee costs as a result of higher
salaries, higher other costs including facilities costs and miscellaneous costs, including additional costs related to increased corporate social responsibility spending as mandated by the Indian Companies Act, 2013.
Foreign Exchange Loss / (Gains), Net
The following table
sets forth our foreign exchange loss / (gains), net for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Foreign exchange loss / (gains), net |
|
$ |
(4.6 |
) |
|
$ |
11.2 |
|
|
$ |
(15.7 |
) |
The higher foreign exchange gains were primarily due to higher hedging gains of $16.4 million from our rupee-denominated
contracts as a result of better hedging rates against the US dollar, partially offset by higher foreign currency revaluation losses by $0.6 million to a loss of $1.2 million in fiscal 2015 from a loss of $0.6 million in fiscal 2014.
106
Amortization of Intangible Assets
The following table sets forth our amortization of intangible assets for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Amortization of intangible assets |
|
$ |
24.2 |
|
|
$ |
23.8 |
|
|
$ |
0.4 |
|
The increase in amortization of intangible assets was primarily attributable to an increase in software related assets from
our India facilities, partially offset by the depreciation of the Indian rupee against the US dollar in fiscal 2015 by an average of 1.2% as compared to the average exchange rate in fiscal 2014.
Operating Profit
The following table sets forth our
operating profit for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Operating profit |
|
$ |
70.5 |
|
|
$ |
49.4 |
|
|
$ |
21.1 |
|
As a percentage of revenue |
|
|
13.2 |
% |
|
|
9.8 |
% |
|
|
|
|
As a percentage of revenue less repair payments |
|
|
14.0 |
% |
|
|
10.5 |
% |
|
|
|
|
Operating profit as a percentage of revenue and revenue less repair payments is higher due to higher revenue, higher foreign
exchanges gains and lower selling and marketing expenses, partially offset by higher general and administrative expenses, higher cost of revenue and higher amortization expenses.
Other income, net
The following table sets forth our
other income, net for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Other income, net |
|
$ |
11.9 |
|
|
$ |
9.5 |
|
|
$ |
2.4 |
|
Other income was higher primarily on account of higher interest income due to higher cash balance and better yield from
investments in FMP and the sale of assets from closed facilities in Gurgaon, Chennai and Bangalore, due to the transfer of our facilities to new locations and consolidation of operations, partially offset by dividend distribution tax on liquid
mutual funds on account of a change in Indian tax law pursuant to the India Finance Act 2014.
Finance Expense
The following table sets forth our finance expense for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Finance expense |
|
$ |
1.3 |
|
|
$ |
2.9 |
|
|
$ |
(1.6 |
) |
Finance expense decreased primarily due to lower interest cost as a result of lower borrowings following scheduled repayments
of our short term and long term loans.
107
Provision for Income Taxes
The following table sets forth our provision for income taxes for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Provision for income taxes |
|
$ |
22.4 |
|
|
$ |
14.3 |
|
|
$ |
8.1 |
|
The increase in provision for income taxes was primarily on account of higher taxable profits. The provision for income taxes
for fiscal 2015 also includes a $1.7 million provision on account of a change in Indian tax law pursuant to the India Finance Act 2014, as a result of which a number of our investments in debt FMPs, which we have held for less than 36 months are
required to be re-categorized as short term capital assets, which are subject to higher tax rates.
Profit
The following table sets forth our profit for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Profit |
|
$ |
58.6 |
|
|
$ |
41.6 |
|
|
$ |
17.0 |
|
As a percentage of revenue |
|
|
11.0 |
% |
|
|
8.3 |
% |
|
|
|
|
As a percentage of revenue less repair payments |
|
|
11.7 |
% |
|
|
8.8 |
% |
|
|
|
|
The increase in profit was primarily on account of higher operating profit, other income and lower finance expense, partially
offset by higher provision for income taxes.
Fiscal 2014 Compared to Fiscal 2013
The following table sets forth our revenue and percentage change in revenue for the periods indicated:
Revenue
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
% Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
|
|
|
Revenue |
|
$ |
502.6 |
|
|
$ |
460.3 |
|
|
$ |
42.4 |
|
|
|
9.2 |
% |
The increase in revenue of $42.4 million was primarily attributable to an increase in revenue from existing clients of
$30.1 million and revenue from new clients of $12.1 million. In addition, we had a decrease in hedging loss on our revenue by $0.2 million to $6.2 million in fiscal 2014 from $6.4 million in fiscal 2013. The increase in revenue was primarily
due to higher volumes in our utilities, banking and financial services, insurance, and shipping and logistics verticals, partially offset by lower volumes in our healthcare and public sector verticals.
108
Revenue by Geography
The following table sets forth the composition of our revenue based on the location of our clients in our key geographies for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenue |
|
|
As a percentage of revenue |
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
UK |
|
$ |
265.0 |
|
|
$ |
245.3 |
|
|
|
52.7 |
% |
|
|
53.3 |
% |
North America (primarily the US) |
|
|
137.4 |
|
|
|
140.2 |
|
|
|
27.3 |
% |
|
|
30.5 |
% |
Europe (excluding the UK) |
|
|
27.0 |
|
|
|
27.3 |
|
|
|
5.4 |
% |
|
|
5.9 |
% |
South Africa |
|
|
20.5 |
|
|
|
14.2 |
|
|
|
4.1 |
% |
|
|
3.1 |
% |
Australia |
|
|
18.5 |
|
|
|
10.8 |
|
|
|
3.7 |
% |
|
|
2.4 |
% |
Rest of world |
|
|
34.2 |
|
|
|
22.5 |
|
|
|
6.8 |
% |
|
|
4.8 |
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
502.6 |
|
|
$ |
460.3 |
|
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The increase in revenue from the UK region was primarily attributable to higher volumes in our banking and financial services,
shipping and logistics, utilities and travel verticals. The increase in revenue from the Rest of world region was primarily attributable to higher volumes in our banking and financial services, shipping and logistics, and insurance verticals. The
increase in revenue from Australia region was primarily attributable to higher volumes in our insurance vertical. The increase in revenue from South Africa region was primarily attributable to higher volumes in our banking and financial services,
travel and retail and CPG verticals. The decrease in revenue in North America (primarily the US) was primarily due to lower volumes in our healthcare and travel verticals, partially offset by higher volumes in our insurance and consulting and
professional services verticals. The decrease in revenue from Europe (excluding the UK) region was primarily due to lower volumes in our banking and financial services, shipping and logistics, and retail and CPG verticals, partially offset by higher
volumes in our insurance and healthcare verticals.
Revenue Less Repair Payments
The following table sets forth our revenue less repair payment and percentage change in revenue less repair payments for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
% Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in million) |
|
|
|
|
Revenue less repair payments |
|
$ |
471.5 |
|
|
$ |
436.1 |
|
|
$ |
35.4 |
|
|
|
8.1 |
% |
The increase in revenue less repair payments of $35.4 million was attributable to an increase in revenue less repair
payments from existing clients of $23.4 million and revenue less repair payments from new clients of $11.8 million. In addition, we had a decrease in hedging loss on our revenue by $0.2 million to $6.2 million in fiscal 2014 from $6.4
million in fiscal 2013. The increase in revenue less repair payment was primarily due to higher volumes in our utilities, banking and financial services, insurance, and shipping and logistics verticals, partially offset by lower volumes in our
healthcare and public sector verticals.
109
Revenue Less Repair Payments by Geography
The following table sets forth the composition of our revenue less repair payments based on the location of our clients in our key geographies for the periods
indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenue less repair payments |
|
|
As a percentage of revenue less repair payments |
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
UK |
|
$ |
233.8 |
|
|
$ |
221.2 |
|
|
|
49.6 |
% |
|
|
50.7 |
% |
North America (primarily the US) |
|
|
137.4 |
|
|
|
140.2 |
|
|
|
29.1 |
% |
|
|
32.2 |
% |
Europe (excluding the UK) |
|
|
27.1 |
|
|
|
27.3 |
|
|
|
5.7 |
% |
|
|
6.3 |
% |
South Africa |
|
|
20.5 |
|
|
|
14.2 |
|
|
|
4.4 |
% |
|
|
3.3 |
% |
Australia |
|
|
18.5 |
|
|
|
10.8 |
|
|
|
3.9 |
% |
|
|
2.5 |
% |
Rest of world |
|
|
34.2 |
|
|
|
22.4 |
|
|
|
7.4 |
% |
|
|
5.0 |
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
471.5 |
|
|
$ |
436.1 |
|
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
100.0 |
% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The increase in revenue from the UK region was primarily attributable to higher volumes in our banking and financial services,
shipping and logistics, utilities and travel verticals. The increase in revenue from the rest of world region was primarily attributable to higher volumes in our banking and financial services, shipping and logistics, and insurance verticals. The
increase in revenue less repair payments from Australia region was primarily attributable to higher volumes in our insurance vertical. The increase in revenue from South Africa region was primarily attributable to higher volumes in our banking and
financial services, travel and retail and CPG verticals. The decrease in revenue in North America (primarily the US) was primarily due to lower volumes in our healthcare and travel verticals, partially offset by higher volumes in our insurance and
consulting and professional services verticals. The decrease in revenue from Europe (excluding the UK) region was primarily due to lower volumes in our banking and financial services, shipping and logistics, and retail and CPG verticals, partially
offset by higher volumes in our insurance and healthcare verticals.
Cost of Revenue
The following table sets forth the composition of our cost of revenue for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Employee costs |
|
$ |
184.7 |
|
|
$ |
178.2 |
|
|
$ |
6.5 |
|
Facilities costs |
|
|
61.3 |
|
|
|
59.3 |
|
|
|
2.0 |
|
Repair payments |
|
|
31.1 |
|
|
|
24.1 |
|
|
|
7.0 |
|
Depreciation |
|
|
13.5 |
|
|
|
14.2 |
|
|
|
(0.7 |
) |
Travel costs |
|
|
10.9 |
|
|
|
9.5 |
|
|
|
1.4 |
|
Legal and professional costs |
|
|
10.9 |
|
|
|
8.5 |
|
|
|
2.4 |
|
Other costs |
|
|
15.3 |
|
|
|
17.3 |
|
|
|
(2.0 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total cost of revenue |
|
$ |
327.7 |
|
|
$ |
311.0 |
|
|
$ |
16.7 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As a percentage of revenue |
|
|
65.2 |
% |
|
|
67.6 |
% |
|
|
|
|
The increase in cost of revenue was primarily due to an increase in repair payments, an increase in employee costs due to
higher headcount and wage increments, an increase in legal and professional services, an increase in facilities costs due to an expansion of facilities in the Philippines, South Africa, Romania and Poland and the addition of new facilities in Mumbai
in India, Sri Lanka and China, and an increase in travel costs associated with transition of client processes to our delivery centers. These increases were partially offset by a decrease in other costs due to a decrease in costs associated with
providing onshore services and subcontract costs. Further, the depreciation of the Indian rupee against the US dollar by an average of 11.0% in fiscal 2014 as compared to the average exchange rate in fiscal 2013 resulted in an overall decrease of
approximately $17.6 million in the cost of revenue.
110
Gross Profit
The following table sets forth our gross profit for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Gross profit |
|
$ |
174.9 |
|
|
$ |
149.3 |
|
|
$ |
25.6 |
|
As a percentage of revenue |
|
|
34.8 |
% |
|
|
32.4 |
% |
|
|
|
|
As a percentage of revenue less repair payments |
|
|
37.1 |
% |
|
|
34.2 |
% |
|
|
|
|
Gross profit was higher primarily due to higher revenue as discussed above. Gross profit as a percentage of revenue and
revenue less repair payments similarly increased primarily due to higher revenue as discussed above. We had a decrease in hedging loss on our revenue by $0.2 million to $6.2 million in fiscal 2014 from $6.4 million in fiscal 2013, and
the depreciation of the Indian rupee against the US dollar in fiscal 2014 by an average of 11.0% as compared to the average exchange rate in fiscal 2013 reduced our cost of revenue.
During fiscal 2014, our built up seats increased by 7.0% from 21,975 as at the end of fiscal 2013 to 23,503 as at the end of fiscal 2014 when we expanded
facilities in the Philippines, South Africa, Romania and Poland and added new facilities in Mumbai in India, Sri Lanka and China. This was part of our strategy to expand our delivery capabilities, including in the SEZ in India. Our total headcount
increased by 5.9% from 25,520 to 27,020 during the same period, resulting in a decline in our seat utilization rate from 1.21 in fiscal 2013 to 1.16 in fiscal 2014. This 0.05 decline in our seat utilization rate reduced our gross profit as a
percentage of revenue by approximately 0.6% and reduced our gross profit as a percentage of revenue less repair payments by approximately 0.7%.
Selling and Marketing Expenses
The following table sets
forth the composition of our selling and marketing expenses for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Employee costs |
|
$ |
26.4 |
|
|
$ |
22.6 |
|
|
$ |
3.8 |
|
Other costs |
|
|
8.8 |
|
|
|
7.6 |
|
|
|
1.2 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total selling and marketing expenses |
|
$ |
35.2 |
|
|
$ |
30.2 |
|
|
$ |
5.0 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As a percentage of revenue |
|
|
7.0 |
% |
|
|
6.6 |
% |
|
|
|
|
As a percentage of revenue less repair payments |
|
|
7.5 |
% |
|
|
6.9 |
% |
|
|
|
|
The increase in selling and marketing expenses was primarily due to an increase in employee costs as a result of the expenses
incurred in the expansion of our sales team and our client partner program. The increase in other costs was primarily due to an increase in travel and legal and professional expenses.
General and Administrative Expenses
The following table
sets forth the composition of our general and administrative expenses for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Employee costs |
|
$ |
39.8 |
|
|
$ |
38.2 |
|
|
$ |
1.6 |
|
Other costs |
|
|
15.6 |
|
|
|
18.9 |
|
|
|
(3.3 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total general and administrative expenses |
|
$ |
55.4 |
|
|
$ |
57.1 |
|
|
$ |
(1.7 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As a percentage of revenue |
|
|
11.0 |
% |
|
|
12.4 |
% |
|
|
|
|
As a percentage of revenue less repair payments |
|
|
11.7 |
% |
|
|
13.1 |
% |
|
|
|
|
111
The decrease in general and administrative expenses was primarily due to a decrease of approximately $3.2 million
due to a depreciation of the Indian rupee against the US dollar by an average of 11.0% in fiscal 2014 by as compared to the average exchange rate in fiscal 2013 and a decrease in other costs as a result of a decrease in legal and professional
expenses and travel expenses. These decreases were partially offset by an increase in employee costs as a result of an increase in headcount and wage increments.
Foreign Exchange Loss / (Gains), Net
The following table
sets forth our foreign exchange loss / (gains), net for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Foreign exchange loss / (gains), net |
|
$ |
11.2 |
|
|
$ |
5.5 |
|
|
$ |
5.7 |
|
The higher foreign exchange losses were primarily due to higher foreign currency revaluation losses by $3.1 million to a loss
of $0.6 million in fiscal 2014 from a gain of $2.5 million in fiscal 2013 and higher hedging losses of $2.5 million from our rupee-denominated contracts as a result of a depreciation of the Indian rupee against the US dollar.
Amortization of Intangible Assets
The following table
sets forth our amortization of intangible assets for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Amortization of intangible assets |
|
$ |
23.8 |
|
|
$ |
26.4 |
|
|
$ |
(2.6 |
) |
The decrease in amortization of intangible assets was primarily attributable to the depreciation of the Indian rupee against
the US dollar in fiscal 2014 by an average of 11.0% as compared to the average exchange rate in fiscal 2013.
Operating Profit
The following table sets forth our operating profit for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Operating profit |
|
$ |
49.4 |
|
|
$ |
30.1 |
|
|
$ |
19.3 |
|
As a percentage of revenue |
|
|
9.8 |
% |
|
|
6.5 |
% |
|
|
|
|
As a percentage of revenue less repair payments |
|
|
10.5 |
% |
|
|
6.9 |
% |
|
|
|
|
Operating profit as a percentage of revenue and revenue less repair payments is higher due to higher gross profit as discussed
above, lower general and administrative expenses and lower amortization costs, partially offset by higher foreign exchanges losses, and higher selling and marketing expenses.
112
Other income, net
The following table sets forth our other income, net for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Other income, net |
|
$ |
9.5 |
|
|
$ |
4.8 |
|
|
$ |
4.7 |
|
Other income was higher primarily on account of higher interest income due to higher cash balance and better yield.
Finance Expense
The following table sets forth our
finance expense for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Finance expense |
|
$ |
2.9 |
|
|
$ |
3.6 |
|
|
$ |
(0.7 |
) |
Finance expense marginally decreased primarily due to lower interest cost on account of full and partial repayment of certain
of our term loans.
Provision for Income Taxes
The
following table sets forth our provision for income taxes for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Provision for income taxes |
|
$ |
14.3 |
|
|
$ |
9.9 |
|
|
$ |
4.4 |
|
The increase in provision for income taxes was primarily on account of higher taxable profits, partially offset by higher
deferred tax credits on losses in some jurisdictions.
Profit
The following table sets forth our profit for the periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
|
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
Change |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Profit |
|
$ |
41.6 |
|
|
$ |
21.4 |
|
|
$ |
20.2 |
|
As a percentage of revenue |
|
|
8.3 |
% |
|
|
4.6 |
% |
|
|
|
|
As a percentage of revenue less repair payments |
|
|
8.8 |
% |
|
|
4.9 |
% |
|
|
|
|
The increase in profit was primarily on account of higher operating profit, other income and lower finance expense, partially
offset by higher provision for income taxes.
113
Results by Reportable Segment
For purposes of evaluating operating performance and allocating resources, we have organized our company by operating segments. See note 26 to our consolidated
financial statements included elsewhere in this annual report. For financial statement reporting purposes, we aggregate the segments that meet the criteria for aggregation as set forth in IFRS 8 Operating Segments. We have separately
reported our Auto Claims BPM segment, as it does not meet the aggregation criteria under IFRS 8. Accordingly, pursuant to IFRS 8, we have two reportable segments: WNS Global BPM and WNS Auto Claims BPM.
WNS Global BPM is delivered out of our delivery centers in China Costa Rica, India, the Philippines, Poland, Romania, South Africa, Sri Lanka, the UK and
the US. This segment includes all of our business activities with the exception of WNS Auto Claims BPM. WNS Auto Claims BPM is our automobile claims management business which is primarily based in the UK and is part of our insurance business unit.
See Part I Item 4. Information on the Company B. Business Overview Business Process Management Service Offerings. We report WNS Auto Claims BPM as a separate segment for financial statement reporting
purposes since a substantial part of our reported revenue in this business consists of amounts invoiced to our clients for payments made by us to third party automobile repair centers, resulting in lower long-term gross margins when measured on the
basis of revenue, relative to the WNS Global BPM segment.
Our revenue is generated primarily from providing business process management services.
In our WNS Auto Claims BPM segment, we provide both fault and non-fault repairs. For fault repairs, we provide claims
handling and repair management services, where we arrange for automobile repairs through a network of third party repair centers. In our repair management services, where we act as the principal in our dealings with the third party repair centers
and our clients, the amounts which we invoice to our clients for payments made by us to third party repair centers are reported as revenue. Where we are not the principal in providing the services, we record revenue from repair services net of
repair cost. Since we wholly subcontract the repairs to the repair centers, we evaluate the financial performance of our fault repair business based on revenue less repair payments to third party repair centers, which is a non-GAAP
financial measure. We believe that revenue less repair payments for fault repairs reflects more accurately the value addition of the business process management services that we directly provide to our clients.
For our non-fault repairs business, we generally provide a consolidated suite of accident management services including credit hire and credit
repair, and we believe that measurement of such business on a basis that includes repair payments in revenue is appropriate. Revenue including repair payments is therefore used as a primary measure to allocate resources and measure operating
performance for accident management services provided in our non-fault repairs business. Our non-fault repairs business where we provide accident management services accounts for a relatively small portion of our revenue for
our WNS Auto Claims BPM segment.
Revenue less repair payments is a non-GAAP financial measure which is calculated as (a) revenue less (b) in
our auto claims business, payments to repair centers for fault repair cases where we act as the principal in our dealings with the third party repair centers and our clients. This non-GAAP financial information is not meant to be
considered in isolation or as a substitute for our financial results prepared in accordance with GAAP. Our revenue less repair payments may not be comparable to similarly titled measures reported by other companies due to potential differences in
the method of calculation.
Our management allocates resources based on segment revenue less repair payments and measures segment performance based on
revenue less repair payments and to a lesser extent on segment operating income. The accounting policies of our reportable segments are the same as those of our company. See Critical Accounting Policies. We may in the future
change our reportable segments based on how our business evolves.
114
The following table shows revenue and revenue less repair payments for our two reportable segments for the
periods indicated:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
|
WNS Global BPM |
|
|
WNS Auto Claims BPM |
|
|
WNS Global BPM |
|
|
WNS Auto Claims BPM |
|
|
WNS Global BPM |
|
|
WNS Auto Claims BPM |
|
Segment revenue(1) |
|
$ |
473.1 |
|
|
$ |
61.1 |
|
|
$ |
439.9 |
|
|
$ |
63.0 |
|
|
$ |
405.4 |
|
|
$ |
55.1 |
|
Less: Payments to repair centers |
|
|
|
|
|
|
30.9 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
31.1 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
24.1 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenue less repair payments(1) |
|
|
473.1 |
|
|
|
30.2 |
|
|
|
439.9 |
|
|
|
31.9 |
|
|
|
405.4 |
|
|
|
31.0 |
|
Cost of revenue (excluding payments to repair centers)(2) |
|
|
292.3 |
|
|
|
18.9 |
|
|
|
275.8 |
|
|
|
19.4 |
|
|
|
265.8 |
|
|
|
20.4 |
|
Other costs(3) |
|
|
82.1 |
|
|
|
5.8 |
|
|
|
91.5 |
|
|
|
5.0 |
|
|
|
82.9 |
|
|
|
5.5 |
|
Segment operating profit |
|
|
98.7 |
|
|
|
5.4 |
|
|
|
72.6 |
|
|
|
7.4 |
|
|
|
56.7 |
|
|
|
5.1 |
|
Other (income)/expense, net |
|
|
(11.1 |
) |
|
|
(0.8 |
) |
|
|
(8.6 |
) |
|
|
(0.9 |
) |
|
|
(4.0 |
) |
|
|
(0.8 |
) |
Finance expense |
|
|
1.3 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2.9 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.6 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Segment profit before income taxes |
|
|
108.5 |
|
|
|
6.2 |
|
|
|
78.3 |
|
|
|
8.4 |
|
|
|
57.1 |
|
|
|
5.9 |
|
Provision for income taxes |
|
|
21.2 |
|
|
|
1.2 |
|
|
|
12.3 |
|
|
|
2.0 |
|
|
|
8.9 |
|
|
|
1.0 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Segment profit |
|
$ |
87.3 |
|
|
$ |
5.0 |
|
|
$ |
66.0 |
|
|
$ |
6.4 |
|
|
$ |
48.2 |
|
|
$ |
4.9 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Notes:
(1) |
Segment revenue and revenue less repair payments include inter-segment revenue of $0.2 million for fiscal 2015, $0.3 million for fiscal 2014 and $0.3 million for fiscal 2013. |
(2) |
Cost of revenue includes inter-segment expenses of $0.2 million for fiscal 2015, $0.3 million for fiscal 2014 and $0.3 million for fiscal 2013, and excludes share-based compensation expenses of
$0.9 million for fiscal 2015, and $1.3 million for fiscal 2014 and $1.0 million for fiscal 2013, which are not allocable between our segments. |
(3) |
Other costs include selling and marketing, general and administrative expense and foreign exchange gain/loss. Excludes share-based compensation expenses of $8.6 million for fiscal 2015, $5.6 million for fiscal
2014 and $4.4 million for fiscal 2013, which are not allocable between our segments. |
WNS Global BPM accounted for 88.6% of our revenue
and 94.0% of our revenue less repair payments in fiscal 2015 as compared to 87.5% of our revenue and 93.2% of our revenue less repair payments in fiscal 2014, and 88.1% of our revenue and 93.0% of our revenue less repair payments in fiscal 2013.
WNS Global BPM
Segment Revenue.
Revenue in the WNS Global BPM segment increased by 7.5% to $473.1 million in fiscal 2015 from $439.9 million in fiscal 2014. This increase was primarily attributable to the increase in the volume of transactions executed for new and existing
clients, with $17.4 million being attributable to new clients and $6.7 million being attributable to existing clients, which included approximately $3.0 million of one time benefits received in fiscal 2015 relating to performance based incentives,
gain sharing and removal of foreign exchange collars from certain client contracts. In addition, we had an increase in hedging gain on our revenue by $9.1 million to $2.9 million in fiscal 2015 from a hedging loss of $6.2 million in fiscal 2014. The
increase was also, to a lesser extent, on account of an appreciation of the pound sterling against the US dollar by an average of 1.5% in fiscal 2015 as compared to the average exchange rate in fiscal 2014.
Revenue in the WNS Global BPM segment increased by 8.5% to $439.9 million in fiscal 2014 from $405.4 million in fiscal 2013. This increase was primarily
attributable to the increase in the volume of transactions executed for new and existing clients, with $23.9 million being attributable to existing clients and $10.4 million being attributable to new clients. The increase was also, to a lesser
extent, on account of an appreciation of the pound sterling against the US dollar by an average of 0.6% in fiscal 2014 as compared to the average exchange rate in fiscal 2013. In addition, we had a decrease in hedging loss of $0.2 million in fiscal
2014, from a hedging loss of $6.4 million in fiscal 2013 to a hedging loss of $6.2 million in fiscal 2014.
115
Segment Operating Profit. Segment operating profit in the WNS Global BPM segment increased by 35.9%
to $98.7 million in fiscal 2015 from $72.6 million in fiscal 2014. The increase was primarily attributable to higher segment revenue, lower selling and marketing expenses and higher foreign exchange gains, partially offset by higher cost
of revenue and higher general and administrative expenses.
Our cost of revenue includes employee costs, facilities costs, depreciation, legal and
professional costs, travel costs and other related costs. Employee related costs represent the largest component of our cost of revenue for the WNS Global BPM segment. Our cost of revenue increased by $16.4 million to $292.3 million in fiscal
2015 from $275.8 million in fiscal 2014, primarily on account of (i) an increase in employee costs by $14.0 million due to an increase in salary and headcount, (ii) an increase in facilities costs by $2.5 million due to an expansion
of facilities in the Pune and Chennai in India and the addition of new facilities in the US, South Africa and China, and (iii) an increase in depreciation cost by $0.6 million. These increases were partially offset by a decrease in travel costs
by $1.4 million. Further, the depreciation of the Indian rupee against the US dollar by an average of 1.2% in fiscal 2015 as compared to the average exchange rate in fiscal 2014, resulted in a lower cost of revenue of approximately $2.0 million.
Our other costs include selling and marketing expenses, general and administrative expenses and foreign exchange loss or gain. Our other costs decreased
by $9.4 million to $82.1 million in fiscal 2015 from $91.5 million in fiscal 2014, primarily on account of (i) an increase in general and administrative expenses by $7.9 million, (ii) a decrease in selling and marketing expenses by $1.3
million, and (iii) an increase in foreign exchange gain by $16.0 million.
The higher foreign exchange gains were primarily due to higher hedging
gains of $16.4 million from our rupee-denominated contracts as a result of a depreciation of the Indian rupee against the US dollar, partially offset by higher foreign currency revaluation losses by $0.6 million to a loss of $1.2 million in fiscal
2015 from a gain of $0.6 million in fiscal 2014.
Selling and marketing expenses decreased by $1.3 million to $29.3 million in fiscal 2015 from
$30.6 million in fiscal 2014, primarily due to a decrease in employee costs as a result of a decrease in sales headcount and a decrease in legal and professional expenses.
General and administrative expenses increased by $7.9 million to $57.5 million in fiscal 2015 from $49.6 million in fiscal 2014, primarily due
to an increase in employee costs as a result of an increase in headcount and wage increments and higher facilities cost, partially offset by the depreciation of the Indian rupee against the US dollar by an average of 1.2% in fiscal 2015 as compared
to the average exchange rate in fiscal 2014.
Segment operating profit in the WNS Global BPM segment increased by 28.1% to $72.6 million in fiscal
2014 from $56.7 million in fiscal 2013. The increase was primarily attributable to higher segment revenue, and lower general and administrative expenses, partially offset by higher cost of revenue, higher selling and marketing expenses, and
higher foreign exchange losses.
Our cost of revenue includes employee costs, facilities costs, depreciation, legal and professional costs, travel costs
and other related costs. Employee related costs represent the largest component of our cost of revenue for the WNS Global BPM segment. Our cost of revenue increased by $10.0 million to $275.8 million in fiscal 2014 from $265.8 million in
fiscal 2013, primarily on account of (i) an increase in employee costs by $5.9 million due to an increase in salary and headcount, (ii) an increase in facilities costs by $3.5 million due to an expansion of facilities in the Philippines,
South Africa, Romania and Poland and the addition of new facilities in Mumbai in India, Sri Lanka and China, and (iii) an increase in travel costs by $1.4 million due to travel costs associated with the transition of client processes to our
delivery centers. These increases were partially offset by a decrease in depreciation cost by $0.3 million. Further, the depreciation of the Indian rupee against the US dollar by an average of 11.0% in fiscal 2014 as compared to the average exchange
rate in fiscal 2013, resulted in a lower cost of revenue of approximately $17.6 million.
Our other costs include selling and marketing expenses, general
and administrative expenses and foreign exchange loss or gain. Our other costs increased by $8.6 million to $91.5 million in fiscal 2014 from $82.9 million in fiscal 2013, primarily on account of (i) an increase in foreign exchange loss by $5.9
million, (ii) an increase in selling and marketing expenses by $3.3 million, and (iii) a decrease in general and administrative expenses by $0.6 million.
116
The higher foreign exchange losses were primarily due to an increase in foreign currency revaluation losses by
$3.1 million to a loss of $0.6 million in fiscal 2014 from a gain of $2.5 million in fiscal 2013 and higher hedging losses of $2.5 million from our rupee-denominated contracts as a result of a depreciation of the Indian rupee against the US dollar.
Selling and marketing expenses increased by $3.3 million to $30.6 million in fiscal 2014 from $27.3 million in fiscal 2013, primarily due
to an increase in employee costs as a result of the expenses incurred in the expansion of our sales team and our client partner program.
General and
administrative expenses decreased by $0.6 million to $49.6 million in fiscal 2014 from $50.2 million in fiscal 2013, primarily due to a decrease of approximately $3.2 million due to the depreciation of the Indian rupee against the US
dollar by an average of 11.0% in fiscal 2014 as compared to the average exchange rate in fiscal 2013 and a decrease in other costs as a result of a decrease in facilities costs, legal and professional expenses and travel expenses, partially offset
by an increase in employee costs as a result of an increase in headcount and wage increments.
Segment Profit. Segment profit in the WNS Global BPM
segment increased by 32.3% to $87.3 million in fiscal 2015 from $66.0 million in fiscal 2014. The increase in profit was primarily attributable to higher segment revenue, lower general and administrative expenses, higher other income, and lower
finance expense, partially offset by higher cost of revenue primarily due to higher employee cost and facilities cost, higher selling and marketing expenses and higher other costs primarily due to higher foreign exchange losses.
The other income, net increased by $2.5 million in fiscal 2015 to $11.1 million from $8.6 million in fiscal 2014.
The finance expense for fiscal 2015 was $1.3 million as compared to $2.9 million in fiscal 2014 due to lower interest cost as a result of lower
borrowings following scheduled repayments of our short term and long term loans.
Provision for income taxes in fiscal 2015 was $21.2 million as
compared to $12.3 million in fiscal 2014. The increase in provision for income taxes was primarily on account of higher profits. The provision for income taxes for fiscal 2015 also includes a $1.7 million provision on account of a change in
Indian tax law pursuant to the India Finance Act 2014, as a result of which a number of our investments in debt FMPs which we have held for less than 36 months are required to be re-categorized as short term capital assets, which are subject to
higher tax rates.
Segment profit in the WNS Global BPM segment increased by 37.1% to $66.0 million in fiscal 2014 from $48.2 million in fiscal 2013.
The increase in profit was primarily attributable to higher segment revenue, lower selling and marketing expenses, higher hedging gains, higher other income, and lower finance expense, partially offset by higher cost of revenue and higher general
and administrative expenses.
The other income, net increased by $4.6 million in fiscal 2014 to $8.6 million from $4.0 million in fiscal 2013.
The finance expense for fiscal 2014 was $2.9 million as compared to $3.6 million in fiscal 2013 due to lower interest cost on account of full and
partial repayment of certain of our term loans.
Provision for income taxes in fiscal 2014 was $12.3 million as compared to $8.9 million in
fiscal 2013. The increase in provision for income taxes was primarily on account of higher taxable profits, partially offset by higher deferred tax credits on losses in some jurisdictions.
WNS Auto Claims BPM
Segment Revenue.
Revenue in the WNS Auto Claims BPM segment decreased by $1.9 million to $61.1 million in fiscal 2015 from $63.0 million in fiscal 2014. The decrease was primarily on account of a decrease in revenue from existing clients of $2.0 million and revenue
from new clients of $0.1 million. The increase was also, to a lesser extent, on account of an appreciation of the pound sterling against the US dollar by an average of 1.5% in fiscal 2015 as compared to the average exchange rate in fiscal 2014.
Payments made to repair centers in fiscal 2015 decreased by $0.2 million to $30.9 million from $31.1 million in fiscal 2014.
Revenue less repair
payments in this segment decreased by 5.3% to $30.2 million in fiscal 2015 from $31.9 million in fiscal 2014 primarily due to lower volume of business of $1.7 million from existing clients, partially offset by revenue less repair payments from new
clients of $0.1 million.
117
Revenue in the WNS Auto Claims BPM segment increased by $7.8 million to $63.0 million in fiscal 2014 from $55.1
million in fiscal 2013. The increase was primarily on account of an increase in revenue from existing clients of $6.1 million and revenue from new clients of $1.7 million. Payments made to repair centers in fiscal 2014 increased by $7.0 million to
$31.1 million from $24.1 million in fiscal 2013.
Revenue less repair payments in this segment increased by 2.8% to $31.9 million in fiscal 2014 from
$31.0 million in fiscal 2013 primarily due to revenue from new clients of $1.4 million, partially offset by a lower volume of business of $0.5 million from existing clients.
Segment Operating Profit. Segment operating profit decreased by $2.0 million to $5.4 million in fiscal 2015 from $7.4 million in fiscal 2014. The
decrease was primarily on account of a decrease in revenue less repair payments, higher general and administrative expenses and higher hedging losses, partially offset by lower cost of revenue (excluding payments to repair centers) and selling and
marketing expenses.
Our cost of revenue (excluding payments to repair centers), decreased by $0.5 million to $18.9 million in fiscal 2015 from $19.4
million in fiscal 2014. The decrease in cost of revenue (excluding payments made to repair centers) was primarily on account of a decrease in facilities cost by $0.9 million and depreciation cost by $0.2 million, partially offset by an increase in
our employee costs by $0.5 million.
Our other costs include selling and marketing expenses, general and administrative expenses and foreign exchange gain
or loss. Our other costs increased by $0.8 million to $5.8 million in fiscal 2015 from $5.0 million in fiscal 2014, primarily on account of an increase in general and administrative expenses by $3.6 million to $4.6 million in fiscal 2015 from $1.1
million in fiscal 2014 and an increase in foreign exchange losses by $0.3 million to a loss of $0.1 million in fiscal 2015 from a gain of $0.1 million in fiscal 2014, partially offset by lower selling and marketing expenses by
$3.0 million to $1.0 million in fiscal 2015 from $4.0 million in fiscal 2014.
Segment operating profit increased by $2.3 million to $7.4
million in fiscal 2014 from $5.1 million in fiscal 2013. The increase was primarily on account of an increase in revenue less repair payments, lower cost of revenue (excluding payments to repair centers), and lower general and administrative
expenses, partially offset by higher selling and marketing expenses.
Our cost of revenue (excluding payments to repair centers), decreased by $1.0
million to $19.4 million in fiscal 2014 from $20.4 million in fiscal 2013. The decrease in cost of revenue (excluding payments made to repair centers) was primarily on account of a decrease in facilities cost by $1.4 million, and depreciation cost
by $0.4 million, partially offset by an increase in our employee costs by $0.9 million.
Our other costs include selling and marketing expenses, general
and administrative expenses and foreign exchange gain or loss. Our other costs decreased by $0.5 million to $5.0 million in fiscal 2014 from $5.5 million in fiscal 2013, primarily on account of a decrease in general and administrative expenses by
$1.9 million to $1.1 million in fiscal 2014 from $3.0 million in fiscal 2013, a decrease in foreign exchange losses by $0.2 million to a gain of $0.1 million in fiscal 2014 from a loss of $0.1 million in fiscal 2013, partially offset by
higher selling and marketing expenses by $1.5 million to $4.0 million in fiscal 2014 from $2.5 million in fiscal 2013.
Segment
Profit. Segment profit decreased by $1.3 million to $5.0 million in fiscal 2015 from $6.4 million in fiscal 2014. The decrease was primarily attributable to lower operating profit and a decrease in other income, net.
The other income, net in fiscal 2015 was an income of $0.8 million compared to an income of $0.9 million in fiscal 2014.
Provision for income taxes in fiscal 2015 was $1.2 million as compared to $2.0 million in fiscal 2014. The provision for income taxes in fiscal 2015 was lower
primarily on account of lower taxable profits.
Segment profit increased by $1.5 million to $6.4 million in fiscal 2014 from $4.9 million in fiscal 2013.
The increase was primarily attributable to higher operating profit and an increase in other income, net.
The other income, net in fiscal 2014 was an
income of $0.9 million compared to an income of $0.8 million in fiscal 2013.
Provision for income taxes in fiscal 2014 was $2.0 million as
compared to $1.0 million in fiscal 2013. The provision for income taxes in fiscal 2014 was higher primarily on account of higher taxable profits.
118
Quarterly Results
The following table presents unaudited quarterly financial information for each of our last eight fiscal quarters on a historical basis. We believe the
quarterly information contains all adjustments necessary to fairly present this information. As a business process management services provider, we anticipate and respond to demand from our clients. Accordingly, we have limited control over the
timing and circumstances under which our services are provided. Typically, we show a decrease in our first quarter operating profit margins as a result of salary increases. For these and other reasons, we can experience variability in our operating
results from quarter to quarter. The operating results for any quarter are not necessarily indicative of the results for any future period.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Fiscal 2015 |
|
|
Fiscal 2014 |
|
|
|
Three months ended |
|
|
Three months ended |
|
|
|
March 31, 2015 |
|
|
December 31, 2014 |
|
|
September 30, 2014 |
|
|
June 30, 2014 |
|
|
March 31, 2014 |
|
|
December 31, 2013 |
|
|
September 30, 2013 |
|
|
June 30, 2013 |
|
|
|
(Unaudited, US dollars in millions) |
|
Revenue |
|
$ |
132.9 |
|
|
$ |
136.0 |
|
|
$ |
134.1 |
|
|
$ |
131.0 |
|
|
$ |
130.3 |
|
|
$ |
127.1 |
|
|
$ |
123.1 |
|
|
$ |
122.1 |
|
Cost of revenue |
|
|
86.8 |
|
|
|
85.1 |
|
|
|
84.5 |
|
|
|
86.2 |
|
|
|
81.9 |
|
|
|
81.7 |
|
|
|
79.7 |
|
|
|
84.4 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Gross Profit |
|
|
46.0 |
|
|
|
50.8 |
|
|
|
49.5 |
|
|
|
44.8 |
|
|
|
48.3 |
|
|
|
45.5 |
|
|
|
43.4 |
|
|
|
37.7 |
|
Operating expenses: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Selling and marketing expenses |
|
|
7.5 |
|
|
|
7.7 |
|
|
|
8.2 |
|
|
|
7.7 |
|
|
|
9.5 |
|
|
|
8.9 |
|
|
|
9.0 |
|
|
|
7.8 |
|
General and administrative expenses |
|
|
17.9 |
|
|
|
18.8 |
|
|
|
17.0 |
|
|
|
16.2 |
|
|
|
14.2 |
|
|
|
13.1 |
|
|
|
13.0 |
|
|
|
15.0 |
|
Foreign exchange loss / (gains), net |
|
|
(3.4 |
) |
|
|
(1.8 |
) |
|
|
(0.7 |
) |
|
|
1.3 |
|
|
|
2.7 |
|
|
|
3.3 |
|
|
|
4.6 |
|
|
|
0.5 |
|
Amortization of intangible assets |
|
|
6.0 |
|
|
|
6.0 |
|
|
|
6.0 |
|
|
|
6.1 |
|
|
|
5.9 |
|
|
|
5.8 |
|
|
|
5.8 |
|
|
|
6.2 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Operating profit |
|
|
17.9 |
|
|
|
20.1 |
|
|
|
18.9 |
|
|
|
13.5 |
|
|
|
15.9 |
|
|
|
14.4 |
|
|
|
10.9 |
|
|
|
8.2 |
|
Other (income) expense, net |
|
|
(2.8 |
) |
|
|
(3.1 |
) |
|
|
(2.9 |
) |
|
|
(3.1 |
) |
|
|
(3.1 |
) |
|
|
(2.5 |
) |
|
|
(1.8 |
) |
|
|
(2.2 |
) |
Finance expense |
|
|
0.2 |
|
|
|
0.3 |
|
|
|
0.3 |
|
|
|
0.5 |
|
|
|
0.7 |
|
|
|
0.7 |
|
|
|
0.8 |
|
|
|
0.8 |
|
Provision for income taxes |
|
|
5.9 |
|
|
|
6.3 |
|
|
|
6.2 |
|
|
|
4.0 |
|
|
|
4.9 |
|
|
|
3.9 |
|
|
|
2.6 |
|
|
|
2.8 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Profit |
|
|
14.7 |
|
|
|
16.5 |
|
|
|
15.3 |
|
|
|
12.1 |
|
|
|
13.4 |
|
|
|
12.2 |
|
|
|
9.3 |
|
|
|
6.7 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
119
The following table sets forth for the periods indicated selected consolidated financial data:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Fiscal 2015 |
|
|
Fiscal 2014 |
|
|
|
Three months ended |
|
|
Three months ended |
|
|
|
March 31, 2015 |
|
|
December 31, 2014 |
|
|
September 30, 2014 |
|
|
June 30, 2014 |
|
|
March 31, 2014 |
|
|
December 31, 2013 |
|
|
September 30, 2013 |
|
|
June 30, 2013 |
|
|
|
(Unaudited) |
|
Gross profit as a percentage of revenue |
|
|
34.7 |
% |
|
|
37.4 |
% |
|
|
36.9 |
% |
|
|
34.2 |
% |
|
|
37.1 |
% |
|
|
35.8 |
% |
|
|
35.3 |
% |
|
|
30.9 |
% |
Operating income as a percentage of revenue |
|
|
13.5 |
% |
|
|
14.8 |
% |
|
|
14.1 |
% |
|
|
10.3 |
% |
|
|
12.2 |
% |
|
|
11.3 |
% |
|
|
8.9 |
% |
|
|
6.7 |
% |
Gross profit as a percentage of revenue less repair payments |
|
|
36.5 |
% |
|
|
39.6 |
% |
|
|
39.1 |
% |
|
|
36.7 |
% |
|
|
39.4 |
% |
|
|
38.0 |
% |
|
|
37.6 |
% |
|
|
33.2 |
% |
Operating income as a percentage of revenue less repair payments |
|
|
14.3 |
% |
|
|
15.6 |
% |
|
|
15.0 |
% |
|
|
11.1 |
% |
|
|
13.0 |
% |
|
|
12.0 |
% |
|
|
9.4 |
% |
|
|
7.2 |
% |
The following table reconciles our revenue (a GAAP measure) to revenue less repair payments (a non-GAAP measure):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Fiscal 2015 |
|
|
Fiscal 2014 |
|
|
|
Three months ended |
|
|
Three months ended |
|
|
|
March 31, 2015 |
|
|
December 31, 2014 |
|
|
September 30, 2014 |
|
|
June 30, 2014 |
|
|
March 31, 2014 |
|
|
December 31, 2013 |
|
|
September 30, 2013 |
|
|
June 30, 2013 |
|
|
|
(Unaudited, US dollars in millions) |
|
Revenue |
|
$ |
132.9 |
|
|
$ |
136.0 |
|
|
$ |
134.1 |
|
|
$ |
131.0 |
|
|
$ |
130.3 |
|
|
$ |
127.1 |
|
|
$ |
123.1 |
|
|
$ |
122.1 |
|
Less: Payments to repair centers |
|
|
6.8 |
|
|
|
7.6 |
|
|
|
7.5 |
|
|
|
8.9 |
|
|
|
7.5 |
|
|
|
7.5 |
|
|
|
7.7 |
|
|
|
8.4 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenue less repair payments |
|
$ |
126.1 |
|
|
$ |
128.4 |
|
|
$ |
126.5 |
|
|
$ |
122.1 |
|
|
$ |
122.7 |
|
|
$ |
119.6 |
|
|
$ |
115.4 |
|
|
$ |
113.8 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
120
Contractual Obligations
Our principal commitments consist of expected principal cash payments relating to our long term debt, obligations under operating leases for office space,
which represent minimum lease payments for office space, short term line of credit, and purchase obligations for property and equipment. The following table sets out our total future contractual obligations as at March 31, 2015 on a
consolidated basis:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Payments Due By Period |
|
|
|
Total |
|
|
Less than 1 year |
|
|
1-3 years |
|
|
3-5 years |
|
|
More than 5 years |
|
|
|
(US dollars in thousands) |
|
Long term debt |
|
$ |
12,841 |
|
|
$ |
12,841 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
Operating leases |
|
|
81,529 |
|
|
|
18,225 |
|
|
|
25,266 |
|
|
|
14,910 |
|
|
|
23,128 |
|
Short term line of credit |
|
|
12,881 |
|
|
|
12,881 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Purchase obligations |
|
|
3,107 |
|
|
|
3,107 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
110,358 |
|
|
$ |
47,054 |
|
|
$ |
25,266 |
|
|
$ |
14,910 |
|
|
$ |
23,128 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Uncertain income tax liabilities totaling $14.5 million are excluded from the table because we cannot make a reasonable
estimate of the period of cash settlement with the relevant taxing authority.
All of our debt is floating rate debt and no interest obligation in respect
of this debt is included in the table above. There is no contractual obligation to renew this debt. The debt amount, and the interest payments associated with it, will vary over time according to our funding requirements and future interest rates.
Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements
We have no
off-balance sheet arrangements or obligations.
Tax Assessment Orders
Transfer pricing regulations to which we are subject require that any international transaction among the WNS group enterprises be on arms-length terms.
Transfer pricing regulations in India have been extended to cover specified Indian domestic transactions as well. We believe that the international and India domestic transactions among the WNS group enterprises are on arms-length terms. If,
however, the applicable tax authorities determine that the transactions among the WNS group enterprises do not meet arms length criteria, we may incur increased tax liability, including accrued interest and penalties. This would cause our tax
expense to increase, possibly materially, thereby reducing our profitability and cash flows. The applicable tax authorities may also disallow deductions or tax holiday benefits claimed by us and assess additional taxable income on us in connection
with their review of our tax returns.
From time to time, we receive orders of assessment from the Indian tax authorities assessing additional taxable
income on us and/or our subsidiaries in connection with their review of our tax returns. We currently have orders of assessment for fiscal 2003 through fiscal 2012 pending before various appellate authorities. These orders assess additional taxable
income that could in the aggregate give rise to an estimated
3,046.6 million ($48.6 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) in additional taxes, including interest of
1,078.9 million ($17.2 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015).
121
The following sets forth the details of these orders of assessment:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Entities |
|
Tax year(s) |
|
|
Amount demanded (including interest) |
|
|
Interest on amount Demanded |
|
|
|
(
and US dollars in millions) |
|
WNS Global, WNS Customer Solutions and Noida |
|
|
Fiscal 2003 |
|
|
|
180.2 |
|
|
$ |
(2.9 |
)(1) |
|
|
60.0 |
|
|
$ |
(1.0 |
)(1) |
WNS Global, WNS Customer Solutions and Noida |
|
|
Fiscal 2004 |
|
|
|
12.5 |
|
|
$ |
(0.2 |
)(1) |
|
|
3.1 |
|
|
$ |
(0.1 |
)(1) |
WNS Global, WNS Customer Solutions and Noida |
|
|
Fiscal 2005 |
|
|
|
27.4 |
|
|
$ |
(0.4 |
)(1) |
|
|
8.6 |
|
|
$ |
(0.1 |
)(1) |
WNS Global, WNS Customer Solutions and Noida |
|
|
Fiscal 2006 |
|
|
|
531.0 |
|
|
$ |
(8.5 |
)(1) |
|
|
173.8 |
|
|
$ |
(2.7 |
)(1) |
WNS BCS and permanent establishment of WNS North America Inc. and WNS UK in India |
|
|
Fiscal 2006 |
|
|
|
67.9 |
|
|
$ |
(1.1 |
)(1) |
|
|
24.1 |
|
|
$ |
(0.4 |
)(1) |
WNS Global, WNS Customer Solutions and Noida |
|
|
Fiscal 2007 |
|
|
|
98.7 |
|
|
$ |
(1.6 |
)(1) |
|
|
31.9 |
|
|
$ |
(0.5 |
)(1) |
WNS BCS and permanent establishment of WNS North America Inc. and WNS UK in India |
|
|
Fiscal 2007 |
|
|
|
34.3 |
|
|
$ |
(0.4 |
)(1) |
|
|
10.8 |
|
|
$ |
(0.2 |
)(1) |
WNS Global, WNS Customer Solutions and Noida |
|
|
Fiscal 2008 |
|
|
|
819.6 |
|
|
$ |
(13.1 |
)(1) |
|
|
344.1 |
|
|
$ |
(5.4 |
)(1) |
WNS BCS and permanent establishment of WNS North America Inc. and WNS UK in India |
|
|
Fiscal 2008 |
|
|
|
41.4 |
|
|
$ |
(0.7 |
)(1) |
|
|
13.2 |
|
|
$ |
(0.2 |
)(1) |
WNS Global, WNS Customer Solutions and Noida |
|
|
Fiscal 2009 |
|
|
|
973.9 |
|
|
$ |
(15.5 |
)(1) |
|
|
336.8 |
|
|
$ |
(5.3 |
)(1) |
WNS BCS and permanent establishment of WNS North America Inc. and WNS UK in India |
|
|
Fiscal 2009 |
|
|
|
21.1 |
|
|
$ |
(0.3 |
)(1) |
|
|
4.1 |
|
|
$ |
(0.1 |
)(1) |
WNS Global, WNS Customer Solutions and Noida |
|
|
Fiscal 2010 |
|
|
|
60.2 |
|
|
$ |
(1.0 |
)(1) |
|
|
23.5 |
|
|
$ |
(0.4 |
)(1) |
WNS BCS and permanent establishment of WNS North America Inc. and WNS UK in India |
|
|
Fiscal 2010 |
|
|
|
1.8 |
|
|
$ |
(0.1 |
)(1) |
|
|
0.4 |
|
|
$ |
(0.1 |
)(1) |
WNS BCS and permanent establishment of WNS North America Inc. and WNS UK in India |
|
|
Fiscal 2011 |
|
|
|
6.6 |
|
|
$ |
(0.1 |
)(1) |
|
|
|
|
|
$ |
|
(1) |
WNS BCS and permanent establishment of WNS North America Inc. and WNS UK in India |
|
|
Fiscal 2012 |
|
|
|
170.0 |
|
|
$ |
(2.7 |
)(1) |
|
|
44.5 |
|
|
$ |
(0.7 |
)(1) |
Total |
|
|
|
|
|
|
3,046.6 |
|
|
$ |
(48.6 |
)(1) |
|
|
1,078.9 |
|
|
$ |
(17.2 |
)(1) |
Note:
(1) |
Based on the exchange rate as at March 31, 2015. |
The aforementioned orders of assessment allege that the
transfer prices we applied to certain of the international transactions between WNS Global or WNS Business Consulting Services Private Limited, or WNS BCS, each of which is our Indian subsidiary, as the case may be, and our other wholly-owned
subsidiaries named above were not on arms length terms, disallow a tax holiday benefit claimed by us, deny the set off of brought forward business losses and unabsorbed depreciation and disallow certain expenses claimed as tax deductible by
WNS Global or WNS BCS, as the case may be. As at March 31, 2015, we have provided a tax reserve of
906.8 million ($14.5 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) primarily on account of the Indian tax authorities denying the set off of brought forward business losses and unabsorbed
depreciation. We have appealed against these orders of assessment before higher appellate authorities.
122
In addition, we currently have orders of assessment pertaining to similar issues that have been decided in our
favor by first level appellate authorities, vacating tax demands of
2,482.2 million ($39.6 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) in additional taxes, including interest of
770.5 million ($12.3 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015). The income tax authorities have filed appeals against these orders at higher appellate authorities.
In case of disputes, the Indian tax authorities may require us to deposit with them all or a portion of the disputed amounts pending resolution of the matters
on appeal. Any amount paid by us as deposits will be refunded to us with interest if we succeed in our appeals. We have deposited some portion of the disputed amount with the tax authorities and may be required to deposit the remaining portion of
the disputed amount with the tax authorities pending final resolution of the respective matters.
As at March 31, 2015, corporate tax returns for
fiscal years 2012 (for certain legal entities) and thereafter remain subject to examination by tax authorities in India.
After consultation with our
Indian tax advisors and based on the facts of these cases, certain legal opinions from counsel, the nature of the tax authorities disallowances and the orders from first level appellate authorities deciding similar issues in our favor in
respect of assessment orders for earlier fiscal years, we believe these orders are unlikely to be sustained at the higher appellate authorities and we intend to vigorously dispute the orders of assessment.
In March 2009, we also received an assessment order from the Indian Service Tax Authority demanding payment of
348.1 million ($5.6 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) of service tax and related penalty for the period from March 1, 2003 to January 31, 2005. The assessment order alleges that
service tax is payable in India on BPM services provided by WNS Global to clients based abroad as the export proceeds are repatriated outside India by WNS Global. In response to an appeal filed by us with the appellate tribunal against the
assessment order in April 2009, the appellate tribunal has remanded the matter back to the lower tax authorities to be adjudicated afresh. Based on consultations with our Indian tax advisors, we believe this order of assessment is more likely
than not to be upheld in our favor. We intend to continue to vigorously dispute the assessment.
No assurance can be given, however, that we will prevail
in our tax disputes. If we do not prevail, payment of additional taxes, interest and penalties may adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition and cash flows. There can also be no assurance that we will not receive similar or
additional orders of assessment in the future.
Liquidity and Capital Resources
Our capital requirements are principally for debt repayment and the establishment of operating facilities to support our growth and acquisitions, and for
fiscal 2016, to fund the repurchase of ADSs under our share repurchase program, as described in further detail below, see Share Repurchases. Our sources of liquidity include cash and cash equivalents and cash flow from
operations, supplemented by equity and debt financing and bank credit lines as required.
As at March 31, 2015, we had cash and cash equivalents of
$32.4 million which were primarily held in US dollars, Indian rupees, pound sterling and Philippines pesos. We typically seek to invest our available cash on hand in bank deposits and money market instruments. Our investments includes
marketable securities consisting of bank deposits, liquid mutual funds and FMPs, which totaled $133.5 million as at March 31, 2015. Our investment in FMPs represents investments in mutual funds scheme wherein the mutual fund has invested in
certificates of deposit issued by banks in India.
As at March 31, 2015, our Indian subsidiary, WNS Global, had a secured line of credit of
900.0 million ($14.4 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) from The Hongkong and Shanghai Banking Corporation Limited, and an unsecured lines of credit of $15.0 million from BNP Paribas,
1,200.0 million ($19.2 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) from Citibank N.A. and
810.0 million ($12.9 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) from Standard Chartered Bank. Interest on these lines of credit would be determined on the date of the borrowing. These lines of
credit generally can be withdrawn by the relevant lender at any time. As at March 31, 2015,
740.7 million ($11.8 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) was utilized for working capital requirements from these lines of credit.
Our China subsidiary, Business Applications Associates Beijing Limited, had obtained a term loan facility of RMB1.25 million ($0.2 million based on the
exchange rate on March 31, 2015) and a line of credit of RMB2.5 million ($0.4 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) from HSBC Bank (China) Company Limited pursuant to a facility agreement dated April 10, 2013. Both
these facilities were fully repaid as at March 31, 2014.
123
In March 2012, WNS Global obtained two new three year term loan facilities consisting of a
510.0 million ($8.1 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) rupee-denominated loan, which was fully repaid on March 12, 2014, and a $7.0 million US dollar-denominated loan. In March 2012, our
UK subsidiary, WNS UK, also obtained a new three-year term loan for £6.1 million ($9.0 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015), rolled over its £9.9 million ($14.6 million based on the exchange rate on
March 31, 2015) two-year term loan (which was originally scheduled to mature in July 2012) for another three-year term, and renewed its £9.9 million ($14.6 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) working
capital facility (which was originally scheduled to mature in July 2012) until March 31, 2016.
Details of these loan facilities are
described below.
|
|
|
WNS Global obtained from HDFC Bank Ltd., or HDFC, a three-year rupee-denominated term loan of
510.0 million ($8.1 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) which was fully drawn on March 12, 2012. The loan was for the purpose of financing certain capital expenditures incurred during the
period from April 2011 to December 2011. The interest on the loan was 11.25% per annum for the first year, which was reset at the rate of 10.3% per annum for the second year. Interest was payable on a monthly basis. The principal
amount was repayable in two equal installments on January 30, 2015 and February 27, 2015. Repayment of the loan was guaranteed by WNS and secured by a charge over our Pune property. This charge ranked pari passu with other charges
over the property in favor of other lenders. We were subject to certain covenants in respect of this loan, including restrictive covenants relating to our total debt to EBITDA ratio, total debt to tangible net worth ratio and EBITDA to debt service
coverage ratio, each as defined in the term sheet relating to this loan. In connection with this rupee-denominated term loan, we had entered into a currency swap to convert the rupee-denominated loan to a US dollar-denominated loan which had
resulted in the loan bearing an effective interest rate to us of 5.78% per annum. On March 12, 2014, WNS Global prepaid the entire loan and there was no amount outstanding under the loan as at March 31, 2015. |
|
|
|
WNS Global obtained from HSBC Bank (Mauritius) Limited a three-year term loan facility for $7.0 million. On April 16, 2012, June 20, 2012, and August 16, 2012, we drew down $2.0, $3.0 and $2.0 million,
respectively, from this facility. The facility was utilized for the purpose of funding WNS Globals capital expenditure plans for fiscal 2013 in compliance with the Reserve Bank of Indias guidelines on External Commercial Borrowings
and Trade Credits. Prior to July 16, 2014, the facility bore interest at a rate of US dollar LIBOR plus a margin of 3.5% per annum. Effective July 16, 2014, the margin was reduced to 3.1% per annum. Interest is payable on a
quarterly basis. The principal amount of each tranche is repayable at the end of three years from the date of drawdown of such tranche. We made a scheduled repayment of $2.0 million on April 16, 2015. Repayment of the loan under the facility is
guaranteed by WNS and secured by a charge over our Pune property. This charge ranks pari passu with other charges over the property in favor of other lenders. The facility agreement contains certain covenants, including restrictive covenants
relating to our debt to EBITDA ratio, debt to adjusted tangible net worth ratio, EBITDA to debt service coverage ratio and fixed asset coverage ratio, each as defined therein. A change in the largest shareholder of WNS together with a loss of 10% of
our clients by revenue within two quarters of the change may also constitute an event of default under this facility agreement. As at March 31, 2015, $7.0 million was outstanding under this facility. |
|
|
|
WNS UK obtained from HSBC Bank plc. an additional three-year term loan facility for £6.1 million ($9.0 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015), which was fully drawn on March 30, 2012.
WNS UK also rolled over on March 30, 2012 its existing term loan of £9.9 million ($14.6 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) from HSBC Bank plc. (which was originally scheduled to mature on July 7, 2012)
for three years until July 7, 2015. The facilities are for the purpose of providing inter-company loans within our company and funding capital expenditures. The facilities bear interest at Bank of England base rate plus a margin of
2.25% per annum. Interest is payable on a quarterly basis. 20% of the principal amount of each loan is repayable at the end of each of 18, 24 and 30 months after drawdown and a final installment of 40% of the principal amount of each loan is
repayable at the end of 36 months after drawdown. We have made scheduled installment repayments aggregating £5.9 million ($8.8 million based on exchange rate on March 31, 2015) on the £9.9 million ($14.6 million based on
exchange rate on March 31, 2015) term loan. As at March 31, 2015, the £6.1 million ($9.0 million based on exchange rate on March 31, 2015) term loan was fully repaid and £4.0 million ($5.9 million based on
exchange rate on March 31, 2015) was outstanding under the £9.9 million term loan. Repayment of each loan is guaranteed by WNS, WNS (Mauritius) Limited, WNS Capital Investments Limited, WNS UK and AHA, and secured by pledges of
shares of WNS (Mauritius) Limited and WNS Capital Investments Limited, a charge over the bank account of WNS Capital Investments Limited, and fixed and floating charges over the respective assets of WNS UK and AHA. The facility agreements contain
certain covenants, including restrictive covenants relating to further borrowing by the borrower, total debt to EBITDA ratio, our total debt to tangible net worth ratio and EBITDA to debt service coverage ratio, each as defined in the facility
agreement. |
124
|
|
|
WNS UK renewed its working capital facility obtained from HSBC Bank plc. of £9.9 million ($14.6 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) until March 31, 2016. The working capital
facility bears interest at Bank of England base rate plus a margin of 2.45% per annum and was renewed at the existing rate. Interest is payable on a quarterly basis. Repayment of this facility is guaranteed by WNS, WNS UK and AHA, and secured
by fixed and floating charges over the respective assets of WNS UK and AHA. The facility agreements contain covenants similar to those contained in WNS UKs term loan facilities described above. The facility is subject to conditions to drawdown
and can be withdrawn by the lender at any time by notice to the borrower. As at March 31, 2015, £0.7 million ($1.1 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) was utilized for working capital requirements from the
above stated lines of credit. |
|
|
|
As at March 31, 2015, our South African subsidiary, WNS Global Services SA (Pty) Ltd., had an unsecured line of credit of ZAR 30.0 million ($2.5 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) from
The HSBC Bank plc. This line of credit can be withdrawn by the lender at any time. As at March 31, 2015, there was no outstanding amount under this facility. |
|
|
|
In September 2010, WNS Global Services Philippines Inc. obtained a $3.2 million three-year secured term loan facility from The Hongkong and Shanghai Banking Corporation Limited. This facility was repaid in three equal
installments on September 28, 2012, March 28, 2013 and September 27, 2013. The loan bore interest at the three-month US dollar LIBOR plus a margin of 3% per annum. Following the full repayment of the facility on
September 27, 2013, the security provided under the facility has been released. |
Based on our current level of operations, we expect
that our anticipated cash generated from operating activities, cash and cash equivalents on hand, and use of existing credit facilities will be sufficient to meet our debt repayment obligations, estimated capital expenditures and working capital
needs for the next 12 months. However, if our lines of credit were to become unavailable for any reason, we would require additional financing to meet our debt repayment obligations, capital expenditures and working capital needs. We currently
expect our capital expenditures needs in fiscal 2016 to be between $21.0 million to $25.0 million, a significant amount of which we expect to spend on infrastructure build-out and the streamlining of our operations. The geographical distribution,
timing and volume of our capital expenditures in the future will depend on new client contracts we may enter into or the expansion of our business under our existing client contracts. As at March 31, 2015, we had commitments for capital
expenditures of $3.1 million relating to the purchase of property and equipment for our delivery centers. Of this committed amount, we plan to spend approximately $2.3 million in India, approximately $0.2 million in the UK, approximately $0.2
million in Europe (excluding the UK), approximately $0.1 million in South Africa and approximately $0.3 million in the rest of the world. We expect to fund these estimated capital expenditures from cash generated from operating activities, existing
cash and cash equivalents and the use of existing credit facilities. Further, under the current volatile conditions as discussed under Global Economic Conditions above, there can be no assurance that our business activity would be
maintained at the expected level to generate the anticipated cash flows from operations. If the current market conditions persist or further deteriorate, we may experience a decrease in demand for our services, resulting in our cash flows from
operations being lower than anticipated. If our cash flows from operations are lower than anticipated, including as a result of the ongoing downturn in the market conditions or otherwise, we may need to obtain additional financing to meet some of
our existing debt repayment obligations and pursue certain of our expansion plans. Further, we may in the future consider making acquisitions. If we have significant growth through acquisitions or require additional operating facilities beyond those
currently planned to service new client contracts, we may also need to obtain additional financing. We believe in maintaining maximum flexibility when it comes to financing our business. We regularly evaluate our current and future financing needs.
Depending on market conditions, we may access the capital markets to strengthen our capital position, and provide us with additional liquidity for general corporate purposes, which may include capital expenditures acquisitions, refinancing of
indebtedness and working capital. If current market conditions continue to persist or deteriorate further, we may not be able to obtain additional financing or any such additional financing may be available to us on unfavorable terms. An inability
to pursue additional opportunities will have a material adverse effect on our ability to maintain our desired level of revenue growth in future periods.
125
The following table shows our cash flows for fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
|
|
(US dollars in millions) |
|
Net cash provided by operating activities |
|
$ |
95.5 |
|
|
$ |
81.4 |
|
|
$ |
64.8 |
|
Net cash used in investing activities |
|
$ |
(40.2 |
) |
|
$ |
(50.9 |
) |
|
$ |
(89.5 |
) |
Net cash provided by/ (used in) financing activities |
|
$ |
(54.9 |
) |
|
$ |
(14.9 |
) |
|
$ |
13.2 |
|
Cash Flows from Operating Activities
Net cash provided by operating activities increased to $95.5 million for fiscal 2015 from $81.4 million for fiscal 2014. The increase in net cash provided
by operating activities for fiscal 2015 as compared to fiscal 2014 was attributable to an increase in profit as adjusted by non-cash related items by $11.1 million, an increase in cash inflow from working capital changes by $5.7 million, a
decrease in interest paid by $1.6 million and an increase in interest received by $0.1 million which was partially offset by an increase in taxes paid by $4.4 million.
The increase in profit as adjusted for non-cash related items by $11.1 million was primarily on account of (i) an increase in profit by $17.0 million,
(ii) an increase in current tax expense by $5.1 million, (iii) a decrease in deferred tax credit by $3.0 million, (iv) an increase in share based compensation expense by $2.6 million, (v) an increase in allowance for doubtful
debts by $1.2 million, (vi) an increase in depreciation and amortization expense by $0.8 million, and (vii) a decrease in unrealized hedging gain by $0.5 million.
This increase was partially offset by (i) a decrease in unrealized exchange losses by $14.5 million, (ii) a decrease in interest expense by $1.6
million, (iii) a decrease in deferred rent expense by $0.6 million, (iv) an increase in dividend income by $1.3 million on account of our investment in marketable securities, (v) an increase in mark to market gain on fixed maturity
plans by $0.6 million, and (vi) an increase in gain on sale of property and equipment by $0.6 million.
Cash flow from working capital changes
increased by $5.7 million for fiscal 2015 as compared to fiscal 2014, primarily as a result of a decrease in cash outflow towards settlement of other liabilities primarily due to settlement of accrued expenses by $8.7 million, an increase in cash
inflow from other advances by $1.7 million which was partially offset by a decrease in cash inflows from accounts receivables primarily due to an increase in unbilled receivables by $3.8 million and an increase in payments towards accounts payables
by $1.2 million.
Net cash provided by operating activities increased to $81.4 million for fiscal 2014 from $64.8 million for fiscal 2013. The
increase in net cash provided by operating activities for fiscal 2014 as compared to fiscal 2013 was attributable to an increase in profit as adjusted by non-cash related items by $23.0 million, a decrease in income taxes paid by $2.2 million,
a decrease in interest paid by $0.6 million and an increase in interest income by $0.2 million which was partially offset by a decrease in cash inflow from working capital changes by $9.5 million.
The increase in profit as adjusted for non-cash related items by $23.0 million was primarily on account of (i) an increase in profit by $20.2 million,
(ii) an increase in unrealized exchange loss by $10.6 million, (iii) a decrease in deferred tax credit by $6.0 million, (iv) an increase in share based compensation expense by $1.6 million and (v) an increase in deferred rent
expense by $0.1 million. The increase was partially offset by (i) an increase in unrealized hedging gain by $5.2 million, (ii) an increase in unrealized gain by $3.9 million on investments, (iii) a decrease in depreciation and
amortization expense by $3.3 million, (iv) a decrease in current tax expenses by $1.6 million, (v) a decrease in interest expense by $0.4 million, (vi) a decrease in allowance of doubtful debts by $0.3 million, (vii) an increase
in dividend income by $0.2 million on account of our investment in marketable securities, (viii) an increase in interest income by $0.2 million, (ix) a decrease in interest expense on deferred consideration paid for Fusion Acquisition by
$0.2 million, (x) a decrease in amortization of debt issue cost by $0.1 million, and (xi) an increase in excess tax benefit credit on share based options exercised by $0.1 million.
126
Cash flow from working capital changes decreased by $9.5 million for fiscal 2014 as compared to fiscal 2013,
primarily as a result of a reduction in cash inflow from accounts receivable by $14.8 million in our WNS Auto Claims BPM segment, an increase in cash outflow towards settlement of other liabilities by $3.4 million primarily on account of settlement
of derivative financial instruments and payment made towards value added tax, which was partially offset by a decrease in cash outflow by $15.0 million in accounts payable in our WNS Auto-Claims BPM segment.
Cash Flows from Investing Activities
Net cash used in
investing activities decreased to $40.2 million for fiscal 2015 from $50.9 million for fiscal 2014. Investing activities in fiscal 2015 and fiscal 2014 consisted of the following: (i) net amount invested in marketable securities in fiscal 2015
of $78.4 million as compared to a net sale of marketable securities of $23.6 million in fiscal 2014, (ii) proceeds received from sale of fixed maturity plans was $66.1 million in fiscal 2015 as compared to a outflow towards purchase of fixed
maturity plans of $50.5 million in fiscal 2014, (iii) investment in fixed deposits of $9.6 million in fiscal 2015 as compared to nil fixed deposits investments in fiscal 2014, (iv) an amount of $0.3 million paid towards acquisitions of
certain assets and the workforce from iSoftStone in fiscal 2015 as compared to $7.6 million in on account of payment towards the settlement of the second and final installment of the purchase consideration of the Fusion acquisition in fiscal 2014,
(v) the capital expenditures of $23.0 million incurred for leasehold improvements, including the purchase of computers, furniture, fixtures and other office equipment and software (classified as intangibles) associated with expanding the
capacity of our delivery centers, for fiscal 2015, which represented an increase of $3.4 million as compared to fiscal 2014, and (vi) dividend received in fiscal 2015 increased to $4.4 million from $3.1 million in fiscal 2014.
Net cash used in investing activities decreased to $50.9 million for fiscal 2014 from $89.5 million for fiscal 2013. Investing activities in fiscal 2014
consisted of the following: (i) amount invested in FMPs in fiscal 2014 of $50.5 million as compared to $43.0 million in fiscal 2013, (ii) a payment made of $7.6 million towards the settlement of deferred consideration for the acquisition
of Fusion in fiscal 2014 as compared to a payment made of $7.1 million made towards the acquisition (net of cash acquired) of Fusion in fiscal 2013, (iii) net proceeds received from sale of marketable securities increased by $45.4 million in
fiscal 2014 as compared to fiscal 2013, and (iv) the capital expenditures incurred for leasehold improvements, including the purchase of computers, furniture, fixtures and other office equipment and software (classified as intangibles)
associated with expanding the capacity of our delivery centers, for fiscal 2014 was $19.6 million, which represented a decrease of $1.6 million as compared to fiscal 2013.
Cash Flows from Financing Activities
Net cash used in
financing activities was $54.9 million for fiscal 2015, as compared to $14.9 million for fiscal 2014. Financing activities primarily consisted of (i) repayments of long term debt taken by WNS UK of $12.0 million in fiscal 2015 as compared
to repayments of long term debt taken by WNS Global of $8.5 million, by WNS UK of $7.3 million and by WNS Global Services Philippines Inc. of $1.1 million in fiscal 2014, and (ii) repayment of short term debt taken by WNS Global of $39.2
million and by WNS UK of $4.3 million in fiscal 2015 as compared to a short term debt taken by WNS Global of $7.2 million, partially offset by short term debt repaid by WNS UK of $5.6 million in fiscal 2014.
Net cash used in financing activities was $14.9 million for fiscal 2014, as compared to $13.2 million provided by financing activities for fiscal 2013.
Financing activities primarily consisted of (i) repayments of long term debt taken by WNS Global of $8.5 million, by WNS UK of $7.3 million and by WNS Global Services Philippines Inc. of $1.1 million in fiscal 2014 as compared to a repayment of
a long term debt taken by WNS (Mauritius) Limited of $24.0 million and by WNS Global Services Philippines Inc. of $2.1 million and a debt taken by WNS Global of $7.0 million in fiscal 2013, and (ii) short term debt taken by WNS Global of $7.2
million, partially offset by short term debt repayment by WNS UK of $5.6 million in fiscal 2014 as compared to a short term debt taken by WNS Global of $21.3 million and by WNS UK of $11.0 million in fiscal 2013.
Share Repurchases
In March 2015, our shareholders
authorized a share repurchase program for the repurchase of up to 1.1 million of our ADSs, each representing one ordinary share, at a price range of $10 to $30 per ADS. Pursuant to the terms of the repurchase program, our ADSs may be purchased
in the open market from time to time for 12 months from April 1, 2015. We intend to fund the repurchase program with cash on hand. We are not obligated under the repurchase program to repurchase a specific number of ADSs, and the
repurchase program may be suspended at any time at our discretion.
127
New Accounting Pronouncements Not Yet Adopted by our Company
Certain new standards, interpretations and amendments to existing standards have been published that are mandatory for our accounting periods beginning on or
after April 1, 2015 or later periods. Those which are considered to be relevant to our operations are set out below.
i. |
In May 2014, the IASB issued IFRS 15 Revenue from Contracts with Customers (IFRS 15). This standard provides a single, principle-based five-step model to be applied to all contracts with customers. Guidance
is provided on topics such as the point at which revenue is recognized, accounting for variable consideration, costs of fulfilling and obtaining a contract and various other related matters. IFRS 15 also introduced new disclosure requirements
with respect to revenue. |
The five steps in the model under IFRS 15 are : (i) identify the contract with the customer;
(ii) identify the performance obligations in the contract; (iii) determine the transaction price; (iv) allocate the transaction price to the performance obligations in the contracts; and (v) recognize revenue when (or as) the
entity satisfies a performance obligation.
IFRS 15 replaces the following standards and interpretations:
|
|
|
IAS 11 Construction Contracts |
|
|
|
IFRIC 13 Customer Loyalty Programmes |
|
|
|
IFRIC 15 Agreements for the Construction of Real Estate |
|
|
|
IFRIC 18 Transfers of Assets from Customers |
|
|
|
SIC-31 Revenue - Barter Transactions Involving Advertising Services |
When
first applying IFRS 15, it should be applied in full for the current period, including retrospective application to all contracts that were not yet complete at the beginning of that period. In respect of prior periods, the transition guidance allows
an option to either:
|
|
|
apply IFRS 15 in full to prior periods (with certain limited practical expedients being available); or |
|
|
|
retain prior period figures as reported under the previous standards, recognizing the cumulative effect of applying IFRS 15 as an adjustment to the opening balance of equity as at the date of initial application
(beginning of current reporting period). |
IFRS 15 is effective for fiscal years beginning on or after January 1, 2017. Earlier
application is permitted. We are currently evaluating the impact that this new standard will have on our consolidated financial statements.
ii. |
In July 2014, the IASB finalized and issued IFRS 9 Financial Instruments. IFRS 9 replaces IAS 39 Financial instruments: recognition and measurement, the previous Standard which dealt with the
recognition and measurement of financial instruments in its entirety upon the formers effective date. |
Key requirements of IFRS 9:
i. |
Replaces IAS 39s measurement categories with the following three categories: |
|
|
|
fair value through profit or loss (FVTPL) |
|
|
|
fair value through other comprehensive income (FVTOCI) |
128
ii. |
Eliminates the requirement for separation of embedded derivatives from hybrid financial assets, the classification requirements to be applied to the hybrid financial asset in its entirety. |
iii. |
Requires an entity to present the amount of change in fair value due to change in entitys own credit risk in other comprehensive income. |
iv. |
Introduces new impairment model, under which the expected credit loss are required to be recognized as compared to the existing incurred credit loss model of IAS 39.
|
v. |
Fundamental changes in hedge accounting by introduction of new general hedge accounting model which: |
|
|
|
Increases the eligibility of hedged item and hedging instruments; |
|
|
|
Introduces a more principlesbased approach to assess hedge effectiveness. |
IFRS 9 is effective for
annual periods beginning on or after January 1, 2018.
Earlier application is permitted provided that all the requirements in the Standard are
applied at the same time with two exceptions:
i. |
The requirement to present changes in the fair value of a liability due to changes in own credit risk may be applied early in isolation; |
ii. |
Entity may choose as its accounting policy choice to continue to apply hedge accounting requirements of IAS 39 instead of new general hedge accounting model as provided in IFRS 9. |
We are currently evaluating the impact of this new standard on our consolidated financial statements.
129
ITEM 6. DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND EMPLOYEES
A. Directors and Executive Officers
Our Board of
Directors consists of nine directors.
The following table sets forth the name, age (as at March 31, 2015) and position of each of our directors and
executive officers as at the date hereof.
|
|
|
|
|
Name |
|
Age |
|
Designation |
Directors |
|
|
|
|
Adrian T. Dillon(1)(2) |
|
61 |
|
Non-Executive Chairman |
Albert Aboody(3) |
|
67 |
|
Director |
Anthony A. Greener(1)(4) |
|
74 |
|
Director |
Gareth Williams(5) |
|
62 |
|
Director |
Jeremy Young(6) |
|
49 |
|
Director |
John Freeland(6)(7) |
|
61 |
|
Director |
Keshav R. Murugesh |
|
51 |
|
Director and Group Chief Executive Officer |
Michael Menezes(6) |
|
62 |
|
Director |
Renu S. Karnad(1)(2) |
|
62 |
|
Director |
Executive Officers |
|
|
|
|
Keshav R. Murugesh |
|
51 |
|
Group Chief Executive Officer |
Sanjay Puria |
|
41 |
|
Group Chief Financial Officer |
Ronald Gillette |
|
58 |
|
Chief Operating Officer |
Swaminathan Rajamani |
|
38 |
|
Chief People Officer |
Notes:
(1) |
Member of our Compensation Committee. |
(2) |
Member of our Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee. |
(3) |
Chairman of our Audit Committee |
(4) |
Chairman of our Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee. |
(5) |
Chairman of our Compensation Committee. |
(6) |
Member of our Audit Committee. |
(7) |
Appointed as a director of our company with effect from September 1, 2014 |
Summarized below is relevant
biographical information covering at least the past five years for each of our directors and executive officers.
130
Directors
Adrian T. Dillon was appointed to our Board of Directors in September 2012 and was designated as Non-Executive Vice Chairman of the Board in
January 2013. In January 2014 he was appointed as the Non-Executive Chairman of the Board. He is currently a member of the Board of Directors and Chairman of the Audit and Finance Committees of Williams-Sonoma, Inc. and member of the Board
of Directors and Chairman of the Audit Committee of Wonga Group Ltd. During his career, he has served as a member of the Board of NDS Group Limited, from 2011 to 2012, Verigy Pty, from 2006 to 2007 and LumiLeds Inc., from 2002 to 2007. He has also
held key finance roles including Chief Financial and Administrative Officer at Skype Limited, from 2010 to 2011, Executive Vice PresidentFinance & Administration and Chief Financial Officer at Agilent Technologies, Inc., from
2001 to 2010 and held various positions at Eaton Corporation, from 1979 to 2001, including Executive Vice President and Chief Financial and Planning Officer from 1995-2001. He was a member and past Chairman of The Conference Board Council of
Financial Executives. Mr. Dillon graduated from Amherst College with a Bachelor of Arts degree in economics. The business address of Mr. Dillon is 490 University Avenue, Los Altos, CA 94022, USA.
Albert Aboody was appointed to our Board of Directors in June 2010 and also serves as the chairman of our Audit Committee. Mr. Aboody is
based in the US. Prior to his appointment as our director, he was a partner with KPMG, US. In this role, he served on the Board of KPMG, India, including as Deputy Chairman and as head of its audit department. He also co-authored chapters on
the Commissions reporting requirements in the 2001-2008 annual editions of the Corporate Controllers Manual. Mr. Aboody is a member of the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants. He was a post-graduate research scholar
at Cambridge University and received a Bachelor of Arts degree from Princeton University. The business address of Mr. Aboody is 401 E 89th Street, # 19 C, New York, NY 10128, USA.
Sir Anthony A. Greener was appointed to our Board of Directors in June 2007. He was the Deputy Chairman of British Telecom from 2001 to 2006 and
Chairman of the Qualifications and Curriculum Authority from 2002 to 2008 and Diageo plc from 1997 to 2000. Prior to that, Sir Anthony was the Chairman and Chief Executive of Guinness plc from 1992 to 1997 and the Chief Executive Officer of Dunhill
Holdings from 1974 to 1986. Sir Anthony is presently Chairman of the St Giles Trust (since 2009), and the Minton Trust (since 2007). He is a Director of Williams-Sonoma Inc. (since 2007), and United Church Schools which is now known as United
Learning (since 2005). He was a Director of Robert Mondavi from 2000 to 2005. Sir Anthony was honored with a knighthood in 1999 for his services to the beverage industry and is also a Fellow Member of the Chartered Institute of Management
Accountants. The business address of Sir Anthony is the Minton Trust, Dores Hill, North Sydmonton, Newbury, Berkshire RG20 9AF, England.
Gareth
Williams was appointed to our Board of Directors in January 2014. Currently Mr. Williams serves as the Non-Executive Director of YSC and as an independent director of Saga plc. He also served as the advisor to the CEO of Diageo Plc until
June 2014. Prior to his appointment to our Board, he was Director Human Resources at Diageo plc, one of the worlds leading premium drink companies. Prior to taking over as Head of Human Resources at Diageo in January 1999, Mr. Williams
held a series of key positions in HR at Grand Metropolitan, plc in North America and the UK from 1984 to 1998, leading up to the merger with Guinness that formed Diageo. Before joining Grand Metropolitan, he spent 10 years with Ford of Britain in a
number of HR roles. Mr. Williams graduated with a Bachelor of Arts degree in Economics from Warwick University. The business address of Mr. Williams is High Trees, Wildernesse Avenue, Sevenoaks, Kent TN15 0EA, UK.
Jeremy Young was appointed to our Board of Directors in May 2004, as a nominee of Warburg Pincus which was the principal shareholder of our
company. Having exited Warburg Pincus, he became independent director from January 2013. During his 20 years at Warburg Pincus, he ran the firms Healthcare, Internet and Business Services sectors in Europe, headed the German office
and was responsible for fundraising in Europe and the Middle East. Prior to joining Warburg Pincus in 1992, Mr. Young held various positions at Baxter Healthcare International, Booz, Allen & Hamilton International and Cellular
Transplant/Cytotherapeutics. He received a Bachelor of Arts degree from Cambridge University and a Master of Business Administration degree from Harvard Business School. He is currently a Vice Chairman of The Haemophilia Society, a UK-based
charitable organization. The business address for Mr. Young is Gloucester House, 29 Pembridge Gardens, London W2 4EB, England.
John Freeland
was appointed to our Board of Directors in September 2014. Mr. Freeland is the Chairman and Co-founder of Surface Architectural Supply Inc. He is also the founder of JF Fitness of Virginia. He was on the Board of Compuware Corporation from
March 2014 until December 2014. He has over 35 years of experience. Most recently, he was the CEO of Symphony Information Resources, Inc. from October 2007 to May 2012, a leading global provider of information, insights and decision solutions. In
his previous roles, he was PresidentWorldwide Operations for salesforce.com and a Managing Partner at Accenture in the areas of global Insurance and global Customer Relationship Management. During his 26-year career at Accenture, he was also
appointed as a member of Accentures executive committee. Mr. Freeland has a Bachelor of Arts degree in Economics from Columbia College and a Master of Business Administration degree from Columbia University. The business address of
Mr. Freeland is 1241 Gulf of Mexico Drive, Apt 1103 Longboat Key, Florida 34228, US.
131
Keshav R. Murugesh was appointed as our Group Chief Executive Officer and director in February 2010.
Mr. Murugesh is based out of Mumbai. Prior to joining WNS, Mr. Murugesh was the Chief Executive Officer of Syntel Inc., a Nasdaq-listed information technology company. He holds a Bachelor of Commerce degree and is a Fellow of The Institute
of Chartered Accountants of India. Prior to Syntel, he worked in various capacities with ITC Limited, an affiliate of BAT Plc. between 1989 and 2002. He is the chairman of the Business Process Management (BPM) Council of NASSCOM since 2013 and a
nominated member of the NASSCOM Executive Council. NASSCOM is the industry association for the IT-BPM sector in India. He is on the Board of WNS Cares Foundation, a company that focuses on sustainability initiatives. He was the Chairman of SIFE
(Students in Free Enterprise) India, which is a global organization involved in educational outreach projects in partnership with businesses across the globe, from 2005 to 2011. The business address for Mr. Murugesh is Gate 4, Godrej &
Boyce Complex, Pirojshanagar, Vikhroli West, Mumbai 400 079, India.
Michael Menezes was appointed to our Board of Directors in January 2014.
Mr. Menezes presently serves as the special advisor to the Continental Bank of Canada and also as an Executive-in-Residence to the MBA students at Ryerson University in Toronto on a voluntary basis. He has also set up a sole proprietor
business, Acumentor Inc. which is engaged in providing consulting and other services. Most recently, he was the CFO, Technology, Operations and Corporate Group at Bank of Montreal from 2000 to 2012. Mr. Menezes has over two decades of global
exposure, both as CEO and CFO in the Financial Services, Consumer Goods and Agri-business sectors. In his previous stints, he has been the CFO for ONIC (Holding), CEO of ITC Agro Tech Ltd., India, apart from holding various senior finance roles at
ITC Ltd. in India. Mr. Menezes received a Bachelor of Arts Degree in Economics from University of Delhi, India and a Masters degree in Economics from London School of Economics, UK. He is also a Chartered Accountant (CA) from the
Institute of Chartered Accountants of India. The home/ business address of Mr. Menezes is 220 Cummer Avenue, Toronto, Canada M2M 2E7.
Renu
S. Karnad was appointed to our Board of Directors in September 2012. Mrs. Karnad had joined Housing Development Finance Corporation Limited (HDFC Ltd) in 1978 and is currently serving as the Managing Director of HDFC Limited. She is
also a director on several other Boards, including BOSCH Limited, Gruh Finance Limited, HDFC Bank Limited, HDFC Asset Management Company Limited, HDFC Ergo General Insurance Company Limited, HDFC Property Ventures Limited, HDFC Standard Life
Insurance Company Limited, Credila Financial Services Private Limited, Indraprastha Medical Corporation Limited, Feedback Infrastructure Services Private Limited, Lafarge India Private Limited, EIH Limited, HIREF International LLC, HIREF
International Fund II Pte. Limited, HIF International Fund Pte. Limited, ABB India Limited, H T Parekh Foundation, and HDFC Plc. Mrs. Karnad holds a Masters degree in Economics from the University of Delhi and is a graduate in law from
the University of Mumbai. She has also been a Parvin Fellow at Princeton Universitys Woodrow Wilson School of International Affairs. The business address of Mrs. Karnad is HDFC Limited, Capital Court, 1st Floor, Munirka, Off Palme Marg,
New Delhi 110067.
Our Board believes that each of our companys directors is skilled, experienced and qualified to serve as a member of the
Board and its committees. Each of the directors, because of their diverse business experience and background, contribute significantly in managing the affairs of our company. The Board of Directors has not adopted any formal policy with respect to
diversity, however, our Board of Directors believes that it is important for its members to represent diverse viewpoints and contribute in the Boards decision making process. Our Board evaluates candidates for election to the Board; the Board
seeks candidates with certain qualities that it believes are important, including experience, integrity, an objective perspective, business acumen and leadership skills. The continuing service by our directors promotes stability and continuity in
the boardroom and gives us the benefit of their familiarity and insights into our business.
Executive Officers
Keshav R. Murugesh is our Group Chief Executive Officer. Please see Directors above for Mr. Murugeshs biographical
information.
Sanjay Puria serves as our Group Chief Financial Officer. He is based out of Mumbai, India and leads WNSs global finance
function. Presently, he serves on the Board of WNS Cares Foundation. Mr. Puria has over 16 years of experience, out of which over 12 years have been in the offshore services industry. He is a veteran at WNS, having managed several key finance
functions including corporate strategy, mergers and acquisitions, financial planning and analysis, and strategic business development before taking over as the Group CFO in August 2013. Prior to joining WNS in 2010, he was at the helm of operations
for a global provider of integrated information technology and knowledge process outsourcing solutions, where his role centered around managing acquisitions, joint ventures, complex and multi-year contracts, strategizing on geographical expansion,
revenue and cost management, pricing and commercials, and implementation of LEAN initiatives. Mr. Puria is a Chartered Accountant (CA) from the Institute of Chartered Accountants of India and has passed the Certified Public Accountant
(CPA) examination from the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants. The business address of Mr. Puria is Gate 4, Godrej & Boyce Complex, Pirojshanagar, Vikhroli, (West) Mumbai 400 079, India.
132
Ronald Gillette is our Chief Operating Officer and is responsible for WNS global sales, operations
and capability creation. Based in Mumbai, he drives WNS strategic plans and operating results. Prior to joining WNS in 2013, Mr. Gillette worked with Xerox in the US and Europe from 2007 to 2013. Most recently, he was the Group President,
Xerox Business Services in Europe with responsibility for all Financial Services and Insurance clients, and previously led its global Finance and Accounting Outsourcing (FAO) business. Before joining Xerox Services, Gillette was a senior partner at
Accenture, responsible for growing its BPM business. He has also worked with Deloitte Consulting, Ernst & Young and EDS in various leadership roles with a focus on building outsourcing businesses. He has a Bachelor of Science degree from
the United States Military Academy, at West Point. He holds a Masters in Business Administration degree from Marymount University in Arlington, Virginia. The business address of Mr. Gillette is Gate 4, Godrej & Boyce Complex,
Pirojshanagar, Vikhroli, (West) Mumbai 400 079, India.
Swaminathan Rajamani is our Chief People Officer. He leads WNS Human Resources
function, and is responsible for the entire gamut of people-oriented processes. Prior to joining WNS in November 2010, he was with CA Technologies, where he served as Vice PresidentHuman Resources and was the Country HeadHR for India. He
has also served as Head of HR Operations at Syntel and thereafter, for a short while, was its Global HR Head. Prior to Syntel, he had a long tenure at GE spanning multiple roles such as Master Black BeltHR and Assistant Vice President and
HeadOperations for HR, Customer Research and Operational Analytics, apart from other roles in mergers and acquisitions. Presently, he serves on the Board of WNS Cares Foundation and WNS Global Services Private Limited. He is a certified Change
Acceleration Coach and a keen practitioner of Six Sigma. Swaminathan has a Masters in Social Work (MSW) from the University of Madras. The business address of Mr. Rajamani is Gate 4, Godrej & Boyce Complex, Pirojshanagar,
Vikhroli, (West) Mumbai 400 079, India.
B. Compensation
Compensation Discussion and Analysis
Compensation
Objectives
Our compensation philosophy is to align employee compensation with our business objectives, so that compensation is used as a strategic
tool that helps us recruit, motivate and retain highly talented individuals who are committed to our core values: clients first, integrity, respect, collaboration, learning and excellence. We believe that our compensation programs are integral to
achieving our goal of One WNS One GoalOutperform!
Our Compensation Committee is responsible for reviewing the overall goals and
objectives of our executive compensation programs, as well as our compensation plans, and making changes to such goals, objectives and plans. Our Compensation Committee bases our executive compensation programs on the following objectives, which
guide us in establishing and maintaining all of our compensation programs:
|
|
|
Pay Differentiation: Based on the Job Responsibility, Individual Performance and Company Performance. As employees progress to higher levels in our company, their ability to directly impact our
results and strategic initiatives increases. Therefore, as employees progress, an increasing proportion of their pay is linked to company performance and tied to creation of shareholder value. |
|
|
|
Pay for Performance. Our compensation is designed to pay for performance and thus we provide higher compensation for strong performance and, conversely, lower compensation for poor performance and/or where
company performance falls short of expectations. Our compensation programs are designed to ensure that successful, high-performing employees remain motivated and committed during periods of temporary downturns in our performance. |
|
|
|
Balanced in Focus on Long Term versus Short Term Goals. As part of our compensation philosophy, we believe that equity-based compensation should be higher for employees with greater levels of
responsibility and influence on our long term results. Therefore, a significant portion of these individuals total compensation is dependent on our long term share price appreciation. In addition, our compensation philosophy seeks to
incentivize our executives to focus on achieving short term performance goals in a manner that supports and encourages long term success and profitability. |
|
|
|
Competitive Value of the Job in the Marketplace. In order to attract and retain a highly skilled work force in a global market space, we remain competitive with the pay of other employers who compete with
us for talent in relevant markets. |
133
|
|
|
Easy to understand. We believe that all aspects of executive compensation should be clearly, comprehensibly and promptly disclosed to employees in order to effectively motivate them. Employees need
to easily understand how their efforts can affect their pay, both directly through individual performance accomplishments and indirectly through contributions to achieving our strategic, financial and operational goals. We also believe that
compensation for our employees should be administered uniformly across our company with clear-cut objectives and performance metrics to eliminate the potential for individual supervisor bias. |
Our Compensation Committee also considers risk when developing our compensation programs and believes that the design of our compensation programs should not
encourage excessive or inappropriate risk taking.
Components of Executive Compensation
The compensation of our executive officers consists of the following five primary components:
|
|
|
Base salary or, in the case of executive officers based in India, fixed compensation; |
|
|
|
Cash bonus or variable incentive; |
|
|
|
Equity incentive grants of RSUs; |
|
|
|
Other benefits and perquisites; and |
The following is a discussion of our considerations in determining each of the
compensation components for our executive officers.
Base Salary or Fixed Compensation
Base salary is a fixed element of our executives annual cash compensation, which is not tied to any performance criteria. We consider base salary an
important part of an executives compensation and our Compensation Committee reviews each executive officers base salary annually as well as at the time of a promotion or other change in responsibility. Any base salary adjustments are
usually approved early in the fiscal year, effective as at April 1, or as set out in the relevant employment agreement. The specific amount of base salary for each executive officer depends on the executives role, scope of
responsibilities, experience and skills. Market practices are also considered in setting base salaries. Base salaries are intended to assist us in attracting executives and recognizing differing levels of responsibility and contribution among
executives.
Cash Bonus or Variable Incentive
In
addition to base salary, annual cash bonuses are another important piece of total compensation for our executive officers. Annual bonus opportunities are intended to support the achievement of our business strategies by tying a meaningful portion of
compensation to the achievement of established objectives for the year. These objectives are discussed in more detail below. Annual bonus opportunities also are a key tool in attracting highly sought-after executives, and cash bonuses add a variable
component to our overall compensation structure.
134
Equity Incentive Grants of RSUs
Our equity-based incentive program, through which we grant RSUs, is a key element of the total compensation for our executive officers. This equity-based
incentive program is intended to attract and retain highly qualified individuals, align their long term interests with those of our shareholders, avoid short term focus and effectively execute our long term business strategies. Our equity-based
compensation is subject to multi-year vesting requirements by which executives gains can either be realized through (i) the achievement of set performance criteria and continued employment through the vesting period, or, simply,
(ii) continued employment through the vesting period.
We believe that the executive officers of our Company should also own and hold our equity to
further align their interests with the long-term interests of our shareholders and further promote our commitment to sound corporate governance practices. To achieve this, we have adopted share ownership guidelines, pursuant to which each executive
officer is required to achieve their respective target share ownership level over a period of five years. For further details see Part I Item 6E Share Ownership Share Ownership Guidelines
Other Benefits and Perquisites
We provide benefits and
perquisites to our executive officers that are generally available to and consistent with those provided to our other employees in the country in which the executive officer is located. We believe these benefits are consistent with the objectives of
our compensation philosophy and allow our executive officers to work more efficiently. Such benefits and perquisites are intended to enhance the competitiveness of our overall compensation program. Such benefits normally include medical, accidental
and life insurance coverage, retirement benefits, club membership, reimbursement of telephone expenses, a car and related maintenance expenses, leased residential accommodation and other miscellaneous benefits which are customary in the location
where the executive officer resides and are generally available to other employees in the country. All executive officers are covered by the directors and officers liability insurance policy maintained by us.
Severance Benefits
Under the terms of our employment
agreements, we are sometimes obligated to pay severance or other enhanced benefits to our executive officers upon termination of their employment.
Our
executive officers globally have enhanced levels of benefits based on their job level, seniority and probable loss of employment after a change in control. Executive officers generally are paid severance for a longer period as compared to other
employees.
|
|
|
Accelerated vesting of equity awards. All granted but unvested share options and RSUs would vest immediately and become exercisable by our executive officers subject to certain conditions set out in the
applicable equity incentive plans or their individual employment agreements. |
|
|
|
Severance and notice payment. Eligible terminated executive officers would receive severance and notice payments as reflected in their individual employment agreements. |
|
|
|
Benefit continuation. Eligible terminated executive officers would receive basic employee benefits such as medical and life insurance and other perquisites as reflected in their individual employment agreements.
|
In addition, we provide change in control severance protection to certain executive officers. Our Compensation Committee believes that such
protection is intended to preserve employee morale and productivity and encourage retention in the face of the disruptive impact of an actual or rumored change in control. In addition, for executive officers, the program is intended to align
executive officers and shareholders interests by enabling executive officers to consider corporate transactions that are in the best interests of our shareholders and other constituents without undue concern over whether the transactions
may jeopardize the executive officers own interest or employment.
135
Our Assessment Process
Our Compensation Committee has established a number of processes to assist it in ensuring that our executive compensation programs are achieving their
objectives. Our Compensation Committee typically reviews each component of compensation at least every 12 months with the goal of allocating compensation between long term and currently paid compensation and between cash and non-cash
compensation, and combining the compensation elements for each executive in a manner we believe best fulfills the objectives of our compensation programs.
Our Compensation Committee is responsible for reviewing the performance of each of our executive officers, approving the compensation level of each of our
executive officers, establishing criteria for the grant of equity awards for each of our executive officers and approving such equity grants. Each of these tasks is generally performed annually by our Compensation Committee.
There are no predetermined individual or corporate performance factors or goals that are used by our Compensation Committee to establish the amounts or mix of
any elements of compensation for the executive officers. Our Compensation Committee works closely with our Group Chief Executive Officer, discussing with him our companys overall performance and his evaluation of and compensation
recommendations for our executive officers. From time to time, our Compensation Committee also seeks the advice and recommendations of an external compensation consultant to benchmark certain components of our compensation practices against those of
its peers. The companies selected for such benchmarking include companies in similar industries and generally of similar sizes and market capitalizations. Where compensation information is not available for any specific position an executive officer
holds for companies that provide business and technology services, our Compensation Committee reviews data corresponding to the most comparable position and also considers the comparative experience of executives.
Our Compensation Committee then utilizes its judgment and experience in making all compensation determinations. Our Compensation Committees
determination of compensation levels is based upon what the members of the committee deem appropriate, considering information such as the factors listed above, as well as input from our Group Chief Executive Officer and, from time to time,
information and advice provided by an independent compensation consultant.
Other processes that our Compensation Committee has established to assist in
ensuring that our compensation programs operate in line with their objectives are:
|
|
|
Assessment of Company Performance: Our Compensation Committee uses financial performance measures to determine a significant portion of the size of payouts under our cash bonus program. The financial performance
measures, adopted on improving both top line (which refers to our revenue less repair payments as described in Part I Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects Overview) and bottom line (which refers to
our adjusted net income, or ANI, which is calculated as our profit excluding amortization of intangible assets and share-based compensation) and other measures, such as operating margin are pre-established by our Compensation Committee annually at
the beginning of the fiscal year. When the pre-determined financial measures are achieved, executive officers receive amounts that are set for these targets. These measures reflect targets that are intended to be aggressive but attainable. The
remainder of an individuals payout under our cash bonus program is determined by the achievement of individual performance objectives. |
136
|
|
|
Assessment of Individual Performance: Individual performance has a strong impact on the compensation of all employees, including our executive officers. The evaluation of an individuals performance
determines a portion of the size of payouts under our cash bonus program and also influences any changes in base salary. At the beginning of each fiscal year, our Compensation Committee, along with our Group Chief Executive Officer, set the
respective performance objectives for the fiscal year for the executive officers. The performance objectives are initially proposed by our Group Chief Executive Officer and modified, as appropriate, by our Compensation Committee based on the
performance assessment conducted for the preceding fiscal year and also looking at goals for the current fiscal year. Every evaluation metric is supplemented with key performance indicators. At the end of the fiscal year, our Group Chief Executive
Officer discusses individuals respective achievement of the pre-established objectives as well as their contribution to our companys overall performance and other leadership accomplishments. This evaluation is shared with our
Compensation Committee. After the discussion, our Compensation Committee, in discussion with our Group Chief Executive Officer, assigns a corresponding numerical performance rating that translates into specific payouts under our cash bonus program
and also influences any changes in base salary. |
The Compensation Committee approves awards under our cash bonus or variable incentive
program consistent with the achievement of applicable goals. The Committee on occasion makes exceptions to payments in strict accordance with achievement of goals based on unusual or extraordinary circumstances. Executive officers must be on the
payroll of our company on the last day of the fiscal year, March 31, to be eligible for payment under our cash bonus or variable incentive program.
Although most of our compensation decisions are taken in the first quarter of the fiscal year, our compensation planning process neither begins nor ends with
any particular Compensation Committee meeting. Compensation decisions are designed to promote our fundamental business objectives and strategy. Our Compensation Committee periodically reviews related matters such as succession planning, evaluation
of management performance and consideration of the business environment and considers such matters in making compensation decisions.
Benchmarking
and Use of Compensation Consultant for Fiscal 2015
During fiscal 2015, our Compensation Committee reviewed compensation programs for our executive
officers against publicly available compensation data, which was compiled directly by our external compensation consultant. The companies selected by our external compensation consultant for its survey for benchmarking our executive officers
compensation included companies in similar industries and generally of similar sizes and market capitalizations.
The list of peer companies against which
we benchmarked the compensation of our executive officers in fiscal 2015 included the following:
|
|
|
EXL Service Holdings Inc.; |
|
|
|
First Source Solutions Limited; |
|
|
|
Wipro Technologies (BPO); |
137
Our Compensation Committee used the data derived by our external compensation consultant primarily to ensure that
our executive compensation programs are competitive. A selected subset of peer companies from those listed above that were found most closely comparable as benchmark for a particular position were considered to arrive at the compensation benchmark
review of individual executive officers. Where compensation information was not publicly disclosed for a specific management position in the relevant industry, our Compensation Committee reviewed data corresponding to the most comparable position
and also considered the comparative experience of the relevant executive officers.
There is enough flexibility in the existing compensation programs to
respond and adjust to the evolving business environment. Accordingly, an individuals compensation elements could be changed by our Compensation Committee based on changes in job responsibilities of the executive. In addition to input from our
external compensation consultants survey, our Compensation Committee also took into consideration our performance and industry indicators in deciding our compensation for fiscal 2015.
Based on the elements listed above and in line with our compensation philosophy, in fiscal 2015 our Compensation Committee adjusted our executive officers
compensation as described in Executive Compensation for Fiscal 2015 below.
Executive Compensation for Fiscal 2015
Total Compensation of Executive Officers
The following
table sets forth the total compensation paid or proposed to be paid to each of our Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer and other named executive officers for services rendered in fiscal 2015 (excluding grants of RSUs which are described
below). The individual compensation of Messrs. Keshav R. Murugesh, Sanjay Puria, Ronald Gillette and Swaminathan Rajamani are disclosed in the statutory / annual accounts of our subsidiary, WNS Global Services (P) Ltd., filed with the
Registrar of Companies in the state of India where its registered office is located.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Name |
|
Base Salary(1) |
|
|
Benefits |
|
|
Bonus |
|
|
Total |
|
Keshav R. Murugesh |
|
$ |
560,475 |
|
|
$ |
54,996 |
|
|
$ |
1,047,683 |
|
|
$ |
1,663,154 |
|
Sanjay Puria |
|
$ |
197,821 |
|
|
$ |
10,789 |
|
|
$ |
183,568 |
|
|
$ |
392,178 |
|
Ronald Gillette |
|
$ |
392,527 |
|
|
$ |
21,080 |
|
|
$ |
394,138 |
|
|
$ |
807,745 |
|
Swaminathan Rajamani |
|
$ |
174,456 |
|
|
$ |
9,530 |
|
|
$ |
161,887 |
|
|
$ |
345,873 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
1,325,279 |
|
|
$ |
96,395 |
|
|
$ |
1,787,276 |
|
|
$ |
3,208,950 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note:
(1) |
Base salary does not include amount contributed towards provident fund which is set out in the table under Other Benefits and Perquisites. |
Base Salary or Fixed Compensation
In reviewing base
salaries for executive officers, our Compensation Committee reviewed compensation programs for our executive officers against publicly available compensation data compiled by our external compensation consultant and considered local market
conditions, market data, the executive officers experience and responsibilities, the perceived risk of having to replace the named executive officer and the fact that the executive officers for fiscal 2015 had satisfactorily performed against
their prior years individual performance objectives.
138
Our Compensation Committee has made the following changes to the base salary from the prior years level :
|
|
|
Mr. Keshav R. Murugeshs base salary (including employer contribution towards Provident Fund (Retirement Benefit)) was revised to $656,927 from $597,206 in fiscal 2015. The salary revision was effective
February 19, 2015. |
|
|
|
Mr. Sanjay Purias base salary (including employer contribution towards Provident Fund (Retirement Benefit)) was revised to $207,795 from $163,618 in fiscal 2015. The salary revision was effective
April 1, 2014. |
|
|
|
Mr. Ronald Gillettes base salary (including employer contribution towards Provident Fund (Retirement Benefit)) was $412,318 in fiscal 2015. There was no change in the compensation during 2015.
|
|
|
|
Mr. Swaminathan Rajamanis base salary (including employer contribution towards Provident Fund (Retirement Benefit)) was revised to $183,253 from $163,618 in fiscal 2015. The salary revision was effective
April 1, 2014. |
Cash Bonus or Variable Incentive
Our Compensation Committee believes that the executive officers must work as a team and focus primarily on company goals rather than solely on individual
goals. Our Compensation Committee believes that enhancing the long term value of our company requires increased revenue (both from existing and new clients), improved contribution and increased ANI. Finally our Compensation Committee believes it
must also reward and encourage individual performance and therefore assigned certain weightages of the variable incentive to company and individual objectives, including achievement of targets for our revenue less repair payments, ANI, operating
margin and certain individual goals for various executive officers. Such bonuses are typically paid in April and/or May each year. The aggregate amount of all cash bonuses to be paid for fiscal 2015 does not exceed the aggregate cash bonus
pool approved by our Compensation Committee for the fiscal year 2015. Each of our executive officers variable incentive packages for fiscal 2015 are as described below:
Our Compensation Committee set Mr. Murugeshs target variable incentive, or cash bonus, for 2015 at $656,927 for 100% achievement of objectives. Our
Compensation Committee assigned as Mr. Murugeshs performance objectives the achievement of targets for our revenue less repair payments and ANI, and individual performance objectives. Mr. Murugesh earned 173.5% of his variable
incentive amount on an overall basis.
Our Compensation Committee set Mr. Purias target variable incentive for 2015 at $103,898 for 100%
achievement of objectives. Our Compensation Committee assigned as Mr. Purias performance objectives the achievement of targets for our revenue less repair payments and ANI, and individual performance objectives. Based on actual
performance against these various objectives, Mr. Puria earned 176.7% of his variable incentive amount on an overall basis.
Our Compensation
Committee set Mr. Gillettes target variable incentive for 2015 at $412,318 for 100% achievement of objectives. Our Compensation Committee assigned as Mr. Gillettes performance objectives the achievement of targets for revenue
less repair payments, ANI and operating margins for our various vertical business units, and individual performance objectives. Based on actual performance against these various objectives, Mr. Gillette earned 95.6% of his variable incentive
amount on an overall basis.
Our Compensation Committee set Mr. Swaminathans target variable incentive for 2015 at $91,626 for 100% achievement
of objectives. Our Compensation Committee assigned as Mr. Swaminathans performance objectives the achievement of targets for our revenue less repair payments and ANI, and individual performance objectives. Based on actual performance
against these various objectives, Mr. Swaminathan earned 176.7% of his variable incentive amount on an overall basis.
139
Equity Incentive Grants of RSUs
During fiscal 2015, we continued the equity incentive scheme which has a vesting schedule linked to continued employment with our company through vesting date,
achievement of financial performance targets and achievement of a certain level of share price appreciation.
Consistent with our philosophy on equity
grants to our executive officers, we awarded the following number of RSUs to our executive officers:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Name |
|
Date of Grant |
|
|
Total RSUs Granted for Fiscal 2015 |
|
|
Grant Date Fair Value ($) (1) |
|
|
Expiration Date |
|
Keshav R. Murugesh |
|
|
29-Apr-14 |
|
|
|
324,537 |
|
|
$ |
19.27 |
|
|
|
28-Apr-24 |
|
Sanjay Puria |
|
|
29-Apr-14 |
|
|
|
30,000 |
|
|
$ |
19.27 |
|
|
|
28-Apr-24 |
|
Ronald Gillette |
|
|
29-Apr-14 |
|
|
|
26,400 |
|
|
$ |
19.27 |
|
|
|
28-Apr-24 |
|
Swaminathan Rajamani |
|
|
29-Apr-14 |
|
|
|
21,600 |
|
|
$ |
19.27 |
|
|
|
28-Apr-24 |
|
Note:
(1) |
The amounts shown under this column reflect the dollar amount of the grant date fair value of equity-based RSUs granted during the year. The fair value of RSUs is generally the market price of our shares on the date of
grant. |
Other Benefits and Perquisites
The retirement plans, health and welfare benefits provided to executive officers are the same plans and benefits available to all other employees of our
company.
All directors and officers, including executive officers, are covered by the directors and officers liability insurance policy
maintained by our company.
Additional perquisites provided to executive officers in fiscal 2015 are summarized below:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Name |
|
Provident Fund |
|
|
Insurance Benefits |
|
|
Club Membership |
|
|
Total |
|
Keshav R. Murugesh |
|
$ |
43,485 |
|
|
$ |
1,768 |
|
|
$ |
9,744 |
|
|
$ |
54,997 |
|
Sanjay Puria |
|
$ |
9,974 |
|
|
$ |
814 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
10,788 |
|
Ronald Gillette |
|
$ |
19,791 |
|
|
$ |
1,289 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
21,080 |
|
Swaminathan Rajamani |
|
$ |
8,796 |
|
|
$ |
734 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
9,530 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
82,046 |
|
|
$ |
4,605 |
|
|
$ |
9,744 |
|
|
$ |
96,395 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
140
Non-executive Director Compensation for Fiscal 2015
Total Compensation of Non-executive Directors
The
following table sets forth the compensation paid or proposed to be paid to our non-executive directors for services rendered in fiscal 2015 (excluding grants of RSUs which are described below):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Name |
|
Retainer Fees |
|
|
Sitting Fees |
|
|
Non-executive Chairman |
|
|
Total |
|
Eric B. Herr (1) |
|
$ |
5,250 |
|
|
$ |
1,000 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
6,250 |
|
Adrian T. Dillon |
|
$ |
63,000 |
|
|
$ |
4,000 |
|
|
$ |
120,000 |
(2) |
|
$ |
187,000 |
|
Jeremy Young |
|
$ |
63,000 |
|
|
$ |
4,000 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
67,000 |
|
Anthony A. Greener |
|
$ |
63,000 |
|
|
$ |
6,000 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
69,000 |
|
Albert Aboody |
|
$ |
63,000 |
|
|
$ |
4,000 |
|
|
$ |
15,000 |
(3) |
|
$ |
82,000 |
|
Renu S. Karnad |
|
$ |
63,000 |
|
|
$ |
4,000 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
67,000 |
|
Gareth Williams |
|
$ |
63,000 |
|
|
$ |
3,000 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
66,000 |
|
Michael Menezes |
|
$ |
63,000 |
|
|
$ |
4,000 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
67,000 |
|
John Freeland(4) |
|
$ |
36,750 |
|
|
$ |
2,000 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
38,750 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
483,000 |
|
|
$ |
32,000 |
|
|
$ |
135,000 |
|
|
$ |
650,000 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Notes:
(1) |
Mr. Eric B. Herr retired as a director of our company with effect from April 30, 2014. |
(2) |
Fee paid to Mr. Adrian T. Dillon for serving as chairman of our Board of Directors in fiscal 2015. |
(3) |
Fee paid to Mr. Albert Aboody for serving as chairman of our Audit Committee in fiscal 2015. |
(4) |
Mr. John Freeland was appointed as a director of our company with effect from September 1, 2014. |
Equity
Incentive Grants of RSUs to Non-executive Directors
The following table sets forth information concerning RSUs awarded to our non-executive directors
in fiscal 2015. No options were granted in fiscal 2015.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Name |
|
Date of Grant |
|
|
Total RSUs Granted for Fiscal 2015 |
|
|
Grant Date Fair Value ($)(1) |
|
|
Expiration Date |
|
Adrian T. Dillon |
|
|
22-Jul-14 |
|
|
|
8,940 |
|
|
$ |
20.47 |
|
|
|
21-Jul-24 |
|
Jeremy Young |
|
|
22-Jul-14 |
|
|
|
3,078 |
|
|
$ |
20.47 |
|
|
|
21-Jul-24 |
|
John Freeland(2) |
|
|
21-Oct-14 |
|
|
|
6,235 |
|
|
$ |
20.21 |
|
|
|
20-Oct-24 |
|
Anthony A. Greener |
|
|
22-Jul-14 |
|
|
|
3,078 |
|
|
$ |
20.47 |
|
|
|
21-Jul-24 |
|
Albert Aboody |
|
|
22-Jul-14 |
|
|
|
3,810 |
|
|
$ |
20.47 |
|
|
|
21-Jul-24 |
|
Renu S. Karnad |
|
|
22-Jul-14 |
|
|
|
3,078 |
|
|
$ |
20.47 |
|
|
|
21-Jul-24 |
|
Gareth Williams |
|
|
22-Jul-14 |
|
|
|
3,078 |
|
|
$ |
20.47 |
|
|
|
21-Jul-24 |
|
Michael Menezes |
|
|
22-Jul-14 |
|
|
|
3,078 |
|
|
$ |
20.47 |
|
|
|
21-Jul-24 |
|
Notes:
(1) |
The amounts shown under this column reflect the dollar amount of the aggregate grant date fair value of equity-based RSUs granted during the year. The fair value of RSUs is generally the market price of our shares on
the date of grant. |
(2) |
Mr. John Freeland was appointed as a director of our company with effect from September 1, 2014. |
141
Future grants of awards will continue to be determined by our Board of Directors or our Compensation Committee
under the Third Amended and Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan.
Employment Agreement of our Executive Director
We entered into an employment agreement with Mr. Keshav R. Murugesh in February 2010, which was amended with effect from February 19, 2013, to
serve as our Group Chief Executive Officer for a five-year term, which will renew automatically for three additional successive terms of three years each, unless either we or Mr. Murugesh elects not to renew the term. Our employment agreement
with Mr. Murugesh was further amended effective February 19, 2014 to revise Mr. Murugeshs compensation (including share grants).
Under the terms of the amended agreement, Mr. Murugesh is entitled to receive compensation, health and other benefits and perquisites commensurate with
his position. Pursuant to the agreement, Mr. Murugesh will be eligible to receive annually such number of RSUs to be computed based on our average share price (taking the daily US dollar closing price) during March of the fiscal year preceding
the date of such determination and the value of such grant shall not be less than eight times the sum of his annual base salary. Mr. Murugesh is entitled to receive additional performance-based grants for meeting additional performance-based
criteria, the value of such grant being up to 20% of six times the sum of his annual base salary. Any grants of RSUs to Mr. Murugesh will be made pursuant to and in accordance with our Third Amended and Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan.
If Mr. Murugeshs employment is terminated by us without cause or by Mr. Murugesh for good reason (each as defined in the amended agreement) or
is terminated for any reason other than those specified in the amended agreement (including without limitation, expiration of his employment period or we elect not to extend his employment), he would be entitled to all accrued and unpaid salary,
accrued and unused vacation and any unreimbursed expenses. Mr. Murugesh would also be entitled to vested benefits and other amounts due to him under our employee benefit plans. Further, where Mr. Murugeshs employment is terminated
for any reason other than those specified in the amended agreement (including without limitation, expiration of his employment period or we elect not to extend his employment), he will also be entitled to his base salary for a period of 12 months
from the effective date of termination and his target bonus for the year in which the termination occurs, both of which will be paid immediately, and all of the share options and RSUs granted to him will vest and the share options and RSUs would
become exercisable on a fully accelerated basis.
Further, where Mr. Murugeshs employment is terminated for reasons of death, disability or
retirement as specified in the amended agreement, he would be entitled to all accrued and unpaid salary and bonus, accrued and unused vacation, any unreimbursed expenses and vested benefits and other amounts due to him under our employee benefit
plans, and all of the share options and RSUs granted to him will vest and the share options and RSUs would become exercisable on a fully accelerated basis.
In addition to the above, if Mr. Murugeshs employment is terminated by us without cause or by Mr. Murugesh for good reason, and
Mr. Murugesh executes and delivers a non-revocable general release of claims in favor of our company, subject to his continued compliance with certain non-competition and confidentiality obligations, Mr. Murugesh would be entitled to
receive the following severance payments and benefits from us:
1. |
His base salary for a period of 12 months from the effective date of termination, which will be paid immediately; |
2. |
His target bonus for the year in which the termination occurs, which will be paid immediately; and |
3. |
Automatic accelerated vesting of RSUs or share options granted him that would have vested with him through the next two vesting dates of each grant from the effective date of termination. Full accelerated vesting will
occur in case of termination of employment for good reason. |
If we experience a change in control (as defined in our Third Restated and
Amended Incentive Award Plan) while Mr. Murugesh is employed under the employment agreement, all of the share options and RSUs granted to Mr. Murugesh under the employment agreement will vest and the share options and RSUs would become
exercisable on a fully accelerated basis.
142
Employee Benefit Plans
2002 Stock Incentive Plan
We adopted the 2002
Stock Incentive Plan on July 3, 2002 to help attract and retain the best available personnel to serve us and our subsidiaries as officers, directors and employees. We terminated the 2002 Stock Incentive Plan upon our adoption of our 2006
Incentive Award Plan effective upon the pricing of our initial public offering as described below. Upon termination of the 2002 Stock Incentive Plan, the shares that would otherwise have been available for the grant under the 2002 Stock Incentive
Plan were effectively rolled over into the 2006 Incentive Award Plan which was amended and restated in 2009 and any awards outstanding remain in full force and effect in accordance with the terms of the 2002 Stock Incentive Plan.
Administration. The 2002 Stock Incentive Plan is administered by our Board of Directors, which may delegate its authority to a committee (in either
case, the Administrator). The Administrator has complete authority, subject to the terms of the 2002 Stock Incentive Plan and applicable law, to make all determinations necessary or advisable for the administration of the 2002 Stock
Incentive Plan.
Eligibility. Under the 2002 Stock Incentive Plan, the Administrator was authorized to grant share options to our officers,
directors and employees, and those of our subsidiaries, subject to the terms and conditions of the 2002 Stock Incentive Plan.
Share Options. Share
options vest and become exercisable as determined by the Administrator and set forth in individual share option agreements, but may not, in any event, be exercised later than ten years after their grant dates. In addition, share options may be
exercised prior to vesting in some cases. Upon exercise, an option holder must tender the full exercise price of the share option in cash, check or other form acceptable to the Administrator, at which time the share options are generally subject to
applicable income, employment and other withholding taxes. Share options may, in the sole discretion of the Administrator as set forth in applicable award agreements, continue to be exercisable for a period following an option holders
termination of service. Shares issued in respect of exercised share options may be subject to additional transfer restrictions. Any grants of share options under the 2002 Stock Incentive Plan to US participants were in the form of non-qualified
share options. Option holders, other than option holders who are employees of our subsidiaries in India, are entitled to exercise their share options for shares or ADSs in our company.
Corporate Transactions. If we engage in a merger or similar corporate transaction, except as may otherwise be provided in an individual award
agreement, outstanding share options will be terminated unless they are assumed by a successor corporation. In addition, the Administrator has broad discretion to adjust the 2002 Stock Incentive Plan and any share options thereunder to account for
any changes in our capitalization.
Amendment. Our Board of Directors may amend or suspend the 2002 Stock Incentive Plan at any time, provided that
any such amendment or suspension must not impact any holder of outstanding share options without such holders consent.
Transferability of Share
Options. Each share option may be exercised during the option holders lifetime only by the option holder. No share option may be sold, pledged, assigned, hypothecated, transferred or disposed of by an option holder other than by express
permission of the Administrator (only in the case of employees of non-Indian subsidiaries), by will or by the laws of descent and distribution.
Number
of Shares Authorized; Outstanding Options. As of the date of termination of the 2002 Stock Incentive Plan on July 25, 2006, the day immediately preceding the date of pricing of our initial public offering, an aggregate of 6,082,042 of our
ordinary shares had been authorized for grant under the 2002 Stock Incentive Plan, of which options to purchase 2,116,266 ordinary shares were issued and exercised and options to purchase 3,875,655 ordinary shares were issued and outstanding. Of the
options to purchase 3,875,655 ordinary shares, options to purchase 3,502,714 ordinary shares have been exercised and options to purchase 21,668 ordinary shares remain outstanding as at March 31, 2015. Options granted under the 2002 Stock
Incentive Plan that are forfeited, lapsed or canceled, settled in cash, that expire or are repurchased by us at the original purchase price would have been available for grant under the 2002 Stock Incentive Plan and would be effectively rolled over
into our 2006 Incentive Award Plan which was amended and restated in 2009.
143
Third Amended and Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan
We adopted our 2006 Incentive Award Plan on June 1, 2006. The purpose of the 2006 Incentive Award Plan is to promote the success and enhance the value of
our company by linking the personal interests of the directors, employees and consultants of our company and our subsidiaries to those of our shareholders and by providing these individuals with an incentive for outstanding performance. The 2006
Incentive Award Plan is further intended to provide us with the ability to motivate, attract and retain the services of these individuals. On February 13, 2009, we adopted the Amended and Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan. The Amended and
Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan reflects, among other changes to our 2006 Incentive Award Plan, an increase in the number of ordinary shares and ADSs available for grant under the plan from 3.0 million to 4.0 million shares/ADSs,
subject to specified adjustments under the plan. On September 13, 2011, we adopted the Second Amended and Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan that reflects an increase in the number of ordinary shares and ADSs available for granted under the
plan to 6.2 million shares/ADSs, subject to specified adjustments under the plan. On September 25, 2013, we adopted the Third Amended and Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan that reflects an increase in the number of ordinary shares and
ADSs available for granted under the plan to 8.6 million shares/ADSs, subject to specified adjustments under the plan.
Shares Available for
Awards. Subject to certain adjustments set forth in the Third Amended and Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan, the maximum number of shares that may be issued or awarded under the Third Amended and Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan is equal to
the sum of (x) 8,600,000 shares, (y) any shares that remain available for issuance under the 2002 Stock Incentive Plan, and (z) any shares subject to awards under the 2002 Stock Incentive Plan which terminate, expire or lapse for any
reason or are settled in cash on or after the effective date of our 2006 Incentive Award Plan. The maximum number of shares which may be subject to awards granted to any one participant during any calendar year is 500,000 shares and the maximum
amount that may be paid to a participant in cash during any calendar year with respect to cash-based awards is $10,000,000. To the extent that an award terminates or is settled in cash, any shares subject to the award will again be available for the
grant. Any shares tendered or withheld to satisfy the grant or exercise price or tax withholding obligation with respect to any award will not be available for subsequent grant. Except as described below with respect to independent directors, no
determination has been made as to the types or amounts of awards that will be granted to specific individuals pursuant to the Third Amended and Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan.
Administration. The Third Amended and Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan is administered by our Board of Directors, which may delegate its authority to
a committee. We anticipate that our Compensation Committee will administer the Third Amended and Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan, except that our Board of Directors will administer the plan with respect to awards granted to our independent
directors. The plan administrator will determine eligibility, the types and sizes of awards, the price and timing of awards and the acceleration or waiver of any vesting restriction, provided that the plan administrator will not have the authority
to accelerate vesting or waive the forfeiture of any performance-based awards.
Eligibility. Our employees, consultants and directors and those of
our subsidiaries are eligible to be granted awards, except that only employees of our company and our qualifying corporate subsidiaries are eligible to be granted options that are intended to qualify as incentive share options under
Section 422 of the Code.
Awards
Options: The plan administrator may grant options on shares. The per share option exercise price of all options granted pursuant to the Third Amended
and Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan will not be less than 100% of the fair market value of a share on the date of grant. No incentive share option may be granted to a grantee who owns more than 10% of our outstanding shares unless the exercise
price is at least 110% of the fair market value of a share on the date of grant. To the extent that the aggregate fair market value of the shares subject to an incentive share option become exercisable for the first time by any option holder during
any calendar year exceeds $100,000, such excess will be treated as a non-qualified option. The plan administrator will determine the methods of payment of the exercise price of an option, which may include cash, shares or other property acceptable
to the plan administrator (and may involve a cashless exercise of the option). The plan administrator shall designate in the award agreement evidencing each share option grant whether such share option shall be exercisable for shares or ADSs. The
award agreement may, in the sole discretion of the plan administrator, permit the option holder to elect, at the time of exercise, whether to receive shares or ADSs in respect of the exercised share option or a portion thereof. The term of options
granted under the Third Amended and Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan may not exceed ten years from the date of grant. However, the term of an incentive share option granted to a person who owns more than 10% of our outstanding shares on the date
of grant may not exceed five years. Under the Third Amended and Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan, the number of awards to be granted to our independent directors will be determined by our Board of Directors or our Compensation Committee.
144
Restricted Shares. The plan administrator may grant shares subject to various restrictions, including
restrictions on transferability, limitations on the right to vote and/or limitations on the right to receive dividends.
Share Appreciation Rights.
The plan administrator may grant share appreciation rights representing the right to receive payment of an amount equal to the excess of the fair market value of a share on the date of exercise over the fair market value of a share on the date of
grant. The term of share appreciation rights granted may not exceed ten years from the date of grant. The plan administrator may elect to pay share appreciation rights in cash, in shares or in a combination of cash and shares.
Performance Shares and Performance Share Units. The plan administrator may grant awards of performance shares denominated in a number of shares and/or
awards of performance share units denominated in unit equivalents of shares and/or units of value, including dollar value of shares. These awards may be linked to performance criteria measured over performance periods as determined by the plan
administrator.
Share Payments. The plan administrator may grant share payments, including payments in the form of shares or options or other
rights to purchase shares. Share payments may be based upon specific performance criteria determined by the plan administrator on the date such share payments are made or on any date thereafter.
Deferred Shares. The plan administrator may grant awards of deferred shares linked to performance criteria determined by the plan administrator. Shares
underlying deferred share awards will not be issued until the deferred share awards have vested, pursuant to a vesting schedule or upon the satisfaction of any vesting conditions or performance criteria set by the plan administrator. Recipients of
deferred share awards generally will have no rights as shareholders with respect to such deferred shares until the shares underlying the deferred share awards have been issued.
Restricted Share Units. The plan administrator may grant RSUs, subject to various vesting conditions. On the maturity date, we will transfer to the
participant one unrestricted, fully transferable share for each vested RSU scheduled to be paid out on such date. The plan administrator will specify the purchase price, if any, to be paid by the participant for such shares. Generally, a participant
will have to be employed by us on the date of payment of vested RSUs to be eligible to receive the payment of shares issuable upon vesting of the RSUs.
Performance Bonus Awards. The plan administrator may grant a cash bonus payable upon the attainment of performance goals based on performance criteria
and measured over a performance period determined appropriate by the plan administrator. Any such cash bonus paid to a covered employee within the meaning of Section 162(m) of the Code may be a performance-based award as
described below.
Performance-Based Awards. The plan administrator may grant awards other than options and share appreciation rights to employees
who are or may be covered employees, as defined in Section 162(m) of the Code, that are intended to be performance-based awards within the meaning of Section 162(m) of the Code in order to preserve the deductibility
of these awards for federal income tax purposes. Participants are only entitled to receive payment for performance-based awards for any given performance period to the extent that pre-established performance goals set by the plan administrator for
the period are satisfied. The plan administrator will determine the type of performance-based awards to be granted, the performance period and the performance goals. Generally, a participant will have to be employed by us on the date the
performance-based award is paid to be eligible for a performance-based award for any period.
Adjustments. In the event of certain changes in our
capitalization, the plan administrator has broad discretion to adjust awards, including without limitation, (i) the aggregate number and type of shares that may be issued under the Third Amended and Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan,
(ii) the terms and conditions of any outstanding awards, and (iii) the grant or exercise price per share for any outstanding awards under such plan to account for such changes. The plan administrator also has the authority to cash out,
terminate or provide for the assumption or substitution of outstanding awards in the event of a corporate transaction.
Change in Control. In the
event of a change in control of our company in which outstanding awards are not assumed by the successor, such awards will generally become fully exercisable and all forfeiture restrictions on such awards will lapse. Upon, or in anticipation of, a
change in control, the plan administrator may cause any awards outstanding to terminate at a specific time in the future and give each participant the right to exercise such awards during such period of time as the plan administrator, in its sole
discretion, determines.
145
Vesting of Full Value Awards. Full value awards (generally, any award other than an option or share
appreciation right) will vest over a period of at least three years (or, in the case of vesting based upon attainment of certain performance goals, over a period of at least one year). However, full value awards that result in the issuance of an
aggregate of up to 5% to the total issuable shares under the Third Amended and Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan may be granted without any minimum vesting periods. In addition, full value awards may vest on an accelerated basis in the event of a
participants death, disability, or retirement, or in the event of our change in control or other special circumstances.
Non-transferability.
Awards granted under the Third Amended and Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan are generally not transferable.
Withholding. We have the right to
withhold, deduct or require a participant to remit to us an amount sufficient to satisfy federal, state, local or foreign taxes (including the participants employment tax obligations) required by law to be withheld with respect to any tax
concerning the participant as a result of the Third Amended and Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan.
Termination or Amendment. Unless terminated
earlier, the Third Amended and Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan will remain in effect for a period of ten years from the effective date of the 2006 Incentive Award Plan, after which no award may be granted under the Third Amended and Restated 2006
Incentive Award Plan. With the approval of our Board of Directors, the plan administrator may terminate or amend the Third Amended and Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan at any time. However, shareholder approval will be required for any amendment
(i) to the extent required by applicable law, regulation or stock exchange rule, (ii) to increase the number of shares available under the Third Amended and Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan, (iii) to permit the grant of options or
share appreciation rights with an exercise price below fair market value on the date of grant, (iv) to extend the exercise period for an option or share appreciation right beyond ten years from the date of grant, or (v) that results in a
material increase in benefits or a change in eligibility requirements. Any amendment or termination must not materially adversely affect any participant without such participants consent.
Outstanding Awards. As at March 31, 2015, options or RSUs to purchase an aggregate of 3,138,638 ordinary shares were outstanding, out of which
options or RSUs to purchase 990,392 ordinary shares were held by all our directors and executive officers as a group. The exercise prices of these options range from $15.32 to $35.30 and the expiration dates of these options range from July 24,
2016 to February 1, 2025. The weighted average grant date fair value of RSUs granted during fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013 were $19.19, $14.87 and $10.93 per ADS, respectively. There is no purchase price for the RSUs.
Other Employee Benefits
We also maintain other employee
benefit plans in the form of certain statutory and incentive plans covering substantially all of our employees. For fiscal 2015, the total amount accrued by us to provide for pension, retirement or similar benefits was $9.3 million.
Provident Fund
In accordance with Indian, Philippines
and Sri Lankan laws, all of our employees in these countries are entitled to receive benefits under the respective government provident fund, a defined contribution plan to which both we and the employee contribute monthly at a pre-determined rate
(for India and Sri Lanka, currently 12% of the employees base salary and for the Philippines, 100 Philippines pesos per month for every employee). These contributions are made to the respective government provident fund and we have no further
obligation under this fund apart from our monthly contributions. We contributed an aggregate of $5.8 million, $5.1 million and $5.1 million in each of fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively, to the government provident fund.
US Savings Plan
Eligible employees in the US participate
in a savings plan, or the US Savings Plan, pursuant to Section 401(k) of the United States Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, or the Code. The US Savings Plan allows our employees to defer a portion of their annual earnings on a
pre-tax basis through voluntary contributions there under. The US Savings Plan provides that we can make optional contributions up to the maximum allowable limit under the Code.
146
UK Pension Scheme
Eligible employees in the UK contribute to a defined contribution pension scheme operated in the UK. The assets of the scheme are held separately from ours in
an independently administered fund. The pension expense represents contributions payable to the fund by us.
Gratuity
In accordance with Indian, the Philippines and Sri Lankan laws, we provide for gratuity liability pursuant to a defined benefit retirement plan covering all
our employees in India, the Philippines and Sri Lanka. Our gratuity plan provides for a lump sum payment to eligible employees on retirement, death, incapacitation or on termination of employment (provided such employee has worked for at least five
years with our company) which is computed on the basis of employees salary and length of service with us (subject to a maximum of approximately $15,962 per employee in India). In India, we provide the gratuity benefit through determined
contributions pursuant to a non-participating annuity contract administered and managed by the Life Insurance Corporation of India, or LIC, and Aviva Life Insurance Company Private Limited. Under this plan, the obligation to pay gratuity remains
with us although LIC and Aviva Life Insurance Company Private Limited administer the plan. We contributed an aggregate of $0.9 million, $1.2 million and $0.8 million in fiscal 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively, to LIC and Aviva Life
Insurance Company Private Limited.
Compensated Absence
Our liability for compensated absences is determined on an accrual basis for the entire unused vacation balance standing to the credit of each employee as at
year-end and were charged to income in the year in which they accrue.
C. Board Practices
Composition of the Board of Directors
Our Memorandum and
Articles of Association provide that our Board of Directors consists of not less than three directors and such maximum number as our directors may determine from time to time. Our Board of Directors currently consists of nine directors. Each of
Messrs. Dillon, Aboody, Williams, Young, Freeland, Menezes, Mrs. Karnad and Sir Anthony satisfies the independence requirements of the NYSE rules.
All directors hold office until the expiry of their term of office, their resignation or removal from office for gross negligence or criminal conduct by a
resolution of our shareholders or until they cease to be directors by virtue of any provision of law or they are disqualified by law from being directors or they become bankrupt or make any arrangement or composition with their creditors generally
or they become of unsound mind. The term of office of the directors is divided into three classes:
|
|
|
Class I, whose term will expire at the annual general meeting to be held in fiscal 2017; |
|
|
|
Class II, whose term will expire at the annual general meeting to be held in fiscal 2018; and |
|
|
|
Class III, whose term will expire at the annual general meeting to be held in fiscal 2016. |
Our directors
for fiscal 2015 are classified as follows:
|
|
|
Class I: Sir Anthony A. Greener, Mr. Gareth Williams and Mr. Adrian T. Dillon; |
|
|
|
Class II: Mr. Keshav R. Murugesh, Mr. Albert Aboody and Mr. Michael Menezes; and |
|
|
|
Class III: Mr. Jeremy Young, Mr. John Freeland and Mrs. Renu S Karnad. |
The appointments
of Messrs. Young and Freeland and Mrs. Karnad will expire at the next annual general meeting, which we expect to hold in September 2015. Mr. Freeland and Mrs. Karnad have expressed their willingness to be
re-elected and, accordingly, we propose to seek shareholders approval for their re-election at the next annual general meeting. Mr. Jeremy Young has decided not to stand for re-election and hence his term of directorship will expire at
the next annual general meeting, we are currently in the process of identifying a new director candidate.
147
At each annual general meeting after the initial classification or special meeting in lieu thereof, the
successors to directors whose terms will then expire serve from the time of election until the third annual meeting following election or special meeting held in lieu thereof. Any additional directorships resulting from an increase in the number of
directors will be distributed among the three classes so that, as nearly as possible, each class will consist of one-third of the directors. This classification of the Board of Directors may have the effect of delaying or preventing changes in
control of management of our company.
There are no family relationships among any of our directors or executive officers. The employment agreement
governing the services of one of our directors provide for benefits upon termination of employment as described above.
Our Board of Directors held five
meetings in fiscal 2015.
Board Leadership Structure and Board Oversight of Risk
Different individuals currently serve in the roles of Chairman of the Board and Group Chief Executive Officer of our company. Our Board believes that splitting
the roles of Chairman of the Board and Group Chief Executive Officer is currently the most appropriate leadership structure for our company. This leadership structure will bring in greater efficiency as a result of vesting two important leadership
roles in separate individuals and increased independence for the Board of Directors.
Boards Role in Risk Oversight
Our Board of Directors is primarily responsible for overseeing our risk management processes. The Board of Directors receives and reviews periodic reports from
the Head of Risk Management and Audit as considered appropriate regarding our companys assessment of risks. The Board of Directors focuses on the most significant risks facing our company and our companys general risk management
strategy, and also ensures that risks undertaken by our company are consistent with the Boards appetite for risk. While the Board oversees our companys risk management, management is responsible for day-to-day risk management processes.
We believe this division of responsibilities is the most effective approach for addressing the risks facing our company and that our Board leadership structure supports this approach.
The Audit Committee has special responsibilities with respect to financial risks, and regularly reports to the full Board of Directors on these issues. Among
other responsibilities, the Audit Committee reviews our companys policies with respect to contingent liabilities and risks that may be material to our company, our companys policies and procedures designed to promote compliance with
laws, regulations, and internal policies and procedures, and major legislative and regulatory developments which could materially impact our company.
The
Compensation Committee also plays a role in risk oversight as it relates to our companys compensation policies and practices. Among other responsibilities, the Compensation Committee designs and evaluates our companys executive
compensation policies and practices so that our companys compensation programs promote accountability among employees and the interests of employees are properly aligned with the interests of our shareholders.
Committees of the Board
Our Board of Directors has three
standing committees: an Audit Committee, a Compensation Committee and a Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee.
148
Audit Committee
The Audit Committee comprises four directors: Messrs. Albert Aboody (Chairman), Michael Menezes, John Freeland and Jeremy Young. Each of
Messrs. Aboody, Menezes, Freeland and Young satisfies the independence requirements of Rule 10A-3 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 as amended, or the Exchange Act, and the NYSE listing standards. The principal duties and
responsibilities of our Audit Committee are as follows:
|
|
|
to serve as an independent and objective party to monitor our financial reporting process and internal control systems; |
|
|
|
to review and appraise the audit efforts of our independent accountants and exercise ultimate authority over the relationship between us and our independent accountants; and |
|
|
|
to provide an open avenue of communication among the independent accountants, financial and senior management and the Board of Directors. |
The Audit Committee has the power to investigate any matter brought to its attention within the scope of its duties. It also has the authority to retain
counsel and advisors to fulfill its responsibilities and duties. Messrs. Aboody and Menezes serve as our Audit Committee financial experts, within the requirements of the rules promulgated by the Commission relating to listed-company audit
committees.
We have posted our Audit Committee charter on our website at www.wns.com. Information contained in our website does
not constitute a part of this annual report.
The Audit Committee held four meetings in fiscal 2015.
Compensation Committee
The Compensation Committee
comprises four directors: Messrs. Gareth Williams (Chairman), Adrian T. Dillon, Mrs. Renu S. Karnad and Sir Anthony A. Greener. Each of Messrs. Williams and Dillon, Mrs. Karnad and Sir Anthony satisfies the
independence requirements of the NYSE listing standards. The scope of this committees duties includes determining the compensation of our executive officers and other key management personnel. The Compensation Committee also
administers the 2002 Stock Incentive Plan and the Third Amended and Restated 2006 Incentive Award Plan, reviews performance appraisal criteria and sets standards for and decides on all employee shares options allocations when delegated to do so by
our Board of Directors.
We have posted our Compensation Committee charter on our website at www.wns.com. Information contained in
our website does not constitute a part of this annual report.
The Compensation Committee held five meetings in fiscal 2015.
Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee
The
Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee comprises three directors: Sir Anthony A. Greener (Chairman), Mr. Adrian T. Dillon and Mrs. Renu S. Karnad. Each of Sir Anthony, Mr. Dillon, and Mrs. Karnad satisfies the
independence requirements of the NYSE listing standards. The principal duties and responsibilities of the nominating and governance committee are as follows:
|
|
|
to assist the Board of Directors by identifying individuals qualified to become board members and members of board committees, to recommend to the Board of Directors nominees for the next annual meeting of shareholders,
and to recommend to the Board of Directors nominees for each committee of the Board of Directors; |
|
|
|
to monitor our corporate governance structure; and |
|
|
|
to periodically review and recommend to the Board of Directors any proposed changes to the corporate governance guidelines applicable to us. |
149
We have posted our Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee charter on our website at
www.wns.com. Information contained in our website does not constitute a part of this annual report.
The Nominating and Corporate
Governance Committee uses its judgment to identify well qualified individuals who are willing and able to serve on our Board of Directors. Pursuant to its charter, the Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee may consider a variety of criteria
in recommending candidates for election to our board, including an individuals personal and professional integrity, ethics and values; experience in corporate management, such as serving as an officer or former officer of a publicly held
company, and a general understanding of marketing, finance and other elements relevant to the success of a publicly-traded company in todays business environment; experience in our companys industry and with relevant social policy
concerns; experience as a board member of another publicly held company; academic expertise in an area of our companys operations; and practical and mature business judgment, including ability to make independent analytical inquiries.
While the Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee does not have a formal policy with respect to the consideration of diversity in identifying director
nominees, it nevertheless considers director nominees with a diverse range of backgrounds, skills, national origins, values, experiences, and occupations.
The Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee held four meetings in fiscal 2015.
Executive Sessions
Our non-executive directors meet
regularly in executive session without executive directors or management present. The purpose of these executive sessions is to promote open and candid discussion among the non-executive directors. Our non-executive directors held four executive
sessions in fiscal 2015.
Shareholders and other interested parties may communicate directly with the presiding director or with our non-executive
directors as a group by writing to the following address: WNS (Holdings) Limited, Attention: Non-Executive Directors, Gate 4, Godrej & Boyce Complex, Pirojshanagar, Vikhroli (W), Mumbai 400 079, India.
D. Employees
For a description of our employees, see
Part I Item 4. Information on the Company Business Overview Human Capital.
150
E. Share Ownership
The following table sets forth information with respect to the beneficial ownership of our ordinary shares as at March 31, 2015 by each of our directors
and all our directors and executive officers as a group as at that date. As used in this table, beneficial ownership means the sole or shared power to vote or direct the voting or to dispose of or direct the sale of any security. A person is deemed
to be the beneficial owner of securities that can be acquired within 60 days upon the exercise of any option, warrant or right. Ordinary shares subject to options, warrants or rights that are currently exercisable or exercisable within
60 days are deemed outstanding for computing the ownership percentage of the person holding the options, warrants or rights, but are not deemed outstanding for computing the ownership percentage of any other person. The amounts and percentages
as at March 31, 2015 are based on an aggregate of 51,950,662 ordinary shares outstanding as at that date.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Number of Ordinary Shares Beneficially Owned |
|
Name |
|
Number |
|
|
Percent |
|
Directors |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Adrian T. Dillon(1) |
|
|
25,232 |
|
|
|
0.049 |
|
Albert Aboody |
|
|
20,682 |
|
|
|
0.040 |
|
Anthony A. Greener(2) |
|
|
48,625 |
|
|
|
0.094 |
|
Gareth Williams |
|
|
1,133 |
|
|
|
0.002 |
|
John Freeland(3) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Jeremy Young(4) |
|
|
41,370 |
|
|
|
0.080 |
|
Keshav R. Murugesh |
|
|
195,766 |
|
|
|
0.377 |
|
Michael Menezes |
|
|
1,133 |
|
|
|
0.002 |
|
Renu S. Karnad |
|
|
4,832 |
|
|
|
0.009 |
|
Executive Officers |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Sanjay Puria |
|
|
9,001 |
|
|
|
0.017 |
|
Ronald Gillette |
|
|
14,400 |
|
|
|
0.028 |
|
Swaminathan Rajamani |
|
|
8,104 |
|
|
|
0.016 |
|
All our directors and executive officers as a group (12 persons as of March 31, 2015) |
|
|
370,278 |
|
|
|
0.713 |
|
Notes:
(1) |
Of the 25,232 shares beneficially owned by Mr. Adrian T. Dillon, 16,765 shares are in the form of ADSs. |
(2) |
Of the 48,625 shares beneficially owned by Sir Anthony Greener, 32,625 shares are held in trust. |
(3) |
Mr. Freeland was appointed as a director of our company with effect from September 1, 2014. |
(4) |
Of the 41,370 shares beneficially owned by Mr. Jeremy Young, 37,350 shares are in the form of ADSs. |
151
The following table sets forth information concerning options and RSUs held by our directors and executive
officers as at March 31, 2015:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Options Summary |
|
|
RSU Summary |
|
Name |
|
Number of shares underlying unexercised but vested options |
|
|
Exercise price |
|
|
Number of shares underlying unexercised options that will vest in next 60 days from March
31, 2015 |
|
|
Number of shares underlying options that have not vested |
|
|
Exercise price |
|
|
Number of shares underlying RSUs held that have vested but unexercised |
|
|
Number of shares underlying RSUs that will vest in next 60 days from March 31, 2015 |
|
|
Vesting Dates |
|
|
Number of shares underlying RSUs held that have not vested |
|
Directors |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Adrian T. Dillon |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
25,860 |
|
Albert Aboody |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
11,059 |
|
Anthony A. Greener |
|
|
14,000 |
(1) |
|
$ |
28.48 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
9,638 |
|
|
|
|
2,000 |
(2) |
|
$ |
22.98 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Gareth Williams |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
7,608 |
|
Jeremy Young |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,648 |
|
|
|
10-May-15 |
|
|
|
12,567 |
|
Keshav R. Murugesh |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
103,482 |
|
|
|
49,953 |
|
|
|
16-Apr-15 |
|
|
|
584,609 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
42,331 |
|
|
|
29-Apr-15 |
|
|
|
|
|
Michael Menezes |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
7,608 |
|
Renu S. Karnad |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
12,138 |
|
John Freeland |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
6,235 |
|
Executive Officers |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Sanjay Puria |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,001 |
|
|
|
3,000 |
|
|
|
16-Apr-15 |
|
|
|
62,583 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5,000 |
|
|
|
29-Apr-15 |
|
|
|
|
|
Ronald Gillette |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
10,000 |
|
|
|
4,400 |
|
|
|
29-Apr-15 |
|
|
|
76,400 |
|
Swaminathan Rajamani |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
504 |
|
|
|
4,000 |
|
|
|
16-Apr-15 |
|
|
|
43,100 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3,600 |
|
|
|
29-Apr-15 |
|
|
|
|
|
Notes:
(1) |
The expiration date of these options is June 14, 2017. |
(2) |
The expiration date of these options is August 7, 2017. |
Share Ownership Guidelines
In July 2014, our Board of Directors adopted a share ownership policy, which was most recently amended in January, 2015 and effective from April 1, 2015,
outlining the share ownership guidelines for, among other employees, our directors and executive officers. We believe that this policy further aligns the interests of our directors and executive officers with the long-term interests of our
shareholders and promotes our commitment to sound corporate governance practices.
152
Under our amended policy, each of our non-executive directors must hold at least the amount of vested shares of
our company by the fifth anniversary of such directors initial election to the Board as shown in the table below:
|
|
|
Position |
|
Share Ownership Guidelines |
For Non-Executive Directors (except Board Chairman) |
|
3.0 x value of annual share grant in $ |
For the Board Chairman |
|
4.0 x value of annual share grant in $ |
In the event a non-executive director holds at least the required valued of our ordinary shares during the required time
period, but the value of the directors shares decreases below the shareholding requirement due to a decline in the price of our ADSs, the director shall be deemed to have complied with this policy so long as the director does not sell any
shares.
Our amended policy provides that our executive officers are required to hold a multiple of their annual base salary in shares of our company as
shown in the table below.
|
|
|
Position |
|
Share Ownership Guidelines |
Group Chief Executive Officer |
|
4.0 x annual base salary |
Chief Operating Officer |
|
2.0 x annual base salary |
Chief Financial Officer |
|
1.5 x annual base salary |
Chief People Officer |
|
1.0 x annual base salary |
Executive officers have five years to achieve the specified ownership level according to the following build-up schedule:
achieving a share ownership level equivalent to 5%, 15%, 30%, 60% and 100% of their specified ownership level in the first, second, third, fourth and fifth year, respectively.
Shares owned by immediate family members and any trust for the benefit only of the executive officer/director or his or her family members are included in the
determination of such executive officer/directors share ownership level.
153
ITEM 7. |
MAJOR SHAREHOLDERS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS |
A. Major Shareholders
The following table sets forth information regarding beneficial ownership of our ordinary shares as at March 31, 2015 held by each person who is known to
us to have a 5.0% or more beneficial share ownership based on an aggregate of 51,950,662 ordinary shares outstanding as of that date. Beneficial ownership is determined in accordance with the rules of the Commission and includes shares over
which the indicated beneficial owner exercises voting and/or investment power or receives the economic benefit of ownership of such securities. Ordinary shares subject to options currently exercisable or exercisable within 60 days are deemed
outstanding for the purposes of computing the percentage ownership of the person holding the options but are not deemed outstanding for the purposes of computing the percentage ownership of any other person.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Name of Beneficial Owner |
|
Number of Shares Beneficially Owned |
|
|
Percentage Beneficially Owned (1) |
|
Waddell & Reed Financial Inc. (2) |
|
|
10,600,811 |
|
|
|
20.41 |
% |
FMR LLC(3) |
|
|
7,249,179 |
|
|
|
13.95 |
% |
Nalanda India Fund Limited(4) |
|
|
5,211,410 |
|
|
|
10.03 |
% |
Columbia Wanger Asset Management, LLC (5) |
|
|
4,471,044 |
|
|
|
8.61 |
% |
TimesSquare Capital Management, LLC(6) |
|
|
3,395,090 |
|
|
|
6.54 |
% |
William Blair & Company, LLC(7) |
|
|
3,191,961 |
|
|
|
6.14 |
% |
Wellington Management Group LLP(8) |
|
|
2,753,010 |
|
|
|
5.30 |
% |
Notes:
(1) |
Based on an aggregate of 51,950,662 ordinary shares outstanding as at March 31, 2015. |
(2) |
Information is based on Amendment No. 4 to a report on Schedule 13G jointly filed with the Commission on February 13, 2015 by (i) Waddell & Reed Financial, Inc., or WRF, a publicly traded
company; (ii) Waddell & Reed Financial Services, Inc., or WRFSI, a subsidiary of WRF; (iii) Waddell & Reed Inc., or WRI, a broker-dealer and underwriting subsidiary of WRFSI; (iv) Waddell & Reed
Investment Management Company, or WRIMCO, an investment advisory subsidiary of WRI; and (v) Ivy Investment Management Company, or IICO, an investment advisory subsidiary of WRF. IICO and WRIMCO are investment advisors or sub-advisors to one or
more open-end investment companies or other managed accounts which are beneficial owners of our ordinary shares. According to this Amendment No. 4, the investment advisory contracts grant IICO and WRIMCO all investment and/or voting power over
securities owned by their advisory clients and the investment sub-advisory contracts grant IICO and WRIMCO investment power over securities owned by their sub-advisory clients and, in most cases, voting power. Any investment restriction of a
sub-advisory contract does not restrict investment discretion or power in a material manner. |
(3) |
Information is based on Amendment No. 10 to a report on Schedule 13G jointly filed with the Commission on February 13, 2015 by FMR LLC, Edward C. Johnson 3d, Abigail P. Johnson, Select Software and Computer
Services Portfolio. Edward C. Johnson 3d is a Director and the Chairman of FMR LLC and Abigail P. Johnson is a Director, the Vice Chairman, the Chief Executive Officer and the President of FMR LLC. According to this Amendment No. 10, members of
the family of Edward C. Johnson 3d, including Abigail P. Johnson, are the predominant owners, directly or through trusts, of Series B voting common shares of FMR LLC, representing 49% of the voting power of FMR LLC. The Johnson family group and all
other Series B shareholders have entered into a shareholders voting agreement under which all Series B voting common shares will be voted in accordance with the majority vote of Series B voting common shares. Accordingly, through their
ownership of voting common shares and the execution of the shareholders voting agreement, members of the Johnson family may be deemed, under the US Investment Company Act of 1940, to form a controlling group with respect to FMR LLC. Neither
FMR LLC nor Edward C. Johnson 3d nor Abigail P. Johnson has the sole power to vote or direct the voting of the shares owned directly by the various investment companies registered under the Investment Company Act, or Fidelity Funds, advised by
Fidelity Management & Research Company, or FMR Co, a wholly owned subsidiary of FMR LLC. Such power resides with the Fidelity Funds Boards of Trustees. Fidelity Management & Research Company carries out the voting of the
shares under written guidelines established by the Fidelity Funds Boards of Trustees. |
(4) |
Information is based on a report on Schedule 13G filed with the Commission on February 2, 2011 Nalanda India Fund Limited. |
154
(5) |
Information is based on Amendment No. 7 to a report on Schedule 13G filed with the Commission on February 11, 2015 by Columbia Wanger Asset Management LLC. |
(6) |
Information is based on Amendment No. 2 to a report on Schedule 13G filed with the Commission on February 11, 2015 by TimesSquare Capital Management, LLC. |
(7) |
Information is based on Amendment No. 1 to a report on Schedule 13G filed with the Commission on February 4, 2015 by William Blair & Company, LLC. |
(8) |
Information is based on a report on Schedule 13G filed with the Commission on February 12, 2015 by Wellington Management Group LLP |
The following summarizes the significant changes in the percentage ownership held by our major shareholders during the past three years:
|
|
|
In February 2013, Warburg Pincus sold its 14,519,144 ADSs (representing 14,519,144 ordinary shares) in our company, after which it ceased to be a shareholder of our company, as described in Amendment No. 2 to
a report on Schedule 13G jointly filed with the Commission on March 1, 2013. |
|
|
|
WRF, WRFSI, WRI, WRIMCO and IICO jointly reported their percentage ownership of our ordinary shares to be 8.1% (based on the then number of our ordinary shares reported as outstanding at that time) in a report on
Schedule 13G filed with the Commission on February 7, 2013, 11.2% (based on the then number of our ordinary shares reported as outstanding at that time) in Amendment No. 1 to a report on Schedule 13G filed with the Commission on
March 8, 2013,15.5% (based on the then number of our ordinary shares reported as outstanding at that time) in Amendment No. 2 to a report on Schedule 13G filed with the Commission on February 7, 2014 and 20.6% (based on the then
number of our ordinary shares reported as outstanding at that time) in Amendment No. 3 and 4 to a report on Schedule 13G filed with the Commission on December 10, 2014 and February 13, 2015, respectively. |
|
|
|
FMR LLC reported its percentage ownership of our ordinary shares to be 6.5% (based on the then number of our ordinary shares reported as outstanding at that time) in Amendment No. 6 to a report on Schedule 13G
jointly filed with the Commission on October 10, 2012, 7.5% (based on the then number of our ordinary shares reported as outstanding at that time) in Amendment No. 7 to a report on Schedule 13G jointly filed with the Commission on
February 14, 2013, 13.6% (based on the then number of our ordinary shares reported as outstanding at that time) in Amendment No. 8 to a report on Schedule 13G jointly filed with the Commission on March 11, 2013, 14.8% (based on the
then number of our ordinary shares reported as outstanding at that time) in Amendment No. 9 to a report on Schedule 13G jointly filed with the Commission on February 14, 2014 and 14.081% (based on the then number of our ordinary shares
reported as outstanding at that time) in Amendment No. 10 to a report on Schedule 13G jointly filed with the Commission on February 13, 2015. |
|
|
|
Columbia Wanger Asset Management, LLC and Columbia Acorn Select jointly reported their percentage ownership of our ordinary shares to be 12.5% (based on the then number of our ordinary shares reported as outstanding at
that time) in Amendment No. 5 to a report on Schedule 13G filed with the Commission on February 14, 2013. Columbia Wanger Asset Management, LLC reported its percentage ownership of our ordinary shares to be 9.5% (based on the then number
of our ordinary shares reported as outstanding at that time) in Amendment No. 6 to a report on Schedule 13G filed with the Commission on February 6, 2014 and 8.6% (based on the then number of our ordinary shares reported as outstanding at
that time) in Amendment No. 7 to a report on Schedule 13G filed with the Commission on February 11, 2015. |
|
|
|
TimesSquare Capital Management, LLC reported its percentage ownership of our ordinary shares to be 6.2% (based on the then number of our ordinary shares reported as outstanding at that time) in a report on Schedule 13G
filed with the Commission on February 11, 2013, 8.1% (based on the then number of our ordinary shares reported as outstanding at that time) in Amendment No. 1 to a report on Schedule 13G filed with the Commission on February 10, 2014
and 6.6% (based on the then number of our ordinary shares reported as outstanding at that time) in Amendment No. 2 to a report on Schedule 13G filed with the Commission on February 11, 2015. |
155
|
|
|
William Blair & Company, LLC reported its percentage ownership of our ordinary shares to be 8.2% (based on the then number of our ordinary shares reported as outstanding at that time) in a report on Schedule
13G filed with the Commission on February 6, 2014 and 6.20% (based on the then number of our ordinary shares reported as outstanding at that time) in Amendment No. 1 to a report on Schedule 13G filed with the Commission on February 4,
2015. |
|
|
|
Wellington Management Group LLP reported its percentage ownership of our ordinary shares to be 5.30% (based on the then number of our ordinary shares reported as outstanding at that time) in a report on Schedule 13G
filed with the Commission on February 11, 2015. |
None of our major shareholders have different voting rights from our other
shareholders.
As at March 31, 2015, 31,707,282 of our ordinary shares, representing 61.03% of our outstanding ordinary shares, were held by a total
of 19 holders of record with addresses in the US. As at the same date, 51,770,634 of our ADSs (representing 51,770,634 ordinary shares), representing 99.65% of our outstanding ordinary shares, were held by one registered holder of record with
addresses in and outside of the US. Since certain of these ordinary shares and ADSs were held by brokers or other nominees, the number of record holders in the US may not be representative of the number of beneficial holders or where the beneficial
holders are resident. All holders of our ordinary shares are entitled to the same voting rights.
B. Related Party Transactions
(Amounts in thousands)
The following is a description of our
related party transactions, determined in accordance with the rules and regulations promulgated under the Exchange Act, that were either material to us or the related party, or otherwise unusual or outside the ordinary course of business.
Mrs. Renu S Karnad was appointed as a director of our company on September 21, 2012. During fiscal 2015, we entered into the following transactions
with companies, in which Mrs. Karnad was a director during those periods:
|
|
|
In fiscal 2015, we sold debt FMP investments amounting to $4,557 issued by HDFC Asset Management Company Limited and realized a total gain of $414. |
|
|
|
We paid $7 in fiscal 2015 to HDFC Ergo General Insurance Company Limited for travel insurance premiums for employees of our company. We have also taken an Errors and Omissions (E&O) policy from HDFC Ergo General
Insurance Company and the premium paid towards this policy was $13 for fiscal 2015. The payment made in fiscal 2015 was an advance payment, which relates to fiscal 2016. |
Mr. Eric Herr retired as a director of our company with effect from April 30, 2014. Mr. Eric B. Herr was a director in Regulatory Data
Corporation during this period, who is our client. In fiscal 2015, we earned revenue of $150 (till April 30, 2014).
Mr. Gareth Williams was
appointed as a director of our company on January 1, 2014. We paid $21 in fiscal 2015 towards training costs of our employees to YSC India Business Psychologists Private Limited. Mr. Gareth Williams was a director in the parent company of
YSC India Business Psychologists Private Limited during this period. During fiscal 2015, Mr. Gareth Williams was appointed as a director of SAGA Plc. which is our client. During fiscal 2015, we earned net revenue of $8,718 from this client.
C. Interests of Experts and Counsel
Not applicable.
156
ITEM 8. |
FINANCIAL INFORMATION |
A. Consolidated Statements and Other Financial Information
Please see Part III Item 18. Financial Statements for a list of the financial statements filed as part of this annual report.
Tax Assessment Orders
Transfer pricing
regulations to which we are subject require that any international transaction among the WNS group enterprises be on arms-length terms. Transfer pricing regulations in India have been extended to cover specified Indian domestic transactions as
well. We believe that the international and India domestic transactions among the WNS group enterprises are on arms-length terms. If, however, the applicable tax authorities determine that the transactions among the WNS group enterprises do
not meet arms length criteria, we may incur increased tax liability, including accrued interest and penalties. This would cause our tax expense to increase, possibly materially, thereby reducing our profitability and cash flows. The applicable
tax authorities may also disallow deductions or tax holiday benefits claimed by us and assess additional taxable income on us in connection with their review of our tax returns.
From time to time, we receive orders of assessment from the Indian tax authorities assessing additional taxable income on us and/or our subsidiaries in
connection with their review of our tax returns. We currently have orders of assessment for fiscal 2003 through fiscal 2012 pending before various appellate authorities. These orders assess additional taxable income that could in the aggregate give
rise to an estimated
3,046.6 million ($48.6 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) in additional taxes, including interest of
1,078.9 million ($17.2 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015).
157
The following sets forth the details of these orders of assessment:
Note:
(1) |
Based on the exchange rate as at March 31, 2015. |
158
The aforementioned orders of assessment allege that the transfer prices we applied to certain of the
international transactions between WNS Global Services Private Limited or WNS Business Consulting Services Private Limited or WNS BCS, each of which is, our Indian subsidiary, as the case may be, and our other wholly-owned subsidiaries named above
were not on arms length terms, disallow a tax holiday benefit claimed by us, deny the set off of brought forward business losses and unabsorbed depreciation and disallow certain expenses claimed as tax deductible by WNS Global or WNS BCS, as
the case may be. As at March 31, 2015, we have provided a tax reserve of
906.8 million ($14.5 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) primarily on account of the Indian tax authorities denying the set off of brought forward business losses and unabsorbed
depreciation. We have appealed against these orders of assessment before higher appellate authorities.
In addition, we currently have orders of
assessment pertaining to similar issues that have been decided in our favor by first level appellate authorities, vacating tax demands of
2,482.2 million ($39.6 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) in additional taxes, including interest of
770.5 million ($12.3 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015). The income tax authorities have filed appeals against these orders at higher appellate authorities.
In case of disputes, the Indian tax authorities may require us to deposit with them all or a portion of the disputed amounts pending resolution of the matters
on appeal. Any amount paid by us as deposits will be refunded to us with interest if we succeed in our appeals. We have deposited some portion of the disputed amount with the tax authorities and may be required to deposit the remaining portion of
the disputed amount with the tax authorities pending final resolution of the respective matters.
As at March 31, 2015, corporate tax returns for
fiscal years 2012 (for certain legal entities) and thereafter remain subject to examination by tax authorities in India.
After consultation with our
Indian tax advisors and based on the facts of these cases, certain legal opinions from counsel, the nature of the tax authorities disallowances and the orders from first level appellate authorities deciding similar issues in our favor in
respect of assessment orders for earlier fiscal years, we believe these orders are unlikely to be sustained at the higher appellate authorities and we intend to vigorously dispute the orders of assessment.
In March 2009, we also received an assessment order from the Indian Service Tax Authority demanding payment of
348.1 million ($5.6 million based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015) of service tax and related penalty for the period from March 1, 2003 to January 31, 2005. The assessment order alleges that
service tax is payable in India on BPM services provided by WNS Global to clients based abroad as the export proceeds are repatriated outside India by WNS Global. In response to an appeal filed by us with the appellate tribunal against the
assessment order in April 2009, the appellate tribunal has remanded the matter back to the lower tax authorities to be adjudicated afresh. Based on consultations with our Indian tax advisors, we believe this order of assessment is more likely
than not to be upheld in our favor. We intend to continue to vigorously dispute the assessment.
No assurance can be given, however, that we will prevail
in our tax disputes. If we do not prevail, payment of additional taxes, interest and penalties may adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition and cash flows. There can also be no assurance that we will not receive similar or
additional orders of assessment in the future.
159
Dividend Policy
Subject to the provisions of the 1991 Law and our Articles of Association, we may by ordinary resolution declare dividends to be paid to our shareholders
according to their respective rights. Any dividends we may declare must not exceed the amount recommended by our Board of Directors. Our board may declare and pay an interim dividend or dividends, including a dividend payable at a fixed rate, if
paying an interim dividend or dividends appears to the Board to be justified. See Part I Item 10. Additional Information B. Memorandum and Articles of Association. We can only declare dividends if our directors
who are to authorize the distribution make a prior statement that, having made full enquiry into our affairs and prospects, they have formed the opinion that:
|
|
|
immediately following the date on which the distribution is proposed to be made, we will be able to discharge our liabilities as they fall due; and |
|
|
|
having regard to our prospects and to the intentions of our directors with respect to the management of our business and to the amount and character of the financial resources that will in their view be available to us,
we will be able to continue to carry on business and we will be able to discharge our liabilities as they fall due until the expiry of the period of 12 months immediately following the date on which the distribution is proposed to be made or until
we are dissolved under Article 150 of the 1991 Law, whichever first occurs. |
We have never declared or paid any dividends on our
ordinary shares. Any future determination to pay cash dividends will be at the discretion of our Board of Directors and will be dependent upon our results of operations and cash flows, our financial position and capital requirements, general
business conditions, legal, tax, regulatory and any contractual restrictions on the payment of dividends and any other factors our Board of Directors deems relevant at the time.
Subject to the deposit agreement governing the issuance of our ADSs, holders of ADSs will be entitled to receive dividends paid on the ordinary shares
represented by such ADSs.
B. Significant Changes
There have been no significant subsequent events following the close of the last fiscal year up to the date of this annual report that are known to us and
require disclosure in this document for which disclosure was not made in this annual report.
160
ITEM 9. |
THE OFFER AND LISTING |
A. Offer and Listing Details
Our ADSs, commenced trading on the NYSE on July 26, 2006. The ADSs were issued by our depositary, Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas, pursuant to a
deposit agreement. The number of our outstanding ordinary shares (including the ordinary shares underlying ADSs) as at March 31, 2015 was 51,950,662. As at March 31, 2015, there were 51,770,634 ADSs outstanding (representing 51,770,634
ordinary shares).
The high and low last reported sale prices per ADS for the periods indicated are as shown below:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Price per ADS on NYSE |
|
|
|
High |
|
|
Low |
|
Fiscal year: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2011 |
|
$ |
13.38 |
|
|
$ |
8.46 |
|
2012 |
|
$ |
13.05 |
|
|
$ |
7.82 |
|
2013 |
|
$ |
15.01 |
|
|
$ |
9.07 |
|
2014 |
|
$ |
22.61 |
|
|
$ |
13.37 |
|
2015 |
|
$ |
25.97 |
|
|
$ |
17.11 |
|
Fiscal Quarter: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2014 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
First quarter |
|
$ |
17.13 |
|
|
$ |
13.37 |
|
Second quarter |
|
$ |
21.47 |
|
|
$ |
16.55 |
|
Third quarter |
|
$ |
22.61 |
|
|
$ |
18.64 |
|
Fourth quarter |
|
$ |
22.59 |
|
|
$ |
17.89 |
|
2015 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
First quarter |
|
$ |
19.72 |
|
|
$ |
17.11 |
|
Second quarter |
|
$ |
23.01 |
|
|
$ |
17.82 |
|
Third quarter |
|
$ |
22.92 |
|
|
$ |
19.33 |
|
Fourth quarter |
|
$ |
25.97 |
|
|
$ |
19.36 |
|
Month: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
November 2014 |
|
$ |
21.49 |
|
|
$ |
19.33 |
|
December 2014 |
|
$ |
21.91 |
|
|
$ |
20.05 |
|
January 2015 |
|
$ |
24.43 |
|
|
$ |
19.36 |
|
February 2015 |
|
$ |
24.91 |
|
|
$ |
22.04 |
|
March 2015 |
|
$ |
25.97 |
|
|
$ |
23.75 |
|
April 2015 |
|
$ |
25.39 |
|
|
$ |
23.28 |
|
B. Plan of Distribution
Not applicable.
C. Markets
Our ADSs are listed on the NYSE under the symbol WNS.
D. Selling Shareholders
Not applicable.
161
E. Dilution
Not applicable.
F. Expenses of the Issue
Not applicable.
ITEM 10. |
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION |
A. Share Capital
Not applicable.
B. Memorandum and Articles of Association
General
We were incorporated in Jersey,
Channel Islands, as a private limited company (with registered number 82262) on February 18, 2002 pursuant to the 1991 Law. We converted from a private limited company to a public limited company on January 4, 2006 when we acquired more
than 30 shareholders as calculated in accordance with Article 17A of the 1991 Law. We gave notice of this to the JFSC in accordance with Article 17(3) of the 1991 Law on January 12, 2006.
The address of our secretary and share registrar is Computershare Investor Services (Jersey) Limited, or Computershare, at Queensway House, Hilgrove Street,
St Helier, Jersey JE1 1ES. Our share register is maintained at the premises of Computershare.
Our activities are regulated by our Memorandum and Articles
of Association. We adopted an amended and restated Memorandum and Articles of Association by special resolution of our shareholders passed on May 22, 2006. This amended and restated Memorandum and Articles of Association came into effect
immediately prior to the completion of our initial public offering in July 2006. The material provisions of our amended and restated Memorandum and Articles of Association are described below. In addition to our Memorandum and Articles of
Association, our activities are regulated by (among other relevant legislation) the 1991 Law. Our Memorandum of Association states our company name, that we are a public company, that we are a par value company, our authorized share capital and that
the liability of our shareholders is limited to the amount (if any) unpaid on their shares. Below is a summary of some of the provisions of our Articles of Association. It is not, nor does it purport to be, complete or to identify all of the rights
and obligations of our shareholders. The summary is qualified in its entirety by reference to our Memorandum and Articles of Association. See Part III Item 19. Exhibits Exhibit 1.1 and Part III
Item 19. Exhibits Exhibit 1.2.
The rights of shareholders described in this section are available only to persons who hold
our certificated shares. ADS holders do not hold our certificated shares and therefore are not directly entitled to the rights conferred on our shareholders by our Articles of Association or the rights conferred on shareholders of a Jersey company
by the 1991 Law, including, without limitation: the right to receive dividends and the right to attend and vote at shareholders meetings; the rights described in Other Jersey Law Considerations Mandatory Purchases and
Acquisitions and Other Jersey Law Considerations Compromises and Arrangements, the right to apply to a Jersey court for an order on the grounds that the affairs of a company are being conducted in a manner which is
unfairly prejudicial to the interests of its shareholders; and the right to apply to the JFSC to have an inspector appointed to investigate the affairs of a company. ADS holders are entitled to receive dividends and to exercise the right to vote
only in accordance with the deposit agreement.
162
Share Capital
As at March 31, 2015, the authorized share capital is £6,100,000, divided into 60,000,000 ordinary shares of 10 pence each and 1,000,000 preferred
shares of 10 pence each. As at March 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, we had 51,950,662, 51,347,538 and 50,588,044 ordinary shares outstanding, respectively. The increase in the number of ordinary shares outstanding during the last three fiscal years
resulted from (i) our follow-on offering in February 2012 and (ii) the issuance of ordinary shares pursuant to our two share-based incentive plans, our 2002 Stock Incentive Plan and our 2006 Incentive Award Plan (as amended and
restated). On September 13, 2011, we adopted the second amendment and restatement of our 2006 Incentive Award Plan to increase the number of ordinary shares and ADSs available for grant thereunder by 2,200,000 ordinary shares/ADSs to a total of
6,200,000 ordinary shares/ADSs. On September 25, 2013, we adopted the third amendment and restatement of our 2006 Incentive Award Plan to increase the number of ordinary shares and ADSs available for grant thereunder by 2,400,000 ordinary
shares/ADSs to a total of 8,600,000 ordinary shares/ADSs. We have not issued any shares for consideration other than cash. There are no preferred shares outstanding.
Pursuant to Jersey law and our Memorandum and Articles of Association, our Board of Directors by resolution may establish one or more classes of preferred
shares having such number of shares, designations, dividend rates, relative voting rights, liquidation rights and other relative participation, optional or other special rights, qualifications, limitations or restrictions as may be fixed by the
board without any further shareholder approval. Such rights, preferences, powers and limitations as may be established could also have the effect of discouraging an attempt to obtain control of us. None of our shares have any redemption rights.
Capacity
Under the 1991 Law, the doctrine of
ultra vires in its application to companies is abolished and accordingly the capacity of a Jersey company is not limited by anything in its memorandum or articles or by any act of its members.
Changes in Capital or our Memorandum and Articles of Association
Subject to the 1991 Law and our Articles of Association, we may by special resolution at a general meeting:
|
|
|
increase our authorized or paid-up share capital; |
|
|
|
consolidate and divide all or any part of our shares into shares of a larger amount than is fixed by our Memorandum of Association; |
|
|
|
sub-divide all or any part of our shares into shares of smaller amount than is fixed by our Memorandum of Association; |
|
|
|
convert any of our issued or unissued shares into shares of another class; |
|
|
|
convert all our issued par value shares into no par value shares and vice versa; |
|
|
|
convert any of our paid-up shares into stock, and reconvert any stock into any number of paid-up shares of any denomination; |
|
|
|
convert any of our issued limited shares into redeemable shares which can be redeemed; |
|
|
|
cancel shares which, at the date of passing of the resolution, have not been taken or agreed to be taken by any person, and diminish the amount of the authorized share capital by the amount of the shares so cancelled;
|
|
|
|
reduce our issued share capital; or |
|
|
|
alter our Memorandum or Articles of Association. |
General Meetings of Shareholders
We may at any time convene general meetings of shareholders. We hold an annual general meeting for each fiscal year. Under the 1991 Law, no more than 18 months
may elapse between the date of one annual general meeting and the next.
163
Our Articles of Association provide that annual general meetings and meetings calling for the passing of a
special resolution require 21 days notice of the place, day and time of the meeting in writing to our shareholders. Any other general meeting requires no less than 14 days notice in writing. Our directors may, at their
discretion, and upon a request made in accordance with the 1991 Law by shareholders holding not less than one tenth of our total voting rights our directors shall, convene a general meeting. Our business may be transacted at a general meeting only
when a quorum of shareholders is present. Two shareholders entitled to attend and to vote on the business to be transacted (or a proxy for a shareholder or a duly authorized representative of a corporation which is a shareholder) and holding shares
conferring not less than one-third of the total voting rights, constitute a quorum provided that if at any time all of our issued shares are held by one shareholder, such quorum shall consist of the shareholder present in person or by proxy.
The annual general meetings deal with and dispose of all matters prescribed by our Articles of Association and by the 1991 Law including:
|
|
|
the consideration of our annual financial statements and report of our directors and auditors; |
|
|
|
the election of directors (if necessary); |
|
|
|
the appointment of auditors and the fixing of their remuneration; |
|
|
|
the sanction of dividends; and |
|
|
|
the transaction of any other business of which notice has been given. |
Failure to hold an annual general
meeting is an offence by our company and our directors under the 1991 Law and carries a potential fine of up to £5,000 for our company and each director.
Voting Rights
Subject to any special terms as to
voting on which any shares may have been issued or may from time to time be held, at a general meeting, every shareholder who is present in person (including any corporation present by its duly authorized representative) shall on a show of hands
have one vote and every shareholder present in person or by proxy shall on a poll have one vote for each share of which he is a holder. In the case of joint holders only one of them may vote and in the absence of election as to who is to vote, the
vote of the senior who tenders a vote, whether in person or by proxy, shall be accepted to the exclusion of the votes of the other joint holders.
A
shareholder may appoint any person (whether or not a shareholder) to act as his proxy at any meeting of shareholders (or of any class of shareholders) in respect of all or a particular number of the shares held by him. A shareholder may appoint more
than one person to act as his proxy and each such person shall act as proxy for the shareholder for the number of shares specified in the instrument appointing the person a proxy. If a shareholder appoints more than one person to act as his proxy,
each instrument appointing a proxy shall specify the number of shares held by the shareholder for which the relevant person is appointed his proxy. Each duly appointed proxy has the same rights as the shareholder by whom he was appointed to speak at
a meeting and vote at a meeting in respect of the number of shares held by the shareholder for which the relevant proxy is appointed his proxy.
For the
purpose of determining shareholders entitled to notice of or to vote at any meeting of shareholders or any adjournment thereof or in order to make a determination of shareholders for any other proper purpose, our directors may fix in advance a date
as the record date for any such determination of shareholders.
Shareholder Resolutions
An ordinary resolution requires the affirmative vote of a simple majority (i.e., more than 50%) of our shareholders entitled to vote in person (or by corporate
representative in case of a corporate entity) or by proxy at a general meeting.
A special resolution requires the affirmative vote of a majority of not
less than two-thirds of our shareholders entitled to vote in person (or by corporate representative in the case of a corporate entity) or by proxy at a general meeting.
Our Articles of Association prohibit the passing of shareholder resolutions by written consent to remove an auditor or to remove a director before the expiry
of his term of office.
164
Dividends
Subject to the provisions of the 1991 Law and of the Articles of Association, we may, by ordinary resolution, declare dividends to be paid to shareholders
according to their respective rights and interests in our distributable reserves. However, no dividend shall exceed the amount recommended by our directors.
Subject to the provisions of the 1991 Law, we may declare and pay an interim dividend or dividends, including a dividend payable at a fixed rate, if an
interim dividend or dividends appears to us to be justified by our distributable reserves.
Except as otherwise provided by the rights attached to any
shares, all dividends shall be declared and paid according to the amounts paid up (as to both par and any premium) otherwise than in advance of calls, on the shares on which the dividend is paid. All dividends unclaimed for a period of ten years
after having been declared or become due for payment shall, if the directors so resolve, be forfeited and shall cease to remain owing by us and shall henceforth belong to us absolutely.
We may, with the authority of an ordinary resolution, direct that payment of any dividend declared may be satisfied wholly or partly by the distribution of
assets, and in particular of paid-up shares or debentures of any other company, or in any one or more of those ways.
We may also with the prior authority
of an ordinary resolution, and subject to such conditions as we may determine, offer to holders of shares the right to elect to receive shares, credited as fully paid, instead of the whole, or some part, to be determined by us, of any dividend
specified by the ordinary resolution.
For the purposes of determining shareholders entitled to receive a dividend or distribution, our directors may fix
a record date for any such determination of shareholders. A record date for any dividend or distribution may be on or at any time before any date on which such dividend or distribution is paid or made and on or at any time before or after any date
on which such dividend or distribution is declared.
Ownership Limitations
Our Articles of Association and the 1991 Law do not contain limits on the number of shares that a shareholder may own.
Transfer of Shares
Every shareholder may transfer
all or any of his shares by instrument of transfer in writing in any usual form or in any form approved by us. The instrument must be executed by or on behalf of the transferor and, in the case of a transfer of a share which is not fully paid up, by
or on behalf of the transferee. The transferor is deemed to remain the holder until the transferees name is entered in the register of shareholders.
We may, in our absolute discretion and without giving any reason, refuse to register any transfer of a share or renunciation of a renounceable letter of
allotment unless:
|
|
|
it is in respect of a share which is fully paid-up; |
|
|
|
it is in respect of only one class of shares; |
|
|
|
it is in favor of a single transferee or not more than four joint transferees; |
|
|
|
it is duly stamped, if so required; and |
|
|
|
it is delivered for registration to our registered office for the time being or another place that we may from time to time determine accompanied by the certificate for the shares to which it relates and any other
evidence as we may reasonably require to prove the right of the transferor or person renouncing to make the transfer or renunciation. |
Share Register
We maintain our register of
members in Jersey. It is open to inspection during business hours by shareholders without charge and by other persons upon payment of a fee not exceeding £5. Any person may obtain a copy of our register of members upon payment of a fee not
exceeding £0.50 per page and providing a declaration under oath as required by the 1991 Law.
165
Variation of Rights
If at any time our share capital is divided into different classes of shares, the special rights attached to any class, unless otherwise provided by the terms
of issue of the shares of that class, may be varied or abrogated with the consent in writing of the holders of the majority of the issued shares of that class, or with the sanction of an ordinary resolution passed at a separate meeting of the
holders of shares of that class, but not otherwise. To every such separate meeting all the provisions of our Articles of Association and of the 1991 Law relating to general meetings or to the proceedings thereat shall apply, mutatis
mutandis, except that the necessary quorum shall be two persons holding or representing at least one-third in nominal amount of the issued shares of that class but so that if at any adjourned meeting of such holders a quorum as above
defined is not present, those holders who are present in person shall be a quorum.
The special rights conferred upon the holders of any class of shares
issued with preferred or other special rights shall be deemed to be varied by the reduction of the capital paid up on such shares and by the creation of further shares ranking in priority thereto, but shall not (unless otherwise expressly provided
by our Articles of Association or by the conditions of issue of such shares) be deemed to be varied by the creation or issue of further shares ranking after or pari passu therewith. The rights conferred on holders of ordinary shares shall be
deemed not to be varied by the creation, issue or redemption of any preferred or preference shares.
Capital Calls
We may, subject to the provisions of our Articles of Association and to any conditions of allotment, from time to time make calls upon the members in respect
of any monies unpaid on their shares (whether on account of the nominal value of the shares or by way of premium) provided that (except as otherwise fixed by the conditions of application or allotment) no call on any share shall be payable
within 14 days of the date appointed for payment of the last preceding call, and each member shall (subject to being given at least 14 clear days notice specifying the time or times and place of payment) pay us at the time or times and place
so specified the amount called on his shares.
If a member fails to pay any call or installment of a call on or before the day appointed for payment
thereof, we may serve a notice on him requiring payment of so much of the call or installment as is unpaid, together with any interest (at a rate not exceeding 10% per annum to be determined by us) which may have accrued and any expenses which
may have been incurred by us by reason of such non-payment. The notice shall name a further day (not earlier than 14 days from the date of service thereof) on or before which and the place where the payment required by the notice is to be made, and
shall state that in the event of non-payment at or before the time and at the place appointed, the shares on which the call was made will be liable to be forfeited.
Borrowing Powers
Our Articles of Association
contain no restrictions on our power to borrow money or to mortgage or charge all or any part of our undertaking, property and assets.
Issue of
Shares and Preemptive Rights
Subject to the provisions of the 1991 Law and to any special rights attached to any shares, we may allot or issue
shares with those preferred, deferred or other special rights or restrictions regarding dividends, voting, return of capital or other matters as our directors from time to time determine. We may issue shares that are redeemable or are liable to be
redeemed at our option or the option of the holder in accordance with our Articles of Association. Subject to the provisions of the 1991 Law, the unissued shares at the date of adoption of our Articles of Association and shares created thereafter
shall be at the disposal of our directors. We cannot issue shares at a discount to par value. Securities, contracts, warrants or other instruments evidencing any preferred shares, option rights, securities having conversion or option rights or
obligations may also be issued by the directors without the approval of the shareholders or entered into by us upon a resolution of the directors to that effect on such terms, conditions and other provisions as are fixed by the directors, including,
without limitation, conditions that preclude or limit any person owning or offering to acquire a specified number or percentage of shares in us in issue, other shares, option rights, securities having conversion or option rights or obligations of us
or the transferee of such person from exercising, converting, transferring or receiving the shares, option rights, securities having conversion or option rights or obligations.
166
There are no pre-emptive rights for the transfer of our shares either within the 1991 Law or our Articles of
Association.
Directors Powers
Our
business shall be managed by the directors who may exercise all of the powers that we are not by the 1991 Law or our Articles of Association required to exercise in a general meeting. Accordingly, the directors may (among other things) borrow money,
mortgage or charge all of our property and assets (present and future) and issue securities.
Meetings of the Board of Directors
A director may, and the secretary on the requisition of a director shall, at any time, summon a meeting of the directors by giving to each director and
alternate director not less than 24 hours notice of the meeting provided that any meeting may be convened at shorter notice and in such manner as each director or his alternate director shall approve provided further
that unless otherwise resolved by the directors notices of directors meetings need not be in writing.
Subject to our Articles of Association,
our Board of Directors may meet for the conducting of business, adjourn and otherwise regulate its proceedings as it sees fit. The quorum necessary for the transaction of business may be determined by the Board of Directors and unless otherwise
determined shall be three persons, each being a director or an alternate director of whom two shall not be executive directors. Where more than three directors are present at a meeting, a majority of them must not be executive directors in order for
the quorum to be constituted at the meeting. A duly convened meeting of the Board of Directors at which a quorum is present is necessary to exercise all or any of the boards authorities, powers and discretions.
Our Board of Directors may from time to time appoint one or more of their number to be the holder of any executive office on such terms and for such periods
as they may determine. The appointment of any director to any executive office shall be subject to termination if he ceases to be a director. Our Board of Directors may entrust to and confer upon a director holding any executive office any of the
powers exercisable by the directors, upon such terms and conditions and with such restrictions as they think fit, and either collaterally with or to the exclusion of their own powers and may from time to time revoke, withdraw, alter or vary all or
any of such powers.
Remuneration of Directors
Our directors shall be entitled to receive by way of fees for their services as directors any sum that we may, by ordinary resolution in general meeting from
time to time determine. That sum, unless otherwise directed by the ordinary resolution by which it is voted, shall be divided among the directors in the manner that they agree or, failing agreement, equally. The remuneration (if any) of an alternate
director shall be payable out of the remuneration payable to the director appointing him as may be agreed between them. The directors shall be repaid their traveling and other expenses properly and necessarily expended by them in attending meetings
of the directors or members or otherwise on our affairs.
If any director shall be appointed agent or to perform extra services or to make any special
exertions, the directors may remunerate such director therefor either by a fixed sum or by commission or participation in profits or otherwise or partly one way and partly in another as they think fit, and such remuneration may be either in addition
to or in substitution for his above mentioned remuneration.
Directors Interests in Contracts
Subject to the provisions of the 1991 Law, a director may hold any other office or place of profit under us (other than the office of auditor) in conjunction
with his office of director and may act in a professional capacity to us on such terms as to tenure of office, remuneration and otherwise as we may determine and, provided that he has disclosed to us the nature and extent of any of his interests
which conflict or may conflict to a material extent with our interests at the first meeting of the directors at which a transaction is considered or as soon as practical after that meeting by notice in writing to the secretary or has otherwise
previously disclosed that he is to be regarded as interested in a transaction with a specific person, a director notwithstanding his office (1) may be a party to, or otherwise interested in, any transaction or arrangement with us or in which we
are otherwise interested, (2) may be a director or other officer of, or employed by, or a party to any transaction or arrangement with, or otherwise interested in, any body corporate promoted by us or in which we are otherwise interested, and
(3) shall not, by reason of his office, be accountable to us for any benefit which he derives from any such office or employment or from any such transaction or arrangement or from any interest in any such body corporate and no such transaction
or arrangement shall be liable to be avoided on the ground of any such interest or benefit.
167
Restrictions on Directors Voting
A director, notwithstanding his interest, may be counted in the quorum present at any meeting at which any contract or arrangement in which he is interested is
considered and, subject as provided above, he may vote in respect of any such contract or arrangement. A director, notwithstanding his interest, may be counted in the quorum present at any meeting at which he is appointed to hold any office or place
of profit under us, or at which the terms of his appointment are arranged, but the director may not vote on his own appointment or the terms thereof or any proposal to select that director for re-election.
Number of Directors
Our board shall determine the
maximum and minimum number of directors provided that the minimum number of directors shall be not less than three.
Directors Appointment,
Resignation, Disqualification and Removal
Our board is divided into three classes that are, as nearly as possible, of equal size. Each class of
directors (other than initially) is elected for a three-year term of office but the terms are staggered so that the term of only one class of directors expires at each annual general meeting. Any additional directorships resulting from an increase
in the number of directors will be distributed among the three classes so that, as nearly as possible, each class will consist of one-third of the directors. This classification of the Board of Directors may have the effect of delaying or preventing
changes in control of management of our company. Our Board of Directors shall have power (unless they determine that any vacancy should be filled by us in general meeting) at any time and from time to time to appoint any person to be a director,
either to fill any vacancy or as an addition to the existing directors. A vacancy for these purposes only will be deemed to exist if a director dies, resigns, ceases or becomes prohibited or disqualified by law from acting as a director, becomes
bankrupt or enters into an arrangement or composition with his creditors, becomes of unsound mind or is removed by us from office for gross negligence or criminal conduct by ordinary resolution. A vacancy for these purposes will not be deemed to
exist upon the expiry of the term of office of a director. At any general meeting at which a director retires or at which a directors period of office expires we shall elect, by ordinary resolution of the general meeting, a director to fill
the vacancy, unless our directors resolve to reduce the number of directors in office. Where the number of persons validly proposed for election or re-election as a director is greater than the number of directors to be elected, the persons
receiving the most votes (up to the number of directors to be elected) shall be elected as directors and an absolute majority of the votes cast shall not be a pre-requisite to the election of such directors.
The directors shall hold office until they resign, they cease to be a director by virtue of a provision of the 1991 Law, they become disqualified by law or
the terms of our Articles of Association from being a director, they become bankrupt or make any arrangement or composition with their creditors generally or they become of unsound mind or they are removed from office by us for gross negligence or
criminal conduct by ordinary resolution in general meeting.
A director is not required to hold any of our shares.
Capitalization of Profits and Reserves
Subject to
our Articles of Association, we may, upon the recommendation of our directors, by ordinary resolution resolve to capitalize any of our undistributed profits (including profits standing to the credit of any reserve account), any sum standing to the
credit of any reserve account as a result of the sale or revaluation of an asset (other than goodwill) and any sum standing to the credit of our share premium account or capital redemption reserve.
Any sum which is capitalized shall be appropriated among our shareholders in the proportion in which such sum would have been divisible amongst them had the
same been applied in paying dividends and applied in (1) paying up the amount (if any) unpaid on the shares held by the shareholders, or (2) issuing to shareholders, fully paid shares (issued either at par or a premium) or (subject to our
Articles of Association) our debentures.
168
Unclaimed Dividends
Any dividend which has remained unclaimed for a period of ten years from the date of declaration thereof shall, if the directors so resolve, be forfeited and
cease to remain owing by us and shall thenceforth belong to us absolutely.
Indemnity, Limitation of Liability and Officers Liability Insurance
Insofar as the 1991 Law allows and, to the fullest extent permitted thereunder, we may indemnify any person who was or is involved in any manner
(including, without limitation, as a party or a witness), or is threatened to be made so involved, in any threatened, pending or completed investigation, claim, action, suit or proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative
including, without limitation, any proceeding by or in the right of ours to procure a judgment in our favor, but excluding any proceeding brought by such person against us or any affiliate of ours by reason of the fact that he is or was an officer,
secretary, servant, employee or agent of ours, or is or was serving at our request as an officer, secretary, servant, employee or agent of another corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust or other enterprise against all expenses (including
attorneys fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement actually and reasonably incurred by him in connection with such proceeding. Such indemnification shall be a contract right and shall include the right to receive payment in
advance of any expenses incurred by the indemnified person in connection with such proceeding, provided always that this right is permitted by the 1991 Law.
Subject to the 1991 Law, we may enter into contracts with any officer, secretary, servant, employee or agent of ours and may create a trust fund, grant a
security interest, make a loan or other advancement or use other means (including, without limitation, a letter of credit) to ensure the payment of such amounts as may be necessary to effect indemnification as provided in the indemnity provisions in
our Articles of Association.
Our directors are empowered to arrange for the purchase and maintenance in our name and at our expense of insurance cover
for the benefit of any current or former officer of ours, our secretary and any current or former agent, servant or employee of ours against any liability which is incurred by any such person by reason of the fact that he is or was an officer of
ours, our secretary or an agent, servant or employee of ours.
Subject to the 1991 Law, the right of indemnification, loan or advancement of expenses
provided in our Articles of Association is not exclusive of any other rights to which a person seeking indemnification may otherwise be entitled, under any statute, memorandum or articles of association, agreement, vote of shareholders or
disinterested directors or otherwise, both as to action in his official capacity and as to action in another capacity while holding such office. The provisions of our Articles of Association inure for the benefit of the heirs and legal
representatives of any person entitled to indemnity under our Articles of Association and are applicable to proceedings commenced or continuing after the adoption of our Articles of Association whether arising from acts or omissions occurring before
or after such adoption.
If any provision or provisions of our Articles of Association relative to indemnity are held to be invalid, illegal or
unenforceable for any reason whatsoever: (i) the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions thereof shall not in any way be affected or impaired; and (ii) to the fullest extent possible, the provisions of our
Articles of Association relative to indemnity shall be construed so as to give effect to the intent manifested by the provision held invalid, illegal or unenforceable.
Nothing in our Articles of Association prohibits us from making loans to officers, our secretary, servants, employees or agents to fund litigation expenses
prior to such expenses being incurred.
169
Distribution of Assets on a Winding-up
Subject to any particular rights or limitations attached to any shares, if we are wound up, our assets available for distribution among our shareholders shall
be applied first in repaying to our shareholders the amount paid up (as to both par and any premium) on their shares respectively, and if such assets shall be more than sufficient to repay to our shareholders the whole amount paid up (as to both par
and any premium) on their shares, the balance shall be distributed among our shareholders in proportion to the amount which at the time of the commencement of the winding up had been actually paid up (as to both par and any premium) on their shares
respectively.
If we are wound up, we may, with the approval of a special resolution and any other sanction required by the 1991 Law, divide the whole or
any part of our assets among our shareholders in specie and our liquidator or, where there is no liquidator, our directors, may, for that purpose, value any assets and determine how the division shall be carried out as between our shareholders or
different classes of shareholders. Similarly, with the approval of a special resolution and subject to any other sanction required by the 1991 Law, all or any of our assets may be vested in trustees for the benefit of our shareholders.
Other Jersey Law Considerations
Purchase of Own
Shares
The 1991 Law provides that we may, with the sanction of a special resolution and subject to certain conditions, purchase any of our shares
which are fully paid.
We may fund the purchase of our own shares from any source provided that our directors are satisfied that immediately after the
date on which the purchase is made, we will be able to discharge our liabilities as they fall due and that having regard to (i) our prospects and to the intentions of our directors with respect to the management of our business and
(ii) the amount and character of the financial resources that will in their view be available to us, we will be able to (a) continue to carry on our business and (b) discharge our liabilities as they fall due until the expiry of the
period of 12 months immediately following the date on which the purchase was made or until we are dissolved, whichever occurs first.
We cannot purchase
our shares if, as a result of such purchase, only redeemable shares would be in issue. Any shares that we purchase (other than shares that are, immediately after being purchased, held as treasury shares) are treated as cancelled upon purchase.
Mandatory Purchases and Acquisitions
The 1991 Law
provides that where a person (which we refer to as the offeror) makes an offer to acquire all of the shares (or all of the shares of any class of shares) (other than treasury shares and any shares already held by the offeror and its
associates at the date of the offer), if the offeror has by virtue of acceptances of the offer acquired or contracted to acquire not less than 90% in nominal value of the shares (or class of shares) to which the offer relates, the offeror by notice
may compulsorily acquire the remaining shares. A holder of any such shares may apply to the Jersey court for an order that the offeror not be entitled to purchase the holders shares or that the offeror purchase the holders shares on
terms different to those of the offer.
Where, prior to the expiry of the offer period, the offeror has by virtue of acceptances of the offer acquired or
contracted to acquire not less than 90% in nominal value of all of the shares of the target company (other than treasury shares and any shares already held by the offeror and its associates at the date of the offer), the holder of any shares (or
class of shares) to which the offer relates who has not accepted the offer may require the offeror to acquire those shares. In such circumstances, each of the offeror and the holder of the shares are entitled to apply to the Jersey court for an
order that the offeror purchase the holders shares on terms different to those of the offer.
170
Compromises and Arrangements
Where a compromise or arrangement is proposed between a company and its creditors, or a class of them, or between the company and its shareholders, or a class
of them, the Jersey court may on the application of the company or a creditor or member of it or, in the case of a company being wound up, of the liquidator, order a meeting of the creditors or class of creditors, or of the shareholders of the
company or class of shareholders (as the case may be), to be called in a manner as the court directs.
If a majority in number representing 3/4ths in
value of the creditors or class of creditors, or 3/4ths of the voting rights of shareholders or class of shareholders (as the case may be), present and voting either in person or by proxy at the meeting agree to a compromise or arrangement, the
compromise or arrangement, if sanctioned by the court, is binding on all creditors or the class of creditors or on all the shareholders or class of shareholders, and also on the company or, in the case of a company in the course of being wound up,
on the liquidator and contributories of the company.
No Pre-Emptive Rights
Neither our Articles of Association nor the 1991 Law confers any pre-emptive rights on our shareholders.
No Mandatory Offer Requirements
In some
countries, the trading and securities legislation contains mandatory offer requirements when shareholders have reached certain share ownership thresholds. There are no mandatory offer requirements under Jersey legislation. The Companies (Takeovers
and Mergers Panel) (Jersey) Law 2009 empowers the Minister for Economic Development in Jersey, or the Minister, to appoint a Panel on Takeovers and Mergers, or the Jersey Panel, as the body responsible for regulating takeovers and mergers of
companies incorporated in Jersey. The Minister has appointed the UK Panel on Takeovers and Mergers, or the UK Panel, to carry out the functions of the Jersey Panel. The Jersey Panel will be empowered to promulgate rules regulating takeovers and
mergers of Jersey companies, or the Jersey Code. The rules applicable to the regulation of takeovers and mergers promulgated by the UK Panel as set out in The City Code on Takeovers and Mergers, or the UK Code, have been adopted as the Jersey
Code. Rule 9 of the UK Code contains rules relative to mandatory offers. However, the UK Code only applies to (i) offers for Jersey companies if any of their securities are admitted to trading on a regulated market in the United
Kingdom or any stock exchange in the Channel Islands or the Isle of Man and (ii) to public or certain private Jersey companies which are considered by the Panel to have their place of central management and control in the United Kingdom, the
Channel Islands or the Isle of Man. As none of our securities are listed on a regulated market in the United Kingdom or on any stock exchange in the Channel Islands or the Isle of Man and as we are not centrally managed and controlled in the United
Kingdom, the Channel Islands or the Isle of Man, it is not anticipated that the UK Code (which has been adopted as the Jersey Code) will apply to us.
In
2012, the UK Panel published consultation paper PCP 2012/3: Companies subject to the Takeover Code, which sought views on proposed amendments to the rules for determining the companies that are subject to the UK
Code. No changes have yet been made to the UK Code on the basis of that consultation. It is possible that future changes to the rules for determining the companies that are subject to the UK Code, made on the basis of that
consultation or otherwise, could result in the UK Code (which has been adopted as the Jersey Code) applying to us.
Non-Jersey Shareholders
There are no limitations imposed by Jersey law or by our Articles of Association on the rights of non-Jersey shareholders to hold or vote on our
ordinary shares or securities convertible into our ordinary shares.
Rights of Minority Shareholders
Under Article 141 of the 1991 Law, a shareholder may apply to court for relief on the ground that our affairs are being conducted or have been conducted
in a manner which is unfairly prejudicial to the interests of our shareholders generally or of some part of our shareholders (including at least the shareholder making the application) or that an actual or proposed act or omission by us (including
an act or omission on our behalf) is or would be so prejudicial. What amounts to unfair prejudice is not defined in the 1991 Law. There may also be common law personal actions available to our shareholders.
171
Under Article 143 of the 1991 Law (which sets out the types of relief a court may grant in relation to an
action brought under Article 141 of the 1991 Law), the court may make an order regulating our affairs, requiring us to refrain from doing or continuing to do an act complained of, authorizing civil proceedings and providing for the purchase of
shares by us or by any of our other shareholders.
Jersey Law and our Memorandum and Articles of Association
The content of our Memorandum and Articles of Association reflects the requirements of the 1991 Law. Jersey company law draws very heavily from company law in
England and there are various similarities between the 1991 Law and English company law. However, the 1991 Law is considerably more limited in content than English company law and there are some notable differences between English and Jersey company
law. There are, for example, no provisions under Jersey law (as there are under English law):
|
|
|
controlling possible conflicts of interests between us and our directors, such as loans by us or directors, and contracts between us and our directors other than a duty on our directors to disclose an interest in any
transaction to be entered into by us or any of our subsidiaries which to a material extent conflicts with our interest; |
|
|
|
specifically requiring particulars to be shown in our accounts of the amount of loans to officers or directors emoluments and pensions, although these would probably be required to be shown in our accounts in
conformity to the requirement that accounts must be prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles; |
|
|
|
requiring us to file details of charges other than charges of Jersey realty; or |
|
|
|
as regards statutory preemption provisions in relation to further issues of shares. |
Comparison of
Shareholders Rights
We are incorporated under the laws of Jersey, Channel Islands. The following discussion summarizes certain material
differences between the rights of holders of our ordinary shares and the rights of holders of the common stock of a typical corporation incorporated under the laws of the State of Delaware which result from differences in governing documents and the
laws of Jersey, Channel Islands and Delaware. The rights of holders of our ADSs differ in certain respects from those of holders of our ordinary shares.
This discussion does not purport to be a complete statement of the rights of holders of our ordinary shares under applicable law in Jersey, Channel Islands
and our Memorandum and Articles of Association or the rights of holders of the common stock of a typical corporation under applicable Delaware law and a typical certificate of incorporation and bylaws.
|
|
|
|
|
Corporate Law Issue |
|
Delaware Law |
|
Jersey Law |
Special Meetings of Shareholders |
|
Shareholders of a Delaware corporation generally do not have the right to call meetings of shareholders unless that right is granted in the certificate of incorporation or by-laws. However, if a corporation fails to hold its annual
meeting within a period of 30 days after the date designated for the annual meeting, or if no date has been designated for a period of 13 months after its last annual meeting, the Delaware Court of Chancery may order a meeting to be held upon the
application of a shareholder. |
|
Under the 1991 Law, directors shall, notwithstanding anything in a Jersey companys articles of association, call a general meeting on a shareholders requisition. A shareholders requisition is a requisition of
shareholders holding not less than one-tenth of the total voting rights of the shareholders of the company who have the right to vote at the meeting requisitioned. Failure to call an annual general meeting in accordance with the requirements of the
1991 Law is a criminal offense on the part of a Jersey company and its directors. The JFSC may, on the application of any officer, secretary or shareholder call, or direct the calling of, an annual general meeting. |
172
|
|
|
|
|
Corporate Law Issue |
|
Delaware Law |
|
Jersey Law |
Interested Director Transactions |
|
Interested director transactions are not voidable if (i) the material facts as to the interested directors relationship or interests are disclosed or are known to the Board of Directors and the board in good faith
authorizes the transaction by the affirmative vote of a majority of the disinterested directors, (ii) the material facts are disclosed or are known to the shareholders entitled to vote on such transaction and the transaction is specifically
approved in good faith by vote of the majority of shares entitled to vote on the matter or (iii) the transaction is fair as to the corporation as of the time it is authorized, approved or ratified by the Board of Directors, a committee or the
shareholders. |
|
A director of a Jersey company who has an interest in a transaction entered into or proposed to be entered into by the company or by a subsidiary which conflicts or may conflict with the interests of the company and of which the
director is aware, must disclose the interest to the company. Failure to disclose an interest entitles the company or a member to apply to the court for an order setting aside the transaction concerned and directing that the director account to the
company for any profit. A transaction is not voidable and a director is not accountable notwithstanding a failure to disclose if the transaction is confirmed by special resolution and the nature and extent of the directors interest in the
transaction are disclosed in reasonable detail in the notice calling the meeting at which the resolution is passed. Without prejudice to its power to order that a director account for any profit, a court shall not set aside a transaction unless it
is satisfied that the interests of third parties who have acted in good faith thereunder would not thereby be unfairly prejudiced and the transaction was not reasonable and fair in the interests of the company at the time it was entered
into. |
173
|
|
|
|
|
Corporate Law Issue |
|
Delaware Law |
|
Jersey Law |
Cumulative Voting |
|
Delaware law does not require that a Delaware corporation provide for cumulative voting. However, the certificate of incorporation of a Delaware corporation may provide that shareholders of any class or classes or of any series may
vote cumulatively either at all elections or at elections under specified circumstances. |
|
There are no provisions in the 1991 Law relating to cumulative voting. |
|
|
|
Approval of Corporate Matters by Written Consent |
|
Unless otherwise specified in a Delaware corporations certificate of incorporation, action required or permitted to be taken by shareholders at an annual or special meeting may be taken by shareholders without a meeting,
without notice and without a vote, if consents in writing setting forth the action, are signed by shareholders with not less than the minimum number of votes that would be necessary to authorize the action at a meeting. All consents must be dated.
No consent is effective unless, within 60 days of the earliest dated consent delivered to the corporation, written consents signed by a sufficient number of holders to take action are delivered to the corporation. |
|
Insofar as the memorandum or articles of a Jersey company do not make other provision in that behalf, anything which may be done at a meeting of the company (other than remove an auditor) or at a meeting of any class of its
shareholders may be done by a resolution in writing signed by or on behalf of each shareholder who, at the date when the resolution is deemed to be passed, would be entitled to vote on the resolution if it were proposed at a meeting. A resolution
shall be deemed to be passed when the instrument, or the last of several instruments, is last signed or on such later date as is specified in the resolution. |
|
|
|
Business Combinations |
|
With certain exceptions, a merger, consolidation or sale of all or substantially all the assets of a Delaware corporation must be approved by the Board of Directors and a majority of the outstanding shares entitled to vote
thereon. |
|
A sale or disposal of all or substantially all the assets of a Jersey company must be approved by the Board of Directors and, only if the Articles of Association of the company require, by the shareholders in general meeting. A
merger involving a Jersey company must be generally documented in a merger agreement which must be approved by special resolution of that company. |
174
|
|
|
|
|
Corporate Law Issue |
|
Delaware Law |
|
Jersey Law |
Limitations on Directors Liability |
|
A Delaware corporation may include in its certificate of incorporation provisions limiting the personal liability of its directors to the corporation or its shareholders for monetary damages for many types of breach of fiduciary
duty. However, these provisions may not limit liability for any breach of the directors duty of loyalty, acts or omissions not in good faith or that involve intentional misconduct or a knowing violation of law, the authorization of unlawful
dividends, or unlawful share purchase or redemption, or any transaction from which a director derived an improper personal benefit. Moreover, these provisions would not be likely to bar claims arising under US federal securities laws. |
|
The 1991 Law does not contain any provisions permitting Jersey companies to limit the liability of directors for breach of fiduciary duty. Any provision, whether contained in the articles of association of, or in a contract with, a
Jersey company or otherwise, whereby the company or any of its subsidiaries or any other person, for some benefit conferred or detriment suffered directly or indirectly by the company, agrees to exempt any person from, or indemnify any person
against, any liability which by law would otherwise attach to the person by reason of the fact that the person is or was an officer of the company is void (subject to what is said below). |
|
|
|
Indemnification of Directors and Officers |
|
A Delaware corporation may indemnify a director or officer of the corporation against expenses (including attorneys fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement actually and reasonably incurred in defense of an
action, suit or proceeding by reason of his or her position if (i) the director or officer acted in good faith and in a manner he or she reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the corporation and (ii) with
respect to any criminal action or proceeding, the director or officer had no reasonable cause to believe his or her conduct was unlawful. |
|
The prohibition referred to above does not apply to a provision for exempting a person from or indemnifying the person against (a) any liabilities incurred in defending any proceedings (whether civil or criminal) (i) in
which judgment is given in the persons favor or the person is acquitted, (ii) which are discontinued otherwise than for some benefit conferred by the person or on the persons behalf or some detriment suffered by the person, or
(iii) which are settled on terms which include such benefit or detriment and, in the opinion of a majority of the directors of the company (excluding any director who conferred such benefit or on whose behalf such benefit was conferred or who
suffered such detriment), the person was substantially successful on the merits in the persons resistance to the proceedings, (b) any liability incurred otherwise than to the company if the person acted in good faith with a view to the
best interests of the company, (c) any liability incurred in connection with an application made to the court for relief from liability for negligence, default, breach of duty or breach of trust under Article 212 of the 1991 Law in which
relief is granted to the person by the court or (d) any liability against which the company normally maintains insurance for persons other than directors. |
175
|
|
|
|
|
Corporate Law Issue |
|
Delaware Law |
|
Jersey Law |
Appraisal Rights |
|
A shareholder of a Delaware corporation participating in certain major corporate transactions may, under certain circumstances, be entitled to appraisal rights pursuant to which the shareholder may receive cash in the amount of the
fair value of the shares held by that shareholder (as determined by a court) in lieu of the consideration the shareholder would otherwise receive in the transaction. |
|
The 1991 Law does not confer upon shareholders any appraisal rights. |
|
|
|
Shareholder Suits |
|
Class actions and derivative actions generally are available to the shareholders of a Delaware corporation for, among other things, breach of fiduciary duty, corporate waste and actions not taken in accordance with applicable
law. In such actions, the court has discretion to permit the winning party to recover attorneys fees incurred in connection with such action. |
|
Under Article 141 of the 1991 Law, a shareholder may apply to court for relief on the ground that a companys affairs are being conducted or have been conducted in a manner which is unfairly prejudicial to the interests of
its shareholders generally or of some part of its shareholders (including at least the shareholder making the application) or that an actual or proposed act or omission by the company (including an act or omission on its behalf) is or would be so
prejudicial. There may also be common law personal actions available to shareholders. Under Article 143 of the 1991 Law (which sets out the types of relief a court may grant in relation to an action brought under Article 141 of the 1991
Law), the court may make an order regulating the affairs of a company, requiring a company to refrain from doing or continuing to do an act complained of, authorizing civil proceedings and providing for the purchase of shares by a company or by any
of its other shareholders. |
|
|
|
Inspection of Books and Records |
|
All shareholders of a Delaware corporation have the right, upon written demand under oath stating the purpose thereof, to inspect or obtain copies of the corporations shares ledger and its other books and records for any
proper purpose. |
|
The register of shareholders and books containing the minutes of general meetings or of meetings of any class of shareholders of a Jersey company must during business hours be open to the inspection of a shareholder of the company
without charge. The register of directors and secretaries must during business hours (subject to such reasonable restrictions as the company may by its articles or in general meeting impose, but so that not less than two hours in each business day
be allowed for inspection) be open to the inspection of a shareholder or director of the company without charge. |
176
|
|
|
|
|
Corporate Law Issue |
|
Delaware Law |
|
Jersey Law |
Amendments to Charter |
|
Amendments to the certificate of incorporation of a Delaware corporation require the affirmative vote of the holders of a majority of the outstanding shares entitled to vote thereon or such greater vote as is provided for in the
certificate of incorporation; a provision in the certificate of incorporation requiring the vote of a greater number or proportion of the directors or of the holders of any class of shares than is required by Delaware corporate law may not be
amended, altered or repealed except by such greater vote. |
|
The memorandum and articles of association of a Jersey company may only be amended by special resolution (being a two-third majority if the articles of association of the company do not specify a greater majority) passed by
shareholders in general meeting or by written resolution signed by all the shareholders entitled to vote. |
Transfer Agent and Registrar
The transfer agent and registrar for our ADSs is Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas.
C. Material Contracts
The following is a summary of each
contract that is or was material to us during the last two years.
(1) Master Services Agreement dated July 11, 2008 between Aviva Global
Services (Management Services) Private Limited and WNS Capital Investment Limited (2008 Aviva master services agreement), (2) Variation Agreement dated August 3, 2009 to the 2008 Aviva master services agreement,
(3) Novation and Agreement of Amendment dated March 24, 2011 among Aviva Global Services (Management Services) Private Limited, WNS Capital Investment Limited and WNS Global Services Private Limited, and(4) 2014 Amendment and Restatement
Agreement dated September 5, 2014
On July 11, 2008, WNS Capital Investment Limited had entered into the Aviva master services agreement
with Aviva MS, pursuant to which Aviva MS agrees to appoint us as service provider and prime contractor to supply certain BPM services to the Aviva group for an initial term of eight years and four months. Under the agreement, Aviva MS has agreed to
provide a minimum volume of business, or minimum volume commitment, to us during the term of the contract. The minimum volume commitment is calculated as 3,000 billable full-time employees, where one billable full-time employee is the equivalent of
a production employee engaged by us to perform our obligations under the contract for one working day of at least nine hours for 250 days a year. We replaced the 2008 Aviva master services agreement in its entirety with the Aviva master services
agreement, by entering into an amendment and restatement agreement in September 2014 in the ordinary course of business. See Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects Our Contracts Revenue by Contract Type.
177
(1) Sale and Purchase Agreement dated June 21, 2012 between BFSL Limited and BGL Group Limited on the one
hand, and WNS Global Services (UK) Limited and WNS (Holdings) Limited, on the other hand (Fusion Sale and Purchase Agreement), (2) Agreement for the Novation of Loan relating to Fusion Outsourcing Services Proprietary Limited dated June
21, 2012 among Fusion Outsourcing Services Proprietary Limited, BFSL Limited and WNS Global Services (UK) Limited (Fusion Loan Novation Agreement), and (3) Co-existence Agreement dated June 21, 2012 among BFSL Limited, BGL Group Limited,
Fusion Outsourcing Services Proprietary Limited, WNS Global Services (UK) Limited and WNS (Holdings) Limited (Fusion Co-existence Agreement).
On June 21, 2012, WNS UK and WNS entered into the Fusion Sale and Purchase Agreement with BFSL Limited, or BFSL, and BGL Group Limited, or BGL Group, pursuant
to which we acquired Fusion. Under the agreement, the purchase price was payable by us in two installments and we paid the first installment of £5,000,000 on June 21, 2012 and a payment on completion of £399,000 on October 30, 2012.
Pursuant to the agreement, on May 31, 2013, the second installment of the purchase consideration of £5,000,000 plus interest of £151,000 was duly paid by us.
On June 21, 2012, WNS UK entered into the Fusion Loan Novation Agreement with BFSL and Fusion pursuant to which BFSL novated to WNS UK all of its rights and
obligations under a facility agreement dated April 8, 2004 (as amended) for a term loan of £10,000,000 which BFSL had advanced to Fusion. This loan was fully repaid in fiscal 2014.
In connection with the acquisition of Fusion, on June 21, 2012, WNS UK and WNS entered into the Fusion Co-existence Agreement with BFSL, BGL Group and Fusion.
Pursuant to the terms of the agreement, the parties have agreed to use the trade name Fusion (together with certain marks) subject to certain territorial restrictions and other restrictions on use.
(3) Employment Agreement dated February 1, 2010 between Keshav R. Murugesh and WNS Global Services Private Limited.
Please see Part I Item 6. Directors, Senior Management and Employees B. Compensation Employment Agreement of our
Executive Director.
178
D. Exchange Controls
There are currently no Jersey or United Kingdom foreign exchange control restrictions on the payment of dividends on our ordinary shares or on the conduct of
our operations. Jersey is in a monetary union with the United Kingdom. There are currently no limitations under Jersey law or our Articles of Association prohibiting persons who are not residents or nationals of United Kingdom from freely holding,
voting or transferring our ordinary shares in the same manner as United Kingdom residents or nationals.
Exchange Rates
Substantially all of our revenue is denominated in pound sterling or US dollars and large part of our expenses, other than payments to repair centers, are
incurred and paid in Indian rupees. We report our financial results in US dollars. The exchange rates among the Indian rupee, the pound sterling and the US dollar have changed substantially in recent years and may fluctuate substantially in the
future. The results of our operations are affected as the Indian rupee and the pound sterling appreciate or depreciate against the US dollar and, as a result, any such appreciation or depreciation will likely affect the market price of our ADSs in
the US.
The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated, information concerning the exchange rates between Indian rupees and US dollars based
on the spot rate released by the Federal Reserve Board:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Fiscal year: |
|
Period End(1) |
|
|
Average(2) |
|
|
High |
|
|
Low |
|
2011 |
|
|
44.54 |
|
|
|
45.49 |
|
|
|
47.49 |
|
|
|
43.90 |
|
2012 |
|
|
50.89 |
|
|
|
47.81 |
|
|
|
53.71 |
|
|
|
44.00 |
|
2013 |
|
|
54.52 |
|
|
|
54.36 |
|
|
|
57.13 |
|
|
|
50.64 |
|
2014 |
|
|
60.00 |
|
|
|
60.35 |
|
|
|
68.80 |
|
|
|
53.65 |
|
2015 |
|
|
62.31 |
|
|
|
61.11 |
|
|
|
63.67 |
|
|
|
58.30 |
|
2016 (until May 01, 2015) |
|
|
63.63 |
|
|
|
62.68 |
|
|
|
63.63 |
|
|
|
61.99 |
|
Notes:
(1) |
The spot rate at each period end and the average rate for each period may differ from the exchange rates used in the preparation of financial statements included elsewhere in this annual report. |
(2) |
Represents the average of the daily exchange rates during the period. |
The following table sets forth, for the
periods indicated, information concerning the exchange rates between Indian rupees and US dollars based on the spot rate released by the Federal Reserve Board:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Month: |
|
High |
|
|
Low |
|
November 2014 |
|
|
62.20 |
|
|
|
61.38 |
|
December 2014 |
|
|
63.67 |
|
|
|
61.78 |
|
January 2015 |
|
|
63.57 |
|
|
|
61.32 |
|
February 2015 |
|
|
62.41 |
|
|
|
61.67 |
|
March 2015 |
|
|
63.06 |
|
|
|
61.76 |
|
April 2015 |
|
|
63.58 |
|
|
|
61.99 |
|
May 2015 (until May 01, 2015) |
|
|
63.63 |
|
|
|
63.63 |
|
179
The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated, information concerning the exchange rates between the
pound sterling and US dollars based on the spot rate released by the Federal Reserve Board:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Fiscal year: |
|
Period End(1) |
|
|
Average(2) |
|
|
High |
|
|
Low |
|
2011 |
|
£ |
0.62 |
|
|
£ |
0.64 |
|
|
£ |
0.70 |
|
|
£ |
0.61 |
|
2012 |
|
|
0.63 |
|
|
|
0.63 |
|
|
|
0.65 |
|
|
|
0.60 |
|
2013 |
|
|
0.66 |
|
|
|
0.63 |
|
|
|
0.67 |
|
|
|
0.61 |
|
2014 |
|
|
0.60 |
|
|
|
0.63 |
|
|
|
0.67 |
|
|
|
0.60 |
|
2015 |
|
|
0.67 |
|
|
|
0.62 |
|
|
|
0.68 |
|
|
|
0.58 |
|
2016 (until May 01, 2015) |
|
|
0.66 |
|
|
|
0.67 |
|
|
|
0.68 |
|
|
|
0.65 |
|
Notes:
(1) |
The spot rate at each period end and the average rate for each period may differ from the exchange rates used in the preparation of financial statements included elsewhere in this annual report. |
(2) |
Represents the average of the daily exchange rates during the period. |
The following table sets forth, for the
periods indicated, information concerning the exchange rates between the pound sterling and US dollars based on the spot rate released by the Federal Reserve Board:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Month: |
|
High |
|
|
Low |
|
November 2014 |
|
£ |
0.64 |
|
|
£ |
0.63 |
|
December 2014 |
|
|
0.64 |
|
|
|
0.64 |
|
January 2015 |
|
|
0.67 |
|
|
|
0.65 |
|
February 2015 |
|
|
0.67 |
|
|
|
0.65 |
|
March 2015 |
|
|
0.68 |
|
|
|
0.65 |
|
April 2015 |
|
|
0.68 |
|
|
|
0.65 |
|
May 2015 (until May 01, 2015) |
|
|
0.66 |
|
|
|
0.66 |
|
E. Taxation
Jersey
Tax Consequences
General
The following
summary of the anticipated tax treatment in Jersey in relation to the payments on the ordinary shares is based on the taxation law in force at the date of this annual report, and does not constitute legal or tax advice and investors should be aware
that the relevant fiscal rules and practice and their interpretation may change. We encourage you to consult your own professional advisors on the implications of subscribing for, buying, holding, selling, redeeming or disposing of ordinary
shares (or ADSs) and the receipt of interest and distributions, whether or not on a winding-up, with respect to the ordinary shares (or ADSs) under the laws of the jurisdictions in which they may be taxed. Under the Income Tax (Jersey) Law 1961, as
amended, or the Jersey Income Tax Law: (i) we are regarded as tax resident in Jersey but, being neither a financial services company nor a specified utility company under the Jersey Income Tax Law at the date hereof, we will not be liable to
pay Jersey income tax, (ii) we will continue to be able to pay dividends on our ordinary shares without any withholding or deduction for or on account of Jersey tax, and (iii) holders of our ordinary shares (other than Jersey residents)
will not be subject to any Jersey tax in respect of the holding, sale or other disposition of their ordinary shares.
On May 6, 2008, Jersey
introduced a 3% general sales tax on goods and services which was increased to 5% with effect from June 1, 2011. We have the benefit of exemption or end user relief from this charge as we have obtained international services entity status (for
which an annual administrative fee of £200 is payable).
Currently, there is no double tax treaty or similar convention between the US and Jersey.
180
As part of an agreement reached in connection with the EU Savings Tax Directive income in the form of interest
payments, and in line with steps taken by other relevant third countries, with effect from July 1, 2005 a retention tax system was introduced in respect of payments of interest, or other similar income, made to an individual beneficial owner
resident in an EU Member State by a paying agent established in Jersey (the terms beneficial owner and paying agent are defined in the EU Savings Tax Directive). The retention tax system applies for a transitional period
prior to the implementation of a system of automatic communication to EU Member States of information regarding such payments. The transitional period will only end after all EU Member States apply automatic exchange of information and EU Member
States unanimously agree that the US has committed to exchange of information upon request. During this transitional period, such an individual beneficial owner resident in an EU Member State is entitled to request a paying agent not to retain tax
from such payments but instead to apply a system by which the details of such payments are communicated to the tax authorities of the EU Member State in which the beneficial owner is resident.
The retention tax system and disclosure arrangements are implemented by means of bilateral agreements with each of the EU Member States, the Taxation
(Agreements with European Union Member States) (Jersey) Regulations 2005 and Guidance Notes issued by the Policy & Resources Committee of the States of Jersey. Based on these provisions and the current practice of the Jersey tax
authorities, dividend distributions to shareholders and income realized by shareholders in a Jersey company upon the sale, refund or redemption of shares do not constitute interest payments for the purposes of the retention tax system and therefore
neither a Jersey company nor any paying agent appointed by it in Jersey is obliged to levy retention tax in Jersey under these provisions in respect thereof. However, the retention tax system could apply in the event that an individual resident in
an EU Member State, otherwise receives an interest payment in respect of a debt claim (if any) owed by a company to the individual.
Taxation of
Dividends
Under existing Jersey law, provided that the ordinary shares and ADSs are not held by, or for the account of, persons resident in Jersey
for income tax purposes, payments in respect of the ordinary shares and ADSs, whether by dividend or other distribution, will not be subject to any taxation in Jersey and no withholding in respect of taxation will be required on those payments to
any holder of our ordinary shares or ADSs.
Holders of our ordinary shares or ADSs who are resident in Jersey for Jersey income tax purposes suffer
deduction of tax on payment of dividends by us at the standard rate of Jersey income tax for the time being in force. Any individual investor who is resident in Jersey who, directly or indirectly, owns more than 2% of our ordinary shares or ADSs may
be subject to the deemed dividend or full attribution provisions which seek to tax shareholders or ADS holders of securities on all or a proportion of our profits in proportion to their shareholdings.
Taxation of Capital Gains and Estate and Gift Tax
Under current Jersey law, there are no death or estate duties, capital gains, gift, wealth, inheritance or capital transfer taxes. No stamp duty is levied in
Jersey on the issue or transfer of ordinary shares or ADSs. In the event of the death of an individual sole shareholder, duty at rates of up to 0.75% of the value of the ordinary shares or ADSs held may be payable on the registration of Jersey
probate or letters of administration which may be required in order to transfer or otherwise deal with ordinary shares or ADSs held by the deceased individual sole shareholder.
US Federal Income Taxation
The following discussion
describes certain material US federal income tax consequences to US Holders (defined below) under present law of an investment in the ADSs or ordinary shares. This summary applies only to US Holders that hold the ADSs or ordinary shares as capital
assets and that have the US dollar as their functional currency. This discussion is based on the tax laws of the US as in effect on the date of this annual report and on US Treasury regulations in effect or, in some cases, proposed, as of the date
of this annual report, as well as judicial and administrative interpretations thereof available on or before such date. All of the foregoing authorities are subject to change, which change could apply retroactively and could affect the tax
consequences described below.
181
The following discussion does not address the Medicare contribution tax on net investment income or the tax
consequences to any particular investor or to persons in special tax situations, such as:
|
|
|
certain financial institutions; |
|
|
|
traders that elect to mark-to-market; |
|
|
|
persons liable for alternative minimum tax; |
|
|
|
real estate investment trusts; |
|
|
|
regulated investment companies; |
|
|
|
persons holding ADSs or ordinary shares as part of a straddle, hedging, conversion or integrated transaction; |
|
|
|
entities treated as partnerships or other pass-through entities, or persons holding ADSs or ordinary shares through such entities; or |
|
|
|
persons that actually or constructively own 10% or more of our voting share; or |
|
|
|
persons who acquired ADSs or ordinary shares pursuant to the exercise of any employee share option or otherwise as compensation. |
US HOLDERS OF OUR ADSs OR ORDINARY SHARES ARE URGED TO CONSULT THEIR TAX ADVISORS ABOUT THE APPLICATION OF THE US FEDERAL TAX RULES TO THEIR PARTICULAR
CIRCUMSTANCES AS WELL AS THE STATE AND LOCAL AND NON-US TAX CONSEQUENCES TO THEM OF THE PURCHASE, OWNERSHIP AND DISPOSITION OF OUR ADSs OR ORDINARY SHARES.
The discussion below of the US federal income tax consequences to US Holders will apply to you if you are a beneficial owner of ADSs or ordinary
shares and you are, for US federal income tax purposes:
|
|
|
an individual who is a citizen or resident of the US; |
|
|
|
a corporation (or other entity taxable as a corporation) organized under the laws of the United States, any State thereof or the District of Columbia; |
|
|
|
an estate whose income is subject to US federal income taxation regardless of its source; or |
|
|
|
a trust that (1) is subject to the primary supervision of a court within the United States and the control of one or more US persons for all substantial decisions of the trust or (2) has a valid election in
effect under applicable US Treasury regulations to be treated as a US person. |
If you are a partner in an entity treated as a partnership
that holds ADSs or ordinary shares, your tax treatment will depend on your status and the activities of such entity.
182
The discussion below assumes that the representations contained in the deposit agreement are true and that the
obligations in the deposit agreement and any related agreement will be complied with in accordance with their terms. If you hold ADSs, you should be treated as the holder of the underlying ordinary shares represented by those ADSs for US federal
income tax purposes. The US Treasury has expressed concerns that intermediaries in the chain of ownership between the holder of an ADS and the issuer of the security underlying the ADS may be taking actions that are inconsistent with the beneficial
ownership of the underlying security (for example, pre-releasing ADSs to persons that do not have the beneficial ownership of the securities underlying the ADSs). Accordingly, the creditability of any foreign taxes paid and the availability of the
reduced tax rate for any dividends received by certain non-corporate US Holders, including individuals US Holders (as discussed below), could be affected by actions taken by intermediaries in the chain of ownership between the holders of ADSs and us
if as a result of such actions the holders of ADSs are not properly treated as beneficial owners of the underlying ordinary shares.
Distributions
Subject to the rules applicable to PFICs, discussed below, the gross amount of distributions made by us with respect to the ADSs or ordinary
shares (including the amount of any taxes withheld therefrom) will be includable in your gross income in the year received (or deemed received) as dividend income to the extent that such distributions are paid out of our current or accumulated
earnings and profits as determined under US federal income tax principles. To the extent the amount of the distribution exceeds our current and accumulated earnings and profits (as determined under US federal income tax principles), such excess
amount will be treated first as a tax-free return of your tax basis in your ADSs or ordinary shares, and then, to the extent such excess amount exceeds your tax basis in your ADSs or ordinary shares, as capital gain. We do not intend to calculate
our earnings and profits under US federal income tax principles. Therefore, a US Holder should expect that a distribution will be treated as a dividend. No dividends received deduction will be allowed for US federal income tax purposes with respect
to dividends paid by us.
With respect to non-corporate US Holders, including individual US Holders, under current law dividends may be qualified
dividend income that is taxed at the lower applicable capital gains rate provided that (1) we are neither a PFIC nor treated as such with respect to you (as discussed below) for either our taxable year in which the dividend is paid or the
preceding taxable year, (2) certain holding period requirements are met, and (3) the ADSs or ordinary shares, as applicable, are readily tradable on an established securities market in the US. Under US Internal Revenue Service, or IRS,
authority, common shares, or ADSs representing such shares, are considered to be readily tradable on an established securities market in the US if they are listed on the NYSE, as our ADSs are. However, based on existing guidance, it is not entirely
clear whether any dividends you receive with respect to the ordinary shares will be taxed as qualified dividend income, because the ordinary shares are not themselves listed on US exchange. You should consult your tax advisors regarding the
availability of the lower rate for dividends paid with respect to ADSs or ordinary shares, including the effects of any change in law after the date of this annual report.
The amount of any distribution paid in a currency other than the US dollar (a foreign currency) will be equal to the US dollar value of such foreign currency
on the date such distribution is received by the depositary, in the case of ADSs, or by you, in the case of ordinary shares, regardless of whether the payment is in fact converted into US dollars at that time. Gain or loss, if any, realized on the
sale or other disposition of such foreign currency will be US source ordinary income or loss, subject to certain exceptions and limitations. If such foreign currency is converted into US dollars on the date of receipt, a US Holder generally should
not be required to recognize foreign currency gain or loss in respect of the dividend. The amount of any distribution of property other than cash will be the fair market value of such property on the date of distribution.
Subject to certain exceptions, for foreign tax credit purposes, dividends distributed by us with respect to ADSs or ordinary shares generally will constitute
foreign source income. The limitation on foreign taxes eligible for credit is calculated separately with respect to specific classes of income. For this purpose, dividends distributed by us with respect to the ADSs or ordinary shares will generally
constitute passive category income. To the extent the dividends would be taxable as qualified dividend income with respect to non-corporate US Holders, including individual US Holders (subject to the discussion above), the amount of the
dividends taken into account for purposes of calculating the foreign tax credit limitation will in general be limited to the gross amount of the dividend, multiplied by the reduced tax rate applicable to qualified dividend income and divided by the
highest tax rate normally applicable to dividends. You are urged to consult your tax advisors regarding the foreign tax credit limitation and source of income rules with respect to distributions on the ADSs or ordinary shares.
183
Sale or Other Disposition of ADSs or Ordinary Shares
Subject to the PFIC rules discussed below, upon a sale or other taxable disposition of ADSs or ordinary shares, you generally will recognize a capital
gain or loss for US federal income tax purposes in an amount equal to the difference between the US dollar value of the amount realized and your tax basis in such ADSs or ordinary shares. If the consideration you receive for the ADSs or ordinary
shares is not paid in US dollars, the amount realized will be the US dollar value of the payment received determined by reference to the spot rate of exchange on the date of the sale or other disposition. However, if the ADSs or ordinary shares, as
applicable, are treated as traded on an established securities market and you are either a cash basis taxpayer or an accrual basis taxpayer that has made a special election (which must be applied consistently from year to year and cannot
be changed without the consent of the IRS), you will determine the US dollar value of the amount realized in a foreign currency by translating the amount received at the spot rate of exchange on the settlement date of the sale. Your initial tax
basis in your ADSs or ordinary shares will equal the US dollar value of the cost of such ADSs or ordinary shares, as applicable. If you use foreign currency to purchase ADSs or ordinary shares, the cost of such ADSs or ordinary shares will be the US
dollar value of the foreign currency purchase price determined by reference to the spot rate of exchange on the date of purchase. However, if the ADSs or ordinary shares, as applicable, are treated as traded on an established securities market and
you are either a cash basis taxpayer or an accrual basis taxpayer who has made the special election described above, you will determine the US dollar value of the cost of such ADSs or ordinary shares, as applicable, by translating the amount paid at
the spot rate of exchange on the settlement date of the purchase.
Subject to certain exceptions and limitations, capital gain or loss on a sale or other
taxable disposition of ADSs or ordinary shares generally will be US source gain or loss and treated as long-term capital gain or loss, if your holding period in the ADSs or ordinary shares exceeds one year. Subject to the PFIC rules discussed
below and other limitations, if you are a non-corporate US Holder, including an individual US Holder, any long-term capital gain will be subject to US federal income tax at preferential rates. The deductibility of capital losses is subject to
significant limitations.
Passive Foreign Investment Company
A non-US corporation is considered a PFIC for any taxable year if either:
|
|
|
at least 75% of its gross income is passive income, or |
|
|
|
at least 50% of its assets (determined on the basis of a quarterly average) is attributable to assets that produce or are held for the production of passive income. |
We will be treated as owning our proportionate share of the assets and earning our proportionate share of the income of any other corporation in which we own,
directly or indirectly, 25% or more (by value) of the stock.
Based on our financial statements and relevant market and shareholder data, we believe that
we should not be treated as a PFIC with respect to our most recently closed taxable year. If we were treated as a PFIC for any year during which you held ADSs or ordinary shares, we will continue to be treated as a PFIC for all succeeding years
during which you hold ADS or ordinary shares, absent a special election as discussed below. The application of the PFIC rules is subject to uncertainty in several respects, and we cannot assure you we will not be a PFIC for any taxable year.
If we are a PFIC for any taxable year during which you hold ADSs or ordinary shares, you will be subject to special tax rules with respect to any
excess distribution you receive and any gain you recognize from a sale or other disposition (including a pledge) of the ADSs or ordinary shares, unless you make a mark-to-market or qualified electing fund, or QEF, election
(if available) as discussed below. Distributions you receive in a taxable year that are greater than 125% of the average annual distributions you received during the shorter of the three preceding taxable years or your holding period for the ADSs or
ordinary shares will be treated as an excess distribution.
184
Under these special tax rules:
|
|
|
the excess distribution or gain will be allocated ratably over your holding period for the ADSs or ordinary shares, |
|
|
|
the amount allocated to the current taxable year, and any taxable year prior to the first taxable year in which we became a PFIC, will be treated as ordinary income, and |
|
|
|
the amount allocated to each other year will be subject to tax at the highest tax rate in effect for that year and the interest charge normally applicable to underpayments of tax will be imposed on the resulting tax
attributable to each such year. |
The tax liability for amounts allocated to years prior to the year of disposition or excess
distribution cannot be offset by any net operating losses for such years, and gains (but not losses) realized on the sale of the ADSs or ordinary shares cannot be treated as capital, even if you hold the ADSs or ordinary shares as capital
assets.
In addition, if we are a PFIC, to the extent any of our subsidiaries are also PFICs, you may be deemed to own shares in such subsidiaries that
are directly or indirectly owned by us in that proportion which the value of the shares you own so bears to the value of all of our shares, and may be subject to the adverse tax consequences described above with respect to the shares of such
subsidiaries you would be deemed to own.
If we are a PFIC, you may avoid taxation under the rules described above by making a QEF election to
include your share of our income on a current basis in any taxable year that we are a PFIC, provided we agree to furnish you annually with certain tax information. However, we do not presently intend to prepare or provide such information.
Alternatively, if the ADSs are marketable stock (as defined below), you can avoid taxation under the unfavorable PFIC rules described above
in respect of the ADSs by making a mark-to-market election in respect of the ADSs by the due date (determined with regard to extensions) for your tax return in respect of your first taxable year during which we are treated as a PFIC. If you make a
mark-to-market election for the ADSs or ordinary shares, you will include in income in each of your taxable years during which we are a PFIC an amount equal to the excess, if any, of the fair market value of the ADSs or ordinary shares as of the
close of your taxable year over your adjusted basis in such ADSs or ordinary shares. You are allowed a deduction for the excess, if any, of the adjusted basis of the ADSs or ordinary shares over their fair market value as of the close of the taxable
year. However, deductions are allowable only to the extent of any net mark-to-market gains on the ADSs or ordinary shares included in your income for prior taxable years. Amounts included in your income under a mark-to-market election, as well as
gain on the actual sale or other disposition of the ADSs or ordinary shares, are treated as ordinary income. Ordinary loss treatment also applies to the deductible portion of any mark-to-market loss on the ADSs or ordinary shares, as well as to any
loss realized on the actual sale or disposition of the ADSs or ordinary shares, to the extent that the amount of such loss does not exceed the net mark-to-market gains previously included for such ADSs or ordinary shares. Your basis in the ADSs or
ordinary shares will be adjusted to reflect any such income or loss amounts. Further, distributions would be taxed as described above under Distributions, except the preferential dividend rates with respect to qualified
dividend income would not apply. You will not be required to recognize mark-to-market gain or loss in respect of your taxable years during which we were not at any time a PFIC.
The mark-to-market election is available only for marketable stock, which is stock that is traded in other than de minimis quantities on at
least 15 days during each calendar quarter on a qualified exchange, including the NYSE, or other market, as defined in the applicable US Treasury regulations. Our ADSs are listed on the NYSE and consequently, if you hold ADSs the mark-to-market
election would be available to you, provided the ADSs are traded in sufficient quantities. US Holders of ADSs or ordinary shares should consult their tax advisors as to whether the ADSs or ordinary shares would qualify for the mark-to-market
election.
You also generally can make a deemed sale election in respect of any time we cease being a PFIC, in which case you will be deemed
to have sold, at fair market value, your ADSs or ordinary shares (and shares of our PFIC subsidiaries, if any, that you are deemed to own) on the last day of our taxable year immediately prior to our taxable year in respect of which we are not a
PFIC. If you make this deemed sale election, you generally would be subject to the unfavorable PFIC rules described above in respect of any gain realized on such deemed sale, but as long as we are not a PFIC for future years, you would not be
subject to the PFIC rules for those future years.
If you hold ADSs or ordinary shares in any year in which we or any of our subsidiaries are a PFIC,
you would be required to file an annual information report with the US Internal Revenue Service, for each entity that is a PFIC, regarding distributions received on the ADSs or ordinary shares and any gain realized on the disposition of the ADSs or
ordinary shares. You should consult your tax advisors regarding the potential application of the PFIC rules to your ownership of ADSs or ordinary shares and the elections discussed above.
185
US Information Reporting and Backup Withholding
Dividend payments with respect to ADSs or ordinary shares and proceeds from the sale, exchange or redemption of ADSs or ordinary shares may be subject to
information reporting to the IRS and possible US backup withholding. Backup withholding will not apply, however, to a US Holder who furnishes a correct taxpayer identification number and makes any other required certification or who is otherwise
exempt from backup withholding and establishes such exempt status. US Holders should consult their tax advisors regarding the application of the US information reporting and backup withholding rules.
Backup withholding is not an additional tax. Amounts withheld as backup withholding may be credited against your US federal income tax liability, and you may
obtain a refund of any excess amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules by filing the appropriate claim for refund with the IRS and furnishing any required information.
Additional Reporting Requirements
US individuals
that own specified foreign financial assets with an aggregate value in excess of US$50,000 are generally required to file an information report with respect to such assets with their tax returns. Specified foreign financial
assets include any financial accounts maintained by foreign financial institutions, as well as any of the following, but only if they are not held in accounts maintained by financial institutions: (i) stocks and securities issued by
non-US persons, (ii) financial instruments and contracts held for investment that have non-US issuers or counterparties, and (iii) interests in foreign entities. Our ADSs or ordinary shares may be subject to these rules. US Holders that
are individuals should consult their tax advisers regarding the application of this requirement to their ownership of our shares.
F. Dividends and
Paying Agents
Not applicable.
G. Statement by
Experts
Not applicable.
H. Documents on Display
Publicly filed documents concerning our company which are referred to in this annual report may be inspected and copied at the public reference
facilities maintained by the Commission at 100 F Street, N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549. Copies of these materials can also be obtained from the Public Reference Room at the Commissions principal office, 100 F Street, N.E., Washington D.C.
20549, after payment of fees at prescribed rates.
The Commission maintains a website at www.sec.gov that contains reports, proxy and information
statements and other information regarding registrants that make electronic filings through its Electronic Data Gathering, Analysis, and Retrieval, or EDGAR, system. We have made all our filings with the Commission using the EDGAR system.
I. Subsidiary Information
For more information on our
subsidiaries, please see Part IItem 4. Information on the Company C. Organizational Structure.
186
ITEM 11. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK
A. General
Market risk is attributable to all market
sensitive financial instruments including foreign currency receivables and payables. The value of a financial instrument may change as a result of changes in the interest rates, foreign currency exchange rates, commodity prices, equity prices and
other market changes that affect market risk sensitive instruments.
Our exposure to market risk is primarily a function of our revenue generating
activities and any future borrowings in foreign currency. The objective of market risk management is to avoid excessive exposure of our earnings to losses. Most of our exposure to market risk arises from our revenue and expenses that are denominated
in different currencies.
The following risk management discussion and the estimated amounts generated from analytical techniques are forward-looking
statements of market risk assuming certain market conditions. Our actual results in the future may differ materially from these projected results due to actual developments in the global financial markets.
B. Risk Management Procedures
We manage market risk
through our treasury operations. Our senior management and our Board of Directors approve our treasury operations objectives and policies. The activities of our treasury operations include management of cash resources, implementation of
hedging strategies for foreign currency exposures, implementation of borrowing strategies and monitoring compliance with market risk limits and policies. Our Foreign Exchange Committee, comprising the Chairman of the Board, our Group Chief Executive
Officer and our Group Chief Financial Officer, is the approving authority for all our hedging transactions.
Components of Market Risk
Exchange Rate Risk
Our exposure to market risk
arises principally from exchange rate risk. Although substantially all of our revenue less repair payments is denominated in pound sterling and US dollars, approximately 55.5% of our expenses (net of payments to repair centers made as part of our
WNS Auto Claims BPM segment) in fiscal 2015 were incurred and paid in Indian rupees. The exchange rates among the Indian rupee, the pound sterling and the US dollar have changed substantially in recent years and may fluctuate substantially in the
future. See Part I Item 5 Operating and Financial Review Prospects Foreign Exchange Exchange Rates.
Our
exchange rate risk primarily arises from our foreign currency-denominated receivables. Based upon our level of operations in fiscal 2015, a sensitivity analysis shows that a 10% appreciation or depreciation in the pound sterling against the US
dollar would have increased or decreased revenue by approximately $27.3 million and increased or decreased revenue less repair payments by approximately $24.3 million in fiscal 2015. Similarly, a 10% appreciation or depreciation in the Indian rupee
against the US dollar would have increased or decreased our expenses incurred and paid in Indian rupee in fiscal 2015 by approximately $24.7 million.
To
protect against foreign exchange gains or losses on forecasted revenue and inter-company revenue, we have instituted a foreign currency cash flow hedging program. Our operating entities hedge a part of their forecast revenue and inter-company
revenue denominated in foreign currencies with forward contracts and options.
Interest Rate Risk
Our exposure to interest rate risk arises principally from our borrowings which have a floating rate of interest, a portion of which is linked to the US dollar
LIBOR and the remainder is linked to the Bank of England base rate. We manage this risk by maintaining an appropriate mix between fixed and floating rate borrowings and through the use of interest rate swap contracts. The costs of floating rate
borrowings may be affected by the fluctuations in the interest rates.
Based upon our level of operations in fiscal 2015, if interest rates were to
increase by 1.0%, the impact on annual interest expense on our floating rate borrowing would be approximately $0.2 million.
We intend to selectively use
interest rate swaps, options and other derivative instruments to manage our exposure to interest rate movements. These exposures are reviewed by appropriate levels of management on a periodic basis. We do not enter into hedging agreements for
speculative purposes.
187
ITEM 12. DESCRIPTION OF SECURITIES OTHER THAN EQUITY SECURITIES
A. Debt Securities
Not applicable.
B. Warrants and Rights
Not applicable.
C. Other Securities
Not applicable.
D. American Depositary Shares
Our ADR facility is
maintained with Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas, or the Depositary, pursuant to a Deposit Agreement, dated as at July 18, 2006, among us, our Depositary and the holders and beneficial owners of ADSs. We use the term holder in
this discussion to refer to the person in whose name an ADR is registered on the books of the Depositary.
In accordance with the Deposit Agreement, the
Depositary may charge fees up to the amounts described below:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Type of Service |
|
Fees |
1. |
|
Issuance of ADSs, including upon the deposit of ordinary shares or to any person to whom an ADS distribution is made pursuant to share dividends or other free distributions of shares, bonus distributions, share splits or other
distributions (except where converted to cash) |
|
$5.00 per 100 ADSs (or any portion thereof) |
|
|
|
2. |
|
Surrender of ADSs for cancellation and withdrawal of ordinary shares underlying such ADSs (including cash distributions made pursuant to a cancellation or withdrawal) |
|
$5.00 per 100 ADSs (or any portion thereof) |
|
|
|
3. |
|
Distribution of cash proceeds, including cash dividends or sale of rights and other entitlements, not made pursuant to a cancellation or withdrawal |
|
$2.00 per 100 ADSs (or any portion thereof) |
|
|
|
4. |
|
Issuance of ADSs upon the exercise of rights |
|
$5.00 per 100 ADSs (or any portion thereof) |
|
|
|
5. |
|
Operations and maintenance costs in administering the ADSs (provided that the total fees assessed under this item, combined with the total fees assessed under item 3 above, should not exceed $0.02 per ADS in any calendar year) |
|
$0.02 per ADS per calendar year |
In addition, holders or beneficial owners of our ADS, persons depositing ordinary shares for deposit and persons surrendering
ADSs for cancellation and withdrawal of deposited securities will be required to pay the following charges:
|
|
|
taxes (including applicable interest and penalties) and other governmental charges; |
|
|
|
registration fees for the registration of ordinary shares or other deposited securities with applicable registrar and applicable to transfers of ordinary shares or other deposited securities in connection with the
deposit or withdrawal of ordinary shares or other deposited securities; |
|
|
|
certain cable, telex, facsimile and electronic transmission and delivery expenses; |
|
|
|
expenses and charges incurred by the Depositary in the conversion of foreign currency into US dollars; |
|
|
|
fees and expenses incurred by the Depositary in connection with compliance with exchange control regulations and other regulatory requirements applicable to ordinary shares, deposited securities, ADSs and ADRs;
|
188
|
|
|
fees and expenses incurred by the Depositary in connection with the delivery of deposited securities; and |
|
|
|
any additional fees, charges, costs or expenses that may be incurred by the Depositary from time to time. |
In
the case of cash distributions, the applicable fees, charges, expenses and taxes will be deducted from the cash being distributed. In the case of distributions other than cash, such as share dividends, the distribution generally will be subject to
appropriate adjustments for the deduction of the applicable fees, charges, expenses and taxes. In certain circumstances, the Depositary may dispose of all or a portion of such distribution and distribute the net proceeds of such sale to the holders
of ADS, after deduction of applicable fees, charges, expenses and taxes.
If the Depositary determines that any distribution in property is subject to any
tax or other governmental charge which the Depositary is obligated to withhold, the Depositary may withhold the amount required to be withheld and may dispose of all or a portion of such property in such amounts and in such manner as the Depositary
deems necessary and appropriate to pay such taxes or charges and the Depositary will distribute the net proceeds of any such sale after deduction of such taxes or charges to the holders of ADSs entitled to the distribution.
During fiscal 2011, the Depository has made a payment of $5,500 to IPREO (Hemscott Holdings Limited) on behalf of our company in consideration for our access
to the Bigdough investor relations tool.
189
PART II
ITEM 13. DEFAULTS, DIVIDEND ARREARAGES AND DELINQUENCIES
None.
ITEM 14. MATERIAL
MODIFICATIONS TO THE RIGHTS OF SECURITY HOLDERS AND USE OF PROCEEDS
Not applicable.
ITEM 15. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures
As
required by Rules 13a-15 and 15d-15 under the Exchange Act, management has evaluated, with the participation of our Group Chief Executive Officer and Group Chief Financial Officer, the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures as of
the end of the period covered by this annual report. Disclosure controls and procedures refer to controls and other procedures designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed in the reports we file or submit under the Exchange Act is
recorded, processed, summarized and reported, within the time periods specified in the rules and forms of the Commission. Disclosure controls and procedures include, without limitation, controls and procedures designed to ensure that information
required to be disclosed by us in our reports that we file or submit under the Exchange Act is accumulated and communicated to management, including our Group Chief Executive Officer and Group Chief Financial Officer, as appropriate to allow timely
decisions regarding our required disclosure.
Based on the foregoing, our Group Chief Executive Officer and Group Chief Financial Officer have concluded
that, as at March 31, 2015, our disclosure controls and procedures were effective and provide a reasonable level of assurance.
Managements
Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting
Management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over
financial reporting.
Internal control over financial reporting refers to a process designed by, or under the supervision of, our Group Chief Executive
Officer and Group Chief Financial Officer and effected by our Board of Directors, management and other personnel, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for
external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles and includes those policies and procedures that:
|
|
|
pertain to the maintenance of records that in reasonable detail accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of our assets; |
|
|
|
provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that our receipts and expenditures
are being made only in accordance with authorizations of our management and members of our Board of Directors; and |
|
|
|
provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of our assets that could have a material effect on our financial statements. |
Management recognizes that there are inherent limitations in the effectiveness of any system of internal control over financial reporting, including the
possibility of human error and the circumvention or override of internal control. Accordingly, even effective internal control over financial reporting can provide only reasonable assurance with respect to financial statement preparation, and may
not prevent or detect all misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate due to changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the
policies or procedures may deteriorate.
Management assessed the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting as at March 31, 2015,
based on the criteria established in 2013 Internal Control Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. Based on the above criteria, and as a result of this assessment, management
concluded that, as at March 31, 2015, our internal control over financial reporting was effective in providing reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external
purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.
The effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as at
March 31, 2015, has been audited by Grant Thornton India LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their report set out below.
190
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
Board of Directors and Shareholders of
WNS (Holdings) Limited
We have audited the internal control over financial reporting of WNS (Holdings) Limited and Subsidiaries (the Company) as of March 31,
2015, based on criteria established in the 2013 Internal ControlIntegrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). The Companys management is responsible for maintaining
effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Managements Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting. Our
responsibility is to express an opinion on the Companys internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.
We conducted our audit in
accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial
reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating
effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
A companys internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial
reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A companys internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that
(1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as
necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors
of the Company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the companys assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of
effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of March 31, 2015, based on
criteria established in 2013 Internal ControlIntegrated Framework issued by COSO.
We also have audited, in accordance with the
standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated financial statements as of and for the year ended March 31, 2015 and our report dated May 5, 2015 expressed an unqualified opinion on those
financial statements.
|
|
/s/ GRANT THORNTON INDIA LLP |
|
Mumbai, India |
May 5, 2015 |
191
Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting
Management has evaluated, with the participation of our Group Chief Executive Officer and Group Chief Financial Officer, whether any changes in our internal
control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by the annual report have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting. Based on the evaluation we
conducted, management has concluded that no such changes have occurred.
ITEM 16A. AUDIT COMMITTEE FINANCIAL EXPERT
Our Audit Committee members are Messrs. Albert Aboody (Chairman), John Freeland, Michael Menezes, and Jeremy Young. Each of Messrs. Aboody,
Freeland, Menezes and Young is an independent director pursuant to the applicable rules of the Commission and the NYSE. See Part I Item 6. Directors, Senior Management and Employees A. Directors and Executive
Officers for the experience and qualifications of the members of the Audit Committee. Our Board of Directors has determined that Messrs. Aboody and Menezes each qualifies as an audit committee financial expert as defined in
Item 16A of Form 20-F.
ITEM 16B. CODE OF ETHICS
We have adopted a written Code of Business Ethics and Conduct that is applicable to all of our directors, senior management and employees. We have posted the
code on our website at www.wns.com. Information contained in our website does not constitute a part of this annual report. We will also make available a copy of the Code of Business Ethics and Conduct to any person, without charge, if
a written request is made to our General Counsel at our principal executive offices at Gate 4, Godrej & Boyce Complex, Pirojshanagar, Vikhroli (W), Mumbai 400 079, India.
ITEM 16C. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES
Principal Accountant Fees and Services
Grant Thornton
India LLP has served as our independent public accountant for the fiscal year ended March 31, 2015. The following table shows the fees we paid or accrued for audit and other services provided by Grant Thornton India LLP for the years ended
March 31, 2015 and March 31, 2014.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Fiscal |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
Audit fees |
|
$ |
482,300 |
|
|
$ |
465,000 |
|
Audit-related fees |
|
|
47,634 |
|
|
|
24,800 |
|
Tax fees |
|
|
32,400 |
|
|
|
26,000 |
|
Notes:
Audit
fees: This category consists of fees billed for the audit of financial statements, quarterly review of financial statements and other audit services, which are normally provided by the independent auditors in connection with statutory and
accounting matters that arose during, or as a result of, the audit or the review of interim financial statements and include the group audit; statutory audits required by non-US jurisdictions; consents and attest services.
Audit-related fees: This category consists of fees billed for assurance and related services that are reasonably related to the performance of the
audit or review of our financial statements or that are traditionally performed by the external auditor, and include service tax certifications and SAS 70 audits and out of pocket expenses.
Tax fees: This category includes fees billed for tax audits.
192
Audit Committee Pre-approval Process
Our Audit Committee reviews and pre-approves the scope and the cost of all audit and permissible non-audit services performed by our independent auditor. All
of the services provided by Grant Thornton India LLP during the last fiscal year have been pre-approved by our Audit Committee.
ITEM 16D. EXEMPTIONS FROM THE LISTING STANDARDS FOR AUDIT COMMITTEES
Not applicable.
ITEM 16E.
PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES BY THE ISSUER AND AFFILIATED PURCHASERS
Neither we, nor any affiliated purchaser, made any purchase of our equity
securities in fiscal 2015.
In March 2015, our shareholders authorized a share repurchase program for the repurchase of up to 1.1 million of our
ADSs, each representing one ordinary share, at a price range of $10 to $30 per ADS. Pursuant to the terms of the repurchase program, our ADSs may be purchased in the open market from time to time for 12 months from April 1, 2015. We are not
obligated under the repurchase program to repurchase a specific number of ADSs, and the repurchase program may be suspended at any time at our discretion.
ITEM 16F. CHANGE IN REGISTRANTS CERTIFYING ACCOUNTANT
Not applicable.
ITEM 16G. |
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE |
We have posted our Corporate Governance Guidelines on our website at
www.wns.com. Information contained in our website does not constitute a part of this annual report.
Messrs. Adrian T.
Dillon, Gareth Williams, Mrs. Renu S. Karnad and Sir Anthony A. Greener are members of our Board of Directors and they serve on each of our Compensation Committee and Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee, except Mr. Williams who
serves only on the Compensation Committee. Messrs. Albert Aboody, Michael Menezes, John Freeland and Jeremy Young serve on our Audit Committee. Each of Messrs. Dillon, Freeland, Menezes, Young, Williams and Aboody, Mrs. Karnad and Sir
Anthony satisfies the independence requirements of the NYSE listing standards and the independence requirements of Rule 10A-3 of the Exchange Act.
We are not aware of any significant differences between our corporate governance practices and those required to be followed by US issuers under the NYSE
listing standards.
As a foreign private issuer, we are exempt from the rules under the Exchange Act governing the furnishing and content of proxy
statements, including disclosure relating to any conflicts of interests concerning the issuers compensation consultants, and our directors, senior management and principal shareholders are exempt from the reporting and short-swing
profit recovery provisions contained in Section 16 of the Exchange Act.
ITEM 16H. |
MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURE |
Not applicable.
193
PART III
ITEM 17. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
See Part III Item 18. Financial Statements for a list of our consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this annual
report.
ITEM 18. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
The following statements are filed as part of this annual report, together with the report of the independent registered public accounting firm:
|
|
|
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm |
|
|
|
Consolidated Statements of Financial Position as at March 31, 2015 and 2014 |
|
|
|
Consolidated Statements of Income for the years ended March 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013 |
|
|
|
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for the years ended March 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013 |
|
|
|
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Equity for the years ended March 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013 |
|
|
|
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended March 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013 |
|
|
|
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements |
194
ITEM 19. EXHIBITS
The following exhibits are filed as part of this annual report:
|
|
|
1.1 |
|
Memorandum of Association of WNS (Holdings) Limited, as amended incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Registration Statement on Form F-1 (File No. 333-135590) of WNS (Holdings) Limited, as filed with
the Commission on July 3, 2006. |
|
|
1.2 |
|
Articles of Association of WNS (Holdings) Limited, as amended incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 of the Registration Statement on Form F-1 (File No. 333-135590) of WNS (Holdings) Limited, as filed with
the Commission on July 3, 2006. |
|
|
2.1 |
|
Form of Deposit Agreement among WNS (Holdings) Limited, Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas, as Depositary, and the holders and beneficial owners of American Depositary Shares evidenced by American Depositary Receipts, or ADR,
issued thereunder (including the Form of ADR) incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of the Registration Statement on Form F-1 (File No. 333-135590) of WNS (Holdings) Limited, as filed with the Commission on July 3,
2006. |
|
|
2.2 |
|
Specimen Ordinary Share Certificate of WNS (Holdings) Limited incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.4 of the Registration Statement on Form 8-A (File No. 001-32945) of WNS (Holdings) Limited, as filed with the
Commission on July 14, 2006. |
|
|
4.1 |
|
Leave and Licence Agreement dated May 10, 2011 between Godrej & Boyce Manufacturing Company Limited and WNS Global Services Private Limited with respect to the lease of office premises with an aggregate area of 84,429 square
feet at Plant 10 incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.3 of the Annual Report on Form 20-F for fiscal 2012 (File No. 001-32945) of WNS (Holdings) Limited, as filed with the Commission on April 26, 2012. |
|
|
4.2 |
|
Leave and Licence Agreement dated May 10, 2011 between Godrej & Boyce Manufacturing Company Limited and WNS Global Services Private Limited with respect to the lease of office premises with an aggregate area of 108,000 square
feet at Plant 5 incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.4 of the Annual Report on Form 20-F for fiscal 2012 (File No. 001-32945) of WNS (Holdings) Limited, as filed with the Commission on April 26, 2012. |
|
|
4.3 |
|
Leave and Licence Agreement dated May 10, 2011 between Godrej & Boyce Manufacturing Company Limited and WNS Global Services Private Limited with respect to the lease of office premises with an aggregate area of 84,934 square
feet at Plant 11 incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.5 of the Annual Report on Form 20-F for fiscal 2012 (File No. 001-32945) of WNS (Holdings) Limited, as filed with the Commission on April 26, 2012. |
|
|
4.4 |
|
Lease Deed dated January 20, 2012 between Sri Divi Satya Mohan, Sri Attaluri Praveen and Sri Divi Satya Sayee Babu, on the one hand, and WNS Global Services Private Limited, on the other hand, with respect to lease of office
premises incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.8 of the Annual Report on Form 20-F for fiscal 2012 (File No. 001-32945) of WNS (Holdings) Limited, as filed with the Commission on April 26, 2012. |
|
|
4.5 |
|
Addendum to Lease Deed dated July 23, 2012 between Sri Divi Satya Mohan, Sri Attaluri Praveen and Sri Divi Satya Sayee Babu, on the one hand, and WNS Global Services Private Limited and WNS Business Consulting Services Private
Limited, on the other hand. incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.5 of the Annual Report on Form 20-F for fiscal 2013 (File No. 001-32945) of WNS (Holdings) Limited, as filed with the Commission on May 2, 2013. |
|
|
4.6 |
|
WNS (Holdings) Limited 2002 Stock Incentive Plan incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.10 of the Registration Statement on Form F-1 (File No. 333-135590) of WNS (Holdings) Limited, as filed with the
Commission on July 3, 2006. |
|
|
4.7 |
|
Contract of Lease dated September 27, 2012 between Megaworld Corporation and WNS Global Services Philippines, Inc. with respect to
lease of office premises incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.6 of the Annual Report on Form 20-F for fiscal 2013 (File No. 001-32945) of WNS (Holdings) Limited, as filed with the Commission on May 2, 2013. |
|
|
4.8 |
|
Form of the Third Amended and Restated WNS (Holdings) Limited 2006 Incentive Award Plan incorporated by reference to Appendix A to WNS (Holdings) Limiteds Proxy Statement which was furnished as Exhibit 99.3 of
its Report on Form 6-K (File No. 001-32945), as furnished to the Commission on August 23, 2013. |
|
|
4.9 |
|
Letter of Intent dated February 14, 2014 between WNS Global Services Private Limited and DLF Assets Private Limited with respect to the lease of office premises on the 8th, 9th and 11th floors of Blocks A2 and A3 at World Tech Park
incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.15 of the Annual Report on Form 20-F for fiscal 2014 (File No. 001-32945) of WNS (Holdings) Limited, as filed with the Commission on May 14, 2014. |
|
|
4.10 |
|
Letter of Intent dated February 14, 2014 between WNS Global Services Private Limited and DLF Assets Private Limited with respect to the lease of office premises on the 10th floor of Blocks A2 and A3 at World Tech Park
incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.16 of the Annual Report on Form 20-F for fiscal 2014 (File No. 001-32945) of WNS (Holdings) Limited, as filed with the Commission on May 14, 2014. |
|
|
4.11 |
|
Letter dated May 8, 2014 between WNS Global Services Private Limited and DLF Assets Private Limited with respect to extension of existing letters of intent for lease of office premises at World Tech Park incorporated by
reference to Exhibit 4.17 of the Annual Report on Form 20-F for fiscal 2014 (File No. 001-32945) of WNS (Holdings) Limited, as filed with the Commission on May 14, 2014. |
|
|
4.12 |
|
Lease Deed commencing April 28, 2014 between WNS Global Services Private Limited and DLF Assets Private Limited with respect to the lease of office premises on the 10th floor of
Blocks A2 and A3 at World Tech Park.** |
|
|
4.13 |
|
Lease Deed commencing April 28, 2014 between WNS Global Services Private Limited and DLF Assets Private Limited with respect to the lease of office premises on the 8th, 9th and 11th floors of Blocks A2 and A3 at World Tech Park.** |
|
|
8.1 |
|
List of subsidiaries of WNS (Holdings) Limited.** |
|
|
12.1 |
|
Certification by the Chief Executive Officer to 17 CFR 240, 15d-14(a), as adopted pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.** |
|
|
12.2 |
|
Certification by the Chief Financial Officer to 17 CFR 240, 15d-14(a), as adopted pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.** |
|
|
13.1 |
|
Certification by the Chief Executive Officer to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.** |
|
|
13.2 |
|
Certification by the Chief Financial Officer to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.** |
|
|
15.1 |
|
Consent of Grant Thornton India LLP, independent registered public accounting firm.** |
195
SIGNATURES
The registrant hereby certifies that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form 20-F and that it has duly caused and authorized the undersigned
to sign this annual report on its behalf.
Date: May 5, 2015
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By: |
|
/s/ Keshav R. Murugesh |
|
|
|
|
Name: |
|
Keshav R. Murugesh |
|
|
|
|
Title: |
|
Group Chief Executive Officer |
196
INDEX TO WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITEDS
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
F - 1
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
Board of Directors and Shareholders of
WNS (Holdings) Limited
We have audited the accompanying consolidated statements of financial position of WNS (Holdings) Limited and subsidiaries (the Company) as of
March 31, 2015 and March 31, 2014, and the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, changes in equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended March 31, 2015. These financial statements
are the responsibility of the Companys management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we
plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial
statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for
our opinion.
In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of
WNS (Holdings) Limited and subsidiaries as of March 31, 2015 and March 31, 2014, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended March 31, 2015, in conformity with International
Financial Reporting Standards, as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board.
We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the
Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the Companys internal control over financial reporting as of March 31, 2015, based on criteria established in 2013 Internal Control Integrated Framework issued by
the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO) and our report dated May 5, 2015 expressed an unqualified opinion on the Companys internal control over financial reporting.
|
/s/ GRANT THORNTON INDIA LLP |
|
Mumbai, India |
May 5, 2015 |
F - 2
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF FINANCIAL POSITION
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at |
|
|
|
Notes |
|
March 31, 2015 |
|
|
March 31, 2014 |
|
ASSETS |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Current assets: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and cash equivalents |
|
5 |
|
$ |
32,448 |
|
|
$ |
33,691 |
|
Investments |
|
6 |
|
|
133,542 |
|
|
|
83,817 |
|
Trade receivables, net |
|
7 |
|
|
55,768 |
|
|
|
61,983 |
|
Unbilled revenue |
|
|
|
|
39,675 |
|
|
|
34,716 |
|
Funds held for clients |
|
|
|
|
12,737 |
|
|
|
15,936 |
|
Derivative assets |
|
13 |
|
|
24,152 |
|
|
|
6,792 |
|
Prepayments and other current assets |
|
8 |
|
|
16,758 |
|
|
|
16,925 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total current assets |
|
|
|
|
315,080 |
|
|
|
253,860 |
|
Non-current assets: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Goodwill |
|
9 |
|
|
79,058 |
|
|
|
85,654 |
|
Intangible assets |
|
10 |
|
|
43,274 |
|
|
|
67,222 |
|
Property and equipment |
|
11 |
|
|
48,230 |
|
|
|
45,165 |
|
Derivative assets |
|
13 |
|
|
5,715 |
|
|
|
4,131 |
|
Deferred tax assets |
|
23 |
|
|
21,331 |
|
|
|
37,066 |
|
Investments |
|
6 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
28,674 |
|
Other non-current assets |
|
8 |
|
|
17,613 |
|
|
|
16,653 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total non-current assets |
|
|
|
|
215,221 |
|
|
|
284,565 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
TOTAL ASSETS |
|
|
|
$ |
530,301 |
|
|
$ |
538,425 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
LIABILITIES AND EQUITY |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Current liabilities: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Trade payables |
|
|
|
$ |
22,706 |
|
|
$ |
29,059 |
|
Provisions and accrued expenses |
|
15 |
|
|
25,622 |
|
|
|
23,897 |
|
Derivative liabilities |
|
13 |
|
|
1,784 |
|
|
|
9,076 |
|
Pension and other employee obligations |
|
14 |
|
|
40,424 |
|
|
|
36,302 |
|
Short term line of credit |
|
12 |
|
|
12,881 |
|
|
|
58,583 |
|
Current portion of long term debt |
|
12 |
|
|
12,828 |
|
|
|
12,637 |
|
Deferred revenue |
|
16 |
|
|
3,881 |
|
|
|
5,371 |
|
Current taxes payable |
|
|
|
|
1,987 |
|
|
|
3,269 |
|
Other liabilities |
|
17 |
|
|
5,931 |
|
|
|
6,650 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total current liabilities |
|
|
|
|
128,044 |
|
|
|
184,844 |
|
Non-current liabilities: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Derivative liabilities |
|
13 |
|
|
390 |
|
|
|
1,399 |
|
Pension and other employee obligations |
|
14 |
|
|
6,069 |
|
|
|
5,168 |
|
Long term debt |
|
12 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
13,509 |
|
Deferred revenue |
|
16 |
|
|
402 |
|
|
|
1,677 |
|
Other non-current liabilities |
|
17 |
|
|
4,017 |
|
|
|
3,909 |
|
Deferred tax liabilities |
|
23 |
|
|
2,273 |
|
|
|
2,949 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total non-current liabilities |
|
|
|
|
13,151 |
|
|
|
28,611 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
TOTAL LIABILITIES |
|
|
|
$ |
141,195 |
|
|
$ |
213,455 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Shareholders equity: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Share capital (ordinary shares $0.16 (10 pence) par value, authorized 60,000,000 shares; issued: 51,950,662 and 51,347,538 shares each
as at March 31, 2015 and March 31, 2014, respectively) |
|
18 |
|
|
8,141 |
|
|
|
8,044 |
|
Share premium |
|
|
|
|
286,805 |
|
|
|
276,601 |
|
Retained earnings |
|
|
|
|
180,345 |
|
|
|
121,731 |
|
Other components of equity |
|
|
|
|
(86,185 |
) |
|
|
(81,406 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total shareholders equity |
|
|
|
|
389,106 |
|
|
|
324,970 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
TOTAL LIABILITIES AND EQUITY |
|
|
|
$ |
530,301 |
|
|
$ |
538,425 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
See accompanying notes.
F - 3
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
Notes |
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Revenue |
|
|
|
$ |
533,893 |
|
|
$ |
502,621 |
|
|
$ |
460,263 |
|
Cost of revenue |
|
19 |
|
|
342,715 |
|
|
|
327,680 |
|
|
|
311,006 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Gross profit |
|
|
|
|
191,178 |
|
|
|
174,941 |
|
|
|
149,257 |
|
Operating expenses: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Selling and marketing expenses |
|
19 |
|
|
31,073 |
|
|
|
35,235 |
|
|
|
30,191 |
|
General and administrative expenses |
|
19 |
|
|
70,013 |
|
|
|
55,385 |
|
|
|
57,091 |
|
Foreign exchange loss/(gain), net |
|
|
|
|
(4,551 |
) |
|
|
11,173 |
|
|
|
5,496 |
|
Amortization of intangible assets |
|
10 |
|
|
24,192 |
|
|
|
23,789 |
|
|
|
26,350 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Operating profit |
|
|
|
|
70,451 |
|
|
|
49,359 |
|
|
|
30,129 |
|
Other income, net |
|
21 |
|
|
(11,912 |
) |
|
|
(9,525 |
) |
|
|
(4,767 |
) |
Finance expense |
|
20 |
|
|
1,332 |
|
|
|
2,948 |
|
|
|
3,633 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Profit before income taxes |
|
|
|
|
81,031 |
|
|
|
55,936 |
|
|
|
31,263 |
|
Provision for income taxes |
|
23 |
|
|
22,417 |
|
|
|
14,289 |
|
|
|
9,864 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Profit |
|
|
|
$ |
58,614 |
|
|
$ |
41,647 |
|
|
$ |
21,399 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Earnings per share of ordinary share |
|
24 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Basic |
|
|
|
$ |
1.14 |
|
|
$ |
0.82 |
|
|
$ |
0.43 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Diluted |
|
|
|
$ |
1.10 |
|
|
$ |
0.79 |
|
|
$ |
0.41 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
See accompanying notes.
F - 4
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
Notes |
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Profit |
|
|
|
$ |
58,614 |
|
|
$ |
41,647 |
|
|
$ |
21,399 |
|
Other comprehensive income/(loss), net of taxes |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Pension adjustment |
|
|
|
|
(380 |
) |
|
|
1,605 |
|
|
|
(117 |
) |
Items that will be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Changes in fair value of cash flow hedges: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Current period gain/(loss) |
|
|
|
|
33,176 |
|
|
|
(21,404 |
) |
|
|
5,658 |
|
Reclassification to profit/(loss) |
|
|
|
|
(7,745 |
) |
|
|
12,935 |
|
|
|
8,692 |
|
Foreign currency translation |
|
|
|
|
(21,588 |
) |
|
|
(19,885 |
) |
|
|
(20,272 |
) |
Income tax provision/(benefit) relating to above |
|
23 |
|
|
(8,242 |
) |
|
|
2,052 |
|
|
|
(4,304 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$ |
(4,399 |
) |
|
$ |
(26,302 |
) |
|
$ |
(10,226 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total other comprehensive loss, net of taxes |
|
|
|
$ |
(4,779 |
) |
|
$ |
(24,697 |
) |
|
$ |
(10,343 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total comprehensive income |
|
|
|
$ |
53,835 |
|
|
$ |
16,950 |
|
|
$ |
11,056 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
See accompanying notes.
F - 5
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN EQUITY
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other components of equity |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Foreign currency translation reserve |
|
|
Cash flow hedging reserve |
|
|
Pension adjustments |
|
|
Total shareholders equity |
|
|
|
Share Capital |
|
|
Share premium |
|
|
Retained earnings |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Number |
|
|
Par value |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance as at April 1, 2012 |
|
|
50,078,881 |
|
|
$ |
7,842 |
|
|
$ |
263,529 |
|
|
$ |
58,685 |
|
|
$ |
(41,784 |
) |
|
$ |
(5,373 |
) |
|
$ |
791 |
|
|
$ |
283,690 |
|
Shares issued for exercised options and RSUs (Refer note 22) |
|
|
509,163 |
|
|
|
80 |
|
|
|
198 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
278 |
|
Reversal of share issuance cost |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
10 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
10 |
|
Share-based compensation (Refer note 22) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5,352 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5,352 |
|
Excess tax benefits from exercise of share-based options and RSUs |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
211 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
211 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Transactions with owners |
|
|
509,163 |
|
|
|
80 |
|
|
|
5,771 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5,851 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Profit |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
21,399 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
21,399 |
|
Other comprehensive income/(loss), net of taxes |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(20,272 |
) |
|
|
10,046 |
|
|
|
(117 |
) |
|
|
(10,343 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total comprehensive income for the year |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
21,399 |
|
|
|
(20,272 |
) |
|
|
10,046 |
|
|
|
(117 |
) |
|
|
11,056 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance as at March 31, 2013 |
|
|
50,588,044 |
|
|
$ |
7,922 |
|
|
$ |
269,300 |
|
|
$ |
80,084 |
|
|
$ |
(62,056 |
) |
|
$ |
4,673 |
|
|
$ |
674 |
|
|
$ |
300,597 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F - 6
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN EQUITY (Contd)
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other components of equity |
|
|
|
|
|
|
Share capital |
|
|
Share premium |
|
|
Retained earnings |
|
|
Foreign currency translation reserve |
|
|
Cash flow hedging reserve |
|
|
Pension adjustments |
|
|
Total shareholders equity |
|
|
|
Number |
|
|
Par value |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance as at April 1, 2013 |
|
|
50,588,044 |
|
|
$ |
7,922 |
|
|
$ |
269,300 |
|
|
$ |
80,084 |
|
|
$ |
(62,056 |
) |
|
$ |
4,673 |
|
|
$ |
674 |
|
|
$ |
300,597 |
|
Shares issued for exercised options and RSUs (Refer note 22) |
|
|
759,494 |
|
|
|
122 |
|
|
|
157 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
279 |
|
Share-based compensation (Refer note 22) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
6,935 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
6,935 |
|
Excess tax benefits from exercise of share-based options and RSUs |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
209 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
209 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Transactions with owners |
|
|
759,494 |
|
|
|
122 |
|
|
|
7,301 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
7,423 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Profit |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
41,647 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
41,647 |
|
Other comprehensive income/(loss), net of taxes |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(19,885 |
) |
|
|
(6,417 |
) |
|
|
1,605 |
|
|
|
(24,697 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total comprehensive income for the year |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
41,647 |
|
|
|
(19,885 |
) |
|
|
(6,417 |
) |
|
|
1,605 |
|
|
|
16,950 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance as at March 31, 2014 |
|
|
51,347,538 |
|
|
$ |
8,044 |
|
|
$ |
276,601 |
|
|
$ |
121,731 |
|
|
$ |
(81,941 |
) |
|
$ |
(1,744 |
) |
|
$ |
2,279 |
|
|
$ |
324,970 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F - 7
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN EQUITY (Contd)
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other components of equity |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Foreign currency translation reserve |
|
|
Cash flow hedging reserve |
|
|
Pension adjustments |
|
|
Total shareholders equity |
|
|
|
Share capital |
|
|
Share premium |
|
|
Retained earnings |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Number |
|
|
Par value |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance as at April 1, 2014 |
|
|
51,347,538 |
|
|
$ |
8,044 |
|
|
$ |
276,601 |
|
|
$ |
121,731 |
|
|
$ |
(81,941 |
) |
|
$ |
(1,744 |
) |
|
$ |
2,279 |
|
|
$ |
324,970 |
|
Shares issued for exercised options and RSUs (Refer note 22) |
|
|
603,124 |
|
|
|
97 |
|
|
|
437 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
534 |
|
Share-based compensation (Refer note 22) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
9,499 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
9,499 |
|
Excess tax benefits from exercise of share-based options and RSUs |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
268 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
268 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Transactions with owners |
|
|
603,124 |
|
|
|
97 |
|
|
|
10,204 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
10,301 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Profit |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
58,614 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
58,614 |
|
Other comprehensive income/(loss), net of taxes |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(21,588 |
) |
|
|
17,189 |
|
|
|
(380 |
) |
|
|
(4,779 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total comprehensive income for the year |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
58,614 |
|
|
|
(21,588 |
) |
|
|
17,189 |
|
|
|
(380 |
) |
|
|
53,835 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance as at March 31, 2015 |
|
|
51,950,662 |
|
|
$ |
8,141 |
|
|
$ |
286,805 |
|
|
$ |
180,345 |
|
|
$ |
(103,529 |
) |
|
$ |
15,445 |
|
|
$ |
1,899 |
|
|
$ |
389,106 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
See accompanying notes.
F - 8
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
(Amounts in thousands)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Cash flows from operating activities: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Profit |
|
$ |
58,614 |
|
|
$ |
41,647 |
|
|
$ |
21,399 |
|
Adjustments to reconcile profit to net cash generated from operating activities: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Depreciation and amortization |
|
|
38,579 |
|
|
|
37,749 |
|
|
|
41,059 |
|
Share-based compensation |
|
|
9,499 |
|
|
|
6,935 |
|
|
|
5,343 |
|
Amortization of debt issue cost |
|
|
81 |
|
|
|
113 |
|
|
|
209 |
|
Allowance for doubtful accounts |
|
|
731 |
|
|
|
(449 |
) |
|
|
(115 |
) |
Unrealized exchange (gain)/loss, net |
|
|
(1,665 |
) |
|
|
12,831 |
|
|
|
2,268 |
|
Current tax expense |
|
|
16,914 |
|
|
|
11,828 |
|
|
|
13,425 |
|
Interest expense |
|
|
1,251 |
|
|
|
2,812 |
|
|
|
3,210 |
|
Interest on deferred consideration |
|
|
|
|
|
|
23 |
|
|
|
215 |
|
Interest income |
|
|
(389 |
) |
|
|
(349 |
) |
|
|
(184 |
) |
Dividend income |
|
|
(4,396 |
) |
|
|
(3,131 |
) |
|
|
(2,958 |
) |
Unrealized gain on investments |
|
|
(4,553 |
) |
|
|
(4,000 |
) |
|
|
(102 |
) |
Loss/(gain) on sale of property and equipment |
|
|
(587 |
) |
|
|
(28 |
) |
|
|
50 |
|
Deferred income taxes |
|
|
5,503 |
|
|
|
2,461 |
|
|
|
(3,561 |
) |
Deferred rent |
|
|
349 |
|
|
|
917 |
|
|
|
768 |
|
Excess tax benefit from share based compensation |
|
|
(99 |
) |
|
|
(106 |
) |
|
|
(55 |
) |
Unrealized loss (gain) on derivative instruments |
|
|
(3,148 |
) |
|
|
(3,697 |
) |
|
|
1,499 |
|
Others |
|
|
55 |
|
|
|
56 |
|
|
|
55 |
|
Changes in operating assets and liabilities: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Trade receivables and unbilled revenue |
|
|
(7,874 |
) |
|
|
(4,085 |
) |
|
|
10,699 |
|
Other assets |
|
|
1,144 |
|
|
|
(576 |
) |
|
|
3,133 |
|
Trade payables |
|
|
(3,671 |
) |
|
|
(2,442 |
) |
|
|
(17,406 |
) |
Deferred revenue |
|
|
(2,577 |
) |
|
|
(2,881 |
) |
|
|
(268 |
) |
Other liabilities |
|
|
11,336 |
|
|
|
2,614 |
|
|
|
5,972 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash generated from operating activities before interest and income taxes: |
|
|
115,097 |
|
|
|
98,242 |
|
|
|
84,655 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Income taxes paid |
|
|
(18,685 |
) |
|
|
(14,251 |
) |
|
|
(16,419 |
) |
Interest paid |
|
|
(1,328 |
) |
|
|
(2,957 |
) |
|
|
(3,594 |
) |
Interest received |
|
|
454 |
|
|
|
357 |
|
|
|
169 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash provided by operating activities |
|
|
95,538 |
|
|
|
81,391 |
|
|
|
64,811 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash flows from investing activities: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Acquisition of iSoftStone assets and the workforce (Refer note 4b) |
|
|
(328 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Acquisition, net of cash acquired (Refer note 4a) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(7,053 |
) |
Deferred consideration paid towards acquisition of Fusion (Refer note 4a) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
(7,608 |
) |
|
|
|
|
Purchase of property and equipment and intangibles |
|
|
(22,968 |
) |
|
|
(19,563 |
) |
|
|
(21,152 |
) |
Marketable securities purchased, net |
|
|
(78,429 |
) |
|
|
23,598 |
|
|
|
(21,783 |
) |
Investments in fixed maturity plan (FMP) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
(50,527 |
) |
|
|
(43,047 |
) |
Proceeds from sale of property and equipment |
|
|
606 |
|
|
|
59 |
|
|
|
296 |
|
Investment in fixed deposit |
|
|
(9,644 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Dividend received |
|
|
4,392 |
|
|
|
3,146 |
|
|
|
2,943 |
|
Proceeds from sale of fixed maturity plan (FMP) |
|
|
66,126 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Government grants received |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
250 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash used in investing activities |
|
|
(40,245 |
) |
|
|
(50,895 |
) |
|
|
(89,546 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash flows from financing activities: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Direct cost incurred in relation to public offering |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(16 |
) |
Proceeds from exercise of stock options |
|
|
534 |
|
|
|
279 |
|
|
|
278 |
|
Repayment of long term debt |
|
|
(12,007 |
) |
|
|
(16,836 |
) |
|
|
(26,133 |
) |
Proceeds from long term debt |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
7,000 |
|
Payment of debt issuance cost |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(279 |
) |
Proceeds/(repayments) from short term borrowings, net |
|
|
(43,521 |
) |
|
|
1,517 |
|
|
|
32,252 |
|
Excess tax benefit from share based compensation |
|
|
99 |
|
|
|
106 |
|
|
|
55 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash provided by/ (used) in financing activities |
|
|
(54,895 |
) |
|
|
(14,934 |
) |
|
|
13,157 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Exchange difference on cash and cash equivalents |
|
|
(1,641 |
) |
|
|
(9,749 |
) |
|
|
(7,269 |
) |
Net change in cash and cash equivalents |
|
|
(1,243 |
) |
|
|
5,813 |
|
|
|
(18,847 |
) |
Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning of the year |
|
|
33,691 |
|
|
|
27,878 |
|
|
|
46,725 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the year |
|
$ |
32,448 |
|
|
$ |
33,691 |
|
|
$ |
27,878 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-cash transactions: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note 1: Liability towards property and equipment and intangible assets purchased on credit/deferred credit |
|
$ |
2,431 |
|
|
$ |
2,486 |
|
|
$ |
2,394 |
|
See accompanying notes.
F - 9
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
1. Company overview
WNS (Holdings) Limited
(WNS Holdings), along with its subsidiaries (collectively, the Company), is a global business process management (BPM) company with client service offices in Australia, Dubai (United Arab Emirates), London (UK),
New Jersey (US) and Singapore and delivery centers in the Peoples Republic of China (China), Costa Rica, India, the Philippines, Poland, Romania, Republic of South Africa (South Africa), Sri Lanka, the United
Kingdom (UK) and the United States (US). The Companys clients are primarily in the insurance; travel and leisure; diversified businesses including manufacturing, retail, consumer packaged goods (CPG), media
and entertainment, and telecommunications; utilities; consulting and professional services; banking and financial services; healthcare; and shipping and logistics industries; as well as the public sector.
WNS Holdings is incorporated in Jersey, Channel Islands and maintains a registered office in Jersey at Queensway House, Hilgrove Street, St Helier, Jersey JE1
1ES.
These consolidated financial statements were approved by the Board of Directors and authorized for issue on May 1, 2015.
2. Summary of significant accounting policies
These consolidated financial statements have been prepared in compliance with
International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as issued by the International Accounting Standard Board.
These consolidated
financial statements correspond to the classification provisions contained in IAS 1(revised), Presentation of Financial Statements.
Accounting policies have been applied consistently to all periods presented in these consolidated financial statements.
These consolidated financial statements have been prepared on a historical cost
convention and on an accrual basis, except for the following material items that have been measured at fair value as required by relevant IFRS:-
a. |
Derivative financial instruments; |
b. |
Share based payment transactions; |
c. |
Marketable securities; and |
d. |
Investments in fixed maturity plan (FMPs). |
c. |
Use of estimates and judgments |
The preparation of financial statements in conformity with IFRS requires
management to make judgments, estimates and assumptions that affect the application of accounting policies and the reported amount of assets, liabilities, income and expenses. Actual results may differ from those estimates.
Estimates and underlying assumptions are reviewed on an ongoing basis. Revisions to accounting estimates are recognized in the period in which the estimates
are revised and in any future period affected. In particular, information about significant areas of estimation, uncertainty and critical judgments in applying accounting policies that have the most significant effect on the amount recognized in the
consolidated financial statements is included in the following notes:
F - 10
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
For certain agreements, the Company has retroactive discounts related to meeting
agreed volumes. In such situations, the Company records revenue at the discounted rate, although the Company initially bills at the higher rate, unless the Company can determine that the agreed volumes will not be met, based on the factors discussed
above.
The Company provides automobile claims handling services, wherein the Company enters into contracts with its clients to process all their claims
over the contract period and the fees are determined either on a per claim basis or is a fixed payment for the contract period. Where the contracts are on a per claim basis, the Company invoices the client at the inception of the claim process. The
Company estimates the processing period for the claims and recognizes revenue over the estimated processing period. This processing period generally ranges between one to two months. The processing time may be greater for new clients and the
estimated service period is adjusted accordingly. The processing period is estimated based on historical experience and other relevant factors, if any.
|
ii. |
Allowance for doubtful accounts |
The allowance for doubtful accounts is evaluated on a regular basis and
adjusted based upon managements best estimate of probable losses inherent in accounts receivable. In estimating probable losses, the Company reviews accounts that are past due, non-performing or in bankruptcy. The Company determines an
estimated loss for specific accounts and estimates an additional amount for the remainder of receivables based on historical trends and other factors. Adverse economic conditions or other factors that might cause deterioration of the financial
health of customers could change the timing and levels of payments received and necessitate a change in estimated losses.
|
iii. |
Current income taxes |
The major tax jurisdictions for the Company are India, United Kingdom and the
United States of America, though the Company also files tax returns in other foreign jurisdictions. Significant judgments are involved in determining the provision for income taxes including judgment on whether tax positions are probable of being
sustained in tax assessments. A tax assessment can involve complex issues, which can only be resolved over extended time periods. The recognition of taxes that are subject to certain legal or economic limits or uncertainties is assessed individually
by management based on the specific facts and circumstances.
|
iv. |
Deferred income taxes |
The assessment of the probability of future taxable profit in which deferred tax
assets can be utilized is based on the Companys latest approved budget forecast, which is adjusted for significant non-taxable profit and expenses and specific limits to the use of any unused tax loss or credit. The tax rules in the
numerous jurisdictions in which the Company operates are also carefully taken into consideration. If a positive forecast of taxable profit indicates the probable use of a deferred tax asset, especially when it can be utilized without a time limit,
that deferred tax asset is usually recognized in full. The recognition of deferred tax assets that are subject to certain legal or economic limits or uncertainties is assessed individually by management based on the specific facts and circumstances.
An impairment loss is recognized for the amount by which an assets or cash-generating
units carrying amount exceeds its recoverable amount. To determine the recoverable amount, management estimates expected future cash flows from each asset or cash-generating unit and determines a suitable interest rate in order to calculate
the present value of those cash flows. In the process of measuring expected future cash flows management makes assumptions about future operating results. These assumptions relate to future events and circumstances. The actual results may vary, and
may cause significant adjustments to the Companys assets within the next financial year.
F - 11
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
In most cases, determining the applicable discount rate involves estimating the appropriate adjustment to market risk and the appropriate adjustment to
asset-specific risk factors.
|
vi. |
Valuation of derivative financial instrument |
Management uses valuation techniques in measuring the fair
value of financial instruments, where active market quotes are not available. In applying the valuation techniques, management makes maximum use of market inputs, and uses estimates and assumptions that are, as far as possible, consistent with
observable data that market participants would use in pricing the instrument. Where applicable data is not observable, management uses its best estimate about the assumptions that market participants would make. These estimates may vary from the
actual prices that would be achieved in an arms length transaction at the reporting date.
|
vii. |
Accounting for defined benefit plans |
In accounting for pension and post-retirement benefits, several
statistical and other factors that attempt to anticipate future events are used to calculate plan expenses and liabilities. These factors include expected return on plan assets, discount rate assumptions and rate of future compensation increases. To
estimate these factors, actuarial consultants also use estimates such as withdrawal, turnover, and mortality rates which require significant judgment. The actuarial assumptions used by the Company may differ materially from actual results in future
periods due to changing market and economic conditions, regulatory events, judicial rulings, higher or lower withdrawal rates, or longer or shorter participant life spans.
|
viii. |
Share-based compensation |
The share based compensation expense is determined based on the Companys
estimate of equity instruments that will eventually vest.
d. |
Basis of consolidation |
The Company consolidates entities over which it has control. Control exists when
the Company has existing rights that give the Company the current ability to direct the activities which affect the entitys returns; the Company is exposed to or has rights to return which may vary depending on the entitys performance;
and the Company has the ability to use its power to affect its own returns from its involvement with the entity. Subsidiaries are consolidated from the date control commences until the date control ceases.
Business combinations are accounted for using the acquisition method under
the provisions of IFRS 3 (Revised), Business Combinations.
The cost of an acquisition is measured at the fair value of the
assets transferred, equity instruments issued and liabilities incurred or assumed at the date of acquisition. The cost of the acquisition also includes the fair value of any contingent consideration. Identifiable tangible and intangible assets
acquired and liabilities and contingent liabilities assumed in a business combination are measured initially at their fair value on the date of acquisition. Significant estimates are required to be made in determining the value of contingent
consideration and intangible assets.
Transaction costs that the Company incurs in connection with a business combination such as finders fees,
legal fees, due diligence fees, and other professional and consulting fees are expensed as incurred.
F - 12
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
|
ii. |
Transactions eliminated on consolidation |
All significant intra-company balances, transactions, income
and expenses including unrealized income or expenses are eliminated on consolidation.
e. |
Functional and presentation currency |
The consolidated financial statements of each of the
Companys subsidiaries are measured using the currency of the primary economic environment in which these entities operate (i.e. the functional currency). The consolidated financial statements are presented in US dollars (USD) which is the
presentation currency of the Company and has been rounded off to the nearest thousands.
f. |
Foreign currency transactions and translation |
|
i. |
Transactions in foreign currency |
Transactions in foreign currency are translated into the functional
currency using the exchange rates prevailing at the dates of the transactions. Foreign exchange gains and losses resulting from the settlement of such transactions and from the translation at the exchange rates prevailing at reporting date of
monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are recognized in the consolidated statement of income. Gains/losses relating to translation or settlement of trading activities are disclosed under foreign exchange gains/losses and
translation or settlements of financing activities are disclosed under finance expenses. In the case of foreign exchange gains/losses on borrowings that are considered as a natural economic hedge for the foreign currency monetary assets, such
foreign exchange gains/losses, net are presented within results from operating activities.
For the purpose of presenting consolidated financial statements, the assets and
liabilities of the Companys foreign operations that have local functional currency are translated into US dollars using exchange rates prevailing at the reporting date. Income and expense are translated at the average exchange rates for the
period. Exchange differences arising, if any, are recorded in equity as part of the Companys other comprehensive income. Such exchange differences are recognized in the consolidated statement of income in the period in which such foreign
operations are disposed. Goodwill and fair value adjustments arising on the acquisition of foreign operation are treated as assets and liabilities of the foreign operation and translated at the exchange rate prevailing at the reporting date.
g. |
Financial instruments initial recognition and subsequent measurement |
Financial instruments are
classified in the following categories:
|
|
|
Non-derivative financial assets comprising loans and receivables at fair value through profit or loss (FVTPL) or available-for-sale. |
|
|
|
Non-derivative financial liabilities comprising long term and short term borrowings and trade and other payables. |
|
|
|
Derivative financial instruments under the category of financial assets or financial liabilities at FVTPL. |
The classification of financial instruments depends on the purpose for which those were acquired. Management determines the classification of the
Companys financial instruments at initial recognition.
|
i. |
Non-derivative financial assets |
Loans and receivables are non-derivative financial assets with fixed or
determinable payments that are not quoted in an active market. They are presented as current assets, except for those maturing later than 12 months after the balance sheet date which are presented as non-current assets. Loans and receivables are
measured initially at fair value plus transaction costs and subsequently carried at amortized cost using the effective interest rate method, less any impairment loss or provisions for doubtful accounts. Loans and receivables are represented by trade
receivables, net of allowances for impairment, unbilled revenue, cash and cash equivalents, funds held for clients, prepayments and other assets.
F - 13
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
|
b) |
Financial assets designated as FVTPL |
Financial assets at FVTPL include financial assets that are either
classified as held for trading if acquired principally for the purpose of selling in the short term or that meet certain conditions and are designated at FVTPL upon initial recognition. Financial assets are initially measured at fair value.
Transaction costs directly attributable to the acquisition of financial assets at fair value through profit and loss are recognized immediately in profit or loss. All derivative financial instruments fall into this category, except for those
designated and effective as hedging instruments, for which the hedge accounting requirements apply. Assets in this category are measured at fair value with gains or losses recognized in profit or loss. The fair values of financial assets in this
category are determined by reference to active market transactions or using a valuation technique where no active market exists. Assets in this category are classified as current assets if expected to be settled within 12 months, otherwise they are
classified as non-current.
|
c) |
Available-for-sale financial assets |
Available-for-sale financial assets are non-derivative financial
assets that are either designated in this category or are not classified in any of the other categories. Available-for-sale financial assets are recognized initially at fair value plus transactions costs. Subsequent to initial recognition, these are
measured at fair value and changes therein, other than impairment losses, are recognized directly in other comprehensive income. When an investment is derecognized, the cumulative gain or loss in other comprehensive income is transferred to the
consolidated statement of income. These are presented as current assets unless management intends to dispose of the assets after 12 months from the balance sheet date.
|
ii. |
Non-derivative financial liabilities |
All financial liabilities are recognized initially at fair value,
except in the case of loans and borrowings which are recognized at fair value net of directly attributable transaction costs. The Companys financial liabilities include trade and other payables, bank overdrafts, loans and borrowings.
Trade and other payables maturing later than 12 months after the balance sheet date are presented as non-current liabilities.
After initial recognition, interest bearing loans and borrowings are subsequently measured at amortized cost using the effective interest rate method. Gains
and losses are recognized in the consolidated statement of income when the liabilities are derecognized as well as through the effective interest rate method amortization process.
|
iii. |
Derivative financial instruments and hedge accounting |
The Company is exposed to foreign currency
fluctuations on foreign currency assets, liabilities, net investment in foreign operations and forecasted cash flows denominated in foreign currency. The Company limits the effect of foreign exchange rate fluctuation by following established risk
management policies including the use of derivatives. The Company enters into derivative financial instruments where the counter party is a bank. The Company holds derivative financial instruments such as foreign exchange forward and option
contracts and interest rate swaps to hedge certain foreign currency and interest rate exposures.
Cash flow hedges
The Company recognizes derivative instruments as either assets or liabilities in the statement of financial position at fair value. Derivative instruments
qualify for hedge accounting when the instrument is designated as a hedge; the hedged item is specifically identifiable and exposes the Company to risk; and it is expected that a change in fair value of the derivative instrument and an opposite
change in the fair value of the hedged item will have a high degree of correlation.
For derivative instruments where hedge accounting is applied, the
Company records the effective portion of derivative instruments that are designated as cash flow hedges in other comprehensive income (loss) in the statement of comprehensive income, which is reclassified into earnings in the same period during
which the hedged item affects earnings. The remaining gain or loss on the derivative instrument in excess of the cumulative change in the present value of future cash flows of the hedged item, if any (i.e., the ineffective portion) or hedge
components excluded from the assessment of effectiveness, and changes in fair value of other derivative instruments not designated as qualifying hedges is recorded as gains/losses, net in the consolidated statement of income. Gains/losses on cash
flow hedges on intercompany forecasted revenue transactions are recorded in foreign exchange gains/losses and cash flow hedge on interest rate swaps are recorded in finance expense. Cash flows from the derivative instruments are classified within
cash flows from operating activities in the statement of cash flows.
F - 14
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
|
iv. |
Offsetting of financial instruments |
Financial assets and financial liabilities are offset against each
other and the net amount reported in the consolidated statement of financial position if, and only if, there is a currently enforceable legal right to offset the recognized amounts and there is an intention to settle on a net basis, or to realize
the assets and settle the liabilities simultaneously.
|
v. |
Fair value of financial instruments |
The fair value of financial instruments that are traded in active
markets at each reporting date is determined by reference to quoted market prices or dealer price quotations, without any deduction for transaction costs. For financial instruments not traded in an active market, the fair value is determined using
appropriate valuation models. Where applicable, these models project future cash flows and discount the future amounts to a present value using market-based observable inputs including interest rate curves, credit risk, foreign exchange rates, and
forward and spot prices for currencies.
|
vi. |
Impairment of financial assets |
The Company assesses at each balance sheet date whether there is
objective evidence that a financial asset or a group of financial assets is impaired. A financial asset is considered impaired if objective evidence indicates that one or more events have had a negative effect on the estimated future cash flows of
that asset. Individually significant financial assets are tested for impairment on an individual basis. The remaining financial assets are assessed collectively in groups that share similar credit risk characteristics.
Impairment loss in respect of loans and receivables measured at amortized cost
are calculated as the difference between their carrying amount, and the present value of the estimated future cash flows discounted at the original effective interest rate. Such impairment loss is recognized in the consolidated statement of income.
|
b) |
Available-for-sale financial assets |
Significant or prolonged decline in the fair value of the security
below its cost and the disappearance of an active trading market for the security are objective evidence that the security is impaired. An impairment loss in respect of an available-for-sale financial asset is calculated by reference to its fair
value. The cumulative loss that was recognized in the equity is transferred to the consolidated statement of income upon impairment.
h. |
Equity and share capital |
|
i. |
Share capital and share premium |
The Company has only one class of equity shares. Par value of the
equity share is recorded as the share capital and the amount received in excess of par value is classified as share premium. The credit corresponding to the share-based compensation and excess tax benefit related to the exercise of share options is
recorded in share premium.
Retained earnings comprise the Companys undistributed earnings after taxes.
|
iii. |
Other components of equity |
Other components of equity consist of the following:
Cash flow hedging reserve
Changes in fair value of
derivative hedging instruments designated and effective as a cash flow hedge are recognized net of taxes.
Foreign currency translation reserve
Foreign currency translation consists of the exchange difference arising from the translation of financial statement of foreign subsidiaries.
F - 15
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
Pension adjustments
This reserve represents cumulative actuarial gain and losses recognized on defined benefits plans.
i. |
Cash and cash equivalents |
The Company considers all highly liquid investments with an initial maturity
of up to three months to be cash equivalents. Cash equivalents are readily convertible into known amounts of cash and subject to an insignificant risk of changes in value.
The Companys marketable securities represent liquid investments and are
acquired principally for the purpose of earning daily dividend income. All additions and redemptions of such investments are recognized on the trade date. Investments are initially measured at cost, which is the fair value of the consideration paid,
including transaction costs. Marketable securities are classified under Available-for-sale category of financial instruments and are recorded at fair value, with changes in fair value, if any recognized in the other comprehensive income. Dividend
income earned on these investments is recorded in the consolidated statement of income.
|
ii. |
Investments in fixed maturity plan |
The Companys investments in fixed maturity plan
(FMPs) represent investments in mutual fund scheme wherein the mutual fund issuer has invested these funds in certificate of deposits with banks in India. The investments in FMP are designated as fair value through profit or loss and
change in fair value recognized in the income statement. The fair value represents original cost of an investment and the investments fair value at each reporting period or net asset value (NAV) as quoted.
The Company manages FMPs on a fair value basis in accordance with the entitys documented risk management, investment strategy and information provided
to the key managerial personnel. The returns on the investment are measured based on the fair value movement rather than looking at the overall returns on the maturity. The Companys investment purchase and sale decisions are also based on the
fair value fluctuations rather than a predetermined policy to hold the investment till maturity. Key management personnel believe that recording these investments through the income statement would provide more relevant information to measure the
performance of the investment.
|
iii. |
Investments in fixed deposits |
Investments in fixed deposits consist of term deposits with original
maturities of more than three months with banks. These are designated as Loans and Receivables.
k. |
Funds held for clients |
Some of the Companys agreements in the auto claims handling services allow
the Company to temporarily hold funds on behalf of the client. The funds are segregated from the Companys funds and there is usually a short period of time between when the Company receives these funds from the client and when the payments are
made on their behalf.
l. |
Property and equipment |
Property and equipment are stated at historical cost. Cost includes expenditures
directly attributable to the acquisition of the asset. Depreciation and amortization is computed using the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets, which are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
Asset description |
|
Asset life (in years) |
|
Buildings |
|
|
20 |
|
Computers and software |
|
|
3-4 |
|
Furniture, fixtures and office equipment |
|
|
2-5 |
|
Vehicles |
|
|
3 |
|
Leasehold improvements |
|
|
Lesser of estimated useful life or lease term |
|
F - 16
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
Assets acquired under finance leases are capitalized as assets by the Company at an amount equal to the fair
value of the leased asset or, if lower, the present value of the minimum lease payments, each determined at the inception of the lease. Assets under finance leases and leasehold improvements are depreciated over the shorter of the lease term or the
estimated useful life of the assets.
Advances paid towards the acquisition of property and equipment and the cost of property and equipment not put to
use before the balance sheet date are disclosed as capital work-in-progress in note 11.
The Company assesses property and equipment for impairment
whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset or group of assets may not be recoverable. If any such indication exists, the Company estimates the recoverable amount of the asset. The recoverable amount of
an asset or cash generating unit is the higher of its fair value less cost to sell (FVLCTS) and its value-in-use (VIU). If the recoverable amount of the asset or the recoverable amount of the cash generating unit to which the
asset belongs is less than its carrying amount, the carrying amount is reduced to its recoverable amount. The reduction is treated as an impairment loss and is recognized in the consolidated statement of income. If at the reporting date there is an
indication that a previously assessed impairment loss no longer exists, the recoverable amount is reassessed and the impairment losses previously recognized are reversed such that the asset is recognized at its recoverable amount but not exceeding
written down value which would have been reported if the impairment losses had not been recognized initially.
Goodwill represents the excess of the cost of an acquisition over the fair value of the
Companys share of the net identifiable assets of the acquired subsidiary at the date of acquisition. Goodwill is allocated to the cash-generating units expected to benefit from the synergies of the combination for the purpose of impairment
testing. Goodwill is tested, at the cash-generating unit (or group of cash generating units) level, for impairment annually or if events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount may not be recoverable. Goodwill is carried at
cost less accumulated impairment losses. Impairment loss on goodwill is not reversed. See further discussion on impairment testing under Impairment of intangible assets and goodwill below.
Intangible assets are recognized only when it is probable that the expected future
economic benefits attributable to the assets will accrue to the Company and the cost can be reliably measured. Intangible assets acquired in a business combination are recorded at fair value using generally accepted valuation methods appropriate for
the type of intangible asset. Intangible assets with definite lives are amortized over the estimated useful lives and are reviewed for impairment, if indicators of impairment arise. See further discussion on impairment testing under Impairment
of intangible assets and goodwill below.
The Companys definite lived intangible assets are amortized over the estimated useful life of the
assets:
|
|
|
|
|
Asset description |
|
Weighted average amortization period (in months) |
|
Customer contracts |
|
|
99 |
|
Customer relationship |
|
|
91 |
|
Software |
|
|
58 |
|
F - 17
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
o. |
Impairment of intangible assets and goodwill |
Goodwill is not subject to amortization and tested
annually for impairment and whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount may not be recoverable. Intangible assets that are subject to amortization are reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in
circumstances indicate that the carrying amount may not be recoverable. An impairment loss is recognized for the amount by which the assets carrying amount exceeds its recoverable amount. The recoverable amount is the higher of an assets
FVLCTS and VIU. For the purposes of assessing impairment, assets are grouped at the cash generating unit level which is the lowest level for which there are separately identifiable cash flows. Impairment losses recognized in respect of cash
generating units are allocated first to reduce the carrying amount of any goodwill allocated to the cash generating units (or group of cash generating units) and then, to reduce the carrying amount of the other assets in the cash generating unit (or
group of cash generating units) on a pro rata basis. Intangible assets that suffered impairment are reviewed for possible reversal of the impairment at each reporting date.
i. Defined contribution plans
US Savings Plan
Eligible employees of the Company in the
US participate in a savings plan (the Plan) under Section 401(k) of the United States Internal Revenue Code (the Code). The Plan allows for employees to defer a portion of their annual earnings on a pre-tax basis
through voluntary contributions to the Plan. The Plan provides that the Company can make optional contributions up to the maximum allowable limit under the Code.
UK Pension Scheme
Eligible employees in the UK
contribute to a defined contribution pension scheme operated in the UK. The assets of the scheme are held separately in an independently administered fund. The pension expense represents contributions payable to the fund maintained by the Company.
Provident Fund
Eligible employees of the Company in
India, the Philippines, Sri Lanka and the UK participate in a defined contribution fund in accordance with the regulatory requirements in the respective jurisdictions. Both the employee and the Company contribute an equal amount to the fund which is
equal to a specified percentage of the employees salary.
The Company has no further obligation under defined contribution plans beyond the
contributions made under these plans. Contributions are charged to income in the year in which they accrue and are included in the consolidated statement of income.
Employees in India, the Philippines and Sri Lanka are entitled to a defined
benefit retirement plan covering eligible employees of the Company. The plan provides for a lump-sum payment to eligible employees, at retirement, death, and incapacitation or on termination of employment, of an amount based on the respective
employees salary and tenure of employment (subject to a maximum of approximately $16 per employee in India). In India contributions are made to funds administered and managed by the Life Insurance Corporation of India (LIC) and
Aviva Life Insurance Company Private Limited (ALICPL) (together, the Fund Administrators) to fund the gratuity liability of an Indian subsidiary. Under this scheme, the obligation to pay gratuity remains with the Company,
although the Fund Administrators administer the scheme. The Companys Sri Lanka subsidiary, Philippines subsidiary and one Indian subsidiary have unfunded gratuity obligations.
Gratuity liabilities are determined by actuarial valuation, performed by an independent actuary, at each balance sheet date using the projected unit credit
method. The Company recognizes the net obligation of a defined benefit plan in its balance sheet as an asset or liability, respectively, in accordance with IAS 19, Employee Benefits (revised 2011). The discount rate is based on
the government securities yield. Actuarial gains and losses arising from experience adjustments and changes in actuarial assumptions are recorded in other comprehensive income in the statement of comprehensive income in the period in which they
arise.
F - 18
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
iii. |
Compensated absences |
The Companys liability for compensated absences, which are expected to be
settled within one year, is determined on an accrual basis for the entire unused vacation balance standing to the credit of each employee as at year-end and were charged to income in the year in which they accrue.
The Company accounts for share-based compensation expense relating to share-based
payments using a fair value method in accordance with IFRS 2Share-based Payments. Grants issued by the Company vest in a graded manner. Under the fair value method, the estimated fair value of awards is charged to income over the
requisite service period, which is generally the vesting period of the award, for each separately vesting portion of the award as if the award was, in substance, multiple awards. The Company includes a forfeiture estimate in the amount of
compensation expense being recognized based on the Companys estimate of equity instruments that will eventually vest.
r. |
Provisions and accrued expenses |
A provision is recognized in the balance sheet when the Company has a
present legal or constructive obligation as a result of a past event, and it is probable that an outflow of economic benefits will be required to settle the obligation. If the effect is material, provisions are recognized at present value by
discounting the expected future cash flows at a pre-tax rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money.
Provisions for onerous
contracts are recognized when the expected benefits to be derived by the Company from a contract are lower than the unavoidable costs of meeting the future obligations under the contract. The provision is measured at the present value of the lower
of the expected cost of terminating the contract and the expected net cost of continuing with the contract. Before a provision is established, the Company recognizes any impairment loss on the assets associated with that contract.
The Company derives revenue from BPM services comprised of back office
administration, data management, contact center management and auto claims handling services.
Revenue is recognized to the extent it is probable that the
economic benefit will flow to the Company, the amount of revenue can be measured reliably, collection is probable, and the cost incurred or to be incurred can be measured reliably. Revenue from rendering services is recognized on an accrual basis
when services are performed.
Revenue earned by back office administration, data management and contact center management services
Back office administration, data management and contact center management contracts are based on the following pricing models:
|
a) |
per full-time-equivalent arrangements, which typically involve billings based on the number of full-time employees (or equivalent) deployed on the execution of the business process outsourced; |
|
b) |
per transaction arrangements, which typically involve billings based on the number of transactions processed (such as the number of e-mail responses, or airline coupons or insurance claims processed); |
|
c) |
fixed-price arrangements, which typically involve billings based on achievements of pre-defined deliverables or milestones; |
|
d) |
outcome-based arrangements, which typically involve billings based on the business result achieved by our clients through our service efforts (such as measured based on a reduction in days sales outstanding, improvement
in working capital, increase in collections or a reduction in operating expenses); or |
|
e) |
other pricing arrangements, including cost-plus arrangements, which typically involve billing the contractually agreed direct and indirect costs and a fee based on the number of employees deployed under the arrangement.
|
F - 19
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
Revenues from the Companys services are recognized primarily on a time-and-material, cost-plus or
unit-priced basis. Revenues under time-and-material contracts are recognized as the services are performed. Revenues are recognized on cost-plus contracts on the basis of contractually agreed direct and indirect costs incurred on a client contract
plus an agreed upon profit mark-up. Revenues are recognized on unit-price based contracts based on the number of specified units of work delivered to a client. Such revenues are recognized as the related services are provided in accordance with the
client contract.
Amounts billed or payments received, where revenue recognition criteria have not been met, are recorded as deferred revenue and are
recognized as revenue when all the recognition criteria have been met. However, the costs related to the performance of BPM services unrelated to transition services (see discussion below) are recognized in the period in which the services are
rendered. An upfront payment received towards future services is recognized ratably over the period when such services are provided.
The Company has
certain minimum commitment arrangements that provide for a minimum revenue commitment on an annual basis. Any revenue shortfall as compared to minimum commitment is invoiced and recognized at the reporting period end.
For certain BPM customers, the Company performs transition activities at the outset of entering into a new contract. The Company has determined these
transition activities do not meet the criteria using the guidance in IAS 18 Revenue (IAS 18), to be accounted for as a separate unit of accounting with stand-alone value separate from the ongoing BPM contract.
Accordingly, transition revenue and costs are subsequently recognized ratably over the period in which the BPM services are performed. Further, the deferral of costs is limited to the amount of the deferred revenue. Any costs in excess of the
deferred transition revenue are recognized in the period incurred.
Revenue earned by auto claims handling services
Auto claims handling services include claims handling and administration (Claims Handling), car hire and arranging for repairs with repair centers
across the UK and the related payment processing for such repairs (Accident Management).With respect to Claims Handling, the Company receives either a per-claim fee or a fixed fee. Revenue for per claim fee is recognized over the
estimated processing period of the claim, which currently ranges from one to two months and revenue for fixed fee is recognized on a straight line basis over the period of the contract. In certain cases, the fee is contingent upon the successful
recovery of a claim on behalf of the customer. In these circumstances, the revenue is deferred until the contingency is resolved. Revenue in respect of car hire is recognized over the car hire term.
In order to provide Accident Management services, the Company arranges for the repair through a network of repair centers. The repair costs are invoiced to
customers. In determining whether the receipt from the customers related to payments to repair centers should be recognized as revenue, the Company considers the criteria established by IAS 18, Illustrative example (IE) 21
Determining whether an entity is acting as a principal or as an agent. When the Company determines that it is the principal in providing Accident Management services, amounts received from customers are recognized and presented as
third party revenue and the payments to repair centers are recognized as cost of revenue in the consolidated statement of income. Factors considered in determining whether the Company is the principal in the transaction include whether:
|
a) |
the Company has the primary responsibility for providing the services, |
|
b) |
the Company negotiates labor rates with repair centers, |
|
c) |
the Company is responsible for timely and satisfactory completion of repairs, and |
|
d) |
the Company bears the risk that the customer may not pay for the services provided (credit risk). |
If there
are circumstances where the above criteria are not met and therefore the Company is not the principal in providing Accident Management services, amounts received from customers are recognized and presented net of payments to repair centers in the
consolidated statement of income. Revenue from Accident Management services is recorded net of the repairer referral fees passed on to customers.
F - 20
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
The Company leases most of its delivery centers and office facilities under operating lease
agreements that are renewable on a periodic basis at the option of the lessor and the lessee. The lease agreements contain rent free periods and rent escalation clauses. Rental expenses for operating leases with step rents are recognized on a
straight-line basis over the lease term. When a lease agreement undergoes a substantial modification of the existing terms, it would be accounted as a new lease agreement with the resultant deferred rent liability credited to the consolidated
statement of income.
Leases under which the Company assumes substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership are classified as finance leases. When
acquired, such assets are capitalized at fair value or present value of the minimum lease payments at the inception of the lease, whichever is lower.
Income tax comprises current and deferred tax. Income tax expense is recognized in
statements of income except to the extent it relates to items directly recognized in equity, in which case it is recognized in equity.
Current income tax for the current and prior periods are measured at the amount
expected to be recovered from or paid to the taxation authorities based on the taxable profit for the period. The tax rates and tax laws used to compute the amount are those that are enacted by the reporting date and applicable for the period. The
Company offsets current tax assets and current tax liabilities, where it has a legally enforceable right to set off the recognized amounts and where it intends either to settle on a net basis, or to realize the asset and liability simultaneously.
Significant judgments are involved in determining the provision for income taxes including judgment on whether tax positions are probable of being
sustained in tax assessments. A tax assessment can involve complex issues, which can only be resolved over extended time periods. The recognition of taxes that are subject to certain legal or economic limits or uncertainties is assessed individually
by management based on the specific facts and circumstances. Though the Company has considered all these issues in estimating its income taxes, there could be an unfavorable resolution of such issues that may affect results of the Companys
operations.
Deferred income tax is recognized using the balance sheet approach. Deferred income
tax assets and liabilities are recognized for all deductible and taxable temporary differences arising between the tax bases of assets and liabilities and their carrying amount in financial statements, except when the deferred income tax arises from
the initial recognition of goodwill or an asset or liability in a transaction that is not a business combination and affects neither accounting nor taxable profits or loss at the time of transaction.
Deferred income tax assets and liabilities are measured at the tax rates that are expected to apply in the period when the asset is realized or the liability
is settled, based on tax rates (and tax laws) that have been enacted or substantively enacted at the reporting date.
Deferred income tax asset in respect
of carry forward of unused tax credits and unused tax losses are recognized to the extent that it is probable that taxable profit will be available against which the deductible temporary differences, and the carry forward of unused tax credits and
unused tax losses can be utilized.
The carrying amount of deferred income tax assets is reviewed at each reporting date and reduced to the extent that it
is no longer probable that sufficient taxable profit will be available to allow all or part of the deferred income tax asset to be utilized.
The Company
recognizes deferred tax liabilities for all taxable temporary differences except those associated with the investments in subsidiaries where the timing of the reversal of the temporary difference can be controlled and it is probable that the
temporary difference will not reverse in the foreseeable future.
F - 21
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
Finance expense comprises of interest cost on borrowings, transaction cost and the
gains/losses on settlement of related derivative instruments. The foreign exchange gains/losses on borrowings are considered as a natural economic hedge for the foreign currency monetary assets which are classified as foreign exchange gains/losses,
net within results from operating activities. Borrowing costs are recognized in the consolidated statement of income using the effective interest method.
Basic earnings per share are computed using the weighted-average number of ordinary
shares outstanding during the period. Diluted earnings per share is computed by considering the impact of the potential issuance of ordinary shares, using the treasury stock method, on the weighted average number of shares outstanding during the
period, except where the results would be anti-dilutive.
The Company recognizes government grants only when there is reasonable assurance that
the conditions attached to them shall be complied with, and the grants will be received. Government grants related to depreciable assets are treated as deferred income and are recognized in the statement of comprehensive income on a systematic and
rational basis over the useful life of the asset. Government grants related to revenue are recognized on a systematic basis in the statement of comprehensive income over the periods necessary to match them with the related costs that they are
intended to compensate.
3. New accounting pronouncements not yet adopted by the Company
Certain new standards, interpretations and amendments to existing standards have been published that are mandatory for the Companys accounting periods
beginning on or after April 1, 2015 or later periods. Those which are considered to be relevant to the Companys operations are set out below.
i. |
In May 2014, the IASB issued IFRS 15 Revenue from Contracts with Customers (IFRS 15). This standard provides a single, principle-based five-step model to be applied to all contracts with customers. Guidance
is provided on topics such as the point at which revenue is recognized, accounting for variable consideration, costs of fulfilling and obtaining a contract and various other related matters. IFRS 15 also introduced new disclosure requirements
with respect to revenue. |
The five steps in the model under IFRS 15 are : (i) identify the contract with the customer;
(ii) identify the performance obligations in the contract; (iii) determine the transaction price; (iv) allocate the transaction price to the performance obligations in the contracts; and (v) recognize revenue when (or as) the
entity satisfies a performance obligation.
IFRS 15 replaces the following standards and interpretations:
|
|
|
IAS 11 Construction Contracts |
|
|
|
IFRIC 13 Customer Loyalty Programmes |
|
|
|
IFRIC 15 Agreements for the Construction of Real Estate |
|
|
|
IFRIC 18 Transfers of Assets from Customers |
|
|
|
SIC-31 Revenue - Barter Transactions Involving Advertising Services |
When first applying
IFRS 15, it should be applied in full for the current period, including retrospective application to all contracts that were not yet complete at the beginning of that period. In respect of prior periods, the transition guidance allows an option to
either:
|
|
|
apply IFRS 15 in full to prior periods (with certain limited practical expedients being available); or |
|
|
|
retain prior period figures as reported under the previous standards, recognizing the cumulative effect of applying IFRS 15 as an adjustment to the opening balance of equity as at the date of initial application
(beginning of current reporting period). |
IFRS 15 is effective for fiscal years beginning on or after January 1, 2017. Earlier
application is permitted. The Company is currently evaluating the impact that this new standard will have on its consolidated financial statements.
F - 22
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
ii. |
In July 2014, the IASB finalized and issued IFRS 9 Financial Instruments. IFRS 9 replaces IAS 39 Financial instruments: recognition and measurement, the previous Standard which dealt with the
recognition and measurement of financial instruments in its entirety upon formers effective date. |
Key requirements of IFRS 9:
i. |
Replaces IAS 39s measurement categories with the following three categories: |
|
|
|
fair value through profit or loss (FVTPL) |
|
|
|
fair value through other comprehensive income (FVTOCI) |
ii. |
Eliminates the requirement for separation of embedded derivatives from hybrid financial assets, the classification requirements to be applied to the hybrid financial asset in its entirety. |
iii. |
Requires an entity to present the amount of change in fair value due to change in entitys own credit risk in other comprehensive income. |
iv. |
Introduces new impairment model, under which the expected credit loss are required to be recognized as compared to the existing incurred credit loss model of IAS 39.
|
v. |
Fundamental changes in hedge accounting by introduction of new general hedge accounting model which: |
|
|
|
Increases the eligibility of hedged item and hedging instruments; |
|
|
|
Introduces a more principlesbased approach to assess hedge effectiveness. |
IFRS 9 is effective for
annual periods beginning on or after January 1, 2018.
Earlier application is permitted provided that all the requirements in the Standard are
applied at the same time with two exceptions:
i. |
The requirement to present changes in the fair value of a liability due to changes in own credit risk may be applied early in isolation; |
ii. |
Entity may choose as its accounting policy choice to continue to apply hedge accounting requirements of IAS 39 instead of new general hedge accounting model as provided in IFRS 9. |
The Company is currently evaluating the impact of this new standard on its consolidated financial statements.
F - 23
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
4. Acquisitions
a) Fusion
On June 21, 2012, the Company acquired all
outstanding equity shares of Fusion Outsourcing Services (Proprietary) Limited (Fusion) (subsequently renamed as WNS Global Services SA (Pty) Ltd), a provider of a range of outsourcing services including contact center, customer care and
business continuity services to both South African and international clients.
The purchase price for the acquisition was £10,000 ($15,680 based on
the exchange rate on June 21, 2012) plus £399 ($644 based on the exchange rate on October 30, 2012) towards adjustment for cash and working capital.
In accordance with the terms of the sale and purchase agreement entered in connection with the acquisition of Fusion, £5,000 ($7,840 based on the
exchange rate on June 21, 2012) was paid at the completion arrangement on June 21, 2012, £399 ($644 based on the exchange rate on October 30, 2012) was paid based on completion accounts on October 30, 2012 and the remainder
£5,000 ($7,840 based on the exchange rate on June 21, 2012) was paid on May 31, 2013 along with interest of 3% per annum above the base rate of Barclays Bank Plc. amounting to £151.
The Company incurred acquisition related cost of $401 which has been included in General and administrative expenses in the consolidated
statements of income.
The purchase price has been allocated to the assets acquired and liabilities assumed as set out below:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Amount |
|
Cash |
|
$ |
1,431 |
|
Trade receivables |
|
|
3,309 |
|
Prepayments and other current assets |
|
|
185 |
|
Property and equipment |
|
|
2,315 |
|
Deferred tax assets, net |
|
|
1,722 |
|
Intangible assets |
|
|
|
|
Customer relationship |
|
|
2,148 |
|
Customer contracts |
|
|
1,427 |
|
Software |
|
|
383 |
|
Current liabilities |
|
|
(2,795 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
Net assets acquired |
|
$ |
10,125 |
|
Less: Purchase consideration |
|
|
16,324 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
Goodwill on acquisition |
|
$ |
6,199 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
b) iSoftStone
On
September 11, 2014, the Company entered into an agreement with iSoftStone Information Technology Co. Ltd. (iSoftStone), a provider of business process outsourcing and management services, pursuant to which the Company agreed to
acquire certain assets and the workforce of iSoftStone effective October 13, 2014(Acquisition Date). The purchase price of the transaction, which was paid in cash, was $328. The excess of purchase price over the assets acquired
amount to $144, which has been recognized as goodwill.
Goodwill is attributable mainly to benefit from the assembled workforce of iSoftStone.
F - 24
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
5. Cash and cash equivalents
The Company considers all highly liquid investments with an initial maturity of up to three months to be cash equivalents. Cash and cash equivalents consist of
the following:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at |
|
|
|
March 31, |
|
|
March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
Cash and bank balance |
|
$ |
24,976 |
|
|
$ |
25,546 |
|
Short term deposits with bank |
|
|
7,472 |
|
|
|
8,145 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
32,448 |
|
|
$ |
33,691 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Short term deposits can be withdrawn by the Company at any time without prior notice and are readily convertible into known
amounts of cash with an insignificant risk of changes in value.
6. Investments
Investments consist of the following:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at |
|
|
|
March 31, |
|
|
March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
Marketable securities(1) |
|
$ |
94,054 |
|
|
$ |
18,332 |
|
Investments in FMPs |
|
|
29,911 |
|
|
|
94,159 |
|
Investment in fixed deposit |
|
|
9,577 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
133,542 |
|
|
$ |
112,491 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note:
(1) Marketable
securities represent short term investments made principally for the purpose of earning dividend income.
The current and noncurrent classification
of investments are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at |
|
|
|
March 31, |
|
|
March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
Current investments |
|
$ |
133,542 |
|
|
$ |
83,817 |
|
Non- current investments |
|
|
|
|
|
|
28,674 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
133,542 |
|
|
$ |
112,491 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F - 25
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
7. Trade receivables, net
Trade receivables consist of the following:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at |
|
|
|
March 31, |
|
|
March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
Trade receivables |
|
$ |
61,104 |
|
|
$ |
66,982 |
|
Allowances for doubtful account receivables |
|
|
(5,336 |
) |
|
|
(4,999 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
55,768 |
|
|
$ |
61,983 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The movement in the allowances for doubtful trade receivables is as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Balance at the beginning of the year |
|
$ |
4,999 |
|
|
$ |
5,145 |
|
|
$ |
5,470 |
|
Charged to operations |
|
|
2,534 |
|
|
|
1,211 |
|
|
|
1,190 |
|
Write-offs |
|
|
(621 |
) |
|
|
(1,058 |
) |
|
|
(955 |
) |
Reversals |
|
|
(1,182 |
) |
|
|
(602 |
) |
|
|
(349 |
) |
Translation adjustment |
|
|
(394 |
) |
|
|
303 |
|
|
|
(211 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance at the end of the year |
|
$ |
5,336 |
|
|
$ |
4,999 |
|
|
$ |
5,145 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F - 26
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
8. Prepayments and other assets
Prepayment and other assets consist of the following:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at |
|
|
|
March 31, 2015 |
|
|
March 31, 2014 |
|
Current: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Service tax and other tax receivables |
|
$ |
5,971 |
|
|
$ |
5,710 |
|
Deferred transition cost |
|
|
132 |
|
|
|
235 |
|
Employee receivables |
|
|
1,103 |
|
|
|
1,398 |
|
Advances to suppliers |
|
|
697 |
|
|
|
609 |
|
Prepaid expenses |
|
|
5,048 |
|
|
|
4,683 |
|
Other assets |
|
|
3,807 |
|
|
|
4,290 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
16,758 |
|
|
$ |
16,925 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-current: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Deposits |
|
$ |
6,476 |
|
|
$ |
6,355 |
|
Non-current tax assets |
|
|
4,873 |
|
|
|
4,288 |
|
Service tax and other tax receivables |
|
|
4,581 |
|
|
|
3,324 |
|
Deferred transition cost |
|
|
117 |
|
|
|
173 |
|
Others |
|
|
1,566 |
|
|
|
2,513 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
17,613 |
|
|
$ |
16,653 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
9. Goodwill
The movement in goodwill balance by reportable segment as at March 31, 2015 and 2014 is as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
WNS Global BPM |
|
|
WNS Auto Claims BPM |
|
|
Total |
|
Balance as at April 1, 2013 |
|
$ |
55,886 |
|
|
$ |
31,246 |
|
|
$ |
87,132 |
|
Foreign currency translation |
|
|
(4,580 |
) |
|
|
3,102 |
|
|
|
(1,478 |
) |
Balance as at March 31, 2014 |
|
$ |
51,306 |
|
|
$ |
34,348 |
|
|
$ |
85,654 |
|
Goodwill arising from acquisition of iSoftStone assets and the workforce (See Note 4b) |
|
|
144 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
144 |
|
Foreign currency translation |
|
|
(2,931 |
) |
|
|
(3,809 |
) |
|
|
(6,740 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance as at March 31, 2015 |
|
$ |
48,519 |
|
|
$ |
30,539 |
|
|
$ |
79,058 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The carrying value of goodwill allocated to the cash generating units (CGU) is as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at |
|
|
|
March 31, |
|
|
March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
WNS Global BPM* |
|
$ |
3,927 |
|
|
$ |
3,917 |
|
South Africa |
|
|
4,252 |
|
|
|
4,882 |
|
Research & Analytics |
|
|
36,508 |
|
|
|
38,197 |
|
Technology Services |
|
|
3,832 |
|
|
|
4,310 |
|
WNS Auto Claims BPM |
|
|
30,539 |
|
|
|
34,348 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$ |
79,058 |
|
|
$ |
85,654 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
* |
Excluding Research & Analytics, South Africa and Technology Services. |
F - 27
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
Key assumptions on which the Company has based its determination of VIUs include:
a) |
Estimated cash flows for five years based on approved internal management budgets with extrapolation for the remaining period, wherever such budgets were shorter than five years period. |
b) |
Terminal value arrived by extrapolating last forecasted year cash flows to perpetuity using long-term growth rates. These long-term growth rates take into consideration external macro-economic sources of data. Such
long-term growth rate considered does not exceed that of the relevant business and industry sector. |
c) |
The discount rates used are based weighted average cost of capital of a comparable market participant, which are adjusted for specific country risks. |
The key assumptions used in performing the impairment test, by each CGU, were as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CGUs |
|
|
|
WNS Global BPM* |
|
|
South Africa |
|
|
Research & Analytics |
|
|
Technology Services |
|
|
WNS Auto Claims BPM |
|
Discount rate |
|
|
19.0 |
% |
|
|
20.0 |
% |
|
|
19.0 |
% |
|
|
13.5 |
% |
|
|
13.5 |
% |
Perpetual growth rate |
|
|
3.0 |
% |
|
|
3.0 |
% |
|
|
3.0 |
% |
|
|
3.0 |
% |
|
|
2.0 |
% |
* |
Excluding research & analytics, South Africa and Technology Services |
The assumptions used were based
on the Companys internal budget. The Company projected revenue, operating margins and cash flows for a period of five years, and applied a perpetual long-term growth rate thereafter.
In arriving at its forecasts, the Company considered past experience, economic trends and inflation as well as industry and market trends. The projections
also took into account factors such as the expected impact from new client wins and expansion from existing clients businesses and efficiency initiatives, and the maturity of the markets in which each business operates.
Based on the above, no impairment was identified as of March 31, 2015 as the recoverable amount of the CGUs exceeded the carrying value.
An analysis of the calculations sensitivity to a change in the key parameters (revenue growth, operating margin, discount rate and long-term growth
rate) did not identify any probable scenarios where the CGUs recoverable amount would fall below its carrying amount.
F - 28
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
10. Intangible assets
The changes in the carrying
value of intangible assets for the year ended March 31, 2014 are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Intellectual |
|
|
|
|
|
Covenant |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Gross carrying value |
|
Customer contracts |
|
|
Customer relationship |
|
|
property rights |
|
|
Leasehold benefits |
|
|
not-to- compete |
|
|
Software |
|
|
Total |
|
Balance as at April 1, 2013 |
|
$ |
170,858 |
|
|
$ |
65,475 |
|
|
$ |
4,675 |
|
|
$ |
1,835 |
|
|
$ |
338 |
|
|
$ |
6,143 |
|
|
$ |
249,324 |
|
Additions |
|
|
167 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5,083 |
|
|
|
5,250 |
|
Translation adjustments |
|
|
(8,469 |
) |
|
|
(76 |
) |
|
|
464 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
23 |
|
|
|
(403 |
) |
|
|
(8,461 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance as at March 31, 2014 |
|
$ |
162,556 |
|
|
$ |
65,399 |
|
|
$ |
5,139 |
|
|
$ |
1,835 |
|
|
$ |
361 |
|
|
$ |
10,823 |
|
|
$ |
246,113 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accumulated amortization |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance as at April 1, 2013 |
|
$ |
105,858 |
|
|
$ |
43,556 |
|
|
$ |
4,675 |
|
|
$ |
1,835 |
|
|
$ |
338 |
|
|
$ |
958 |
|
|
$ |
157,220 |
|
Amortization |
|
|
16,379 |
|
|
|
5,798 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,612 |
|
|
|
23,789 |
|
Translation adjustments |
|
|
(2,802 |
) |
|
|
142 |
|
|
|
464 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
23 |
|
|
|
55 |
|
|
|
(2,118 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance as at March 31, 2014 |
|
$ |
119,435 |
|
|
$ |
49,496 |
|
|
$ |
5,139 |
|
|
$ |
1,835 |
|
|
$ |
361 |
|
|
$ |
2,625 |
|
|
$ |
178,891 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net carrying value as at March 31, 2014 |
|
$ |
43,121 |
|
|
$ |
15,903 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
8,198 |
|
|
$ |
67,222 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F - 29
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
The changes in the carrying value of intangible assets for the year ended March 31, 2015 are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Intellectual |
|
|
|
|
|
Covenant |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Gross carrying value |
|
Customer contracts |
|
|
Customer relationship |
|
|
property rights |
|
|
Leasehold benefits |
|
|
not-to- compete |
|
|
Software |
|
|
Total |
|
Balance as at April 1, 2014 |
|
$ |
162,556 |
|
|
$ |
65,399 |
|
|
$ |
5,139 |
|
|
$ |
1,835 |
|
|
$ |
361 |
|
|
$ |
10,823 |
|
|
$ |
246,113 |
|
Additions |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,207 |
|
|
|
2,207 |
|
Translation adjustments |
|
|
(3,803 |
) |
|
|
(1,471 |
) |
|
|
(570 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
(29 |
) |
|
|
(619 |
) |
|
|
(6,492 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance as at March 31, 2015 |
|
$ |
158,753 |
|
|
$ |
63,928 |
|
|
$ |
4,569 |
|
|
$ |
1,835 |
|
|
$ |
332 |
|
|
$ |
12,411 |
|
|
$ |
241,828 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accumulated amortization |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance as at April 1, 2014 |
|
$ |
119,435 |
|
|
$ |
49,496 |
|
|
$ |
5,139 |
|
|
$ |
1,835 |
|
|
$ |
361 |
|
|
$ |
2,625 |
|
|
$ |
178,891 |
|
Amortization |
|
|
16,153 |
|
|
|
5,720 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,319 |
|
|
|
24,192 |
|
Translation adjustments |
|
|
(2,397 |
) |
|
|
(1,307 |
) |
|
|
(570 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
(29 |
) |
|
|
(226 |
) |
|
|
(4,529 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance as at March 31, 2015 |
|
$ |
133,191 |
|
|
$ |
53,909 |
|
|
$ |
4,569 |
|
|
$ |
1,835 |
|
|
$ |
332 |
|
|
$ |
4,718 |
|
|
$ |
198,554 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net carrying value as at March 31, 2015 |
|
$ |
25,562 |
|
|
$ |
10,019 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
7,693 |
|
|
$ |
43,274 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at March 31, 2015, the estimated remaining weighted average amortization periods for intangible assets are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance Life |
|
|
|
(In months) |
|
Customer contracts |
|
|
20 |
|
Customer relationship |
|
|
27 |
|
Software |
|
|
35 |
|
The estimated annual amortization expense based on remaining weighted average amortization periods for intangible assets and
exchange rates, each as at March 31, 2015 are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Amount |
|
2016 |
|
$ |
24,037 |
|
2017 |
|
|
15,654 |
|
2018 |
|
|
1,835 |
|
2019 |
|
|
1,050 |
|
2020 |
|
|
698 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$ |
43,274 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
F - 30
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
11. Property and equipment
The changes in the
carrying value of property and equipment for the year ended March 31, 2014 are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Gross carrying value |
|
Buildings |
|
|
Computers and software |
|
|
Furniture, fixtures and office equipment |
|
|
Vehicles |
|
|
Leasehold improvements |
|
|
Total |
|
Balance as at April 1, 2013 |
|
$ |
11,132 |
|
|
$ |
65169 |
|
|
$ |
56351 |
|
|
$ |
1099 |
|
|
$ |
47,885 |
|
|
$ |
181,636 |
|
Additions |
|
|
|
|
|
|
5,552 |
|
|
|
4,819 |
|
|
|
6 |
|
|
|
3,708 |
|
|
|
14,085 |
|
Disposal/Retirements/Adjustments |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(124 |
) |
|
|
(513 |
) |
|
|
(394 |
) |
|
|
(1,031 |
) |
Translation adjustments |
|
|
(509 |
) |
|
|
(2,609 |
) |
|
|
(4,367 |
) |
|
|
(104 |
) |
|
|
(4,025 |
) |
|
|
(11,614 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance as at March 31, 2014 |
|
$ |
10,623 |
|
|
$ |
68,112 |
|
|
$ |
56,679 |
|
|
$ |
488 |
|
|
$ |
47,174 |
|
|
$ |
183,076 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accumulated depreciation |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance as at April 1, 2013 |
|
$ |
2,344 |
|
|
$ |
58,222 |
|
|
$ |
44,148 |
|
|
$ |
972 |
|
|
$ |
33,623 |
|
|
$ |
139,309 |
|
Depreciation |
|
|
530 |
|
|
|
4,358 |
|
|
|
4,796 |
|
|
|
75 |
|
|
|
4,201 |
|
|
|
13,960 |
|
Disposal/Retirements/Adjustments |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(117 |
) |
|
|
(498 |
) |
|
|
(395 |
) |
|
|
(1,010 |
) |
Translation adjustments |
|
|
(105 |
) |
|
|
(2,230 |
) |
|
|
(3,400 |
) |
|
|
(92 |
) |
|
|
(2,947 |
) |
|
|
(8,774 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance as at March 31, 2014 |
|
$ |
2,769 |
|
|
$ |
60,350 |
|
|
$ |
45,427 |
|
|
$ |
457 |
|
|
$ |
34,482 |
|
|
$ |
143,485 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Capital work-in-progress |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5,574 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net carrying value as at March 31, 2014 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$ |
45,165 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The changes in the carrying value of property and equipment for the year ended March 31, 2015 are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Gross carrying value |
|
Buildings |
|
|
Computers And software |
|
|
Furniture, fixtures and office equipment |
|
|
Vehicles |
|
|
Leasehold improvements |
|
|
Total |
|
Balance as at April 1, 2014 |
|
$ |
10,623 |
|
|
$ |
68,112 |
|
|
$ |
56,679 |
|
|
$ |
488 |
|
|
$ |
47,174 |
|
|
$ |
183,076 |
|
Additions |
|
|
|
|
|
|
7,033 |
|
|
|
7,367 |
|
|
|
209 |
|
|
|
7,782 |
|
|
|
22,391 |
|
On acquisition of iSoftStone assets and the workforce (See Note 4b) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
98 |
|
|
|
51 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
149 |
|
Disposal/Retirements/Adjustments |
|
|
|
|
|
|
(3,292 |
) |
|
|
(2,596 |
) |
|
|
(221 |
) |
|
|
(3,160 |
) |
|
|
(9,269 |
) |
Translation adjustments |
|
|
(218 |
) |
|
|
(4,436 |
) |
|
|
(2,860 |
) |
|
|
(21 |
) |
|
|
(2,438 |
) |
|
|
(9,973 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance as at March 31, 2015 |
|
$ |
10,405 |
|
|
$ |
67,515 |
|
|
$ |
58,641 |
|
|
$ |
455 |
|
|
$ |
49,358 |
|
|
$ |
186,374 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accumulated depreciation |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance as at April 1, 2014 |
|
$ |
2,769 |
|
|
$ |
60,350 |
|
|
$ |
45,427 |
|
|
$ |
457 |
|
|
$ |
34,482 |
|
|
$ |
143,485 |
|
Depreciation |
|
|
526 |
|
|
|
4,403 |
|
|
|
4,771 |
|
|
|
71 |
|
|
|
4,616 |
|
|
|
14,387 |
|
Disposal/Retirements/Adjustments |
|
|
|
|
|
|
(2,901 |
) |
|
|
(2,524 |
) |
|
|
(221 |
) |
|
|
(3,152 |
) |
|
|
(8,798 |
) |
Translation adjustments |
|
|
(63 |
) |
|
|
(3,784 |
) |
|
|
(2,277 |
) |
|
|
(18 |
) |
|
|
(1,630 |
) |
|
|
(7,772 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance as at March 31, 2015 |
|
$ |
3,232 |
|
|
$ |
58,068 |
|
|
$ |
45,397 |
|
|
$ |
289 |
|
|
$ |
34,316 |
|
|
$ |
141,302 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Capital work-in-progress |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3,158 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net carrying value as at March 31, 2015 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$ |
48,230 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Certain property and equipment are pledged as collateral against borrowings with a carrying amount of $12,392 and $12,627 as
at March 31, 2015 and 2014.
F - 31
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
12. Loans and borrowings
Short-term line of credit
The Companys Indian
subsidiary, WNS Global Services Private Limited (WNS Global), has secured and unsecured lines of credit with banks amounting to $61,449. Of these available lines of credit, as at March 31, 2015, $11,823 (March 31, 2014 $52,925) was
utilized for working capital requirements.
The Company has also established a line of credit in the UK amounting to £9,880 ($14,602 based on the
exchange rate on March 31, 2015), of which £716 ($1,058 based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2015; $5,658 based on the exchange rate on March 31, 2014) was utilized for working capital requirements as at March 31, 2015.
Further the Company has also established a line of credit in South Africa amounting to ZAR 30,000 ($2,468 based on the exchange rate on March 31,
2015). There was no outstanding balance as at March 31, 2015.
Long-term debt
The long-term loans and borrowings consist of the following:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at |
|
|
|
March 31, 2015 |
|
|
March 31, 2014 |
|
Interest rate |
|
Foreign currency |
|
|
Total |
|
|
Foreign currency |
|
|
Total |
|
3M USD LIBOR + 3.1% |
|
$ |
|
|
|
|
6,990 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
|
6,944 |
|
Bank of England base rate + 2.25% |
|
£ |
3,952 |
|
|
|
5,838 |
|
|
£ |
7,904 |
|
|
|
13,113 |
|
Bank of England base rate + 2.25% |
|
£ |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
£ |
3,672 |
|
|
|
6,089 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$ |
12,828 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
$ |
26,146 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Current portion of long term debt |
|
|
|
|
|
$ |
12,828 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
$ |
12,637 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Long term debt |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$ |
13,509 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The Company has pledged trade receivables, other financial assets, property and equipment with a carrying amount of $149,670
and $145,523 as of March 31, 2015 and March 31, 2014, respectively, as collateral for the above mentioned borrowings. In addition, the facility agreements for the above mentioned borrowings contain certain restrictive covenants on the
indebtedness of the Company, total borrowings to tangible net worth ratio, total borrowings to EBITDA ratio and a minimum interest coverage ratio. As of March 31, 2015 the Company was in compliance with all of the covenants.
F - 32
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
13. Financial instruments
Financial instruments by category
The carrying value and
fair value of financial instruments by class as at March 31, 2015 are as follows:
Financial assets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Loans and receivables |
|
|
Financial assets at FVTPL |
|
|
Derivative designated as cash flow hedges (carried at fair value) |
|
|
Available for sale |
|
|
Total carrying value |
|
|
Total fair value |
|
Cash and cash equivalents |
|
$ |
32,448 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
32,448 |
|
|
$ |
32,448 |
|
Bank deposits and marketable securities |
|
|
9,577 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
94,054 |
|
|
|
103,631 |
|
|
|
103,631 |
|
Trade receivables |
|
|
55,768 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
55,768 |
|
|
|
55,768 |
|
Unbilled revenue |
|
|
39,675 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
39,675 |
|
|
|
39,675 |
|
Funds held for clients |
|
|
12,737 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
12,737 |
|
|
|
12,737 |
|
Prepayments and other assets (1) |
|
|
3,161 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3,161 |
|
|
|
3,161 |
|
Investment in FMP |
|
|
|
|
|
|
29,911 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
29,911 |
|
|
|
29,911 |
|
Other non-current assets (2) |
|
|
6,476 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
6,476 |
|
|
|
6,476 |
|
Derivative assets |
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,274 |
|
|
|
27,593 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
29,867 |
|
|
|
29,867 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total carrying value |
|
$ |
159,842 |
|
|
$ |
32,185 |
|
|
$ |
27,593 |
|
|
$ |
94,054 |
|
|
$ |
313,674 |
|
|
$ |
313,674 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Financial liabilities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Financial liabilities at FVTPL |
|
|
Derivative designated as cash flow hedges (carried at fair value) |
|
|
Financial liabilities at amortized cost |
|
|
Total carrying value |
|
|
Total fair value |
|
Trade payables |
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
22,706 |
|
|
$ |
22,706 |
|
|
$ |
22,706 |
|
Current portion of long term debt |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
12,828 |
|
|
|
12,828 |
|
|
|
12,828 |
|
Short term line of credit |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
12,881 |
|
|
|
12,881 |
|
|
|
12,881 |
|
Other employee obligations (3) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
36,290 |
|
|
|
36,290 |
|
|
|
36,290 |
|
Provision and accrued expenses (4) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
24,869 |
|
|
|
24,869 |
|
|
|
24,869 |
|
Other liabilities (5) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
304 |
|
|
|
304 |
|
|
|
304 |
|
Derivative liabilities |
|
|
791 |
|
|
|
1,383 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,174 |
|
|
|
2,174 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total carrying value |
|
$ |
791 |
|
|
$ |
1,383 |
|
|
$ |
109,878 |
|
|
$ |
112,052 |
|
|
$ |
112,052 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Notes:
(1) |
Excluding non-financial assets $13,597. |
(2) |
Excluding non-financial assets $11,137. |
(3) |
Excluding non-financial liabilities $10,203. |
(4) |
Excluding non-financial liabilities $753. |
(5) |
Excluding non-financial liabilities $9,644. |
F - 33
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
The carrying value and fair value of financial instruments by class as at March 31, 2014 are as follows:
Financial assets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Loans and Receivables |
|
|
Financial assets at FVTPL |
|
|
Derivative designated as cash flow hedges (carried at fair value) |
|
|
Available for sale |
|
|
Total carrying value |
|
|
Total fair value |
|
Cash and cash equivalents |
|
$ |
33,691 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
33,691 |
|
|
$ |
33,691 |
|
Bank deposits and marketable securities |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
18,332 |
|
|
|
18,332 |
|
|
|
18,332 |
|
Trade receivables |
|
|
61,983 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
61,983 |
|
|
|
61,983 |
|
Unbilled revenue |
|
|
34,716 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
34,716 |
|
|
|
34,716 |
|
Funds held for clients |
|
|
15,936 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
15,936 |
|
|
|
15,936 |
|
Prepayments and other assets (1) |
|
|
3,716 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3,716 |
|
|
|
3,716 |
|
Investment in FMP |
|
|
|
|
|
|
94,159 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
94,159 |
|
|
|
94,159 |
|
Other non-current assets (2) |
|
|
6,355 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
6,355 |
|
|
|
6,355 |
|
Derivative assets |
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,118 |
|
|
|
9,805 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
10,923 |
|
|
|
10,923 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total carrying value |
|
$ |
156,397 |
|
|
$ |
95,277 |
|
|
$ |
9,805 |
|
|
$ |
18,332 |
|
|
$ |
279,811 |
|
|
$ |
279,811 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Financial liabilities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Financial liabilities at FVTPL |
|
|
Derivative designated as cash flow hedges (carried at fair value) |
|
|
Financial liabilities at amortized cost |
|
|
Total carrying value |
|
|
Total fair value |
|
Trade payables |
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
29,059 |
|
|
$ |
29,059 |
|
|
$ |
29,059 |
|
Current portion of long term debt |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
12,637 |
|
|
|
12,637 |
|
|
|
12,637 |
|
Long term debt |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
13,509 |
|
|
|
13,509 |
|
|
|
13,509 |
|
Short term line of credit |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
58,583 |
|
|
|
58,583 |
|
|
|
58,583 |
|
Pension and other employee obligations (3) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
32,369 |
|
|
|
32,369 |
|
|
|
32,369 |
|
Provision and accrued expenses (4) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
23,204 |
|
|
|
23,204 |
|
|
|
23,204 |
|
Other liabilities (5) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,660 |
|
|
|
1,660 |
|
|
|
1,660 |
|
Derivative liabilities |
|
|
674 |
|
|
|
9,801 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
10,475 |
|
|
|
10,475 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total carrying value |
|
$ |
674 |
|
|
$ |
9,801 |
|
|
$ |
171,021 |
|
|
$ |
181,496 |
|
|
$ |
181,496 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Notes:
(1) |
Excluding non-financial assets $13,209. |
(2) |
Excluding non-financial assets $10,298. |
(3) |
Excluding non-financial liabilities $9,102. |
(4) |
Excluding non-financial liabilities $693. |
(5) |
Excluding non-financial liabilities $8,899. |
F - 34
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
Financial assets and liabilities subject to offsetting, enforceable master netting arrangements or similar
agreements as at March 31, 2015 are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Description
of types of
financial assets |
|
Gross amounts of recognized financial assets |
|
|
Gross amounts of recognized financial liabilities offset in the statement
of financial position |
|
|
Net amounts of financial assets presented in the statement of financial position |
|
|
Related amount not set off in financial instruments |
|
|
Net amount |
|
|
|
|
|
Financial instruments |
|
|
Cash collateral received |
|
|
Derivative assets |
|
$ |
29,867 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
29,867 |
|
|
$ |
(1,670 |
) |
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
28,197 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
29,867 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
29,867 |
|
|
$ |
(1,670 |
) |
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
28,197 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Description
of types of
financial liabilities |
|
Gross amounts of recognized financial liabilities |
|
|
Gross amounts of recognized financial assets offset in the statement of financial position |
|
|
Net amounts of financial liabilities presented in the statement of financial position |
|
|
Related amount not set off in financial instruments |
|
|
Net amount |
|
|
|
|
|
Financial instruments |
|
|
Cash collateral pledged |
|
|
Derivative liabilities |
|
$ |
2,174 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
2,174 |
|
|
$ |
(1,670 |
) |
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
504 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
2,174 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
2,174 |
|
|
$ |
(1,670 |
) |
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
504 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F - 35
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
Financial assets and liabilities subject to offsetting, enforceable master netting arrangements or similar
agreements as at March 31, 2014 are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Description
of types of
financial assets |
|
Gross amounts of recognized financial assets |
|
|
Gross amounts of recognized financial liabilities offset in the statement
of financial position |
|
|
Net amounts of financial assets presented in the statement of financial position |
|
|
Related amount not set off in financial instruments |
|
|
Net amount |
|
|
|
|
|
Financial instruments |
|
|
Cash collateral received |
|
|
Derivative assets |
|
$ |
10,923 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
10,923 |
|
|
$ |
(3,758 |
) |
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
7,165 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
10,923 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
10,923 |
|
|
$ |
(3,758 |
) |
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
7,165 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Description
of types of
financial liabilities |
|
Gross amounts of recognized financial liabilities |
|
|
Gross amounts of recognized financial assets offset in the statement of financial position |
|
|
Net amounts of financial liabilities presented in the statement of financial position |
|
|
Related amount not set off in financial instruments |
|
|
Net amount |
|
|
|
|
|
Financial instruments |
|
|
Cash collateral pledged |
|
|
Derivative liabilities |
|
$ |
10,475 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
10,475 |
|
|
$ |
(3,758 |
) |
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
6,717 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
10,475 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
10,475 |
|
|
$ |
(3,758 |
) |
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
6,717 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Fair value hierarchy
The
following is the hierarchy for determining and disclosing the fair value of financial instruments by valuation technique:
Level 1 quoted prices
(unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets or liabilities.
Level 2 other techniques for which all inputs have a significant effect on the
recorded fair value are observable, either directly or indirectly.
Level 3 techniques which use inputs that have a significant effect on the
recorded fair value that are not based on observable market data.
F - 36
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
The assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis as at March 31, 2015 are as
follows:-
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Description |
|
March 31, 2015 |
|
|
Fair value measurement at reporting date using |
|
|
|
Quoted prices in active markets for identical assets (Level 1) |
|
|
Significant other observable inputs (Level 2) |
|
|
Significant unobservable inputs (Level 3) |
|
Assets |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Financial assets at FVTPL |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Foreign exchange contracts |
|
$ |
2,274 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
2,274 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
Investment in FMPs |
|
|
29,911 |
|
|
|
29,911 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Financial assets at fair value through other comprehensive income |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Foreign exchange contracts |
|
|
27,593 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
27,593 |
|
|
|
|
|
Investments available for sale |
|
|
94,054 |
|
|
|
94,054 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total assets |
|
$ |
153,832 |
|
|
$ |
123,965 |
|
|
$ |
29,867 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Liabilities |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Financial liabilities at FVTPL |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Foreign exchange contracts |
|
$ |
791 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
791 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
Financial liabilities at fair value through other comprehensive income |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Foreign exchange contracts |
|
|
1,383 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,383 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total liabilities |
|
$ |
2,174 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
2,174 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F - 37
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
The assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis as at March 31, 2014 are as
follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Description |
|
March 31, 2014 |
|
|
Fair value measurement at reporting date using |
|
|
|
Quoted prices in active markets for identical assets (Level 1) |
|
|
Significant other observable inputs (Level 2) |
|
|
Significant unobservable inputs (Level 3) |
|
Assets |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Financial assets at FVTPL |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Foreign exchange contracts |
|
$ |
1,118 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
1,118 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
Investment in FMPs |
|
|
94,159 |
|
|
|
94,159 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Financial assets at fair value through other comprehensive income |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Foreign exchange contracts |
|
|
9,805 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
9,805 |
|
|
|
|
|
Investments available for sale |
|
|
18,332 |
|
|
|
18,332 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total assets |
|
$ |
123,414 |
|
|
$ |
112,491 |
|
|
$ |
10,923 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Liabilities |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Financial liabilities at FVTPL |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Foreign exchange contracts |
|
$ |
674 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
674 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
Financial liabilities at fair value through other comprehensive income |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Foreign exchange contracts |
|
|
9,801 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
9,801 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total liabilities |
|
$ |
10,475 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
10,475 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The fair value is estimated using discounted cash flow approach which involves assumptions and judgments regarding risk
characteristics of the instruments, discount rates, future cash flows, foreign exchange spot and forward premium rates. During the year ended March 31, 2015 and 2014, there were no transfers between Level 1 and Level 2 fair value measurements,
and no transfers into and out of Level 3 fair value measurements.
F - 38
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
Derivative financial instruments
The primary risks managed by using derivative instruments are foreign currency exchange risk and interest rate risk. Forward and option contracts up to 24
months on various foreign currencies are entered into to manage the foreign currency exchange rate risk on forecasted revenue denominated in foreign currencies and monetary assets and liabilities held in non-functional currencies. The Companys
primary exchange rate exposure is with the US dollars, pound sterling and the Indian rupee. For derivative instruments which qualify for cash flow hedge accounting, the Company records the effective portion of gain or loss from changes in the fair
value of the derivative instruments in other comprehensive income (loss), which is reclassified into earnings in the same period during which the hedged item affects earnings. Derivative instruments qualify for hedge accounting when the instrument
is designated as a hedge; the hedged item is specifically identifiable and exposes the Company to risk; and it is expected that a change in fair value of the derivative instrument and an opposite change in the fair value of the hedged item will have
a high degree of correlation. Determining the high degree of correlation between the change in fair value of the hedged item and the derivative instruments involves significant judgment including the probability of the occurrence of the forecasted
transaction. When it is probable that a forecasted transaction will not occur, the Company discontinues the hedge accounting and recognizes immediately in the consolidated statement of income, the gains and losses attributable to such derivative
instrument that were accumulated in other comprehensive income (loss).
The following table presents the notional values of outstanding foreign exchange
forward contracts and foreign exchange option contracts:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at |
|
|
|
March 31, 2015 |
|
|
March 31, 2014 |
|
Forward contracts (Sell) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In US dollars |
|
$ |
168,315 |
|
|
$ |
139,980 |
|
In United Kingdom Pound Sterling |
|
|
141,693 |
|
|
|
140,357 |
|
In Euro |
|
|
9,745 |
|
|
|
10,241 |
|
In Australian dollars |
|
|
25,065 |
|
|
|
21,102 |
|
Others |
|
|
13,887 |
|
|
|
19,421 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$ |
358,705 |
|
|
$ |
331,101 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Option contracts (Sell) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In US dollars |
|
$ |
79,898 |
|
|
$ |
75,843 |
|
In United Kingdom Pound Sterling |
|
|
106,767 |
|
|
|
126,280 |
|
In Euro |
|
|
7,697 |
|
|
|
8,995 |
|
In Australian dollars |
|
|
19,462 |
|
|
|
19,408 |
|
Others |
|
|
3,342 |
|
|
|
4,279 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$ |
217,166 |
|
|
$ |
234,805 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The amount of gain/(loss) reclassified from other comprehensive income into consolidated statement of income in
respective line items for the years ended March 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013 are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Revenue |
|
$ |
4,347 |
|
|
$ |
4,938 |
|
|
$ |
1,763 |
|
Foreign exchange gain/(loss), net |
|
|
3,399 |
|
|
|
7,997 |
|
|
|
6,968 |
|
Finance expense |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(39 |
) |
Income tax related to amounts reclassified into statement of income |
|
|
(2,764 |
) |
|
|
(4,418 |
) |
|
|
(3,566 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
4,982 |
|
|
$ |
8,517 |
|
|
$ |
5,126 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F - 39
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
As at March 31, 2015, the gain amounting to $15,445 on account of cash flow hedges is expected to be
reclassified from other comprehensive income into statement of income over a period of 24 months.
Due to the discontinuation of cash flow hedge
accounting on account of non-occurrence of original forecasted transactions by the end of the originally specified time period, the Company recognized in the consolidated statement of income for the years ended March 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013
gains of $13, $125 and $1,105, respectively.
Financial risk management
Financial risk factors
The Companys activities
expose it to a variety of financial risks: market risk, interest risk, credit risk and liquidity risk. The Companys primary focus is to foresee the unpredictability of financial markets and seek to minimize potential adverse effects on its
financial performance. The primary market risk to the Company is foreign exchange risk. The Company uses derivative financial instruments to mitigate foreign exchange related risk exposures. The Companys exposure to credit risk is influenced
mainly by the individual characteristic of each customer and the concentration of risk from the top few customers. The demographics of the customer including the default risk of the industry and country in which the customer operates also has an
influence on credit risk assessment. The Company does not enter into or trade financial instruments, including derivative financial instruments, for speculative purposes.
Risk management procedures
The Company manages market
risk through treasury operations. Senior management and Board of Directors approve the Companys treasury operations objectives and policies. The activities of treasury operations include management of cash resources, implementation of
hedging strategies for foreign currency exposures, implementation of borrowing strategies and monitoring compliance with market risk limits and policies. The Companys foreign exchange committee, comprising the Chairman of the Board, Group
Chief Executive Officer and Group Chief Financial Officer, is the approving authority for all hedging transactions.
Components of market risk
Exchange rate or currency risk:
The Companys
exposure to market risk arises principally from exchange rate risk. Although substantially all of revenue is denominated in pound sterling and US dollars, a significant portion of expenses for the year ended March 31, 2015 (net of payments to
repair centers made as part of the Companys WNS Auto Claims BPM segment) were incurred and paid in Indian rupees. The exchange rates among the Indian rupee, the pound sterling and the US dollar have changed substantially in recent years and
may fluctuate substantially in the future. The Company hedges a portion of forecasted external and inter-company revenue denominated in foreign currencies with forward contracts and options.
Based upon the Companys level of operations for the year ended March 31, 2015, a sensitivity analysis shows that a 10% appreciation or depreciation
in the pound sterling against the US dollar would have increased or decreased, respectively, the Companys revenue for the year ended March 31, 2015 by approximately $27,342. Similarly, a 10% appreciation or depreciation in the Indian
rupee against the US dollar would have increased or decreased, respectively, the Companys expenses incurred and paid in Indian rupee for the year ended March 31, 2015 by approximately $24,681.
F - 40
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
The foreign currency risk from non-derivative financial instruments as at March 31, 2015 is as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at March 31, 2015 |
|
|
|
US Dollar |
|
|
Pound Sterling |
|
|
Indian Rupees |
|
|
Australian Dollar |
|
|
Euro |
|
|
Other Currencies |
|
|
Total |
|
Cash and cash equivalents |
|
$ |
171 |
|
|
$ |
236 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
1,858 |
|
|
$ |
264 |
|
|
$ |
137 |
|
|
$ |
2,666 |
|
Trade receivables |
|
|
81,456 |
|
|
|
63,670 |
|
|
|
5,916 |
|
|
|
7,615 |
|
|
|
2,311 |
|
|
|
2,797 |
|
|
|
163,765 |
|
Unbilled revenue |
|
|
3,782 |
|
|
|
602 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,156 |
|
|
|
1,705 |
|
|
|
142 |
|
|
|
8,387 |
|
Prepayments and other current assets |
|
|
495 |
|
|
|
190 |
|
|
|
240 |
|
|
|
15 |
|
|
|
52 |
|
|
|
28 |
|
|
|
1,020 |
|
Other non-current assets |
|
|
23 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
16 |
|
|
|
39 |
|
Trade payables |
|
|
(52,309 |
) |
|
|
(46,402 |
) |
|
|
(13,679 |
) |
|
|
(4,998 |
) |
|
|
(1,106 |
) |
|
|
(816 |
) |
|
|
(119,310 |
) |
Provisions and accrued expenses |
|
|
(2,032 |
) |
|
|
(371 |
) |
|
|
(15 |
) |
|
|
(7 |
) |
|
|
(233 |
) |
|
|
(76 |
) |
|
|
(2,734 |
) |
Current portion of long term debt |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Pension and other employee obligations |
|
|
|
|
|
|
(12 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(42 |
) |
|
|
(224 |
) |
|
|
(278 |
) |
Short term line of credit |
|
|
|
|
|
|
(11,823 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(11,823 |
) |
Long term debt |
|
|
(7,000 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(7,000 |
) |
Other liabilities |
|
|
(36 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(2 |
) |
|
|
(38 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net assets (liabilities) |
|
$ |
24,550 |
|
|
$ |
6,090 |
|
|
$ |
(7,538 |
) |
|
$ |
6,639 |
|
|
$ |
2,951 |
|
|
$ |
2,002 |
|
|
$ |
34,694 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F - 41
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
The foreign currency risk from non-derivative financial instruments as at March 31, 2014 is as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at March 31, 2014 |
|
|
|
US Dollar |
|
|
Pound Sterling |
|
|
Indian Rupees |
|
|
Australian Dollar |
|
|
Euro |
|
|
Other Currencies |
|
|
Total |
|
Cash and cash equivalents |
|
$ |
3,706 |
|
|
$ |
382 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
57 |
|
|
$ |
317 |
|
|
$ |
4,462 |
|
Trade receivables |
|
|
89,182 |
|
|
|
50,721 |
|
|
|
6,179 |
|
|
|
10,799 |
|
|
|
4,805 |
|
|
|
2,682 |
|
|
|
164,368 |
|
Unbilled revenue |
|
|
3,745 |
|
|
|
280 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,267 |
|
|
|
677 |
|
|
|
238 |
|
|
|
7,207 |
|
Prepayments and other current assets |
|
|
710 |
|
|
|
1,379 |
|
|
|
244 |
|
|
|
10 |
|
|
|
271 |
|
|
|
34 |
|
|
|
2,648 |
|
Other non-current assets |
|
|
3 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
17 |
|
|
|
20 |
|
Trade payables |
|
|
(39,130 |
) |
|
|
(20,497 |
) |
|
|
(11,380 |
) |
|
|
(10,010 |
) |
|
|
(1,239 |
) |
|
|
(158 |
) |
|
|
(82,414 |
) |
Provisions and accrued expenses |
|
|
(2,546 |
) |
|
|
(31 |
) |
|
|
(217 |
) |
|
|
(8 |
) |
|
|
(317 |
) |
|
|
(32 |
) |
|
|
(3,151 |
) |
Current portion of long term debt |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Pension and other employee obligations |
|
|
|
|
|
|
(15 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(54 |
) |
|
|
(301 |
) |
|
|
(370 |
) |
Short term line of credit |
|
|
(25,000 |
) |
|
|
(27,925 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(52,925 |
) |
Long term debt |
|
|
(7,000 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(7,000 |
) |
Other liabilities |
|
|
(44 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(2 |
) |
|
|
(46 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net assets (liabilities) |
|
$ |
23,626 |
|
|
$ |
4,294 |
|
|
$ |
(5,174 |
) |
|
$ |
3,058 |
|
|
$ |
4,200 |
|
|
$ |
2,795 |
|
|
$ |
32,799 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other currencies reflect currencies such as Philippines Peso (PHP), Canadian dollar (CAD), Polish zloty (PLN), Sri Lankan
Rupee (LKR), Romanian Leu (RON) and South African Rand (ZAR) etc.
As at March 31, 2015, every 5% appreciation or depreciation of the respective
foreign currencies compared to the functional currency of the Company would impact the Companys profit before tax from operating activities by approximately $695.
Interest rate risk:
The Companys exposure to
interest rate risk arises principally from borrowings which have a floating rate of interest, a portion of which is linked to the US dollar LIBOR and the remainder is linked to the BOE rate. The risk is managed by the Company by maintaining an
appropriate mix between fixed and floating rate borrowings and by the use of interest rate swap contracts. The costs of floating rate borrowings may be affected by the fluctuations in the interest rates. If interest rates were to increase by 100
bps, additional annual interest expense on the Companys floating rate borrowing would amount to approximately $218.
The Company intends to
selectively use interest rate swaps, options and other derivative instruments to manage exposure to interest rate movements. These exposures are reviewed by appropriate levels of management on a periodic basis. The Company does not enter into
hedging agreements for speculative purposes.
Credit risk:
Credit risk arises from the possibility that customers may not be able to settle their obligations as agreed. Trade receivables are typically unsecured and are
derived from revenue earned from customers primarily located in the United Kingdom and the United States. Credit risk is managed through periodical assessment of the financial reliability of customers, taking into account the financial condition,
current economic trends, analysis of historical bad debts and ageing of accounts receivable. The credit risk on marketable securities, FMPs, bank deposits and derivative financial instruments is limited because the counterparties are banks and
mutual funds with high credit-ratings assigned by international credit-rating agencies.
F - 42
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
The following table gives details in respect of the percentage of revenue generated from the Companys
top customer and top five customers:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year Ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Revenue from top customer |
|
|
13.4 |
% |
|
|
15.2 |
% |
|
|
16.9 |
% |
Revenue from top five customers |
|
|
33.0 |
% |
|
|
36.9 |
% |
|
|
37.1 |
% |
Financial assets that are neither past due nor impaired
Cash equivalents, bank deposits, marketable securities, investment in FMPs, unbilled revenue and other assets, are neither past due and nor impaired except
trade receivables as described below.
Financial assets that are past due but not impaired
There is no other class of financial assets that is past due but not impaired except for trade receivables. The Companys credit period generally ranges
from 30-60 days. The age-wise break up of trade receivables, net of allowances that are past due beyond credit period, are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at |
|
|
|
March 31, 2015 |
|
|
March 31, 2014 |
|
Neither past due nor impaired |
|
$ |
40,544 |
|
|
$ |
48,421 |
|
Past due but not impaired |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Past due 0-30 days |
|
|
10,811 |
|
|
|
7,322 |
|
Past due 31-60 days |
|
|
1,091 |
|
|
|
1,625 |
|
Past due 61-90 days |
|
|
496 |
|
|
|
1,077 |
|
Past due over 90 days |
|
|
2,826 |
|
|
|
3,538 |
|
Past due and impaired |
|
|
5,336 |
|
|
|
4,999 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
61,104 |
|
|
$ |
66,982 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Allowances for doubtful account receivables |
|
$ |
(5,336 |
) |
|
$ |
(4,999 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Trade receivables net of allowances for doubtful account receivables |
|
$ |
55,768 |
|
|
$ |
61,983 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Liquidity risk:
Liquidity risk is the risk that the Company will encounter difficulty in meeting the obligations associated with its financial liabilities that are settled by
delivering cash or another financial asset. The Companys approach to managing liquidity is to ensure, as far as possible, that it will always have sufficient liquidity to meet its liabilities when due, under normal and stressed conditions,
without incurring unacceptable losses or risking damage to the reputation. Typically the Company ensures that it has sufficient cash on demand to meet expected operational expenses and service financial obligations. In addition, the Company has
concluded arrangements with well reputed banks and has unused lines of credit of $65, 638 as of March 31, 2015 that could be drawn upon should there be a need.
F - 43
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
The contractual maturities of financial liabilities are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at March 31, 2015 |
|
|
|
Less than 1 Year |
|
|
1-2 years |
|
|
2-4 years |
|
|
Total |
|
Long term debt(1) |
|
$ |
12,841 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
12,841 |
|
Trade Payables |
|
|
22,706 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
22,706 |
|
Short term line of credit |
|
|
12,881 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
12,881 |
|
Provision and accrued expenses |
|
|
24,869 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
24,869 |
|
Other liabilities |
|
|
304 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
304 |
|
Other employee obligations |
|
|
36,290 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
36,290 |
|
Derivative financial instruments |
|
|
1,784 |
|
|
|
390 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,174 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
111,675 |
|
|
$ |
390 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
112,065 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Notes:
(1) |
Before netting off debt issuance cost of $13. |
(2) |
Non-financial liabilities are explained in financial instruments categories table above. |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at March 31, 2014 |
|
|
|
Less than 1 Year |
|
|
1-2 years |
|
|
2-4 years |
|
|
Total |
|
Long term debt(1) |
|
$ |
12,672 |
|
|
$ |
13,569 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
26,241 |
|
Trade Payables |
|
|
29,059 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
29,059 |
|
Short term line of credit |
|
|
58,583 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
58,583 |
|
Provision and accrued expenses |
|
|
23,204 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
23,204 |
|
Other liabilities |
|
|
1,660 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,660 |
|
Other employee obligations |
|
|
32,369 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
32,369 |
|
Derivative financial instruments |
|
|
9,076 |
|
|
|
1,399 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
10,475 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
166,623 |
|
|
$ |
14,968 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
181,591 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Notes:
(1) |
Before netting off debt issuance cost of $95. |
(2) |
Non-financial liabilities are explained in financial instruments categories table above. |
The balanced view of
liquidity and financial indebtedness is stated in the table below. This calculation of the net cash position is used by the management:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at |
|
|
|
March 31, 2015 |
|
|
March 31, 2014 |
|
Cash and cash equivalents |
|
$ |
32,448 |
|
|
$ |
33,691 |
|
Investments |
|
|
133,542 |
|
|
|
112,491 |
|
Short term line of credit |
|
|
(12,881 |
) |
|
|
(58,583 |
) |
Long term debt(1) |
|
|
(12,828 |
) |
|
|
(26,146 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash position |
|
$ |
140,281 |
|
|
$ |
61,453 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note:
(1) |
This includes the current portion of long term debt. |
F - 44
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
14. Pension and other employee obligations
Pension and other employee obligations consist of the following:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at |
|
|
|
March 31, 2015 |
|
|
March 31, 2014 |
|
Current: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Salaries and bonus |
|
$ |
36,290 |
|
|
$ |
32,234 |
|
Pension |
|
|
496 |
|
|
|
363 |
|
Withholding taxes on salary and statutory payables |
|
|
3,638 |
|
|
|
3,572 |
|
Other employees payable |
|
|
|
|
|
|
133 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
40,424 |
|
|
$ |
36,302 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-current: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Pension |
|
$ |
6,069 |
|
|
$ |
5,168 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Employee benefit costs consist of the following:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Salaries and bonus |
|
$ |
252,420 |
|
|
$ |
235,280 |
|
|
$ |
225,184 |
|
Employee benefit plans: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Defined contribution plan |
|
|
7,396 |
|
|
|
6,434 |
|
|
|
6,521 |
|
Defined benefit plan |
|
|
1,874 |
|
|
|
2,234 |
|
|
|
1,957 |
|
Share based compensation |
|
|
9,499 |
|
|
|
6,935 |
|
|
|
5,343 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
271,189 |
|
|
$ |
250,833 |
|
|
$ |
239,005 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Employee benefit costs is recognized in the following line items in the consolidated statement of income:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Cost of revenue |
|
$ |
199,766 |
|
|
$ |
184,655 |
|
|
$ |
178,206 |
|
Selling and marketing expenses |
|
|
23,073 |
|
|
|
26,397 |
|
|
|
22,570 |
|
General and administrative expenses |
|
|
48,350 |
|
|
|
39,831 |
|
|
|
38,229 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
271,189 |
|
|
$ |
250,883 |
|
|
$ |
239,005 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Defined contribution plan
The Companys contributions to defined contribution plans are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
India |
|
$ |
5,115 |
|
|
$ |
4,534 |
|
|
$ |
4,798 |
|
Philippines |
|
|
63 |
|
|
|
57 |
|
|
|
57 |
|
South Africa |
|
|
518 |
|
|
|
494 |
|
|
|
349 |
|
Sri Lanka |
|
|
577 |
|
|
|
466 |
|
|
|
291 |
|
United Kingdom |
|
|
831 |
|
|
|
743 |
|
|
|
849 |
|
United States |
|
|
292 |
|
|
|
140 |
|
|
|
177 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
7,396 |
|
|
$ |
6,434 |
|
|
$ |
6,521 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F - 45
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
Defined benefit plan
The net periodic cost recognized by the Company in respect of gratuity payments under the Companys gratuity plans covering eligible employees of the
Company in India, the Philippines and Sri Lanka is as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Service cost |
|
$ |
1,351 |
|
|
$ |
1,780 |
|
|
$ |
1,487 |
|
Interest on the net defined benefit liability |
|
|
523 |
|
|
|
454 |
|
|
|
470 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net gratuity cost |
|
$ |
1,874 |
|
|
$ |
2,234 |
|
|
$ |
1,957 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at |
|
|
|
March 2015 |
|
|
March 2014 |
|
Change in projected benefit obligations |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Obligation at beginning of the year |
|
$ |
6,337 |
|
|
$ |
7,134 |
|
Foreign currency translation |
|
|
(248 |
) |
|
|
(633 |
) |
Service cost |
|
|
1,351 |
|
|
|
1,780 |
|
Interest cost |
|
|
541 |
|
|
|
479 |
|
Benefits paid |
|
|
(1,079 |
) |
|
|
(792 |
) |
Actuarial (gain)/loss |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
From changes in demographic assumptions |
|
|
(44 |
) |
|
|
(56 |
) |
From changes in financial assumptions |
|
|
308 |
|
|
|
(494 |
) |
From actual experience compared to assumptions |
|
|
155 |
|
|
|
(1,081 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Benefit obligation at end of the year |
|
$ |
7,321 |
|
|
$ |
6,337 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Change in plan assets |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Plan assets at beginning of the year |
|
$ |
806 |
|
|
$ |
357 |
|
Foreign currency translation |
|
|
(37 |
) |
|
|
(31 |
) |
Expected return on plan assets |
|
|
18 |
|
|
|
25 |
|
Actuarial loss/(gain) |
|
|
39 |
|
|
|
(26 |
) |
Actual contributions |
|
|
939 |
|
|
|
1,273 |
|
Benefits paid |
|
|
(1,009 |
) |
|
|
(792 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Plan assets at end of the year |
|
$ |
756 |
|
|
$ |
806 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accrued pension liability |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Current |
|
$ |
496 |
|
|
$ |
363 |
|
Non-current |
|
|
6,069 |
|
|
|
5,168 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net amount recognized |
|
$ |
6,565 |
|
|
$ |
5,531 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Present value of funded defined benefit obligation |
|
$ |
5,271 |
|
|
$ |
4,925 |
|
Fair value of plan assets |
|
|
(756 |
) |
|
|
(806 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
4,515 |
|
|
|
4,119 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Present value of unfunded defined benefit obligation |
|
$ |
2,050 |
|
|
$ |
1,412 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Weighted average duration of defined benefit obligation (both funded and unfunded) |
|
|
8.64 years |
|
|
|
7.68 years |
|
Net amount recognized relating to India plan, Philippines plan and Sri Lanka plan was $4,525, $1,640 and $400 as at
March 31, 2015 and $4,134, $1,046 and $351 as at March 31, 2014, respectively.
F - 46
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
The assumptions used in accounting for the gratuity plans are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Discount rate: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
India |
|
|
8.00% |
|
|
|
8.75% |
|
|
|
7.85% |
|
Philippines |
|
|
5.03% |
|
|
|
5.52% |
|
|
|
3.91% |
|
Sri Lanka |
|
|
9.85% |
|
|
|
9.50% |
|
|
|
11.00% |
|
Rate of increase in compensation level |
|
|
6% to 8% |
|
|
|
6% to 8% |
|
|
|
8.00% |
|
Expected rate of return on plan assets |
|
|
8.00% |
|
|
|
8.75% |
|
|
|
7.50% |
|
The Company evaluates these assumptions annually based on its long-term plans of growth and industry standards. The discount
rates are based on current market yields on government securities adjusted for a suitable risk premium to reflect the additional risk for high quality corporate bonds.
As at March 31, 2015, for each of the Companys defined benefit plans, the sensitivity of the defined benefit obligation to a change in each
significant actuarial assumption is as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
India |
|
|
Philippines |
|
|
Sri Lanka |
|
Discount rate: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Increase in discount rate by 1% |
|
|
(4.1 |
)% |
|
|
(20.5 |
)% |
|
|
(9.4 |
)% |
Decrease in discount rate 1% |
|
|
3.4 |
% |
|
|
26.6 |
% |
|
|
11.4 |
% |
Rate of increase in compensation level: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Increase in salary escalation rate by 1% |
|
|
3.0 |
% |
|
|
24.7 |
% |
|
|
11.5 |
% |
Decrease in salary escalation rate by 1% |
|
|
(3.8 |
)% |
|
|
(19.6 |
)% |
|
|
(9.6 |
)% |
Each sensitivity amount is calculated assuming that all other assumptions are held constant. The Company is not able to
predict the extent of likely future changes in these assumptions, but based on past experience, the discount rate for each plan could change by up to 1% within a 12 month period.
As at March 31, 2015, $3 and $753 ($3 and $803, respectively, as at March 31, 2014) of the fund assets are invested with LIC and ALICPL,
respectively. Of the funds invested with LIC, approximately 40% and 60% of the funds are invested in unquoted government securities and money market instruments, respectively. Of the funds invested with ALICPL, approximately 64% and 36% are invested
in unquoted government securities and money market instruments, respectively. Since the Companys plan assets are managed by third party fund administrators, the contributions made by the Company are pooled with the corpus of the funds managed
by such fund administrators and invested in accordance with regulatory guidelines. The Companys funding policy is to contribute to the Plan amounts necessary on an actuarial basis to, at a minimum, satisfy the minimum funding requirements.
Additional discretionary contributions above the minimum funding requirement can be made and are generally based on adjustment for any over or under funding.
The expected benefits are based on the same assumptions used to measure the Companys defined benefit obligations as at March 31, 2015. The Company
expects to contribute $1,215 for the year ending March 31, 2016. The maturity analysis of the Companys defined benefit payments is as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Amount |
|
2016 |
|
$ |
1,270 |
|
2017 |
|
|
1,140 |
|
2018 |
|
|
912 |
|
2019 |
|
|
785 |
|
2020 |
|
|
669 |
|
Thereafter |
|
|
2,112 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$ |
6,888 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
F - 47
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
15. Provisions and accrued expenses
Provisions and accrued expenses consist of the following:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at |
|
|
|
March 31, 2015 |
|
|
March 31, 2014 |
|
Provisions |
|
$ |
753 |
|
|
$ |
693 |
|
Accrued expenses |
|
|
24,869 |
|
|
|
23,204 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
25,622 |
|
|
$ |
23,897 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A summary of activity for provisions is as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at |
|
|
|
March 31, 2015 |
|
|
March 31, 2014 |
|
Balance at the beginning of the year |
|
$ |
693 |
|
|
$ |
674 |
|
Additional provision |
|
|
754 |
|
|
|
649 |
|
Provision used |
|
|
(692 |
) |
|
|
(622 |
) |
Translation adjustments |
|
|
(2 |
) |
|
|
(8 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance at the end of the year |
|
$ |
753 |
|
|
$ |
693 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
16. Deferred revenue
Deferred revenue consists of the following:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at |
|
|
|
March 31, 2015 |
|
|
March 31, 2014 |
|
Current: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Payments in advance of services |
|
$ |
600 |
|
|
$ |
775 |
|
Advance billings |
|
|
2,384 |
|
|
|
3,651 |
|
Claims handling |
|
|
|
|
|
|
11 |
|
Others |
|
|
897 |
|
|
|
934 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
3,881 |
|
|
$ |
5,371 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at |
|
|
|
March 31, 2015 |
|
|
March 31, 2014 |
|
Non-current: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Payments in advance of services |
|
$ |
220 |
|
|
$ |
495 |
|
Advance billings |
|
|
163 |
|
|
|
1,182 |
|
Other |
|
|
19 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
402 |
|
|
$ |
1,677 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F - 48
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
17. Other liabilities
Other liabilities consist of the following:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at |
|
|
|
March 31, 2015 |
|
|
March 31, 2014 |
|
Current: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Withholding taxes and value added tax payables |
|
$ |
3,989 |
|
|
$ |
3,265 |
|
Deferred rent |
|
|
806 |
|
|
|
644 |
|
Other liabilities |
|
|
1,136 |
|
|
|
2,741 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
5,931 |
|
|
$ |
6,650 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-current: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Deferred rent |
|
$ |
3,601 |
|
|
$ |
3,609 |
|
Other liabilities |
|
|
416 |
|
|
|
300 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
4,017 |
|
|
$ |
3,909 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
18. Share capital
As at
March 31, 2015, the authorized share capital was £6,100 divided into 60,000,000 ordinary shares of 10 pence each and 1,000,000 preferred shares of 10 pence each. The Company had 51,950,662 ordinary shares outstanding as at March 31,
2015. There were no preferred shares outstanding as at March 31, 2015.
As at March 31, 2014, the authorized share capital was £6,100
divided into 60,000,000 ordinary shares of 10 pence each and 1,000,000 preferred shares of 10 pence each. The Company had 51,347,538 ordinary shares outstanding as at March 31, 2014. There were no preferred shares outstanding as at
March 31, 2014.
In March 2015, WNS Holdings shareholders authorized a share repurchase program for the repurchase of up to 1.1 million of our ADSs,
each representing one ordinary share, at a price range of $10 to $30 per ADS. Pursuant to the terms of the repurchase program, WNS Holdings ADSs may be purchased in the open market from time to time for 12 months from April 1, 2015. WNS
Holdings are not obligated under the repurchase program to repurchase a specific number of ADSs, and the repurchase program may be suspended at any time at WNS Holdings discretion.
F - 49
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
19. Expenses by nature
Expenses by nature consist of the following:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Employee cost |
|
$ |
271,189 |
|
|
$ |
250,883 |
|
|
$ |
239,005 |
|
Repair payments |
|
|
30,877 |
|
|
|
31,099 |
|
|
|
24,132 |
|
Facilities cost |
|
|
70,801 |
|
|
|
65,652 |
|
|
|
65,684 |
|
Depreciation |
|
|
14,387 |
|
|
|
13,960 |
|
|
|
14,709 |
|
Legal and professional expenses |
|
|
13,108 |
|
|
|
17,735 |
|
|
|
15,162 |
|
Travel expenses |
|
|
15,806 |
|
|
|
16,804 |
|
|
|
15,214 |
|
Others |
|
|
27,633 |
|
|
|
22,167 |
|
|
|
24,382 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total cost of revenue, selling and marketing and general and administrative expenses |
|
$ |
443,801 |
|
|
$ |
418,300 |
|
|
$ |
398,288 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
20. Finance expense
Finance expense consists of the following:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Interest expense |
|
$ |
1,251 |
|
|
$ |
2,812 |
|
|
$ |
3,224 |
|
Interest on deferred purchase consideration |
|
|
|
|
|
|
23 |
|
|
|
215 |
|
Interest rate swap |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(15 |
) |
Debt issue cost |
|
|
81 |
|
|
|
113 |
|
|
|
209 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
1,332 |
|
|
$ |
2,948 |
|
|
$ |
3,633 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
21. Other income, net
Other income, net consists of the following:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Income from interest and dividend on marketable securities |
|
$ |
4,785 |
|
|
$ |
3,480 |
|
|
$ |
3,140 |
|
Net gain/(loss) arising on financial assets designated as FVTPL |
|
|
4,553 |
|
|
|
4,000 |
|
|
|
102 |
|
Others |
|
|
2,574 |
|
|
|
2,045 |
|
|
|
1,525 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
11,912 |
|
|
$ |
9,525 |
|
|
$ |
4,767 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F - 50
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
22. Share-based payments
The Company has two share-based incentive plans, the 2002 Stock Incentive Plan adopted on July 1, 2002 and the 2006 Incentive Award Plan adopted on
June 1, 2006, as amended and restated in February 2009 and September 2011 (collectively referred to as the Plans). Under the Plans, share based options may be granted to eligible participants. Options are generally granted
for a term of ten years and have a graded vesting period of up to four years. The Company settles employee share-based option exercises with newly issued ordinary shares. As at March 31, 2015, the Company had 445,888 ordinary shares available
for future grants.
Share-based compensation expense during the years ended March 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013 are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Share-based compensation expense recorded in |
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
Cost of revenue |
|
|
856 |
|
|
|
1,316 |
|
|
|
992 |
|
Selling and marketing expenses |
|
|
779 |
|
|
|
591 |
|
|
|
425 |
|
General and administrative expenses |
|
|
7,864 |
|
|
|
5,028 |
|
|
|
3,926 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total share-based compensation expense |
|
$ |
9,499 |
|
|
$ |
6,935 |
|
|
$ |
5,343 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Upon exercise of share options and RSUs, the Company issued 603,124, 759,494 and 509,163 shares, respectively, during the
years ended March 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013.
F - 51
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
Share-based options
Movements in the number of options outstanding under the 2006 Incentive Award Plan and their related weighted average exercise prices are as follow:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Shares |
|
|
Weighted average exercise price |
|
|
Weighted average remaining contract term (in years) |
|
|
Aggregate intrinsic value |
|
Outstanding as at April 1, 2013 |
|
|
902,245 |
|
|
$ |
21.60 |
|
|
|
3.45 |
|
|
$ |
491 |
|
Exercised |
|
|
(45,131 |
) |
|
|
7.01 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Lapsed |
|
|
(1,000 |
) |
|
|
12.26 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Outstanding as at March 31, 2014 |
|
|
856,114 |
|
|
$ |
22.38 |
|
|
|
2.52 |
|
|
$ |
339 |
|
Exercised |
|
|
(39,827 |
) |
|
|
13.76 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Lapsed |
|
|
(1 |
) |
|
|
2.72 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Outstanding as at March 31, 2015 |
|
|
816,286 |
|
|
$ |
22.80 |
|
|
|
1.53 |
|
|
$ |
2,407 |
|
Options exercisable |
|
|
816,286 |
|
|
$ |
22.80 |
|
|
|
1.53 |
|
|
$ |
2,407 |
|
The aggregate intrinsic value of options exercised during the year ended March 31, 2015 and 2014 was $306 and $584,
respectively. The total grant date fair value of options vested during the year ended March 31, 2015 and 2014 was $nil for each year. Total cash received as a result of option exercised during the year ended March 31, 2015 and
March 31, 2014 was $535 and $279, respectively.
The fair value of options granted is estimated on the date of grant using the Black-Scholes-Merton
option-pricing model. No options were granted during the years ended March 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013.
The weighted average share price of options
exercised during the year ended March 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013 was $21.13, $19.09 and $11.23 respectively. The options outstanding at March 31, 2015 had an exercise price per option in the range of $5.7 to $35.3 (March 31, 2014: $2.7 to
$35.3) and a weighted average remaining contractual term of 1.53 years (March 31, 2014: 2.52 years)
Restricted Share Units
The 2006 Incentive Award Plan also allows for grant of RSUs. Each RSU represents the right to receive one ordinary share and vests over a period of up to three
years.
Movements in the number of RSUs outstanding under the 2006 Incentive Award Plan and their related weighted average exercise prices are as follow:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Shares |
|
|
Weighted average fair value |
|
|
Weighted average remaining contract term (in years) |
|
|
Aggregate intrinsic value |
|
Outstanding as at April 1, 2013 |
|
|
1,482,177 |
|
|
$ |
11.41 |
|
|
|
7.82 |
|
|
$ |
21,847 |
|
Granted |
|
|
592,547 |
|
|
|
14.87 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Exercised |
|
|
(676,045 |
) |
|
|
12.24 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Forfeited |
|
|
(53,567 |
) |
|
|
12.64 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Lapsed |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Outstanding as at March 31, 2014 |
|
|
1,345,112 |
|
|
$ |
12.47 |
|
|
|
7.93 |
|
|
$ |
24,212 |
|
Granted |
|
|
560,024 |
|
|
|
19.19 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Exercised |
|
|
(516,171 |
) |
|
|
11.81 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Forfeited |
|
|
(65,467 |
) |
|
|
16.44 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Lapsed |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Outstanding as at March 31, 2015 |
|
|
1,323,498 |
|
|
$ |
15.37 |
|
|
|
7.86 |
|
|
$ |
32,187 |
|
RSUs exercisable |
|
|
406,699 |
|
|
$ |
11.28 |
|
|
|
5.98 |
|
|
$ |
9,891 |
|
F - 52
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
The fair value of RSUs is generally the market price of the Companys shares on the date of grant. As at
March 31, 2015, there was $4,768 of unrecognized compensation cost related to unvested RSUs. This amount is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of 2.73 years. To the extent the actual forfeiture rate is different than what
the Company has anticipated, share based compensation related to these RSUs will be different from the Companys expectations.
The weighted average
grant date fair value of RSUs granted during the year ended March 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013 was $19.19, $14.87, and $10.93 per ADS, respectively. The aggregate intrinsic value of RSUs exercised during the year ended March 31, 2015 and 2014
was $9,529 and $13,139, respectively. The total grant date fair value of RSUs vested during the year ended March 31, 2015 and 2014 was $5,878 and $4,909, respectively.
The weighted average share price of RSU exercised during the year ended March 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013 was $18.46, $19.43 and $10.63, respectively.
Performance share units
The 2006 Incentive Award
Plan also allows for grant of performance share units (PSUs). Each PSU represents the right to receive one ordinary share based on the Companys performance against specified targets and vests over a period of up to four years.
Movements in the number of PSUs outstanding under the 2006 Incentive Award Plan and their related weighted average exercise prices are as follow:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Shares |
|
|
Weighted average fair value |
|
|
Weighted average remaining contract term (in years) |
|
|
Aggregate intrinsic value |
|
Outstanding as at April 1, 2013 |
|
|
951,190 |
|
|
$ |
10.44 |
|
|
|
8.26 |
|
|
$ |
14,021 |
|
Granted |
|
|
203,434 |
|
|
|
14.53 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Exercised |
|
|
(38,318 |
) |
|
|
8.77 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Forfeited |
|
|
(638,393 |
) |
|
|
10.90 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Outstanding as at March 31, 2014 |
|
|
477,913 |
|
|
$ |
11.70 |
|
|
|
7.98 |
|
|
$ |
8,602 |
|
Granted |
|
|
327,409 |
|
|
|
19.02 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Exercised |
|
|
(47,126 |
) |
|
|
9.69 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Forfeited |
|
|
(198,626 |
) |
|
|
11.22 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Outstanding as at March 31, 2015 |
|
|
559,570 |
|
|
$ |
14.98 |
|
|
|
8.16 |
|
|
$ |
13,609 |
|
PSUs exercisable |
|
|
31,409 |
|
|
$ |
9.38 |
|
|
|
5.85 |
|
|
$ |
764 |
|
The fair value of PSUs is generally the market price of the Companys shares on the date of grant, and assumes that
performance targets will be achieved. As at March 31, 2015, there was $4,023 of unrecognized compensation cost related to unvested PSUs, net of forfeitures. This amount is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of 1.66 years.
Over the performance period, the number of shares that will be issued will be adjusted upward or downward based upon the probability of achievement of the performance targets. The ultimate number of shares issued and the related compensation cost
recognized as expense will be based on a comparison of the final performance metrics to the specified targets.
The weighted average grant date fair value
of PSUs granted during the years ended March 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013 was $19.02, $14.53, and $9.63 respectively, per ADS. The aggregate intrinsic value of PSUs exercised during the year ended March 31, 2015 and 2014 was $1,000 and $789,
respectively. The total grant date fair value of PSUs vested during the year ended March 31, 2015 and 2014 was $388 and $712, respectively.
The
weighted average share price of PSU exercised during the year ended March 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013 was $21.23, $20.60 and $nil, respectively.
F - 53
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
23. Income taxes
The domestic and foreign source component of profit (loss) before income taxes is as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Domestic |
|
$ |
(3,351 |
) |
|
$ |
(3,501 |
) |
|
$ |
(589 |
) |
Foreign |
|
|
84,382 |
|
|
|
59,437 |
|
|
|
31,852 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Profit before income taxes |
|
$ |
81,031 |
|
|
$ |
55,936 |
|
|
$ |
31,263 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The Companys provision for income taxes consists of the following:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Current taxes |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Domestic taxes |
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
Foreign taxes |
|
|
16,914 |
|
|
|
11,828 |
|
|
|
13,425 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
16,914 |
|
|
|
11,828 |
|
|
|
13,425 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Deferred taxes |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Domestic taxes |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Foreign taxes |
|
|
5,503 |
|
|
|
2,461 |
|
|
|
(3,561 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5,503 |
|
|
|
2,461 |
|
|
|
(3,561 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$ |
22,417 |
|
|
$ |
14,289 |
|
|
$ |
9,864 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Domestic taxes are nil as there are no statutory taxes applicable in Jersey, Channel Islands. Foreign taxes are based on
applicable tax rates in each subsidiarys jurisdiction.
The Company has a delivery center located in Gurgaon, India registered under the
Special Economic Zone (SEZ) scheme is eligible for 50% income tax exemption from fiscal 2013 to fiscal 2022. The Company in fiscal 2012 started operations in delivery centers in Pune, Mumbai and Chennai, India registered under the
SEZ scheme that are eligible for 100% income tax exemption until fiscal 2016 and 50% income tax exemption from fiscal 2017 to fiscal 2026. During fiscal 2015, the Company started its operations in new delivery centers in Gurgaon and Pune, India
registered under the SEZ scheme that are eligible for 100% income tax exemption until fiscal 2019, and 50% income tax exemption from fiscal 2020 to fiscal 2029. The Government of India pursuant to the Indian Finance Act, 2011 has also levied minimum
alternate tax (MAT) on the book profits earned by the SEZ units at the prevailing rate which is currently 20.96%. The Companys operations in Costa Rica are eligible for a 100% income tax exemption until fiscal 2017 and 50% income
tax exemption from fiscal 2018 to fiscal 2021. The Companys operations in Philippines located in Eastwood Avenue, Manila were eligible for tax exemptions until fiscal 2015. During fiscal 2013, the Company started operations in a new delivery
center in Philippines located in Techno Plaza II, Manila which is eligible for tax exemption until fiscal 2017. The Government of Sri Lanka has exempted profits earned from export revenue from tax, which enables the Companys Sri Lankan
subsidiary to continue to claim a tax exemption.
If the income tax exemption was not available, the additional income tax expense at the respective
statutory rates in India and Sri Lanka would have been approximately $3,011, $1,671 and $769 for the years ended March 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively. Such additional tax would have decreased the basic and diluted earnings per share for
the year ended March 31, 2015 by $0.06 and $0.06, respectively ($0.03 and $0.03, respectively for the year ended March 31, 2014 and $0.02 and $0.01, respectively, for the year ended March 31, 2013).
F - 54
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
Income taxes recognized directly in equity are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Current taxes: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Excess tax deductions related to share-based payments |
|
|
(99 |
) |
|
|
(104 |
) |
|
|
(55 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$ |
(99 |
) |
|
$ |
(104 |
) |
|
$ |
(55 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Deferred taxes: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Excess tax deductions related to share-based payments |
|
|
(169 |
) |
|
|
(105 |
) |
|
|
(156 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$ |
(169 |
) |
|
$ |
(105 |
) |
|
$ |
(156 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total income tax recognized directly in equity |
|
$ |
(268 |
) |
|
$ |
(209 |
) |
|
$ |
(211 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Income taxes recognized in other comprehensive income are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Current taxes |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Deferred taxes: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Unrealized gain/(loss) on cash flow hedging derivatives |
|
|
8,242 |
|
|
|
(2,052 |
) |
|
|
4,304 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total income tax recognized directly in other comprehensive income |
|
$ |
8,242 |
|
|
$ |
(2,052 |
) |
|
$ |
4,304 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The reconciliation of estimated income tax to provision for income tax:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Profit before income taxes |
|
$ |
81,031 |
|
|
$ |
55,936 |
|
|
$ |
31,263 |
|
Income tax expense at tax rates applicable to individual entities |
|
|
26,749 |
|
|
|
20,365 |
|
|
|
11,094 |
|
Effect of: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Items not deductible for tax |
|
|
228 |
|
|
|
80 |
|
|
|
96 |
|
Exempt income |
|
|
(5,228 |
) |
|
|
(3,509 |
) |
|
|
(1,766 |
) |
(Gain)/Loss in respect of which deferred tax (liability)/asset not recognized due to uncertainty and ineligibility to carry
forward |
|
|
318 |
|
|
|
(47 |
) |
|
|
2,983 |
|
Temporary difference that will reverse during tax holiday period |
|
|
1,175 |
|
|
|
(2,154 |
) |
|
|
(2,338 |
) |
Change in tax rate and law |
|
|
268 |
|
|
|
169 |
|
|
|
(318 |
) |
Provision for uncertain tax position |
|
|
(345 |
) |
|
|
(163 |
) |
|
|
(80 |
) |
State taxes |
|
|
17 |
|
|
|
27 |
|
|
|
(5 |
) |
Others, net |
|
|
(765 |
) |
|
|
(479 |
) |
|
|
198 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Provision for income tax |
|
$ |
22,417 |
|
|
$ |
14,289 |
|
|
$ |
9,864 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F - 55
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
Deferred taxes for the year ended March 31, 2015 arising from temporary differences and unused tax
losses can be summarized below:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Opening Balance |
|
|
Additions due to acquisition during the year |
|
|
Recognized in statement of income |
|
|
Recognized in equity |
|
|
Recognized in/ Reclassified from Other comprehensive income |
|
|
Foreign currency translation |
|
|
Closing balance |
|
Deferred tax assets: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Property and equipment |
|
$ |
8,280 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
(1,386 |
) |
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
(356 |
) |
|
$ |
6,538 |
|
Net operating loss carry forward |
|
|
4,363 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
246 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(305 |
) |
|
|
4,304 |
|
Accruals deductible on actual payment |
|
|
3,720 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
639 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(158 |
) |
|
|
4,201 |
|
Share-based compensation |
|
|
5,356 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
803 |
|
|
|
169 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(218 |
) |
|
|
6,110 |
|
Minimum alternate tax |
|
|
15,289 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(6,405 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(557 |
) |
|
|
8,327 |
|
Others |
|
|
1,710 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(160 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(106 |
) |
|
|
1,444 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total deferred tax assets |
|
$ |
38,718 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
(6,263 |
) |
|
$ |
169 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
(1,700 |
) |
|
$ |
30,924 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Deferred tax liabilities: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Intangibles |
|
|
4,886 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(2,751 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(90 |
) |
|
|
2,045 |
|
Unrealized gain/(loss) on cash flow hedging and investments |
|
|
(285 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,991 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
8,242 |
|
|
|
(127 |
) |
|
|
9,821 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total deferred tax liabilities |
|
$ |
4,601 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
(760 |
) |
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
8,242 |
|
|
$ |
(217 |
) |
|
$ |
11,866 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net deferred tax assets/(liabilities) |
|
$ |
34,117 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
(5,503 |
) |
|
$ |
169 |
|
|
$ |
(8,242 |
) |
|
$ |
(1,483 |
) |
|
$ |
19,058 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F - 56
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
Deferred taxes for the year ended March 31, 2014 arising from temporary differences and unused tax
losses can be summarized below:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Opening balance |
|
|
Additions due to acquisition during the year |
|
|
Recognized in statement of income |
|
|
Recognized in equity |
|
|
Recognized in/ Reclassified from Other comprehensive income |
|
|
Foreign currency translation |
|
|
Closing balance |
|
Deferred tax assets: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Property and equipment |
|
$ |
9,927 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
(821 |
) |
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
(826 |
) |
|
$ |
8,280 |
|
Net operating loss carry forward |
|
|
4,165 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
695 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(497 |
) |
|
|
4,363 |
|
Accruals deductible on actual payment |
|
|
3,298 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
764 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(342 |
) |
|
|
3,720 |
|
Share-based compensation |
|
|
4,200 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,303 |
|
|
|
105 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(252 |
) |
|
|
5,356 |
|
Minimum alternate tax |
|
|
23,306 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(5,668 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(2,349 |
) |
|
|
15,289 |
|
Others |
|
|
1,397 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
261 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
52 |
|
|
|
1,710 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total deferred tax assets |
|
$ |
46,293 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
(3.466 |
) |
|
$ |
105 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
(4,214 |
) |
|
$ |
38,718 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Deferred tax liabilities: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Intangibles |
|
|
7,008 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1,798 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(324 |
) |
|
|
4,886 |
|
Unrealized gain/(loss) on cash flow hedging |
|
|
1,249 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
793 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(2,052 |
) |
|
|
(275 |
) |
|
|
(285 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total deferred tax liabilities |
|
$ |
8,257 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
(1,005 |
) |
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
(2,052 |
) |
|
$ |
(599 |
) |
|
$ |
4,601 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net deferred tax assets/(liabilities) |
|
$ |
38,036 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
(2,461 |
) |
|
$ |
105 |
|
|
$ |
2,052 |
|
|
$ |
(3,615 |
) |
|
$ |
34,117 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F - 57
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
Deferred taxes for the year ended March 31, 2013 arising from temporary differences and unused tax
losses can be summarized below:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Opening Balance |
|
|
Additions due to acquisition during the year |
|
|
Recognized in statement of income |
|
|
Recognized in equity |
|
|
Recognized in/ Reclassified from Other comprehensive income |
|
|
Foreign currency translation |
|
|
Closing balance |
|
Deferred tax assets: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Property and equipment |
|
$ |
10,574 |
|
|
$ |
(45 |
) |
|
$ |
71 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
(673 |
) |
|
$ |
9,927 |
|
Net operating loss carry forward |
|
|
470 |
|
|
|
2,542 |
|
|
|
1,465 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(312 |
) |
|
|
4,165 |
|
Accruals deductible on actual payment |
|
|
2,084 |
|
|
|
190 |
|
|
|
980 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
44 |
|
|
|
3,298 |
|
Share-based compensation |
|
|
3,057 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
918 |
|
|
|
156 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
69 |
|
|
|
4,200 |
|
Minimum alternate tax |
|
|
26,461 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1,250 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1,905 |
) |
|
|
23,306 |
|
Others |
|
|
1,140 |
|
|
|
36 |
|
|
|
262 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(41 |
) |
|
|
1,397 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total deferred tax assets |
|
$ |
43,786 |
|
|
$ |
2,723 |
|
|
$ |
2,446 |
|
|
$ |
156 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
(2,818 |
) |
|
$ |
46,293 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Deferred tax liabilities: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Intangibles |
|
|
6,885 |
|
|
|
1,001 |
|
|
|
(685 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(193 |
) |
|
|
7,008 |
|
Unrealized gain/(loss) on cash flow hedging |
|
|
(2,851 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
(430 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
4,304 |
|
|
|
226 |
|
|
|
1,249 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total deferred tax liabilities |
|
$ |
4,034 |
|
|
$ |
1,001 |
|
|
$ |
(1,115 |
) |
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
4,304 |
|
|
$ |
33 |
|
|
$ |
8,257 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net deferred tax assets/(liabilities) |
|
$ |
39,752 |
|
|
$ |
1,722 |
|
|
$ |
3,561 |
|
|
$ |
156 |
|
|
$ |
(4,304 |
) |
|
$ |
(2,851 |
) |
|
$ |
38,036 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F - 58
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
Deferred tax presented in the statement of financial position is as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at |
|
|
|
March 31, 2015 |
|
|
March 31, 2014 |
|
Deferred tax assets |
|
|
21,331 |
|
|
|
37,066 |
|
Deferred tax liabilities |
|
|
(2,273 |
) |
|
|
(2,949 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net deferred tax assets |
|
$ |
19,058 |
|
|
$ |
34,117 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
There are unused tax losses amounting to $44,540 as at March 31, 2015 for which no deferred tax asset has been recognized
as these losses either relate to certain tax jurisdictions where the group entities have had past losses and there is no conclusive evidence to support the view that sufficient taxable profit will be generated by such group entities in the future to
offset such losses or there is uncertainty in the treatment of such losses under the tax laws of the relevant jurisdictions. The expiry dates of the tax benefit for these losses depend on the local tax laws of each jurisdiction and, if not utilized,
would expire on various dates starting from financial year 2016 to 2022. However, in the UK there is no expiry period for the unused tax losses.
MAT paid
by the India entity as per the Indian Income tax Act can be carried forward and set-off against future income tax liabilities of the company under normal tax provisions within a period of ten years. Such credit for MAT paid, has been recognized on
the basis of estimated taxable income in future years and, if not utilized, would expire in financial year 2021 and 2022.
Deferred income tax liabilities
on earnings of Companys subsidiaries have not been provided as such earnings are deemed to be permanently reinvested in the business and the Company is able to control the timing of the reversals of temporary differences associated with these
investments. Accordingly, temporary difference on which deferred tax liability has not been recognized amounts to $233,214, $158,352 and $139,267 as at March 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
F - 59
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
From time to time, the Company receives orders of assessment from the Indian tax authorities assessing
additional taxable income on the Company and/or its subsidiaries in connection with their review of their tax returns. The Company currently has orders of assessment outstanding for various years through fiscal 2012, which assess additional taxable
income that could in the aggregate give rise to an estimated $48,629 in additional taxes, including interest of $17,222. These orders of assessment allege that the transfer prices the Company applied to certain of the international transactions
between WNS Global and its other wholly-owned subsidiaries were not on arms length terms, disallow a tax holiday benefit claimed by the Company, deny the set off of brought forward business losses and unabsorbed depreciation and disallow
certain expenses claimed as tax deductible by WNS Global. The Company has appealed against these orders of assessment before higher appellate authorities.
In addition, the Company has orders of assessment pertaining to similar issues that have been decided in favor of the Company by first level appellate
authorities, vacating the tax demands of $39,620 in additional taxes, including interest of $12,299. The income tax authorities have filed appeals against these orders at higher appellate authorities.
Uncertain tax positions are reflected at the amount likely to be paid to the taxation authorities. A liability is recognized in connection with each item that
is not probable of being sustained on examination by taxing authority. The liability is measured using single best estimate of the most likely outcome for each position taken in the tax return. Thus the provision would be the aggregate liability in
connection with all uncertain tax positions. As of March 31, 2015, the Company has provided a tax reserve of $14,474 primarily on account of the Indian tax authorities denying the set off of brought forward business losses and unabsorbed
depreciation.
As at March 31, 2015, corporate tax returns for years ended March 31, 2012 (for certain legal entities) and onward remain subject
to examination by tax authorities in India.
Based on the facts of these cases, the nature of the tax authorities disallowances and the orders from
first level appellate authorities deciding similar issues in favor of the Company in respect of assessment orders for earlier fiscal years and after consultation with the Companys external tax advisors, the Company believe these orders are
unlikely to be sustained at the higher appellate authorities. The Company has deposited $12,134 of the disputed amounts with the tax authorities and may be required to deposit the remaining portion of the disputed amounts with the tax authorities
pending final resolution of the respective matters.
Others
On March 21, 2009, the Company received an assessment order from the Indian service tax authority, demanding payment of $5,557 of service tax and related
penalty for the period from March 1, 2003 to January 31, 2005. The assessment order alleges that service tax is payable in India on BPM services provided by the Company to clients based abroad as the export proceeds are repatriated outside
India by the Company. In response to the appeal filed by the Company with appellate tribunal against the assessment order in April 2009, the appellate tribunal has remanded the matter back to lower tax authorities to be adjudicated afresh.
After consultation with Indian tax advisors, the Company believes this order of assessment is more likely than not to be upheld in favor of the Company. The Company intends to continue to vigorously dispute the assessment.
F - 60
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
24. Earnings per share
The following table sets forth the computation of basic and diluted earnings per share:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Numerator: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Profit |
|
$ |
58,614 |
|
|
$ |
41,647 |
|
|
$ |
21,399 |
|
Denominator: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Basic weighted average ordinary shares outstanding |
|
|
51,633,516 |
|
|
|
50,958,864 |
|
|
|
50,309,140 |
|
Dilutive impact of equivalent stock options and RSUs |
|
|
1,795,465 |
|
|
|
1,730,293 |
|
|
|
1,402,392 |
|
Diluted weighted average ordinary shares outstanding |
|
|
53,428,981 |
|
|
|
52,689,157 |
|
|
|
51,711,532 |
|
The computation of earnings per ordinary share (EPS) was determined by dividing profit by the weighted average
ordinary shares outstanding during the respective periods.
The Company excludes options with exercise price that are greater than the average market
price from the calculation of diluted EPS because their effect would be anti-dilutive. In the years ended March 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, the Company excluded from the calculation of diluted EPS options to purchase 314,454; 314,454; and 815,378
shares, respectively.
F - 61
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
25. Related party
The following is a list of the Companys subsidiaries as at March 31, 2015:
|
|
|
|
|
Direct subsidiaries |
|
Step subsidiaries |
|
Place of
incorporation |
|
|
|
WNS Global Services Netherlands Cooperative U.A. |
|
|
|
The Netherlands |
|
|
|
|
|
WNS Global Services Philippines Inc. |
|
Philippines |
|
|
|
|
|
WNS Global Services (Romania) S.R.L. |
|
Romania |
|
|
|
WNS North America Inc. |
|
|
|
Delaware, USA |
|
|
|
|
|
WNS Business Consulting Services Private Limited |
|
India |
|
|
|
|
|
WNS Global Services Inc. |
|
Delaware, USA |
|
|
|
|
|
WNS BPO Services Costa Rica, S.R.L |
|
Costa Rica |
|
|
|
WNS Global Services (UK) Limited |
|
|
|
United Kingdom |
|
|
|
|
|
WNS Workflow Technologies Limited |
|
United Kingdom |
|
|
|
|
|
Accidents Happen Assistance Limited |
|
United Kingdom |
|
|
|
|
|
WNS Global Services SA (Pty) Ltd. |
|
South Africa |
|
|
|
|
|
WNS Legal Assistance LLP (2) |
|
United Kingdom |
|
|
|
WNS (Mauritius) Limited |
|
|
|
Mauritius |
|
|
|
|
|
WNS Capital Investment Limited |
|
Mauritius |
|
|
|
|
|
WNS Customer Solutions (Singapore) Private Limited |
|
Singapore |
|
|
|
|
|
WNS Customer Solutions (Private) Limited |
|
Sri Lanka |
|
|
|
|
|
WNS Global Services (Australia) Pty Ltd |
|
Australia |
|
|
|
|
|
Business Applications Associates Beijing Limited |
|
China |
|
|
|
|
|
WNS Global Services Private Limited (1) |
|
India |
|
|
|
|
|
WNS Global Services (Private) Limited |
|
Sri Lanka |
|
|
|
|
|
WNS Global Services (Dalian) Co. Ltd. |
|
China |
Notes:
(1) |
WNS Global Services Private Limited is being held jointly by WNS (Mauritius) Limited and WNS Customer Solutions (Singapore) Private Limited. The percentage of holding for WNS (Mauritius) Limited is 80% and for WNS
Customer Solutions (Singapore) Limited is 20%. |
(2) |
All the above subsidiaries are wholly owned except WNS Legal Assistance LLP, a limited liability partnership, organized under the laws of England and Wales in November 2014. We intend for WNS Legal Assistance LLP to
provide legal and professional services for our Auto Claims BPM (as defined in Note 26) segment in the UK. WNS Legal Assistance LLP is 80% owned by WNS Global Services (UK) Limited and 20% owned by Prettys. |
F - 62
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
|
|
|
Name of the related party |
|
Relationship |
Warburg Pincus and its affiliates (till February 12, 2013) |
|
Principal shareholder |
|
|
Datacap Software Private Limited (Datacap) (till December 31, 2013) |
|
A company of which a member of key management is a principal shareholder |
|
|
Acumentor Inc. (w.e.f April 1, 2014) |
|
An entity of which a member of key management is the sole proprietor |
|
|
Surface Architectural Supply Inc. (w.e.f September 1, 2014) |
|
A company in which a member of key management has a controlling stake |
|
|
J F Fitness of Virginia (w.e.f September 1, 2014) |
|
A company in which a member of key management has a controlling stake |
|
|
Sheron LLC (w.e.f April 1, 2014) |
|
A company which a close relative of the member of key management owns and controls |
|
|
Key management personnel |
|
|
Adrian T. Dillon (Appointed on September 21, 2012) |
|
Chairman (Appointed as Chairman effective January 1, 2014, was Non-Executive Vice Chairman till December 31, 2013) |
|
|
Keshav R. Murugesh |
|
Director and Group Chief Executive Officer |
|
|
Jeremy Young |
|
Director |
|
|
Deepak S. Parekh (Ceased to be director from September 4, 2012) |
|
Director |
|
|
Renu S. Karnad (Appointed on September 21, 2012) |
|
Director |
|
|
Eric B. Herr (Ceased to be director from April 30, 2014) |
|
Director (Ceased to be Chairman from January 1, 2014) |
|
|
Richard O. Bernays (Ceased to be director from December 31, 2013) |
|
Director |
|
|
Anthony A. Greener |
|
Director |
|
|
Albert Aboody |
|
Director |
|
|
Alok Misra (Ceased to be CFO from August 17, 2012) |
|
Group Chief Financial Officer |
|
|
Deepak Sogani (Resigned on August 27, 2013) |
|
Group Chief Financial Officer |
|
|
Johnson J. Selvadurai (Ceased to be an executive officer from January 1, 2014) |
|
Managing Director Europe |
|
|
Michael Garber (Ceased to be an executive officer from January 1, 2014) |
|
Chief Sales and Marketing Officer |
|
|
Kumar Subramaniam (Appointed as Interim Group Chief Financial Officer for the period August 17, 2012 to December 2, 2012) |
|
Group Chief Financial Officer |
|
|
Ronald Strout (Ceased to be an executive officer from June 28, 2012) |
|
Chief of Staff and Head Americas |
|
|
Swaminathan Rajamani |
|
Chief People Officer |
|
|
Ronald Gillette (Appointed as executive officer on January 1, 2014) |
|
Chief Operating Officer |
|
|
Sanjay Puria (Appointed as Group Chief Financial Officer effective August 28, 2013) |
|
Group Chief Financial Officer |
|
|
Gareth Williams (Appointed on January 1, 2014) |
|
Director |
|
|
Michael Menezes (Appointed on January 1, 2014) |
|
Director |
|
|
John Freeland (Appointed on September 1 , 2014) |
|
Director |
F - 63
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, |
|
Nature of transaction with related parties |
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
|
2013 |
|
Revenue |
|
|
|
|
Warburg Pincus and its Affiliates |
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
3,753 |
|
Cost of Revenue |
|
|
|
|
Datacap |
|
|
|
|
|
|
21 |
|
|
|
27 |
|
Key management personnel* |
|
|
|
|
Remuneration and short-term benefits |
|
|
3,763 |
|
|
|
3,890 |
|
|
|
3,365 |
|
Defined contribution plan |
|
|
82 |
|
|
|
108 |
|
|
|
106 |
|
Other benefits |
|
|
14 |
|
|
|
30 |
|
|
|
23 |
|
Share based compensation |
|
|
5,759 |
|
|
|
3,259 |
|
|
|
3,036 |
|
* |
Defined benefit plan is not disclosed as these are determined for the Company as a whole. |
F - 64
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
26. Operating segments
The Company has several operating segments based on a mix of industry and the types of services. The composition and organization of these operating segments
currently is designed in such a way that the back office shared processes, i.e. the horizontal structure, delivers service to industry specific back office and front office processes i.e. the vertical structure. These structures represent a matrix
form of organization structure, accordingly operating segments have been determined based on the core principle of segment reporting in accordance with IFRS 8 Operating segments (IFRS 8). These operating segments include
travel, insurance, banking and financial services, healthcare, utilities, retail and consumer products groups, auto claims and others. The Company believes that the business process outsourcing services that it provides to customers in industries
other than auto claims such as travel, insurance, banking and financial services, healthcare, utilities, retail and consumer products groups and others that are similar in terms of services, service delivery methods, use of technology, and long-term
gross profit and hence meet the aggregation criteria in accordance with IFRS 8. WNS Assistance and Accidents Happen Assistance Limited (which constitutes WNS Auto Claims BPM), which provide automobile claims handling services, do not meet the
aggregation criteria. Accordingly, the Company has determined that it has two reportable segments WNS Global BPM and WNS Auto Claims BPM.
The Chief Operating Decision Maker (CODM) has been identified as the Group Chief Executive Officer. The CODM evaluates the Companys
performance and allocates resources based on revenue growth of vertical structure.
In order to provide accident management services, the Company arranges
for the repair through a network of repair centers. Repair costs paid to automobile repair centers are invoiced to customers and recognized as revenue except the cases where the Company has concluded that it is not the principal in providing claims
handling services and hence it would be appropriate to record revenue from repair services on a net basis i.e. net of repair cost. The Company uses revenue less repair payments for Fault repairs as a primary measure to allocate resources
and measure segment performance. Revenue less repair payments is a non-GAAP measure which is calculated as (a) revenue less (b) in the Companys auto claims business, payments to repair centers for Fault repair cases where
the Company acts as the principal in its dealings with the third party repair centers and its clients. For Non-fault repairs, revenue including repair payments is used as a primary measure. As the Company provides a consolidated suite of
accident management services including credit hire and credit repair for its Non-fault repairs business, the Company believes that measurement of that line of business has to be on a basis that includes repair payments in revenue.
F - 65
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
The segment results for the year ended March 31, 2015 are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, 2015 |
|
|
|
WNS Global BPM |
|
|
WNS Auto Claims BPM |
|
|
Inter segments* |
|
|
Total |
|
Revenue from external customers |
|
$ |
472,840 |
|
|
$ |
61,053 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
533,893 |
|
Segment revenue |
|
$ |
473,056 |
|
|
$ |
61,053 |
|
|
$ |
(216 |
) |
|
$ |
533,893 |
|
Payments to repair centers |
|
|
|
|
|
|
30,878 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
30,878 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenue less repair payments |
|
|
473,056 |
|
|
|
30,175 |
|
|
|
(216 |
) |
|
|
503,015 |
|
Depreciation |
|
|
14,027 |
|
|
|
360 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
14,387 |
|
Other costs |
|
|
360,299 |
|
|
|
24,403 |
|
|
|
(216 |
) |
|
|
384,486 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Segment operating profit |
|
|
98,730 |
|
|
|
5,412 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
104,142 |
|
Other income, net |
|
|
(11,140 |
) |
|
|
(772 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
(11,912 |
) |
Finance expense |
|
|
1,332 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,332 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Segment profit before income taxes |
|
|
108,538 |
|
|
|
6,184 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
114,722 |
|
Provision for income taxes |
|
|
21,246 |
|
|
|
1,171 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
22,417 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Segment profit |
|
|
87,292 |
|
|
|
5,013 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
92,305 |
|
Amortization of intangible assets |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
24,192 |
|
Share based compensation expense |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
9,499 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Profit |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$ |
58,614 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Addition to non-current assets |
|
$ |
20,923 |
|
|
$ |
1,785 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
22,708 |
|
Total assets, net of elimination |
|
|
393,152 |
|
|
|
137,149 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
530,301 |
|
Total liabilities, net of elimination |
|
$ |
78,539 |
|
|
$ |
62,656 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
141,195 |
|
* |
Transactions between inter segments represent invoices raised by WNS Global BPM on WNS Auto Claims BPM for business process outsourcing services rendered by the former to latter. |
One customer in the WNS Global BPM segment accounted for 13.4% of the Companys total revenue for the year ended March 31, 2015. The receivables
from this customer comprised 9.8% of the Companys total accounts receivables as at March 31, 2015.
F - 66
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
The segment results for the year ended March 31, 2014 are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, 2014 |
|
|
|
WNS Global BPM |
|
|
WNS Auto Claims BPM |
|
|
Inter segments* |
|
|
Total |
|
Revenue from external customers |
|
$ |
439,654 |
|
|
$ |
62,967 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
502,621 |
|
Segment revenue |
|
$ |
439,916 |
|
|
$ |
62,967 |
|
|
$ |
(262 |
) |
|
$ |
502,621 |
|
Payments to repair centers |
|
|
|
|
|
|
31,100 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
31,100 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenue less repair payments |
|
|
439,916 |
|
|
|
31,867 |
|
|
|
(262 |
) |
|
|
471,521 |
|
Depreciation |
|
|
13,366 |
|
|
|
594 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
13,960 |
|
Other costs |
|
|
353,892 |
|
|
|
23,848 |
|
|
|
(262 |
) |
|
|
377,478 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Segment operating profit |
|
|
72,658 |
|
|
|
7,425 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
80,083 |
|
Other income, net |
|
|
(8,600 |
) |
|
|
(925 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
(9,525 |
) |
Finance expense |
|
|
2,948 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,948 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Segment profit before income taxes |
|
|
78,310 |
|
|
|
8,350 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
86,660 |
|
Provision for income taxes |
|
|
12,293 |
|
|
|
1,996 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
14,289 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Segment profit |
|
|
66,017 |
|
|
|
6,354 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
72,371 |
|
Amortization of intangible assets |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
23,789 |
|
Share based compensation expense |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
6,935 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Profit |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$ |
41,647 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Addition to non-current assets |
|
$ |
17,321 |
|
|
$ |
1,487 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
18,808 |
|
Total assets, net of elimination |
|
|
408,972 |
|
|
|
129,453 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
538,425 |
|
Total liabilities, net of elimination |
|
$ |
162,896 |
|
|
$ |
50,559 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
213,455 |
|
* |
Transactions between inter segments represent invoices raised by WNS Global BPM on WNS Auto Claims BPM for business process outsourcing services rendered by the former to latter. |
One customer in the WNS Global BPM segment accounted for 15.2% of the Companys total revenue for the year ended March 31, 2014. The
receivables from this customer comprised 10.4% of the Companys total accounts receivables as at March 31, 2014.
F - 67
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
The segment results for the year ended March 31, 2013 are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended March 31, 2013 |
|
|
|
WNS Global BPM |
|
|
WNS Auto Claims BPM |
|
|
Inter segments* |
|
|
Total |
|
Revenue from external customers |
|
$ |
405,131 |
|
|
$ |
55,132 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
460,263 |
|
Segment revenue |
|
$ |
405,438 |
|
|
$ |
55,132 |
|
|
$ |
(307 |
) |
|
$ |
460,263 |
|
Payments to repair centers |
|
|
|
|
|
|
24,133 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
24,133 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenue less repair payments |
|
|
405,438 |
|
|
|
30,999 |
|
|
|
(307 |
) |
|
|
436,130 |
|
Depreciation |
|
|
13,694 |
|
|
|
1,015 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
14,709 |
|
Other costs |
|
|
335,008 |
|
|
|
24,898 |
|
|
|
(307 |
) |
|
|
359,599 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Segment operating profit |
|
|
56,736 |
|
|
|
5,086 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
61,822 |
|
Other expense/(income), net |
|
|
(3,952 |
) |
|
|
(815 |
) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
(4,767 |
) |
Finance expense |
|
|
3,633 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3,633 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Segment profit before income taxes |
|
|
57,055 |
|
|
|
5,901 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
62,956 |
|
Provision for income taxes |
|
|
8,893 |
|
|
|
971 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
9,864 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Segment profit |
|
|
48,162 |
|
|
|
4,930 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
53,092 |
|
Amortization of intangible assets |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
26,350 |
|
Share based compensation expense |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5,343 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Profit |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$ |
21,399 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Addition to non-current assets |
|
$ |
28,214 |
|
|
$ |
1,150 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
29,364 |
|
Total assets, net of elimination |
|
|
423,309 |
|
|
|
111,584 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
534,893 |
|
Total liabilities, net of elimination |
|
$ |
188,669 |
|
|
$ |
45,627 |
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
234,296 |
|
* |
Transactions between inter segments represent invoices raised by WNS Global BPM on WNS Auto Claims BPM for business process outsourcing services rendered by the former to latter. |
One customer in the WNS Global BPM segment accounted for 16.9% of the Companys total revenue for the year ended March 31, 2013. The
receivables from this customer comprised 9.1% of the Companys total accounts receivables as at March 31, 2013.
F - 68
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
External Revenue
Revenues from the geographic segments based on domicile of the customer. The Companys external revenue by geographic area is as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended |
|
|
|
March 31, 2015 |
|
|
March 31, 2014 |
|
|
March 31, 2013 |
|
Jersey, Channel Islands |
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
UK |
|
|
281,928 |
|
|
|
265,026 |
|
|
|
245,300 |
|
US |
|
|
138,501 |
|
|
|
137,369 |
|
|
|
140,218 |
|
Europe (excluding UK) |
|
|
28,758 |
|
|
|
26,989 |
|
|
|
27,291 |
|
South Africa |
|
|
17,405 |
|
|
|
20,502 |
|
|
|
14,238 |
|
Australia |
|
|
34,193 |
|
|
|
18,510 |
|
|
|
10,830 |
|
Rest of the world |
|
|
33,108 |
|
|
|
34,225 |
|
|
|
22,386 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
533,893 |
|
|
$ |
502,621 |
|
|
$ |
460,263 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The Companys non-current assets (excluding goodwill and intangibles) by geographic area are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at March 31, |
|
|
|
2015 |
|
|
2014 |
|
Jersey, Channel Islands |
|
$ |
|
|
|
$ |
|
|
UK |
|
|
4,133 |
|
|
|
3,276 |
|
North America |
|
|
3,266 |
|
|
|
3,774 |
|
India |
|
|
28,066 |
|
|
|
22,605 |
|
South Africa |
|
|
2,830 |
|
|
|
4,126 |
|
Philippines |
|
|
4,420 |
|
|
|
5,734 |
|
Rest of the world |
|
|
5,515 |
|
|
|
5,650 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total |
|
$ |
48,230 |
|
|
$ |
45,165 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
27. Commitment and Contingencies
Leases
The Company has entered into various
non-cancelable operating lease agreements for certain delivery centers and offices with original lease periods expiring between fiscal 2016 and 2028. The details of future minimum lease payments under non-cancelable operating leases as at
March 31, 2015 are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Operating lease |
|
Less than 1 year |
|
$ |
18,225 |
|
1-3 years |
|
|
25,266 |
|
3-5 years |
|
|
14,910 |
|
More than 5 years |
|
|
23,128 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total minimum lease payments |
|
$ |
81,529 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
Rental expenses were $23,794, $22,994 and $22,459, respectively, for the years ended March 31, 2015, 2014, and 2013.
F - 69
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
Capital commitments
As at March 31, 2015 and 2014, the Company had committed to spend approximately $3,107 and $3,576, respectively, under agreements to purchase property and
equipment. These amounts are net of capital advances paid in respect of these purchases.
Bank guarantees and others
Certain subsidiaries of the Company hold bank guarantees aggregating $895 and $694 as at March 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively. These guarantees have a
remaining expiry term ranging from one to five years.
Restricted time deposits placed with bankers as security for guarantees given by them to regulatory
authorities aggregating $510 and $881 as at March 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively, are included in other current assets. These deposits represent cash collateral against bank guarantees issued by the banks on behalf of the Company to third
parties.
Contingencies
In the ordinary course of
business, the Company is involved in lawsuits, claims and administrative proceedings. While uncertainties are inherent in the final outcome of these matters, the Company believes, after consultation with counsel, that the disposition of these
proceedings will not have a material adverse effect on the Companys financial position, results of operations or cash flows.
F - 70
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)
28. Additional capital disclosures
The key objective of the Companys capital management is to ensure that it maintains a stable capital structure with the focus on total equity to uphold
investor, creditor, and customer confidence and to ensure future development of its business. The Company focuses on keeping a strong total equity base to ensure independence, security, as well as a high financial flexibility for potential future
borrowings, if required, without impacting the risk profile of the Company.
The capital structure as at March 31, 2015 and 2014 was as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As at |
|
|
|
March 31, 2015 |
|
|
March 31, 2014 |
|
|
% Change |
|
Total equity attributable to the equity shareholders of the Company |
|
$ |
389,106 |
|
|
$ |
324,970 |
|
|
|
20 |
% |
As percentage of total capital |
|
|
94 |
% |
|
|
79 |
% |
|
|
|
|
Short term line of credit |
|
|
12,881 |
|
|
|
58,583 |
|
|
|
|
|
Long term debt(1) |
|
|
12,828 |
|
|
|
26,146 |
|
|
|
|
|
Total debt |
|
$ |
25,709 |
|
|
$ |
84,729 |
|
|
|
(70 |
)% |
As percentage of total capital |
|
|
6 |
% |
|
|
21 |
% |
|
|
|
|
Total capital (debt and equity) |
|
$ |
414,815 |
|
|
$ |
409,698 |
|
|
|
1 |
% |
Note:
The Company is
predominantly equity-financed. This is also evident from the fact that debt represented only 6% and 21% of total capital as at March 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively.
F - 71
Exhibit 4.12
LEASE DEED
THIS LEASE DEED is
made at Gurgaon on this day of , 2014.
BETWEEN
M/s DLF Assets Private
Limited, a company incorporated under the Companies Act, 1956 and having its Registered Office at 1-E, Jhandewalan Extension, Naaz Cinema Complex, New Delhi - 110 055 India (hereinafter referred to as THE LESSOR which
expression shall unless it be repugnant to the context or meaning thereof, be deemed to mean and include its successors, administrators, transferees and assigns) acting through its Authorized Signatories, Mr. Amit Grover and Mr. Navin
Kedia duly authorized vide Board Resolution dated 17th January, 2014 of the First Part.
AND
M/s WNS Global Services Private
Limited, a company incorporated under the Companies Act 1956 and having its Registered Office and Head Office/Corporate Office at Plant No. 10, Gate No. 4, Godrej & Boyce Complex, Pirojshangar, LBS Marg, Vikhroli (West),
Mumbai 400079 (hereinafter referred to as THE LESSEE which expression shall, unless it be repugnant to the context or meaning thereof, be deemed to mean and include its successors) having Permanent Account Number (PAN)
AAACW2598L and Tax Deduction and Collection Account Number (TAN) MUMW01007G, acting through its Authorized Signatory Mr. Varun Vasisht duly authorized vide Board Resolution dated
31st October, 2013 of the Second Part.
(Both THE LESSOR and THE LESSEE are collectively
referred to as the Parties).
- 1 -
WHEREAS:
A. |
DLF Limited has been granted formal approval for the Said Plot (as defined hereinafter) by the Department of Commerce (EPZ Section), Ministry of Commerce & Industry, Government of India, by a letter of
approval (Ref No. F.2/137/2005-EPZ) dated October 25, 2006 and notified vide Notification no. S.O. 2070 (E) dated December 6, 2006 and S.O. 395 (E) dated March 19, 2007, pursuant to the provision of the SEZ Laws;
|
B. |
DLF Limited and THE LESSOR thereafter executed certain agreements which inter alia detailed the terms and conditions with respect to transfer and handing over of certain specified buildings on the Said Plot to
THE LESSOR. By virtue of these agreements and after requisite regulatory approvals including the approvals from the Board of Approval, Ministry of Commerce, Government of India, THE LESSOR became the co-developer with rights to develop, operate and
maintain the Said Building including conversion of Bare Shell building into Warm Shell building. |
C. |
THE LESSOR is seized and possessed of the Said Building developed/ to be developed and is competent to lease office spaces in the Said Building. |
D. |
THE LESSEE has approached THE LESSOR to lease office space(s) in the said Building and THE LESSOR has agreed to lease and THE LESSEE has executed the LOI with THE LESSOR to take on lease the Demised Premises (as
hereinafter defined). |
E. |
Based on the above representations made by THE LESSOR and after due inspection and verification of the Said Plot, the Said Complex (as defined hereinafter), the Said Building and the Demised Premises (as defined
hereinafter) and also all the approvals and sanctions including approved building plans, ownership record of the said Plot, Said Building and other documents relating to the title, competency, and all other relevant details, THE LESSEE is satisfied
in all respects with regard to the right, title, authority and competency of THE LESSOR to enter into this Lease Deed. |
F. |
THE LESSEE hereby confirms that it shall carry out, implement and execute all interior works/ designs in the Demised Premises in compliance/ adherence with the approval/ guidelines issued by THE LESSOR from time
to time for carrying out such interior works in the Demised Premises. |
G. |
THE LESSEE further confirms that it shall obtain/ has obtained all pre-requisite sanctions, approvals, licenses, from all the statutory/ competent authorities which may be necessary for commencement of its
business operations in the Demised Premises. THE LESSEE shall be solely responsible and liable for any action by any authority, claim/ damages etc. arising out of non-compliance thereof. |
- 2 -
H. |
THE LESSEE shall be responsible for compliances of all applicable laws and to perform all of its obligations under this Lease Deed including various permissions and approvals to the extent required to be
observed/ performed by THE LESSEE under the SEZ Laws and THE LESSOR shall not be liable in any manner towards any action/ claims / damages arising due to any non-compliance of any laws and non-fulfillment of any obligations by THE LESSEE.
|
I. |
Upon assurances and representations of THE LESSEE that it shall strictly abide by the covenants contained in this Lease Deed and has all the required and necessary approvals and permissions under the SEZ Laws and
other applicable statutes, bye-laws for operating THE LESSEEs unit in the Demised Premises, THE LESSOR in good faith believing all representations of THE LESSEE to be true, has agreed to give on lease to THE LESSEE, the Demised Premises, on
the terms and conditions recorded herein. |
J. |
THE LESSEE confirms that it is executing this Lease Deed with full knowledge of all the Laws, Bye-laws, Rules, Regulations, Notification etc. which are applicable to the Said Plot, Said Complex, Said Building and
the Demised Premises. |
K. |
Both the Parties have agreed to enter into this Lease Deed on the terms and conditions stipulated in this Lease Deed and as per the commercial terms as provided in the LOI and as annexed hereto as Annexures
C-I(a) and Annexures C-II to C-IV and T-I to T-X annexed hereto. |
NOW THEREFORE IT IS HEREBY AGREED BY AND BETWEEN THE
PARTIES HERETO AS FOLLOWS:
1. |
DEFINITIONS AND INTERPRETATION: |
In this Lease Deed, unless the context otherwise requires, the following
terms shall have the following meanings:
Access Cards shall mean the access cards provided by THE LESSOR to THE LESSEE and /or
its employees.
Bare Shell shall mean the built up structures with lift lobbies, external facades, fire suppression system as
per building norms, cement flooring, no plaster on concrete columns, walls or ceiling except on brick walls.
- 3 -
Car Parking Charges shall mean the charges collectively payable for car parking
spaces and additional car parking spaces (if any), as detailed in Annexure C-I(a).
Demised Premises shall mean super
built up area admeasuring 4,144.102 sq. mtrs. (44,607 sq. ft.) (approx.) on 10th Floor in the Said Building and as more fully described and detailed as per Annexures T-I & T-II.
Due Date shall mean the 1st day of each English calendar month but not later
than 7th day of each English calendar month.
Façade Signage shall
mean the signage which may be put up by THE LESSEE indicating its name or logo and to be put up on an earmarked location with size and specification as approved / permitted by THE LESSOR.
Façade Signage Charges shall mean the annual charges payable by THE LESSEE for putting up the Façade Signage as
detailed in Annexure C-I(a).
IFRESD shall mean the interest free refundable electricity security deposit, as provided
in Annexure C-I(a).
IFRMSD shall mean the interest free refundable maintenance security deposit, as provided in
Annexure C-I(a).
IFRSD shall mean the interest free refundable security deposit, as provided in Annexure C-I(a).
IPR shall mean intellectual property rights collectively including all trade names, trademarks, service marks, brand name(s),
logos, symbols, proprietary marks, etc.
Lease Commencement Date shall mean the date of commencement of Lease Term as provided
in Annexure C-I(a).
Lease Deed shall mean this lease deed executed between THE LESSOR and THE LESSEE and shall include
all the annexures thereto and any amendment/modifications made to this lease deed in accordance with the terms hereto.
Lease Renewal
Term shall mean a further period of 5 years from the expiry of the Lease Term.
Lease Term shall mean a period of 5 years
from the Lease Commencement Date.
- 4 -
Lock-in period shall mean a period as provided in Annexure C I
(a) from the Lease Commencement Date.
LOI shall mean the letter of intent dated 14th February, 2014 in respect of leasing of the Demised Premises.
Letter of
Approval shall mean the letter of approval granted by the concerned authority under the SEZ Laws.
Maintenance
Charges shall mean the monthly charges towards the maintenance services, as provided in Annexure C-I (a).
Property shall collectively mean the Said Plot, the Said Complex and the Said Building.
Rent Commencement Date shall mean the date for commencement of payment of Warm Shell Rent as provided in Annexure C-I(a).
Said Building shall mean tower A2 & A3, of the Said Complex, in Warm Shell condition.
Said Complex shall mean the complex consisting of multi storied towers with basements/ stilt constructed on the Said Plot and known
as DLF World Tech Park, NH8, Gurgaon.
Said Plot shall mean the land measuring 37 Acres situated at NH8, Silokhera, Gurgaon
more fully described in Annexure C-II.
Security Deposits shall mean IFRSD, IFRMSD and IFRESD collectively.
SEZ approvals shall mean the approvals under the SEZ Laws.
SEZ Laws shall mean the Special Economic Zones Act, 2005 and any amendment thereto and the rules and regulations framed thereunder
from time to time.
Taxes on Property shall mean collectively any and all taxes, duties, charges, cesses, levy(ies) etc. on the
Property as may be levied by the Central Government and/or State Government and/or local bodies and/or any other competent authority(ies).
TDS shall mean the tax deducted at source at the applicable rates as per the Income Tax Act or any other tax of similar nature
under any statute as applicable from time to time.
- 5 -
Warm Shell shall mean Bare Shell with complete building atriums, all fittings, air
conditioning ducts, electrical distribution and fire fighting, electricity provisions on each floor up to the shaft, 100% power back up including power back up for air conditioning system and back up air conditioning provision for the office area up
to Air Handling Unit (AHU) on each floor.
Warm Shell Rent shall mean the monthly rent payable for the Demised Premises as
provided in Annexure C-I(a).
1.1 |
In the interpretation of this Lease Deed including the recitals and annexures, unless the context or subject matter otherwise requires: |
|
(a) |
the singular includes the plural and vice versa and in particular (but without limiting the generality of the foregoing) any word or expression defined in the singular shall have a corresponding meaning if used in the
plural and vice versa; |
|
(b) |
a reference to any gender includes the other gender; |
|
(c) |
a reference to any agreement, deed or other instrument (including, without limitation, references to this Lease Deed) includes the same as varied, amended, supplemented, restated, novated or replaced from time to time;
|
|
(d) |
a reference to any statutory provision or to any provision of any legislation includes any modification, amendment or re-enactment of any legislative provision substituted for any or all statutory instruments or
notification issued under such legislation or such provisions; |
|
(e) |
where a word or phrase has a defined meaning, any other part of speech or grammatical form in respect of the word or phrase has a corresponding meaning; and |
|
(f) |
a reference to a clause or annexure is a reference to the relevant clause of or annexure to this Lease Deed. |
1.2 |
In this Lease Deed, headings are for the convenience of reference only and shall not affect interpretation. |
- 6 -
THE LESSOR hereby agrees to grant the Demised Premises on lease to
THE LESSEE and THE LESSEE agrees to take the Demised Premises on lease from THE LESSOR, as per terms and conditions of this Lease Deed, together with the right to park cars in terms of this Lease Deed, in the car parking spaces earmarked by
THE LESSOR in the basement(s)/ stilt/ surface car parking spaces as provided in Annexure T-III of this Lease Deed.
3.1 |
THE LESSEE shall pay the Warm Shell Rent in advance for the month in respect of which such Warm Shell Rent is payable, to THE LESSOR or its nominees/ permitted assigns by cheque/ bank draft/ wire transfer (in accordance
with the ECS form annexed as Annexure C-V of this Lease Deed), payable from the Rent Commencement Date. |
3.2 |
The Warm Shell Rent shall be payable by the Due Date and shall be paid in advance for each month in respect of which the Warm Shell Rent would be payable. |
3.3 |
Any other taxes/ duties/ charges/ cesses / levy(ies) etc. as applicable, from time to time, on Warm Shell Rent including service tax shall be payable by THE LESSEE in addition to the Warm Shell Rent as mentioned
hereinabove. |
3.4 |
Payment of Warm Shell Rent is subject to deduction of TDS. |
3.5 |
Notwithstanding other rights of THE LESSOR as provided in this Lease Deed, all delayed payments under this Lease Deed shall carry an interest of 15% per annum from the Due Date till the date the payments are made.
|
4.1 |
Car parking spaces shall be provided in stilt/ surface/ basement car parking spaces (as applicable) on the Said Plot, the charges for which are detailed in Annexure C-I(a) of this Lease Deed. Any additional car
parking spaces shall be provided, subject to availability, as per the charges detailed in the aforementioned Annexure C-I(a). |
4.2 |
The Car Parking Charges shall be payable by the Due Date and shall be paid in advance for each month in respect of which the Car Parking Charges would be payable. |
4.3 |
Such car parking spaces shall be earmarked for the exclusive use of THE LESSEE and shall not be used by THE LESSEE for storage or any purpose other than parking its cars/ two wheelers. |
- 7 -
4.4 |
The Lock-in Period shall also be applicable to the car parking spaces including any additional car parking spaces. |
4.5 |
Any other taxes/ duties/ charges/ cesses/levy(ies) etc. as applicable from time to time, on the Car Parking Charges including service tax shall be payable by THE LESSEE in addition to the Car Parking Charges as
mentioned hereinabove. |
5.1 |
Lift Lobby and Building Atrium Directory Signage/ Name/ Logo |
5.1.1 |
THE LESSEE may be allowed to put its directional signage/ name/ logo on the lift lobby of the floor occupied by it, at its own cost. |
5.1.2 |
The location for putting such directional signage/ name/ logo and the size of the same shall be subject to prior written approval of THE LESSOR. |
5.1.3 |
All taxes, fee, charges, cess, duties, levy(ies) etc on putting up such directional signage/ name/ logo shall be the sole liability of THE LESSEE and payable directly to the concerned authorities by THE LESSEE, as
applicable from time to time. |
5.1.4 |
THE LESSOR may display THE LESSEEs name/ logo on the building directory signage placed in the atrium of the Said Building as per the location, size and specification of such building directory signage determined
by THE LESSOR. |
5.1.5 |
The aforesaid shall be subject to the laws and regulations, as applicable from time to time. |
5.2.1 |
The Façade Signage Charges shall be payable by THE LESSEE to THE LESSOR or its nominees/ assigns in advance from the Lease Commencement Date or from the date the Façade Signage is taken by THE LESSEE (i.e.
the date on which the addendum for modifying Annexure C-I(a) to this effect is signed between the Parties), whichever is later. |
5.2.2 |
There shall be no refund /adjustment of such Façade Signage Charges on expiry of lease and/ or any earlier termination thereof. |
5.2.3 |
The Façade Signage Charges shall escalate together and as per escalation in Warm Shell Rent as mentioned in Annexure C-I(a). |
- 8 -
5.2.4 |
All taxes including service tax, duties, rates, cesses, costs and charges relating to the Façade Signage, payable to the authorities concerned from time to time, shall be borne and paid by THE LESSEE directly.
|
5.2.5 |
Service tax and any other taxes/duties/charges/levy(ies) etc. as statutorily applicable from time to time on Façade Signage Charges shall be payable by THE LESSEE in addition to the Façade Signage Charges
as mentioned hereinabove. |
5.2.6 |
The above shall be subject to the laws and regulations as applicable from time to time. |
5.2.7 |
No signage of any kind either inside or outside shall be allowed on the façade glass/ columns of the Demised Premises. |
6.1 |
The maintenance services for the Said Plot / Said Complex/Said Building, as set out in Annexure T-IV to this Lease Deed, shall be provided by THE LESSOR or its nominees/ assigns, the estimated Maintenance Charges
for which shall be calculated prorata of the super built up area of the Demised Premises to the total super built-up area of the Property. |
6.2 |
The Maintenance Charges for such maintenance services shall be paid to THE LESSOR or its nominees/ assigns, in advance for each month, as per the bill(s)/ invoice(s) raised by THE LESSOR or its nominees/ assigns.
|
6.3 |
The Maintenance Charges shall be subject to deduction of Income Tax at source as applicable, from time to time. |
6.4 |
Any other taxes/ duties/ charges/ cesses / levy(ies) etc. as applicable from time to time on Maintenance Charges including service tax shall be payable by THE LESSEE in addition to the Maintenance Charges mentioned
hereinabove as and when demanded by THE LESSOR. |
6.5 |
The Maintenance Charges shall be payable by the Due Date, in advance for each month in respect of which such Maintenance Charges would be payable. |
6.6 |
The Maintenance Charges as specified in this Lease Deed are subject to increase of prices of diesel, gas, petroleum products and other consumables, electricity rates, taxes, wages and salaries, cost of annual
maintenance contracts of lifts, DGs, HVAC supplies, transformers, panels etc. during the Lease Term and the Lease Renewal Term (if any). |
- 9 -
6.7 |
After completion of a financial year (i.e. from 1st April of a calendar year to 31st March of the next
calendar year), THE LESSOR or its nominees / assigns will provide THE LESSEE, within a reasonable time period, a third party auditor certificate of expenditure/ expenses towards maintenance charges incurred during such financial year.
|
Any under-recovery by THE LESSOR or its nominees/assigns shall become payable by THE LESSEE to THE LESSOR or its
nominees/assigns and any over-recovery by THE LESSOR or its nominees/assigns shall become refundable by THE LESSOR/ or its nominees/assigns to THE LESSEE. Any such payment by refund to THE LESSEE shall be without any interest and such payment shall
be payable by either party within thirty (30) days of providing such third party auditor certificate and issuance of credit/ debit note (as applicable).
7. |
POWER/ ELECTRICITY/ POWER BACK-UP CHARGES: |
7.1 |
The power/ electricity and power back-up for the Said Plot/ Said Complex/ Said Building/ Demised Premises will be provided by grid (as per availability) or private utility companies or generator sets, the charges of
which will be as per Annexure C-I(a) of this Lease Deed. |
7.2 |
Separate meters will be installed by THE LESSOR for recording the consumption of power, power back up, AHU electrical usage and water in the Demised Premises. The cost for such meters, if applicable, shall be payable by
THE LESSOR as a one-time non-refundable cost. Alternatively, the monthly meter hire charges, if applicable, shall be payable by THE LESSEE separately along with the monthly power consumption charges. |
7.3 |
The bills for such charges shall be raised by THE LESSOR or its nominees/ assigns as per the meter reading and shall be payable by THE LESSEE by the due date as mentioned in such bills. |
8.1 |
Interest Free Refundable Security Deposit (IFRSD) |
8.1.1 |
THE LESSEE shall pay and always maintain the IFRSD as per details given in Annexure-C-I(a) with THE LESSOR, during the Lease Term and the Lease Renewal Term, if any. |
8.1.2 |
The aforesaid IFRSD shall automatically stand proportionately increased and payable upon escalation in Warm Shell Rent, as mentioned in Annexure C-I(a) of this Lease Deed and shall be paid by THE LESSEE along
with the first payment of the escalated Warm Shell Rent to THE LESSOR. |
- 10 -
8.2 |
Interest Free Refundable Maintenance Security Deposit (IFRMSD)- |
8.2.1 |
THE LESSEE shall pay and always maintain the IFRMSD as per details given in Annexure-C-I(a) with THE LESSOR or its nominees/ assigns, during the Lease Term and the Lease Renewal Term, if any. |
8.3 |
Interest Free Refundable Electricity Security Deposit (IFRESD) |
8.3.1 |
THE LESSEE shall pay and always maintain with THE LESSOR, the IFRESD as per details given in Annexure-C-I(a) for an amount for power load of 0.006 KVA per sq.ft. for the Demised Premises provided by THE
LESSOR for internal lighting and power (excluding HVAC load) during the Lease Term and the Lease Renewal Term, if any. |
8.3.2 |
Any additional power load required by THE LESSEE shall be provided not exceeding 3% of 0.006 KVA per sq.ft. of the Demised Premises, subject to availability and on payment of a non-refundable charge of Rs. 10,000/- per
KVA of power load in addition to the refundable deposit of Rs. 3,000/- per KVA of power load. However, any additional infrastructure cost required for supply of power from the source of power to the electrical tap off box on the floor shall be borne
by THE LESSEE at cost + 20% basis. Any additional power load requirement beyond 3% of 0.006 KVA per sq.ft of leased area and the payment thereof shall be subject to mutual agreement between the Parties. |
8.3.3 |
Any deposit/ charges as may be demanded by the grid/ utility companies supplying power to the Demised Premises/ Said Building/ Said Complex from time to time, shall be additionally payable by THE LESSEE on the basis of
proportionate electricity load provided to the Demised Premises, prior to such connection. |
8.4 |
Refund of Security Deposits |
The Security Deposits, shall be the amounts kept with THE
LESSOR against due performance of obligations and payments of all dues by THE LESSEE under the Lease Deed. THE LESSOR shall be entitled, at any time with intimation to THE LESSEE, to utilize and make deduction(s) from the Security Deposits, of an
amount, which in the opinion of THE LESSOR, is/ are equivalent to the outstanding dues of THE LESSEE, or for making good any loss or damage caused or permitted to be caused to THE LESSOR or Demised Premises by THE LESSEE. THE LESSEE shall be
required to forthwith replenish the Security Deposits to the full amount upon any deduction(s) made by THE LESSOR under any provision of this Lease Deed.
- 11 -
THE LESSOR shall provide to THE LESSEE the statement of the outstanding dues payable by THE
LESSEE, if any, and other estimated charges payable under the Lease Deed, supported with relevant documents, Fifteen (15) days prior to the expiry of the Lease Term/ Lease Renewal Term (if any) and THE LESSEE undertakes to clear the aforesaid
amounts and provide the TDS certificates regarding the payments made to THE LESSOR within the permissible time frame as per the income tax regulations.
Simultaneous to the expiry/ earlier termination of this Lease Deed and upon THE LESSEE surrendering peaceful, vacant and physical possession of
the Demised Premises in as good condition as it was in at the time when THE LESSEE was handed over the Demised Premises for fit outs, reasonable wear and tear excepted, subject to THE LESSEE making payment of any and all outstanding dues/ claims for
damages (if any) under this Lease Deed or Lease Renewal Term (if any) separately to THE LESSOR, THE LESSOR shall refund all Security Deposits as mentioned above to THE LESSEE, without any interest.
However, such refund is subject to adjustment or deduction of dues with respect to the TDS (if any) and outstanding dues under this Lease Deed
including Warm shell Rent, Maintenance Charges, Power Charges/ claims for damages (if any) under this Lease Deed or renewal thereof, if the above are not paid by THE LESSEE.
In case of any delay by THE LESSOR in refunding the Security Deposits to THE LESSEE as aforesaid, provided such delay is not attributable to
THE LESSEE, THE LESSOR shall pay an interest of 15% per annum for the period of such delay.
9.1 |
In addition to the payments mentioned in preceding clauses, Taxes on Property are payable/ reimbursable by THE LESSEE calculated prorata of the super built up area of the Demised Premises to the total super built-up
area of the Property as well as payable/reimbursable in respect of car parking spaces, if applicable. |
9.2 |
Taxes on Property as presently levied and all increases and/ or fresh impositions thereof as levied both prospectively and retrospectively and shall be payable/ reimbursable from the Lease Commencement Date and till the
occupancy period by THE LESSEE or the Lock-in period, whichever is later, as applicable. |
- 12 -
9.3 |
Taxes on Property shall be paid/ reimbursed by THE LESSEE to THE LESSOR, within fifteen (15) days of the date of invoice/ demand raised/ made by THE LESSOR, giving details thereof duly supported with copies of
relevant documents, if any. |
9.4 |
Any penalties/ interest arising due to delayed payments/ reimbursements by THE LESSEE shall be solely to THE LESSEEs account. Similarly, any penalties arising due to delayed payments by THE LESSOR shall be solely
to THE LESSORs account. |
10.1 |
Unless earlier terminated in accordance with the terms of this Lease Deed, the lease shall be valid for the Lease Term. |
10.2 |
The Parties shall comply with the SEZ Laws and shall keep their SEZ approvals valid during the entire Lease Term and Lease Renewal Term (if any). |
10.3 |
THE LESSEE agrees that in the event the Letter of Approval granted to THE LESSEE expires or is withdrawn or cancelled for any reason whatsoever by the concerned authority under the SEZ Laws, then in such an event the
Lease Deed shall stand automatically terminated on such expiry / withdrawal / cancellation without any further notice from THE LESSOR. In such an event of expiry / termination/ cancellation of the letter of approval then it shall be treated as
termination of the Lease Deed under Clause 12.1 and shall be liable of consequences as stipulated therein. |
11. |
LEASE RENEWAL AND ESCALATION: |
11.1 |
Lease Renewal Term (if any): THE LESSEE shall have the option to renew the Lease Deed for the Lease Renewal Term and such renewal shall be permitted by THE LESSOR, provided that: |
|
(a) |
THE LESSEE has provided THE LESSOR with a written notice at least six (6) months prior to the expiry of the Lease Term, stating its intention to renew the Lease Deed for the Lease Renewal Term; and
|
|
(b) |
THE LESSEE has received approval for such Lease Renewal Term under the provisions of the applicable laws including SEZ Laws. |
11.2 |
Such renewal, if any, shall be subject to performance of its obligations under this Lease Deed by THE LESSEE and execution of a fresh Lease Deed in respect of the Lease Renewal Term before the expiry of the existing
lease tenure. |
11.3 |
The LESSEE shall be liable to pay the escalations in Warm Shell Rent, Car Parking charges and IFRSD (if any) as provided in Annexure C-I(a) during the Lease Term or Lease Renewal Term (if any). |
- 13 -
12. |
LOCK-IN PERIOD/ TERMINATION BY THE LESSEE: |
12.1 |
Termination by THE LESSEE before the expiry of the Lock-in Period: |
THE LESSEE may
terminate the lease, by giving a prior written notice for a period of six (06) months before the expiry of the Lock-in period or by making payment of Warm Shell Rent, Car Parking Charges, Taxes on Property, Façade Signage Charges (if
any), Maintenance Charges, taxes and any other charges in lieu of the said notice period of six (06) months and also the amount equivalent to any rent-free period (period between the Lease Commencement Date and the Rent Commencement Date)
extended to THE LESSEE.
In such an event, THE LESSEE shall also be liable to pay the amount equivalent to the Warm Shell Rent and other
charges as aforesaid for the entire unexpired Lock-in period or the date of expiry of the Six (06) months notice period mentioned herein above, whichever is later and handover the peaceful, physical and vacant possession of the Demised Premises
to THE LESSOR in as good condition as it was in at the time when THE LESSEE was handed over the Demised Premises for fit outs, reasonable wear and tear excepted. In the event THE LESSEE fails to handover the Demised Premises to THE LESSOR upon
termination as aforesaid, then THE LESSEE shall be treated as an unauthorized occupant and shall also be liable to pay use and occupation charges as provided in clause 15.1 of this Lease Deed.
12.2 |
Termination by THE LESSEE after the expiry of the Lock-in Period: |
THE LESSEE may
terminate the lease, by giving a prior written notice for a period of six (06) months anytime after the expiry of the Lock-in period, or alternatively by making payment of Warm Shell Rent, Car Parking Charges, Taxes on Property, Façade
Signage Charges (if any), Maintenance Charges, taxes and any other charges in lieu of the said notice period and handover the peaceful, physical and vacant possession of the Demised Premises to THE LESSOR in as good condition as it was in at the
time when THE LESSEE was handed over the Demised Premises for fit outs, reasonable wear and tear excepted. In the event THE LESSEE fails to handover the Demised Premises to THE LESSOR upon termination as aforesaid, then THE LESSEE shall be treated
as an unauthorized occupant and shall also be liable to pay use and occupation charges as provided in clause 15.1 of this Lease Deed.
- 14 -
12.3 |
Notice Period for termination of the Lease Renewal Term (if any): Prior written notice of Six (06) months shall be given by THE LESSEE to THE LESSOR for termination of the Lease Renewal Term (if any) and in that
event, provisions of Clause 12.2 shall be applicable. |
12.4 |
THE LESSEE shall pay the Warm Shell Rent and other charges as stipulated in Clause 12.1 and 12.2 above (as the case may be) in case the lease is terminated under Clause 14 of this Lease Deed. |
12.5 |
THE LESSEE shall not be entitled to raise any dispute or claim on any amount payable to/ claimed by THE LESSOR as stated above. |
13. |
DEFAULT IN PAYMENT BY THE LESSEE: |
In case THE LESSEE defaults in making payments under
the Lease Deed, the following shall be applicable:
13.1 |
Beyond Seven (07) days from the Due Date: An interest of 15% per annum shall be applicable on the unpaid amounts, from the Due Date till the date of such payment to THE LESSOR. |
13.2 |
Beyond Sixty (60) days from the Due Date: THE LESSOR or its nominee/assign shall, in its sole discretion and with prior intimation of seven (07) days, stop supplying to THE LESSEE electricity / air
conditioning/ water and / or all other services and resume the services only after receiving full payment of any and all dues, payable including interest payable thereon as stated above. |
13.3 |
The aforesaid is in addition to any other remedies/ actions THE LESSOR may take and THE LESSOR shall have no responsibility or liability for any costs, loss and damage, if any, suffered by THE LESSEE on account of same.
THE LESSEE shall not be entitled to lodge any claim whatsoever against THE LESSOR as a result of such action. |
14. |
TERMINATION OF LEASE FOR NON-PAYMENT/ BREACH (ES) BY THE LESSEE AND/ OR INSOLVENCY OF THE LESSEE: |
14.1 |
The lease shall stand terminated after prior notice of fifteen (15) days to THE LESSEE by THE LESSOR in the following events: |
|
a) |
On failure of THE LESSEE to pay the amount payable under the Lease Deed for seventy five (75) days from the Due Date; or |
|
b) |
On failure to remedy the breach of any of covenant or conditions of the Lease Deed despite of issuance of written notice by THE LESSOR stating such breach/default and demanding rectification thereof within fifteen
(15) days of the date of the notice. |
- 15 -
In such cases, on or before the expiry of the notice period as aforesaid, THE LESSEE shall hand
over peaceful, vacant and physical possession of the Demised Premises in as good condition as it was in at the time when THE LESSEE was handed over the Demised Premises for fit outs, reasonable wear and tear excepted, to THE LESSOR and shall make
payments of all outstanding dues and all claims for damages (if any) under this Lease Deed or Lease Renewal Term (if any) to THE LESSOR, including payment of all dues under the Lease Deed for the termination notice period of six (06) months in
case the balance Lease Term or Lease Renewal Term after such termination is more than six (06) months and for the balance unexpired Lease Term or Lease Renewal Term in case the balance Lease Term or Lease Renewal Term after such termination is
less than six (06) months.
14.2 |
Subject to clause 29.3, THE LESSEE represents and agrees that it shall maintain its corporate/ juridical existence during the Lease Term or Lease Renewal Term. In the event, THE LESSEE files a petition for being
declared as insolvent and/ or fails to maintain its corporate/ juridical existence and/ or is adjudicated as insolvent, then the lease shall forthwith stand terminated and THE LESSEE shall be treated as an unauthorized occupant for the Demised
Premises and shall also be liable to pay use and occupation charges as provided in clause 15.1 of this Lease Deed. In such an event, THE LESSOR shall enter into the Demised Premises to assume the possession which shall be without prejudice to the
rights of THE LESSOR to claim/ recover its dues along with interest/ damages under the Lease Deed, till the date of such termination. |
Notwithstanding the above, THE LESSOR may in its sole discretion with intimation to THE LESSEE, adjust all outstanding amounts payable under
this Lease Deed, by THE LESSEE, against the Security Deposits paid by THE LESSEE, and any shortfall after such adjustment (if any) shall be paid by THE LESSEE immediately to THE LESSOR.
- 16 -
15. |
USE AND OCCUPATION CHARGES BEYOND TERMINATION OF LEASE: |
15.1 |
If the lease is terminated by either party or expires by efflux of time and Demised Premises is not vacated and handed over by THE LESSEE in accordance with the terms of this Lease Deed, THE LESSEE shall be liable to
pay use and occupation charges for each day of occupation calculated on the basis of three (03) times the Warm Shell Rent divided by 30 days i.e. Rs.1,82,889/- per day (Rupees One Lakh Eighty Two Thousand Eight Hundred and Eighty Nine only per
day), along with amount equivalent to Warm Shell Rent, Car Parking Charges, Façade Signage Charges (if any), Maintenance Charges, taxes and any other charges as provided in Annexure C-I(a) till the handover of the Demised Premises by
THE LESSEE to THE LESSOR. |
15.2 |
THE LESSEE agrees not to raise any claims/ dispute(s) in this regard and the aforesaid right(s) of THE LESSOR shall be without prejudice to the rights and remedies of THE LESSOR under the Lease Deed and under any law
for the time being in force. |
16.1 |
During the Lease Term and the Lease Renewal Term (if any), THE LESSOR shall obtain fire and earth quake insurance coverage of the entire Said Building, insurance cover against third-party liability and shall make timely
payment of all insurance premiums. |
16.2 |
During the Lease Term and the Lease Renewal Term (if any), THE LESSEE shall obtain comprehensive insurance coverage, including third-party coverage, of all interior works while carrying out interiors or renovations,
furniture, equipment and/or other items kept or stored in the Demised Premises, and shall make timely payments of all insurance premia. THE LESSOR shall in no way be responsible for any loss occasioned by THE LESSEE on account of not obtaining
comprehensive insurance coverage as stated above. |
16.3 |
However, it is made clear between the Parties that in the event of an accident or fire or damages or for any other reason resulting in any loss, financial or otherwise to either party or to third parties, both Parties
agree to take up the matter with their respective insurance companies through the insurance cover including third party liability. |
16.4 |
Either party shall not do or permit to be done or shall not omit to be done any act or thing which may render void or voidable any insurance relating to or in respect of a part or the whole of the Said Plot, the Said
Building or the Demised Premises, or cause any increase in premium payable by other party in respect thereof. |
- 17 -
17. |
ENTRY BY ACCESS CARDS: (AS AND WHEN APPLICABLE) |
17.1 |
Entry to the Said Building/ Said Complex by THE LESSEE and its employees shall be permitted only through the Access Cards. |
17.2 |
Any loss of Access Card shall be intimated to THE LESSOR immediately to avoid misuse thereof. |
17.3 |
Any additional/ replacement of any lost Access Card will be provided within 5 days from the date of request of such Access Card by THE LESSEE and till the time such Access Cards are issued, the entry to the Said
Building shall be allowed to the employees/ visitors of THE LESSEE through temporary visitor Access Cards provided by THE LESSOR. |
17.4 |
The charges for issuance of Access Card shall be Rs. 20/- per Access Card. |
17.5 |
Upon cessation or termination of any employee(s), THE LESSEE shall intimate and return the Access Card(s) of such employee(s) to THE LESSOR immediately. |
17.6 |
The Access Card management for the Demised Premises shall be done by THE LESSEE, at its own cost, for its employees through a unique password and training. |
17.7 |
In addition, any SEZ Access Cards may be separately issued as per the policy/ guidelines of the SEZ/ concerned authorities, at an additional cost. |
18. |
TENTATIVE SPECIFICATIONS/ NAMING RIGHTS/ DISPLAY ETC. |
18.1 |
TENTATIVE SPECIFICATIONS OF THE SAID BUILDING/ DEMISED PREMISES: |
The specifications and
information as to the materials used in construction of the Said Building are set out in Annexure T-V and Annexure T-VI of this Lease Deed and any change in the specifications required by THE LESSEE, shall be charged at 1.2 times the
actual cost subject to feasibility thereof and subject to necessary approvals/ applicable laws, rules and regulations as applicable from time to time.
18.2 |
BUILDING NAMING RIGHTS: |
18.2.1 |
THE LESSOR reserves the naming rights of the Said Building/ Said Complex. |
18.2.2 |
The occupants may use such name of the Said Building/ Said Complex in the business addresses for all purposes. |
- 18 -
18.2.3 |
THE LESSEE shall not raise any objection if THE LESSOR changes the name of the Said Building/ Said Complex at any time in its sole discretion. |
18.3 |
THE LESSORs RIGHT TO MAKE ADDITIONS: |
18.3.1 |
THE LESSOR shall have absolute right to make additions, raise storeys or put up additional structures in and around the Said Building, without any hindrance to THE LESSEEs right to use or enjoy peaceful possession
and its conduct of business. THE LESSEE shall have no right to raise any objection for such additions etc. by THE LESSOR. |
18.3.2 |
Any such additional structures and storeys shall be the sole property of THE LESSOR, which THE LESSOR will be entitled to make use of or dispose of in any way it chooses without any reference to THE LESSEE.
|
18.4 |
DISPLAY OF MULTIMEDIA/VISUAL FORMAT: |
THE LESSEE acknowledges that THE LESSOR or its
nominees/assigns have the right to install posters, banners, contra-visions and displays of any multimedia/ visual format in the areas like lift lobbies, atrium(s), lifts, outer glass façade, curtain walls, external walls etc. of the Said
Building/ Said Complex and THE LESSEE shall not object to any such installation by THE LESSOR.
19.1 |
For carrying out interior/ fitout works, THE LESSEEs architect shall coordinate with THE LESSORs architect for approval of the drawing(s)/plan(s) and sanctions if any required by THE LESSEE. THE LESSEE shall
submit all the interior works drawings together as per Annexure T-IX attached herewith. THE LESSOR shall revert back on the drawings/ plans submitted by THE LESSEE within fifteen (15) days of such submission by THE LESSEE and Such
approvals shall not be unreasonably withheld by THE LESSOR. However, the Lease Commencement Date and the Rent Commencement Date shall not be deferred for any delay on this account. |
19.2 |
During the period of carrying interior/ fit out works, THE LESSEE shall take all precautions, fire and safety measures and cover its risks and THE LESSOR shall not be liable/ responsible for any loss or damage suffered
by THE LESSEE including but not limited to its materials and to third parties. Further, THE LESSEE shall keep THE LESSSOR indemnified and make good any loss or damage suffered by THE LESSOR due to any act of negligence, omission or commission of THE
LESSEE, its contractors, agents, employees, workmen of the contractors including but not limited to failure to comply with statutory and regulatory requirements. During such period, THE LESSEE shall be liable to pay electricity, water, power charges
and charges for security services at actuals plus 20%. |
- 19 -
19.3 |
THE LESSEE hereby confirms that it shall carry out, implement and execute all interior works/ designs/ alterations in the Demised Premises in compliance/ adherence with the approval/ guidelines issued by THE LESSOR and
the concerned authority(ies) from time to time for carrying out such interior works in the Demised Premises and in accordance with the local laws/bye laws and NBC as applicable and a certificate from a reputed consultant to that effect shall be
provided to THE LESSOR before starting the interior fit out work. After the completion of the interior/ fit out works, THE LESSEE shall provide to THE LESSOR a certificate from a reputed consultant verifying that the interior/ fit out works have
been carried out by THE LESSEE as per the drawings approved by THE LESSOR and in accordance with the local laws/ bye laws and NBC, as applicable, certifying that all safety measures have been taken care of including connection of fire panel with THE
LESSORs fire panel. THE LESSOR shall have the right to inspect and verify the same either directly or through its nominee/assigns. |
19.4 |
For any interior/ fit out works including any additions/ modifications/ alterations in the Demised Premises in accordance with the National Building Code as applicable, THE LESSEE shall carry out such works without
altering/ tampering with the fire fighting and fire detection systems as installed therein. However any additions/ modifications/ alterations to the existing fire fighting and fire detection system shall be done by THE LESSEE only after obtaining
prior written approval from THE LESSOR and by providing alternate and stand by fire fighting systems during all such works in the Demised Premises. |
19.5 |
THE LESSEE shall not carry out any work involving structural alterations/ cutting/ chopping/ digging/ hacking/ dismantling in any manner or form/ destroying the floors or walls of the Demised Premises or the Said
Building without prior written permission of THE LESSOR. |
19.6 |
THE LESSEE shall be directly liable for any legal or financial consequences arising out of such interior/ fit out works including liability towards any third party and all damages to the Demised Premises/ Said Building
or loss of life arising out of such interior/ fit out works shall be the sole responsibility of THE LESSEE. |
19.7 |
THE LESSEEs responsibilities during interior works as stated above are more detailed in Annexure T-X to this Lease Deed. |
- 20 -
20. |
FIRE FIGHTING AND FIRE DETECTION SYSTEM(S): |
20.1 |
The fire fighting and fire detection system, which is provided by THE LESSOR in accordance with National Building Code, is limited to installation of sprinklers and fire detection system in the basement(s) and common
areas of the Said Building such as lobbies, staircases corridors, etc. and service shaft for fire fighting and sprinkler services on each floor. |
20.2 |
Any kind of hazard including fire, electrical or otherwise from the Demised Premises due to inadequate fire fighting system installed by THE LESSEE or faulty installation of air-conditioning, electrical systems and
other equipment shall be the sole responsibility of THE LESSEE and THE LESSOR shall not be liable for any legal or financial consequences arising therefrom and THE LESSEE agrees to keep THE LESSOR indemnified and harmless in this regard at all
times. |
20.3 |
THE LESSEE shall allow third party fire/ safety experts being appointed by THE LESSOR/ its nominees for fire/ safety audit at all times. |
20.4 |
THE LESSEE shall take all steps including appointing a safety representative/ manager to ensure that all safety related activities within the Demised Premises are performed. THE LESSEE shall have the audit of their
entire electrical systems, fire fighting systems and HVAC systems done on a half-yearly basis by a reputed consultant and submit a certificate to THE LESSORs building manager certifying that all THE LESSEEs installations are in good and
safe working condition and do not have any possibility of short circuit and/or becoming a fire source. |
21. |
ADDITIONAL FIRE FIGHTING SYSTEM(S): |
21.1 |
For any additional fire safety measures required due to statutory /governmental directives, THE LESSOR shall undertake the same and THE LESSEE shall reimburse to THE LESSOR the cost thereof, calculated at actual cost
plus 20% basis, proportionate of the super built up area of the Demised Premises to the total super built-up area of the Property. |
21.2 |
For any additional fire safety measures required by THE LESSEE in the Demised Premises, THE LESSOR may undertake the same and THE LESSEE shall reimburse to THE LESSOR the cost thereof, calculated at actual cost+20%
basis, or alternatively THE LESSEE may undertake the same themselves, however, subject to THE LESSORs prior written approval on the same. |
21.3 |
In case THE LESSOR suggests any additional fire fighting or fire detection systems to THE LESSEE which may or may not be statutorily required, for installation by THE LESSEE within the Demised Premises and THE LESSEE
fails to implement THE LESSORs suggestion either fully or in part, then THE LESSEE alone shall be liable and responsible for all consequences arising from such inaction/decision on its part. |
21.4 |
All cost for such installation(s) of any additional fire fighting systems are non-refundable and shall be borne by THE LESSEE alone. |
- 21 -
22.1 |
THE LESSEE shall plan and distribute its electrical loads in the Demised Premises in conformity with the electrical systems installed by THE LESSOR, with prior written approval of THE LESSOR. |
22.2 |
Any modifications, additions, alterations in electrical and other systems already installed in the Demised Premises/ Said Building, if required and feasible as assessed by THE LESSOR in line with the base building
design, will be done by THE LESSOR and payable by THE LESSEE calculated at 1.2 times of actual costs incurred by THE LESSOR. |
23. |
MAINTENANCE & MINOR REPAIRS: |
THE LESSEE shall carry out the day-to-day
maintenance including minor repairs, distempering and polishing the interiors of the Demised Premises and the fixtures and fittings installed therein at its own cost.
24. |
COMMON AREA/ FACILITIES: |
24.1 |
THE LESSEE is entitled to use the common areas, facilities and amenities within the Said Building/ Said Complex/ Said Plot, as available, only subject to the timely payment of Maintenance Charges payable under this
Lease Deed. |
24.2 |
In the event of failure of timely payment of Maintenance Charges as aforesaid, THE LESSEE shall not have the right to use or demand use of aforesaid facilities. |
24.3 |
THE LESSEE shall not use the common areas including fire exits/ basements etc. of the Said Building/ Said Complex/ Said Plot for storage purpose or create any obstructions in the same. |
24.4 |
THE LESSEE shall only have the right to use and shall have no ownership rights, title, and interest or claim whatsoever in the Said Plot, common areas, facilities and amenities within the Said Building.
|
- 22 -
25. |
INSPECTION OF DEMISED PREMISES: |
25.1 |
THE LESSEE shall allow THE LESSOR and its agents to enter the Demised Premises after prior intimation, except in case of emergency(ies) including any fire etc., for inspection or any maintenance related issues at the
frequency it may deem fit including any emergency and/ or unforeseen circumstances or any inspection by Government agency or under its directions. |
25.2 |
However, for periodic inspections, two (02) days advance intimation will be given in writing to THE LESSEE, except in case of emergency (ies) and/or unforeseen circumstances. |
26. |
REINSTATEMENT OF DEMISED PREMISES: |
THE LESSEE shall hand over the peaceful, vacant and
physical possession of the Demised Premises in as good condition as it was in at the time when THE LESSEE was handed over the Demised Premises for fit outs, together with THE LESSORs fixtures and fittings installed therein, if any, (normal
wear and tear excepted) on the expiry /earlier termination of the Lease Deed, whichever is earlier.
27. |
USAGE OF DEMISED PREMISES BY THE LESSEE: |
27.1 |
THE LESSEE shall use the Demised Premises for IT/ ITeS usage as per the rules and regulations as may be applicable from time to time for such usage including the State and Central SEZ Act and the rules framed
thereunder. |
27.2 |
THE LESSEE shall not carry out or permit to be carried out in the Demised Premises or any part thereof any activities which shall be or are likely to be unlawful, obnoxious or creating nuisance, annoyance or disturbance
to other lessees/tenants/occupants of the Said Building. |
27.3 |
The Demised Premises shall be used by THE LESSEE only and THE LESSEE shall not assign, transfer, mortgage, sublease or grant leave & license or transfer or part with or share possession in any manner
whatsoever, of any portion of the Demised Premises. |
27.4 |
THE LESSEE shall not store any goods, hazardous or combustible or heavy in nature, to affect the construction or the structure or common use of the Said Building or any part thereof. |
- 23 -
28. |
SEZ UNIT APPROVAL FOR DEMISED PREMISES: |
28.1 |
THE LESSEE has obtained the SEZ unit approvals for the Demised Premises vide Letter of Approval dated 28th April, 2014, before signing of this Lease Deed and
before taking handover of Demised Premises for interior fit out works/ commencement of interior fit-outs by THE LESSOR (as applicable). |
28.2 |
THE LESSEE shall arrange to get the aforesaid SEZ unit approvals terminated and complete all formalities with regards to such termination at its own cost prior to the expiry/ earlier termination of the Lease Term or
Lease Renewal Term (if any) failing which it will be assumed that the peaceful handover of Demised Premises has not been done by THE LESSEE and THE LESSOR shall be entitled to claim damages, payments and other dues as per the Lease Deed.
|
28.3 |
In the event, THE LESSEE merges/ amalgamates / consolidates and transfer its assets and liabilities with/ to any entity on account of any merger/ amalgamation/ consolidation, then a fresh lease deed shall be executed
between THE LESSOR and the new entity/ transferee, subject to the new entity/ transferee obtaining prior SEZ approval. The new entity/ transferee shall execute an undertaking as per the draft attached as Annexure C-III for the remaining
period of the Lease Term. In case of any outstanding dues payable by THE LESSEE to THE LESSOR as per Lease Deed, such outstanding amounts should be included in the petition to the appropriate court seeking permission for such merger/ amalgamation/
consolidation as applicable under the relevant laws. Pending approval of any merger/ amalgamation/ consolidation, THE LESSEE will continue to make all payments payable as per the Lease Deed. |
28.4 |
All costs, charges, expenses including penalties, payable on or in respect of execution and registration of the fresh Lease Deed and on all other instruments and deeds to be executed pursuant to the fresh Lease Deed
shall be borne and paid solely by new entity/transferee who shall be responsible for compliance of all applicable laws including the provisions of Indian Stamp Act, 1899, Registration Act, etc. |
28.5 |
However, fresh Lease Deed will be executed only after payment of all outstanding dues by THE LESSEE and submission of relevant documents to THE LESSOR. |
- 24 -
29. |
HANDING OVER OF DEMISED PREMISES: |
29.1 |
At the time of handover of the Demised Premises for the interior / fit-out works, THE LESSEE is satisfied that the construction work as also various installations as per Annexure T-V are in good working condition
and issues, if any, with respect thereto have been resolved and rectified before its taking possession of the Demised Premises. |
29.2 |
THE LESSEE confirms that further to its taking possession of the Demised Premises, it shall not require THE LESSOR to undertake any repair, renovation, or improvisation, installations, etc. whatsoever (except structural
repairs required, if any) concerning the Demised Premises, Said Building and the Said Plot. |
30. |
INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHTS (IPR): |
THE LESSEE represents to THE LESSOR that:
30.1 |
It is the owner / licensee of the IPR and has full right, title and interest in the use of such IPR. |
30.2 |
Any IPR if used by THE LESSEE in Demised Premises/Said Building/Said Complex does not and shall not infringe the IPR of any third party. |
30.3 |
THE LESSEE has not received any notice of any claim against it involving any conflict or claim of conflicts with respect to IPR. |
30.4 |
THE LESSEE undertakes to hold THE LESSOR harmless from any action brought about by any third party for any IPR infringement by THE LESSEE. |
30.5 |
THE LESSEE undertakes to defend any and all such acts, suits, proceedings, claims, judgments etc. against THE LESSOR in connection with the IPR used by THE LESSEE in Demised Premises/Said Building/Said Complex and any
fees, costs, expenses of any kind related or incidental to any such action with respect to the IPR used by THE LESSEE in Demised Premises/Said Building/Said Complex of THE LESSEE incurred by THE LESSOR in defending itself shall be borne by THE
LESSEE, which THE LESSEE agrees to pay within seven (07) days of demand by THE LESSOR. |
- 25 -
31.1 |
Both the Parties agree to comply with, through out the Lease Term, at their own cost, all the Laws, Rules, Regulations, and Notifications etc. and their amendments made from time to time, as may be applicable, including
but not limited to the following: |
|
|
|
Environment (Protection) Act, 1986, |
|
|
|
Water (Prevention and Control of Pollution) Act, 1974, |
|
|
|
Air (Prevention and Control of Pollution) Act, 1981, |
|
|
|
Food Safety and Standards Act, 2006 and Rules, 2011, |
|
|
|
Municipal Solid Wastes (Management and Handling) Rules, 2000, |
|
|
|
Hazardous Wastes (Management and Handling) Rules, 1989, |
|
|
|
Batteries (Management and Handling) Rules, 2001 and regulations, |
|
|
|
Central/ State laws, rules concerning safe handling, storage, treatment and disposal of the wastes etc., |
|
|
|
VAT, Sales Tax, Service Tax and other statutorily applicable taxes, |
|
|
|
State and Central SEZ Act and the rules framed thereunder, |
|
|
|
Central/state laws pertaining to fire and safety. |
31.2 |
Both the Parties shall always remain responsible for the consequences of their respective non-compliance of the aforesaid Acts/ Rules and/or any other applicable laws/ rules/ regulations. |
31.3 |
Both the Parties shall perform their respective obligations towards installation, operation and keeping at all times in operational condition, various equipments, machinery etc. in the Said Plot/ Said Complex/ Said
Building/ Demised Premises at their own cost and expenses in conformity with all the applicable laws as aforesaid. |
31.4 |
Both the Parties shall always remain responsible for their respective obligations to obtain and always keep valid and make available necessary certificates from the Pollution Control Board and/or other appropriate
authorities in this regard. |
32. |
AIR CONDITIONING FACILITIES: |
32.1 |
THE LESSOR shall, at its own cost, design and install a continuous and proper air conditioning system and shall use its best efforts to maintain and run the same in good order and condition to ensure air conditioning
facilities to the Demised Premises. |
32.2 |
If any changes, additions, alterations in the system is required by THE LESSEE due to its interior layouts, THE LESSOR may, if possible and feasible, make such changes and recover from THE LESSEE, the additional costs
at 1.2 times of the actual costs incurred. |
- 26 -
32.3 |
Provision for air conditioning (except in the event of mechanical defect/or electrical failure) to the Demised Premises will be provided as mentioned below: |
a) Normal office hours i.e. from 8 a.m. to 8 p.m. on all week days except Saturdays, Sundays, Public and National Holidays.
On Saturdays, air-conditioning will be provided from 8 a.m. to 2 p.m. only.
b) Any other specific operational hours of THE LESSEE, with prior written notice to THE LESSOR and by executing the necessary documentation in
respect thereof and upon payment of the applicable estimated maintenance charges provided in Annexure C-I(a) of this Lease Deed.
Provision for lift services (except in the event of mechanical defect/or
electrical failure) to the Demised Premises will be provided as mentioned below:
a) Normal office hours i.e. from 8 a.m. to 8 p.m. on all
week days except Saturdays, Sundays, Public and National Holidays.
On Saturdays, the lift services will be provided for first half of day
only i.e. from 8 a.m. to 2 p.m.
b) Any other specific operational hours of THE LESSEE, with prior written notice to THE LESSOR and by
executing the necessary documentation in respect thereof and upon payment of the applicable estimated maintenance charges provided in Annexure C-I(a) of this Lease Deed.
c) One of the lifts in the Said Building shall, however, operate even after normal office hours as well as on second half on Saturdays and also
on Sundays, Public and National Holidays.
d) The aforesaid timings shall be subject to such restrictions as may be imposed by any
competent authority(ies) or as per any applicable law in this behalf.
THE LESSOR shall carry out all major and structural repairs to the
Demised Premises and also to the Said Building and THE LESSEE shall not be entitled to carry out any structural changes/ additions/ alterations etc. in the same.
- 27 -
35. |
SUPPLY OF POWER/ ELECTRICITY/ WATER: |
THE LESSOR shall, subject to the payment of the
applicable charges as specified in this Lease Deed and non-occurrence of any Force Majeure event, supply and maintain regular supply of power/ electricity and water to the Demised Premises.
36. |
WATERTIGHT CONDITION: |
THE LESSOR shall keep the Demised Premises in watertight
condition.
37. |
PERMISSION TO CARRY OUT REPAIR/ INTERNAL ALTERATIONS: |
37.1 |
THE LESSOR shall allow THE LESSEE erection of internal partitions and other internal alterations and additions, except structural additions/alterations of permanent nature, which are not visible from outside, as may be
necessary for the business of THE LESSEE. |
37.2 |
THE LESSEE shall with prior written intimation of seven (07) days and written approval of THE LESSORs architect, commence such alteration(s) or addition(s) in the Demised Premises. |
37.3 |
If any such additions or alterations, require the prior approval or permission of any Municipality/ local body/ Government authority or are governed by any rules or regulations by such authority, THE LESSEE shall not
commence or carry out such additions or alterations or erections without obtaining the prior permission(s) or approval(s) or complying with such rules and regulations as aforesaid. |
37.4 |
THE LESSEE shall upon vacating and handing over the Demised Premises to THE LESSOR remove such fixtures, fittings, additions and partitions and restore the Demised Premises in as good condition as it was in at the time
when THE LESSEE was handed over the Demised Premises for fit outs, reasonable wear and tear excepted. |
38. |
PEACEFUL ENJOYMENT OF DEMISED PREMISES: |
THE LESSOR shall allow during the term of the
Lease Deed, peaceful enjoyment of the Demised Premises to THE LESSEE, subject to THE LESSEE performing all its obligations under this Lease Deed.
- 28 -
39. |
SUPER BUILT-UP AREA CALCULATIONS: |
The super built up area calculations for the
Demised Premises are as provided in Annexure T-I hereto.
40. |
ELECTRICAL & AIR CONDITIONING SERVICES: |
40.1 |
THE LESSOR has provided electrical wiring only up to the main distribution board on each floor in the Said Building and shall not provide any electric wiring, fixtures and fans etc., inside the Demised Premises.
|
40.2 |
Similarly air conditioning is provided by THE LESSOR up to air handling unit on each floor of the Said Building. |
40.3 |
The electrical wiring from the main distribution board to the Demised Premises including all fixtures etc., the internal distribution system of electricity, air conditioning, etc. in the Demised Premises shall be the
sole responsibility of THE LESSEE at their own cost. |
41. |
THE LESSORs REPRESENTATIONS: |
41.1 |
THE LESSOR is seized and possessed of the Said Plot and the Said Building developed/ to be developed thereon and is competent to lease office space in the Said Building developed/ to be developed on the Said Plot.
|
41.2 |
To the best of its knowledge, as on the date of signing of this Lease Deed, |
i) no notice of
acquisition or requisition, in respect of the Demised Premises, is received or is in force.
ii) no hindrance of whatsoever nature is in
the way of performance of obligations of THE LESSOR under this Lease Deed.
iii) the Demised Premises is structurally fit and secured.
42. |
FORCE MAJEURE/ NON PERFORMANCE OF OBLIGATIONS: |
42.1 |
Either party shall not be held responsible for any consequences or liabilities under this Lease Deed if it is prevented in performing its obligations by reason of laws or regulations, action by any Government or local
body or other authority, or due to reasons of force majeure which may include but not limited to riots, insurrection, war, terrorist action, acts of God and unforeseen circumstances beyond its control. Upon happening of the any such force majeure
event, either party would inform the other party of such event. Upon abatement of such event, either party would inform the other party about cessation of the same. |
- 29 -
42.2 |
In the event the Demised Premises or any part thereof be destroyed or damaged due to the following circumstances (including but not limited to): |
|
i) |
Fire (not caused by any willful act or negligence of THE LESSEE), |
|
ii) |
Act(s) of God like earthquake, tempest, flood or lightning etc., |
|
iii) |
By reasons of laws or regulations, action by any government or local body or other authority, |
|
iv) |
Violence of any army or mob or enemies of the country, and/ or |
|
v) |
Any other irresistible force rendering the Demised Premises unfit for the purpose for which the same was leased; |
then, THE LESSEE may, temporarily vacate the whole or such portion of the Demised Premises, as may be required, to enable THE LESSOR to carry
out repairs to restore the Demised Premises to as good condition as it was in at the time of handover of the Demised Premises for interior fit-outs.
42.3 |
In such an event, all payments specified under the Lease Deed for the affected area of the Demised Premises or portion thereof shall abate till the time the Demised Premises is repaired and restored to as good condition
as it was in at the time of handover of the Demised Premises for interior fit-outs. |
42.4 |
However, all payments specified under the Lease Deed during such period shall continue to be made by THE LESSEE for the unaffected area of the Demised Premises. |
42.5 |
Furthermore, if the above situation continues for a period of more than ninety (90) calendar days, THE LESSEE may terminate the Lease Deed by giving a prior written notice of thirty (30) days and THE LESSOR
shall refund the Security Deposits paid by THE LESSEE, subject to recovery/ adjustment of the outstanding dues, if any, under the Lease Deed. |
42.6 |
THE LESSOR shall not be responsible for paying any expenses or any financial or legal consequences arising out of such force majeure situation. |
42.7 |
The performance of THE LESSORs obligations shall be subject to the regular payment(s) as stipulated under this Lease Deed by THE LESSEE. |
- 30 -
43. |
ACQUISITION OR REQUISITION BY GOVERNMENT: |
43.1 |
In case the Demised Premises or any part thereof is acquired or requisitioned by the Government/ Statutory Authorities, local or otherwise, THE LESSOR alone shall be entitled to claim any compensation payable for such
acquisition/ requisition and THE LESSEE shall not raise any claim in respect thereof. |
43.2 |
In such a case, performance of THE LESSORs and THE LESSEEs obligations shall be as per the requisition/ acquisition notice received from the concerned authorities. |
43.3 |
If permissible under such requisition/acquisition notice, THE LESSEE, as per the terms of the requisition/ acquisition notice, may directly claim any and all compensation payable regarding the interior fit-outs
belonging to THE LESSEE in the Demised Premises and THE LESSOR shall not be liable to THE LESSEE for any claim/ compensation in respect thereof. |
43.4 |
In case such requisition/ acquisition notice results in termination of the Lease Deed, in that case unless prohibited under the requisition notice the Security Deposits paid under this Lease Deed will be refunded to THE
LESSEE within a reasonable time frame, if permissible under the requisition notice, after adjustment or deduction of arrear(s) of rent, charges and any other dues, if any, payable under this Lease Deed. |
44. |
SALE/ MORTGAGE/ TRANSFER: |
44.1 |
In the event THE LESSOR transfers either by way of sale or mortgages, or creates a third party charge in any manner whatsoever, on the Demised Premises, THE LESSEE shall not raise any objection to the same.
|
44.2 |
However, such creation of mortgage/charge shall not affect the rights of THE LESSEE to use the Demised Premises during the Lease Term. |
44.3 |
In case of sale, upon intimation by THE LESSOR, THE LESSEE shall attorn as a tenant to the new transferee on the same terms and conditions as stated in this Lease Deed. |
45. |
MODIFICATION/AMENDMENT/VARIATION: |
45.1 |
This Lease Deed along with the Annexure(s) constitutes the entire agreement between the Parties and revokes and supersedes all previous discussions, written or oral, correspondence, Letter of Intent and/or any deeds
between the Parties. The LOI attached to statement of commercials (attached as part of Annexure C-I(a) is merely for the purpose of commercial understanding and any terms/stipulations contained therein shall not contradict/supersede in any way the
terms and conditions contained in the Lease Deed. |
45.2 |
This Lease Deed shall not be changed or modified except by written amendment by way of an addendum duly agreed and signed by the Parties. |
- 31 -
46. |
ESSENCE OF THE LEASE DEED: |
In respect of any sums payable under this Lease Deed, time
shall be of the essence and that failure of THE LESSEE to pay by the Due Date any sum due and payable by THE LESSEE to THE LESSOR shall be liable for the consequences stipulated in this Lease Deed.
Failure of either party to enforce at any time or for any period of time the
provisions hereof shall not be construed to be waiver of any provisions or of the right thereafter to enforce each and every provision hereof.
If any provision is determined to be void or unenforceable under
applicable law(s), such provisions of this Lease Deed shall be deemed amended or deleted to the extent necessary to conform to applicable law(s) and the remaining provisions of this Lease Deed shall remain valid and enforceable.
49. |
PLURALITY OF THE LESSEE: |
If two or more persons are included in the term THE
LESSEE all covenants, terms, conditions and restrictions shall be binding on them jointly and each of them severally.
All or any disputes arising out of, touching upon, connected with,
concerning or in relation to the terms of this Lease Deed including the interpretation and validity of the terms thereof and the respective rights and obligations of the parties shall be settled amicably by mutual discussion failing which the
same shall be settled through arbitration The arbitration shall be governed by the Arbitration & Conciliation Act, 1996 or any statutory amendments/ modifications thereof for the time being in force. The arbitration proceedings shall
be held at Gurgaon by the Sole Arbitrator who shall be appointed by THE LESSOR who shall be a retired high court judge and whose decision shall be final and binding upon the Parties. THE LESSEE hereby confirms that he/she/it shall have no
objection to this appointment. The language of the arbitration proceedings shall be in English language only.
- 32 -
The civil courts at Gurgaon and Punjab & Haryana High Court at Chandigarh, Haryana alone
shall have the jurisdiction concerning all matters in this Lease Deed.
51. |
EXECUTION AND REGISTRATION OF LEASE DEED: |
51.1 |
All costs, charges etc including any penalties, on execution and registration of this Lease Deed or on all other instruments and deeds to be executed pursuant to this Lease Deed, as applicable, shall be borne and paid
solely by THE LESSEE. Each party shall bear their own legal fees/ charges. |
51.2 |
The stamp duty and registration charges shall be paid by THE LESSEE at the time of signing of the Lease Deed and in any case before the handover of the Demised Premises for interior works. |
51.3 |
THE LESSEE shall be responsible for the compliance of Indian Stamp Act, 1899 and local stamp act and rules made thereunder. |
51.4 |
THE LESSEE shall furnish a copy of the registered Lease Deed to the concerned authority under the SEZ Laws within six months from the issuance of Letter of Approval. |
51.5 |
The original executed and registered Lease Deed shall be retained by THE LESSOR and a certified copy of the same will be provided to THE LESSEE. |
51.6 |
The original Lease Deed shall be produced by THE LESSOR as and when required by THE LESSEE upon receipt of prior notice of 2 days from THE LESSEE, except in case of emergency(ies). |
51.7 |
That all annexures to this Lease Deed shall become part and parcel of this Lease Deed. However, it is clearly stipulated that except the commercials as mentioned in the LOI and also as reiterated in Annexure
C-I(a) of this Lease Deed, all other terms and conditions of the said LOI shall stand superseded by the terms and conditions of this Lease Deed. |
- 33 -
52. |
GOVERNMENTAL/ STATUTORY PROCEDURAL REQUIREMENTS: |
All governmental/ statutory procedural
requirements with respect to the obligations of the Parties under or arising out of this Lease Deed shall be complied with by the respective party, as applicable from time to time.
This Lease Deed and the rights and obligations of the Parties under or
arising out of this Lease Deed shall be construed and enforced in accordance with the laws of India.
54.1 |
No announcements, disclosures, publicity of any nature, regarding either party and other negotiations vis-à-vis this transaction will be made by either party unless the form, content and timing of the release is
approved in writing by both the parties hereto. |
54.2 |
Either party may disclose the existence of the transaction to its legal counsels, accountants, lenders, merchant bankers, engineers, architects, interior designers, vendors, suppliers and other persons who need to be
aware of the existence of the transaction, and to the extent that such disclosure is required by Law or a Court order or by any Statutory Authority(ies). |
55. |
CUSTOMER CONTROLLED METER SYSTEM (CCMS) |
In order to facilitate THE LESSEE in making
timely payment of the amounts payable under the Lease Deed, THE LESSOR may introduce and implement Customer Controlled Meter system (CCMS) which would facilitate THE LESSEE to also track online the amounts payable by THE LESSEE to THE LESSOR in
addition to the information available to THE LESSEE under the Lease Deed. The CCMS would also record and show the units of power consumed by THE LESSEE.
In the event THE LESSOR introduces and implements the CCMS, then separate meters shall be installed in the Demised Premises at the cost and
expense of THE LESSEE. THE LESSEE will be able to see the power consumed and to monitor the power load being utilized by it. THE LESSEE will also be able to access the information about the amounts due and payable by THE LESSEE viz. Warm Shell Rent,
Car Parking Charges, Maintenance, Charges, power consumption charges, Façade Signage Charges (if any), taxes and any other charges payable under the Lease Deed to THE LESSOR. The CCMS will facilitate THE LESSEE in avoiding defaults of
payments under the Lease Deed and thus avoiding disruption of electricity/ air conditioning/ water and all other services which would otherwise be stopped in case THE LESSEE fails to make payments of the amounts due and payable under the Lease Deed
by the Due Date. Thus THE LESSEE can monitor and control the payments and consumption of electricity as an additional facility in addition to the information available to THE LESSEE under the Lease Deed.
- 34 -
Any notice, letter or communication to be made, served or communicated unto
either party under these presents shall be in writing and shall be deemed to be duly made, served or communicated only if the notice, letter or communication is addressed to other party at the address given below or such other addresses as may be
intimated in writing and sent by registered post/ fax/ email (given hereunder)/ speed post or delivered personally with acknowledgement. The communication is to be addressed to the following:
|
|
|
For THE LESSOR |
|
For THE LESSEE |
Director Offices |
|
General Counsel |
10th Floor, DLF Gateway Tower, |
|
Gate 4, Plant 10, Godrej & |
DLF City Phase III, |
|
Boyce Complex, LBS Marg, |
Gurgaon 122002, Haryana, INDIA |
|
Pirojshanagar, Vikhroli (W), Mumbai, |
Phone 91-124 - 4568909 |
|
India |
Fax 91-124 - 4568909 |
|
|
E Mail: lease-gurgaon@dlf.in |
|
|
The terms and conditions agreed between THE LESSOR and THE LESSEE containing interalia a) covenants and
conditions to be observed and performed by THE LESSEE, and b) covenants and conditions to be observed and performed by THE LESSOR, are as per this Lease Deed and Annexures C-I (a) to C-IV and T-I to T-X which shall form an integral part
of this Lease Deed and shall be binding on THE LESSOR and THE LESSEE.
THE LESSOR, DLF Assets Private Limited through its Authorized Signatories
Mr. Navin Kedia and Mr. Amit Grover authorized to execute Lease Deeds etc. have executed this Lease Deed. This Lease Deed will be presented for registration before the Registering Authority and get registered by Mr. Jasmer Singh S/o
Mr. Balwant Singh R/o C-68, Indira Enclave, Ned Sarai, New Delhi 110068 who has been authorized vide Resolution dated 26.4.2006 of THE LESSOR to appear before the Registering Authority and present for registration, acknowledge and get
registered the Deed executed by Mr. Navin Kedia and Mr. Amit Grover on behalf of THE LESSOR.
IN WITNESS WHEREOF the Parties hereto have set
their hands to these presents on the day, month and year first and above mentioned.
- 35 -
THE LESSOR:
SIGNED AND DELIVERED on behalf of the above named DLF Assets Private Limited acting through Mr. Navin Kedia and Mr. Amit Grover, its Authorized
Signatories:
In the presence of:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For and on behalf of |
|
|
WITNESSES: |
|
DLF Assets Private Limited |
|
|
1. |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/s/ Navin Kedia /s/ Amit Grover |
|
|
2. |
|
AUTHORIZED SIGNATORIES |
|
|
THE LESSEE:
SIGNED AND DELIVERED on behalf of the above named WNS Global Services Private Limited acting through Mr. Varun Vasisht, its Authorized Signatory:
In the presence of:
|
|
|
|
|
WITNESSES |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For and on behalf of |
|
|
1. |
|
WNS Global Services Private Limited |
|
|
|
|
|
2. |
|
/s/ Varun Vasisht |
|
|
|
AUTHORIZED SIGNATORY |
|
|
- 36 -
ANNEXURES
|
|
|
|
|
A. COMMERCIAL |
C-I(a) |
|
|
|
Statement of Commercials |
|
|
|
C-II |
|
|
|
Description of the Said Plot |
|
|
|
C-III |
|
|
|
Merger and Amalgamation Draft Undertaking |
|
|
|
C-IV(a) |
|
|
|
Expansion Option for THE LESSEE |
|
|
|
C-IV(b) |
|
|
|
Draft Notice for Hard Option or First Right of Refusal |
|
|
|
C-V |
|
|
|
Electronic Clearing System Activation form |
|
B. TECHNICAL |
T-I |
|
|
|
Tentative Super Built-up area calculations |
|
|
|
T-II |
|
|
|
Description of the Floor Plan(s) of the Demised Premises |
|
|
|
T-III |
|
|
|
Car parking spaces earmarked for use by THE LESSEE |
|
|
|
T-IV |
|
|
|
Monthly Maintenance and service expenditure (Indicative) |
|
|
|
T-V |
|
|
|
Tentative Building Specifications |
|
|
|
T-VI |
|
|
|
Sharing of Services/ Division of Floor |
|
|
|
T-VII |
|
|
|
Guiding Principles for the Fit-outs of the Demised Premises |
|
|
|
T-VIII |
|
|
|
Handover for Fit Outs of the Demised Premises |
|
|
|
T-IX |
|
|
|
List of Drawings required for approval by THE LESSOR |
|
|
|
T-X |
|
|
|
THE LESSEEs responsibility during interior fit-outs work, additions/modifications/alterations of interior works and during the Lease Term / Lease Renewal Term and operations during the Lease Term / Lease Renewal
Term |
- 37 -
ANNEXURE C-I (a)
STATEMENT OF COMMERCIALS PAYABLE BY M/S. WNS GLOBAL SERVICES PRIVATE LIMITED TO M/S. DLF ASSETS PRIVATE LIMITED DURING THE PERIOD OF LEASE FOR APPROX.
44,607 SQ.FT. (4,144.102 SQ.MTRS) OF SUPER BUILT UP AREA ON 10th FLOOR OF BLOCKS A2 & A3 AT DLF WORLD TECH PARK, NH8, GURGAON
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
LEASE TERM |
|
LEASE RENEWAL TERM |
|
Initials of THE LESSEE |
|
|
|
|
From |
|
To |
|
From |
|
To |
|
From |
|
To |
|
From |
|
To |
|
From |
|
To |
|
PARTICULARS |
|
28-Apr-2014 |
|
28-Feb-2017 |
|
1-Mar-2017 |
|
27-Apr-2019 |
|
28-Apr-2019 |
|
28-Feb-2020 |
|
1-Mar-2020 |
|
28-Feb-2023 |
|
1-Mar-2023 |
|
27-Apr-2024 |
|
Super built up area in sq.ft. (& in sq.mtrs.) |
|
44,607 (4,144.102) |
|
44,607 (4,144.102) |
|
|
Lease Commencement Date |
|
28-Apr-2014 |
|
28-Apr-2019 |
|
|
Rent Commencement Date for Warm Shell Rent & Car Parking Spaces |
|
1-Jun-2014 |
|
28-Apr-2019 |
|
|
Lock-in Period from LCD (Months) |
|
36 |
|
|
|
|
Warm Shell Rent (44,607 sq.ft.) |
|
Rs per sq.ft. per month |
|
41.00 |
|
47.15 |
|
47.15 |
|
54.22 |
|
62.35 |
|
|
|
|
Rs. per month |
|
18,28,887.00 |
|
21,03,220.05 |
|
21,03,220.05 |
|
24,18,591.54 |
|
27,81,246.45 |
|
|
Car Parking Charges (per car park per month) |
|
1 per 1000 sq.ft. car parks i.e. 45 car parks @ Rs. 3,000 per car park per month |
|
1,35,000 |
|
1,55,250 |
|
1,55,250 |
|
1,78,538 |
|
2,05,318.13 |
|
|
|
|
NIL additional car parks @ Rs. 5,000 per car park per month |
|
NA |
|
NA |
|
NA |
|
NA |
|
NA |
|
|
Interest Free Refundable Security Deposit (IFRSD) in Rs. |
|
Amount always equivalent to 6 months Warm Shell Rent |
|
1,09,73,322 |
|
1,26,19,320 |
|
1,26,19,320 |
|
1,45,11,549 |
|
1,66,87,479 |
|
|
|
|
Payable on signing of Letter of Intent (equivalent to 3 months Warm Shell Rent) |
|
54,86,661 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Payable on signing of Lease Deed (equivalent to 3 months Warm Shell Rent) |
|
54,86,661 |
|
16,45,998 |
|
|
|
18,92,229 |
|
21,75,929 |
|
|
Interest Free Refundable Maintenance Security Deposit (IFRMSD) in Rs. |
|
For Normal Office hours - payable on the Lease Deed @ Rs. 18/- per sq.ft. per month (equivalent to 6 months maintenance charges) |
|
48,17,556 |
|
|
|
48,17,556 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
Interest Free Refundable Electricity Security Deposit (IFRESD) in Rs. - payable on signing the Lease Deed |
|
For Power Load (268 KVA) @ Rs. 3,000/- per KVA |
|
8,04,000 |
|
|
|
8,04,000 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
- 38 -
Annexure C-I(a)
Terms and Conditions:
1) |
The payment of Warm Shell Rent, Car Parking Charges and Maintenance Charges shall be subject to deduction of TDS. |
2) |
Any taxes/ duties/ charges/ cesses / levy (ies) etc. including service tax, as applicable from time to time, whether central / state/ municipal/ local etc on payments made by THE LESSEE shall be additional and shall be
borne by THE LESSEE. |
3) |
The due date of monthly payments viz. Warm Shell Rent, Car Parking Charges, Maintenance Charges, Terrace Area Charges (if any) and any other monthly charge is 1st day
of each English calendar month (Due Date) but not later than 7th day of the calendar month, along with taxes and duties as applicable. The due date for payment of charges for power consumption
shall be the date mentioned in the bills raised for such charges. |
4) |
All delayed payments shall carry an interest of 15% per annum from the Due Date till the date the payments are made by THE LESSEE. |
5) |
In addition to the Warm Shell Rent, any and all taxes, duties, charges, cesses, levy (ies) etc. on Property (collectively referred to as Taxes on Property) are payable/ reimbursable by THE LESSEE, from the
Lease Commencement Date, calculated prorata of the super built-up area of the Demised Premises to the super built-up area of the Property as well as payable/ reimbursable in respect of car parking spaces, if applicable. |
6) |
The Lock-in Period of Thirty Six (36) months from Lease Commencement Date as mentioned in above shall be applicable to Warm Shell Rent, Car Parking Charges, Maintenance
Charges, Taxes on Property and taxes etc. as applicable. |
7) |
THE LESSEE agrees to pay to THE LESSOR all the above commercials on their respective due dates. |
8) |
All costs, charges etc. including any penalties, on execution and registration of this instrument or on all other instruments and deeds to be executed pursuant to this agreement, as applicable, shall be borne and paid
solely by THE LESSEE. |
9) |
THE LESSOR and THE LESSEE shall bear their own legal fees/ charges. |
10) |
All the escalations/ increases @ 15% in the Warm Shell Rent, IFRSD, Car Parking Charges or any other charges as specified in the Statement of Commercials above are duly agreed by THE LESSEE and THE LESSEE hereby
signifies the acceptance of the above in form of initials/ signatures. |
11) |
The Maintenance charges payable by THE LESSEE, from the Lease Commencement Date, are calculated on actual cost plus 20% basis, which as on 1st May, 2013 are estimated as under: |
|
a) |
For normal office hours i.e. 8.00 am to 8.00 pm IST Monday to Friday and 8.00 am to 2.00 pm IST on Saturdays excluding on Sundays, Public and National Holidays: Rs.18/- per sq.ft.
per month. |
- 39 -
|
b) |
For 365*24*7 operations excluding Public and National Holidays: Rs.30/- per sq. ft. per month. |
|
c) |
For working beyond normal office hours (provided it is a full floor): Rs 0.13/- per sq. ft. per hour on the super built up area of the full floor even if the area of Demised
Premises is less than the full floor area or per hour for the Demised Premises to be intimated by the Building Manager when required. |
Since the building is already operational, while THE LESSEE is carrying out the fit out works but does not utilize the central air conditioning
for the Demised Premises during the fitout period; maintenance will be charged at Rs. 7/- per sq. ft. per month.
The Maintenance Charges,
as specified above in this LOI, are subject to increase of prices of diesel, gas, petroleum products and other consumables, electricity rates, taxes, wages and salaries, cost of annual maintenance contracts of lifts, DGs, HVAC supplies,
transformers, panels etc. during the Lease Term and the Lease Renewal Term (if any).
|
d) |
Maintenance services are as set out in Annexure T-II of this LOI. |
12) |
Charges for Usage of Power in the Demised Premises during interior fit-outs and Lease Term and the Lease Renewal Term: |
|
a) |
For supply of power from Grid power (subject to availability) - As per applicable grid rates |
|
b) |
For supply of power from back up sources - Cost + 20% |
|
c) |
When power taken from Utilities company is used - Cost + 20% |
|
d) |
The cost of power used for common areas from any source, along with other expenditure like security, housekeeping, AMCs etc., is charged in the overall maintenance charges at Cost + 20%. |
13) |
The initial Lease Term shall be Five (05) years with THE LESSEE having the sole option to renew the lease for one further term of 5 years. |
14) |
In case of renewal of lease term or earlier termination of the Lease Deed, an advance written notice of Six (06) months shall be served by THE LESSEE. |
- 40 -
15) |
THE LESSEE currently holds on lease the following office premises in DLF Infinity Towers, Phase III, DLF Cyber City, Gurgaon with M/s DLF Cyber City Developers Limited, the Warm Shell Rent for which is payable as
tabulated below: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Super Built up Area (sq.ft.) |
|
Tower |
|
Current Warm Shell Rent (Rs. per sq.ft. per month) |
|
Lease Expiry Date(s)/
Current Warm Shell
Rent payable till |
38,576 |
|
A |
|
34.50/- |
|
30th April, 2014 |
52,419 |
|
B |
|
34.50/- |
|
31st May, 2014 |
51,244 |
|
C |
|
34.50/- |
|
31st March, 2015 |
And, the following arrangement is agreed between the Parties for the Demised Premises as covered and more
particularly detailed in the Annexure C-I(a) of this Lease Deed, and shall be effective once the Lease Deed is signed for the Demised Premises.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Super Built up Area (sq.ft.) |
|
Warm Shell Rent (Rs. per sq.ft. per month) |
|
Rent Commencement Date |
|
Warm Shell Rent
payable till |
44,607 |
|
41.00/- |
|
1st June, 2014 |
|
28th February, 2017 |
It is agreed between the Parties that in case of delay in date of Occupation i.e. commencement of operations
of THE LESSEE in the Demised Premises beyond 1st June, 2014 but not later than 31st July, 2014 in any case, THE LESSEE shall be
liable to pay Warm Shell Rent along with all other charges for DLF Infinity Tower space, as tabulated below:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Super Built up Area (sq.ft.) |
|
Tower |
|
Warm Shell Rent beyond Lease Expiry Date(s) (Rs. per sq.ft. per month) |
|
Warm Shell Rent payable till |
38,576 |
|
A |
|
39.67/- |
|
31st July, 2014 |
52,419 |
|
B |
|
39.67/- |
|
31st July, 2014 |
51,244 |
|
C |
|
34.50/- |
|
31st July, 2014 |
However, it is made clear between the Parties that
|
i) |
The Warm Shell Rent for the Demised Premises shall commence from 1st June, 2014 irrespective of any delay in date of Occupation i.e. commencement of operations
of THE LESSEE in the Demised Premises. |
|
ii) |
Irrespective of the date of Occupation i.e. commencement of operations of THE LESSEE in the Demised Premises; the lease for the space under lease at DLF Infinity Tower shall stand terminated w.e.f. 1st August, 2014 and become invalid, ineffective and incapable of enforcement in any manner whatsoever and THE LESSEE shall be left with no right, title or interest in respect of the lease of the
entire space at DLF Infinity Tower. |
|
iii) |
The security deposits paid by THE LESSEE under the lease deeds for the space at DLF Infinity Tower shall be refunded to THE LESSEE, without any interest, once THE LESSEE clears all its dues under the lease deeds and
surrenders peaceful, vacant and physical possession of the entire premises, subject to adjustment of outstanding dues, if any. |
- 41 -
16) |
THE LESSEE had on lease approx. 35,215 sq.ft. super built up area at part of 9th Floor, Block 3, DLF IT Park at Chennai. |
The said space had a lock in period till 31st March, 2015. However the Lock in
period from the period 15th April, 2014 till 31st March, 2015 has been agreed to be waived off and the said space has been handed
over to THE LESSOR on 15th April, 2014.
It is agreed between the parties that
the security deposit paid by THE LESSEE towards the said space shall be adjusted against the deposit payable by THE LESSEE for the Demised Premises and the balance amount shall be payable by THE LESSEE upon signing of the Lease Deed for the Demised
Premises.
- 42 -
ANNEXURE C-II
DESCRIPTION OF THE SAID PLOT
- 43 -
ANNEXURE C-III
(Applicable in case THE LESSEE merges or amalgamates after the Lease Deed is signed)
To be given by transferee company
DRAFT UNDERTAKING
I, ,
the authorized representative, vide board resolution/power of attorney dated (Copy enclosed),
, do hereby declare that
|
1. |
We are fully aware with the Lease Deed dated executed between M/s DLF
and M/s.
and contents thereof. |
|
2. |
We are fully aware with the terms and conditions of the abovementioned Lease Deed. We are aware that as per the terms and conditions of the aforementioned Lease Deed, in case of merger/consolidation or amalgamation of
THE LESSEE with any other entity, a fresh Lease Deed shall be executed between THE LESSOR and the other entity as provided in Clause 28.3 of the above said Lease Deed subject to such new entity/transferee obtaining prior SEZ approval.
|
|
3. |
We undertake that as per the provisions of the Lease Deed we shall execute a fresh lease deed on same terms and conditions within 30 days of passing of the order by the Court approving the scheme of merger.
|
|
4. |
We are aware that we will step into the shoes of THE LESSEE for the remaining period of the Lease Term and that our liability to make payments of rental and other charges as per the Lease Deed shall commence from the
date of passing of the final order approving the merger. Till then the payments of rent and other charges payable under the Lease Deed shall be borne and paid regularly by THE LESSEE. |
|
5. |
We unequivocally agree, confirm and acknowledge to THE LESSOR that we shall be responsible for enforcement/compliance of all the terms and conditions of the Lease Deed and that we bind ourselves with the terms and
conditions of the aforementioned Lease Deed and we shall also be liable for breach/non-compliance of the terms and conditions as per the Lease Deed dated
. |
|
Confirmed by: |
|
( ) |
THE LESSEE |
- 44 -
ANNEXURE C-IV
ELECTRONIC CLEARING SYSTEM ACTIVATION FORM
|
|
|
|
|
1 |
|
Name of the Vendor: |
|
DLF ASSETS PVT. LTD. |
|
|
|
2 |
|
Contact person: |
|
Ms. Sherry Sharma |
|
|
|
3 |
|
Designation: |
|
SM |
|
|
|
4 |
|
Address: |
|
DLF GATEWAY TOWER, 6TH FLOOR, PHASE
III, GURGAON. |
|
|
|
5 |
|
Mobile No: |
|
7838088809 |
|
|
|
6 |
|
Contact No: |
|
0124-4778041 |
|
|
|
7 |
|
Email ID: |
|
sharma-sherry@dlf.in |
|
|
|
8 |
|
Fax: |
|
|
|
|
|
9. |
|
PAN: |
|
AACCD4923A |
|
|
|
10. |
|
TAN: |
|
DELD09632A |
|
|
|
11. |
|
Bank Name: |
|
CITI BANK |
|
|
|
12. |
|
Bank Address: |
|
JEEVAN BHARTI BUILDING, 124, CONNAUGHT CIRCUS,
NEW DELHI 110001. |
|
|
|
13. |
|
Account No.: |
|
0011812228 |
|
|
|
14. |
|
NEFT Code: |
|
CITI0000002 |
|
|
|
15. |
|
RTGS Code: |
|
CITI0000002 |
|
|
|
16. |
|
Swift Code *: |
|
CITIINBX |
Note:
|
|
THE LESSEE to check with concerned bank for NEFT / RTGS / SWIFT Codes. |
|
|
Swift Code is required in case THE LESSEE has an account with HSBC bank. |
|
|
Bill-wise details against NEFT payments by mail. |
- 45 -
ANNEXURE T-I
TENTATIVE SUPER BUILT UP AREA CALCULATIONS
TENTATIVE SUPER BUILT UP AREA CALCULATIONS
BLOCK
A2, DLF IT SEZ SILOKHERA
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
FLOOR / OFFICE NO. |
|
OFFICE AREA |
|
|
TERRACE AREA |
|
|
SUPER AREA |
|
|
TOTAL SUPER BUILT UP AREA |
|
|
(SQM) |
|
|
(SFT) |
|
|
(SQM) |
|
|
(SFT) |
|
|
(SQM) |
|
|
(SFT) |
|
|
(SQM) |
|
|
(SFT) |
|
EIGHTH/ 8F |
|
|
1660.582 |
|
|
|
17875 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2075.728 |
|
|
|
22343 |
|
|
|
2075.728 |
|
|
|
22343 |
|
NINETH/ 9F |
|
|
1660.582 |
|
|
|
17875 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2075.728 |
|
|
|
22343 |
|
|
|
2075.728 |
|
|
|
22343 |
|
TENTH/ 10F |
|
|
1654.718 |
|
|
|
17811 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2068.398 |
|
|
|
22264 |
|
|
|
2068.398 |
|
|
|
22264 |
|
ELEVENTH/11F/2 |
|
|
975.340 |
|
|
|
10499 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1219.176 |
|
|
|
13123 |
|
|
|
1219.176 |
|
|
|
13123 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
TOTAL |
|
|
5951.222 |
|
|
|
64060 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
7439.03 |
|
|
|
80073 |
|
|
|
7439.03 |
|
|
|
80073 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The Super built up area shall be the sum of Office area of the said premises and its prorata share of Common areas in the
entire said building i.e., Block A2.
Whereas the Office area of the said premises shall mean the entire area enclosed by its periphery walls including
area under walls, wall cladding, columns, half the area of walls common with other premises etc. which form integral part of said premises and prorata share of common corridor, AMU and electrical rooms for offices on this floor. Common area shall
mean all such parts / areas in the said building which M/s WNS Global Services Private Limited / Occupants of the said premises shall use by sharing with other Allottees / Occupants in the said building including entrance canopy and lobby, stilt
area, atrium, corridors and passages, common toilets, area of cooling towers, security / fire control room(s), lift shafts, all electrical shafts, D.C. shafts, AC shafts, pressurisation shafts, plumbing and fire shafts on all floors and rooms,
staircases, mumties, refuge areas, lift machine rooms, water tanks, electric substation and transformers. In addition entire services area in basement including but not limited to D.G. set rooms, AC plant room underground water and other storage
tanks, pump rooms, maintenance and service rooms, fan rooms and circulation areas etc. shall be counted towards common area.
- 46 -
TENTATIVE SUPER BUILT UP AREA CALCULATIONS
BLOCK A3, DLF IT SEZ SlLOKHERA
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
FLOOR / OFFICE NO. |
|
OFFICE AREA |
|
|
TERRACE AREA |
|
|
SUPER AREA |
|
|
TOTAL SUPER BUILT UP AREA |
|
|
(SQM) |
|
|
(SFT) |
|
|
(SQM) |
|
|
(SFT) |
|
|
(SQM) |
|
|
(SFT) |
|
|
(SQM) |
|
|
(SFT) |
|
EIGHTH/ 8F |
|
|
1666.426 |
|
|
|
17937 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2083.033 |
|
|
|
22422 |
|
|
|
2083.033 |
|
|
|
22422 |
|
NINETH/ 9F |
|
|
1666.426 |
|
|
|
17937 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2083.033 |
|
|
|
22422 |
|
|
|
2083.033 |
|
|
|
22422 |
|
TENTH/ 10F |
|
|
1660.563 |
|
|
|
17874 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2075.704 |
|
|
|
22343 |
|
|
|
2075.704 |
|
|
|
22343 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
TOTAL |
|
|
4993.415 |
|
|
|
53748 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
6241.770 |
|
|
|
67187 |
|
|
|
6241.770 |
|
|
|
67187 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The Super built up area shall be the sum of Office area of the said premises and its prorata share of Common areas in the
entire said building i.e., Block A3
Whereas the Office area of the said premises shall mean the entire area enclosed by its periphery walls including
area under walls, wall cladding, columns, half the area of walls common with other premises etc. which form integral part of said premises and prorata share of common corridor, AHU and electrical rooms for offices on this floor. Common area shall
mean all such parts / areas in the said building which M/s WNS Global Services Private Limited / Occupants of the said premises shall use by sharing with other Allottees / Occupants in the said building including entrance canopy and lobby, stilt
area, atrium, corridors and passages, common toilets, area of cooling lowers, security / fire control room(s), lift shafts, all electrical shafts, D.G. shafts, AC shafts, pressurisation shafts, plumbing and fire shafts on all floors and rooms,
staircases, mumties, refuge areas, lift machine rooms, water tanks, electric substation and transformers. In addition entire services area in basement including but not limited to D.G. set rooms, AC plant room underground water and other storage
tanks, pump rooms, maintenance and service rooms, fan rooms and circulation areas etc. shall be counted towards common area.
- 47 -
ANNEXURE T-II
DESCRIPTION OF THE FLOOR PLAN(S) OF THE DEMISED PREMISES
(Highlighted area)
10th Floor, Block A2 & A3
- 48 -
ANNEXURE T-III
CAR PARKING SPACES EARMARKED FOR USE BY THE LESSEE
Number of car parking spaces earmarked in the basement/stilt/ surface car parking spaces for use by THE LESSEE
Forty Five (45) Numbers
- 49 -
ANNEXURE T-IV
MONTHLY MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE EXPENDITURE (INDICATIVE)
A. |
The expected monthly maintenance and service charges shall be 1.20 times the sum total of the following expenditure calculated on sq.ft. of super built up area basis and shall be charged every month. The
expenditure shall include but shall not be limited to the following: |
1. |
Annual maintenance contracts, service contract expenditure including taxes & statutory levies as applicable, lease rental and other charges for operation and maintenance of all electro-mechanical equipments and
all other equipment installed and to be additionally installed by THE LESSOR/maintenance agency. |
2. |
Cost of water for all purposes. |
3. |
Cost of electricity for central air-conditioning (excluding AHUs) and all services provided including in the parking, common and external areas. |
4. |
Cost of maintenance of landscaped areas, compound wall, tube well, electrification sewerage, roads and paths and any other services within the boundary of the Said Plot. |
5. |
Cost of maintenance, cleaning, painting and necessary replacements of a revenue nature in common areas including cost of maintenance of basements and common services therein. |
6. |
Cost of security services. |
7. |
Cost of administrative staff, maintenance staff of the building and the manager directly related to the maintenance of the building. |
8. |
Cost of all consumables for all services in common areas. |
9. |
Annual fees of various authorities. |
10. |
Cost of diesel and lubricants etc. for DG sets and cost of gas and lubricants etc. for gas generators and air conditioning systems etc. |
- 50 -
11. |
Cost of all replacements / refurnishing of parts of various equipments used in maintenance services. |
12. |
Cost of augmentation/upgradations/replacement/deployment of existing and additional security/fire/other electromechanical systems acquired through leasing/ amortization/ rental basis. |
13. |
Cost of expenses incurred on infrastructure in and around the Said Building. |
14. |
Cost of insurance of Building and fitouts when fitted out space is provided. |
15. |
Depreciation / sinking fund /lease rentals of all electro-mechanical equipments, including but not limited to chillers, D.G. Sets and lifts. |
16. |
Maintenance Charges for Car Parking Spaces. |
17. |
Any expenditure incurred on personnel, administrative and any other related cost of the custom/excise staff posted at SEZ operations. |
B. |
Cost of exclusive services, if any, provided to the occupant shall be extra. |
C. |
Service Tax and other taxes, as applicable, shall be additional. |
- 51 -
ANNEXURE T-V
TENTATIVE BUILDING SPECIFICATIONS
|
|
|
STRUCTURE |
|
RCC framed structure |
|
|
Finishes |
|
|
|
|
External Façade |
|
Combination of Clear Float Glass and/or Reflective floats glass with Granite / Metal Cladding / Exterior paint / any other. |
|
|
Atrium, Lift Lobbies Floors & Walls. |
|
Combination of Indian marbles and / or granites. |
|
|
Main staircase(s) / Fire Escape staircase(s) |
|
Terrazzo / Kota Stone / Good concrete. |
|
|
Elevators |
|
High Speed Passenger Elevators. Service
Elevator |
|
|
Parking |
|
Stilt/Surface/Basements |
|
|
Amenities |
|
Centrally Air Conditioned Building Provision for office area Air Conditioning provided upto AHU on each floor. The internal distribution system of Air Conditioning shall be sole responsibility of the tenant. |
|
|
Power Back up |
|
100% power back-up including power back up for AC system also. |
|
|
Fire Fighting |
|
Sprinkler and fire detection system will be provided in the basement area and common area only as per NBC. One layer of upright sprinklers for areas above the false ceiling shall be provided by THE LESSOR. Another layer of pendant
type sprinklers for areas below the false ceiling to be provided by THE LESSEE as per NBC norms. |
|
|
Wash room |
|
Gents / Ladies Toilet on each floor as per statutory norms, CI/GI piping will be provided, but no CP fittings, Fixtures Wall / Floor finishes. Door & shutters will be provided. |
|
|
Electricity/Telephone |
|
Provision on each floor up to the shaft. Connections have to be arranged by respective owners/users. No Electric conduits or wiring shall be provided in the slab. |
- 52 -
NOTE:
|
A. |
Materials specially the imported ones are subject to availability as per prevalent policies of Govt. of India. |
|
B. |
Wherever larger floor heights are provided due to architectural reasons, from the viewpoint of air conditioning load, the height of false ceiling to be done by THE LESSEE shall not exceed 3 mtrs. from the finished floor
level. |
|
C. |
The above-mentioned specifications are for common area only. The office area will be in Warm Shell condition only. All fittings, A.C. Ducts, Electrical distribution and Fire Fighting etc. shall be the sole
responsibility of THE LESSEE. |
|
D. |
Plumbing provision for extra toilets may be provided at one / two different locations |
|
E. |
The above specifications are tentative and are subject to change at the sole discretion of THE LESSOR. |
- 53 -
ANNEXURE T-VI
SHARING OF SERVICES / DIVISION OF FLOOR
(i) In case the Demised Premises is not contiguous with the AHU due to which the ducting is required to pass through any other LESSEEs premises
on the same floor, then THE LESSEE will provide FCU/AHU for the Demised Premises and will also bring chilled water piping upto the Demised Premises.
(ii) However, in case of floor division into two or more offices, such that the services are to be shared amongst The LESSEE of the floor, THE LESSEE
will design their services in sharing with the other LESSEE(s) on the floors. Similarly, THE LESSEE will not object to any other LESSEE passing their services from THE LESSEEs Demised Premises (if required). Any damage to the interiors of THE
LESSEE while passing of any common services by any other LESSEE will be rectified by the other LESSEE taking services through THE LESSEEs premises.
(iii) THE LESSEE {(if THE LESSEE is the first occupant to be using common AHU which is to be shared with the later occupant(s))}, will make
arrangements in their ducting/plenum for tap-off for any other LESSEE whose services are designed from a common AHU shared by THE LESSEE.
(iv) The
necessary electrical connection for the FCU/AHU is to be done by THE LESSEE and connected to THE LESSORs panel by doing the necessary modifications. Also, the cost of chilled water piping/any electrical/plumbing/fire fighting modification
shall be borne by THE LESSEE.
(v) HVAC plenum and lowside ducting needs to be done by THE LESSEE at its own cost. In case, all occupants of the
floor have closed their false ceiling and no duct is left for future lessee, THE LESSEE occupying at later stage will have to install their own FCU and make the necessary connections to chilled water lines. THE LESSEE is required to share the cost
of HVAC plenum/ ducting provisioning with other lessees.
(vi) Any dismantling of false ceiling of common areas for services by THE LESSEE is to be
made good(as per THE LESSORs specifications) by THE LESSEE at their own cost.
(vii) Sprinkler tap off: THE LESSEE has to take tap
off for down type Sprinklers with installation of valves under supervision of Building services.
- 54 -
ANNEXURE T-VII
GUIDING PRINCIPLES FOR THE FIT-OUTS OF THE DEMISED PREMISES
1. |
Temporary Electricity / Water Supply will be provided for fit-out works at one point in shaft on request by THE LESSEE. |
2. |
Construction Hoist / Staircase in the tower will be made available to shift the materials to the respective floors, whenever required by THE LESSEE. |
3. |
Vertical stacks for plumbing shall be made available on the relevant floor(s) when requested by THE LESSEE. |
4. |
Temporary toilets for labour force to be arranged by the respective contractors of THE LESSEE. |
5. |
Clear construction access. Materials to be kept by THE LESSEE at their respective floors. |
6. |
THE LESSOR shall not provide any storage space to THE LESSEE in the basements of the Said Building. |
7. |
THE LESSEE shall be fully responsible for all regulatory & statutory compliances at all times during fit-out period and during fit-out occupancy. |
- 55 -
ANNEXURE T-VIII
HANDOVER OF DEMISED PREMISES FOR OCCUPATION
1. |
Gas Generators, DG and Chillers shall be commissioned for servicing the Demised Premises when THE LESSEE has completed their scope of work for the low side before the integration with THE LESSOR high side services can
be done. The services will be provided/ connected within three working days of THE LESSEEs request after THE LESSEE has completed their scope of work including interiors as per drawings approved by THE LESSOR. |
2. |
Lift facility will be available one day before THE LESSEE starts operations, when advised by THE LESSEE. |
3. |
THE LESSEE to discuss and finalize all connectivity issues relating to telephone and wireless services with the service provider. Cables of Telephone Service Provider shall be terminated to the basement of the building.
|
4. |
THE LESSOR shall not provide any storage space to THE LESSEE in the basements of the Said Building. |
- 56 -
ANNEXURE T-IX
LIST OF DRAWINGS REQUIRED FOR APPROVAL BY THE LESSOR
1. Architectural Design
|
1. |
Interior layout drawing showing all the facilities provided. |
|
2. |
Typical section details showing the false ceiling height. |
|
3. |
Additional toilet/pantry detail drawings if any. |
|
4. |
False ceiling details along the curtain/structural glazing. |
2. Electrical Design
|
1. |
Electrical load sheet (Equipment and lighting load details). |
|
2. |
SLD showing load balancing of the system. |
|
4. |
Data and raceway layout. |
|
5. |
Power and LV system layout. |
|
6. |
Smoke detection and PA system layout. |
|
7. |
Coordinated Reflected Ceiling Plan with other services. |
|
8. |
Number of earth pits required to be provided. |
3. HVAC Design
|
1. |
Ducting layout showing AHU capacity. |
|
2. |
Chilled water pipe routing if provision of FCU required. |
|
3. |
Number of outdoor split units required in case provided by client. |
|
4. |
Toilet and pantry ventilation layout. |
4. Plumbing and Fire Fighting Design
|
1. |
Population / Occupancy details. |
|
2. |
Toilets and pantry plumbing detail drawings. |
Important Design Considerations
1. |
Upright layer of sprinklers provided by THE LESSOR shall not be disturbed by the client. A separate tap-off has been provided for installing the second layer of pendant type sprinklers. |
2. |
Sprinkler drop points to be MS threaded for 50mm & below as required by NBC. |
3. |
Quick response Sprinkler Bulbs to be installed. |
- 57 -
4. |
Flexible connections for sprinklers if used shall be UL listed & tested for working pressure at 200psi. |
5. |
If sprinklers are to be isolated in any area (server room / UPS room / Electrical room), an automatic fire fighting system such as FM200 or CO2 based system shall be provided by the client. |
6. |
No reduction in number of WCs/fixtures/urinals/wash-basins. |
7. |
Only cisterns to be used. No flush valves allowed. |
8. |
Fire Dampers shall be motorized and not fused linked. |
9. |
Fire dampers to be put both in supply ducting and return air path. |
10. |
AC split units/ PACs to be designed only for critical areas such as server room/Hub room/Cafeteria (in case client wants to avoid mixing of AHU air and cafeteria air). |
11. |
Only roller blinds to be provided. |
12. |
Partitions within office premise to be designed to terminate at mullions, keeping an expansion joint of 5mm to be filled with silicon sealant only. |
13. |
Provision for trap door has been made for all shafts. Trap doors to be provided by the client with proper locking arrangement. The trap doors shall not be permanently sealed /closed. One set of keys for the trap doors
should always be available with the security guard of the client so that the shaft is accessible during any emergency. The shaft accessible through the clients premises to be kept clean by the client at all times. |
14. |
Only MS Conduits shall be used for electrical wiring. |
15. |
The smoke detection and PA system being provided by the client is required to be integrated by the client with base buildings smoke detection and PA system. |
Notes:
1. |
The Lessee to submit the complete set of drawings/details which will be approved by THE LESSORs architect with comments and returned to THE LESSEE. Incomplete submission will not be approved. Two photocopies of
the approved drawings to be submitted one to DLF Building Services and another to DLF Technical Services for records. |
2. |
Drawings should be coordinated with other services drawing. |
3. |
Location of server room / UPS room or any other facility room where additional structural load is to be considered should be clearly marked with the equipment load details and layout, for structural design
consideration. |
4. |
Drawings should be of legible format and should be duly signed by Architect/Consultant. |
5. |
Design should be in compliance with NBC/fire norms/byelaws. |
6. |
Any modification sought in the base building or any facility which has an impact on the buildings architectural feature should be highlighted in the architectural drawings for approval. Such modifications seeking
any structural changes, façade changes or aesthetics of any building would not be considered. |
- 58 -
7. |
Name of the Architect/Consultant with his phone number should be mentioned on the drawings so that in case of clarification or discussion if any required can be done on the phone itself. |
8. |
Please ensure to mention the clients name, building name, floor and area on all the drawings. |
- 59 -
ANNEXURE T-X
THE LESSEES RESPONSIBILITY DURING INTERIOR FITOUTS WORK, ADDITIONS/ MODIFICATIONS/ ALTERATIONS OF INTERIOR WORKS (REFERRED HEREINAFTER AS INTERIOR
WORKS) AND DURING THE LEASE TERM / LEASE RENEWAL TERM AND DURING OPERATIONS
THE LESSOR has provided the fire detection systems as elaborated in Part
B. These systems are as per NBC norm.
A |
THE LESSEE will be responsible to ensure the following elaborated under different sub heads: |
(I) |
FIRE DETECTION & FIRE FIGHTING |
1. |
The existing sprinkler systems provided is not to be isolated or closed at any point of time during interior works. |
|
(a) |
For providing sprinklers below false ceiling a separate network of sprinklers to be installed. |
|
(b) |
Before starting the interior/fitout works, THE LESSEE will also check for themselves that the sprinkler systems are in working condition. |
|
(c) |
Upon completion of False Ceiling, the sprinkler below false ceiling is to be charged. Only upon charging the sprinklers below false ceiling, THE LESSEE can do other interior works and can bring in the carpets /
furniture / modular workstations/ chairs / wood for partitions etc. into the premises for installation. |
|
(d) |
Sprinkler system as per NBC. |
2. |
Fire detection, alarm systems and fire fighting systems must not be closed or isolated during the period when interior works are carried out or during the lease period or lease renewal period. (should be as per NBC).
|
2 (a). |
As and when there is Puja/ Havan in THE LESSEEs Premises the Building Manager to take proper action for alarm system so that other occupants are not disturbed. THE LESSEE shall send prior notice for the Puja/
Havan including the essential details like time, date and the venue to the Building Manager. |
- 60 -
3. |
Before start of Interior works THE LESSEE to ensure 4 nos. Fire Extinguishers, 4 Nos. Sand buckets & 4 nos. Water buckets are placed at different locations on each floor of the premises when THE LESSEE is
starting the interiors. |
4. |
Before doing any welding works, THE LESSEE to obtain hot works permit and ensure that the site is clear, no paper/wood pieces/or any other combustible material is around and adequate standby fire-fighting mechanism in
place, which includes at least 2 nos of fire extinguishers, 1 nos of sand buckets, 1 nos of water bucket etc are in place. Once the welding is completed, the site to be re-inspected for any welding spark. |
5. |
No gas of any kind to be used for welding purposes. Only arc/electrical welding to be used. |
6. |
Zonal fire detection panels are provided on all floors. THE LESSEE to ensure that at any point of time there would be some smoke detectors spread over the Demised Premises operational and connected to the Zonal panel.
|
7. |
During interior works, THE LESSEE to ensure proper signages and fire escape routes are prominently displayed inside their premises. |
8. |
Security Guards professionally trained in fire fighting systems to be deployed on each floor during all shifts round the clock. They should be capable of handling the fire-fighting equipments provided on the floors such
as fire hydrants etc. |
9. |
The entire building is a no smoking zone. THE LESSEE to ensure that even during interior works no person smokes inside the building. Match Boxes & Cigarette Lighters are not allowed at site in the building.
|
10. |
No items of any nature to be stored in Electrical Control / Panel Room. A stray electrical spark may result in such items catching fire; moreover, presence of such items may impede access to Control Panel in times of
emergency. |
11. |
Use/storage of cooking gas / cooking gas cylinders in the Demised Premises is not allowed. |
12. |
THE LESSEEs Security Personnel should not remain inside the offices after they have been closed for the day. Unauthorized smoking by such staff can also contribute to major fire. After closing hours, your
Security/Guard be stationed outside the office (and not within), and the interiors of the offices can be monitored by then over closed circuit video cameras. |
- 61 -
13. |
THE LESSEE to install automatic gas flooding Fire Extinguishing System, FM 200 or equivalent, in case THE LESSEE wants to remove the sprinkler system in the Server Room. The FM 200 will not be kept on manual mode under
any circumstances. |
(II) |
ELECTRICAL & MECHANICAL |
14. |
For the operational usage THE LESSOR has provided the electrical tap-off in electrical room along with sub-meters installed for supply of power from grid/supplying agency and back-up power. THE LESSEE to tap-off
electricity through proper distribution panel / board properly earthed. The distribution of electricity inside the premises during the interior works shall be responsibility of THE LESSEE. |
15. |
All electrical installation shall be carried by authorized licensed contractor and THE LESSEE shall submit installation test certificate issued by same contractor and certificate of verification of these installation by
a reputed electrical consultant. |
16. |
During interior works Electrical supply for fitout to be given through portable DG/Building DG (if installed). In case power for fitouts is provided through temporary portable DG installed outside, THE LESSEE will have
to take the tapping though a cable of suitable rating from outside the building. Lessee to take the electricity in a proper panel/fitted with MCB & ELCB with proper earthing. Cable of proper rating to be used as per load. No loose
connection & joints in wires will be allowed. During interior works while using drilling/hammering machine or any other electrical equipment, THE LESSEE shall ensure that proper 3 pin plugs are used. No over loading of socket will be
allowed. |
17. |
All outgoing feeders single phase & 3 phase in Panels & DBs outlets shall be suitable of individual equipment rating and out going feeders must have a protection arrangement so that it should trip in
the event of overload, short circuit & earth fault. |
18. |
All material to be used should be of IS Standard & from reputed manufacturer. No sub standard material to be used. |
19. |
No aluminum cable to be used. Only copper cables of ISI make to be used. |
20. |
Under no circumstances during interiors / operations should the safety system in the circuit / MCB / ELCB be bypassed. THE LESSOR to ensure that this is adhered to under all circumstances. |
- 62 -
21. |
Only CFL & tubes with electronic chokes to be used. No Aluminum / Copper chokes to be used. |
22. |
Compressors of Split AC/ Precision AC shall be serviced regularly to avoid overheating / jamming of compressor / fan motor. Stabilizer sockets to be checked regularly for heating. |
23. |
Supply from one socket to be used for one source only and 3 wire cable to be used rather than 3 different cables. No overloading of sockets. |
24. |
Balancing of load should be proper in all 3 phases. |
25. |
Coffee machine / water cooler/ oven and any other Electrical appliances should be properly earthed and to be used with a proper rating of cable through ELCB. |
26. |
For power output 15 amp plug; for lighting 5 amp plug and for AC industrial sockets to be used. |
27. |
Small step down transformer on false ceiling for lighting to be properly secured. |
28. |
No PVC pipes to be used for Electrical wiring, only MS pipes to be used. |
29. |
Electrical panel wiring to be properly dressed and the gap between the phases to be proper. |
30. |
CT provided in the electrical panel should be of proper size and should have a proper gap between the space and CT to be checked for any heating/ cracking. |
31. |
One circuit should not have more than eight light point or two power points. |
32. |
For neon signages, transformer should be placed outside safe place or LED signages to be used. |
33. |
THE LESSEE to ensure that the electro-mechanical systems installed in the Demised Premises is properly maintained during their interior works and at the time of operations. THE LESSEE to also ensure that no fire spreads
from the Demised Premises. |
34. |
THE LESSEE to have the audit of their entire Electrical systems done on a half-yearly basis by a reputed Electrical consultant and provide a certificate certifying that all THE LESSEEs installations including
insulation resistance are in good and safe working condition and does not have any possibility of short circuit and becoming a fire source. To be submitted to the facility manager on half-yearly basis. |
- 63 -
35. |
THE LESSEE to have the audit of their entire HVAC systems done on a half-yearly basis by a reputed HVAC consultant and provide a certificate certifying that all THE LESSEEs installations are in good and safe
working condition and does not have any possibility of short circuit and becoming a fire source. To be submitted to the facility manager on half-yearly basis. |
(III) |
DRAWINGS & SPECIFICATIONS |
36. |
THE LESSEE shall ensure that the fitout works is done as per the drawings approved by THE LESSORs architect. No deviation will be allowed. |
37. |
THE LESSEE to use fire retardant material in the design of their interior works. |
38. |
While designing of interior works, it should be kept in mind that the access to the fire hydrants is not restricted in any way. |
39. |
For flushing of water closets only cisterns/concealed cisterns are to be used. No flushing valves to be installed. |
40. |
THE LESSEE shall ensure that no structural damage takes place. |
41. |
Every day, on completion of work, THE LESSEE shall ensure that the site is cleaned all combustible & non-combustible scrap including any wood/paper/lose paint /any other material/scrap is remove from the
premises. |
42. |
THE LESSEE shall ensure that the malba/scrap is disposed out of site every day. |
43. |
THE LESSEE shall ensure that the stair cases are not blocked with interior fitout material. |
44. |
No material shall be stocked in the lift lobby area. |
- 64 -
45. |
THE LESSEE shall not store paint and other combustible material at Demised Premises. The material may be brought onto the floor for interior finishing as and when it is required. |
46. |
No storage of any material / records in basement is allowed as it obstructs free movement. However, for a limited period of 10 days during interior works THE LESSEE with the permission of the facility manager can use
this earmarked car/two wheeler parking space as temporary storage for fixture/furniture which is in the process of being installed. The same must be barricaded by THE LESSEE and THE LESSEE must depute a security guard for the same. THE LESSEE must
install a Fire Fighting system such as extinguishers, sand buckets & water buckets to the satisfaction of the facility manager for this temporary storage area. This furniture/fixture will be allowed to be brought only 7 days in advance of
installation. The storage area must be cleared by THE LESSEE immediately after shifting the material in their premises. In case the interiors are getting delayed beyond the targeted date, THE LESSEE will clear the temporary store immediately and
shift all material in their premises. When the material is shifted on the floor the packing / covering to be removed the same day and all packing / covering material to be shifted out of the premises and the building on the same day.
|
47. |
During normal office hours, no noisy interior works such as drilling, hammering, cutting, chisilling etc is to be carried out by THE LESSEE. The same can be done after normal office hours. However, works other than the
above can be carried on which cause no disturbance to the occupied floors. |
48. |
Working Norms for Interior Works |
|
(a) |
In New Building where no other LESSEE is operational the interior works can be done on 24 hrs. basis. |
|
(b) |
In a multi-tenanted building as soon as any other LESSEE completes their interior works and becomes operational; no noisy works to be done during office hours. |
|
(c) |
Noisy works such as drilling, hammering, cutting, chiseling etc. to be carrying out by THE LESSEE after normal office hours. |
49. |
No Parking of CNG / LPG powered cars in basements as the chances of occurrence of fire / explosion in such vehicles are very high. |
THE LESSEE shall use the parking spaces only for the purposes of parking its cars and for no other use.
- 65 -
THE LESSEE undertakes that it shall not make any constructions on the car /two wheeler parking
spaces or create obstruction of any kind on it or around these spaces to hinder the movement of vehicles and persons.
50. |
All the terraces of the Said Building including the parapet walls of the terraces shall always be the property of THE LESSOR and THE LESSOR shall be entitled to use the same for any purpose as it may deem fit.
|
51. |
The façade of the Said Building shall also be used by other LESSEES/Occupants for displaying their name and advertisements as per THE LESSORs approval. |
No signage of any kind either inside or outside shall be allowed on the façade glass/ columns of the Demised Premises.
52. |
That before any machinery, equipment, safe or furniture, etc. is moved into or out of the Demised Premises, due approval in writing must be taken by THE LESSEE from the Building Manager or other authorized personnel
appointed by THE LESSOR, in the absence of which the movement thereof will not be permitted by THE LESSOR, provided, however, such movement will be allowed during normal business hours only. |
53. |
Lifts/ elevators/ escalators of reputed makes have been provided in the Said Building/ Said Complex. |
THE LESSEE should educate its employees, visitors and customers with regard to the DOs and DONTs of the safe usage of these items.
These are self operating lifts/ elevators/ escalators. Dos and Donts as recommended by the suppliers are as displayed therein.
The maintenance of these items is done by giving AMCs to suppliers/ third parties.
In the event of any mishap occurring, THE LESSOR or its employees shall not be held responsible for any consequences arising from usage of
these items.
- 66 -
B. |
The following fire-detection and alarm system are provided as per NBC norms inside the premises: |
Fire Detection & Alarm System:
|
1. |
Main control / Alarm panel located in security room connected with the floor-wise zonal panel located near the staircase. |
|
2. |
The Smoke / Heat Detectors installed by the floor occupant are connected to the zonal panels located on the floors. |
|
3. |
The main panel has inbuilt zone-wise fire detector and automatic alarm on all floors, through an amplifier. |
|
4. |
All AHUs and other ventilation / pressurization systems are operationally hooked-up with fire alarm / detection system. |
Fire Fighting System
The following fire fighting systems are provided along with:
|
|
|
Fire Pumps (Hydrants & sprinkler) |
|
|
|
Diesel Driven engine pump |
|
|
|
Fire extinguishers in common areas |
|
|
|
Public address and Alarm System |
|
|
|
Automatic / manual Fire Alarm system |
The Fire Hydrant systems comprises of internal fire hydrant system
available on all the floors and the external hydrant system around the building.
Sprinkler system is provided in basement, Lift lobby and service area
and office areas as per NBC norms.
- 67 -
Exhibit 4.13
LEASE DEED
THIS LEASE DEED is
made at Gurgaon on this day of , 2014.
BETWEEN
M/s DLF Assets Private
Limited, a company incorporated under the Companies Act, 1956 and having its Registered Office at 1-E, Jhandewalan Extension, Naaz Cinema Complex, New Delhi - 110 055 India (hereinafter referred to as THE LESSOR which
expression shall unless it be repugnant to the context or meaning thereof, be deemed to mean and include its successors, administrators, transferees and assigns) acting through its Authorized Signatories, Mr. Amit Grover and Mr. Navin
Kedia duly authorized vide Board Resolution dated 17th January, 2014 of the First Part.
AND
M/s WNS Global Services Private
Limited, a company incorporated under the Companies Act 1956 and having its Registered Office and Head Office/Corporate Office at Plant No. 10, Gate No. 4, Godrej & Boyce Complex, Pirojshangar, LBS Marg, Vikhroli (West),
Mumbai 400079 (hereinafter referred to as THE LESSEE which expression shall, unless it be repugnant to the context or meaning thereof, be deemed to mean and include its successors) having Permanent Account Number (PAN)
AAACW2598L and Tax Deduction and Collection Account Number (TAN) MUMW01007G, acting through its Authorized Signatory Mr. Varun Vasisht duly authorized vide Board Resolution dated
31st October, 2013 of the Second Part.
(Both THE LESSOR and THE LESSEE are collectively
referred to as the Parties).
- 1 -
WHEREAS:
A. |
DLF Limited has been granted formal approval for the Said Plot (as defined hereinafter) by the Department of Commerce (EPZ Section), Ministry of Commerce & Industry, Government of India, by a letter of
approval (Ref No. F.2/137/2005-EPZ) dated October 25, 2006 and notified vide Notification no. S.O. 2070 (E) dated December 6, 2006 and S.O. 395 (E) dated March 19, 2007, pursuant to the provision of the SEZ Laws;
|
B. |
DLF Limited and THE LESSOR thereafter executed certain agreements which inter alia detailed the terms and conditions with respect to transfer and handing over of certain specified buildings on the Said Plot to
THE LESSOR. By virtue of these agreements and after requisite regulatory approvals including the approvals from the Board of Approval, Ministry of Commerce, Government of India, THE LESSOR became the co-developer with rights to develop, operate and
maintain the Said Building including conversion of Bare Shell building into Warm Shell building. |
C. |
THE LESSOR is seized and possessed of the Said Building developed/ to be developed and is competent to lease office spaces in the Said Building. |
D. |
THE LESSEE has approached THE LESSOR to lease office space(s) in the said Building and THE LESSOR has agreed to lease and THE LESSEE has executed the LOI with THE LESSOR to take on lease the Demised Premises (as
hereinafter defined). |
E. |
Based on the above representations made by THE LESSOR and after due inspection and verification of the Said Plot, the Said Complex (as defined hereinafter), the Said Building and the Demised Premises (as defined
hereinafter) and also all the approvals and sanctions including approved building plans, ownership record of the said Plot, Said Building and other documents relating to the title, competency, and all other relevant details, THE LESSEE is satisfied
in all respects with regard to the right, title, authority and competency of THE LESSOR to enter into this Lease Deed. |
F. |
THE LESSEE hereby confirms that it shall carry out, implement and execute all interior works/ designs in the Demised Premises in compliance/ adherence with the approval/ guidelines issued by THE LESSOR from time
to time for carrying out such interior works in the Demised Premises. |
G. |
THE LESSEE further confirms that it shall obtain/ has obtained all pre-requisite sanctions, approvals, licenses, from all the statutory/ competent authorities which may be necessary for commencement of its
business operations in the Demised Premises. THE LESSEE shall be solely responsible and liable for any action by any authority, claim/ damages etc. arising out of non-compliance thereof. |
H. |
THE LESSEE shall be responsible for compliances of all applicable laws and to perform all of its obligations under this Lease Deed including various permissions and approvals to the extent required to be
observed/ performed by THE LESSEE under the SEZ Laws and THE LESSOR shall not be liable in any manner towards any action/ claims / damages arising due to any non-compliance of any laws and non-fulfillment of any obligations by THE LESSEE.
|
- 2 -
I. |
Upon assurances and representations of THE LESSEE that it shall strictly abide by the covenants contained in this Lease Deed and has all the required and necessary approvals and permissions under the SEZ Laws and
other applicable statutes, bye-laws for operating THE LESSEEs unit in the Demised Premises, THE LESSOR in good faith believing all representations of THE LESSEE to be true, has agreed to give on lease to THE LESSEE, the Demised Premises, on
the terms and conditions recorded herein. |
J. |
THE LESSEE confirms that it is executing this Lease Deed with full knowledge of all the Laws, Bye-laws, Rules, Regulations, Notification etc. which are applicable to the Said Plot, Said Complex, Said Building and
the Demised Premises. |
K. |
Both the Parties have agreed to enter into this Lease Deed on the terms and conditions stipulated in this Lease Deed and as per the commercial terms as provided in the LOI and as annexed hereto as Annexures C-I(a) and/or C-I(b) and Annexures C-II to C-V and T-I to T-X annexed hereto. |
NOW THEREFORE IT IS HEREBY AGREED BY AND BETWEEN THE PARTIES HERETO AS FOLLOWS:
1. |
DEFINITIONS AND INTERPRETATION: |
In this Lease Deed, unless the context otherwise requires, the following
terms shall have the following meanings:
Access Cards shall mean the access cards provided by THE LESSOR to THE LESSEE and /or
its employees.
Bare Shell shall mean the built up structures with lift lobbies, external facades, fire suppression system as
per building norms, cement flooring, no plaster on concrete columns, walls or ceiling except on brick walls.
Car Parking
Charges shall mean the charges collectively payable for car parking spaces and additional car parking spaces (if any), as detailed in Annexure C-I(a).
Demised Premises shall mean super built up area admeasuring 9,536.698 sq. mtrs. (1,02,653 sq. ft.) (approx.) on 8th, 9th & part of 11th Floor in the Said Building and as more fully described and
detailed as per Annexures T-I & T-II.
Due Date shall mean the
1st day of each English calendar month but not later than 7th day of each English calendar month.
- 3 -
Façade Signage shall mean the signage which may be put up by THE LESSEE
indicating its name or logo and to be put up on an earmarked location with size and specification as approved / permitted by THE LESSOR.
Façade Signage Charges shall mean the annual charges payable by THE LESSEE for putting up the Façade Signage as
detailed in Annexure C-I(a).
IFRESD shall mean the interest free refundable electricity security deposit, as provided
in Annexure C-I(a).
IFRMSD shall mean the interest free refundable maintenance security deposit, as provided in
Annexure C-I(a).
IFRSD shall mean the interest free refundable security deposit, as provided in Annexure C-I(a).
IPR shall mean intellectual property rights collectively including all trade names, trademarks, service marks, brand
name(s), logos, symbols, proprietary marks, etc.
Lease Commencement Date shall mean the date of commencement of
Lease Term as provided in Annexure C-I(a).
Lease Deed shall mean this lease deed executed between THE LESSOR and THE
LESSEE and shall include all the annexures thereto and any amendment/modifications made to this lease deed in accordance with the terms hereto.
Lease Renewal Term shall mean a further period of 5 years from the expiry of the Lease Term.
Lease Term shall mean a period of 5 years from the Lease Commencement Date.
Lock-in period shall mean a period as provided in Annexure C I (a) from the Lease Commencement Date.
LOI shall mean the letter of intent dated 14th February, 2014 in respect
of leasing of the Demised Premises.
Letter of Approval shall mean the letter of approval granted by the concerned authority
under the SEZ Laws.
Maintenance Charges shall mean the monthly charges towards the maintenance services, as provided in
Annexure C-I (a).
- 4 -
Property shall collectively mean the Said Plot, the Said Complex and the Said
Building.
Rent Commencement Date shall mean the date for commencement of payment of Warm Shell Rent as provided in Annexure
C-I(a).
Said Building shall mean tower A2 & A3, of the Said Complex, in Warm Shell condition.
Said Complex shall mean the complex consisting of multi storied towers with basements/ stilt constructed on the Said Plot and known
as DLF World Tech Park, NH8, Gurgaon.
Said Plot shall mean the land measuring 37 Acres situated at NH8, Silokhera, Gurgaon
more fully described in Annexure C-II.
Security Deposits shall mean IFRSD, IFRMSD and IFRESD collectively.
SEZ approvals shall mean the approvals under the SEZ Laws.
SEZ Laws shall mean the Special Economic Zones Act, 2005 and any amendment thereto and the rules and regulations framed thereunder
from time to time.
Taxes on Property shall mean collectively any and all taxes, duties, charges, cesses, levy(ies) etc. on the
Property as may be levied by the Central Government and/or State Government and/or local bodies and/or any other competent authority(ies).
TDS shall mean the tax deducted at source at the applicable rates as per the Income Tax Act or any other tax of similar nature
under any statute as applicable from time to time.
Warm Shell shall mean Bare Shell with complete building atriums, all
fittings, air conditioning ducts, electrical distribution and fire fighting, electricity provisions on each floor up to the shaft, 100% power back up including power back up for air conditioning system and back up air conditioning provision for the
office area up to Air Handling Unit (AHU) on each floor.
Warm Shell Rent shall mean the monthly rent payable for the Demised
Premises as provided in Annexure C-I(a).
1.1 |
In the interpretation of this Lease Deed including the recitals and annexures, unless the context or subject matter otherwise requires: |
|
(a) |
the singular includes the plural and vice versa and in particular (but without limiting the generality of the foregoing) any word or expression defined in the singular shall have a corresponding meaning if used in the
plural and vice versa; |
- 5 -
|
(b) |
a reference to any gender includes the other gender; |
|
(c) |
a reference to any agreement, deed or other instrument (including, without limitation, references to this Lease Deed) includes the same as varied, amended, supplemented, restated, novated or replaced from time to time;
|
|
(d) |
a reference to any statutory provision or to any provision of any legislation includes any modification, amendment or re-enactment of any legislative provision substituted for any or all statutory instruments or
notification issued under such legislation or such provisions; |
|
(e) |
where a word or phrase has a defined meaning, any other part of speech or grammatical form in respect of the word or phrase has a corresponding meaning; and |
|
(f) |
a reference to a clause or annexure is a reference to the relevant clause of or annexure to this Lease Deed. |
1.2 |
In this Lease Deed, headings are for the convenience of reference only and shall not affect interpretation. |
THE LESSOR hereby agrees to grant the Demised Premises on lease to
THE LESSEE and THE LESSEE agrees to take the Demised Premises on lease from THE LESSOR, as per terms and conditions of this Lease Deed, together with the right to park cars in terms of this Lease Deed, in the car parking spaces earmarked by
THE LESSOR in the basement(s)/ stilt/ surface car parking spaces as provided in Annexure T-III of this Lease Deed.
2.1 |
Expansion option for THE LESSEE: In the event, THE LESSEE intends to expand its office space in the Said Complex, the details for the same are as given in Annexures C- IV(a) and C-IV(b) of this
Lease Deed and a separate Lease Deed will be signed between the parties for the aforesaid expansion option. (Strike off if not applicable) |
3.1 |
THE LESSEE shall pay the Warm Shell Rent in advance for the month in respect of which such Warm Shell Rent is payable, to THE LESSOR or its nominees/ permitted assigns by cheque/ bank draft/ wire transfer (in accordance
with the ECS form annexed as Annexure C-V of this Lease Deed), payable from the Rent Commencement Date. |
3.2 |
The Warm Shell Rent shall be payable by the Due Date and shall be paid in advance for each month in respect of which the Warm Shell Rent would be payable. |
- 6 -
3.3 |
Any other taxes/ duties/ charges/ cesses / levy(ies) etc. as applicable, from time to time, on Warm Shell Rent including service tax shall be payable by THE LESSEE in addition to the Warm Shell Rent as mentioned
hereinabove. |
3.4 |
Payment of Warm Shell Rent is subject to deduction of TDS. |
3.5 |
Notwithstanding other rights of THE LESSOR as provided in this Lease Deed, all delayed payments under this Lease Deed shall carry an interest of 15% per annum from the Due Date till the date the payments are made.
|
4.1 |
Car parking spaces shall be provided in stilt/ surface/ basement car parking spaces (as applicable) on the Said Plot, the charges for which are detailed in Annexure C-I(a) of this Lease Deed. Any additional car
parking spaces shall be provided, subject to availability, as per the charges detailed in the aforementioned Annexure C-I(a). |
4.2 |
The Car Parking Charges shall be payable by the Due Date and shall be paid in advance for each month in respect of which the Car Parking Charges would be payable. |
4.3 |
Such car parking spaces shall be earmarked for the exclusive use of THE LESSEE and shall not be used by THE LESSEE for storage or any purpose other than parking its cars/ two wheelers. |
4.4 |
The Lock-in Period shall also be applicable to the car parking spaces including any additional car parking spaces. |
4.5 |
Any other taxes/ duties/ charges/ cesses/levy(ies) etc. as applicable from time to time, on the Car Parking Charges including service tax shall be payable by THE LESSEE in addition to the Car Parking Charges as
mentioned hereinabove. |
5.1 |
Lift Lobby and Building Atrium Directory Signage/ Name/ Logo |
5.1.1 |
THE LESSEE may be allowed to put its directional signage/ name/ logo on the lift lobby of the floor occupied by it, at its own cost. |
5.1.2 |
The location for putting such directional signage/ name/ logo and the size of the same shall be subject to prior written approval of THE LESSOR. |
5.1.3 |
All taxes, fee, charges, cess, duties, levy(ies) etc on putting up such directional signage/ name/ logo shall be the sole liability of THE LESSEE and payable directly to the concerned authorities by THE LESSEE, as
applicable from time to time. |
- 7 -
5.1.4 |
THE LESSOR may display THE LESSEEs name/ logo on the building directory signage placed in the atrium of the Said Building as per the location, size and specification of such building directory signage determined
by THE LESSOR. |
5.1.5 |
The aforesaid shall be subject to the laws and regulations, as applicable from time to time. |
5.2.1 |
The Façade Signage Charges shall be payable by THE LESSEE to THE LESSOR or its nominees/ assigns in advance from the Lease Commencement Date or from the date the Façade Signage is taken by THE LESSEE (i.e.
the date on which the addendum for modifying Annexure C-I(a) to this effect is signed between the Parties), whichever is later. |
5.2.2 |
There shall be no refund /adjustment of such Façade Signage Charges on expiry of lease and/ or any earlier termination thereof. |
5.2.3 |
The Façade Signage Charges shall escalate together and as per escalation in Warm Shell Rent as mentioned in Annexure C-I(a). |
5.2.4 |
All taxes including service tax, duties, rates, cesses, costs and charges relating to the Façade Signage, payable to the authorities concerned from time to time, shall be borne and paid by THE LESSEE directly.
|
5.2.5 |
Service tax and any other taxes/duties/charges/levy(ies) etc. as statutorily applicable from time to time on Façade Signage Charges shall be payable by THE LESSEE in addition to the Façade Signage Charges
as mentioned hereinabove. |
5.2.6 |
The above shall be subject to the laws and regulations as applicable from time to time. |
5.2.7 |
No signage of any kind either inside or outside shall be allowed on the façade glass/ columns of the Demised Premises. |
6.1 |
The maintenance services for the Said Plot / Said Complex/Said Building, as set out in Annexure T-IV to this Lease Deed, shall be provided by THE LESSOR or its nominees/ assigns, the estimated Maintenance Charges
for which shall be calculated prorata of the super built up area of the Demised Premises to the total super built-up area of the Property. |
6.2 |
The Maintenance Charges for such maintenance services shall be paid to THE LESSOR or its nominees/ assigns, in advance for each month, as per the bill(s)/ invoice(s) raised by THE LESSOR or its nominees/ assigns.
|
- 8 -
6.3 |
The Maintenance Charges shall be subject to deduction of Income Tax at source as applicable, from time to time. |
6.4 |
Any other taxes/ duties/ charges/ cesses / levy(ies) etc. as applicable from time to time on Maintenance Charges including service tax shall be payable by THE LESSEE in addition to the Maintenance Charges mentioned
hereinabove as and when demanded by THE LESSOR. |
6.5 |
The Maintenance Charges shall be payable by the Due Date, in advance for each month in respect of which such Maintenance Charges would be payable. |
6.6 |
The Maintenance Charges as specified in this Lease Deed are subject to increase of prices of diesel, gas, petroleum products and other consumables, electricity rates, taxes, wages and salaries, cost of annual
maintenance contracts of lifts, DGs, HVAC supplies, transformers, panels etc. during the Lease Term and the Lease Renewal Term (if any). |
6.7 |
After completion of a financial year (i.e. from 1st April of a calendar year to 31st March of the next
calendar year), THE LESSOR or its nominees / assigns will provide THE LESSEE, within a reasonable time period, a third party auditor certificate of expenditure/ expenses towards maintenance charges incurred during such financial year.
|
Any under-recovery by THE LESSOR or its nominees/assigns shall become payable by THE LESSEE to THE LESSOR or its
nominees/assigns and any over-recovery by THE LESSOR or its nominees/assigns shall become refundable by THE LESSOR/ or its nominees/assigns to THE LESSEE. Any such payment by refund to THE LESSEE shall be without any interest and such payment shall
be payable by either party within thirty (30) days of providing such third party auditor certificate and issuance of credit/ debit note (as applicable).
7. |
POWER/ ELECTRICITY/ POWER BACK-UP CHARGES: |
7.1 |
The power/ electricity and power back-up for the Said Plot/ Said Complex/ Said Building/ Demised Premises will be provided by grid (as per availability) or private utility companies or generator sets, the charges of
which will be as per Annexure C-I(a) of this Lease Deed. |
7.2 |
Separate meters will be installed by THE LESSOR for recording the consumption of power, power back up, AHU electrical usage and water in the Demised Premises. The cost for such meters, if applicable, shall be payable by
THE LESSOR as a one-time non-refundable cost. Alternatively, the monthly meter hire charges, if applicable, shall be payable by THE LESSEE separately along with the monthly power consumption charges. |
7.3 |
The bills for such charges shall be raised by THE LESSOR or its nominees/ assigns as per the meter reading and shall be payable by THE LESSEE by the due date as mentioned in such bills. |
- 9 -
8.1 |
Interest Free Refundable Security Deposit (IFRSD) |
8.1.1 |
THE LESSEE shall pay and always maintain the IFRSD as per details given in Annexure-C-I(a) with THE LESSOR, during the Lease Term and the Lease Renewal Term, if any. |
8.1.2 |
The aforesaid IFRSD shall automatically stand proportionately increased and payable upon escalation in Warm Shell Rent, as mentioned in Annexure C-I(a) of this Lease Deed and shall be paid by THE LESSEE along
with the first payment of the escalated Warm Shell Rent to THE LESSOR. |
8.2 |
Interest Free Refundable Maintenance Security Deposit (IFRMSD)- |
8.2.1 |
THE LESSEE shall pay and always maintain the IFRMSD as per details given in Annexure-C-I(a) with THE LESSOR or its nominees/ assigns, during the Lease Term and the Lease Renewal Term, if any. |
8.3 |
Interest Free Refundable Electricity Security Deposit (IFRESD) |
8.3.1 |
THE LESSEE shall pay and always maintain with THE LESSOR, the IFRESD as per details given in Annexure-C-I(a) for an amount for power load of 0.006 KVA per sq.ft. for the Demised Premises provided by THE
LESSOR for internal lighting and power (excluding HVAC load) during the Lease Term and the Lease Renewal Term, if any. |
8.3.2 |
Any additional power load required by THE LESSEE shall be provided not exceeding 3% of 0.006 KVA per sq.ft. of the Demised Premises, subject to availability and on payment of a non-refundable charge of Rs. 10,000/- per
KVA of power load in addition to the refundable deposit of Rs. 3,000/- per KVA of power load. However, any additional infrastructure cost required for supply of power from the source of power to the electrical tap off box on the floor shall be borne
by THE LESSEE at cost + 20% basis. Any additional power load requirement beyond 3% of 0.006 KVA per sq.ft of leased area and the payment thereof shall be subject to mutual agreement between the Parties. |
8.3.3 |
Any deposit/ charges as may be demanded by the grid/ utility companies supplying power to the Demised Premises/ Said Building/ Said Complex from time to time, shall be additionally payable by THE LESSEE on the basis of
proportionate electricity load provided to the Demised Premises, prior to such connection. |
8.4 |
Refund of Security Deposits |
The Security Deposits, shall be the amounts kept with THE
LESSOR against due performance of obligations and payments of all dues by THE LESSEE under the Lease Deed. THE LESSOR shall be entitled, at any time with intimation to THE LESSEE, to utilize and make deduction(s) from the Security Deposits, of an
amount, which in the opinion of THE LESSOR, is/ are equivalent to the outstanding dues of THE LESSEE, or for making good any loss or damage caused or permitted to be caused to THE LESSOR or Demised Premises by THE LESSEE. THE LESSEE shall be
required to forthwith replenish the Security Deposits to the full amount upon any deduction(s) made by THE LESSOR under any provision of this Lease Deed.
- 10 -
THE LESSOR shall provide to THE LESSEE the statement of the outstanding dues payable by THE
LESSEE, if any, and other estimated charges payable under the Lease Deed, supported with relevant documents, Fifteen (15) days prior to the expiry of the Lease Term/ Lease Renewal Term (if any) and THE LESSEE undertakes to clear the aforesaid
amounts and provide the TDS certificates regarding the payments made to THE LESSOR within the permissible time frame as per the income tax regulations.
Simultaneous to the expiry/ earlier termination of this Lease Deed and upon THE LESSEE surrendering peaceful, vacant and physical possession of
the Demised Premises in as good condition as it was in at the time when THE LESSEE was handed over the Demised Premises for fit outs, reasonable wear and tear excepted, subject to THE LESSEE making payment of any and all outstanding dues/ claims for
damages (if any) under this Lease Deed or Lease Renewal Term (if any) separately to THE LESSOR, THE LESSOR shall refund all Security Deposits as mentioned above to THE LESSEE, without any interest.
However, such refund is subject to adjustment or deduction of dues with respect to the TDS (if any) and outstanding dues under this Lease Deed
including Warm shell Rent, Maintenance Charges, Power Charges/ claims for damages (if any) under this Lease Deed or renewal thereof, if the above are not paid by THE LESSEE.
In case of any delay by THE LESSOR in refunding the Security Deposits to THE LESSEE as aforesaid, provided such delay is not attributable to
THE LESSEE, THE LESSOR shall pay an interest of 15% per annum for the period of such delay.
9.1 |
In addition to the payments mentioned in preceding clauses, Taxes on Property are payable/ reimbursable by THE LESSEE calculated prorata of the super built up area of the Demised Premises to the total super built-up
area of the Property as well as payable/reimbursable in respect of car parking spaces, if applicable. |
9.2 |
Taxes on Property as presently levied and all increases and/ or fresh impositions thereof as levied both prospectively and retrospectively and shall be payable/ reimbursable from the Lease Commencement Date and till the
occupancy period by THE LESSEE or the Lock-in period, whichever is later, as applicable. |
- 11 -
9.3 |
Taxes on Property shall be paid/ reimbursed by THE LESSEE to THE LESSOR, within fifteen (15) days of the date of invoice/ demand raised/ made by THE LESSOR, giving details thereof duly supported with copies of
relevant documents, if any. |
9.4 |
Any penalties/ interest arising due to delayed payments/ reimbursements by THE LESSEE shall be solely to THE LESSEEs account. Similarly, any penalties arising due to delayed payments by THE LESSOR shall be solely
to THE LESSORs account. |
10.1 |
Unless earlier terminated in accordance with the terms of this Lease Deed, the lease shall be valid for the Lease Term. |
10.2 |
The Parties shall comply with the SEZ Laws and shall keep their SEZ approvals valid during the entire Lease Term and Lease Renewal Term (if any). |
10.3 |
THE LESSEE agrees that in the event the Letter of Approval granted to THE LESSEE expires or is withdrawn or cancelled for any reason whatsoever by the concerned authority under the SEZ Laws, then in such an event the
Lease Deed shall stand automatically terminated on such expiry / withdrawal / cancellation without any further notice from THE LESSOR. In such an event of expiry / termination/ cancellation of the letter of approval then it shall be treated as
termination of the Lease Deed under Clause 12.1 and shall be liable of consequences as stipulated therein. |
11. |
LEASE RENEWAL AND ESCALATION: |
11.1 |
Lease Renewal Term (if any): THE LESSEE shall have the option to renew the Lease Deed for the Lease Renewal Term and such renewal shall be permitted by THE LESSOR, provided that: |
|
(a) |
THE LESSEE has provided THE LESSOR with a written notice at least six (6) months prior to the expiry of the Lease Term, stating its intention to renew the Lease Deed for the Lease Renewal Term; and
|
|
(b) |
THE LESSEE has received approval for such Lease Renewal Term under the provisions of the applicable laws including SEZ Laws. |
11.2 |
Such renewal, if any, shall be subject to performance of its obligations under this Lease Deed by THE LESSEE and execution of a fresh Lease Deed in respect of the Lease Renewal Term before the expiry of the existing
lease tenure. |
11.3 |
The LESSEE shall be liable to pay the escalations in Warm Shell Rent, Car Parking charges and IFRSD (if any) as provided in Annexure C-I(a) during the Lease Term or Lease Renewal Term (if any). |
- 12 -
12. |
LOCK-IN PERIOD/ TERMINATION BY THE LESSEE: |
12.1 |
Termination by THE LESSEE before the expiry of the Lock-in Period: |
THE LESSEE may
terminate the lease, by giving a prior written notice for a period of six (06) months before the expiry of the Lock-in period or by making payment of Warm Shell Rent, Car Parking Charges, Taxes on Property, Façade Signage Charges (if
any), Maintenance Charges, taxes and any other charges in lieu of the said notice period of six (06) months and also the amount equivalent to any rent-free period (period between the Lease Commencement Date and the Rent Commencement Date)
extended to THE LESSEE.
In such an event, THE LESSEE shall also be liable to pay the amount equivalent to the Warm Shell Rent and other
charges as aforesaid for the entire unexpired Lock-in period or the date of expiry of the Six (06) months notice period mentioned herein above, whichever is later and handover the peaceful, physical and vacant possession of the Demised Premises
to THE LESSOR in as good condition as it was in at the time when THE LESSEE was handed over the Demised Premises for fit outs, reasonable wear and tear excepted. In the event THE LESSEE fails to handover the Demised Premises to THE LESSOR upon
termination as aforesaid, then THE LESSEE shall be treated as an unauthorized occupant and shall also be liable to pay use and occupation charges as provided in clause 15.1 of this Lease Deed.
12.2 |
Termination by THE LESSEE after the expiry of the Lock-in Period: |
THE LESSEE may
terminate the lease, by giving a prior written notice for a period of six (06) months anytime after the expiry of the Lock-in period, or alternatively by making payment of Warm Shell Rent, Car Parking Charges, Taxes on Property, Façade
Signage Charges (if any), Maintenance Charges, taxes and any other charges in lieu of the said notice period and handover the peaceful, physical and vacant possession of the Demised Premises to THE LESSOR in as good condition as it was in at the
time when THE LESSEE was handed over the Demised Premises for fit outs, reasonable wear and tear excepted. In the event THE LESSEE fails to handover the Demised Premises to THE LESSOR upon termination as aforesaid, then THE LESSEE shall be treated
as an unauthorized occupant and shall also be liable to pay use and occupation charges as provided in clause 15.1 of this Lease Deed.
12.3 |
Notice Period for termination of the Lease Renewal Term (if any): Prior written notice of Six (06) months shall be given by THE LESSEE to THE LESSOR for termination of the Lease Renewal Term (if any) and in that
event, provisions of Clause 12.2 shall be applicable. |
- 13 -
12.4 |
THE LESSEE shall pay the Warm Shell Rent and other charges as stipulated in Clause 12.1 and 12.2 above (as the case may be) in case the lease is terminated under Clause 14 of this Lease Deed. |
12.5 |
THE LESSEE shall not be entitled to raise any dispute or claim on any amount payable to/ claimed by THE LESSOR as stated above. |
13. |
DEFAULT IN PAYMENT BY THE LESSEE: |
In case THE LESSEE defaults in making payments under
the Lease Deed, the following shall be applicable:
13.1 |
Beyond Seven (07) days from the Due Date: An interest of 15% per annum shall be applicable on the unpaid amounts, from the Due Date till the date of such payment to THE LESSOR. |
13.2 |
Beyond Sixty (60) days from the Due Date: THE LESSOR or its nominee/assign shall, in its sole discretion and with prior intimation of seven (07) days, stop supplying to THE LESSEE electricity / air
conditioning/ water and / or all other services and resume the services only after receiving full payment of any and all dues, payable including interest payable thereon as stated above. |
13.3 |
The aforesaid is in addition to any other remedies/ actions THE LESSOR may take and THE LESSOR shall have no responsibility or liability for any costs, loss and damage, if any, suffered by THE LESSEE on account of same.
THE LESSEE shall not be entitled to lodge any claim whatsoever against THE LESSOR as a result of such action. |
14. |
TERMINATION OF LEASE FOR NON-PAYMENT/ BREACH (ES) BY THE LESSEE AND/ OR INSOLVENCY OF THE LESSEE: |
14.1 |
The lease shall stand terminated after prior notice of fifteen (15) days to THE LESSEE by THE LESSOR in the following events: |
|
a) |
On failure of THE LESSEE to pay the amount payable under the Lease Deed for seventy five (75) days from the Due Date; or |
|
b) |
On failure to remedy the breach of any of covenant or conditions of the Lease Deed despite of issuance of written notice by THE LESSOR stating such breach/default and demanding rectification thereof within fifteen
(15) days of the date of the notice. |
In such cases, on or before the expiry of the notice period as aforesaid, THE
LESSEE shall hand over peaceful, vacant and physical possession of the Demised Premises in as good condition as it was in at the time when THE LESSEE was handed over the Demised Premises for fit outs, reasonable wear and tear excepted, to THE LESSOR
and shall make payments of all outstanding dues and all claims for damages (if any) under this Lease Deed or Lease Renewal Term (if any) to THE LESSOR, including payment of all dues under the Lease Deed for the termination notice period of six
(06) months in case the balance Lease Term or Lease Renewal Term after such termination is more than six (06) months and for the balance unexpired Lease Term or Lease Renewal Term in case the balance Lease Term or Lease Renewal Term after
such termination is less than six (06) months.
- 14 -
14.2 |
Subject to clause 29.3, THE LESSEE represents and agrees that it shall maintain its corporate/ juridical existence during the Lease Term or Lease Renewal Term. In the event, THE LESSEE files a petition for being
declared as insolvent and/ or fails to maintain its corporate/ juridical existence and/ or is adjudicated as insolvent, then the lease shall forthwith stand terminated and THE LESSEE shall be treated as an unauthorized occupant for the Demised
Premises and shall also be liable to pay use and occupation charges as provided in clause 15.1 of this Lease Deed. In such an event, THE LESSOR shall enter into the Demised Premises to assume the possession which shall be without prejudice to the
rights of THE LESSOR to claim/ recover its dues along with interest/ damages under the Lease Deed, till the date of such termination. |
Notwithstanding the above, THE LESSOR may in its sole discretion with intimation to THE LESSEE, adjust all outstanding amounts payable under
this Lease Deed, by THE LESSEE, against the Security Deposits paid by THE LESSEE, and any shortfall after such adjustment (if any) shall be paid by THE LESSEE immediately to THE LESSOR.
15. |
USE AND OCCUPATION CHARGES BEYOND TERMINATION OF LEASE: |
15.1 |
If the lease is terminated by either party or expires by efflux of time and Demised Premises is not vacated and handed over by THE LESSEE in accordance with the terms of this Lease Deed, THE LESSEE shall be liable to
pay use and occupation charges for each day of occupation calculated on the basis of three (03) times the Warm Shell Rent divided by 30 days i.e. Rs.4,20,877/- per day (Rupees Four Lakhs Twenty Thousand Eight Hundred and Seventy Seven only per
day), along with amount equivalent to Warm Shell Rent, Car Parking Charges, Façade Signage Charges (if any), Maintenance Charges, taxes and any other charges as provided in Annexure C-I(a) till the handover of the Demised Premises by
THE LESSEE to THE LESSOR. |
15.2 |
THE LESSEE agrees not to raise any claims/ dispute(s) in this regard and the aforesaid right(s) of THE LESSOR shall be without prejudice to the rights and remedies of THE LESSOR under the Lease Deed and under any law
for the time being in force. |
16.1 |
During the Lease Term and the Lease Renewal Term (if any), THE LESSOR shall obtain fire and earth quake insurance coverage of the entire Said Building, insurance cover against third-party liability and shall make timely
payment of all insurance premiums. |
- 15 -
16.2 |
During the Lease Term and the Lease Renewal Term (if any), THE LESSEE shall obtain comprehensive insurance coverage, including third-party coverage, of all interior works while carrying out interiors or renovations,
furniture, equipment and/or other items kept or stored in the Demised Premises, and shall make timely payments of all insurance premia. THE LESSOR shall in no way be responsible for any loss occasioned by THE LESSEE on account of not obtaining
comprehensive insurance coverage as stated above. |
16.3 |
However, it is made clear between the Parties that in the event of an accident or fire or damages or for any other reason resulting in any loss, financial or otherwise to either party or to third parties, both Parties
agree to take up the matter with their respective insurance companies through the insurance cover including third party liability. |
16.4 |
Either party shall not do or permit to be done or shall not omit to be done any act or thing which may render void or voidable any insurance relating to or in respect of a part or the whole of the Said Plot, the Said
Building or the Demised Premises, or cause any increase in premium payable by other party in respect thereof. |
17. |
ENTRY BY ACCESS CARDS: (AS AND WHEN APPLICABLE) |
17.1 |
Entry to the Said Building/ Said Complex by THE LESSEE and its employees shall be permitted only through the Access Cards. |
17.2 |
Any loss of Access Card shall be intimated to THE LESSOR immediately to avoid misuse thereof. |
17.3 |
Any additional/ replacement of any lost Access Card will be provided within 5 days from the date of request of such Access Card by THE LESSEE and till the time such Access Cards are issued, the entry to the Said
Building shall be allowed to the employees/ visitors of THE LESSEE through temporary visitor Access Cards provided by THE LESSOR. |
17.4 |
The charges for issuance of Access Card shall be Rs. 20/- per Access Card. |
17.5 |
Upon cessation or termination of any employee(s), THE LESSEE shall intimate and return the Access Card(s) of such employee(s) to THE LESSOR immediately. |
17.6 |
The Access Card management for the Demised Premises shall be done by THE LESSEE, at its own cost, for its employees through a unique password and training. |
17.7 |
In addition, any SEZ Access Cards may be separately issued as per the policy/ guidelines of the SEZ/ concerned authorities, at an additional cost. |
- 16 -
18. |
TENTATIVE SPECIFICATIONS/ NAMING RIGHTS/ DISPLAY ETC. |
18.1 |
TENTATIVE SPECIFICATIONS OF THE SAID BUILDING/ DEMISED PREMISES: |
The specifications and
information as to the materials used in construction of the Said Building are set out in Annexure T-V and Annexure T-VI of this Lease Deed and any change in the specifications required by THE LESSEE, shall be charged at 1.2 times the
actual cost subject to feasibility thereof and subject to necessary approvals/ applicable laws, rules and regulations as applicable from time to time.
18.2 |
BUILDING NAMING RIGHTS: |
18.2.1 |
THE LESSOR reserves the naming rights of the Said Building/ Said Complex. |
18.2.2 |
The occupants may use such name of the Said Building/ Said Complex in the business addresses for all purposes. |
18.2.3 |
THE LESSEE shall not raise any objection if THE LESSOR changes the name of the Said Building/ Said Complex at any time in its sole discretion. |
18.3 |
THE LESSORs RIGHT TO MAKE ADDITIONS: |
18.3.1 |
THE LESSOR shall have absolute right to make additions, raise storeys or put up additional structures in and around the Said Building, without any hindrance to THE LESSEEs right to use or enjoy peaceful possession
and its conduct of business. THE LESSEE shall have no right to raise any objection for such additions etc. by THE LESSOR. |
18.3.2 |
Any such additional structures and storeys shall be the sole property of THE LESSOR, which THE LESSOR will be entitled to make use of or dispose of in any way it chooses without any reference to THE LESSEE.
|
18.4 |
DISPLAY OF MULTIMEDIA/VISUAL FORMAT: |
THE LESSEE acknowledges that THE LESSOR or its
nominees/assigns have the right to install posters, banners, contra-visions and displays of any multimedia/ visual format in the areas like lift lobbies, atrium(s), lifts, outer glass façade, curtain
walls, external walls etc. of the Said Building/ Said Complex and THE LESSEE shall not object to any such installation by THE LESSOR.
- 17 -
19.1 |
For carrying out interior/ fitout works, THE LESSEEs architect shall coordinate with THE LESSORs architect for approval of the drawing(s)/plan(s) and sanctions if any required by THE LESSEE. THE LESSEE shall
submit all the interior works drawings together as per Annexure T-IX attached herewith. THE LESSOR shall revert back on the drawings/ plans submitted by THE LESSEE within fifteen (15) days of such submission by THE LESSEE and Such
approvals shall not be unreasonably withheld by THE LESSOR. However, the Lease Commencement Date and the Rent Commencement Date shall not be deferred for any delay on this account. |
19.2 |
During the period of carrying interior/ fit out works, THE LESSEE shall take all precautions, fire and safety measures and cover its risks and THE LESSOR shall not be liable/ responsible for any loss or damage suffered
by THE LESSEE including but not limited to its materials and to third parties. Further, THE LESSEE shall keep THE LESSSOR indemnified and make good any loss or damage suffered by THE LESSOR due to any act of negligence, omission or commission of THE
LESSEE, its contractors, agents, employees, workmen of the contractors including but not limited to failure to comply with statutory and regulatory requirements. During such period, THE LESSEE shall be liable to pay electricity, water, power charges
and charges for security services at actuals plus 20%. |
19.3 |
THE LESSEE hereby confirms that it shall carry out, implement and execute all interior works/ designs/ alterations in the Demised Premises in compliance/ adherence with the approval/ guidelines issued by THE LESSOR and
the concerned authority(ies) from time to time for carrying out such interior works in the Demised Premises and in accordance with the local laws/bye laws and NBC as applicable and a certificate from a reputed consultant to that effect shall be
provided to THE LESSOR before starting the interior fit out work. After the completion of the interior/ fit out works, THE LESSEE shall provide to THE LESSOR a certificate from a reputed consultant verifying that the interior/ fit out works have
been carried out by THE LESSEE as per the drawings approved by THE LESSOR and in accordance with the local laws/ bye laws and NBC, as applicable, certifying that all safety measures have been taken care of including connection of fire panel with THE
LESSORs fire panel. THE LESSOR shall have the right to inspect and verify the same either directly or through its nominee/assigns. |
19.4 |
For any interior/ fit out works including any additions/ modifications/ alterations in the Demised Premises in accordance with the National Building Code as applicable, THE LESSEE shall carry out such works without
altering/ tampering with the fire fighting and fire detection systems as installed therein. However any additions/ modifications/ alterations to the existing fire fighting and fire detection system shall be done by THE LESSEE only after obtaining
prior written approval from THE LESSOR and by providing alternate and stand by fire fighting systems during all such works in the Demised Premises. |
19.5 |
THE LESSEE shall not carry out any work involving structural alterations/ cutting/ chopping/ digging/ hacking/ dismantling in any manner or form/ destroying the floors or walls of the Demised Premises or the Said
Building without prior written permission of THE LESSOR. |
19.6 |
THE LESSEE shall be directly liable for any legal or financial consequences arising out of such interior/ fit out works including liability towards any third party and all damages to the Demised Premises/ Said Building
or loss of life arising out of such interior/ fit out works shall be the sole responsibility of THE LESSEE. |
19.7 |
THE LESSEEs responsibilities during interior works as stated above are more detailed in Annexure T-X to this Lease Deed. |
- 18 -
20. |
FIRE FIGHTING AND FIRE DETECTION SYSTEM(S): |
20.1 |
The fire fighting and fire detection system, which is provided by THE LESSOR in accordance with National Building Code, is limited to installation of sprinklers and fire detection system in the basement(s) and common
areas of the Said Building such as lobbies, staircases corridors, etc. and service shaft for fire fighting and sprinkler services on each floor. |
20.2 |
Any kind of hazard including fire, electrical or otherwise from the Demised Premises due to inadequate fire fighting system installed by THE LESSEE or faulty installation of air-conditioning, electrical systems and
other equipment shall be the sole responsibility of THE LESSEE and THE LESSOR shall not be liable for any legal or financial consequences arising therefrom and THE LESSEE agrees to keep THE LESSOR indemnified and harmless in this regard at all
times. |
20.3 |
THE LESSEE shall allow third party fire/ safety experts being appointed by THE LESSOR/ its nominees for fire/ safety audit at all times. |
20.4 |
THE LESSEE shall take all steps including appointing a safety representative/ manager to ensure that all safety related activities within the Demised Premises are performed. THE LESSEE shall have the audit of their
entire electrical systems, fire fighting systems and HVAC systems done on a half-yearly basis by a reputed consultant and submit a certificate to THE LESSORs building manager certifying that all THE LESSEEs installations are in good and
safe working condition and do not have any possibility of short circuit and/or becoming a fire source. |
21. |
ADDITIONAL FIRE FIGHTING SYSTEM(S): |
21.1 |
For any additional fire safety measures required due to statutory /governmental directives, THE LESSOR shall undertake the same and THE LESSEE shall reimburse to THE LESSOR the cost thereof, calculated at actual cost
plus 20% basis, proportionate of the super built up area of the Demised Premises to the total super built-up area of the Property. |
21.2 |
For any additional fire safety measures required by THE LESSEE in the Demised Premises, THE LESSOR may undertake the same and THE LESSEE shall reimburse to THE LESSOR the cost thereof, calculated at actual cost+20%
basis, or alternatively THE LESSEE may undertake the same themselves, however, subject to THE LESSORs prior written approval on the same. |
21.3 |
In case THE LESSOR suggests any additional fire fighting or fire detection systems to THE LESSEE which may or may not be statutorily required, for installation by THE LESSEE within the Demised Premises and THE LESSEE
fails to implement THE LESSORs suggestion either fully or in part, then THE LESSEE alone shall be liable and responsible for all consequences arising from such inaction/decision on its part. |
21.4 |
All cost for such installation(s) of any additional fire fighting systems are non- refundable and shall be borne by THE LESSEE alone. |
- 19 -
22.1 |
THE LESSEE shall plan and distribute its electrical loads in the Demised Premises in conformity with the electrical systems installed by THE LESSOR, with prior written approval of THE LESSOR. |
22.2 |
Any modifications, additions, alterations in electrical and other systems already installed in the Demised Premises/ Said Building, if required and feasible as assessed by THE LESSOR in line with the base building
design, will be done by THE LESSOR and payable by THE LESSEE calculated at 1.2 times of actual costs incurred by THE LESSOR. |
23. |
MAINTENANCE & MINOR REPAIRS: |
THE LESSEE shall carry out the day-to-day
maintenance including minor repairs, distempering and polishing the interiors of the Demised Premises and the fixtures and fittings installed therein at its own cost.
24. |
COMMON AREA/ FACILITIES: |
24.1 |
THE LESSEE is entitled to use the common areas, facilities and amenities within the Said Building/ Said Complex/ Said Plot, as available, only subject to the timely payment of Maintenance Charges payable under this
Lease Deed. |
24.2 |
In the event of failure of timely payment of Maintenance Charges as aforesaid, THE LESSEE shall not have the right to use or demand use of aforesaid facilities. |
24.3 |
THE LESSEE shall not use the common areas including fire exits/ basements etc. of the Said Building/ Said Complex/ Said Plot for storage purpose or create any obstructions in the same. |
24.4 |
THE LESSEE shall only have the right to use and shall have no ownership rights, title, and interest or claim whatsoever in the Said Plot, common areas, facilities and amenities within the Said Building.
|
25. |
INSPECTION OF DEMISED PREMISES: |
25.1 |
THE LESSEE shall allow THE LESSOR and its agents to enter the Demised Premises after prior intimation, except in case of emergency(ies) including any fire etc., for inspection or any maintenance related issues at the
frequency it may deem fit including any emergency and/ or unforeseen circumstances or any inspection by Government agency or under its directions. |
25.2 |
However, for periodic inspections, two (02) days advance intimation will be given in writing to THE LESSEE, except in case of emergency (ies) and/or unforeseen circumstances. |
- 20 -
26. |
REINSTATEMENT OF DEMISED PREMISES: |
THE LESSEE shall hand over the peaceful, vacant and
physical possession of the Demised Premises in as good condition as it was in at the time when THE LESSEE was handed over the Demised Premises for fit outs, together with THE LESSORs fixtures and fittings installed therein, if any, (normal
wear and tear excepted) on the expiry /earlier termination of the Lease Deed, whichever is earlier.
27. |
USAGE OF DEMISED PREMISES BY THE LESSEE: |
27.1 |
THE LESSEE shall use the Demised Premises for IT/ ITeS usage as per the rules and regulations as may be applicable from time to time for such usage including the State and Central SEZ Act and the rules framed
thereunder. |
27.2 |
THE LESSEE shall not carry out or permit to be carried out in the Demised Premises or any part thereof any activities which shall be or are likely to be unlawful, obnoxious or creating nuisance, annoyance or disturbance
to other lessees/tenants/occupants of the Said Building. |
27.3 |
The Demised Premises shall be used by THE LESSEE only and THE LESSEE shall not assign, transfer, mortgage, sublease or grant leave & license or transfer or part with or share possession in any manner
whatsoever, of any portion of the Demised Premises. |
27.4 |
THE LESSEE shall not store any goods, hazardous or combustible or heavy in nature, to affect the construction or the structure or common use of the Said Building or any part thereof. |
28. |
SEZ UNIT APPROVAL FOR DEMISED PREMISES: |
28.1 |
THE LESSEE has obtained the SEZ unit approvals for the Demised Premises vide Letter of Approval dated 28th April, 2014, before signing of this Lease Deed and
before taking handover of Demised Premises for interior fit out works/ commencement of interior fit-outs by THE LESSOR (as applicable). |
28.2 |
THE LESSEE shall arrange to get the aforesaid SEZ unit approvals terminated and complete all formalities with regards to such termination at its own cost prior to the expiry/ earlier termination of the Lease Term or
Lease Renewal Term (if any) failing which it will be assumed that the peaceful handover of Demised Premises has not been done by THE LESSEE and THE LESSOR shall be entitled to claim damages, payments and other dues as per the Lease Deed.
|
- 21 -
28.3 |
In the event, THE LESSEE merges/ amalgamates / consolidates and transfer its assets and liabilities with/ to any entity on account of any merger/ amalgamation/ consolidation, then a fresh lease deed shall be executed
between THE LESSOR and the new entity/ transferee, subject to the new entity/ transferee obtaining prior SEZ approval. The new entity/ transferee shall execute an undertaking as per the draft attached as Annexure C-III for the remaining
period of the Lease Term. In case of any outstanding dues payable by THE LESSEE to THE LESSOR as per Lease Deed, such outstanding amounts should be included in the petition to the appropriate court seeking permission for such merger/ amalgamation/
consolidation as applicable under the relevant laws. Pending approval of any merger/ amalgamation/ consolidation, THE LESSEE will continue to make all payments payable as per the Lease Deed. |
28.4 |
All costs, charges, expenses including penalties, payable on or in respect of execution and registration of the fresh Lease Deed and on all other instruments and deeds to be executed pursuant to the fresh Lease Deed
shall be borne and paid solely by new entity/transferee who shall be responsible for compliance of all applicable laws including the provisions of Indian Stamp Act, 1899, Registration Act, etc. |
28.5 |
However, fresh Lease Deed will be executed only after payment of all outstanding dues by THE LESSEE and submission of relevant documents to THE LESSOR. |
29. |
HANDING OVER OF DEMISED PREMISES: |
29.1 |
At the time of handover of the Demised Premises for the interior / fit-out works, THE LESSEE is satisfied that the construction work as also various installations as per Annexure T-V are in good working condition
and issues, if any, with respect thereto have been resolved and rectified before its taking possession of the Demised Premises. |
29.2 |
THE LESSEE confirms that further to its taking possession of the Demised Premises, it shall not require THE LESSOR to undertake any repair, renovation, or improvisation, installations, etc. whatsoever (except structural
repairs required, if any) concerning the Demised Premises, Said Building and the Said Plot. |
30. |
INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHTS (IPR): |
THE LESSEE represents to THE LESSOR that:
30.1 |
It is the owner / licensee of the IPR and has full right, title and interest in the use of such IPR. |
30.2 |
Any IPR if used by THE LESSEE in Demised Premises/Said Building/Said Complex does not and shall not infringe the IPR of any third party. |
30.3 |
THE LESSEE has not received any notice of any claim against it involving any conflict or claim of conflicts with respect to IPR. |
- 22 -
30.4 |
THE LESSEE undertakes to hold THE LESSOR harmless from any action brought about by any third party for any IPR infringement by THE LESSEE. |
30.5 |
THE LESSEE undertakes to defend any and all such acts, suits, proceedings, claims, judgments etc. against THE LESSOR in connection with the IPR used by THE LESSEE in Demised Premises/Said Building/Said Complex and any
fees, costs, expenses of any kind related or incidental to any such action with respect to the IPR used by THE LESSEE in Demised Premises/Said Building/Said Complex of THE LESSEE incurred by THE LESSOR in defending itself shall be borne by THE
LESSEE, which THE LESSEE agrees to pay within seven (07) days of demand by THE LESSOR. |
31.1 |
Both the Parties agree to comply with, through out the Lease Term, at their own cost, all the Laws, Rules, Regulations, and Notifications etc. and their amendments made from time to time, as may be applicable, including
but not limited to the following: |
|
|
|
Environment (Protection) Act, 1986, |
|
|
|
Water (Prevention and Control of Pollution) Act, 1974, |
|
|
|
Air (Prevention and Control of Pollution) Act, 1981, |
|
|
|
Food Safety and Standards Act, 2006 and Rules, 2011, |
|
|
|
Municipal Solid Wastes (Management and Handling) Rules, 2000, |
|
|
|
Hazardous Wastes (Management and Handling) Rules, 1989, |
|
|
|
Batteries (Management and Handling) Rules, 2001 and regulations, |
|
|
|
Central/ State laws, rules concerning safe handling, storage, treatment and disposal of the wastes etc., |
|
|
|
VAT, Sales Tax, Service Tax and other statutorily applicable taxes, |
|
|
|
State and Central SEZ Act and the rules framed thereunder, |
|
|
|
Central/state laws pertaining to fire and safety. |
31.2 |
Both the Parties shall always remain responsible for the consequences of their respective non-compliance of the aforesaid Acts/ Rules and/or any other applicable laws/ rules/ regulations. |
31.3 |
Both the Parties shall perform their respective obligations towards installation, operation and keeping at all times in operational condition, various equipments, machinery etc. in the Said Plot/ Said Complex/ Said
Building/ Demised Premises at their own cost and expenses in conformity with all the applicable laws as aforesaid. |
31.4 |
Both the Parties shall always remain responsible for their respective obligations to obtain and always keep valid and make available necessary certificates from the Pollution Control Board and/or other appropriate
authorities in this regard. |
- 23 -
32. |
AIR CONDITIONING FACILITIES: |
32.1 |
THE LESSOR shall, at its own cost, design and install a continuous and proper air conditioning system and shall use its best efforts to maintain and run the same in good order and condition to ensure air conditioning
facilities to the Demised Premises. |
32.2 |
If any changes, additions, alterations in the system is required by THE LESSEE due to its interior layouts, THE LESSOR may, if possible and feasible, make such changes and recover from THE LESSEE, the additional costs
at 1.2 times of the actual costs incurred. |
32.3 |
Provision for air conditioning (except in the event of mechanical defect/or electrical failure) to the Demised Premises will be provided as mentioned below: |
a) Normal office hours i.e. from 8 a.m. to 8 p.m. on all week days except Saturdays, Sundays, Public and National Holidays.
On Saturdays, air-conditioning will be provided from 8 a.m. to 2 p.m. only.
b) Any other specific operational hours of THE LESSEE, with prior written notice to THE LESSOR and by executing the necessary documentation in
respect thereof and upon payment of the applicable estimated maintenance charges provided in Annexure C-I(a) of this Lease Deed.
Provision for lift services (except in the event of mechanical defect/or
electrical failure) to the Demised Premises will be provided as mentioned below:
a) Normal office hours i.e. from 8 a.m. to 8 p.m. on all
week days except Saturdays, Sundays, Public and National Holidays.
On Saturdays, the lift services will be provided for first half of day
only i.e. from 8 a.m. to 2 p.m.
b) Any other specific operational hours of THE LESSEE, with prior written notice to THE LESSOR and by
executing the necessary documentation in respect thereof and upon payment of the applicable estimated maintenance charges provided in Annexure C-I(a) of this Lease Deed.
c) One of the lifts in the Said Building shall, however, operate even after normal office hours as well as on second half on Saturdays and also
on Sundays, Public and National Holidays.
d) The aforesaid timings shall be subject to such restrictions as may be imposed by any
competent authority(ies) or as per any applicable law in this behalf.
- 24 -
THE LESSOR shall carry out all major and structural repairs to the
Demised Premises and also to the Said Building and THE LESSEE shall not be entitled to carry out any structural changes/ additions/ alterations etc. in the same.
35. |
SUPPLY OF POWER/ ELECTRICITY/ WATER: |
THE LESSOR shall, subject to the payment of the
applicable charges as specified in this Lease Deed and non-occurrence of any Force Majeure event, supply and maintain regular supply of power/ electricity and water to the Demised Premises.
36. |
WATERTIGHT CONDITION: |
THE LESSOR shall keep the Demised Premises in watertight
condition.
37. |
PERMISSION TO CARRY OUT REPAIR/ INTERNAL ALTERATIONS: |
37.1 |
THE LESSOR shall allow THE LESSEE erection of internal partitions and other internal alterations and additions, except structural additions/alterations of permanent nature, which are not visible from outside, as may be
necessary for the business of THE LESSEE. |
37.2 |
THE LESSEE shall with prior written intimation of seven (07) days and written approval of THE LESSORs architect, commence such alteration(s) or addition(s) in the Demised Premises. |
37.3 |
If any such additions or alterations, require the prior approval or permission of any Municipality/ local body/ Government authority or are governed by any rules or regulations by such authority, THE LESSEE shall not
commence or carry out such additions or alterations or erections without obtaining the prior permission(s) or approval(s) or complying with such rules and regulations as aforesaid. |
37.4 |
THE LESSEE shall upon vacating and handing over the Demised Premises to THE LESSOR remove such fixtures, fittings, additions and partitions and restore the Demised Premises in as good condition as it was in at the time
when THE LESSEE was handed over the Demised Premises for fit outs, reasonable wear and tear excepted. |
38. |
PEACEFUL ENJOYMENT OF DEMISED PREMISES: |
THE LESSOR shall allow during the term of the
Lease Deed, peaceful enjoyment of the Demised Premises to THE LESSEE, subject to THE LESSEE performing all its obligations under this Lease Deed.
- 25 -
39. |
SUPER BUILT-UP AREA CALCULATIONS: |
The super built up area calculations for the
Demised Premises are as provided in Annexure T-I hereto.
40. |
ELECTRICAL & AIR CONDITIONING SERVICES: |
40.1 |
THE LESSOR has provided electrical wiring only up to the main distribution board on each floor in the Said Building and shall not provide any electric wiring, fixtures and fans etc., inside the Demised Premises.
|
40.2 |
Similarly air conditioning is provided by THE LESSOR up to air handling unit on each floor of the Said Building. |
40.3 |
The electrical wiring from the main distribution board to the Demised Premises including all fixtures etc., the internal distribution system of electricity, air conditioning, etc. in the Demised Premises shall be the
sole responsibility of THE LESSEE at their own cost. |
41. |
THE LESSORs REPRESENTATIONS: |
41.1 |
THE LESSOR is seized and possessed of the Said Plot and the Said Building developed/ to be developed thereon and is competent to lease office space in the Said Building developed/ to be developed on the Said Plot.
|
41.2 |
To the best of its knowledge, as on the date of signing of this Lease Deed, |
i) no notice of
acquisition or requisition, in respect of the Demised Premises, is received or is in force.
ii) no hindrance of whatsoever nature is in
the way of performance of obligations of THE LESSOR under this Lease Deed.
iii) the Demised Premises is structurally fit and secured.
42. |
FORCE MAJEURE/ NON PERFORMANCE OF OBLIGATIONS: |
42.1 |
Either party shall not be held responsible for any consequences or liabilities under this Lease Deed if it is prevented in performing its obligations by reason of laws or regulations, action by any Government or local
body or other authority, or due to reasons of force majeure which may include but not limited to riots, insurrection, war, terrorist action, acts of God and unforeseen circumstances beyond its control. Upon happening of the any such force majeure
event, either party would inform the other party of such event. Upon abatement of such event, either party would inform the other party about cessation of the same. |
- 26 -
42.2 |
In the event the Demised Premises or any part thereof be destroyed or damaged due to the following circumstances (including but not limited to): |
|
i) |
Fire (not caused by any willful act or negligence of THE LESSEE), |
|
ii) |
Act(s) of God like earthquake, tempest, flood or lightning etc., |
|
iii) |
By reasons of laws or regulations, action by any government or local body or other authority, |
|
iv) |
Violence of any army or mob or enemies of the country, and/ or |
|
v) |
Any other irresistible force rendering the Demised Premises unfit for the purpose for which the same was leased; |
then, THE LESSEE may, temporarily vacate the whole or such portion of the Demised Premises, as may be required, to enable THE LESSOR to carry
out repairs to restore the Demised Premises to as good condition as it was in at the time of handover of the Demised Premises for interior fit-outs.
42.3 |
In such an event, all payments specified under the Lease Deed for the affected area of the Demised Premises or portion thereof shall abate till the time the Demised Premises is repaired and restored to as good condition
as it was in at the time of handover of the Demised Premises for interior fit-outs. |
42.4 |
However, all payments specified under the Lease Deed during such period shall continue to be made by THE LESSEE for the unaffected area of the Demised Premises. |
42.5 |
Furthermore, if the above situation continues for a period of more than ninety (90) calendar days, THE LESSEE may terminate the Lease Deed by giving a prior written notice of thirty (30) days and THE LESSOR
shall refund the Security Deposits paid by THE LESSEE, subject to recovery/ adjustment of the outstanding dues, if any, under the Lease Deed. |
42.6 |
THE LESSOR shall not be responsible for paying any expenses or any financial or legal consequences arising out of such force majeure situation. |
42.7 |
The performance of THE LESSORs obligations shall be subject to the regular payment(s) as stipulated under this Lease Deed by THE LESSEE. |
43. |
ACQUISITION OR REQUISITION BY GOVERNMENT: |
43.1 |
In case the Demised Premises or any part thereof is acquired or requisitioned by the Government/ Statutory Authorities, local or otherwise, THE LESSOR alone shall be entitled to claim any compensation payable for such
acquisition/ requisition and THE LESSEE shall not raise any claim in respect thereof. |
43.2 |
In such a case, performance of THE LESSORs and THE LESSEEs obligations shall be as per the requisition/ acquisition notice received from the concerned authorities. |
- 27 -
43.3 |
If permissible under such requisition/acquisition notice, THE LESSEE, as per the terms of the requisition/ acquisition notice, may directly claim any and all compensation payable regarding the interior fit-outs
belonging to THE LESSEE in the Demised Premises and THE LESSOR shall not be liable to THE LESSEE for any claim/ compensation in respect thereof. |
43.4 |
In case such requisition/ acquisition notice results in termination of the Lease Deed, in that case unless prohibited under the requisition notice the Security Deposits paid under this Lease Deed will be refunded to THE
LESSEE within a reasonable time frame, if permissible under the requisition notice, after adjustment or deduction of arrear(s) of rent, charges and any other dues, if any, payable under this Lease Deed. |
44. |
SALE/ MORTGAGE/ TRANSFER: |
44.1 |
In the event THE LESSOR transfers either by way of sale or mortgages, or creates a third party charge in any manner whatsoever, on the Demised Premises, THE LESSEE shall not raise any objection to the same.
|
44.2 |
However, such creation of mortgage/charge shall not affect the rights of THE LESSEE to use the Demised Premises during the Lease Term. |
44.3 |
In case of sale, upon intimation by THE LESSOR, THE LESSEE shall attorn as a tenant to the new transferee on the same terms and conditions as stated in this Lease Deed. |
45. |
MODIFICATION/AMENDMENT/VARIATION: |
45.1 |
This Lease Deed along with the Annexure(s) constitutes the entire agreement between the Parties and revokes and supersedes all previous discussions, written or oral, correspondence, Letter of Intent and/or any deeds
between the Parties. The LOI attached to statement of commercials (attached as part of Annexure C-I(a) is merely for the purpose of commercial understanding and any terms/stipulations contained therein shall not contradict/supersede in any way the
terms and conditions contained in the Lease Deed. |
45.2 |
This Lease Deed shall not be changed or modified except by written amendment by way of an addendum duly agreed and signed by the Parties. |
46. |
ESSENCE OF THE LEASE DEED: |
In respect of any sums payable under this Lease Deed, time
shall be of the essence and that failure of THE LESSEE to pay by the Due Date any sum due and payable by THE LESSEE to THE LESSOR shall be liable for the consequences stipulated in this Lease Deed.
- 28 -
Failure of either party to enforce at any time or for any period of time the
provisions hereof shall not be construed to be waiver of any provisions or of the right thereafter to enforce each and every provision hereof.
If any provision is determined to be void or unenforceable under
applicable law(s), such provisions of this Lease Deed shall be deemed amended or deleted to the extent necessary to conform to applicable law(s) and the remaining provisions of this Lease Deed shall remain valid and enforceable.
49. |
PLURALITY OF THE LESSEE: |
If two or more persons are included in the term THE
LESSEE all covenants, terms, conditions and restrictions shall be binding on them jointly and each of them severally.
All or any disputes arising out of, touching upon, connected with,
concerning or in relation to the terms of this Lease Deed including the interpretation and validity of the terms thereof and the respective rights and obligations of the parties shall be settled amicably by mutual discussion failing which the
same shall be settled through arbitration The arbitration shall be governed by the Arbitration & Conciliation Act, 1996 or any statutory amendments/ modifications thereof for the time being in force. The arbitration proceedings shall
be held at Gurgaon by the Sole Arbitrator who shall be appointed by THE LESSOR who shall be a retired high court judge and whose decision shall be final and binding upon the Parties. THE LESSEE hereby confirms that he/she/it shall have no
objection to this appointment. The language of the arbitration proceedings shall be in English language only.
The civil courts at Gurgaon
and Punjab & Haryana High Court at Chandigarh, Haryana alone shall have the jurisdiction concerning all matters in this Lease Deed.
51. |
EXECUTION AND REGISTRATION OF LEASE DEED: |
51.1 |
All costs, charges etc including any penalties, on execution and registration of this Lease Deed or on all other instruments and deeds to be executed pursuant to this Lease Deed, as applicable, shall be borne and paid
solely by THE LESSEE. Each party shall bear their own legal fees/ charges. |
51.2 |
The stamp duty and registration charges shall be paid by THE LESSEE at the time of signing of the Lease Deed and in any case before the handover of the Demised Premises for interior works. |
- 29 -
51.3 |
THE LESSEE shall be responsible for the compliance of Indian Stamp Act, 1899 and local stamp act and rules made thereunder. |
51.4 |
THE LESSEE shall furnish a copy of the registered Lease Deed to the concerned authority under the SEZ Laws within six months from the issuance of Letter of Approval. |
51.5 |
The original executed and registered Lease Deed shall be retained by THE LESSOR and a certified copy of the same will be provided to THE LESSEE. |
51.6 |
The original Lease Deed shall be produced by THE LESSOR as and when required by THE LESSEE upon receipt of prior notice of 2 days from THE LESSEE, except in case of emergency(ies). |
51.7 |
That all annexures to this Lease Deed shall become part and parcel of this Lease Deed. However, it is clearly stipulated that except the commercials as mentioned in the LOI and also as reiterated in Annexure
C-I(a) of this Lease Deed, all other terms and conditions of the said LOI shall stand superseded by the terms and conditions of this Lease Deed. |
52. |
GOVERNMENTAL/ STATUTORY PROCEDURAL REQUIREMENTS: |
All governmental/ statutory procedural
requirements with respect to the obligations of the Parties under or arising out of this Lease Deed shall be complied with by the respective party, as applicable from time to time.
This Lease Deed and the rights and obligations of the Parties under or
arising out of this Lease Deed shall be construed and enforced in accordance with the laws of India.
54.1 |
No announcements, disclosures, publicity of any nature, regarding either party and other negotiations vis-à-vis this transaction will be made by either party unless the form, content and timing of the release is
approved in writing by both the parties hereto. |
54.2 |
Either party may disclose the existence of the transaction to its legal counsels, accountants, lenders, merchant bankers, engineers, architects, interior designers, vendors, suppliers and other persons who need to be
aware of the existence of the transaction, and to the extent that such disclosure is required by Law or a Court order or by any Statutory Authority(ies). |
- 30 -
55. |
CUSTOMER CONTROLLED METER SYSTEM (CCMS) |
In order to facilitate THE LESSEE in making
timely payment of the amounts payable under the Lease Deed, THE LESSOR may introduce and implement Customer Controlled Meter system (CCMS) which would facilitate THE LESSEE to also track online the amounts payable by THE LESSEE to THE LESSOR in
addition to the information available to THE LESSEE under the Lease Deed. The CCMS would also record and show the units of power consumed by THE LESSEE.
In the event THE LESSOR introduces and implements the CCMS, then separate meters shall be installed in the Demised Premises at the cost and
expense of THE LESSEE. THE LESSEE will be able to see the power consumed and to monitor the power load being utilized by it. THE LESSEE will also be able to access the information about the amounts due and payable by THE LESSEE viz. Warm Shell Rent,
Car Parking Charges, Maintenance, Charges, power consumption charges, Façade Signage Charges (if any), taxes and any other charges payable under the Lease Deed to THE LESSOR. The CCMS will facilitate THE LESSEE in avoiding defaults of
payments under the Lease Deed and thus avoiding disruption of electricity/ air conditioning/ water and all other services which would otherwise be stopped in case THE LESSEE fails to make payments of the amounts due and payable under the Lease Deed
by the Due Date. Thus THE LESSEE can monitor and control the payments and consumption of electricity as an additional facility in addition to the information available to THE LESSEE under the Lease Deed.
Any notice, letter or communication to be made, served or communicated unto
either party under these presents shall be in writing and shall be deemed to be duly made, served or communicated only if the notice, letter or communication is addressed to other party at the address given below or such other addresses as may be
intimated in writing and sent by registered post/ fax/ email (given hereunder)/ speed post or delivered personally with acknowledgement. The communication is to be addressed to the following:
|
|
|
For THE LESSOR |
|
For THE LESSEE |
Director Offices |
|
General Counsel |
10th Floor, DLF Gateway Tower, |
|
Gate 4, Plant 10, Godrej & |
DLF City Phase III, |
|
Boyce Complex, LBS Marg, |
Gurgaon 122002, Haryana, INDIA |
|
Pirojshanagar, Vikhroli (W), Mumbai, |
Phone 91-124 - 4568909 |
|
India |
Fax 91-124 - 4568909 |
|
|
E Mail: lease-gurgaon@dlf.in |
|
|
The terms and conditions agreed between THE LESSOR and THE LESSEE containing interalia a) covenants and
conditions to be observed and performed by THE LESSEE, and b) covenants and conditions to be observed and performed by THE LESSOR, are as per this Lease Deed and Annexures C-I (a) to C-V and T-I to T-X which shall form an integral part
of this Lease Deed and shall be binding on THE LESSOR and THE LESSEE.
- 31 -
THE LESSOR, DLF Assets Private Limited through its Authorized Signatories Mr. Navin Kedia and Mr. Amit
Grover authorized to execute Lease Deeds etc. have executed this Lease Deed. This Lease Deed will be presented for registration before the Registering Authority and get registered by Mr. Jasmer Singh S/o Mr. Balwant Singh R/o C-68, Indira
Enclave, Ned Sarai, New Delhi 110068 who has been authorized vide Resolution dated 26.4.2006 of THE LESSOR to appear before the Registering Authority and present for registration, acknowledge and get registered the Deed executed by Mr. Navin
Kedia and Mr. Amit Grover on behalf of THE LESSOR.
IN WITNESS WHEREOF the Parties hereto have set their hands to these presents on the day, month
and year first and above mentioned.
THE LESSOR:
SIGNED AND DELIVERED on behalf of the above named DLF Assets Private Limited acting through Mr. Navin Kedia and Mr. Amit Grover, its
Authorized Signatories:
In the presence of:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For and on behalf of |
|
|
WITNESSES: |
|
DLF Assets Private Limited |
|
|
1. |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/s/ Navin Kedia /s/ Amit Grover |
|
|
2. |
|
AUTHORIZED SIGNATORIES |
|
|
THE LESSEE:
SIGNED AND DELIVERED on behalf of the above named WNS Global Services Private Limited acting through Mr. Mr. Varun Vasisht, its Authorized
Signatory:
In the presence of:
|
|
|
|
|
WITNESSES |
|
|
|
|
|
|
For and on behalf of |
|
|
1. |
|
WNS Global Services Private Limited |
|
|
|
|
|
2. |
|
/s/ Varun Vasisht
AUTHORIZED SIGNATORY |
|
|
- 32 -
ANNEXURES
|
|
|
|
|
A. COMMERCIAL |
C-I(a) |
|
|
|
Statement of Commercials |
|
|
|
C-II |
|
|
|
Description of the Said Plot |
|
|
|
C-III |
|
|
|
Merger and Amalgamation Draft Undertaking |
|
|
|
C-IV(a) |
|
|
|
Expansion Option for THE LESSEE |
|
|
|
C-IV(b) |
|
|
|
Draft Notice for Hard Option or First Right of Refusal |
|
|
|
C-V |
|
|
|
Electronic Clearing System Activation form |
|
B. TECHNICAL |
T-I |
|
|
|
Tentative Super Built-up area calculations |
|
|
|
T-II |
|
|
|
Description of the Floor Plan(s) of the Demised Premises |
|
|
|
T-III |
|
|
|
Car parking spaces earmarked for use by THE LESSEE |
|
|
|
T-IV |
|
|
|
Monthly Maintenance and service expenditure (Indicative) |
|
|
|
T-V |
|
|
|
Tentative Building Specifications |
|
|
|
T-VI |
|
|
|
Sharing of Services/ Division of Floor |
|
|
|
T-VII |
|
|
|
Guiding Principles for the Fit-outs of the Demised Premises |
|
|
|
T-VIII |
|
|
|
Handover for Fit Outs of the Demised Premises |
|
|
|
T-IX |
|
|
|
List of Drawings required for approval by THE LESSOR |
|
|
|
T-X |
|
|
|
THE LESSEEs responsibility during interior fit-outs work, additions/modifications/alterations of interior works and during the Lease Term / Lease Renewal Term and operations during the Lease Term / Lease Renewal Term |
- 33 -
ANNEXURE C-I (a)
STATEMENT OF COMMERCIALS PAYABLE BY M/S. WNS GLOBAL SERVICES PRIVATE LIMITED TO M/S. DLF ASSETS PRIVATE LIMITED DURING THE PERIOD OF LEASE FOR APPROX.
1,02,653 SQ.FT. (9,536.698 SQ.MTRS) OF SUPER BUILT UP AREA ON 8th & 9th FLOOR OF BLOCKS A2 & A3 & PART OF 11th FLOOR OF BLOCK A2 AT DLF WORLD TECH PARK, NH8, GURGAON
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
LEASE TERM |
|
LEASE RENEWAL TERM |
|
Remarks (Ref No.) |
|
|
Initials of THE LESSEE |
|
|
|
|
From |
|
To |
|
From |
|
To |
|
From |
|
To |
|
From |
|
To |
|
From |
|
To |
|
From |
|
To |
|
|
PARTICULARS |
|
28-Apr-2014 |
|
31-Mar-2015 |
|
1-Apr-2015 |
|
28-Feb-2017 |
|
1-Mar-2017 |
|
27-Apr-2019 |
|
28-Apr-2019 |
|
28-Feb-2020 |
|
1-Mar-2020 |
|
28-Feb-2023 |
|
1-Mar-2023 |
|
27-Apr-2024 |
|
|
Super built up area in sq.ft. (& in sq.mtrs.) |
|
1,02,653 (9,536.698) |
|
1,02,653 (9,536.698) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
Lease Commencement Date |
|
28-Apr-2014 |
|
28-Apr-2019 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
Rent Commencement Date for Warm Shell Rent & Car Parking Spaces |
|
1-Jun-2014 |
|
28-Apr-2019 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
Lock-in Period from LCD (Months) |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
36 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Warm Shell Rent (51,244 sq.ft.) |
|
Rs per sq.ft. per month |
|
34.50 |
|
41.00 |
|
47.15 |
|
47.15 |
|
54.22 |
|
62.35 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Rs. per month |
|
17,67,918.00 |
|
21,01,004.00 |
|
24,16,154.60 |
|
24,16,154.60 |
|
27,78,449.68 |
|
31,95,063.40
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Warm Shell Rent (51,409 sq.ft.) |
|
Rs per sq.ft. per month |
|
41.00 |
|
41.00 |
|
47.15 |
|
47.15 |
|
54.22 |
|
62.35 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Rs. per month |
|
21,07,769.00 |
|
21,07,769.00 |
|
24,23,934.35 |
|
24,23,934.35 |
|
27,87,395.98 |
|
32,05,351.15 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
Car Parking Charges (per car park per month) |
|
1 per 1000 sq.ft. car parks i.e. 103 car parks @ Rs. 3,000 per car park per month |
|
3,09,000 |
|
3,09,000 |
|
3,55,350 |
|
3,55,350 |
|
4,08,653 |
|
4,69,950.38 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
NIL additional car parks @ Rs. 5,000 per car park per month |
|
NA |
|
NA |
|
NA |
|
NA |
|
NA |
|
NA |
|
|
|
|
|
|
Interest Free Refundable Security Deposit (IFRSD) in Rs. |
|
Amount always equivalent to 6 months Warm Shell Rent |
|
2,32,54,122 |
|
2,52,52,638 |
|
2,90,40,534 |
|
2,90,40,534 |
|
3,33,95,074 |
|
3,84,02,487 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Payable on signing of Letter of Intent (equivalent to 3 months Warm Shell Rent) |
|
1,16,27,061 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Payable on signing of Lease Deed (equivalent to 3 months Warm Shell Rent) |
|
1,16,27,061 |
|
|
|
37,87,896 |
|
|
|
43,54,540 |
|
50,07,413 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Payable on or before 1st April 2015 |
|
|
|
19,98,516 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1 |
|
|
|
Interest Free Refundable Maintenance Security Deposit (IFRMSD) in Rs. |
|
For Normal Office hours - payable on the Lease Deed @ Rs. 18/- per sq.ft. per month (equivalent to 6 months maintenance charges) |
|
1,10,86,524 |
|
|
|
|
|
1,10,86,524 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Interest Free Refundable Electricity Security Deposit (IFRESD) in Rs. - payable on signing the Lease Deed |
|
For Power Load (616 KVA) @ Rs. 3,000/- per KVA |
|
18,48,000 |
|
|
|
|
|
18,48,000 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For Additional Power Load (147 KVA) @ Rs. 3,000/- per KVA |
|
4,41,000 |
|
|
|
|
|
4,41,000 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-refundable charge in Rs. - payable on signing the Lease Deed |
|
For Additional Power Load (147 KVA) @ Rs. 10,000/- per KVA |
|
14,70,000 |
|
|
|
|
|
14,70,000 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Infrastructure charges in Rs. - payable on signing the Lease Deed |
|
For Additional Power Load (147 KVA) |
|
Actual cost + 20% |
|
|
|
|
|
Actual cost + 20% |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Façade Signage Charges (per annum) for 1 signage |
|
NIL |
|
|
|
|
|
NIL |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Remarks:
1 |
THE LESSEE would pay additional IFRSD of Rs. 19,98,526 on or before 1st April 2015 due to escalation in Warm shell rental of 51,244 sq.ft. from Rs.34.50/- per sq. ft. to Rs.41/- per sq.ft. |
- 34 -
Annexure C-I(a)
Terms and Conditions:
1) |
The payment of Warm Shell Rent, Car Parking Charges and Maintenance Charges shall be subject to deduction of TDS. |
2) |
Any taxes/ duties/ charges/ cesses / levy (ies) etc. including service tax, as applicable from time to time, whether central / state/ municipal/ local etc on payments made by THE LESSEE shall be additional and shall be
borne by THE LESSEE. |
3) |
The due date of monthly payments viz. Warm Shell Rent, Car Parking Charges, Maintenance Charges, Terrace Area Charges (if any) and any other monthly charge is 1st day
of each English calendar month (Due Date) but not later than 7th day of the calendar month, along with taxes and duties as applicable. The due date for payment of charges for power consumption
shall be the date mentioned in the bills raised for such charges. |
4) |
All delayed payments shall carry an interest of 15% per annum from the Due Date till the date the payments are made by THE LESSEE. |
5) |
In addition to the Warm Shell Rent, any and all taxes, duties, charges, cesses, levy (ies) etc. on Property (collectively referred to as Taxes on Property) are payable/ reimbursable by THE LESSEE, from the
Lease Commencement Date, calculated prorata of the super built-up area of the Demised Premises to the super built-up area of the Property as well as payable/ reimbursable in respect of car parking spaces, if applicable. |
6) |
The Lock-in Period of Thirty Six (36) months from Lease Commencement Date as mentioned in above shall be applicable to Warm Shell Rent, Car Parking Charges, Maintenance
Charges, Taxes on Property and taxes etc. as applicable. |
7) |
THE LESSEE agrees to pay to THE LESSOR all the above commercials on their respective due dates. |
8) |
All costs, charges etc. including any penalties, on execution and registration of this instrument or on all other instruments and deeds to be executed pursuant to this agreement, as applicable, shall be borne and paid
solely by THE LESSEE. |
9) |
THE LESSOR and THE LESSEE shall bear their own legal fees/ charges. |
10) |
All the escalations/ increases @ 15% in the Warm Shell Rent, IFRSD, Car Parking Charges or any other charges as specified in the Statement of Commercials above are duly agreed by THE LESSEE and THE LESSEE hereby
signifies the acceptance of the above in form of initials/ signatures. |
11) |
The Maintenance charges payable by THE LESSEE, from the Lease Commencement Date, are calculated on actual cost plus 20% basis, which as on 1st May, 2013 are estimated as under: |
|
a) |
For normal office hours i.e. 8.00 am to 8.00 pm IST Monday to Friday and 8.00 am to 2.00 pm IST on Saturdays excluding on Sundays, Public and National Holidays: Rs.18/- per sq.ft.
per month. |
- 35 -
|
b) |
For 365*24*7 operations excluding Public and National Holidays: Rs.30/- per sq. ft. per month. |
|
c) |
For working beyond normal office hours (provided it is a full floor): Rs 0.13/- per sq. ft. per hour on the super built up area of the full floor even if the area of Demised
Premises is less than the full floor area or per hour for the Demised Premises to be intimated by the Building Manager when required. |
Since the building is already operational, while THE LESSEE is carrying out the fit out works but does not utilize the central air conditioning
for the Demised Premises during the fitout period; maintenance will be charged at Rs. 7/- per sq. ft. per month.
The Maintenance Charges,
as specified above in this LOI, are subject to increase of prices of diesel, gas, petroleum products and other consumables, electricity rates, taxes, wages and salaries, cost of annual maintenance contracts of lifts, DGs, HVAC supplies,
transformers, panels etc. during the Lease Term and the Lease Renewal Term (if any).
|
d) |
Maintenance services are as set out in Annexure T-II of this LOI. |
12) |
Charges for Usage of Power in the Demised Premises during interior fit-outs and Lease Term and the Lease Renewal Term: |
|
a) |
For supply of power from Grid power (subject to availability) - As per applicable grid rates |
|
b) |
For supply of power from back up sources - Cost + 20% |
|
c) |
When power taken from Utilities company is used - Cost + 20% |
|
d) |
The cost of power used for common areas from any source, along with other expenditure like security, housekeeping, AMCs etc., is charged in the overall maintenance charges at Cost + 20%. |
13) |
The initial Lease Term shall be Five (05) years with THE LESSEE having the sole option to renew the lease for one further term of 5 years. |
14) |
In case of renewal of lease term or earlier termination of the Lease Deed, an advance written notice of Six (06) months shall be served by THE LESSEE. |
- 36 -
15) |
THE LESSEE currently holds on lease the following office premises in DLF Infinity Towers, Phase III, DLF Cyber City, Gurgaon with M/s DLF Cyber City Developers Limited, the Warm Shell Rent for which is payable as
tabulated below: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Super Built up Area (sq.ft.) |
|
Tower |
|
Current Warm Shell Rent (Rs. per sq.ft. per month) |
|
Lease Expiry Date(s)/
Current Warm Shell Rent
payable till |
38,576 |
|
A |
|
34.50/- |
|
30th April, 2014 |
52,419 |
|
B |
|
34.50/- |
|
31st May, 2014 |
51,244 |
|
C |
|
34.50/- |
|
31st March, 2015 |
And, the following arrangement is agreed between the Parties for the Demised Premises as covered and more
particularly detailed in the Annexure C-I(a) of this Lease Deed, and shall be effective once the Lease Deed is signed for the Demised Premises.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Super Built up Area (sq.ft.) |
|
Warm Shell Rent (Rs. per sq.ft. per month) |
|
Rent Commencement Date |
|
Warm Shell Rent
payable till |
51,244 |
|
34.50/- |
|
1st June, 2014 |
|
31st March, 2015 |
51,409 |
|
41.00/- |
|
1st June, 2014 |
|
28th February, 2017 |
It is agreed between the Parties that in case of delay in date of Occupation i.e. commencement of operations
of THE LESSEE in the Demised Premises beyond 1st June, 2014 but not later than 31st July, 2014 in any case, THE LESSEE shall be
liable to pay Warm Shell Rent along with all other charges for DLF Infinity Tower space, as tabulated below:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Super Built up Area (sq.ft.) |
|
Tower |
|
Warm Shell Rent beyond Lease Expiry Date(s) (Rs. per sq.ft. per month) |
|
Warm Shell Rent
payable till |
38,576 |
|
A |
|
39.67/- |
|
31st July, 2014 |
52,419 |
|
B |
|
39.67/- |
|
31st July, 2014 |
51,244 |
|
C |
|
34.50/- |
|
31st July, 2014 |
However, it is made clear between the Parties that
|
i) |
The Warm Shell Rent for the Demised Premises shall commence from 1st June, 2014 irrespective of any delay in date of Occupation i.e. commencement of operations
of THE LESSEE in the Demised Premises. |
|
ii) |
Irrespective of the date of Occupation i.e. commencement of operations of THE LESSEE in the Demised Premises; the lease for the space under lease at DLF Infinity Tower shall stand terminated w.e.f. 1st August, 2014 and become invalid, ineffective and incapable of enforcement in any manner whatsoever and THE LESSEE shall be left with no right, title or interest in respect of the lease of the
entire space at DLF Infinity Tower. |
|
iii) |
The security deposits paid by THE LESSEE under the lease deeds for the space at DLF Infinity Tower shall be refunded to THE LESSEE, without any interest, once THE LESSEE clears all its dues under the lease deeds and
surrenders peaceful, vacant and physical possession of the entire premises, subject to adjustment of outstanding dues, if any. |
- 37 -
16) |
THE LESSEE had on lease approx. 35,215 sq.ft. super built up area at part of 9th Floor, Block 3, DLF IT Park at Chennai. |
The said space had a lock in period till 31st March, 2015. However the
Lock in period from the period 15th April, 2014 till 31st March, 2015 has been agreed to be waived off and the said space has been
handed over to THE LESSOR on 15th April, 2014.
It is agreed between the parties
that the security deposit paid by THE LESSEE towards the said space shall be adjusted against the deposit payable by THE LESSEE for the Demised Premises and the balance amount shall be payable by THE LESSEE upon signing of the Lease Deed for the
Demised Premises.
- 38 -
ANNEXURE C-II
DESCRIPTION OF THE SAID PLOT
- 39 -
ANNEXURE C-III
(Applicable in case THE LESSEE merges or amalgamates after the Lease Deed is signed)
To be given by transferee company
DRAFT UNDERTAKING
I, ,
the authorized representative, vide board resolution/power of attorney dated (Copy enclosed),
, do hereby declare that
|
1. |
We are fully aware with the Lease Deed dated executed between M/s DLF
and M/s.
and contents thereof. |
|
2. |
We are fully aware with the terms and conditions of the abovementioned Lease Deed. We are aware that as per the terms and conditions of the aforementioned Lease Deed, in case of merger/consolidation or amalgamation of
THE LESSEE with any other entity, a fresh Lease Deed shall be executed between THE LESSOR and the other entity as provided in Clause 29.3 of the above said Lease Deed subject to such new entity/transferee obtaining prior SEZ approval.
|
|
3. |
We undertake that as per the provisions of the Lease Deed we shall execute a fresh lease deed on same terms and conditions within 30 days of passing of the order by the Court approving the scheme of merger.
|
|
4. |
We are aware that we will step into the shoes of THE LESSEE for the remaining period of the Lease Term and that our liability to make payments of rental and other charges as per the Lease Deed shall commence from the
date of passing of the final order approving the merger. Till then the payments of rent and other charges payable under the Lease Deed shall be borne and paid regularly by THE LESSEE. |
|
5. |
We unequivocally agree, confirm and acknowledge to THE LESSOR that we shall be responsible for enforcement/compliance of all the terms and conditions of the Lease Deed and that we bind ourselves with the terms and
conditions of the aforementioned Lease Deed and we shall also be liable for breach/non-compliance of the terms and conditions as per the Lease Deed dated
. |
|
Confirmed by: |
|
( ) |
THE LESSEE |
- 40 -
ANNEXURE C-IV(a)
EXPANSION OPTION FOR THE LESSEE
FIRST
RIGHT OF REFUSAL (FRR) (Hereinafter referred to as the FRR as the case may be).
The details of the option(s) are as below:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Area
(sq.ft.) |
|
Floor |
|
Block/
Tower |
|
Type of
option (FRR) |
|
Option Commencement
Date |
|
Option
Expiry Date |
22,343 |
|
11th |
|
A3 |
|
FRR |
|
1st May, 2014 |
|
31st April, 2015 |
9,141 |
|
11th |
|
A2 |
|
FRR |
|
1st May, 2014 |
|
31st April, 2015 |
THE LESSEE shall provide notice for exercising the FRR option as per the format annexed as Annexure C-IV (b) of
this Lease Deed. In the event of failure to provide such notice by the Option expiry date, the aforesaid relevant option shall lapse.
The Lease and Rent
Commencement Date of the FRR space shall commence from the date of exercise of the FRR option.
The Lease Deed for the FRR space to be signed within 7
days from the date of notice of exercise of the FRR option on the same format as original lease executed between the Parties for the Demised Premises.
The Rent escalation for the FRR option space will be along with the Rent escalation for the Demised Premises, as detailed in Annexure C-I(a) of this
Lease Deed. All other terms and conditions will remain same as that of Demised Premises except any rent-free period agreed for the Demised Premises.
- 41 -
ANNEXURE C-IV(b)
(Applicable in case THE LESSEE exercises the First Right Of Refusal)
Date:
Sub: Lease Deed dated executed
between
and .
This is with reference to the Lease Deed dated
executed between
and
(hereinafter referred to as the said Lease Deed) for an area admeasuring approx. sq. ft.
(approx. sq. mtrs.) on the Floor, Tower
,
(hereinafter referred to as the Demised Premises) along with the right to use car parking spaces.
In terms of Clause of the said Lease Deed,
we, , do hereby serve upon you the notice that we confirm to take the space of First Right of Refusal on lease as defined therein
with effect from the date of this letter as mentioned hereinabove.
This is for your notice and necessary action.
- 42 -
ANNEXURE C-V
ELECTRONIC CLEARING SYSTEM ACTIVATION FORM
|
|
|
|
|
1 |
|
Name of the Vendor: |
|
DLF ASSETS PVT. LTD. |
|
|
|
2 |
|
Contact person: |
|
Ms. Nancy Rana |
|
|
|
3 |
|
Designation: |
|
Manager |
|
|
|
4 |
|
Address: |
|
DLF GATEWAY TOWER, 6TH FLOOR, PHASE
III, GURGAON. |
|
|
|
5 |
|
Mobile No: |
|
7838088809 |
|
|
|
6 |
|
Contact No: |
|
0124-4778035 |
|
|
|
7 |
|
Email ID: |
|
Rana-nancy@dlf.in |
|
|
|
8 |
|
Fax: |
|
|
|
|
|
9. |
|
PAN: |
|
AACCD4923A |
|
|
|
10. |
|
TAN: |
|
DELD09632A |
|
|
|
11. |
|
Bank Name: |
|
CITI BANK |
|
|
|
12. |
|
Bank Address: |
|
JEEVAN BHARTI BUILDING, 124, CONNAUGHT CIRCUS,
NEW DELHI 110001. |
|
|
|
13. |
|
Account No.: |
|
0011812228 |
|
|
|
14. |
|
NEFT Code: |
|
CITI0000002 |
|
|
|
15. |
|
RTGS Code: |
|
CITI0000002 |
|
|
|
16. |
|
Swift Code *: |
|
CITIINBX |
Note:
|
|
THE LESSEE to check with concerned bank for NEFT / RTGS / SWIFT Codes. |
|
|
Swift Code is required in case THE LESSEE has an account with HSBC bank. |
|
|
Bill-wise details against NEFT payments by mail. |
- 43 -
ANNEXURE T-I
TENTATIVE SUPER BUILT UP AREA CALCULATIONS
TENTATIVE SUPER BUILT UP AREA CALCULATIONS
BLOCK
A2, DLF IT SEZ SILOKHERA
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
FLOOR / OFFICE NO. |
|
OFFICE AREA |
|
|
TERRACE AREA |
|
|
SUPER AREA |
|
|
TOTAL SUPER BUILT UP AREA |
|
|
(SQM) |
|
|
(SFT) |
|
|
(SQM) |
|
|
(SFT) |
|
|
(SQM) |
|
|
(SFT) |
|
|
(SQM) |
|
|
(SFT) |
|
EIGHTH/ 8F |
|
|
1660.582 |
|
|
|
17875 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2075.728 |
|
|
|
22343 |
|
|
|
2075.728 |
|
|
|
22343 |
|
NINETH/ 9F |
|
|
1600.582 |
|
|
|
17875 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2075.728 |
|
|
|
22343 |
|
|
|
2075.728 |
|
|
|
22343 |
|
TENTH/ 10F |
|
|
1654.718 |
|
|
|
17811 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2068.398 |
|
|
|
22264 |
|
|
|
2068.398 |
|
|
|
22264 |
|
ELEVENTH/11F/2 |
|
|
975.340 |
|
|
|
10499 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1219.176 |
|
|
|
13123 |
|
|
|
1219.176 |
|
|
|
13123 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
TOTAL |
|
|
5951.222 |
|
|
|
64060 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
7439.03 |
|
|
|
80073 |
|
|
|
7439.03 |
|
|
|
80073 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The Super built up area shall be the sum of Office area of the said premises and its prorata share of Common areas in the
entire said building i.e., Block A2.
Whereas the Office area of the said premises shall mean the entire area enclosed by its periphery walls including
area under walls, wall cladding, columns, half the area of walls common with other premises etc. which form integral part of said premises and prorata share of common corridor, AHU and electrical rooms for offices on this floor. Common area shall
mean all such parts / areas in the said building which M/s WNS Global Services Private Limited / Occupants of the said premises shall use by sharing with other Allottees / Occupants in the said building including entrance canopy and lobby, stilt
area, atrium, corridors and passages, common toilets, area of cooling towers, security / fire control room(s), lift shafts, all electrical shafts, D.G. shafts, AC shafts, pressurisation shafts, plumbing and fire shafts on all floors and rooms,
staircases, mumties, refuge areas, lift machine rooms, water tanks, electric substation and transformers. In addition entire services area in basement including but not limited to D.G. set rooms, AC plant room underground water and other storage
tanks, pump rooms, maintenance and service rooms, fan rooms and circulation areas etc. shall be counted towards common area.
- 44 -
TENTATIVE SUPER BUILT UP AREA CALCULATIONS
BLOCK A3, DLF IT SEZ SILOKHERA
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
FLOOR / OFFICE NO. |
|
OFFICE AREA |
|
|
TERRACE AREA |
|
|
SUPER AREA |
|
|
TOTAL SUPER BUILT UP AREA |
|
|
(SQM) |
|
|
(SFT) |
|
|
(SQM) |
|
|
(SFT) |
|
|
(SQM) |
|
|
(SFT) |
|
|
(SQM) |
|
|
(SFT) |
|
EIGHTH/ 8F |
|
|
1666.426 |
|
|
|
17937 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2083.033 |
|
|
|
22422 |
|
|
|
2083.033 |
|
|
|
22422 |
|
NINETH/ 9F |
|
|
1666.426 |
|
|
|
17937 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2083.033 |
|
|
|
22422 |
|
|
|
2083.033 |
|
|
|
22422 |
|
TENTH/ 10F |
|
|
1660.563 |
|
|
|
17874 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2075.704 |
|
|
|
22343 |
|
|
|
2075.704 |
|
|
|
22343 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
TOTAL |
|
|
4993.415 |
|
|
|
53748 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
6241.770 |
|
|
|
67187 |
|
|
|
6241.770 |
|
|
|
67187 |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The Super built up area shall be the sum of Office area of the said premises and its prorata share of Common areas in the
entire said building i.e., Block A3
Whereas the Office area of the said premises shall mean the entire area enclosed by its periphery walls including
area under walls, wall cladding, columns, half the area of walls common with other premises etc. which form integral part of said premises and prorata share of common corridor. AHU and electrical rooms for offices on this floor. Common area shall
mean all such parts / areas in the said building which M/s WNS Global Services Private Limited / Occupants of the said premises shall use by sharing with other Allottees / Occupants in the said building including entrance canopy and lobby, stilt
area, atrium, corridors and passages, common toilets, area of cooling towers, security / fine control room(s), lift shafts, all electrical shafts, D.G. shafts, AC shafts, pressurisation shafts, plumbing and fire shafts on all floors and rooms,
staircases, mumties, refuse areas, lift machine rooms, water tanks, electric substation and transformers. In addition entire services area in basement including but not limited to D.G. set rooms, AC plant room underground water and other storage
tanks, pump rooms, maintenance and service rooms, fan rooms and circulation areas etc. shall be counted towards common area.
- 45 -
ANNEXURE T-II
DESCRIPTION OF THE FLOOR PLAN(S) OF THE DEMISED PREMISES
(Highlighted area)
Entire 8 & 9th Floors, Block A2 & A3
- 46 -
Part of 11th Floor, Block A2
- 47 -
ANNEXURE T-III
CAR PARKING SPACES EARMARKED FOR USE BY THE LESSEE
Number of car parking spaces earmarked in the basement/stilt/ surface car parking spaces for use by THE LESSEE
One Hundred and Three (103) Numbers
- 48 -
ANNEXURE T-IV
MONTHLY MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE EXPENDITURE (INDICATIVE)
A. |
The expected monthly maintenance and service charges shall be 1.20 times the sum total of the following expenditure calculated on sq.ft. of super built up area basis and shall be charged every month. The
expenditure shall include but shall not be limited to the following: |
1. |
Annual maintenance contracts, service contract expenditure including taxes & statutory levies as applicable, lease rental and other charges for operation and maintenance of all electro-mechanical equipments and
all other equipment installed and to be additionally installed by THE LESSOR/maintenance agency. |
2. |
Cost of water for all purposes. |
3. |
Cost of electricity for central air-conditioning (excluding AHUs) and all services provided including in the parking, common and external areas. |
4. |
Cost of maintenance of landscaped areas, compound wall, tube well, electrification sewerage, roads and paths and any other services within the boundary of the Said Plot. |
5. |
Cost of maintenance, cleaning, painting and necessary replacements of a revenue nature in common areas including cost of maintenance of basements and common services therein. |
6. |
Cost of security services. |
7. |
Cost of administrative staff, maintenance staff of the building and the manager directly related to the maintenance of the building. |
8. |
Cost of all consumables for all services in common areas. |
9. |
Annual fees of various authorities. |
10. |
Cost of diesel and lubricants etc. for DG sets and cost of gas and lubricants etc. for gas generators and air conditioning systems etc. |
- 49 -
11. |
Cost of all replacements / refurnishing of parts of various equipments used in maintenance services. |
12. |
Cost of augmentation/upgradations/replacement/deployment of existing and additional security/fire/other electromechanical systems acquired through leasing/ amortization/ rental basis. |
13. |
Cost of expenses incurred on infrastructure in and around the Said Building. |
14. |
Cost of insurance of Building and fitouts when fitted out space is provided. |
15. |
Depreciation / sinking fund /lease rentals of all electro-mechanical equipments, including but not limited to chillers, D.G. Sets and lifts. |
16. |
Maintenance Charges for Car Parking Spaces. |
17. |
Any expenditure incurred on personnel, administrative and any other related cost of the custom/excise staff posted at SEZ operations. |
B. |
Cost of exclusive services, if any, provided to the occupant shall be extra. |
C. |
Service Tax and other taxes, as applicable, shall be additional. |
- 50 -
ANNEXURE T-V
TENTATIVE BUILDING SPECIFICATIONS
|
|
|
STRUCTURE |
|
RCC framed structure |
|
|
Finishes |
|
|
|
|
External Façade |
|
Combination of Clear Float Glass and/or Reflective floats glass with Granite / Metal Cladding / Exterior paint / any other. |
|
|
Atrium, Lift Lobbies Floors & Walls. |
|
Combination of Indian marbles and / or granites. |
|
|
Main staircase(s) / Fire Escape staircase(s) |
|
Terrazzo / Kota Stone / Good concrete. |
|
|
Elevators |
|
High Speed Passenger Elevators. Service
Elevator |
|
|
Parking |
|
Stilt/Surface/Basements |
|
|
Amenities |
|
Centrally Air Conditioned Building Provision for office area Air Conditioning provided upto AHU on each floor. The internal distribution system of Air Conditioning shall be sole responsibility of the tenant. |
|
|
Power Back up |
|
100% power back-up including power back up for AC system also. |
|
|
Fire Fighting |
|
Sprinkler and fire detection system will be provided in the basement area and common area only as per NBC. One layer of upright sprinklers for areas above the false ceiling shall be provided by THE LESSOR. Another layer of pendant
type sprinklers for areas below the false ceiling to be provided by THE LESSEE as per NBC norms. |
|
|
Wash room |
|
Gents / Ladies Toilet on each floor as per statutory norms, CI/GI piping will be provided, but no CP fittings, Fixtures Wall / Floor finishes. Door & shutters will be provided. |
|
|
Electricity/Telephone |
|
Provision on each floor up to the shaft. Connections have to be arranged by respective owners/users. No Electric conduits or wiring shall be provided in the slab. |
- 51 -
NOTE:
|
A. |
Materials specially the imported ones are subject to availability as per prevalent policies of Govt. of India. |
|
B. |
Wherever larger floor heights are provided due to architectural reasons, from the viewpoint of air conditioning load, the height of false ceiling to be done by THE LESSEE shall not exceed 3 mtrs. from the finished floor
level. |
|
C. |
The above-mentioned specifications are for common area only. The office area will be in Warm Shell condition only. All fittings, A.C. Ducts, Electrical distribution and Fire Fighting etc. shall be the sole
responsibility of THE LESSEE. |
|
D. |
Plumbing provision for extra toilets may be provided at one / two different locations |
|
E. |
The above specifications are tentative and are subject to change at the sole discretion of THE LESSOR. |
- 52 -
ANNEXURE T-VI
SHARING OF SERVICES / DIVISION OF FLOOR
(i) In case the Demised Premises is not contiguous with the AHU due to which the ducting is required to pass through any other LESSEEs premises
on the same floor, then THE LESSEE will provide FCU/AHU for the Demised Premises and will also bring chilled water piping up to the Demised Premises.
(ii) However, in case of floor division into two or more offices, such that the services are to be shared amongst The LESSEE of the floor, THE LESSEE
will design their services in sharing with the other LESSEE(s) on the floors. Similarly, THE LESSEE will not object to any other LESSEE passing their services from THE LESSEEs Demised Premises (if required). Any damage to the interiors of THE
LESSEE while passing of any common services by any other LESSEE will be rectified by the other LESSEE taking services through THE LESSEEs premises.
(iii) THE LESSEE {(if THE LESSEE is the first occupant to be using common AHU which is to be shared with the later occupant(s))}, will make
arrangements in their ducting/plenum for tap-off for any other LESSEE whose services are designed from a common AHU shared by THE LESSEE.
(iv)The
necessary electrical connection for the FCU/AHU is to be done by THE LESSEE and connected to THE LESSORs panel by doing the necessary modifications. Also, the cost of chilled water piping/any electrical/plumbing/fire fighting modification
shall be borne by THE LESSEE.
(v) HVAC plenum and lowside ducting needs to be done by THE LESSEE at its own cost. In case, all occupants of the
floor have closed their false ceiling and no duct is left for future lessee, THE LESSEE occupying at later stage will have to install their own FCU and make the necessary connections to chilled water lines. THE LESSEE is required to share the cost
of HVAC plenum/ ducting provisioning with other lessees.
(vi) Any dismantling of false ceiling of common areas for services by THE LESSEE is to be
made good (as per THE LESSORs specifications) by THE LESSEE at their own cost.
(vii) Sprinkler tap off: THE LESSEE has to take tap
off for down type Sprinklers with installation of valves under supervision of Building services.
- 53 -
ANNEXURE T-VII
GUIDING PRINCIPLES FOR THE FIT-OUTS OF THE DEMISED PREMISES
1. |
Temporary Electricity / Water Supply will be provided for fit-out works at one point in shaft on request by THE LESSEE. |
2. |
Construction Hoist / Staircase in the tower will be made available to shift the materials to the respective floors, whenever required by THE LESSEE. |
3. |
Vertical stacks for plumbing shall be made available on the relevant floor(s) when requested by THE LESSEE. |
4. |
Temporary toilets for labour force to be arranged by the respective contractors of THE LESSEE. |
5. |
Clear construction access. Materials to be kept by THE LESSEE at their respective floors. |
6. |
THE LESSOR shall not provide any storage space to THE LESSEE in the basements of the Said Building. |
7. |
THE LESSEE shall be fully responsible for all regulatory & statutory compliances at all times during fit-out period and during fit-out occupancy. |
- 54 -
ANNEXURE T-VIII
HANDOVER OF DEMISED PREMISES FOR OCCUPATION
1. |
Gas Generators, DG and Chillers shall be commissioned for servicing the Demised Premises when THE LESSEE has completed their scope of work for the low side before the integration with THE LESSOR high side services can
be done. The services will be provided/ connected within three working days of THE LESSEEs request after THE LESSEE has completed their scope of work including interiors as per drawings approved by THE LESSOR. |
2. |
Lift facility will be available one day before THE LESSEE starts operations, when advised by THE LESSEE. |
3. |
THE LESSEE to discuss and finalize all connectivity issues relating to telephone and wireless services with the service provider. Cables of Telephone Service Provider shall be terminated to the basement of the building.
|
4. |
THE LESSOR shall not provide any storage space to THE LESSEE in the basements of the Said Building. |
- 55 -
ANNEXURE T-IX
LIST OF DRAWINGS REQUIRED FOR APPROVAL BY THE LESSOR
1. Architectural Design
|
1. |
Interior layout drawing showing all the facilities provided. |
|
2. |
Typical section details showing the false ceiling height. |
|
3. |
Additional toilet/pantry detail drawings if any. |
|
4. |
False ceiling details along the curtain/structural glazing. |
2. Electrical Design
|
1. |
Electrical load sheet (Equipment and lighting load details). |
|
2. |
SLD showing load balancing of the system. |
|
4. |
Data and raceway layout. |
|
5. |
Power and LV system layout. |
|
6. |
Smoke detection and PA system layout. |
|
7. |
Coordinated Reflected Ceiling Plan with other services. |
|
8. |
Number of earth pits required to be provided. |
3. HVAC Design
|
1. |
Ducting layout showing AHU capacity. |
|
2. |
Chilled water pipe routing if provision of FCU required. |
|
3. |
Number of outdoor split units required in case provided by client. |
|
4. |
Toilet and pantry ventilation layout. |
4. Plumbing and Fire Fighting Design
|
1. |
Population / Occupancy details. |
|
2. |
Toilets and pantry plumbing detail drawings. |
Important Design Considerations
1. |
Upright layer of sprinklers provided by THE LESSOR shall not be disturbed by the client. A separate tap-off has been provided for installing the second layer of pendant type sprinklers. |
2. |
Sprinkler drop points to be MS threaded for 50mm & below as required by NBC. |
3. |
Quick response Sprinkler Bulbs to be installed. |
- 56 -
4. |
Flexible connections for sprinklers if used shall be UL listed & tested for working pressure at 200psi. |
5. |
If sprinklers are to be isolated in any area (server room / UPS room / Electrical room), an automatic fire fighting system such as FM200 or CO2 based system shall be provided by the client. |
6. |
No reduction in number of WCs/fixtures/urinals/wash-basins. |
7. |
Only cisterns to be used. No flush valves allowed. |
8. |
Fire Dampers shall be motorized and not fused linked. |
9. |
Fire dampers to be put both in supply ducting and return air path. |
10. |
AC split units/ PACs to be designed only for critical areas such as server room/Hub room/Cafeteria (in case client wants to avoid mixing of AHU air and cafeteria air). |
11. |
Only roller blinds to be provided. |
12. |
Partitions within office premise to be designed to terminate at mullions, keeping an expansion joint of 5mm to be filled with silicon sealant only. |
13. |
Provision for trap door has been made for all shafts. Trap doors to be provided by the client with proper locking arrangement. The trap doors shall not be permanently sealed /closed. One set of keys for the trap doors
should always be available with the security guard of the client so that the shaft is accessible during any emergency. The shaft accessible through the clients premises to be kept clean by the client at all times. |
14. |
Only MS Conduits shall be used for electrical wiring. |
15. |
The smoke detection and PA system being provided by the client is required to be integrated by the client with base buildings smoke detection and PA system. |
Notes:
1. |
The Lessee to submit the complete set of drawings/details which will be approved by THE LESSORs architect with comments and returned to THE LESSEE. Incomplete submission will not be approved. Two photocopies of
the approved drawings to be submitted one to DLF Building Services and another to DLF Technical Services for records. |
2. |
Drawings should be coordinated with other services drawing. |
3. |
Location of server room / UPS room or any other facility room where additional structural load is to be considered should be clearly marked with the equipment load details and layout, for structural design
consideration. |
4. |
Drawings should be of legible format and should be duly signed by Architect/Consultant. |
5. |
Design should be in compliance with NBC/fire norms/byelaws. |
6. |
Any modification sought in the base building or any facility which has an impact on the buildings architectural feature should be highlighted in the architectural drawings for approval. Such modifications seeking
any structural changes, façade changes or aesthetics of any building would not be considered. |
- 57 -
7. |
Name of the Architect/Consultant with his phone number should be mentioned on the drawings so that in case of clarification or discussion if any required can be done on the phone itself. |
8. |
Please ensure to mention the clients name, building name, floor and area on all the drawings. |
- 58 -
ANNEXURE T-X
THE LESSEES RESPONSIBILITY DURING INTERIOR FITOUTS WORK, ADDITIONS/ MODIFICATIONS/ ALTERATIONS OF INTERIOR WORKS (REFERRED HEREINAFTER AS INTERIOR
WORKS) AND DURING THE LEASE TERM / LEASE RENEWAL TERM AND DURING OPERATIONS
THE LESSOR has provided the fire detection systems as elaborated in Part
B. These systems are as per NBC norm.
A |
THE LESSEE will be responsible to ensure the following elaborated under different sub heads: |
(I) |
FIRE DETECTION & FIRE FIGHTING |
1. |
The existing sprinkler systems provided is not to be isolated or closed at any point of time during interior works. |
|
(a) |
For providing sprinklers below false ceiling a separate network of sprinklers to be installed. |
|
(b) |
Before starting the interior/fitout works, THE LESSEE will also check for themselves that the sprinkler systems are in working condition. |
|
(c) |
Upon completion of False Ceiling, the sprinkler below false ceiling is to be charged. Only upon charging the sprinklers below false ceiling, THE LESSEE can do other interior works and can bring in the carpets /
furniture / modular workstations/ chairs / wood for partitions etc. into the premises for installation. |
|
(d) |
Sprinkler system as per NBC. |
2. |
Fire detection, alarm systems and fire fighting systems must not be closed or isolated during the period when interior works are carried out or during the lease period or lease renewal period. (should be as per NBC).
|
2 (a). |
As and when there is Puja/ Havan in THE LESSEEs Premises the Building Manager to take proper action for alarm system so that other occupants are not disturbed. THE LESSEE shall send prior notice for the Puja/
Havan including the essential details like time, date and the venue to the Building Manager. |
- 59 -
3. |
Before start of Interior works THE LESSEE to ensure 4 nos. Fire Extinguishers, 4 Nos. Sand buckets & 4 nos. Water buckets are placed at different locations on each floor of the premises when THE LESSEE is
starting the interiors. |
4. |
Before doing any welding works, THE LESSEE to obtain hot works permit and ensure that the site is clear, no paper/wood pieces/or any other combustible material is around and adequate standby fire-fighting mechanism in
place, which includes at least 2 nos of fire extinguishers, 1 nos of sand buckets, 1 nos of water bucket etc are in place. Once the welding is completed, the site to be re-inspected for any welding spark. |
5. |
No gas of any kind to be used for welding purposes. Only arc/electrical welding to be used. |
6. |
Zonal fire detection panels are provided on all floors. THE LESSEE to ensure that at any point of time there would be some smoke detectors spread over the Demised Premises operational and connected to the Zonal panel.
|
7. |
During interior works, THE LESSEE to ensure proper signages and fire escape routes are prominently displayed inside their premises. |
8. |
Security Guards professionally trained in fire fighting systems to be deployed on each floor during all shifts round the clock. They should be capable of handling the fire-fighting equipments provided on the floors such
as fire hydrants etc. |
9. |
The entire building is a no smoking zone. THE LESSEE to ensure that even during interior works no person smokes inside the building. Match Boxes & Cigarette Lighters are not allowed at site in the building.
|
10. |
No items of any nature to be stored in Electrical Control / Panel Room. A stray electrical spark may result in such items catching fire; moreover, presence of such items may impede access to Control Panel in times of
emergency. |
11. |
Use/storage of cooking gas / cooking gas cylinders in the Demised Premises is not allowed. |
12. |
THE LESSEEs Security Personnel should not remain inside the offices after they have been closed for the day. Unauthorized smoking by such staff can also contribute to major fire. After closing hours, your
Security/Guard be stationed outside the office (and not within), and the interiors of the offices can be monitored by then over closed circuit video cameras. |
- 60 -
13. |
THE LESSEE to install automatic gas flooding Fire Extinguishing System, FM 200 or equivalent, in case THE LESSEE wants to remove the sprinkler system in the Server Room. The FM 200 will not be kept on manual mode under
any circumstances. |
(II) |
ELECTRICAL & MECHANICAL |
14. |
For the operational usage THE LESSOR has provided the electrical tap-off in electrical room along with sub-meters installed for supply of power from grid/supplying agency and back-up power. THE LESSEE to tap-off
electricity through proper distribution panel / board properly earthed. The distribution of electricity inside the premises during the interior works shall be responsibility of THE LESSEE. |
15. |
All electrical installation shall be carried by authorized licensed contractor and THE LESSEE shall submit installation test certificate issued by same contractor and certificate of verification of these installation by
a reputed electrical consultant. |
16. |
During interior works Electrical supply for fitout to be given through portable DG/Building DG (if installed). In case power for fitouts is provided through temporary portable DG installed outside, THE LESSEE will have
to take the tapping though a cable of suitable rating from outside the building. Lessee to take the electricity in a proper panel/fitted with MCB & ELCB with proper earthing. Cable of proper rating to be used as per load. No loose
connection & joints in wires will be allowed. During interior works while using drilling/hammering machine or any other electrical equipment, THE LESSEE shall ensure that proper 3 pin plugs are used. No over loading of socket will be
allowed. |
17. |
All outgoing feeders single phase & 3 phase in Panels & DBs outlets shall be suitable of individual equipment rating and out going feeders must have a protection arrangement so that it should trip in
the event of overload, short circuit & earth fault. |
18. |
All material to be used should be of IS Standard & from reputed manufacturer. No sub standard material to be used. |
19. |
No aluminum cable to be used. Only copper cables of ISI make to be used. |
20. |
Under no circumstances during interiors / operations should the safety system in the circuit / MCB / ELCB be bypassed. THE LESSOR to ensure that this is adhered to under all circumstances. |
- 61 -
21. |
Only CFL & tubes with electronic chokes to be used. No Aluminum / Copper chokes to be used. |
22. |
Compressors of Split AC/ Precision AC shall be serviced regularly to avoid overheating / jamming of compressor / fan motor. Stabilizer sockets to be checked regularly for heating. |
23. |
Supply from one socket to be used for one source only and 3 wire cable to be used rather than 3 different cables. No overloading of sockets. |
24. |
Balancing of load should be proper in all 3 phases. |
25. |
Coffee machine / water cooler/ oven and any other Electrical appliances should be properly earthed and to be used with a proper rating of cable through ELCB. |
26. |
For power output 15 amp plug; for lighting 5 amp plug and for AC industrial sockets to be used. |
27. |
Small step down transformer on false ceiling for lighting to be properly secured. |
28. |
No PVC pipes to be used for Electrical wiring, only MS pipes to be used. |
29. |
Electrical panel wiring to be properly dressed and the gap between the phases to be proper. |
30. |
CT provided in the electrical panel should be of proper size and should have a proper gap between the space and CT to be checked for any heating/ cracking. |
31. |
One circuit should not have more than eight light point or two power points. |
32. |
For neon signages, transformer should be placed outside safe place or LED signages to be used. |
33. |
THE LESSEE to ensure that the electro-mechanical systems installed in the Demised Premises is properly maintained during their interior works and at the time of operations. THE LESSEE to also ensure that no fire spreads
from the Demised Premises. |
- 62 -
34. |
THE LESSEE to have the audit of their entire Electrical systems done on a half-yearly basis by a reputed Electrical consultant and provide a certificate certifying that all THE LESSEEs installations including
insulation resistance are in good and safe working condition and does not have any possibility of short circuit and becoming a fire source. To be submitted to the facility manager on half-yearly basis. |
35. |
THE LESSEE to have the audit of their entire HVAC systems done on a half-yearly basis by a reputed HVAC consultant and provide a certificate certifying that all THE LESSEEs installations are in good and safe
working condition and does not have any possibility of short circuit and becoming a fire source. To be submitted to the facility manager on half-yearly basis. |
(III) |
DRAWINGS & SPECIFICATIONS |
36. |
THE LESSEE shall ensure that the fitout works is done as per the drawings approved by THE LESSORs architect. No deviation will be allowed. |
37. |
THE LESSEE to use fire retardant material in the design of their interior works. |
38. |
While designing of interior works, it should be kept in mind that the access to the fire hydrants is not restricted in any way. |
39. |
For flushing of water closets only cisterns/concealed cisterns are to be used. No flushing valves to be installed. |
40. |
THE LESSEE shall ensure that no structural damage takes place. |
41. |
Every day, on completion of work, THE LESSEE shall ensure that the site is cleaned all combustible & non-combustible scrap including any wood/paper/lose paint /any other material/scrap is remove from the
premises. |
42. |
THE LESSEE shall ensure that the malba/scrap is disposed out of site every day. |
43. |
THE LESSEE shall ensure that the stair cases are not blocked with interior fitout material. |
44. |
No material shall be stocked in the lift lobby area. |
- 63 -
45. |
THE LESSEE shall not store paint and other combustible material at Demised Premises. The material may be brought onto the floor for interior finishing as and when it is required. |
46. |
No storage of any material / records in basement is allowed as it obstructs free movement. However, for a limited period of 10 days during interior works THE LESSEE with the permission of the facility manager can use
this earmarked car/two wheeler parking space as temporary storage for fixture/furniture which is in the process of being installed. The same must be barricaded by THE LESSEE and THE LESSEE must depute a security guard for the same. THE LESSEE must
install a Fire Fighting system such as extinguishers, sand buckets & water buckets to the satisfaction of the facility manager for this temporary storage area. This furniture/fixture will be allowed to be brought only 7 days in advance of
installation. The storage area must be cleared by THE LESSEE immediately after shifting the material in their premises. In case the interiors are getting delayed beyond the targeted date, THE LESSEE will clear the temporary store immediately and
shift all material in their premises. When the material is shifted on the floor the packing / covering to be removed the same day and all packing / covering material to be shifted out of the premises and the building on the same day.
|
47. |
During normal office hours, no noisy interior works such as drilling, hammering, cutting, chisilling etc is to be carried out by THE LESSEE. The same can be done after normal office hours. However, works other than the
above can be carried on which cause no disturbance to the occupied floors. |
48. |
Working Norms for Interior Works |
|
(a) |
In New Building where no other LESSEE is operational the interior works can be done on 24 hrs. basis. |
|
(b) |
In a multi-tenanted building as soon as any other LESSEE completes their interior works and becomes operational; no noisy works to be done during office hours. |
|
(c) |
Noisy works such as drilling, hammering, cutting, chiseling etc. to be carrying out by THE LESSEE after normal office hours. |
49. |
No Parking of CNG / LPG powered cars in basements as the chances of occurrence of fire / explosion in such vehicles are very high. |
THE LESSEE shall use the parking spaces only for the purposes of parking its cars and for no other use.
- 64 -
THE LESSEE undertakes that it shall not make any constructions on the car /two wheeler parking
spaces or create obstruction of any kind on it or around these spaces to hinder the movement of vehicles and persons.
50. |
All the terraces of the Said Building including the parapet walls of the terraces shall always be the property of THE LESSOR and THE LESSOR shall be entitled to use the same for any purpose as it may deem fit.
|
51. |
The façade of the Said Building shall also be used by other LESSEES/Occupants for displaying their name and advertisements as per THE LESSORs approval. |
No signage of any kind either inside or outside shall be allowed on the façade glass/ columns of the Demised Premises.
52. |
That before any machinery, equipment, safe or furniture, etc. is moved into or out of the Demised Premises, due approval in writing must be taken by THE LESSEE from the Building Manager or other authorized personnel
appointed by THE LESSOR, in the absence of which the movement thereof will not be permitted by THE LESSOR, provided, however, such movement will be allowed during normal business hours only. |
53. |
Lifts/ elevators/ escalators of reputed makes have been provided in the Said Building/ Said Complex. |
THE LESSEE should educate its employees, visitors and customers with regard to the DOs and DONTs of the safe usage of these items.
These are self operating lifts/ elevators/ escalators. Dos and Donts as recommended by the suppliers are as displayed therein.
The maintenance of these items is done by giving AMCs to suppliers/ third parties.
In the event of any mishap occurring, THE LESSOR or its employees shall not be held responsible for any consequences arising from usage of
these items.
- 65 -
B. |
The following fire-detection and alarm system are provided as per NBC norms inside the premises: |
Fire Detection & Alarm System:
|
1. |
Main control / Alarm panel located in security room connected with the floor-wise zonal panel located near the staircase. |
|
2. |
The Smoke / Heat Detectors installed by the floor occupant are connected to the zonal panels located on the floors. |
|
3. |
The main panel has inbuilt zone-wise fire detector and automatic alarm on all floors, through an amplifier. |
|
4. |
All AHUs and other ventilation / pressurization systems are operationally hooked-up with fire alarm / detection system. |
Fire Fighting System
The following fire fighting systems are provided along with:
|
|
|
Fire Pumps (Hydrants & sprinkler) |
|
|
|
Diesel Driven engine pump |
|
|
|
Fire extinguishers in common areas |
|
|
|
Public address and Alarm System |
|
|
|
Automatic / manual Fire Alarm system |
The Fire Hydrant systems comprises of internal fire hydrant system
available on all the floors and the external hydrant system around the building.
Sprinkler system is provided in basement, Lift lobby and service area
and office areas as per NBC norms.
- 66 -
Exhibit 8.1
WNS (HOLDINGS) LIMITED
LIST OF SUBSIDIARIES
|
|
|
|
|
S/No. |
|
Name of Subsidiary |
|
Place of Incorporation |
|
|
|
1. |
|
WNS Global Services Netherlands Cooperative U.A. |
|
The Netherlands |
|
|
|
2. |
|
WNS North America, Inc. |
|
Delaware, USA |
|
|
|
3. |
|
WNS Global Services (UK) Limited |
|
United Kingdom |
|
|
|
4. |
|
WNS (Mauritius) Limited |
|
Mauritius |
|
|
|
5. |
|
WNS Global Services (Romania) S.R.L. |
|
Romania |
|
|
|
6. |
|
WNS Global Services Philippines, Inc. |
|
Philippines |
|
|
|
7. |
|
WNS Business Consulting Services Private Limited |
|
India |
|
|
|
8. |
|
WNS Workflow Technologies Limited |
|
United Kingdom |
|
|
|
9. |
|
Accidents Happen Assistance Limited |
|
United Kingdom |
|
|
|
10. |
|
WNS Global Services Inc. |
|
Delaware, USA |
|
|
|
11. |
|
Business Applications Associates Beijing Limited |
|
China |
|
|
|
12. |
|
WNS Capital Investment Limited |
|
Mauritius |
|
|
|
13. |
|
WNS Global Services (Private) Limited |
|
Sri Lanka |
|
|
|
14. |
|
WNS Customer Solutions (Singapore) Private Limited |
|
Singapore |
|
|
|
15. |
|
WNS Customer Solutions (Private) Limited |
|
Sri Lanka |
|
|
|
16. |
|
WNS Global Services Private Limited |
|
India |
|
|
|
17. |
|
WNS BPO Services Costa Rica, S.R.L. |
|
Costa Rica |
|
|
|
18. |
|
WNS Global Services (Australia) Pty Ltd |
|
Australia |
|
|
|
19. |
|
WNS Mauritius Limited ME (Branch) |
|
Dubai Airport Free Zone |
|
|
|
20. |
|
WNS Cares Foundation(1) |
|
India |
|
|
|
21. |
|
WNS Global Services (UK) Limited (Spółka Z Ograniczoną Odpowiedzialnością) Oddział W Polsce, Gdansk (Branch) |
|
Poland |
|
|
|
22. |
|
WNS Global Services SA (Pty) Ltd. |
|
South Africa |
|
|
|
23. |
|
Business Applications Associates Beijing Limited Guangzhou Branch (Branch) |
|
China |
|
|
|
24. |
|
WNS Global Services (Dalian) Co. Ltd. |
|
China |
|
|
|
25. |
|
WNS Global Services Private Limited (Singapore Branch)(2) |
|
Singapore |
|
|
|
26. |
|
WNS Legal Assistance LLP(3) |
|
United Kingdom |
Notes:
(1). |
WNS Cares Foundation is a not-for-profit organization registered under formerly Section 25 of the Indian Companies Act, 1956 (which has become Section 8 of the Indian Companies Act, 2013), formed for the
purpose of promoting corporate social responsibilities. |
(2) |
WNS Global Services Private Limited (Singapore Branch) is a branch office of WNS Global Services Private Limited registered in Singapore on November 28, 2014. |
(3) |
WNS Legal Assistance LLP was incorporated under the Limited Liability Partnerships Act, 2000 in the UK on November 4, 2014. |
Exhibit 12.1
Certification of Chief Executive Officer
Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
I, Keshav R. Murugesh, certify that:
1. |
I have reviewed this annual report on Form 20-F of WNS (Holdings) Limited; |
2. |
Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such
statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report; |
3. |
Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the
company as of, and for, the periods presented in this report; |
4. |
The companys other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal
control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15(d)-15(f)) for the company and have: |
|
(a) |
designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the company, including its
consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared; |
|
(b) |
designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of
financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles; |
|
(c) |
evaluated the effectiveness of the companys disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the
period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and |
|
(d) |
disclosed in this report any change in the companys internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by the annual report that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to
materially affect, the companys internal control over financial reporting; and |
5. |
The companys other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the companys auditors and the Audit Committee of the
companys Board of Directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions): |
|
(a) |
all significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the companys ability to record, process,
summarize and report financial information; and |
|
(b) |
any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the companys internal control over financial reporting. |
Date: May 5, 2015
|
|
|
By: |
|
/s/ Keshav R. Murugesh |
Name: |
|
Keshav R. Murugesh |
Title: |
|
Group Chief Executive Officer |
Exhibit 12.2
Certification of Chief Financial Officer
Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
I, Sanjay Puria, certify that:
1. |
I have reviewed this annual report on Form 20-F of WNS (Holdings) Limited; |
2. |
Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such
statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report; |
3. |
Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the
company as of, and for, the periods presented in this report; |
4. |
The companys other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal
control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15(d)-15(f)) for the company and have: |
|
(a) |
designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the company, including its
consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared; |
|
(b) |
designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of
financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles; |
|
(c) |
evaluated the effectiveness of the companys disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the
period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and |
|
(d) |
disclosed in this report any change in the companys internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by the annual report that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to
materially affect, the companys internal control over financial reporting; and |
5. |
The companys other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the companys auditors and the Audit Committee of the
companys Board of Directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions): |
|
(a) |
all significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the companys ability to record, process,
summarize and report financial information; and |
|
(b) |
any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the companys internal control over financial reporting. |
Date: May 5, 2015
|
|
|
By: |
|
/s/ Sanjay Puria |
Name: |
|
Sanjay Puria |
Title: |
|
Group Chief Financial Officer |
Exhibit 13.1
Certification of Chief Executive Officer
Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as created by Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, the undersigned officer of WNS
(Holdings) Limited (the Company) hereby certifies, to such officers knowledge, that:
|
(i) |
the accompanying annual report on Form 20-F of the Company for the year ended March 31, 2015 (the Report) fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or Section 15(d), as
applicable, of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended; and |
|
(ii) |
the information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company. |
Date: May 5, 2015
|
|
|
By: |
|
/s/ Keshav R. Murugesh |
Name: |
|
Keshav R. Murugesh |
Title: |
|
Group Chief Executive Officer |
The foregoing certification is being furnished solely to accompany the Report pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, and is
not being filed either as part of the Report or as a separate disclosure statement, and is not to be incorporated by reference into the Report or any other filing of the Company, whether made before or after the date hereof, regardless
of any general incorporation language in such filing. The foregoing certification shall not be deemed filed for purposes of Section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or otherwise subject to the liabilities of
Section 18 or Sections 11 and 12(a)(2) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.
Exhibit 13.2
Certification of Chief Financial Officer
Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as created by Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, the undersigned officer of WNS
(Holdings) Limited (the Company) hereby certifies, to such officers knowledge, that:
|
(i) |
the accompanying annual report on Form 20-F of the Company for the year ended March 31, 2015 (the Report) fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or Section 15(d), as
applicable, of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended; and |
|
(ii) |
the information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company. |
Date: May 5, 2015
|
|
|
By: |
|
/s/ Sanjay Puria |
Name: |
|
Sanjay Puria |
Title: |
|
Group Chief Financial Officer |
The foregoing certification is being furnished solely to accompany the Report pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, and is
not being filed either as part of the Report or as a separate disclosure statement, and is not to be incorporated by reference into the Report or any other filing of the Company, whether made before or after the date hereof, regardless
of any general incorporation language in such filing. The foregoing certification shall not be deemed filed for purposes of Section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or otherwise subject to the liabilities of
Section 18 or Sections 11 and 12(a)(2) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.
Exhibit 15.1
CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
We have issued our reports dated May 5, 2015 with respect to the consolidated financial statements and internal control over financial reporting included
in the Annual Report of WNS (Holdings) Limited on Form 20-F for the year ended March 31, 2015.
We hereby consent to the incorporation by reference of
said reports in the Registration Statements of WNS (Holdings) Limited on Form S-8 (File No. 333-136168, File No. 333-157356, File No. 333-176849 and File No. 333-191416).
/s/ GRANT THORNTON INDIA LLP
Mumbai, India
May 5, 2015
WNS (NYSE:WNS)
Historical Stock Chart
From Oct 2024 to Nov 2024
WNS (NYSE:WNS)
Historical Stock Chart
From Nov 2023 to Nov 2024